TABLE OF CONTENTS
As filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on January 18, 2022
Registration No. 333-261059
UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
WASHINGTON, D.C. 20549
Amendment No. 1
to
FORM S-1
REGISTRATION STATEMENT
UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, INC.
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)
Delaware
(State or other jurisdiction of
incorporation or organization)
7370
(Primary Standard Industrial
Classification Code Number)
83-0662116
(I.R.S. Employer
Identification Number)
1233 West Loop South, Suite 1170
Houston, TX 77027
(Address, including zip code, and telephone number, including area code, of registrant’s principal executive offices)
Mark Walker
Chairman and Chief Executive Officer
Keith Smith
President
1233 West Loop Suite 1170
Houston, TX 77027
(832) 402-1051
(Name, address, including zip code, and telephone number, including area code, of agent for service)
Copies to:
Phyllis Young, Esq.
Stephen E. Older, Esq.
Rakesh Gopalan, Esq.
McGuireWoods LLP
1251 Avenue of the Americas, 20th Floor
New York, New York 10020
(212) 548-2100
Ben A. Stacke, Esq.
Jonathan R. Zimmerman, Esq.
Faegre Drinker Biddle & Reath LLP
2200 Wells Fargo Center
90 South Seventh Street
Minneapolis, Minnesota 55402
(612) 766-7000
Approximate date of commencement of proposed sale to the public: As soon as practicable after the effective date of this registration statement.
If any of the securities being registered on this Form are to be offered on a delayed or continuous basis pursuant to Rule 415 under the Securities Act of 1933, check the following box.   ☒
If this Form is filed to register additional securities for an offering pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering.   ☐
If this Form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(c) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering.   ☐
If this Form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(d) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering.   ☐
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, a smaller reporting company or an emerging growth company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer,” “smaller reporting company,” and “emerging growth company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.
Large accelerated filer
Accelerated filer
Non-accelerated filer
Smaller reporting company
Emerging growth company
If an emerging growth company, indicate by check mark if the registrant has elected not to use the extended transition period for complying with any new or revised financial accounting standards provided pursuant to Section 7(a)(2)(B) of the Securities Act. ☐
CALCULATION OF REGISTRATION FEE
Title of Each Class of Securities
to be Registered
Amount To Be
Registered(1)
Proposed Maximum
Offering Price
Per Share
Proposed Maximum
Aggregate
Offering Price(1)(2)
Amount of
Registration Fee(2)
Class A common stock, par value $0.001 per share
4,600,000
$9.00
$41,400,000
$3,837.78
Representatives’ Warrants(3)
Class A common stock underlying Representatives’ Warrants
230,000
$10.80
$2,484,000
$230.27
Total
4,830,000
      —
$43,884,000
$4,068.05 (4)
(1)
Estimated solely for the purpose of calculating the amount of the registration fee pursuant to Rule 457(a) under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.
(2)
Includes 600,000 shares of Class A common stock that the underwriters have the option to purchase to cover over-allotments, if any.
(3)
We have agreed to issue to the representatives of the several underwriters warrants to purchase the number of shares of our common stock (the “Representatives’ Warrants”) in the aggregate amount equal to five percent (5%) of the shares of our common stock to be issued and sold. The Representatives’ Warrants are exercisable for a price per share equal to 120% of the public offering price.
(4)
The registrant previously paid $3,708.00 of this amount in connection with the initial filing of this Registration Statement.
The registrant hereby amends this registration statement on such date or dates as may be necessary to delay its effective date until the registrant shall file a further amendment that specifically states that this registration statement shall thereafter become effective in accordance with Section 8(a) of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, or until the registration statement shall become effective on such date as the Securities and Exchange Commission, acting pursuant to said Section 8(a), may determine.

TABLE OF CONTENTS
The information in this preliminary prospectus is not complete and may be changed. We may not sell these securities until the registration statement filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission is effective. This preliminary prospectus is not an offer to sell these securities and it is not soliciting an offer to buy these securities in any jurisdiction where the offer or sale is not permitted.
SUBJECT TO COMPLETION, DATED JANUARY 18, 2022
PRELIMINARY PROSPECTUS
4,000,000 Shares
[MISSING IMAGE: LG_DIRECTDIGITALBLACK-4CLR.JPG]
Class A Common Stock
This is our initial public offering of our Class A common stock. Prior to this offering, there has been no public market for shares of our Class A common stock. We currently estimate that the initial public offering price will be between $7.00 and $9.00 per share. We have applied to list our Class A common stock on the Nasdaq Capital Market under the symbol “DRCT.”
We intend to use the net proceeds that we receive from this offering to purchase from Direct Digital Holdings, LLC (“DDH LLC”) newly issued common units of DDH LLC (the “LLC Units”). There is no public market for the LLC Units. The purchase price for each newly issued LLC Unit will be equal to the initial public offering price of each share of our Class A common stock, less the underwriting discounts and commissions referred to below. We intend to cause DDH LLC to use the net proceeds it receives from us in connection with this offering as described in the section titled “Use of Proceeds,” including to repurchase from USDM Holdings, Inc. (“USDM”) all of the units in DDH LLC held by USDM. The other holders of units in DDH LLC will retain their units in DDH LLC. This offering is being conducted through what is commonly referred to as an umbrella partnership-C Corporation (“Up-C”) structure, which is often used by partnerships and limited liability companies undertaking an initial public offering. The Up-C structure will allow the holders of the units in DDH LLC, who will retain their equity ownership in DDH LLC (collectively, the “Continuing LLC Owners”), to continue to realize tax benefits associated with owning interests in an entity that is treated as a partnership, or “passthrough” entity, for U.S. federal income tax purposes and may provide future tax benefits for both Direct Digital Holdings, Inc. and the Continuing LLC Owners if and when the Continuing LLC Owners ultimately redeem or exchange their LLC Units for shares of our Class A common stock. We are a holding company, and upon the closing of this offering and the application of proceeds therefrom our principal asset will be the LLC Units we purchase from DDH LLC, representing an aggregate 26.0% economic interest in DDH LLC. The remaining 74.0% economic interest in DDH LLC will be owned by the Continuing LLC Owners through their ownership of LLC Units. See the section titled “Organizational Transactions.”
Following the closing of this offering, we will have two classes of common stock: Class A common stock and Class B common stock. The Class B common stock, which we refer to as noneconomic voting equity interests, will have no rights to receive any distributions or dividends, whether cash or stock, and will not be publicly traded. Each share of Class A common stock and each share of Class B common stock will entitle its holder to one vote per share on all matters presented to our stockholders. Immediately following the completion of this offering, (i) all of our Class B common stock will be held by the Continuing LLC Owners, on a one-to-one basis with the number of LLC Units they respectively own, (ii) the holders of our Class A common stock issued in this offering collectively will hold 100% of the economic interests in us and 26.0% of the voting power in us, (iii) the Continuing LLC Owners, through their ownership of Class B common stock, collectively will hold no economic interest in us and the remaining 74.0% of the voting power in us and (iv) USDM will hold no interest in DDH LLC or us.
We will be the sole managing member of DDH LLC. We will operate and control all of the business and affairs of DDH LLC and, through DDH LLC and its subsidiaries, conduct our business. Upon the completion of this offering, the aggregate number of shares owned by our controlling stockholder, Direct Digital Management, LLC (“DDM”), a holding company owned by our Chairman and Chief Executive Officer and our President, will represent approximately 74.0% of the total voting power of our outstanding capital stock (or approximately 71.2% of the total voting power of our outstanding capital stock, if the underwriters exercise in full their option to purchase additional shares of Class A common stock). As a result of the voting control held by DDM following this offering, we will be a “controlled company” under the listing requirements of The Nasdaq Stock Market LLC and the Nasdaq Marketplace Rules. We do not intend to rely on the exemptions from the corporate governance requirements of the Nasdaq Marketplace Rules.
We are an “emerging growth company,” as defined under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities Act”), and will be subject to reduced public reporting requirements. This prospectus complies with the requirements that apply to an issuer that is an emerging growth company. See “Prospectus Summary — Implications of Being an Emerging Growth Company.”
Investing in our Class A common stock involves risks. See “Risk Factors” beginning on page 23 to read about factors you should consider before buying our Class A common stock.
Per Share
Total
Initial public offering price
$         $        
Underwriting discounts and commissions(1)
$ $
Proceeds, before expenses, to us
$ $
(1)
See “Underwriting” for additional information regarding compensation payable to the underwriters.
The offering is being underwritten on a firm commitment basis. We have granted the underwriters an option for 45 days to purchase up to an additional 600,000 shares of Class A common stock from us at the initial public offering price less the underwriting discounts and commissions to cover over-allotments, if any.
Neither the Securities and Exchange Commission nor any other regulatory body or state securities commission has approved or disapproved of these securities or passed upon the accuracy or adequacy of this prospectus. Any representation to the contrary is a criminal offense.
The underwriters expect to deliver the shares of Class A common stock to purchasers on or about                  , 2022.
Joint Book-Running Managers
The Benchmark Company
Roth Capital Partners
Prospectus dated                  , 2022.

TABLE OF CONTENTS
[MISSING IMAGE: TM2125950D3-COV_PAGE14CLR.JPG]

TABLE OF CONTENTS
[MISSING IMAGE: TM2125950D6-COV_02PAGE4CLR.JPG]

TABLE OF CONTENTS
[MISSING IMAGE: TM2125950D6-COV_03PAGE4CLR.JPG]

TABLE OF CONTENTS
  We reach your audience at the right time in the right place and on the right device.
[MISSING IMAGE: TM2125950D1-COV_PAGE44CLR.JPG]

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Page
1
16
23
52
54
55
56
61
63
66
72
91
104
111
117
121
123
128
129
134
141
141
Through and including           , 2022 (the 25th day after the date of this prospectus), all dealers that buy, sell, or trade shares of our Class A common stock, whether or not participating in our initial public offering, may be required to deliver a prospectus. This delivery requirement is in addition to the obligation of dealers to deliver a prospectus when acting as underwriter and with respect to its unsold allotments or subscriptions.
Neither we nor the underwriters have authorized anyone to provide any information or to make any representations other than those contained in this prospectus or in any free writing prospectuses we have prepared. We take no responsibility for, and can provide no assurance as to the reliability of, any other information that others may give you. We are offering to sell, and seeking offers to buy, shares of our Class A common stock only in jurisdictions where offers and sales are permitted. The information in this prospectus is accurate only as of the date of this prospectus, regardless of the time of delivery of this prospectus or any sale of shares of our Class A common stock. Our business, financial condition, results of operations and prospects may have changed since that date.
For investors outside the United States: Neither we nor any of the underwriters have done anything that would permit this offering or the possession or distribution of this prospectus in any jurisdiction where action for that purpose is required, other than in the United States. Persons outside of the United States who come into possession of this prospectus must inform themselves about, and observe any restrictions relating to, this offering and the possession and distribution of this prospectus outside of the United States.
INDUSTRY AND MARKET DATA
Unless otherwise indicated, information in this prospectus concerning economic conditions, our industry, our markets and our competitive position is based on a variety of sources, including information from independent industry analysts and publications, as well as our own estimates and research.
 
i

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
Our estimates are derived from publicly available information released by third-party sources, as well as data from our internal research, and are based on such data and our knowledge of our industry, which we believe to be reasonable. The independent industry publications used in this prospectus were not prepared on our behalf. While we are not aware of any misstatements regarding any information presented in this prospectus, forecasts, assumptions, expectations, beliefs, estimates and projections involve risk and uncertainties and are subject to change based on various factors, including those described under the headings “Cautionary Note Regarding Forward-Looking Statements” and “Risk Factors.”
TRADEMARKS AND TRADE NAMES
We own or have rights to trademarks, service marks and trade names that we use in connection with the operation of our business, including our corporate names and logos. Other trademarks, service marks and trade names appearing in this prospectus are the property of their respective owners. Solely for convenience, some of the trademarks, service marks and trade names referred to in this prospectus are listed without the ® or ™ symbols, but we will assert, to the fullest extent under applicable law, our rights to our trademarks, service marks and trade names.
 
ii

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
BASIS OF PRESENTATION
In connection with the closing of this offering, we will effect certain organizational transactions. Unless otherwise stated or the context otherwise requires, all information in this prospectus reflects the completion of the organizational transactions and this offering (the “Organizational Transactions”). See the section titled “Organizational Transactions” for additional information regarding the Organizational Transactions.
Unless the context requires otherwise, references in this prospectus to:

the “Company,” “Direct Digital,” “Direct Digital Holdings,” “DDH,” “we,” “us” and “our” refer (i) following the completion of the Organizational Transactions, including this offering, to Direct Digital Holdings, Inc., and, unless otherwise stated, all of its subsidiaries, including Direct Digital Holdings, LLC, which we refer to as “DDH LLC,” and, unless otherwise stated, its subsidiaries, and (ii) on or prior to the completion of the Organizational Transactions, including this offering, to Direct Digital Holdings, LLC and, unless otherwise stated, its subsidiaries.

“Continuing LLC Owners” refers to the individuals and entities that will continue to own LLC Units (as defined below) and which also hold noneconomic shares of Class B common stock after the completion of the Organizational Transactions. The Continuing LLC Owners may, following the completion of this offering, exchange or redeem their LLC Units for shares of our Class A common stock as described in the section titled “Certain Relationships and Related Person Transactions — DDH LLC Agreement,” together with a cancellation of the same number of their shares of Class B common stock.

“DDM” refers to Direct Digital Management, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company owned by Mark Walker, our Chairman and Chief Executive Officer, and Keith Smith, our President.

“LLC Units” refers to the multiple classes of common units in DDH LLC until we adopt our amended and restated LLC agreement upon the effectiveness of this offering, after which “LLC Units” refers to economic nonvoting common units in DDH LLC.

“Tax Receivable Agreement” refers to the tax receivable agreement to be entered into following this offering by and among Direct Digital Holdings, DDH LLC and the Continuing LLC Owners. See the section titled “Certain Relationships and Related Person Transactions — Tax Receivable Agreement” for additional information.

“USDM” refers to USDM Holdings, LLC, a holding company owned by Leah Woolford, former manager of DDH LLC, which (i) following the completion of the Organization Transactions, including this offering, will hold no LLC Units, no shares of our Class A common stock and no shares of our Class B common stock and (ii) on or prior to the completion of the Organizational Transactions, including this offering, holds certain units in DDH LLC.
Following completion of the Organizational Transactions and the application of net proceeds therefrom, we will be a holding company and the sole managing member of DDH LLC and our principal asset will be our interests in DDH LLC. DDH LLC is the predecessor of the issuer, Direct Digital, for financial reporting purposes. Accordingly, this prospectus contains the historical consolidated financial statements of DDH LLC. As we will have no other interest in any operations other than those of DDH LLC and its subsidiaries, the historical consolidated financial information included in this prospectus is that of DDH LLC and its subsidiaries. As Direct Digital has no business transactions or activities to date and had no assets or liabilities during the periods presented, the historical financial statements of this entity are not included in this prospectus. Following completion of this offering, the reporting entity for purposes of periodic reporting will be Direct Digital.
The unaudited pro forma financial information of Direct Digital Holdings presented in this prospectus has been derived by the application of pro forma adjustments to the historical consolidated financial statements of DDH LLC and its subsidiaries included elsewhere in this prospectus. The unaudited pro forma consolidated financial data of Direct Digital Holdings presented in this prospectus has been derived from the application of pro forma adjustments to the historical consolidated financial statements of DDH LLC included elsewhere in this prospectus. These pro forma adjustments give effect to the Organizational Transactions as described in the section titled “Organizational Transactions,” including the completion of
 
iii

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
this offering and other related transactions, as if all such transactions had occurred on an earlier date. See the section titled “Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Financial Information” for a complete description of the adjustments and assumptions underlying the unaudited pro forma consolidated financial data included in this prospectus.
 
iv

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
PROSPECTUS SUMMARY
This summary highlights information contained in greater detail elsewhere in this prospectus. This summary is not complete and does not contain all of the information you should consider in making your investment decision. You should read the entire prospectus carefully before making an investment in our Class A common stock and should carefully consider, among other things, our consolidated financial statements and the related notes and the sections entitled “Risk Factors,” “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations,” “Business” and “Organizational Transactions” included elsewhere in this prospectus.
Company Overview
We are an end-to-end, full-service programmatic advertising platform primarily focused on providing advertising technology, data-driven campaign optimization and other solutions to underserved and less efficient markets on both the buy- and sell-side of the digital advertising ecosystem. Direct Digital Holdings, Inc. is the holding company for the business formed in 2018 by our acquisitions of Huddled Masses, LLC (“Huddled Masses”) and Colossus Media, LLC (“Colossus Media”). Colossus Media operates our proprietary sell-side programmatic platform operating under the trademarked banner of Colossus SSP™ (“Colossus SSP”). Huddled Masses is the platform for the buy-side of our business. In 2020, we acquired Orange142, LLC (“Orange142”) to further bolster our overall programmatic buy-side advertising platform and to enhance our offerings across multiple industry verticals such as travel, healthcare, education, financial services, consumer products, etc. with particular emphasis on small- and mid-sized businesses (which we define as companies with revenue between $5 million and $500 million) transitioning into digital with growing digital media budgets.
This offering is being conducted through what is commonly referred to as an Up-C structure, which is often used by partnerships and limited liability companies when they decide to undertake an initial public offering. See “Summary of the Organizational Transactions” later in this Prospectus Summary for important details regarding our structure.
In the digital advertising space, buyers, particularly small- and mid-sized businesses, can potentially achieve significantly higher return on investment (“ROI”) on their advertising spend compared to traditional media advertising by leveraging data-driven over-the-top/connected TV (“OTT/CTV”), video and display, in-app, native, and audio advertisements that are delivered both at scale and on a highly targeted basis. Traditional (non-digital) advertising, such as broadcast TV or print media, follows the “spray and pray” approach to reach out to the public, but the ROI from using such traditional (non-digital) advertising campaigns is mostly unpredictable. On the other hand, digital advertising is heavily data-driven and can provide real-time details of targeted advertising campaigns and outcomes. On the sell-side, publishers can more successfully sell their advertising inventory in a programmatic manner by sharing data and information about their digital audiences at scale on an individualized basis, which helps buyers on SSPs such as our Colossus SSP to better target audiences.
 
1

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
[MISSING IMAGE: TM2125950D1-FC_PROGRAM4C.JPG]
We believe that we have a unique competitive advantage due to our data-driven technology that allows us to provide front-end, buy-side planning for our small- and mid-sized clients, coupled with our proprietary Colossus SSP where we can curate the last-mile in the execution process to drive higher ROI. Each month, the Colossus SSP processes over 35 billion impressions and over 150 billion auction bid requests that seek to buy ad inventory from our publishers. In September 2021, Colossus SSP served over 39,386 clients. In our business and throughout this prospectus, we use the terms client and customer interchangeably.
We enable small- and mid-sized clients to leverage programmatic technology to engage their potential customers more directly, on a one-on-one basis, in any local market, with specificity to media device and footprint. Our technology leverages data to assess where our clients’ potential customers are in the decision-making process and manage campaign pacing and optimization based on data-driven analytics to drive the purchasing decision or encourage the call to action. The result is the mutual benefit to both our buy-side and sell-side clients, in that our buy-side clients enjoy a more even playing field compared to larger advertisers by driving more effective marketing and advertising in local markets that are compatible to their business footprint. In addition, our sell-side clients enjoy greater opportunity to monetize their ad inventory to new ad buyers that otherwise would be unavailable to them.
We have aligned our business strategy to capitalize on what we believe are significant growth opportunities due to fundamental market shifts and industry inefficiencies. Several trends, happening in parallel, are revolutionizing the way that advertising is bought and sold. Specifically, the rise of the internet has led to a wholesale change in the way that media is consumed and monetized, as ads can be digitally delivered on a 1-to-1 basis. In traditional methods of advertising, such as broadcast TV, ads can target a specific network, program or geography, but not a single household or individual as digital and OTT/CTV ads can. Traditional television U.S. ad spending declined by 12.5% in 2020, while digital spend grew by 15% during the same period and is projected to show growth of approximately 25% for 2021. Additionally, we expect that the continued destabilization, including the phase out of digital “cookies” in 2023, will (i) create more opportunities for technology companies that provide next-generation CTV and digital solutions and (ii) minimize performance disruption for advertisers and agencies.
 
2

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
The buy-side component of our business is comprised of Huddled Masses, which has been in operation since 2012, and Orange142, which has been in operation since 2013. Both businesses offer technology-enabled advertising solutions and strategic planning to clients. In particular, our buy-side platform focuses on small-to-mid-sized clients. With marketing budgets typically more limited and operating footprints generally more local or state-to-state, we believe small- and mid-sized businesses are focused primarily on ROI-based results that deliver precise advertising and measurable campaign success to level the playing field with larger competitors. Serving the needs of hundreds of small- and mid-sized clients, with more than 4,000 campaigns annually, the buy-side of our business leverages the insights of leading demand side platforms (“DSPs”), such as The Trade Desk, Xandr, Google DV360, MediaMath and others, to drive increased advertising ROI and reduced customer acquisition costs for our clients.
Colossus Media, which has been in operation since 2017, is our proprietary sell-side programmatic platform operating under the trademarked banner of Colossus SSP™. Colossus SSP is a stand-alone tech-enabled, data-driven platform that helps deliver targeted advertising to diverse and multicultural audiences, including African Americans, Latin Americans, Asian Americans and LGBTQ+ customers, as well as other specific audiences. We partner with both large publishers such as Hearst, Meredith, Gannett, Univision, and several others, as well as smaller publishers such as Ebony Magazine, People Magazine, Family Traveler, Dinero, Sailing World, and many others.
Our business strategy on the sell-side also presents significant growth potential, as we believe we are well positioned to be able to bring underserved multicultural publishers into the advertising ecosystem, thereby increasing our value proposition across all clients including our large clients. We have proprietary rights to the Colossus SSP via a license agreement with a third-party developer. We believe the Colossus SSP is the last-mile of delivery for our buy-side clients in that our customized technology curates unique, highly-optimized audiences informed by proprietary data and data analytics, resulting in increased campaign performance.
Each impression or transaction occurs in a fraction of a second. Given that most transactions take place in an auction/bidding format, we continue to make investments across the platform to further reduce the processing time. In addition to the robust infrastructure supporting our platform, it is also critical that we align with key industry partners in the digital supply chain. The Colossus SSP is agnostic to any specific demand side platform.
We also leverage a sophisticated data management platform, which is DDH’s proprietary data collection and data marketing platform used to gather first-party data, market intelligence and audience segmentation information to support campaign optimization efforts for buy-side clients, Colossus SSP clients and third-party clients. Our combined platform offers results in an enhanced, highly loyal client base, particularly on the buy-side.
Our Industry and Trends
There are several key industry trends that are revolutionizing the way that advertising is bought and sold. We are well positioned to take advantage of the rapidly evolving industry trends in digital marketing and shifts in consumer behavior, including:
Shift to Digital Advertising.   Media has increasingly become more digital as a result of three key items:

Advances in technology with more sophisticated digital content delivery across multiple platforms;

Changes in consumer behavior, including spending longer portions of the day using mobile and other devices; and

Better audience segmentation with more efficient targeting and measurable results.
The resulting shift has enabled a variety of options for advertisers to efficiently target and measure their advertising campaigns across nearly every media channel and device. These efforts have been led by big-budgeted, large, multi-national corporations incentivized to cast a broad advertising net to support
 
3

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
national brands. Based on eMarketer data, 65% of small- and mid-sized companies expect to increase their programmatic advertising budget, and of those companies, 12% expect to increase their advertising spending by over 25%.
Shift from Linear Broadcast to OTT/CTV.   According to eMarketer, as of the end of 2019, approximately 84 million U.S. households maintained a cable subscription which declined to approximately 78 million U.S. households at the end of 2020. However, advertising reach could access more than 104 million households via OTT and CTV channels. Consumers increasingly want the flexibility and freedom to consume content on their own terms resulting in access to premium content at lower prices and with fewer interruptions. Advertisers are recognizing these trends and reallocating their ad budgets accordingly to those companies that can access audiences through a variety of existing and new channels.
Increased Adoption of Digital Advertising by Small- and Mid-Sized Companies.   Only recently small- and mid-sized businesses have begun to leverage the power of digital media in meaningful ways, as emerging technologies have enabled advertising across multiple channels in a highly localized nature. Campaign efficiencies yielding measurable results and higher advertising ROI, as well as the needs necessitated by the COVID-19 pandemic, have prompted these companies to begin utilizing digital advertising on an accelerated pace. We believe this market is rapidly expanding, and that small-to-mid-sized advertisers will continue to increase their digital spend.
Significant Increase in Multicultural Audience and Targeted Content.   As digital media has grown and emerging marketing channels continue to gain adoption, audience segmentation, including on multicultural lines, has become more granular. A growing and increasing segment of those audiences is the multicultural audience, which has been traditionally underserved in the industry. According to the U.S. Census Bureau, racial minority and multi-racial consumers represent 42% of the U.S. population and are projected to be the numerical majority in the U.S. by 2044. When we expand the definition of multicultural to include LGBTQ+ customers, the numbers are significantly greater. Advertisers and publishers alike face the same challenge. Advertisers are seeking new avenues and opportunities to connect with multicultural audiences in their natural media consumption environments while publishers are producing unique content to attract loyal consumers. The advantage will go to those innovative companies able to directly connect both sides to those audiences and leverage the insights flowing from those connections.
Local Ad Buying Becoming More Programmatic.   Programmatic advertising enables advertisers to precisely target local audiences and increasingly an “audience of one.” Large amounts of inventory have been consolidated, allowing local advertisers to then be more selective about where, when and to whom they show their ads. The technology behind programmatic advertising, such as geotargeting, IP address identification, 1-3-5 radius store location advertising, has provided the opportunity for targeted local advertising to smaller advertisers, which technologies in the past have been more easily available to larger national advertisers. We believe being able to go into a programmatic platform and target the same audience across all digital inventory is a major competitive advantage. Additionally, we also believe that the ability to customize audiences to the needs of local providers is a significant benefit for local advertisers since they are able to deviate from the broad audience segments defined by national advertisers. Higher customer engagement translates into higher retention and extended customer lifecycle representing the opportunity to sell and upsell customers. We believe the local advertising market remains in the early stages of understanding and leveraging these capabilities.
Death of Cookies Will Likely Destabilize Small- to Mid-Size Business Ad Market.   As the advertising industry faces the eventual phasing out of third-party cookies, namely by Google, by 2023, small-to-mid-sized business will face potentially greater challenges in the adoption and transition to digital. While first-party data driven by first-party cookies will still have broad-based advertising support, more robust advertising efforts are expected to experience some level of performance degradation. Specifically, the inability to tie ad impressions to an identity will add to the list of challenges already being faced by small- to mid-sized businesses. We expect that the destabilization will create significant opportunities for next-generation technology companies that can provide media buying solutions and minimize performance disruption for advertisers and agencies.
The COVID-19 pandemic has put a greater focus on ROI on ad spend performance. Compared to traditional channels, digital ads are more measurable and flexible, making them more attractive and resilient.
 
4

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
(Based on data from eMarketer)
[MISSING IMAGE: TM2125950D3-BC_TOTAL4C.JPG]
Our Customers
On the buy-side of our business, our customers consist of purchasers of programmatic advertising inventory. We had approximately 150 direct customers during the year ended December 31, 2020 and approximately 158 direct customers during the nine months ended September 30, 2021, in each case consisting of advertising buyers, including small- and mid-sized companies, large advertising holding companies (which may manage several agencies), independent advertising agencies and mid-market advertising service organizations. However, we work on over 4,000 campaigns annually, as many advertising agencies and advertising holding companies have decision-making that is generally highly decentralized, such that purchasing decisions are made, and relationships with advertisers are located, at the agency, local branch or division level. We serve a variety of customers across multiple industries including travel/tourism (including destination marketing organizations or DMOs), energy, consumer packaged goods (“CPG”), healthcare, education, financial services (including cryptocurrency technologies) and other industries. Some of the significant brands we work with on the buy-side include Curo, the U.S. Army, Just Energy, Bitcoin Depot, Visit Virginia Beach, Visit Colorado Springs, and Pigeon Forge.
On the sell-side of our business, Colossus SSP, the buyers on our platform include DSPs, agencies and individual advertisers. We have broad exposure to the ecosystem of buyers, reaching on average approximately 15,400 advertisers per month in 2020, which has increased to approximately 56,025 per month during the nine months ended September 30, 2021. As spending on programmatic advertising increasingly becomes a larger share of the overall ad spend, advertisers and agencies are seeking greater control of their digital advertising supply chains. To take advantage of this industry shift, we have entered into Supply Path Optimization (“SPO”) agreements directly with buyers. As part of these agreements, we are providing advertisers and agencies with benefits ranging from custom data and workflow integrations, product features, volume-based business terms, and visibility into campaign performance data and methodology. As a result of these direct relationships, our existing advertisers and agencies are incentivized to allocate an increasing percentage of their advertising budgets to our platform.
 
5

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
Our Competitive Strengths
We believe the following attributes and capabilities form our core strengths and provide us with competitive advantages:

End-to-End, Technology-Driven Solution Focused on Providing Higher Value to Underserved Markets.    Our small- and mid-sized client base is seeking high ROI, low customer acquisition costs, and measurable results that grow their topline. Because we focus exclusively on the first and last miles of media delivery, we engage clients at the front-end of the digital supply chain with the first dollar of spend, in many cases prior to agency involvement, and drive data-driven results across the digital advertising ecosystem to optimize ROI. We offer an end-to-end solution that enables us to set and carry-out the digital campaign strategy of our clients in full, in a more efficient and less expensive manner than some of our competitors. Small- and mid-sized companies are looking for partners that can drive results across the entire digital supply chain. On the Colossus SSP, we offer a wide range of niche and general market publishers an opportunity to maximize advertising revenue driven by technology-enabled targeted advertising to multicultural and other audiences. We believe our technology’s ability to tailor our efforts to our clients-specific needs and inform those efforts with data and algorithmic learnings is a long-term advantage to serving this end of the market.

Comprehensive Processes Enhance Ad Inventory Quality and Reduce Invalid Traffic (“IVT”).   We operate what we believe to be one of the most comprehensive processes in the digital advertising ecosystem to enhance ad inventory quality. In August 2021, Colossus SSP was ranked by MediaMath as 4th among the industry’s approximately 80 supply-side companies in terms of key quality measures such as transparency, fraud detection, and accountability. In the advertising industry, inventory quality is assessed in terms of IVT, which can be impacted by fraud such as “fake eyeballs” generated by automated technologies set up to artificially inflate impression counts. As a result of our platform design and proactive IVT mitigation efforts, in 2020, as well as for the nine months ended September 30, 2021, less than 1% of inventory was determined to be invalid, resulting in minimal financial impact to our customers. We address IVT on a number of fronts, including: sophisticated technology, which detects and avoids invalid traffic on the front end; direct publisher and inventory relationships, for supply path optimization; and ongoing campaign and inventory performance review, to ensure inventory quality and brand protection controls are in place.

Curated Data-Driven Sell-Side Platform (“SSP”) to Support Buy-Side.   The Colossus SSP enables us to gather data to build and develop unique product offerings for our clients. The ability to curate our supply allows us to serve a broad range of clients with challenging and unique advertising needs and optimize campaign performance in a way that our siloed competitors are unable to do. This model, together with our infrastructure solutions and ability to quickly access excess server capacity, helps us scale up efficiently and allows us to grow our business at a faster pace than a pure buy-side solution would. In addition, our clients can easily buy targeted data from over 150 sources through our platform. We also provide clients access to our proprietary data through our data management platform, which only increases with continued use of our platform. We believe that the integration of data and decisioning within a single platform enables us to better serve our clients.

High Client Retention Rate and Cross Selling Opportunities.   In September 2021, we had approximately 158 clients on the buy-side through 1,824 different campaigns and 56,025 clients on the sell-side. They understand the independent nature of our platform and relentless focus on driving ROI-based results. Our value proposition is complete alignment across our entire digital supply platform beginning with the first dollar in and last dollar out. We are technology and media agnostic, and our clients trust us to provide the best opportunity for success of their brands and businesses. As a result, our clients have been loyal, with over 90% client retention for the clients that represent approximately 80% of our revenues. In addition, we cultivate client relationships through our pipeline of moderate and self-serve clients that conduct campaigns within our platform that eventually grow into managed service clients, which has resulted in their increased use of our platform over time. As our clients expand their usage of our technology platform, they often transition to our managed services delivery model, which in turn drives increased client loyalty. The managed services delivery model allows us to combine our technology with a highly personalized offering to strategically design and manage advertising campaigns, provide ad hoc support and recommend strategy adjustments as needed.
 
6

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 

Growing and Profitable Business Model.   We have grown our revenue steadily and profitably, which we believe demonstrates the power of our technology platform, the strength of our client relationships and the leverage inherent to our business model. For the year ended December 31, 2020, our sell-side advertising revenue increased to $2.8 million compared to $0.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2019, or an increase of 253%, and for the nine months ended September 30, 2021, our sell-side advertising revenue increased to $5.3 million compared to $1.5 million for the nine months ended September 30, 2020. On September 30, 2020, we acquired Orange142 to further bolster our overall buy-side advertising platform and enhance our offerings across multiple industry verticals such as travel, healthcare, education, financial services, consumer products and others, with particular emphasis on small- and mid-sized businesses transitioning into digital with growing digital media budgets. For the years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019, our net loss was flat at $(0.9) million for both periods. For the nine months ended September 30, 2021, net income was $0.6 million compared to net loss of $(0.4) million for the same period in 2020. For the year ended December 31, 2020, Adjusted EBITDA increased to $0.6 million compared to Adjusted EBTIDA of $(0.9) million for the year ended December 31, 2019, an increase of $1.5 million, or 171%. For the nine months ended September 30, 2021, Adjusted EBITDA increased to $4.5 million compared to Adjusted EBITDA of $(0.1) million for the nine months ended September 30, 2020. (see “Non-GAAP Financial Measures” later in this Prospectus Summary for more information about our use of non-GAAP financial measures).

Solutions for the Destabilization of Advertising.   As a result of the impending phase out of third-party cookies by 2023 by Google, we have begun integrating identity resolution solutions in order to provide our clients with accurate, targeted advertising without cookies. These solutions provide higher CPM (cost per thousand impressions) advertising, thus resulting in higher revenues. Leveraging our third-party technology providers, our technology has a potential reach of over 250 million matched people online and is powered by over 600 million unique online authentication events per month. To cater to the need for precision and scale, we will be investing in artificial intelligence and machine learning technology to build out our own collection of identities, often referred to as an “ID Lake,” from first-party and third-party data sources, that will facilitate matches and relations between the disparate sets of data.

Experienced Management Team.   Our management team, led by our two founders, has significant experience in the digital advertising industry and with identifying and integrating acquired businesses. Specifically, our two founders, Chairman and Chief Executive Officer Mark Walker and President Keith Smith, have over 45 years of combined experience. The team has led digital marketing efforts for companies both large and small, with unique experience leading small- and mid-sized companies through the challenges of transitioning platforms into the programmatic advertising space. Our Chief Technology Officer, Anu Pillai, is experienced in developing digital platforms on both the buy-side and sell-side, ranging from consumer packaged goods companies focused on e-commerce to publishers seeking to monetize their ad inventory. Our Chief Financial Officer, Susan Echard, a former senior auditor at Ernst & Young LLP, has significant experience working with public companies directly as well a strong background with mergers and acquisitions.

ESG-Centered Strategy.   We believe our business strategy promotes the ideals of a business focused on environmental, social and governance (“ESG”) issues, with particular focus on social and governance issues. Our unique focus has already resulted in numerous partnerships with both large and small advertisers as the multicultural market continues to grow and expand.
Social, Diversity and Governance
We believe it is essential for our organization, from top to bottom, to understand and relate to the issues our clients face on both the buy-side and sell-side. Our founding owners are of African-American descent and founded our Company on multicultural principles designed to alleviate the challenges that buyers and publishers face accessing an expansive multicultural market. Our management team reflects the tone and tenor of our multicultural audiences and our policies on gender equality and gender pay. More than 70% of our management are women and/or identify as being from a diverse background, including all four of our executive officers.
 
7

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
Environmental
Our platform requires significant amounts of information to be stored across multiple servers and we anticipate those amounts to increase significantly as we grow. We are committed to ensuring that we incorporate environmental excellence in our business mindset. Energy use, recycling practices and resource conservation are a few of the factors we take into consideration in building our technological infrastructure, selecting IT partners, and utilizing key suppliers. In the first quarter of 2022, we will transition our server platform to HPE Greenlake, which is centered on environmentally-friendly operations and marketed as “Greenlake-as-a-service,” through which we promote its energy conservation principles. We opted for HPE GreenLake’s as-a-service model because it represents a shift towards supplier responsibility for the elimination of wasted infrastructure and processing capacity. Our needs are metered and monitored, providing insights that can lead to significant resource and energy efficiencies by avoiding overprovisioning and optimizing the IT refresh cycle. This enables us to bring existing equipment to the highest levels of utilization and to eliminate idling equipment that drains energy and resources, yielding both environmental and financial savings.
Our Growth Strategy
We have a multi-pronged growth strategy designed to continue to build upon the momentum we have generated so far in order to create opportunities. Our key growth strategies include our plans to:

Continue to expand our highly productive “on the ground” buy-side and sell-side sales teams throughout the United States, with a particular focus on markets where we believe our client base is underserved.

Utilize management’s experience to identify and close additional acquisition opportunities to accelerate expansion into new industry verticals, grow market share and enhance platform innovation capabilities.

Leveraging our end-to-end product offering as a differentiating factor to win new business and cross-sell to existing clients.

Aggressively grow the Colossus SSP advertising inventory, including both multicultural and general inventory. We aim to increase our omni-channel capabilities to focus on highest growth content formats such as OTT/CTV, audio (such as podcasts, etc.), in-app and others.

Continued innovation and development of our data management platform and proprietary ID Lake and collection of first-party data to inform decision-making and optimize client campaigns.

Invest in further optimization of our infrastructure and technology solutions to maximize revenue and operating efficiencies.
Recent Quarterly Revenue Performance
Because there is significant seasonality to our business, to provide additional information about our recent financial results of operations, we have included the information below for each of the last seven fiscal quarters about our unaudited historical revenue as well as the unaudited historical revenue for Orange142 prior to our acquisition. Orange142 had one significant agency that transitioned its customer’s business internally with the agency during the fourth quarter of 2020, which had an impact on the comparative quarterly revenue results. Revenue related to this customer represented $2.4 million, $1.6 million, $1.7 million, $0.4 million, $0.3 million, $0.3 million, and $0.1 million, for the three months ended March 31, 2020, June 30, 2020, September 30, 2020, December 31, 2020, March 31, 2021, June 30, 2021 and September 30, 2021, respectively. For more information about our financial condition and results of operations, please see the section titled “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and our financial statements included elsewhere in this prospectus.
 
8

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
For the Three Months Ended
Revenue
March 31,
2020
June 30,
2020
September 30,
2020
December 31,
2020
March 31,
2021
June 30,
2021
September 30,
2021
DDH Historical
Buy-side advertising
$ 1,444,533 $ 1,471,761 $ 1,461,414 $ 5,278,457 $ 4,828,047 $ 9,113,305 $ 6,033,883
Sell-side advertising
$ 175,758 $ 537,832 $ 784,710 $ 1,323,054 $ 865,685 $ 2,068,588 $ 2,326,862
Orange142 Historical
$ 5,264,746 $ 6,272,039 $ 6,401,296
Other Recent Developments
USDM Redemption
On November 14, 2021, we entered into a Redemption Agreement with USDM pursuant to which we agreed to (i) effective upon the closing of the 2021 Credit Facility (as defined below), redeem USDM’s 3,500 Class A Preferred Units of DDH LLC for a total purchase price of approximately $3.56 million and (ii) effective upon the consummation of this offering, redeem USDM’s 7,046 Class B Preferred Units for a total purchase price of $7.05 million plus an estimated $0.1 million in preferred return distribution deficits in respect of the Class B Preferred Units and redeem USDM’s 5,637 LLC Units in exchange for a total purchase price of $7.0 million. After such redemptions, USDM will no longer own any equity or other interests in us or DDH LLC.
Lafayette Square Refinancing
On December 3, 2021, DDH LLC entered into a Term Loan and Security Agreement (the “2021 Credit Facility”) with Lafayette Square Loan Servicing, LLC (“Lafayette Square”), as administrative agent, and the various lenders thereto. The 2021 Credit Facility provides for a term loan in the principal amount of up to $32.0 million, consisting of a $22.0 million closing date term loan and an up to $10.0 million delayed draw term loan. The loans under the 2021 Credit Facility bear interest at LIBOR plus the applicable margin minus any applicable impact discount. The applicable margin under the 2021 Credit Facility is determined based on the consolidated total net leverage ratio of the Company and its consolidated subsidiaries, at a rate of 6.50% per annum if the consolidated total net leverage ratio is less than 2.00 to 1.00 and up to 9.00% per annum if the consolidated total net leverage ratio is greater than 4.00 to 1.00. The applicable impact discount under the 2021 Credit Facility is a discount of 0.05% per annum to the extent that DDH LLC adopts certain services intended to improve overall employee satisfaction and retention plus an additional discount of 0.05% per annum to the extent that DDH LLC maintains a B Corp certification by Standards Analysts at the non-profit B Lab (or a successor certification or administrator). The maturity date of the 2021 Credit Facility is December 3, 2026.
The obligations under the 2021 Credit Facility are secured by senior, first-priority liens on all or substantially all assets of DDH LLC and its subsidiaries and are guaranteed by the subsidiaries of DDH LLC, and include a pledge and guarantee by the Company. The 2021 Credit Facility is subject to an intercreditor agreement pursuant to which the Revolving Credit Facility (as defined below) has a priority lien on the trade accounts receivable of DDH LLC and its subsidiaries that constitute eligible accounts under the Revolving Credit Facility and related proceeds, and the 2021 Credit Facility has a priority lien on all other collateral.
In connection with the entry into the 2021 Credit Facility, we paid off in full and terminated our prior term loan facility with Silverpeak Credit Partners, LP (see “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Liquidity and Capital Resources”). Additionally, proceeds of the 2021 Credit Facility were used to redeem all of USDM’s 3,500 Class A Preferred Units held in DDH LLC.
East West Bank Amendment
On December 17, 2021, DDH LLC entered into an amendment to the credit agreement dated September 30, 2020 by and among East West Bank, DDH LLC and each of its subsidiaries that provides for a revolving credit facility with commitments up to $4.5 million and initial availability of $1.0 million (the
 
9

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
“Revolving Credit Facility”). The amendment increased the availability under the Revolving Credit Facility from $1.0 million to up to $2.5 million and increased the commitments under the Revolving Credit Facility from $4.5 million to $5.0 million. Additionally, the amendment provides for certain technical amendments to permit the transactions contemplated by the initial public offering, as well as amendments to certain of the financial definitions and financial covenants in order to take into account the loans and transactions contemplated by the 2021 Credit Facility. The amendment also provides for customary LIBOR transition provisions to be incorporated into the Revolving Credit Facility.
Year End Results
We are in the process of finalizing our results for the quarter and year ended December 31, 2021. Based on currently available information, we estimate that for the quarter ended December 31, 2021, revenue is expected to be between $12.3 million and $13.3 million, and for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2021, revenue is expected to be between $37.6 million and $38.6 million. For the quarter ended December 31, 2021, gross profit is expected to be between $4.8 million and $5.2 million, and for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2021, gross profit is expected to be between $18.2 million and $18.6 million. For the quarter ended December 31, 2021, income from operations is expected to be between $1.0 million and $1.6 million, and for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2021, income from operations is expected to be between $4.0 million and $4.6 million. Intangible amortization expenses included in our operating expenses is expected to be approximately $0.5 million and $2.0 million for the quarter and fiscal year ended December 31, 2021, respectively.
Our consolidated financial statements for the three months and year ended December 31, 2021 are not yet available. These estimates are based on information currently available to management. Our actual results are not expected to vary materially from the estimated preliminary results included herein. The estimates included in this prospectus have been prepared by, and are the responsibility of management, and our independent registered public accounting firm has not audited, reviewed, compiled, or performed any procedures with respect to the estimates and does not express an opinion or any other form of assurances with respect thereto.
Summary Risk Factors
An investment in our Class A common stock involves a high degree of risk. You should carefully consider the risks summarized below. These risks are discussed more fully in the “Risk Factors” section following this Prospectus Summary. These risks include, but are not limited to, the following:

our revenue and operating results are highly dependent on the overall demand for advertising that could be influenced by economic downturns;

the market for programmatic advertising campaigns is relatively new and evolving, so if this market develops slower or differently than we expect, our business, growth prospects and results of operations would be adversely affected;

the effects of health epidemics, such as the ongoing global COVID-19 pandemic, have had, and could in the future have, an adverse impact on our business, financial condition and results of operations;

operational and performance issues with our platform, whether real or perceived, including a failure to respond to technological changes or to upgrade our technology systems, may adversely affect our business, operating results and financial condition;

a significant inadvertent disclosure or breach of confidential and/or personal information we hold, or of the security of our or our customers’, suppliers’ or other partners’ computer systems could be detrimental to our business, reputation and results of operations;

if the non-proprietary technology, software, products and services that we use are unavailable, have future terms we cannot agree to, or do not perform as we expect, our business, operating results and financial condition could be harmed;
 
10

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 

unfavorable publicity and negative public perception about our industry, particularly concerns regarding data privacy and security relating to our industry’s technology and practices, and perceived failure to comply with laws and industry self-regulation, could adversely affect our business and operating results;

if the use of third-party “cookies,” mobile device IDs or other tracking technologies is restricted without similar or better alternatives, our platform’s effectiveness could be diminished and our business, results of operations, and financial condition could be adversely affected;

the market in which we participate is intensely competitive, and we may not be able to compete successfully with our current or future competitors;

high customer concentration exposes us to all of the risks faced by our major customers and may subject us to significant fluctuations or declines in revenues;

we have a limited operating history and, as a result, our past results may not be indicative of future operating performance;

our business is subject to numerous legal and regulatory requirements and any violation of these requirements or any misconduct by our employees, subcontractors, agents or business partners could harm our business and reputation;

we will be a holding company following the completion of this offering. Our principal asset after the completion of this offering will be our interest in DDH LLC, and, accordingly, we will depend on distributions from DDH LLC to pay our taxes, expenses (including payments under the Tax Receivable Agreement) and dividends. DDH LLC’s ability to make such distributions may be subject to various limitations and restrictions;

DDH LLC may make distributions of cash to us substantially in excess of the amounts we use to make distributions to our stockholders and pay our expenses (including our taxes and payments under the Tax Receivable Agreement). To the extent we do not distribute such excess cash as dividends on our Class A common stock, the Continuing LLC Owners would benefit from any value attributable to such cash as a result of their ownership of Class A common stock upon an exchange or redemption of their LLC Units; and

the requirements of being a public company may strain our resources, divert our management’s attention and affect our ability to attract and retain qualified board members.
Implications of Being an Emerging Growth Company
As a company with less than $1.07 billion in revenue during our last fiscal year, we qualify as an “emerging growth company” as defined in the Jumpstart Our Business Startups Act (the “JOBS Act”), under the rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”). An emerging growth company may take advantage of specified reduced reporting and other requirements that are otherwise applicable generally to public companies. These provisions include:

a requirement to have only two years of audited financial statements and only two years of related management’s discussion and analysis of financial condition and results of operations disclosure;

reduced disclosure obligations regarding executive compensation under Item 402 of Regulation S-K;

no requirement for non-binding advisory votes on executive compensation or golden parachute arrangements; and

an exemption from the auditor attestation requirement in the assessment of internal control over financial reporting pursuant to the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
We may take advantage of these provisions until the end of the fiscal year in which the fifth anniversary of this offering occurs, or such earlier time that we no longer qualify as an emerging growth company. In future years, we will cease to be an emerging growth company if we have $1.07 billion in annual revenue or more, become a “large accelerated filer” as defined in Rule 12b-2 under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “Exchange Act”), or issue more than $1.0 billion of non-convertible debt securities over a
 
11

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
three-year period. We may choose to take advantage of some but not all of these reduced requirements. Even after we no longer qualify as an emerging growth company, we may still qualify as a “smaller reporting company,” which would allow us to take advantage of many of the same exemptions from disclosure requirements discussed above.
We have elected to take advantage of some of the reduced disclosure obligations regarding financial statements and executive compensation in this prospectus and may elect to take advantage of other reduced requirements in future filings. As a result, the information we provide to our stockholders may be different from what you might receive from other public reporting companies in which you hold equity interests.
The JOBS Act permits an emerging growth company, like us, to take advantage of an extended transition period to comply with new or revised accounting standards applicable to public companies. We are choosing to take advantage of this provision and, as a result, we will not be required to comply with new or revised accounting standards until those standards would otherwise apply to private companies.
Summary of the Organizational Transactions
Direct Digital Holdings was incorporated as a Delaware corporation on August 23, 2021 and is the issuer of the Class A common stock being offered in this offering. This offering is being conducted through what is commonly referred to as an “Up-C” structure, which is often used by partnerships and limited liability companies when they decide to undertake an initial public offering. To implement the Up-C structure, we will effect certain organizational changes (the “Organizational Transactions”). Unless otherwise stated or the context otherwise requires, all information in this prospectus reflects the completion of these Organizational Transactions.
The key terms of the Up-C structure are:

the Up-C structure will allow the Continuing LLC Owners to retain their equity ownership in DDH LLC and to continue to realize tax benefits associated with owning interests in an entity that is treated as a partnership, or “passthrough” entity, for U.S. federal income tax purposes following the completion of the offering;

investors in this offering will, by contrast, hold their equity ownership in Direct Digital Holdings, a Delaware corporation that is a domestic corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes, in the form of shares of Class A common stock;

USDM will have all of its LLC Units purchased by DDH LLC with a portion of the proceeds from this offering, as discussed in the section titled “Use of Proceeds” and will cease having any interest in DDH LLC or us; and

the Continuing LLC Owners will hold LLC Units and will also hold noneconomic voting equity interests in the form of Class B common stock in Direct Digital Holdings. One of the tax benefits to the Continuing LLC Owners associated with this structure is that future taxable income of DDH LLC that is allocated to the Continuing LLC Owners will be taxed on a pass-through basis and therefore will not be subject to corporate taxes at the entity level. Additionally, the Continuing LLC Owners may, from time to time, redeem or exchange their LLC Units for shares of our Class A common stock on a one-for-one basis. The Up-C structure also provides the Continuing LLC Owners with potential liquidity that holders of non-publicly traded limited liability companies are not typically afforded. If we ever generate sufficient taxable income to utilize the tax benefits, Digital Direct Holdings expects to benefit from the Up-C structure because, in general, we expect cash tax savings in amounts equal to 15% of certain tax benefits arising from such redemptions or exchanges of the Continuing Owners’ LLC Units for Class A common stock or cash and certain other tax benefits covered by the Tax Receivable Agreement discussed in the section titled “Certain Relationships and Related Person Transactions — Tax Receivable Agreement.” See the section titled “Risk Factors — Risks Related to Our Organizational Structure.”
In connection with the closing of this offering, we will consummate the following transactions:

we will amend and restate the limited liability company agreement of DDH LLC, or the DDH LLC Agreement, to, among other things, appoint Direct Digital Holdings as the sole managing member
 
12

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
of DDH LLC and effectuate a recapitalization of all outstanding preferred and common units of DDH LLC into a single class of economic nonvoting common units of DDH LLC. We will otherwise operate as a holding company. Direct Digital Holdings will include DDH LLC in its consolidated financial statements;

we will amend and restate Direct Digital Holdings’ certificate of incorporation to, among other things, provide for Class A common stock, each share of which entitles its holders to one vote per share, and Class B common stock, each share of which entitles its holders to one vote per share on all matters presented to Direct Digital Holdings’ stockholders;

we will cause DDH LLC to purchase all of the LLC Units held by USDM for an aggregate purchase price of approximately $14.0 million;

the Continuing LLC Owners will continue to own the LLC Units they receive in exchange for their outstanding units in DDH LLC, representing approximately 74.0% of the economic interest in the business of DDH LLC and its subsidiaries (or approximately 71.2%, if the underwriters exercise in full their option to purchase additional shares of Class A common stock) and we will issue shares of Class B common stock to the Continuing LLC Owners, on a one-to-one basis with the number of LLC Units each Continuing LLC Owner owns upon the consummation of the Organizational Transactions, for nominal consideration;

the LLC Units, following the completion of this offering, will be redeemable, at the Continuing LLC Owners’ election from time to time, for newly issued shares of Class A common stock on a one-for-one basis (subject to customary adjustments, including for stock splits, stock dividends and reclassifications) in accordance with the terms of the DDH LLC Agreement; provided that, at Direct Digital Holdings’ election, Direct Digital Holdings may effect a direct exchange of such Class A common stock. Shares of Class B common stock will be cancelled on a one-for-one basis if we, at the election of the Continuing LLC Owners that hold Class B common stock, redeem or exchange such holders’ LLC Units pursuant to the terms of the DDH LLC Agreement;

Direct Digital Holdings will enter into the Tax Receivable Agreement with the Continuing LLC Owners and DDH LLC;

Direct Digital Holdings will issue 4,000,000 shares of Class A common stock to the purchasers in this offering (or 4,600,000 shares of our Class A common stock if the underwriters exercise in full their option to purchase additional shares of Class A common stock);

Direct Digital Holdings will use all of the net proceeds from this offering (including any net proceeds received upon exercise of the underwriters’ option to purchase additional shares of Class A common stock) to acquire newly issued LLC Units from DDH LLC at a purchase price per unit equal to the initial public offering price per share of Class A common stock, less underwriting discounts and commissions, collectively representing 26.0% of DDH LLC’s outstanding LLC Units (or 28.8%, if the underwriters exercise in full their option to purchase additional shares of Class A common stock); and

DDH LLC will use the proceeds from the sale of LLC Units to Direct Digital Holdings as described in the section titled “Use of Proceeds,” including to purchase all LLC Units held by USDM for an aggregate purchase price of approximately $14.0 million.
Upon the completion of this offering, the purchasers in this offering (i) will own 4,000,000 shares of Class A common stock, representing approximately 26.0% of the combined voting power of all of Direct Digital Holdings’ common stock (or 4,600,000 shares of Class A common stock representing approximately 28.8%, if the underwriters exercise in full their option to purchase additional shares of Class A common stock), (ii) will own 26.0% of the economic interest in Direct Digital Holdings (or 28.8%, if the underwriters exercise in full their option to purchase additional shares of Class A common stock) and (iii) through Direct Digital Holdings’ ownership of LLC Units, indirectly will hold (applying the percentages in the preceding clause (ii) to Direct Digital Holdings’ percentage economic interest in DDH LLC) approximately 26.0% of the economic interest in DDH LLC (or 28.8% if the underwriters exercise in full their option to purchase additional shares of Class A common stock).
 
13

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
We refer to the foregoing Organizational Transactions collectively as the “Organizational Transactions.” For more information regarding our structure after the completion of the Organizational Transactions, including this offering, see the section titled “Organizational Transactions.” Immediately following the completion of this offering, Direct Digital Holdings will be a holding company and its principal asset will be the LLC Units we purchase from DDH LLC. As the sole managing member of DDH LLC, Direct Digital Holdings will operate and control all of the business and affairs of DDH LLC and, through DDH LLC and its subsidiaries, conduct our business. Accordingly, Direct Digital Holdings will have the sole voting interest in, and control the management of, DDH LLC. As a result, we will consolidate DDH LLC in our consolidated financial statements and will report a non-controlling interest related to the LLC Units held by the Continuing LLC Owners on our consolidated financial statements.
See the section titled “Description of Capital Stock” for more information about our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and the terms of the Class A common stock and the Class B common stock. See the section titled “Certain Relationships and Related Person Transactions” for more information about (i) the DDH LLC Agreement, including the terms of the LLC Units and the redemption right of the Continuing LLC Owners; and (ii) the Tax Receivable Agreement. See the section titled “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Liquidity and Capital Resources — Tax Receivable Agreement” for more information about expected payments under the Tax Receivable Agreement.
The diagram below depicts our organizational structure after giving effect to the Organizational Transactions, including this offering, assuming no exercise by the underwriters of their option to purchase additional shares of Class A common stock.
[MISSING IMAGE: TM2125950D10-FC_DIRECT4C.JPG]
Our Capital Structure
Upon the completion of this offering, we will have two classes of common stock. Our Class A common stock, which is the stock we are offering by means of this prospectus, will have one vote per share and our Class B common stock will have one vote per share.
 
14

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
Upon the completion of this offering, all shares of Class B common stock will be held by the Continuing LLC Owners. Accordingly, upon completion of this offering, assuming an offering size as set forth above and an initial public offering price of $8.00 per share (the midpoint of the price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus), the shares beneficially owned by the Continuing LLC Owners will represent 74.0% of the total voting power of our outstanding capital stock. The Continuing LLC Owners will be able to determine or significantly influence any action requiring the approval of our stockholders, including the election of our board of directors, the adoption of amendments to our certificate of incorporation and bylaws, and the approval of any merger, consolidation, sale of all or substantially all of our assets, or other major corporate transaction.
The multi-class structure of our common stock is intended to ensure that, for the foreseeable future, the Continuing LLC Owners continue to control or significantly influence our governance which we believe will permit us to continue to prioritize our long-term goals rather than short-term results, to enhance the likelihood of stability in the composition of our board of directors and its policies, and to discourage certain types of transactions that may involve an actual or threatened acquisition of us.
Company and Other Information
Our principal executive office is located at 1233 West Loop South, Suite 1170, Houston, Texas 77027. Our telephone number is (832) 402-1051. Our main internet address is www.directdigitalholdings.com. We do not incorporate the information on or accessible through our website into this prospectus, and you should not consider any information on, or that can be accessed through, our website as a part of this prospectus.
 
15

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
THE OFFERING
Issuer
Direct Digital Holdings, Inc., a Delaware corporation
Class A Common stock offered by us
4,000,000 shares
Underwriters’ option to purchase additional shares of Class A common stock from us
600,000 shares
Total Class A common stock to be outstanding immediately after this offering
4,000,000 shares (4,600,000 shares if the option to purchase additional shares from us is exercised in full)(1)
Total Class B common stock to be outstanding immediately after this offering(1)
11,378,000 shares, all of which will be owned by the Continuing LLC Owners.
Use of proceeds
We estimate that our net proceeds from this offering will be approximately $27.0 million (or $31.5 million if the underwriters exercise the over-allotment option in full), based on an assumed initial public offering price of $8.00 per share, which is the midpoint of the price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, and after deducting estimated underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated offering expenses payable by us.
We intend to use the net proceeds from this offering to purchase 4,000,000 newly issued LLC Units (or 4,600,000 LLC Units if the underwriters exercise the over-allotment option in full) directly from DDH LLC at a purchase price per unit equal to the initial public offering price per share of Class A common stock, less underwriting discounts and commissions. We intend to cause DDH LLC to use approximately $14.0 million of such proceeds to purchase all of the LLC Units held by USDM and the remainder for working capital and general corporate purposes, including potential future acquisition of, or investment in, technologies or businesses that complement our business. See “Use of Proceeds” for additional information.
Voting Rights
Holders of our Class A common stock and Class B common stock will vote together as a single class on all matters presented to stockholders for their vote or approval, except as otherwise required by law. Each share of Class A common stock and each share of Class B common stock will entitle its holder to one vote per share on all such matters. See the section titled “Description of Capital Stock” for additional information.
Voting power held by purchasers in this offering
26.0% (or 28.8% if the option to purchase additional shares of Class A common stock from us is exercised in full)
Voting power held by all holders of Class A common stock after giving effect to this offering
26.0% (or 28.8% if the option to purchase additional shares of Class A common stock from us is exercised in full)
Voting power held by all holders of Class B common stock after giving effect to this offering
74.0% (or 71.2% if the option to purchase additional shares of Class A common stock from us is exercised in full)
 
16

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
Class B common stock exchange rights
The Continuing LLC Owners of DDH LLC, from time to time following the completion of this offering, may exchange their LLC Units for shares of Class A common stock on a one-to-one basis, and a corresponding number of such shares of Class B common stock will be cancelled; provided that, at Direct Digital Holdings’ election, Direct Digital Holdings may effect a direct exchange of such Class A common stock. See “Organizational Transactions” for more information.
Lock-up
We, all of our directors, officers and the Continuous LLC Owners have agreed with the underwriters, subject to certain exceptions, not to sell, transfer or dispose of, directly or indirectly, any of our Class A common stock or securities convertible into or exercisable or exchangeable for our Class A common stock for a period of 180 days after the date of the final closing of this offering. See “Shares Eligible for Future Sale” and “Underwriting” for more information.
Representatives’ Warrants
We have agreed to issue to the representatives a warrant to purchase a number of shares of common stock equal to 5% of the total number of shares issued in this offering. The representatives’ warrant will be exercisable at a per share exercise price equal to 120% of the public offering price per share of common stock sold in this offering. The representatives’ warrant is exercisable at any time and from time to time, in whole or in part, during the four-and-a-half-year period commencing six months after the effective date of the registration statement of which this prospectus forms a part. The registration statement of which this prospectus forms a part also registers the issuance of the shares of common stock issuable upon exercise of the representatives’ warrant. See “Underwriting” for more information.
Risk factors
See “Risk Factors” to read about factors you should consider before buying shares of our Class A common stock.
Proposed trading symbol
“DRCT”
(1)
The number of shares of our Class A common stock to be outstanding immediately after this offering is based on the units of DDH LLC outstanding as of September 30, 2021, and excludes the following:

11,378,000 shares of Class A common stock reserved as of the closing date of this offering for future issuance upon redemption or exchange of LLC Units by the Continuing LLC Owners;

1,500,000 shares of Class A common stock reserved for issuance under our 2022 Omnibus Incentive Plan; and

up to 230,000 shares of common stock issuable upon exercise of the representatives’ warrants issued in connection with this offering.
 
17

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
Summary Consolidated Historical and Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Financial Information
The following tables present the summary consolidated historical and unaudited pro forma consolidated financial information for DDH LLC and its subsidiaries and Orange142, in each case, for the periods and at the dates indicated. DDH LLC is the predecessor of the issuer, Direct Digital Holdings, for financial reporting purposes. The summary consolidated statements of operations and information for the years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019 and the summary consolidated balance sheet information as of December 31, 2020 and 2019 have been derived from the audited consolidated financial statements and notes of each of DDH LLC and its subsidiaries and Orange142 included elsewhere in this prospectus and the summary consolidated statements of operations and information for the nine months ended September 30, 2021 and 2020 and the summary consolidated balance sheet information as of September 30, 2021 have been derived from the unaudited consolidated financial statements and notes of DDH LLC and its subsidiaries and Orange142 included elsewhere in this prospectus. You should read this information together with our audited consolidated financial statements and related notes and unaudited consolidated financial statements and related notes appearing elsewhere in this prospectus and the information in the sections titled “Capitalization,” “Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Financial Information” and “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations.” Our historical results are not necessarily indicative of our future results and results of interim periods are not necessarily indicative of results for the entire year.
The summary unaudited pro forma and unaudited pro forma as adjusted consolidated financial information of DDH LLC presented below has been derived from our unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this prospectus. The summary unaudited pro forma balance sheet information as of September 30, 2021 and December 31, 2020 gives effect to the Organizational Transactions as described in the section titled “Organizational Transactions” as if all such transactions had occurred on that date. The summary unaudited pro forma and unaudited pro forma as adjusted consolidated statement of operations for the nine months ended September 30, 2021 and 2020 and the year ended December 31, 2020 gives effect to DDH’s acquisition of Orange142 as if this transaction had occurred on January 1, 2020. The unaudited pro forma and unaudited pro forma as adjusted consolidated financial information includes various estimates which are subject to material change and may not be indicative of what our operations or financial position would have been had such transaction taken place on the dates indicated, or that may be expected to occur in the future. See the section titled “Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Financial Information” for a complete description of the adjustments and assumptions underlying the summary unaudited pro forma consolidated financial information.
The summary consolidated historical information of Direct Digital Holdings has not been presented as Direct Digital Holdings is a newly incorporated entity, has had no business transactions or activities to date and had no assets or liabilities during the periods presented in this section.
 
18

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
Year Ended
December 31, 2020
For the Nine Months Ended
September 30, 2020
For the Nine Months Ended
September 30, 2021
As Reported
Pro forma
for the
acquisition of
Orange142,
LLC
(unaudited)
As Reported
(unaudited)
Pro forma
for the
acquisition of
Orange142,
LLC
(unaudited)
As Reported
(unaudited)
Pro forma,
as adjusted
for the
Organizational
Transactions
(unaudited)
Revenues 
Buy-side advertising
$ 9,656,165 $ 27,594,246 $ 4,377,708 $ 22,315,789 $ 19,975,235 $ 19,975,235
Sell-side advertising
2,821,354 2,821,354 1,498,300 1,498,300 5,261,135 5,261,135
Total revenues
12,477,519 30,415,600 5,876,008 23,814,089 25,236,370 25,236,370
Cost of revenues
Buy-side advertising
4,864,234 10,131,697 2,836,035 8,103,498 7,480,727 7,480,727
Sell-side advertising
2,440,975 2,440,975 1,350,083 1,350,083 4,348,756 4,348,756
Total cost of revenues
7,305,209 12,572,672 4,186,118 9,453,581 11,829,483 11,829,483
Gross profit
5,172,310 17,842,928 1,689,890 14,360,508 13,406,887 13,406,887
Operating expenses
Compensation, taxes and
benefits
3,334,060 7,095,086 1,324,196 5,085,222 6,131,930 6,131,930
General and administrative
1,848,407 4,791,311 600,543 3,543,447 4,214,229 4,214,229
Total operating expenses
6,016,874 11,886,397 2,574,739 8,628,669 10,346,159 10,346,159
(Loss) income from operations
(844,564) 5,956,531 (884,849) 5,731,839 3,060,728 3,060,728
Other (expense) income
Other income
134,776 146,676 134,761 146,661 19,186 19,186
Forgiveness of Paycheck Protection
Program loan
277,100 277,100 10,000 10,000
Gain from revaluation and settlement of seller notes and earnout liability
401,677 401,677 401,677 401,677 21,232 21,232
Loss on redemption of preferred units
(590,689)
Interest expense
(865,055) (2,937,006) (19,925) (2,229,103) (2,432,567) (2,432,567)
Total other (expense) income
(51,502) (2,111,553) 516,513 (1,680,765) (2,382,149) (2,972,838)
Tax expense
(12,124) (61,095) (12,154) (61,125) (54,878) (54,878)
Net income (loss)
$ (908,190) $ 3,783,883 $ (380,490) $ 3,989,949 $ 623,701 $ 33,012
Net income (loss) per common unit/Class A common stock:
Basic and diluted
$ (30.32) $ 110.70 $ (13.32) $ 121.74 $ 18.25 $ nm
Weighted-average common units/Class A common stock outstanding:
Basic and diluted 
29,954 34,182 28,566 32,773 34,182 15,378,000
 
19

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
As of
September 30, 2021
December 31,
2020
(audited)
Actual
(unaudited)
Pro Forma
for the
Organizational
Transactions
(unaudited)
ASSETS
CURRENT ASSETS
Cash and cash equivalents
$ 1,611,998 $ 2,603,152 $ 15,589,432
Accounts receivable, net
4,679,376 3,903,809 3,903,809
Prepaid expenses and other current assets
223,344 727,075 727,075
Total current assets
6,514,718 7,234,036 20,220,316
Goodwill
6,519,636 6,519,636 6,519,636
Intangible assets, net
17,545,396 16,080,032 16,080,032
Deferred financing costs, net
90,607 51,775 51,775
Other long-term assets
25,118 12,948 12,948
Total assets
$ 30,695,475 $ 29,898,427 $ 42,884,707
LIABILITIES AND MEMBERS’ EQUITY/STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY
CURRENT LIABILITIES
Accounts payable
$ 3,263,326 $ 3,110,281 $ 3,110,281
Accrued liabilities
1,392,520 1,510,563 1,510,563
Notes payable, current portion
1,206,750 2,611,685 2,611,685
Deferred revenues
308,682 684,303 684,303
Related party payables
70,801 69,837 69,837
Seller notes payable
315,509
Seller earnout payable
74,909
Total current liabilities
6,632,497 7,986,669 7,986,669
Notes payable, net of short-term portion and
$501,796 and $286,741 of deferred financing, respectively, cost as of December 31, 2020 and September 30, 2021
11,213,697 9,086,328 9,086,328
Mandatorily redeemable non-participating
preferred units
9,913,940 9,913,940 3,458,378
Line of credit
407,051 407,051 407,051
Paycheck Protection Program loan
10,000 287,143 287,143
Economic Injury Disaster Loan
150,000 150,000 150,000
Total liabilities
28,327,185 27,831,131 21,375,569
MEMBERS’/STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY
Units, 1,000,000 units authorized as of December 31, 2020 and
September 30, 2021; 34,182 units issued and outstanding as
of December 31, 2020 and September 30, 2021
4,294,241 4,294,241
Accumulated deficit
(1,925,951) (2,226,945) (2,817,634)
 
20

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
As of
September 30, 2021
December 31,
2020
(audited)
Actual
(unaudited)
Pro Forma
for the
Organizational
Transactions
(unaudited)
Class A common stock, $0.001 par value per share; no shares authorized, issued or outstanding as of December 31, 2020 and September 30, 2021, actual; 160,000,000 shares authorized, 4,000,000 shares issued and outstanding as of September 30, 2021, pro forma
4,000
Class B common stock, $0.001 par value per share; no shares authorized, issued or outstanding as of December 31, 2020 and September 30, 2021, actual; 20,000,000 shares authorized, 11,378,000 shares issued and outstanding as of September 30, 2021, pro forma
11,378
Additional paid-in capital
24,311,394
Total members’/stockholders’ equity
2,368,290 2,067,296 21,509,138
Total liabilities and members’/stockholders’ equity
$ 30,695,475 $ 29,898,427 $ 42,884,707
Non-GAAP Financial Measures
In addition to our results determined in accordance with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles (“GAAP”), including, in particular operating income, net cash provided by operating activities, and net income, we believe that earnings before interest, taxes, depreciation and amortization (“EBITDA”), as adjusted for acquisition transaction costs, forgiveness of Paycheck Protection Program loans and gain from revaluation and settlement of seller notes and earnout liability (“Adjusted EBITDA”), a non-GAAP measure, is useful in evaluating our operating performance. The most directly comparable GAAP measure to Adjusted EBITDA is net income.
The following table presents a reconciliation of Adjusted EBITDA to net income for each of the periods presented:
For the Nine Months Ended
September 30,
For the Year Ended
December 31,
2021
2020
2020
2019
Net income (loss)
$ 623,701 $ (380,490) $ (908,190) $ (883,768)
Add back (deduct):
Amortization of intangible assets
1,465,364 488,454
Acquisition transaction costs
650,000 834,407
Interest expense
2,432,567 19,925 865,055 57,105
Tax expense
54,878 12,154 12,124 39,137
Forgiveness of Paycheck Protection Program loan
(10,000) (277,100)
Gain from revaluation and settlement of seller notes and earnout liability
(21,232) (401,677) (401,677) (79,091)
Adjusted EBITDA
$ 4,545,278 $ (100,088) $ 613,073 $ (866,617)
In addition to operating income and net income, we use Adjusted EBITDA as a measure of operational efficiency. We believe that this non-GAAP financial measure is useful to investors for period-to-period comparisons of our business and in understanding and evaluating our operating results for the following reasons:

Adjusted EBITDA is widely used by investors and securities analysts to measure a company’s operating performance without regard to items such as depreciation and amortization, interest
 
21

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
expense, provision for income taxes, and certain one-time items such as acquisition transaction costs and gains from settlements or loan forgiveness that can vary substantially from company to company depending upon their financing, capital structures and the method by which assets were acquired;

Our management uses Adjusted EBITDA in conjunction with GAAP financial measures for planning purposes, including the preparation of our annual operating budget, as a measure of operating performance and the effectiveness of our business strategies and in communications with our board of directors concerning our financial performance; and

Adjusted EBITDA provides consistency and comparability with our past financial performance, facilitates period-to-period comparisons of operations, and also facilitates comparisons with other peer companies, many of which use similar non-GAAP financial measures to supplement their GAAP results.
Our use of this non-GAAP financial measure has limitations as an analytical tool, and you should not consider it in isolation or as a substitute for analysis of our financial results as reported under GAAP.
 
22

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
RISK FACTORS
Investing in our Class A common stock involves a high degree of risk. You should carefully consider the following risk factors, together with the other information contained in this prospectus, including the section titled “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and our financial statements and related notes, before purchasing our Class A common stock. Our business, results of operations, financial condition or prospects could also be harmed by risks and uncertainties that are not presently known to us or that we currently believe are not material. We have listed below (not necessarily in order of importance or probability of occurrence) what we believe to be the most significant risk factors applicable to us, but they do not constitute all of the risks that may be applicable to us. If any of the risks actually occur, our business, results of operations, financial condition and prospects could be materially and adversely affected. In that event, the market price of our Class A common stock could decline, and you could lose all or part of your investment. Some statements in this prospectus, including statements in the following risk factors, constitute forward-looking statements. Please refer to the section titled “Cautionary Note Regarding Forward-Looking Statements.”
Risks Related to our Business
We rely on highly skilled personnel and if we are unable to attract, retain or motivate substantial numbers of qualified personnel or expand and train our sales force, we may not be able to grow effectively.
We rely on highly skilled personnel and if we are unable to attract, retain or motivate substantial numbers of qualified personnel or expand and train our sales force, we may not be able to grow effectively. Our success largely depends on the talents and efforts of key technical, sales and marketing employees and our future success depends on our continuing ability to identify, hire, develop, motivate and retain highly skilled personnel for all areas of our organization. Competition in our industry is intense and often leads to increased compensation and other personnel costs. In addition, competition for employees with experience in our industry can be intense where our development operations are concentrated and where other technology companies compete for management and engineering talent. Our continued ability to compete and grow effectively depends on our ability to attract substantial numbers of qualified new employees and to retain and motivate our existing employees.
The digital advertising industry is intensely competitive, and if we do not effectively compete against current and future competitors, our business, results of operations, and financial condition could be harmed.
We operate in a highly competitive and rapidly changing industry that is subject to changing technology and customer demands and that includes many companies providing competing solutions. With the introduction of new technologies and the influx of new entrants into the market, we expect competition to persist and intensify in the future, which could harm our ability to increase revenue and maintain profitability. New technologies and methods of buying advertising present a dynamic competitive challenge, as market participants offer multiple new products and services aimed at capturing advertising spend.
We compete with smaller, privately-held companies and with public companies such as The Trade Desk, Pubmatic, Magnite, and Acuity Ads. Our current and potential competitors may have significantly more financial, technical, marketing and other resources than we have, allowing them to devote greater resources to the development, promotion, sale and support of their products and services. They may also have more extensive customer bases and broader supplier relationships than we have. As a result, these competitors may be better able to respond quickly to new technologies, develop deeper marketer relationships or offer services at lower prices. Increased competition may result in reduced pricing for our platform, increased sales and marketing expense, longer sales cycles or a decrease of our market share, any of which could negatively affect our revenue and future operating results and our ability to grow our business. These companies may also have greater brand recognition than we have, actively seek to serve our market, and have the power to significantly change the nature of the marketplace to their advantage. Some of our larger competitors have substantially broader product offerings and may leverage their relationships based on other products or incorporate functionality into existing products to gain business in a manner that may discourage customers from using our platform, including through selling at zero or negative margins or product bundling with other services they provide at reduced prices. Customers may prefer to purchase
 
23

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
advertising on their own or through another platform without leveraging our buy-side business. Potential customers may also prefer to leverage larger sell-side platforms rather than a new platform regardless of product performance or features. These larger competitors often have broader product lines and market focus and may therefore not be as susceptible to downturns in a particular market. We may also experience negative market perception as a result of being a smaller company than our larger competitors.
We may also face competition from companies that we do not yet know about or do not yet exist. If existing or new companies develop, market or resell competitive high-value marketing products or services, acquire one of our existing competitors or form a strategic alliance with one of our competitors, our ability to compete effectively could be significantly compromised and our results of operations could be harmed.
We may not be able to secure additional financing on favorable terms, or at all, to meet our future capital needs, which may in turn impair our growth.
We intend to continue to grow our business, which may require additional capital to develop new features or enhance our platform, improve our operating infrastructure, finance working capital requirements or acquire complementary businesses and technologies. Accordingly, we may need to engage in additional equity or debt financings to secure additional capital. If we raise additional funds through future issuances of equity or convertible debt securities, our existing stockholders could suffer significant dilution, and any new equity securities we issue could have rights, preferences and privileges superior to those of holders of our Class A common stock. Any debt financing that we secure in the future could involve restrictive covenants relating to our capital raising activities and other financial and operational matters, which may make it more difficult for us to obtain additional capital and to pursue business opportunities. If we are unable to secure additional funding on favorable terms, or at all, when we require it, our ability to continue to grow our business to react to market conditions could be impaired and our business may be harmed.
The effects of health pandemics, such as the ongoing global COVID-19 pandemic, have had, and could in the future have, an adverse impact on our business, financial condition and results of operations.
Our business and operations have been and could in the future be adversely affected by health pandemics, such as the global COVID-19 pandemic. The COVID-19 pandemic and efforts to control its spread have curtailed the movement of people, goods and services worldwide, including in the regions in which we and our clients and partners operate, and are significantly impacting economic activity and financial markets. Many marketers have decreased or paused their advertising spending as a response to the economic uncertainty, decline in business activity and other COVID-related impacts, which have negatively impacted some parts of our business, and may continue to negatively impact, our revenue and results of operations, the extent and duration of which we may not be able to accurately predict. In addition, our clients’ and advertisers’ businesses or cash flows have been and may continue to be negatively impacted by the COVID-19 pandemic, which has and may continue to lead them to seek adjustments to payment terms or delay making payments or default on their payables, any of which may impact the timely receipt and/or collectability of our receivables. Typically, we are contractually required to pay for advertising inventory and data suppliers within a negotiated period of time, regardless of whether our clients pay us on time, or at all, and we may not be able to renegotiate better terms. As a result, our business, results of operations, and financial condition may be adversely impacted.
Our operations are subject to a range of external factors related to the COVID-19 pandemic that are not within our control. We have taken precautionary measures intended to minimize the risk of the spread of the virus to our employees, partners and clients, and the communities in which we operate. A wide range of governmental restrictions were previously, and may again be, imposed on our employees, clients and partners’ physical movement to limit the spread of COVID-19. There can be no assurance that precautionary measures, whether adopted by us or imposed by others, will be effective, and such measures could negatively affect our sales, marketing and client service efforts, delay and lengthen our sales cycles, decrease our employees’, clients’ or partners’ productivity, or create operational or other challenges, any of which could harm our business, results of operations and financial condition.
Our customers or potential customers, particularly in industries most impacted by the COVID-19 pandemic, including the retail, restaurant, hotel, hospitality, consumer discretionary, airline, and oil and gas
 
24

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
industries and companies whose customers operate in impacted industries, may reduce their technology or sales and marketing spending or delay their sales transformation initiatives, which could materially and adversely impact our business.
The economic uncertainty caused by the COVID-19 pandemic has made and may continue to make it difficult for us to forecast revenue and operating results and to make decisions regarding operational cost structures and investments. We have committed, and we plan to continue to commit, resources to grow our business, including to expand our international presence, employee base and technology development, and such investments may not yield anticipated returns, particularly if worldwide business activity continues to be impacted by the COVID-19 pandemic. The duration and extent of the impact from the COVID-19 pandemic depend on future developments that cannot be accurately predicted at this time, and if we are not able to respond to and manage the impact of such events effectively, our business may be harmed.
High customer concentration exposes us to various risks faced by our major customers and may subject us to significant fluctuations or declines in revenues.
A limited number of our major customers have contributed a significant portion to our revenues in the past. Our revenue from the top two largest customers accounted for approximately 25% and 41% of our total revenues in the fiscal years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively, and approximately 33% and 51% of our total revenues in the nine months ended September 30, 2021 and 2020, respectively. Our revenue from our top ten largest customers accounted for approximately 59% and 75% of our total revenues in the fiscal years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively, and approximately 69% and 92% of our total revenues in the nine months ended September 30, 2021 and 2020, respectively. Although we continually seek to diversify our customer base, we cannot assure you that the proportion of the revenue contribution from these customers to our total revenues will decrease in the near future. Dependence on a limited number of major customers will expose us to the risks of substantial losses and may increase our accounts receivable and extend its turn-over days if any of them reduces or even ceases business with us. Specifically, any one of the following events, among others, may cause material fluctuations or declines in our revenues and have a material and adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and prospects:

an overall decline in the business of one or more of our significant customers;

the decision by one or more of our significant customers to switch to our competitors;

the reduction in the prices for our services agreed by one or more of our significant customers; or

the failure or inability of any of our significant customers to make timely payment for our services.
Operational and performance issues with our platform, whether real or perceived, including a failure to respond to technological changes or to upgrade our technology systems, may adversely affect our business, operating results and financial condition.
We depend upon the sustained and uninterrupted performance of our platform to manage our advertising inventory supply; acquire advertising inventory for each campaign; collect, process and interpret data; and optimize campaign performance in real time and provide billing information to our financial systems. If our platform cannot scale to meet demand, if there are errors in our execution of any of these functions on our platform, or if we experience outages, then our business may be harmed.
Our platform is complex and multifaceted. Operational and performance issues could arise from the platform itself or from outside factors, such as cyberattacks or other third-party attacks. Errors, failures, vulnerabilities or bugs have been found in the past, and may be found in the future. Our platform also relies on third-party technology and systems to perform properly. It is often used in connection with computing environments utilizing different operating systems, system management software, equipment and networking configurations, which may cause errors in, or failures of, our platform or such other computing environments. Operational and performance issues with our platform could include the failure of our user interface, outages, errors during upgrades or patches, discrepancies in costs billed versus costs paid, unanticipated volume overwhelming our databases, server failure or catastrophic events affecting one or more server facilities. While we have built redundancies in our systems, full redundancies do not exist. Some failures will shut our platform down completely, others only partially. We provide service-level agreements
 
25

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
to some of our customers, and if our platform is not available for specified amounts of time or if there are failures in the interaction between our platform, partner platform and third-party technologies, we may be required to provide credits or other financial compensation to our customers.
As we grow our business, we expect to continue to invest in technology services and equipment. Without these improvements, our operations might suffer from unanticipated system disruptions, slow transaction processing, unreliable service levels, impaired quality or delays in reporting accurate information regarding transactions in our platform, any of which could negatively affect our reputation and ability to attract and retain customers. In addition, the expansion and improvement of our systems and infrastructure may require us to commit substantial financial, operational and technical resources, with no assurance our business will grow. If we fail to respond to technological change or to adequately maintain, expand, upgrade and develop our systems and infrastructure in a timely fashion, our growth prospects and results of operations could be adversely affected.
Operational and performance issues with our platform could also result in negative publicity, damage to our brand and reputation, loss of or delay in market acceptance of our platform, increased costs or loss of revenue, loss of the ability to access our platform, loss of competitive position or claims by customers for losses sustained by them. Alleviating problems resulting from such issues could require significant expenditures of capital and other resources and could cause interruptions, delays or the cessation of our business, any of which may adversely affect our operating results and financial condition.
A significant inadvertent disclosure or breach of confidential and/or personal information we hold, or of the security of our or our customers’, suppliers’ or other partners’ computer systems, could be detrimental to our business, reputation and results of operations.
Portions of our business require the storage, transmission and utilization of data, including access to personal information, much of which must be maintained on a confidential basis. These activities may in the future make us a target of cyber-attacks by third parties seeking unauthorized access to the data we maintain and to which we provide access, including our customer data, or to disrupt our ability to provide service through the Colossus SSP. Based on the types and volume of personal data on our systems, we believe that we are a particularly attractive target for such breaches and attacks.
In recent years, the frequency, severity and sophistication of cyber-attacks, computer malware, viruses, social engineering, and other intentional misconduct by computer hackers has significantly increased, and government agencies and security experts have warned about the growing risks of hackers, cyber criminals and other potential attackers targeting information technology systems. Such third parties could attempt to gain entry to our systems for the purpose of stealing data or disrupting the systems. In addition, our security measures may also be breached due to employee error, malfeasance, system errors or vulnerabilities, including vulnerabilities of our vendors, suppliers, their products or otherwise. Third parties may also attempt to fraudulently induce employees or customers into disclosing sensitive information such as user names, passwords or other information to gain access to our customers’ data or our data, including intellectual property and other confidential business information.
We currently serve the majority of Colossus SSP functions from third-party data center hosting facilities. While we and our third-party cloud providers have implemented security measures designed to protect against security breaches, these measures could fail or may be insufficient, particularly as techniques used to sabotage or obtain unauthorized access to systems change frequently and generally are not recognized until launched against a target, resulting in the unauthorized disclosure, modification, misuse, destruction or loss of our or our customers’ data or other sensitive information. Any failure to prevent or mitigate security breaches and improper access to or disclosure of the data we maintain, including personal information, could result in litigation, indemnity obligations, regulatory enforcement actions, investigations, fines, penalties, mitigation and remediation costs, disputes, reputational harm, diversion of management’s attention, and other liabilities and damage to our business.
We believe we have taken appropriate measures to protect our systems from intrusion, but we cannot be certain that advances in criminal capabilities, discovery of new vulnerabilities in our systems and attempts to exploit those vulnerabilities, physical system or facility break-ins and data thefts or other developments will not compromise or breach the technology protecting our systems and the information we possess.
 
26

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
We may incur significant costs in protecting against or remediating cyber-attacks. Any security breach could result in operational disruptions that impair our ability to meet our customers’ requirements, which could result in decreased revenue. Also, whether there is an actual or a perceived breach of our security, our reputation could suffer irreparable harm, causing our current and prospective customers to reject our products and services in the future, deterring data suppliers from supplying us data or customers from uploading their data on our platform, or changing consumer behaviors and use of our technology. Further, we could be forced to expend significant resources in response to a security breach, including those expended in notifying individuals and providing mitigating services, repairing system damage, increasing cyber security protection costs by deploying additional personnel and protection technologies, and litigating and resolving legal claims or governmental inquiries and investigations, all of which could divert the attention of our management and key personnel away from our business operations. Federal, state and foreign governments continue to consider and implement laws and regulations addressing data privacy, cybersecurity, and data protection laws, which include provisions relating to breaches. For example, statutory damages may be available to users through a private right of action for certain data breaches under the California Consumer Privacy Act (the “CCPA”), and potentially other states’ laws. In any event, a significant security breach could materially harm our business, operating results and financial condition.
Our customers, suppliers and other partners are primarily responsible for the security of their information technology environments, and we rely heavily on them and other third parties to supply clean data content and/or to utilize our products and services in a secure manner. Each of these third parties may face risks relating to cyber security, which could disrupt their businesses and therefore materially impact ours. While we provide guidance and specific requirements in some cases, we do not directly control any of such parties’ cyber security operations, or the amount of investment they place in guarding against cyber security threats. Accordingly, we are subject to any flaws in or breaches of their systems, which could materially impact our business, results of operations, and financial condition.
Our success and revenue growth are dependent on adding new customers, effectively educating and training our existing customers on how to make full use of our platform and increasing usage of our platform by our customers.
Our success is dependent on regularly adding new customers and increasing our customers’ usage of our platform. Our contracts and relationships with customers generally do not include long-term or exclusive obligations requiring them to use our platform or maintain or increase their use of our platform. Our customers typically have relationships with numerous providers and can use both our platform and those of our competitors without incurring significant costs or disruption. Our customers may also choose to decrease their overall advertising spend for any reason. Accordingly, we must continually work to win new customers and retain existing customers, increase their usage of our platform and capture a larger share of their advertising spend. We may not be successful at educating and training customers, particularly our newer customers, on how to use our platform, in particular our advanced reporting tools, in order for our customers to get the most benefit from our platform and increase their usage. If these efforts are unsuccessful or customers decide not to continue to maintain or increase their usage of our platform for any other reason, or if we fail to attract new customers, our revenue could fail to grow or decline, which would materially and adversely harm our business, results of operations, and financial condition. We cannot assure you that our customers will continue to use and increase their spend on our platform or that we will be able to attract a sufficient number of new customers to continue to grow our business and revenue. If customers representing a significant portion of our business decide to materially reduce their use of our platform or cease using our platform altogether, our revenue could be significantly reduced, which could have a material adverse effect on our business, operating results and financial condition. We may not be able to replace customers who decrease or cease their usage of our platform with new customers that will use our platform to the same extent.
If we fail to detect advertising fraud, we could harm our reputation and hurt our ability to execute our business plan.
As our business expands to providing services to publishers, advertisers and agencies, we must deliver effective digital advertising campaigns. Some of those campaigns may experience fraudulent and other invalid impressions, clicks or conversions that advertisers may perceive as undesirable, such as non-human
 
27

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
traffic generated by computers designed to simulate human users and artificially inflate user traffic on websites. These activities could overstate the performance of any given digital advertising campaign and could harm our reputation. It may be difficult for us to detect fraudulent or malicious activity because we do not own content and rely in part on our digital media properties to control such activity. Industry self-regulatory bodies, the U.S. Federal Trade Commission (the “FTC”) and certain influential members of Congress have increased their scrutiny and awareness of, and have taken recent actions to address, advertising fraud and other malicious activity. If we fail to detect or prevent fraudulent or other malicious activity, the affected advertisers may experience or perceive a reduced return on their investment and our reputation may be harmed. High levels of fraudulent or malicious activity could lead to dissatisfaction with our solutions, refusals to pay, refund or future credit demands or withdrawal of future business, any of which could have a material adverse effect on our business, prospects or results of operations.
The market growth forecasts included in this prospectus may prove to be inaccurate and, even if the market in which we compete achieves forecasted growth, we cannot assure you our business will grow at similar rates, if at all.
Market growth forecasts are subject to significant uncertainty and are based on assumptions and estimates that may not prove to be accurate. The forecasts in this prospectus relating to expected growth in the digital advertising and programmatic ad markets may prove to be inaccurate. Even if these markets experience the forecasted growth, we may not grow our business at similar rates, or at all. Our growth is subject to many factors including our success in implementing our business strategy, which is subject to many risks and uncertainties. The failure of either the market in which we operate or our business to grow as forecasted could have a material adverse effect on our business, prospects or results of operations.
The market for programmatic advertising campaigns is relatively new and evolving. If this market develops slower or differently than we expect, our business, growth prospects and results of operations would be adversely affected.
The substantial majority of our revenue has been derived from customers that programmatically purchase or sell advertising inventory through our platform. We expect that spending on programmatic ad buying and selling will continue to be our primary source of revenue for the foreseeable future, and that our revenue growth will largely depend on increasing spend through our platform. The market for programmatic ad buying is an emerging market, and our current and potential customers may not shift quickly enough to programmatic ad buying from other buying methods, reducing our growth potential. Because our industry is relatively new, we will encounter risks and difficulties frequently encountered by early-stage companies in similarly rapidly evolving industries, including the need to:

Maintain our reputation and build trust with advertisers and digital media property owners;

Offer competitive pricing to publishers, advertisers and digital media agencies;

Maintain quality and expand quantity of our advertising inventory;

Continue to develop, launch and upgrade the technologies that enable us to provide our solutions;

Respond to evolving government regulations relating to the internet, telecommunications, mobile, privacy, marketing and advertising aspects of our business;

Identify, attract, retain and motivate qualified personnel; and

Cost-effectively manage our operations.
If the market for programmatic ad buying deteriorates or develops more slowly than we expect, it could reduce demand for our platform, and our business, growth prospects and financial condition would be adversely affected.
In addition, revenue may not necessarily grow at the same rate as spend on our platform. Growth in spend may outpace growth in our revenue as the market for programmatic advertising matures due to a number of factors including quantity discounts and product, media, customer and channel mix shifts. A significant change in revenue as a percentage of spend could reflect an adverse change in our business and growth prospectus. In addition, any such fluctuations, even if they reflect our strategic decisions, could cause
 
28

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
our performance to fall below the expectations of securities analysts and investors, and adversely affect the price of our Class A common stock.
We often have long sales cycles, which can result in significant time between initial contact with a prospect and execution of a customer agreement, making it difficult to project when, if at all, we will obtain new customers and when we will generate revenue from those customers.
Our sales cycle, from initial contact to contract execution and implementation, can take significant time. Our sell-side sales cycle often has a duration of six-to-12 months, while our buy-side business sales cycle often has a duration of three-to-nine months. As part of our sales cycle, we may incur significant expenses before we generate any revenue from a prospective customer. We have no assurance that the substantial time and money spent on our sales efforts will generate significant revenue. If conditions in the marketplace, generally or with a specific prospective customer, change negatively, it is possible that we will be unable to recover any of these expenses. Our sales efforts involve educating our customers about the use, technical capabilities and benefits of our platform, and working through technical connections and troubleshooting technical issues with prospective customers. Some of our customers undertake an evaluation process that frequently involves not only our platform but also the offerings of our competitors. As a result, it is difficult to predict when we will obtain new customers and begin generating revenue from these new customers. Even if our sales efforts result in obtaining a new customer, the customer controls when and to what extent it uses our platform and therefore the amount of revenue we generate, and it may not sufficiently justify the expenses incurred to acquire the customer and the related training support. As a result, we may not be able to add customers, or generate revenue, as quickly as we may expect, which could harm our growth prospects.
Failure to maintain the brand security features of our solution could harm our reputation and expose us to liabilities.
Advertising is bought and sold through our solution in automated transactions that occur in milliseconds. It is important to sellers that the advertising placed on their media be of high quality, consistent with applicable seller standards, not conflict with existing seller arrangements, and be compliant with applicable legal and regulatory requirements. It is important to buyers that their advertisements be placed on appropriate media, in proximity with appropriate content, that the impressions for which they are charged be legitimate, and that their advertising campaigns yield their desired results. We use various measures, including technology, internal processes and protocols in an effort to store, manage and process rules set by buyers and sellers and to ensure the quality and integrity of the results delivered to sellers and advertisers through our solution. If we fail to properly implement or honor rules established by buyers and sellers, improper advertisements may be placed through our platform, which can result in harm to our reputation as well as the need to pay refunds and potential legal liabilities.
Economic downturns and market conditions beyond our control could adversely affect our business, results of operations and financial condition.
Our business depends on the overall demand for advertising and on the economic health of advertisers and publishers that benefit from our platform. Economic downturns or unstable market conditions such as those potentially created by the outbreak of COVID-19 discussed above, may cause advertisers to decrease their advertising budgets, which could reduce spend though our platform and adversely affect our business, results of operations, and financial condition. As we explore new countries to expand our business, economic downturns or unstable market conditions in any of those countries could result in our investments not yielding the returns we anticipate.
We may be required to delay recognition of some of our revenue, which may harm our financial results in any given period.
We may be required to delay recognition of revenue for a significant period of time after entering into an agreement due to a variety of factors, including, among other things, whether:

the transaction involves both current products and products that are under development;
 
29

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 

the customer requires significant modifications, configurations or complex interfaces that could delay delivery or acceptance of our products;

the transaction involves acceptance criteria or other terms that may delay revenue recognition; or

the transaction involves performance milestones or payment terms that depend upon contingencies.
Because of these factors and other specific revenue recognition requirements under GAAP, we must have very precise terms in our contracts to recognize revenue when we initially provide access to our survey platform or other products. Although we strive to enter into agreements that meet the criteria under GAAP for current revenue recognition on delivered performance obligations, our agreements are often subject to negotiation and revision based on the demands of our customers. The final terms of our agreements sometimes result in deferred revenue recognition, which may adversely affect our financial results in any given period. In addition, more customers may require extended payment terms, shorter term contracts or alternative licensing arrangements that could reduce the amount of revenue we recognize upon delivery of our other products and could adversely affect our short-term financial results.
Furthermore, the presentation of our financial results requires us to make estimates and assumptions that may affect revenue recognition. In some instances, we could reasonably use different estimates and assumptions, and changes in estimates are likely to occur from period to period. Accordingly, actual results could differ significantly from our estimates.
Our credit facilities subject us to operating restrictions and financial covenants that impose risk of default and may restrict our business and financing activities.
Our credit facilities are subject to certain financial ratio and liquidity covenants, as well as restrictions that limit our ability, among other things, to:

dispose of or sell our assets;

make material changes in our business or management;

consolidate or merge with other entities;

incur additional indebtedness;

create liens on our assets;

pay dividends;

make investments;

enter into transactions with affiliates; and

pay off or redeem subordinated indebtedness.
These covenants may restrict our ability to finance our operations and to pursue our business activities and strategies. Our ability to comply with these covenants may be affected by events beyond our control. If a default were to occur and is not waived, such default could cause, among other remedies, all of the outstanding indebtedness under our credit facilities to become immediately due and payable. In such an event, our liquid assets might not be sufficient to meet our repayment obligations, and we might be forced to liquidate collateral assets at unfavorable prices or our assets may be foreclosed upon and sold at unfavorable valuations.
Our ability to renew our existing term credit facility, which matures in September 2023, our existing revolving credit facility, which matures in December 2026, or to enter into a new credit facility to replace or supplement the existing facilities may be limited due to various factors, including the status of our business, global credit market conditions and perceptions of our business or industry by sources of financing. In addition, if credit is available, lenders may seek more restrictive covenants and higher interest rates that may reduce our borrowing capacity, increase our costs and reduce our operating flexibility.
If we do not have or are unable to generate sufficient cash available to repay our debt obligations when they become due and payable, either upon maturity or in the event of a default, we may not be able to obtain
 
30

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
additional debt or equity financing on favorable terms, if at all. Our inability to obtain financing may negatively impact our ability to operate and continue our business as a going concern.
Our business is subject to the risk of catastrophic events such as pandemics, earthquakes, flooding, fire and power outages, and to interruption by man-made problems such as terrorism.
Our business is vulnerable to damage or interruption from pandemics, earthquakes, flooding, fire, power outages, telecommunications failures, terrorist attacks, acts of war, human errors, break-ins and similar events. A significant natural disaster could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition, and our insurance coverage may be insufficient to compensate us for losses that may occur. In addition, acts of terrorism could cause disruptions in our or our publishers’ and partners’ businesses or the economy as a whole. Our servers may also be vulnerable to computer viruses, break-ins, denial-of-service attacks and similar disruptions from unauthorized tampering with our computer systems, which could lead to interruptions, delays and the loss of critical data. We may not have sufficient protection or recovery plans in some circumstances. As we rely heavily on our data center facilities, computer and communications systems and the internet to conduct our business and provide high-quality customer service, these disruptions could negatively impact our ability to run our business and either directly or indirectly disrupt publishers’ and partners’ businesses, which could have an adverse effect on our business, results of operations, and financial condition.
Unfavorable publicity and negative public perception about our industry, particularly concerns regarding data privacy and security relating to our industry’s technology and practices, and perceived failure to comply with laws and industry self-regulation, could adversely affect our business and operating results.
With the growth of digital advertising, there is increasing awareness and concern among the general public, privacy advocates, mainstream media, governmental bodies and others regarding marketing, advertising and data privacy matters, particularly as they relate to individual privacy interests and the global reach of the online marketplace. Concerns about industry practices with regard to the collection, use and disclosure of personal information, whether or not valid and whether driven by applicable laws and regulations, industry standards, customer or inventory provider expectations, or the broader public, may harm our reputation, result in loss of goodwill and inhibit the use of our platform by current and future customers. Any unfavorable publicity or negative public perception about us, our industry, including our competitors, or even other data-focused industries, can affect our business and results of operations, and may lead to digital publishers or our customers changing their business practices or additional regulatory scrutiny or lawmaking that affects us or our industry. For example, in recent years, consumer advocates, mainstream media and elected officials have increasingly and publicly criticized the data and marketing industry for its collection, storage and use of personal data. Additional public scrutiny may lead to general distrust of our industry, consumer reluctance to share and permit use of personal data, increased consumer opt-out rates or increased private class actions, any of which could negatively influence, change or reduce our current and prospective customers’ demand for our products and services, subject us to liability and adversely affect our business and operating results.
Our management team has limited experience managing a public company.
Most members of our management team have limited or no experience managing a publicly-traded company, interacting with public company investors, and complying with the increasingly complex laws, rules and regulations that govern public companies. There are significant obligations we will now be subject to relating to reporting, procedures and internal controls, and our management team may not successfully or efficiently manage our transition to being a public company. These new obligations and added scrutiny will require significant attention from our management and could divert their attention away from the day-to-day management of our business, which could adversely affect our business, operating results and financial condition. We expect that compliance with these requirements will increase our compliance costs. We will need to hire additional accounting, financial and legal staff with appropriate public company experience and technical accounting knowledge and will need to establish an internal audit function. We cannot predict or estimate the amount of additional costs we may incur as a result of becoming a public company or the timing of these costs.
 
31

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
We also expect that being a public company will make it more expensive for us to obtain director and officer liability insurance, and we may be required to accept reduced coverage or incur substantially higher costs to obtain coverage. These factors could also make it more difficult for us to attract and retain qualified members of our board of directors, particularly to serve on our Audit Committee and Compensation Committee, and qualified executive officers.
We are subject to payment-related risks and, if our clients do not pay or dispute their invoices, our business, financial condition and operating results may be adversely affected.
Many of our contracts with advertising agencies provide that if the advertiser does not pay the agency, the agency is not liable to us, and we must seek payment solely from the advertiser. Contracting with these agencies, which in some cases have or may develop higher-risk credit profiles, may subject us to greater credit risk than if we were to contract directly with advertisers. This credit risk may vary depending on the nature of an advertising agency’s aggregated advertiser base. We may also be involved in disputes with agencies and their advertisers over the operation of our platform, the terms of our agreements or our billings for purchases made by them through our platform. If we are unable to collect or make adjustments to bills to clients, we could incur write-offs for bad debt, which could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations for the periods in which the write-offs occur. In the future, bad debt may exceed reserves for such contingencies and our bad debt exposure may increase over time. Any increase in write-offs for bad debt could have a materially negative effect on our business, results of operations, and financial condition. Even if we are not paid by our clients on time or at all, we are still obligated to pay for the advertising we have purchased for the advertising campaign, and as a consequence, our results of operations and financial condition would be adversely impacted.
Furthermore, we are generally contractually required to pay suppliers of advertising inventory and data within a negotiated period of time, regardless of whether our customers pay us on time, or at all. While we attempt to negotiate long payment periods with our suppliers and shorter periods from our customers, we are not always successful. As a result, our accounts payable are often due on shorter cycles than our accounts receivables, requiring us to remit payments from our own funds, and accept the risk of bad debt.
Our revenue and operating results are highly dependent on the overall demand for advertising. Factors that affect the amount of advertising spending, such as economic downturns and seasonality, particularly in the second and third quarters of our fiscal year, can make it difficult to predict our revenue and could adversely affect our business.
Our business depends on the overall demand for advertising and on the economic health of our current and prospective sellers and advertisers. If advertisers reduce their overall advertising spending, our revenue and results of operations are directly affected. For Colossus SSP, many advertisers devote a disproportionate amount of their advertising budgets to the third and fourth quarters of the calendar year to coincide with the annual holiday purchasing season, and buyers may spend more in the second and third quarters for seasonality and budget reasons. As a result, if any events occur to reduce the amount of advertising spending during the second, third or fourth quarters, or reduce the amount of inventory available to advertisers during that period, it could have a disproportionate adverse effect on our revenue and operating results for that fiscal year. Economic downturns or instability in political or market conditions generally may cause current or new advertisers to reduce their advertising budgets. Reductions in inventory due to loss of sellers would make our solution less robust and attractive to buyers. Adverse economic conditions and general uncertainty about economic recovery are likely to affect our business prospects. In particular, uncertainty regarding the impacts of COVID-19 on the economy in the United States may cause general business conditions in the United States and elsewhere to deteriorate or become volatile, which could cause advertisers to delay, decrease or cancel purchases of our solution, and expose us to increased credit risk on advertiser orders. Moreover, any changes in the favorable tax treatment of advertising expenses and the deductibility thereof would likely cause a reduction in advertising demand.
If the non-proprietary technology, software, products and services that we use are unavailable, have future terms we cannot agree to, or do not perform as we expect, our business, results of operations and financial condition could be harmed.
We depend on various technology, software, products and services from third parties or available as open source, including for critical features and functionality of our platform and technology, payment
 
32

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
processing, payroll and other professional services. Identifying, negotiating, complying with and integrating with third-party terms and technology are complex, costly and time-consuming matters. Failure by third-party providers to maintain, support or secure their technology either generally or for our accounts specifically, or downtime, errors or defects in their products or services, could materially and adversely impact our platform, our administrative obligations or other areas of our business. Having to replace any third-party providers or their technology, products or services could result in outages or difficulties in our ability to provide our services, which could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition.
If the use of third-party “cookies,” mobile device IDs or other tracking technologies is restricted without similar or better alternatives, our platform’s effectiveness could be diminished and our business, results of operations, and financial condition could be adversely affected.
We use “cookies,” which are small text files placed on consumer devices when an internet browser is used, and mobile device identifiers, to gather data that enables our platform to be more effective. Our cookies and mobile device IDs do not identify consumers directly, but record information such as when a consumer views or clicks on an advertisement, when a consumer uses a mobile app, the consumer’s location, consumer demographic, psychographic interest and browser or other device information. Publishers and partners may also choose to share their information about consumers’ interests or give us permission to use their cookies and mobile device IDs. We use data from cookies, mobile device IDs, and other tracking technologies to help advertisers decide whether to bid on, and how to price, an ad impression in a certain location, at a given time or for a particular consumer. Without cookies, mobile device IDs and other tracking technology data, transactions processed through our platform would be executed with less insight into consumer activity, reducing the precision of advertisers’ decisions about which impressions to purchase for an advertising campaign. This could make placement of advertising through our platform less valuable and harm our revenue. If our ability to use cookies, mobile device IDs or other tracking technologies is limited, we may be required to develop or obtain additional applications and technologies to compensate for the lack of cookies, mobile device IDs and other tracking technology data, which could be time consuming or costly to develop, less effective and subject to additional regulation.
Some consumers also download free or paid “ad blocking” software on their computers or mobile devices, not only for privacy reasons, but also to counteract the adverse effect advertisements can have on the consumer experience, including increased load times, data consumption and screen overcrowding. Ad-blocking technologies and other global privacy controls may prevent some third-party cookies, or other tracking technologies, from being stored on a consumer’s computer or mobile device. If more consumers adopt these measures, our business, results of operations, and financial condition could be adversely affected. Ad-blocking technologies could have an adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition if they reduce the volume or effectiveness and value of advertising. In addition, some ad-blocking technologies block only ads that are targeted through use of third-party data, while allowing ads based on first-party data (i.e., data owned by the publisher). These ad blockers could place us at a disadvantage because we rely on third-party data, while some large competitors have a significant amount of first-party data they use to direct advertising. Other technologies allow ads that are deemed “acceptable,” which could be defined in ways that place us or our publishers at a disadvantage, particularly if such technologies are controlled or influenced by our competitors. Even if ad blockers do not ultimately have an adverse effect on our business, investor concerns about ad blockers could cause our stock price to decline.
Additionally, in January 2020, Alphabet Inc.’s Google subsidiary (“Alphabet”) announced that its Chrome web browser would be removing support for third-party cookies by 2023. In March 2021, Alphabet announced that it would not build alternate identifiers to track individuals as they browse across the web, nor would Google use them in its products. These changes, and other privacy controls that may be put in place by other web companies in the future, have the potential to have an adverse effect on our business, results of operations, and financial condition if they reduce the volume or effectiveness and value of advertising.
Market pressure may reduce our revenue per impression.
Our revenue may be affected by market changes, new demands by publishers and buyers, removal of cookies usage from the existing value chain, new solutions and competitive pressure. Our solutions may be
 
33

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
priced too high or too low, either of which may carry adverse consequences. We may receive requests from publishers for discounts, fee revisions, rebates and refunds, or from DSPs, agencies and advertisers for volume discounts, fee revisions and rebates. Any of these developments could adversely affect our business, results of operations or financial condition. Any failure for our pricing approaches to gain acceptance could adversely affect our business, results of operations and financial condition.
We face potential liability and harm to our business based on the human factor of inputting information into our platform.
We or our customers set up campaigns on our platform using a number of available variables. While our platform includes several checks and balances, it is possible for human error to result in significant over-spending. We offer a number of protections such as daily or overall spending caps. However, despite these protections, the risk of overspend exists. For example, campaigns which last for a period of time can be set to pace evenly or as quickly as possible. If a customer with a high credit limit enters an incorrect daily cap with a campaign set to a rapid pace, it is possible for a campaign to accidently go significantly over budget. Our potential liability for such errors may be higher when they occur in situations in which we are executing purchases on behalf of a customer rather than the customer using the self-service feature of our platform. While our customer contracts state that customers are responsible for media purchased through our platform, we are ultimately responsible for paying the inventory providers and we may be unable to collect when such errors occur.
If we are unable to successfully execute our strategies and continue to develop and sell the services and solutions our customers demand, our business, results of operations and financial condition may suffer.
We must adapt to rapidly changing customer demands and preferences in order to successfully execute our strategies. This requires us to anticipate and respond to customer demands and preferences, address business model shifts, optimize our go-to-market execution by improving our cost structure, align sales coverage with strategic goals, improve channel execution and strengthen our services and capabilities in our areas of strategic focus. Any failure to successfully execute our strategies, including any failure to invest in strategic growth areas, could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.
We have a limited operating history and, as a result, our past results may not be indicative of future operating performance.
We have a limited operating history with the current scale of our business, which makes it difficult to forecast our future results. You should not rely on our past quarterly or annual results of operations as indicators of future performance. You should consider and evaluate our prospects in light of the risks and uncertainty frequently encountered by companies like ours.
The loss, modification or delay of large or multiple contracts may negatively impact our financial performance.
Our contracts have generally been for terms of relatively short duration. Additionally, our clients generally will have the ability to delay the execution of services, reduce the number of hours that services require, and terminate their contracts with us upon a short notice for convenience and upon the occurrence of certain defined events, such as “for cause.” The loss or delay of a large contract or multiple contracts could adversely and materially affect our operating results.
Our clients include destination marketing organizations (“DMOs”), which often operate as public/private partnerships involving a national, provincial, state and local governmental entity.
Our work for DMOs carries various risks inherent in the government contracting process. These risks include, but are not limited to, the following:

Government entities typically fund projects through appropriated monies and demand is affected by public sector budgetary cycles and funding authorizations. While these projects are often planned and executed as multi-year projects, government entities usually reserve the right to change the scope of or terminate these projects for lack of approved funding and/or at their convenience, which also could limit our recovery of incurred costs, reimbursable expenses and profits on work completed prior to the termination.
 
34

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 

Government contracts are subject to heightened reputational and contractual risks compared to contracts with commercial clients. For example, government contracts and the proceedings surrounding them are often subject to more extensive scrutiny and publicity. Negative publicity, including an allegation of improper or illegal activity, regardless of its accuracy, or challenges to government contracts awarded to us, may adversely affect our reputation.

Government contracts can be challenged by other interested parties and such challenges, even if unsuccessful, can increase costs, cause delays and defer project implementation and revenue recognition.

Terms and conditions of government contracts also tend to be more onerous and difficult to negotiate. For example, these contracts often contain high liability for breaches and feature less favorable payment terms and sometimes require us to take on liability for the performance of third parties.

Political and economic factors such as pending elections, the outcome of elections, changes in leadership among key executive or legislative decision makers, revisions to governmental tax or other policies and reduced tax revenues can affect the number and terms of new government contracts signed or the speed at which new contracts are signed, decrease future levels of spending and authorizations for programs that we bid, shift spending priorities to programs in areas for which we do not provide services and/or lead to changes in enforcement or how compliance with relevant rules or laws is assessed.

If a government client discovers improper or illegal activities during audits or investigations, we may become subject to various civil and criminal penalties, including those under the civil U.S. False Claims Act and administrative sanctions, which may include termination of contracts, forfeiture of profits, suspension of payments, fines and suspensions or debarment from doing business with other agencies of that government. The inherent limitations of internal controls may not prevent or detect all improper or illegal activities.

U.S. government contracting regulations impose strict compliance and disclosure obligations. Disclosure is required if certain company personnel have knowledge of “credible evidence” of a violation of federal criminal laws involving fraud, conflict of interest, bribery or improper gratuity, a violation of the civil U.S. False Claims Act or receipt of a significant overpayment from the government. Failure to make required disclosures could be a basis for suspension and/or debarment from federal government contracting in addition to breach of the specific contract and could also impact contracting beyond the U.S. federal level. Reported matters also could lead to audits or investigations and other civil, criminal or administrative sanctions.
The occurrences or conditions described above could affect not only our business with the DMOs and related government entities involved, but also our business with other entities of the same or other governmental bodies or with certain commercial clients and could have a material and adverse effect on our business, results of operations, and financial condition.
We invest significantly in development, and to the extent our development investments do not translate into new solutions or material enhancements to our current solutions, or if we do not use those investments efficiently, our business and results of operations would be harmed.
A key element of our strategy is to invest significantly in our development efforts to improve and develop our software and the features and functionality for our platform. If we do not spend our development budget efficiently or effectively, our business may be harmed and we may not realize the expected benefits of our strategy. Moreover, development projects can be technically challenging, time-consuming and expensive. The nature of these development cycles may cause us to experience delays between the time we incur expenses associated with development and the time we are able to offer compelling platform updates and generate revenue, if any, from such investment. Additionally, anticipated enterprise demand for solutions we are developing could decrease after the development cycle has commenced, and we would nonetheless be unable to avoid substantial costs associated with the development of any such solutions. If we expend a significant amount of resources on development and our efforts do not lead to the successful introduction or
 
35

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
improvement of solutions that are competitive in our current or future markets, our business and results of operations would be adversely affected.
We must provide value to both publishers and buyers of advertising without being perceived as favoring one over the other or being perceived as competing with them through our service offerings.
We provide a platform that intermediates between publishers seeking to sell advertising space and buyers seeking to purchase that space. If we were to be perceived as favoring one side of the transaction to the detriment of the other, or presenting a competitive challenge to their own businesses, demand for our platform from publishers or buyers would decrease and our business, results of operations and financial condition would be adversely affected.
Future acquisitions or strategic investments could be difficult to identify and integrate, divert the attention of management, and could disrupt our business, dilute stockholder value and adversely affect our business, results of operations and financial condition.
As part of our growth strategy, we may acquire or invest in other businesses, assets or technologies that are complementary to and fit within our strategic goals. Any acquisition or investment may divert the attention of management and require us to use significant amounts of cash, issue dilutive equity securities or incur debt. In addition, the anticipated benefits of any acquisition or investment may not be realized, and we may be exposed to unknown risks, any of which could adversely affect our business, results of operations and financial condition, including risks arising from:

difficulties in integrating the operations, technologies, product or service offerings, administrative systems and personnel of acquired businesses, especially if those businesses operate outside of our core competency or geographies in which we currently operate;

ineffectiveness or incompatibility of acquired technologies or solutions;

potential loss of key employees of the acquired business;

inability to maintain key business relationships and reputation of the acquired business;

diversion of management attention from other business concerns;

litigation arising from the acquisition or the activities of the acquired business, including claims from terminated employees, customers, former stockholders or other third parties;

assumption of contractual obligations that contain terms that are not beneficial to us, require us to license or waive intellectual property rights, or increase our risk of liability;

complications in the integration of acquired businesses or diminished prospects, including as a result of the COVID-19 pandemic and its global economic effects;

failure to generate the expected financial results related to an acquisition on a timely manner or at all;

failure to accurately forecast the impact of an acquisition transaction; and

implementation or remediation of effective controls, procedures, and policies for acquired businesses.
To fund future acquisitions, we may pay cash or issue additional shares of our Class A common stock or securities convertible into or exchangeable for shares of our Class A common stock, which could dilute our stockholders or diminish our cash reserves. Borrowing to fund an acquisition would result in increased fixed obligations and could also subject us to covenants or other restrictions that could limit our ability to effectively run our business.
Risks Related to Legal and Regulatory
Our business is subject to numerous legal and regulatory requirements and any violation of these requirements or any misconduct by our employees, subcontractors, agents or business partners could harm our business and reputation.
In addition to government contract procurement laws and regulations, we are subject to numerous other federal, state and foreign legal requirements on matters as diverse as data privacy and protection,
 
36

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
employment and labor relations, immigration, taxation, anti-corruption, import/export controls, trade restrictions, internal and disclosure control obligations, securities regulation and anti-competition. Compliance with diverse and changing legal requirements is costly, time-consuming and requires significant resources. Violations of one or more of these requirements in the conduct of our business could result in significant fines and other damages, criminal sanctions against us or our officers, prohibitions on doing business and damage to our reputation. Violations of these regulations or contractual obligations related to regulatory compliance in connection with the performance of customer contracts could also result in liability for significant monetary damages, fines and/or criminal prosecution, unfavorable publicity and other reputational damage, restrictions on our ability to compete for work and allegations by our customers that we have not performed our contractual obligations.
Misconduct by our employees, subcontractors, agents or business partners could subject us to fines and penalties, restitution or other damages, loss of security clearance, loss of current and future customer contracts and suspension or debarment from contracting with federal, state or local government agencies, any of which could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations. Such misconduct could include fraud or other improper activities such as falsifying time or other records, failure to comply with our policies and procedures or violations of applicable laws and regulations.
Changes in legislative, judicial, regulatory or cultural environments relating to information collection, use and processing may limit our ability to collect, use and process data. Such developments could cause revenue to decline, increase the cost of data, reduce the availability of data and adversely affect the demand for our products and services.
We receive, store and process personal information and other data from and about consumers in addition to personal information and other data from and about our customers, employees and services providers. Our handling of this data is subject to a wide variety of federal, state and foreign laws and regulations and is subject to regulation by various government authorities and consumer actions. Our data handling is also subject to contractual obligations and may be deemed to be subject to industry standards.
The U.S. federal and various state and foreign governments have adopted or proposed laws relating to the collection, disclosure, processing, use, storage and security of data relating to individuals and households, including the use of contact information and other data for marketing, advertising and other communications with individuals and businesses. In the U.S., various laws and regulations apply to the collection, disclosure, processing, use, storage and security of certain types of data. Additionally, the FTC, many state attorneys general and many courts are interpreting federal and state consumer protection laws as imposing standards for the collection, disclosure, process, use, storage and security of data. The regulatory framework for data privacy issues worldwide is complex, continually evolving and often conflicting, and is likely to remain uncertain for the foreseeable future. The occurrence of unanticipated events often rapidly drives the adoption of legislation or regulation affecting the use, collection or other processing of data and manner in which we conduct our business. As a result, further restrictions could be placed upon the collection, disclosure, processing, use, storage and security of information, which could result in a material increase in the cost of obtaining certain kinds of data and could limit the ways in which we may collect, disclose, process, use, store or secure information.
U.S. federal and state legislatures, along with federal regulatory authorities, have recently increased their focus on matters concerning the collection and use of consumer data, including relating to interest-based advertising, or the use of data to draw inferences about a user’s interests and deliver relevant advertising to that user, and similar or related practices, such as cross-device data collection and aggregation, and steps taken to de-identify personal data and to use and distribute the resulting data, including for purposes of personalization and the targeting of advertisements. In the U.S., non-sensitive consumer data generally may be used under current rules and regulations, subject to certain restrictions, including relating to transparency and affirmative “opt-out” rights of the collection or use of such data in certain instances. To the extent additional opt-out rights are made available in the U.S., additional regulations are imposed, or if an “opt-in” model were to be adopted, less data would be available, the cost of data and compliance would be higher, or we could be required to modify our data processing practices and policies.
While our platform and people-based framework operates primarily in the United States, some of our operations may subject us to data privacy laws outside the United States.
 
37

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
We are subject to evolving laws and regulations that dictate whether, how and under what circumstances we, or our data processors, may transfer, process and/or receive certain data, including data shared between countries or regions in which we operate and data shared among our products and services. If one or more of the legal bases for transferring data to the U.S. is invalidated, if we are unable to transfer or receive data between and among countries and regions in which we operate, or if we are prohibited from sharing data among our products and services, it could affect the manner in which we provide our services or adversely affect our financial results.
In addition to government regulation, self-regulatory standards and other industry standards may legally or contractually apply to us or be argued to apply to us, or we may elect to comply with such standards or to facilitate our customers’ compliance with such standards. Because privacy, data protection and information security are competitive factors in our industry, we require the advertising publishers participating in our DDP to provide all consumers with notice about our use of cookies and other technologies to execute the collection of consumer data and of the collection and use of consumer data for certain purposes, and to provide consumers with certain choices relating to the use of consumer data. Some of these self-regulatory bodies have the ability to discipline members or participants, which could result in fines, penalties, and/or public censure of our publishers, which could in turn cause reputational harm to us. Additionally, some of these self-regulatory bodies might refer violations of their requirements to the Federal Trade Commission or other regulatory bodies, which could similarly implicate us.
Regulatory investigations and enforcement actions could also impact us. In the U.S., the FTC uses its enforcement powers under Section 5 of the Federal Trade Commission Act (which prohibits “unfair” and “deceptive” trade practices) to investigate companies engaging in online tracking and the processing of consumer personal information more generally. Advocacy organizations have also filed complaints with data protection authorities against advertising technology companies, arguing that certain of these companies’ practices do not comply with the General Data Protection Regulation (“GDPR”). It is possible that investigations or enforcement actions will involve our practices or practices similar to ours.
In May 2018, the European Union’s GDPR went into effect, and together with national legislation, regulations and guidelines of the EU, UK and Switzerland, ushered in a new and complex data protection regime including principles, rights and obligations with extraterritorial reach of EU, UK and Swiss data protection authorities. The European data protection and security laws, including GDPR, provide for extensive data subject rights, robust obligations on data controllers and processors and additional requirements on businesses to put in place data protection and security compliance programs, systems and processes. Continued evolution of, and varied implementation and interpretation of such European data protection and security laws has increased, and continues to extend. Among other requirements, the GDPR (and its UK equivalent commonly referred to as “UK GDPR”) regulates transfers of personal data (subject to such laws) from the European Economic Area (“EEA”) and the UK to the U.S. as well as other third countries outside EEA and the UK which are deemed not to provide adequate standards of data protection to the levels required by GDPR. The GDPR and UK GDPR also impose numerous privacy-related obligations and requirements for companies operating in the EU and the UK including requiring data controllers not to transfer personal data to US-based processors unless they agree to certain legally binding processing obligations, greater control for data subjects (for example, the “right to be forgotten”), increased data portability for EU and UK consumers, data breach notification requirements and exposure to substantial fines for non-compliance. Under the GDPR and UK GDPR, fines of up to 20 million euros or 4% of the annual global revenue of the non-compliant company, whichever is greater, could be imposed for violations of certain of the GDPR’s and UK GDPR’s requirements. Such penalties are in addition to any civil litigation claims by customers and data subjects. The frequency and quantum of fines imposed by EU and UK data protection regulators under GDPR and UK GDPR has been increasing since 2019. Accordingly, the costs of complying with the GDPR, UK GDPR and other foreign data privacy regulatory regimes may make our expansion into these markets less profitable or uneconomical, limiting our potential growth, and potentially adversely affecting our business, prospectus and results of operations.
Our legal risk depends in part on our customers’ or other third parties’ adherence to privacy laws and regulations and their use of our services in ways consistent with end user expectations. We rely on representations made to us by customers and data suppliers that they will comply with all applicable laws, including all relevant privacy and data protection regulations. Although we make reasonable efforts to enforce
 
38

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
such representations and contractual requirements, we do not fully audit our customers’ or data suppliers’ compliance with our recommended disclosures or their adherence to privacy laws and regulations. If our customers or data suppliers fail to adhere to our expectations or contracts in this regard, we and our customers or data suppliers could be subject to adverse publicity, damages, and related possible investigation or other regulatory activity.
Because the interpretation and application of privacy and data protection laws, regulations and standards are uncertain, it is possible that these laws, regulations and standards may be interpreted and applied in manners that are, or are asserted to be, inconsistent with our data management practices or the technological features of our products and services. If so, in addition to the possibility of fines, investigations, lawsuits and other claims and proceedings, it may be necessary or desirable for us to fundamentally change our business activities and practices or modify our products and services, which could have an adverse effect on our business. We may be unable to make such changes or modifications in a commercially reasonable manner or at all. Any inability to adequately address privacy concerns, even if unfounded, or any actual or perceived failure to comply with applicable privacy or data protection laws, regulations, standards or policies, could result in additional cost and liability to us, damage our reputation, inhibit sales and harm our business. Furthermore, the costs of compliance with, and other burdens imposed by, the laws, regulations, standards and policies that are applicable to the businesses of our customers may limit the use and adoption of, and reduce the overall demand for, our platform. Privacy concerns, whether valid or not valid, may inhibit market adoption of our platform particularly in certain industries and foreign countries.
Changes in the regulation of the internet could adversely affect our business.
Laws, rules and regulations governing internet communications, advertising and e-commerce are dynamic and the extent of future government regulation with respect thereto is uncertain. Federal and state regulations govern various aspects of our online business, including intellectual property ownership and infringement, trade secrets, the distribution of electronic communications, marketing and advertising, user privacy and data security, search engines and internet tracking technologies. In addition, changes in laws or regulations that adversely affect the growth, popularity or use of the internet, including potentially the recent repeal in the United States of net neutrality, could decrease the demand for our offerings and increase our cost of doing business. Future taxation on the use of the internet or e-commerce transactions could also be imposed. Existing or future regulation or taxation could hinder growth or adversely affect the use of the internet, including the viability of internet e-commerce, which could reduce our revenue, increase our operating expenses and expose us to significant liabilities.
We are subject to anti-bribery, anti-corruption and similar laws and non-compliance with such laws can subject us to criminal penalties or significant fines and harm our business and reputation.
We are subject to anti-bribery and similar laws, such as the U.S. Foreign Corrupt Practices Act of 1977, as amended (the “FCPA”), the U.S. domestic bribery statute contained in 18 U.S.C. § 201, the USA PATRIOT Act, U.S. Travel Act, the U.K. Bribery Act 2010 and Proceeds of Crime Act 2002, and possibly other anti-corruption, anti-bribery and anti-money laundering laws in countries in which we conduct activities. Anti-corruption laws have been enforced with great rigor in recent years and are interpreted broadly and prohibit companies and their employees and their agents from making or offering improper payments or other benefits to government officials and others in the private sector. The FCPA or other applicable anti-corruption laws may also hold us liable for acts of corruption or bribery committed by our third-party business partners, representatives and agents, even if we do not authorize such activities. As we increase our international sales and business, and increase our use of third parties, our risks under these laws will increase. As a public company, the FCPA separately requires that we keep accurate books and records and maintain internal accounting controls sufficient to assure management’s control, authority and responsibility over our assets. We have adopted policies and procedures and conduct training designed to prevent improper payments and other corrupt practices prohibited by applicable laws, but cannot guarantee that improprieties will not occur. Noncompliance with these laws could subject us to investigations, sanctions, settlements, prosecution, other enforcement actions, disgorgement of profits, significant fines, damages, other civil and criminal penalties or injunctions, suspension and/or debarment from contracting with specified persons, the loss of export privileges, reputational harm, adverse media coverage and other collateral
 
39

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
consequences. Any investigations, actions and/or sanctions could have an adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition.
We rely on licenses to use the intellectual property rights of third parties to conduct our business.
We rely on products, technologies and intellectual property that we license from third parties for use in operating our business. We cannot assure you that these third-party licenses, or support for such licensed products and technologies, will continue to be available to us on commercially reasonable terms, if at all. We cannot be certain that our licensors are not infringing the intellectual property rights of others or that our suppliers and licensors have sufficient rights to the technology in all jurisdictions in which we may operate. Some of our license agreements may be terminated by our licensors for convenience. If we are unable to obtain or maintain rights to any of this technology because of intellectual property infringement claims brought by third parties against our suppliers and licensors or against us, or if we are unable to continue to obtain the technology or enter into new agreements on commercially reasonable terms, our ability to operate and expand our business could be harmed.
Risks Related to Our Organizational Structure
We will be a holding company and our principal asset after the completion of this offering will be our equity interests in DDH LLC, and, accordingly, we will depend on distributions from DDH LLC to pay our taxes, expenses and dividends.
Upon the closing of this offering, we will be a holding company and will have no material assets other than our ownership of LLC Units of DDH LLC. As such, we will have no independent means of generating net sales or cash flow, and our ability to pay our taxes and operating expenses or declare and pay dividends in the future, if any, will be dependent upon the financial results and cash flows of DDH LLC and its subsidiaries and distributions we receive from DDH LLC. DDH LLC and its subsidiaries may not generate sufficient cash flow to distribute funds to us and applicable state law and contractual restrictions, including negative covenants in our debt instruments, may not permit such distributions.
We anticipate that DDH LLC will continue to be treated as a partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes and, as such, generally will not be subject to any entity-level U.S. federal income tax. Instead, taxable income will be allocated to holders of LLC Units, including us. Accordingly, we will incur income taxes on our allocable share of any net taxable income of DDH LLC and will also incur expenses related to our operations, including payments under the Tax Receivable Agreement, which could be significant. See the section titled “Certain Relationships and Related Person Transactions — Tax Receivable Agreement” for additional information. Furthermore, our allocable share of DDH LLC’s net taxable income will increase over time as the Continuing LLC Owners redeem or exchange their LLC Units for shares of our Class A common stock.
We intend, as its managing member, to cause DDH LLC to make cash distributions to the owners of LLC Units, including us, in an amount sufficient to (i) fund their or our tax obligations in respect of allocations of taxable income from DDH LLC and (ii) cover our operating expenses, including payments under the Tax Receivable Agreement. However, DDH LLC’s ability to make such distributions may be subject to various limitations and restrictions, such as restrictions on distributions that would either violate any contract or agreement to which DDH LLC is then a party, including debt agreements, or any applicable law. In addition, liability for adjustments to a partnership’s tax return for taxable years beginning after December 31, 2017, can be imposed on the partnership itself in certain circumstances, absent an election to the contrary. DDH LLC could be subject to material liabilities pursuant to adjustments to its partnership tax returns if, for example, its calculations or allocations of taxable income or loss are incorrect, which also could limit its ability to make distributions to us.
If we do not have sufficient funds to pay taxes or other liabilities or to fund our operations, we may have to borrow funds, which could adversely affect our liquidity and financial condition and subject us to various restrictions imposed by any such lenders. To the extent that we are unable to make payments under the Tax Receivable Agreement for any reason, such payments generally will be deferred and will possibly accrue interest until paid; provided, however, that nonpayment for a specified period may constitute a material breach of a material obligation under the Tax Receivable Agreement and therefore accelerate
 
40

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
payments due thereunder. See the section titled “Certain Relationships and Related Person Transactions — Tax Receivable Agreement” for more information. In addition, if DDH LLC does not have sufficient funds to make distributions, our ability to declare and pay cash dividends will also be restricted or impaired.
DDH LLC may make cash distributions to us substantially in excess of the amounts we use to make distributions to our stockholders and pay our expenses. To the extent we do not distribute such excess cash as dividends on our Class A common stock, the Continuing LLC Owners would benefit from such cash as a result of their ownership of Class A common stock upon an exchange or redemption of their LLC Units.
Following the completion of this offering, we will receive a portion of any distributions made by DDH LLC. Any cash received from such distributions will first be used by us to satisfy any tax liability and then to make any payments required under the Tax Receivable Agreement. Subject to having available cash and subject to limitations imposed by applicable law and contractual restrictions (including pursuant to our debt instruments), the DDH LLC Agreement requires DDH LLC to make certain distributions to us and the Continuing LLC Owners, pro rata, to facilitate the payment of taxes with respect to the income of DDH LLC that is allocated to us and them to the extent that other distributions made by DDH LLC are otherwise insufficient to pay the tax liabilities of holders of LLC Units. These distributions are based on an assumed tax rate, and to the extent the distributions we receive exceed the amounts we actually require to pay taxes, Tax Receivable Agreement payments and other expenses, we will not be required to distribute such excess cash. Our board of directors may, in its sole discretion, choose to use such excess cash for any purpose, including (i) to make distributions to the holders of our Class A common stock, (ii) to acquire additional newly issued LLC Units, and/or (iii) to repurchase outstanding shares of our Class A common stock. Unless and until our board of directors chooses, in its sole discretion, to declare a distribution, we will have no obligation to distribute such cash (or other available cash other than any declared dividend) to our stockholders.
No adjustments to the redemption or exchange ratio of LLC Units for shares of our Class A common stock will be made as a result of either (i) any cash distribution by us or (ii) any cash that we retain and do not distribute to our stockholders. To the extent we do not distribute such cash as dividends on our Class A common stock and instead, for example, hold such cash balances, buy additional LLC Units or lend them to DDH LLC, this may result in shares of our Class A common stock increasing in value relative to the LLC Units. The holders of LLC Units may benefit from any value attributable to such cash balances if they acquire shares of Class A common stock in redemption of or exchange for their LLC Units or if we acquire additional LLC Units (whether from DDH LLC or from holders of LLC Units) at a price based on the market price of our Class A common stock at the time. See the sections titled “Certain Relationships and Related Person Transactions — DDH LLC Agreement” and “Dividend Policy” for further information.
The Tax Receivable Agreement with the Continuing LLC Owners and DDH LLC requires us to make cash payments to them in respect of certain tax benefits to which we may become entitled. In certain circumstances, payments under the Tax Receivable Agreement may be accelerated and/or significantly exceed the actual tax benefits we realize.
Upon the closing of this offering, we will be a party to the Tax Receivable Agreement with DDH LLC and each of the Continuing LLC Owners. Under the Tax Receivable Agreement, we will be required to make cash payments to the Continuing LLC Owners equal to 85% of the tax benefits, if any, that we actually realize, or in certain circumstances, are deemed to realize (calculated using certain assumptions) as a result of (i) increases in the tax basis of assets of DDH LLC resulting from (a) any future redemptions or exchanges of LLC Units described under “Certain Relationships and Related Person Transactions — DDH LLC Agreement — LLC Unit Redemption Right” and (b) payments under the Tax Receivable Agreement and (ii) certain other tax benefits arising from payments under the Tax Receivable Agreement. See the section titled “Certain Relationships and Related Person Transactions — Tax Receivable Agreement” for more information. While the actual amount and timing of any payments under the Tax Receivable Agreement, will vary depending upon a number of factors, including the timing of exchanges, the price of shares of our Class A common stock at the time of the redemption or exchange, the extent to which such redemptions or exchanges are taxable, future tax rates, and the amount and timing of our taxable income (prior to taking into account the tax depreciation or amortization deductions arising from the basis adjustments), we expect that, as a result of the size of the increases in the tax basis of the tangible and intangible assets of DDH LLC attributable to our interests in DDH LLC, during the expected term of the Tax Receivable
 
41

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
Agreement, the payments that we may make to the Continuing LLC Owners could be significant. See the section titled “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Liquidity and Capital Resources — Tax Receivable Agreement” for further information.
Payments under the Tax Receivable Agreement will be based on the tax reporting positions that we determine, and the Internal Revenue Service (the “IRS”) or another tax authority may challenge all or part of the tax basis increases, as well as other related tax positions we take, and a court could sustain such challenge. The Continuing LLC Owners who are parties to the Tax Receivable Agreement will not reimburse us for any payments previously made under the Tax Receivable Agreement if such basis increases or other benefits are subsequently disallowed, except that any excess payments made by us to the Continuing LLC Owners under the Tax Receivable Agreement will be netted against future payments that we might otherwise be required to make to the Continuing LLC Owners under the Tax Receivable Agreement. However, a challenge to any tax benefits initially claimed by us may not arise for a number of years following the initial time of such payment or, even if challenged early, such excess cash payment may be greater than the amount of future cash payments that we might otherwise be required to make under the terms of the Tax Receivable Agreement and, as a result, there might not be sufficient future cash payments against which the prior payments can be fully netted. The applicable U.S. federal income tax rules are complex and factual in nature, and there can be no assurance that the IRS or a court will not disagree with our tax reporting positions. Therefore, payments could be made under the Tax Receivable Agreement in excess of the tax savings that we realize in respect of the tax attributes with respect to the Continuing LLC Owners that are the subject of the Tax Receivable Agreement (the “Tax Attributes”). See the section titled “Certain Relationships and Related Person Transactions — Tax Receivable Agreement.”
Finally, the Tax Receivable Agreement also provides that, upon certain mergers, asset sales or other forms of business combination or certain other changes of control, our (or our successor’s) obligations with respect to tax benefits would be based on certain assumptions, including that we (or our successor) would have sufficient taxable income to utilize the benefits arising from the increased tax deductions and tax basis and other benefits covered by the Tax Receivable Agreement. Consequently, it is possible, in these circumstances, that the actual cash tax savings realized by us may be significantly less than the corresponding Tax Receivable Agreement payments. Our accelerated payment obligations and/or assumptions adopted under the Tax Receivable Agreement in the case of a change of control may impair our ability to consummate a change of control transaction or negatively impact the value received by owners of our Class A common stock in a change of control transaction.
If we were deemed to be an investment company under the 1940 Act as a result of our ownership of DDH LLC, applicable restrictions could make it impractical for us to continue our business as contemplated and could adversely affect our business, results of operations and financial condition.
Under Sections 3(a)(1)(A) and (C) of the 1940 Act, a company generally will be deemed to be an “investment company” for purposes of the 1940 Act if (i) it is, or holds itself out as being, engaged primarily, or proposes to engage primarily, in the business of investing, reinvesting or trading in securities or (ii) it engages, or proposes to engage, in the business of investing, reinvesting, owning, holding or trading in securities and it owns or proposes to acquire investment securities having a value exceeding 40% of the value of its total assets (exclusive of U.S. government securities and cash items) on an unconsolidated basis. We do not believe that we are an “investment company,” as such term is defined in either of those sections of the 1940 Act.
As the sole managing member of DDH LLC, we will control and operate DDH LLC. On that basis, we believe that our interest in DDH LLC is not an “investment security” as that term is used in the 1940 Act. However, if we were to cease participation in the management of DDH LLC, our interest in DDH LLC could be deemed an “investment security” for purposes of the 1940 Act.
We and DDH LLC intend to conduct our operations so that we will not be deemed an investment company. However, if we were to be deemed an investment company, restrictions imposed by the 1940 Act, including limitations on our capital structure and our ability to transact with affiliates, could make it impractical for us to continue our business as contemplated and could adversely affect our business, results of operations and financial condition.
 
42

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
Our organizational structure, including the Tax Receivable Agreement, confers certain benefits upon the Continuing LLC Owners that will not benefit the Class A Common stockholders to the same extent as they will benefit the Continuing LLC Owners.
Our organizational structure, including the Tax Receivable Agreement, confers certain benefits upon the Continuing LLC Owners that will not benefit the holders of our Class A common stock to the same extent. We will enter into a Tax Receivable Agreement with DDH LLC and the Continuing LLC Owners that exchange their LLC Units, which will provide for the payment by us to the Continuing LLC Owners, collectively, of 85% of the amount of tax benefits, if any, that we actually realize, or in some circumstances are deemed to realize, as a result of the Tax Attributes. Due to the uncertainty of various factors, we cannot precisely quantify the likely tax benefits we will realize as a result of purchases of LLC Units and LLC Unit exchanges and the resulting amounts we are likely to pay out to the Continuing LLC Owners pursuant to the Tax Receivable Agreement; however, we estimate that such payments may be substantial. See “Certain Relationships and Related Person Transactions — Tax Receivable Agreement” for more information. Although we will retain 15% of the amount of such tax benefits that are actually realized, this and other aspects of our organizational structure may adversely impact the future trading market for the Class A common stock. In addition, our organizational structure, including the Tax Receivable Agreement, will impose additional compliance costs and require a significant commitment of resources that would not be required of a company with a simpler organizational structure.
We may not be able to realize all or a portion of the tax benefits that are currently expected to result from the Tax Attributes covered by the Tax Receivable Agreement and from payments made under the Tax Receivable Agreement.
Our ability to realize the tax benefits that we currently expect to be available as a result of the Tax Attributes, the payments made pursuant to the Tax Receivable Agreement, and the interest deductions imputed under the Tax Receivable Agreement all depend on a number of assumptions, including that we earn sufficient taxable income each year during the period over which such deductions are available and that there are no adverse changes in applicable law or regulations. Additionally, if our actual taxable income were insufficient or there were additional adverse changes in applicable law or regulations, we may be unable to realize all or a portion of the expected tax benefits and our cash flows and stockholders’ equity could be negatively affected. See “Certain Relationships and Related Person Transactions — Tax Receivable Agreement” for more information.
DDH is controlled by the Continuing LLC Owners, whose interests may differ from those of our public stockholders.
Immediately following the completion of this offering and the application of net proceeds from this offering, the Continuing LLC Owners will control approximately 74.0% of the combined voting power of our common stock through their ownership of Class B common stock. These Continuing LLC Owners will, for the foreseeable future, be able to substantially influence us through their ownership position over corporate management and affairs, and will be able to control virtually all matters requiring stockholder approval. These Continuing LLC Owners will be able to, subject to applicable law, elect a majority of the members of our board of directors and control actions to be taken by us and our board of directors, including amendments to our certificate of incorporation and bylaws and approval of significant corporate transactions, including mergers and sales of substantially all of our assets. The directors so elected will have the authority, subject to the terms of our indebtedness and applicable rules and regulations, to issue additional stock, implement stock repurchase programs, declare dividends and make other decisions. It is possible that the interests of these Continuing LLC Owners may in some circumstances conflict with our interests and the interests of our other stockholders, including you. For example, these Continuing LLC Owners may have different tax positions from us, especially in light of the Tax Receivable Agreement, which could influence our decisions regarding whether and when to dispose of assets, whether and when to incur new or refinance existing indebtedness, and whether and when DDH should terminate the Tax Receivable Agreement and accelerate its obligations thereunder. In addition, the determination of future tax reporting positions and the structuring of future transactions may take into consideration these Continuing LLC Owners’ tax or other considerations, which may differ from the considerations of us or our other
 
43

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
stockholders. See the section titled “Certain Relationships and Related Person Transactions — Tax Receivable Agreement” for more information.
Risks Related to Owning our Class A Common Stock
If you purchase shares of our Class A common stock in this offering, your investment will experience immediate dilution.
We expect the initial public offering price of our Class A common stock to be substantially higher than the pro forma net tangible book value per share of our Class A common stock following this offering based on the total value of our tangible assets less our total liabilities. Therefore, if you purchase shares of our Class A common stock in this offering, you will pay a price per share that substantially exceeds our pro forma net tangible book value per share after this offering. Based on an assumed initial public offering price of $8.00 per share, which is the midpoint of the price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, you will experience immediate dilution of $8.07 per share, representing the difference between our pro forma as adjusted net tangible book value per share as of September 30, 2021, after giving effect to the issuance of 4,000,000 shares of our Class A common stock in this offering. To the extent current or future outstanding equity awards are settled in shares of our capital stock, you will incur further dilution. Furthermore, if the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional shares or outstanding options are exercised, you could experience further dilution. For a further description of the dilution that you will experience immediately after this offering, see the section titled “Dilution” for more information.
If we fail to maintain or implement effective internal controls, we may not be able to report financial results accurately or on a timely basis, or to detect fraud, which could have a material adverse effect on our business and the per share price of our Class A common stock.
The Sarbanes-Oxley Act requires, among other things, that we maintain effective disclosure controls and procedures and internal control over financial reporting. We are continuing to develop and refine our disclosure controls and other procedures that are designed to ensure that information required to be disclosed by us in the reports that we will file with the SEC is recorded, processed, summarized and reported within the time periods specified in SEC rules and forms. We are also continuing to improve our internal control over financial reporting. We have expended, and anticipate that we will continue to expend, significant resources in order to maintain and improve the effectiveness of our disclosure controls and procedures and internal control over financial reporting.
Our current controls and any new controls that we develop may become inadequate because of changes in conditions in our business. Further, weaknesses in our disclosure controls or our internal control over financial reporting may be discovered in the future. Any failure to develop or maintain effective controls, or any difficulties encountered in their implementation or improvement, could harm our operating results or cause us to fail to meet our reporting obligations and may result in a restatement of our financial statements for prior periods. Any failure to implement and maintain effective internal control over financial reporting could also adversely affect the results of management reports and independent registered public accounting firm audits of our internal control over financial reporting that we will eventually be required to include in our periodic reports that will be filed with the SEC. Ineffective disclosure controls and procedures, and internal control over financial reporting could also cause investors to lose confidence in our reported financial and other information, which would likely have a negative effect on the market price of our Class A common stock. In addition, if we are unable to continue to meet these requirements, we may not be able to remain listed on the Nasdaq Capital Market.
We are not currently required to comply with the SEC rules that implement Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act, and are therefore not required to make a formal assessment of the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting for that purpose. Upon becoming a public company, we will be required to provide an annual management report on the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting commencing with our second annual report on Form 10-K. Our independent registered public accounting firm is not required to audit the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting until after we are no longer an “emerging growth company,” as defined in the JOBS Act. At such time, our
 
44

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
independent registered public accounting firm may issue a report that is adverse in the event it is not satisfied with the level at which our internal control over financial reporting is documented, designed or operating.
Any failure to maintain effective disclosure controls and internal control over financial reporting could have a material and adverse effect on our business and operating results and cause a decline in the market price of our Class A common stock.
Sales of substantial blocks of our Class A common stock into the public market after this offering, including when “lock-up” or “market standoff” periods end, or the perception that such sales might occur, could cause the market price of our Class A common stock to decline.
Sales of substantial blocks of our Class A common stock into the public market after this offering, including when “lock-up” or “market standoff” periods end, or the perception that such sales might occur, could cause the market price of our Class A common stock to decline and may make it more difficult for you to sell your Class A common stock at a time and price that you deem appropriate. Upon completion of this offering, we will have 4,000,000 shares of Class A common stock outstanding (assuming no exercise of the underwriters’ option to purchase additional shares). All of the shares of Class A common stock sold in this offering will be freely tradable without restrictions or further registration under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, or the Securities Act, except for any shares held by our “affiliates” as defined in Rule 144 under the Securities Act.
Subject to exceptions described in the section titled “Underwriting,” we, all of our directors and officers and all of the other holders of our capital stock and securities convertible into, or exchangeable for, our capital stock, have agreed not to offer, sell or agree to sell, directly or indirectly, any shares of Class A common stock without the permission of the representatives of the underwriters for a period of 180 days from the date of this prospectus. When the applicable lock-up period expires, we, our directors and officers and locked-up equity holders will be able to sell shares into the public market.
We also intend to register the offer and sale of all shares of Class A common stock that we may issue under our equity compensation plans.
There has been no public market for our Class A common stock prior to this offering, and an active market in which investors can resell their shares of our Class A common stock may not develop.
Prior to this offering, there has been no public market for our Class A common stock. We cannot predict the extent to which an active market for our Class A common stock will develop or be sustained after this offering, or how the development of such a market might affect the market price of our Class A common stock. The initial public offering price of our shares in this offering has been agreed to between us and the underwriters based on a number of factors, including market conditions in effect around the time of this offering, and it may not be in any way indicative of the price at which the shares of our Class A common stock will trade following the completion of this offering. Accordingly, investors may not be able to resell their shares of our Class A common stock at or above the initial public offering price.
We may experience fluctuations in our operating results, which could make our future operating results difficult to predict or cause our operating results to fall below analysts’ and investors’ expectations.
Our quarterly and annual operating results have fluctuated in the past and we expect our future operating results to fluctuate due to a variety of factors, many of which are beyond our control. Fluctuations in our operating results could cause our performance to fall below the expectations of analysts and investors, and adversely affect the price of our Class A common stock. Because our business is changing and evolving rapidly, our historical operating results may not be necessarily indicative of our future operating results. Factors that may cause our operating results to fluctuate include the following:

changes in demand for our platform, including related to the seasonal nature of spending on digital advertising campaigns;

changes in our pricing policies, the pricing policies of our competitors and the pricing or availability of inventory, data or of other third-party services;
 
45

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 

changes in our customer base and platform offerings;

the addition or loss of customers;

changes in advertising budget allocations, agency affiliations or marketing strategies;

changes to our product, media, customer or channel mix;

changes and uncertainty in the regulatory environment for us, advertisers or publishers;

changes in the economic prospects of advertisers or the economy generally, which could alter advertisers’ spending priorities, or could increase the time or costs required to complete advertising inventory sales;

the possible effects of the widespread domestic and global impact of the COVID-19 pandemic, including on general economic conditions, public health and consumer demand and financial markets;

changes in the availability of advertising inventory through real-time advertising exchanges or in the cost of reaching end consumers through digital advertising;

disruptions or outages on our platform;

the introduction of new technologies or offerings by our competitors;

changes in our capital expenditures as we acquire the hardware, equipment and other assets required to support our business;

timing differences between our payments for advertising inventory and our collection of related advertising revenue;

the length and unpredictability of our sales cycle; and

costs related to acquisitions of businesses or technologies, or employee recruiting.
Based upon the factors above and others beyond our control, we have a limited ability to forecast our future revenue, costs and expenses, and as a result, our operating results may, from time to time, fall below our estimates or the expectations of analysts and investors.
Seasonal fluctuations in advertising activity could have a material impact on our revenue, cash flow and operating results.
Our revenue, cash flow, operating results and other key operating and performance metrics may vary from quarter to quarter due to the seasonal nature of our customers’ spending on advertising campaigns. Pricing of digital ad impressions in the fourth quarter is likely to be higher due to increased demand. In addition, adverse economic conditions or economic uncertainty may cause advertisers to decrease purchases of digital ad impressions, adversely affecting our revenue and results of operations. For example, if Google and Facebook become the preferred destinations for advertisers, lower demand for ad impressions processed on our platform could cause publishers to reduce their use of our platform or to cease using it altogether. A decline in the market for programmatic advertising or the failure of that market to grow as expected could also adversely affect our business, results of operations and financial condition. Any decline in the volume or perceived quality of the ad impressions available on our platform could further reduce demand. Any such developments could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition. Political advertising could also cause our revenue to increase during election cycles and decrease during other periods, making it difficult to predict our revenue, cash flow and operating results, all of which could fall below our expectations.
Our charter documents and Delaware law could discourage takeover attempts and other corporate governance changes.
Our certificate of incorporation and bylaws in effect upon completion of this offering contain provisions that could delay or prevent a change in control of our Company. These provisions could also make it difficult for stockholders to elect directors that are not nominated by the current members of our board of directors or take other corporate actions, including effecting changes in our management. These provisions include certain provisions that:
 
46

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 

permit the board of directors to establish the number of directors and fill any vacancies and newly created directorships;

provide that, after a removal for cause, vacancies on our board of directors may be filled only by a majority of directors then in office, even though less than a quorum;

prohibit cumulative voting in the election of directors;

require the affirmative vote of the holders of 66 2/3% of the voting power of our outstanding common stock to amend certain provisions of our certificate of incorporation and bylaws;

authorize the issuance of “blank check” preferred stock that our board of directors could use to implement a stockholder rights plan;

restrict the forum for certain litigation against us to Delaware or federal courts;

permit our board of directors to alter our bylaws without obtaining stockholder approval; and

establish advance notice requirements for nominations for election to our board of directors or for proposing matters that can be acted upon by stockholders at annual stockholder meetings.
In addition, as a Delaware corporation, we are subject to Section 203 of the Delaware General Corporation Law (the “DGCL”). These provisions may prohibit large stockholders, in particular those owning 15% or more of our outstanding voting stock, from merging or combining with us for a period of time without the approval of our board of directors. In addition, our credit facility includes, and other debt instruments we may enter into in the future may include, provisions entitling the lenders to demand immediate repayment of all borrowings upon the occurrence of certain change of control events relating to us, which also could discourage, delay or prevent a business combination transaction.
The requirements of being a public company may strain our resources, divert our management’s attention and affect our ability to attract and retain qualified board members.
As a public company, we will be subject to the reporting requirements of the Exchange Act, and will be required to comply with the applicable requirements of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act and the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act, the listing requirements of the Nasdaq Capital Market, and other applicable securities rules and regulations. Compliance with these rules and regulations will increase our legal and financial compliance costs, make some activities more difficult, time-consuming or costly and increase demand on our systems and resources. Among other things, the Exchange Act requires that we file annual, quarterly and current reports with respect to our business and operating results and maintain effective disclosure controls and procedures and internal controls over financial reporting. Significant resources and management oversight will be required to maintain and, if required, improve our disclosure controls and procedures and internal controls over financial reporting to meet this standard. As a result, management’s attention may be diverted from other business concerns, which could harm our business and operating results. Although we have already hired additional employees to comply with these requirements, we may need to hire even more employees in the future, which will increase our costs and expenses.
We also expect that being a public company and these new rules and regulations will make it more expensive for us to obtain director and officer liability insurance, and we may be required to accept reduced coverage or incur substantially higher costs to obtain coverage. These factors could also make it more difficult for us to attract and retain qualified members of our board of directors, particularly to serve on our audit committee and compensation committee, and qualified executive officers.
We have broad discretion in the use of net proceeds that we receive in this offering and we may not use them effectively.
After giving effect to the use of proceeds described in “Use of Proceeds,” we expect to have remaining net proceeds, which we currently intend to use for working capital and other general corporate purposes, including potential future acquisition of, or investment in, technologies or businesses that complement our business. We have no present commitments or agreements to enter into any acquisitions or make any investments. Our management will have broad discretion in the application of the net proceeds, including
 
47

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
possible acquisitions of, or investments in, businesses or technologies. The failure by our management to apply these funds effectively could harm our business, operating results and financial condition.
Reduced reporting and disclosure requirements applicable to us as an emerging growth company could make our Class A common stock less attractive to investors.
We are an emerging growth company and, for as long as we continue to be an emerging growth company, we may continue to avail ourselves of exemptions from various reporting requirements applicable to other public companies. Consequently, we are not required to have our independent registered public accounting firm audit our internal control over financial reporting under Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act, and we are subject to reduced disclosure obligations regarding executive compensation in our periodic reports and proxy statements and exemptions from the requirements of holding a nonbinding advisory vote on executive compensation and stockholder approval of any golden parachute payments not previously approved. In addition, the JOBS Act provides that an emerging growth company can take advantage of an extended transition period for complying with new or revised accounting standards. As a result, our financial statements may not be comparable to companies that comply with new or revised accounting pronouncements as of the dates such pronouncements are effective for public companies. We could be an emerging growth company for up to five years following the completion of this offering. We will cease to be an emerging growth company upon the earliest of: (i) the end of the fiscal year following the fifth anniversary of this offering, (ii) the first fiscal year after our annual gross revenue is $1.07 billion or more, (iii) the date on which we have, during the previous three-year period, issued more than $1 billion in nonconvertible debt securities or (iv) the end of any fiscal year in which the market value of our Class A common stock held by non-affiliates exceeded $700 million as of the end of the second quarter of that fiscal year. We cannot predict whether investors will find our Class A common stock less attractive if we choose to rely on these exemptions. If some investors find our Class A common stock less attractive as a result of any choices to reduce future disclosure, there may be a less active trading market for our Class A common stock, and the price of our Class A common stock may be more volatile.
Our shares of Class A common stock will be subject to potential delisting if we do not continue to maintain the listing requirements of the Nasdaq Capital Market.
We have applied to have our shares of Class A common stock listed on the Nasdaq Capital Market, under the symbol “DRCT.” The Nasdaq Capital Market has rules for continued listing, including, without limitation, minimum market capitalization and other requirements. Failure to maintain our listing, or de-listing from the Nasdaq Capital Market, would make it more difficult for shareholders to sell our securities and more difficult to obtain accurate price quotations on our securities. This could have an adverse effect on the price of our Class A common stock. Our ability to issue additional securities for financing or other purposes, or otherwise to arrange for any financing we may need in the future, may also be materially and adversely affected if our Class A common stock is not traded on a national securities exchange.
Because we do not anticipate paying any cash dividends on our Class A common stock in the foreseeable future, capital appreciation, if any, will be your sole source of gains.
We have never declared or paid any dividends on our Class A common stock. We currently intend to retain any earnings to finance the operation and expansion of our business, and we do not anticipate paying any cash dividends in the foreseeable future. Any determination to pay dividends in the future will be at the discretion of our board of directors. In addition, the terms of our existing debt arrangements preclude us from paying dividends and our future debt agreements, if any, may contain similar restrictions. As a result, you may only receive a return on your investment in our Class A common stock if the market price of our Class A common stock increases.
The trading price of the shares of our Class A common stock is likely to be volatile, and purchasers of our Class A common stock could incur substantial losses.
Technology stocks historically have experienced high levels of volatility. The trading price of our Class A common stock following this offering may fluctuate substantially. Following the completion of this offering, the market price of our Class A common stock may be higher or lower than the price you pay in
 
48

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
the offering, depending on many factors, some of which are beyond our control and may not be related to our operating performance. These fluctuations could cause you to incur substantial losses, including all of your investment in our Class A common stock. Factors that could cause fluctuations in the trading price of our Class A common stock include the following:

significant volatility in the market price and trading volume of technology companies in general and of companies in the digital advertising industry in particular;

announcements of new solutions or technologies, commercial relationships, acquisitions or other events by us or our competitors;

price and volume fluctuations in the overall stock market from time to time;

changes in how customers perceive the benefits of our platform and future offerings;

the public’s reaction to our press releases, other public announcements and filings with the SEC;

fluctuations in the trading volume of our shares or the size of our public float;

sales of large blocks of our Class A common stock;

actual or anticipated changes or fluctuations in our results of operations or financial projections;

changes in actual or future expectations of investors or securities analysts;

litigation involving us, our industry or both;

governmental or regulatory actions or audits;

regulatory developments applicable to our business, including those related to privacy in the United States or globally;

general economic conditions and trends;

major catastrophic events in our domestic and foreign markets; and

departures of key employees.
We are a “controlled company” for purposes of the Nasdaq Marketplace Rules and, as a result, qualify for, and may rely on, exemptions and relief from certain corporate governance requirements. If we rely on these exemptions, our stockholders will not have the same protections afforded to stockholders of companies that are subject to such requirements.
Following this offering, DDM will beneficially own approximately 74.0% of the combined voting power of our Class A and Class B common stock. As a result, we will be a “controlled company” within the meaning of the Nasdaq corporate governance standards. Under these corporate governance standards, a company of which more than 50% of the voting power in the election of directors is held by an individual, group or another company is a “controlled company” and may elect not to comply with certain corporate governance requirements. For example, controlled companies are not required to have:

a board that is composed of a majority of “independent directors,” as defined under the Nasdaq rules;

a compensation committee that is composed entirely of independent directors; and

director nominations be made, or recommended to the full board of directors, by its independent directors, or by a nominations/governance committee that is composed entirely of independent directors.
While we do not intend to rely on the exemptions related to being a “controlled company” within the meaning of the Nasdaq rules, we may utilize these exemptions for as long as we continue to qualify as a “controlled company.” Accordingly, our stockholders may not have the same protections afforded to stockholders of companies that are subject to all of the corporate governance requirements of the Nasdaq Capital Market. Investors may find our Class A common stock less attractive as a result of our reliance on these exemptions. If some investors find our Class A common stock less attractive as a result, there may be a less active trading market for our Class A common stock and our stock price may be more volatile.
 
49

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
General Risks
Failure to manage our growth effectively could cause our business to suffer and have an adverse effect on our business, operating results and financial condition.
We have experienced significant growth in a short period of time. To manage our growth effectively, we must continually evaluate and evolve our organization. We must also manage our employees, operations, finances, technology and development and capital investments efficiently. Our efficiency, productivity and the quality of our platform and customer service may be adversely impacted if we do not train our new personnel, particularly our sales and support personnel, quickly and effectively, or if we fail to appropriately coordinate across our organization. Additionally, our rapid growth may place a strain on our resources, infrastructure and ability to maintain the quality of our platform. You should not consider our revenue growth and levels of profitability in recent periods as indicative of future performance. In future periods, our revenue or profitability could decline or grow more slowly than we expect. Failure to manage our growth effectively could cause our business to suffer and have an adverse effect on our operating results and financial condition.
If securities or industry analysts do not publish research or reports about our business, or publish inaccurate or unfavorable research reports about our business, our share price and trading volume could decline.
The trading market for our Class A common stock will partially depend on the research and reports that securities or industry analysts publish about us or our business. We do not have any control over these analysts. If one or more of the analysts who cover us should downgrade our shares or change their opinion of our business prospects, our share price would likely decline. If one or more of these analysts ceases coverage of us or fails to regularly publish reports on us, we could lose visibility in the financial markets, which could cause our share price or trading volume to decline.
Our reported financial results may be adversely affected by changes in accounting principles generally accepted in the United States. If our estimates or judgments relating to our critical accounting policies prove to be incorrect, our results of operations could be adversely affected.
U.S. generally accepted accounting principles (“GAAP”), are subject to interpretation by the Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”), the SEC and various bodies formed to promulgate and interpret appropriate accounting principles. A change in these principles or interpretations could have a significant effect on our reported results of operations and could affect the reporting of transactions already completed before the announcement of a change.
The preparation of financial statements in conformity with GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the amounts reported in our consolidated financial statements and accompanying notes appearing elsewhere in this prospectus. We base our estimates on historical experience and on various other assumptions that we believe to be reasonable under the circumstances, as discussed in the section titled “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates.” The results of these estimates form the basis for making judgments about the carrying values of assets, liabilities and equity, and the amount of revenue and expenses that are not readily apparent from other sources. Significant estimates, judgments, and assumptions used in our financial statements include, but are not limited to, those related to revenue recognition, accounts receivable and related reserves, useful lives and realizability of long lived assets, capitalized internal-use software development costs, assumptions used in the valuation of warrants, accounting for stock-based compensation, and valuation allowances against deferred tax assets. These estimates are periodically reviewed for any changes in circumstances, facts and experience. Our results of operations may be adversely affected if our assumptions change or if actual circumstances differ from those in our assumptions, which could cause our results of operations to fall below the expectations of securities analysts and investors, resulting in a decline in the market price of our Class A common stock.
Global and national financial events may have an impact on our business and financial condition in ways that we currently cannot predict.
A credit crisis, turmoil in the global or U.S. financial system, recession or similar possible events in the future could negatively impact us. A financial crisis or recession may limit our ability to raise capital through
 
50

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
credit and equity markets. The prices for the products and services that we intend to provide may be affected by a number of factors, and it is unknown how these factors may be impacted by a global or national financial event.
If our estimates or judgments relating to our critical accounting policies are erroneous or based on assumptions that change or prove to be incorrect, our operating results could fall below the expectations of securities analysts and investors, resulting in a decline in our stock price.
The preparation of financial statements in conformity with GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the amounts reported in the consolidated financial statements and accompanying notes. We base our estimates on our best judgment, historical experience, information derived from third parties and on various other assumptions that we believe to be reasonable under the circumstances, as discussed in the section titled “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations,” the results of which form the basis for making judgments about the carrying values of assets, liabilities, equity, revenue and expenses that are not readily apparent from other sources. Our operating results may be adversely affected if our judgments prove to be wrong, assumptions change or actual circumstances differ from those in our assumptions, which could cause our operating results to fall below the expectations of securities analysts and investors, resulting in a decline in our stock price. Significant assumptions and estimates used in preparing our consolidated financial statements include those related to revenue recognition, stock-based compensation and income taxes.
 
51

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
CAUTIONARY NOTE REGARDING FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS
This prospectus contains forward-looking statements within the meaning of federal securities laws and which are subject to certain risks, trends and uncertainties. We use words such as “could,” “would,” “may,” “might,” “will,” “expect,” “likely,” “believe,” “continue,” “anticipate,” “estimate,” “intend,” “plan,” “project” and other similar expressions to identify forward-looking statements, but not all forward-looking statements include these words. All of our forward-looking statements involve estimates and uncertainties that could cause actual results to differ materially from those expressed in or implied by the forward-looking statements. Accordingly, any such statements are qualified in their entirety by reference to the information described under the caption “Risk Factors” and elsewhere in this prospectus.
The forward-looking statements contained in this prospectus are based on assumptions that we have made in light of our industry experience and our perceptions of historical trends, current conditions, expected future developments and other factors we believe are appropriate under the circumstances. As you read and consider this prospectus, you should understand that these statements are not guarantees of performance or results. They involve risks, uncertainties (many of which are beyond our control) and assumptions. Although we believe that these forward-looking statements are based on reasonable assumptions, you should be aware that many factors could affect our actual operating and financial performance and cause our performance to differ materially from the performance expressed in or implied by the forward-looking statements. We believe these factors include, but are not limited to, the following:

our dependence on the overall demand for advertising, which could be influenced by economic downturns;

any slow-down or unanticipated development in the market for programmatic advertising campaigns;

the effects of health epidemics, such as the ongoing global COVID-19 pandemic;

operational and performance issues with our platform, whether real or perceived, including a failure to respond to technological changes or to upgrade our technology systems;

any significant inadvertent disclosure or breach of confidential and/or personal information we hold, or of the security of our or our customers’, suppliers’ or other partners’ computer systems;

any unavailability or non-performance of the non-proprietary technology, software, products and services that we use;

unfavorable publicity and negative public perception about our industry, particularly concerns regarding data privacy and security relating to our industry’s technology and practices, and any perceived failure to comply with laws and industry self-regulation;

restrictions on the use of third-party “cookies,” mobile device IDs or other tracking technologies, which could diminish our platform’s effectiveness;

any inability to compete in our intensely competitive market;

any significant fluctuations caused by our high customer concentration;

our limited operating history, which could result in our past results not being indicative of future operating performance;

any violation of legal and regulatory requirements or any misconduct by our employees, subcontractors, agents or business partners;

any strain on our resources, diversion of our management’s attention or impact on our ability to attract and retain qualified board members as a result of being a public company;

as a holding company, we will depend on distributions from DDH LLC to pay our taxes, expenses (including payments under the Tax Receivable Agreement) and dividends;

DDH LLC may make distributions of cash to us substantially in excess of the amounts we use to make distributions to our stockholders and pay our expenses (including our taxes and payments under the Tax Receivable Agreement), which, to the extent not distributed as dividends on our Class A
 
52

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
common stock, would benefit the Continuing LLC Owners as a result of their ownership of Class A common stock upon an exchange or redemption of their LLC Units; and

other factors and assumptions discussed in this prospectus under “Risk Factors,” “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and “Business.”
Should one or more of these risks or uncertainties materialize, or should any of these assumptions prove to be incorrect, our actual operating and financial performance may vary in material respects from the performance projected in these forward-looking statements. Further, any forward-looking statement speaks only as of the date on which it is made, and except as required by law, we undertake no obligation to update any forward-looking statement contained in this prospectus to reflect events or circumstances after the date on which it is made or to reflect the occurrence of anticipated or unanticipated events or circumstances. New factors that could cause our business not to develop as we expect emerge from time to time, and it is not possible for us to predict all of them. Further, we cannot assess the impact of each currently known or new factor on our results of operations or the extent to which any factor, or combination of factors, may cause actual results to differ materially from those contained in any forward-looking statements.
 
53

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
USE OF PROCEEDS
We estimate that the net proceeds from the sale of our Class A common stock that we are offering will be approximately $27.0 million (or approximately $31.5 million if the underwriters’ option to purchase additional shares of our Class A common stock from us is exercised in full), based on an assumed public offering price of $8.00 per share, which is the midpoint of the price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, and after deducting estimated underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated offering expenses payable by us. We intend to use the net proceeds from this offering to purchase 4,000,000 newly issued LLC Units (or 4,600,000 LLC Units if the underwriters exercise in full their option to purchase additional shares of Class A common stock) directly from DDH LLC at a purchase price per LLC Unit equal to the initial public offering price per share of Class A common stock less the underwriting discounts and commissions.
We intend to cause DDH LLC to use such proceeds (together with any additional proceeds it may receive if the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional shares of Class A common stock), after deducting estimated offering expenses, together with our existing cash and cash equivalents, to purchase all LLC Units held by USDM for an aggregate purchase price of approximately $14.0 million and for working capital and general corporate purposes, including potential future acquisition of, or investment in, technologies or businesses that complement our business. We have no present commitments or agreements to enter into any such acquisitions or make any such investments. Pending these uses, we may invest the net proceeds from this offering in short-term, investment-grade, interest-bearing securities such as money market accounts, certificates of deposit, commercial paper and guaranteed obligations of the U.S. government.
Each $1.00 increase or decrease in the assumed initial public offering price of $8.00 per share, which is the midpoint of the price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, would increase or decrease the net proceeds that we receive from this offering by approximately $3.7 million, assuming that the number of shares offered by us, as set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, remains the same and after deducting the estimated underwriting discounts and commissions payable by us. Similarly, each increase or decrease of 1,000,000 shares of Class A common stock offered by us in this offering would increase or decrease the net proceeds that we receive from this offering by approximately $7.4 million, assuming the assumed initial public offering price remains the same and after deducting the estimated underwriting discounts and commissions payable by us.
This expected use of the net proceeds from this offering represents our intentions based upon our current financial condition, results of operations, business plans and conditions. As of the date of this prospectus, we cannot predict with certainty all of the particular uses for the net proceeds to be received upon the closing of this offering or the amounts that we will actually spend on the uses set forth above. The amounts and timing of our actual expenditures may vary significantly depending on numerous factors. As a result, our management will retain broad discretion over the allocation of the net proceeds from this offering.
 
54

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIVIDEND POLICY
Since our inception, we have not paid any dividends on our Class A common stock, and we currently expect that, for the foreseeable future, all earnings will be retained for the development of our business and no dividends will be declared or paid. In the future, our board of directors may decide, at its discretion, whether dividends may be declared and paid, taking into consideration, among other things, our earnings, operating results, financial condition and capital requirements, general business conditions and other pertinent facts. Holders of our Class B common stock are not entitled to participate in any dividends declared by our board of directors.
Upon the completion of this offering, Direct Digital Holdings will be a holding company and will have no material assets other than its ownership of LLC Units. Accordingly, we will depend on distributions from DDH LLC to pay our taxes and expenses, including payments under the Tax Receivable Agreement. The limited liability company agreement of DDH LLC that will be in effect at the time of this offering provides that certain distributions intended to cover the taxes of DDH LLC’s owners will be made based upon assumed tax rates and other assumptions provided in the DDH LLC Agreement. See the section titled “Certain Relationships and Related Person Transactions — DDH LLC Agreement” for more information. Additionally, in the event Direct Digital Holdings declares any cash dividends, we intend to cause DDH LLC to make distributions to Direct Digital Holdings in an amount sufficient to cover such cash dividends declared by us. If DDH LLC makes such distributions to Direct Digital Holdings, the Continuing LLC Owners will also be entitled to receive the respective equivalent pro rata distributions in accordance with the percentages of their respective LLC Units. See the section titled “Risk Factors — Risks Related to Our Organizational Structure.” To the extent that the tax distributions we receive exceed the amounts we actually require to pay taxes, Tax Receivable Agreement payments and other expenses, we will not be required to distribute such excess cash.
DDH LLC’s ability to make such distributions may be subject to various limitations and restrictions. In addition, DDH LLC is generally prohibited under Delaware law from making a distribution to a member to the extent that, at the time of the distribution, after giving effect to the distribution, liabilities of DDH LLC (with certain exceptions) exceed the fair value of its assets. DDH LLC’s subsidiaries are generally subject to similar legal limitations on its ability to make distributions to DDH LLC.
 
55

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
ORGANIZATIONAL TRANSACTIONS
Existing Organization
Prior to the completion of this offering and the Organizational Transactions described below, the Continuing LLC Owners were the only owners of DDH LLC. DDH LLC is treated as a partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes and, as such, generally is not subject to any U.S. federal entity-level income taxes. Rather, taxable income or loss is included in the U.S. federal income tax returns of DDH LLC’s members.
Direct Digital Holdings was incorporated as a Delaware corporation on August 23, 2021 and is the issuer of the Class A common stock being offered in this offering.
Organizational Transactions
In connection with the closing of this offering, we will consummate the following organizational transactions, which we refer to collectively as the “Organizational Transactions”:

we will amend and restate the DDH LLC Agreement to, among other things, appoint Direct Digital Holdings as the sole managing member of DDH LLC and effectuate a recapitalization of all outstanding preferred units and common units into a single class of economic nonvoting units of DDH LLC. We will otherwise operate as a holding company. Direct Digital Holdings will include DDH LLC in its consolidated financial statements;

we will amend and restate the Direct Digital Holdings certificate of incorporation to, among other things, provide for Class A common stock, each share of which entitles its holders to one vote per share, and Class B common stock, each share of which entitles its holders to one vote per share on all matters presented to Direct Digital Holdings’ stockholders;

we will cause DDH LLC to purchase all of the LLC Units held by USDM for an aggregate purchase price of approximately $14.0 million;

the Continuing LLC Owners will continue to own the LLC Units they receive in exchange for their outstanding common units in DDH LLC, representing approximately 74.0% of the economic interest in the business of DDH LLC and its subsidiaries (or approximately 71.2%, if the underwriters exercise in full their option to purchase additional shares of Class A common stock) and we will issue shares of Class B common stock, each share of which entitles its holder to one vote per share, to the Continuing LLC Owners on a one-to-one basis with the number of LLC Units each Continuing LLC Owner owns upon the consummation of the Organizational Transactions, for nominal consideration; the LLC Units, following the completion of this offering, will be redeemable, at the Continuing LLC Owners’ election from time to time, for newly issued shares of Class A common stock on a one-for-one basis (subject to customary adjustments, including for stock splits, stock dividends and reclassifications) in accordance with the terms of the DDH LLC Agreement; provided that, at Direct Digital Holdings’ election, Direct Digital Holdings may effect a direct exchange of such Class A common stock. Shares of Class B common stock will be cancelled on a one-for-one basis if we, at the election of the Continuing LLC Owners that hold Class B common stock, redeem or exchange such holders’ LLC Units pursuant to the terms of the DDH LLC Agreement;

Direct Digital Holdings will enter into the Tax Receivable Agreement with the Continuing LLC Owners and DDH LLC;

Direct Digital Holdings will issue 4,000,000 shares of Class A common stock to the purchasers in this offering (or 4,600,000 shares of our Class A common stock if the underwriters exercise in full their option to purchase additional shares of Class A common stock); and

Direct Digital Holdings will use all of the net proceeds from this offering (including any net proceeds received upon exercise of the underwriters’ option to purchase additional shares of Class A common stock) to acquire newly issued LLC Units from DDH LLC at a purchase price per interest equal to the initial public offering price per share of Class A common stock, less underwriting discounts and commissions, collectively representing 26.0% of DDH LLC’s outstanding LLC Units (or 28.8%, if
 
56

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
the underwriters exercise in full their option to purchase additional shares of Class A common stock). Following the completion of this offering, Direct Digital Holdings will hold a number of LLC Units that is equal to the number of shares of Class A common stock that it has issued, a relationship that we believe fosters transparency because it results in a single share of Class A common stock representing the same percentage ownership in DDH LLC as a single unit of LLC Units. See the section titled “Certain Relationships and Related Person Transactions — DDH LLC Agreement.”
Organizational Structure Following This Offering
Immediately following the completion of the Organizational Transactions, including this offering:

Direct Digital Holdings will be a holding company and the principal asset of Direct Digital Holdings will be our interests in DDH LLC;

Direct Digital Holdings will be the sole managing member of DDH LLC and will control the business and affairs of DDH LLC and its subsidiaries;

Direct Digital Holdings’ amended and restated certificate of incorporation and the DDH LLC Agreement will require that we and DDH LLC at all times maintain a one-to-one ratio between the number of shares of Class A common stock issued by us and the number of LLC Units owned by us, as well as a one-to-one ratio between the number of shares of Class B common stock owned by the Continuing LLC Owners and the number of LLC Units owned by the Continuing LLC Owners;

Direct Digital Holdings will own LLC Units representing 26.0% of the economic interest in DDH LLC (or 28.8%, if the underwriters exercise in full their option to purchase additional shares of Class A common stock);

the purchasers in this offering (i) will own 4,000,000 shares of Class A common stock, representing approximately 26.0% of the combined voting power of all of Direct Digital Holdings common stock (or 4,600,000 shares of Class A common stock, representing approximately 28.8%, if the underwriters exercise in full their option to purchase additional shares of Class A common stock), (ii) will own 100% of the economic interest in Direct Digital Holdings and (iii) through Direct Digital Holdings ownership of LLC Units, indirectly will hold approximately 26.0% of the economic interest in DDH LLC (or 28.8% if the underwriters exercise in full their option to purchase additional shares of Class A common stock);

the Continuing LLC Owners will own (i) through their ownership of Class B common stock approximately 74.0% of the voting power in Direct Digital Holdings (or approximately 71.2%, if the underwriters exercise in full their option to purchase additional shares of Class A common stock) and (ii) LLC Units, representing 74.0% of the economic interest in DDH LLC (or 71.2%, if the underwriters exercise in full their option to purchase additional shares of Class A common stock). Following the completion of the offering, each LLC Unit held by the Continuing LLC Owners will be redeemable, at their election (subject to the terms of the DDH LLC Agreement) from time to time, for newly issued shares of Class A common stock on a one-for-one basis (subject to customary adjustments, including for stock splits, stock dividends and reclassifications) in accordance with the terms of the DDH LLC Agreement; provided that, at Direct Digital Holdings’ election, Direct Digital Holdings may effect a direct exchange of such Class A common stock. Shares of Class B common stock will be cancelled on a one-for-one basis if we, at the election of the Continuing LLC Owners, redeem or exchange their LLC Units pursuant to the terms of the DDH LLC Agreement. See the section titled “Certain Relationships and Related Person Transactions — DDH LLC Agreement;”

USDM will hold no interest in DDH LLC or us; and

Direct Digital Holdings will enter into the Tax Receivable Agreement with the Continuing LLC Owners and DDH LLC.
Our corporate structure following the completion of this offering, as described below, is commonly referred to as an umbrella partnership-C-corporation, or Up-C, structure, which is often used by partnerships and limited liability companies when they undertake an initial public offering of their business. The Up-C structure will allow the Continuing LLC Owners to retain their equity ownership in DDH LLC and to continue to realize tax benefits associated with owning interests in an entity that is treated as a partnership, or
 
57

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
“passthrough” entity, for U.S. federal income tax purposes following the completion of the offering. Investors in this offering will, by contrast, hold their equity ownership in Direct Digital Holdings, a Delaware corporation that is a domestic corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes, in the form of shares of Class A common stock. The Continuing LLC Owners will hold LLC Units and, in the case of Continuing LLC Owners who do not exchange their LLC Units for shares of our Class A common stock in connection with the completion of this offering, an equal number of shares of Class B common stock in Direct Digital Holdings. One of the tax benefits to the Continuing LLC Owners associated with this structure is that future taxable income of DDH LLC that is allocated to the Continuing LLC Owners will be taxed on a pass-through basis and therefore will not be subject to corporate taxes at the entity level. Additionally, the Continuing LLC Owners may, from time to time, redeem or exchange their LLC Units for newly issued shares of our Class A common stock on a one-for-one basis. The Up-C structure also provides the Continuing LLC Owners with potential liquidity that holders of non-publicly traded limited liability companies are not typically afforded. If we generate sufficient taxable income, Direct Digital Holdings expects to benefit from the Up-C structure because, in general, we expect cash tax savings in amounts equal to 15% of the Tax Attributes, as described above, arising from such redemptions or exchanges of the Continuing Owners’ LLC Units for Class A Common Stock and certain other tax benefits covered by the Tax Receivable Agreement discussed in the section titled “Certain Relationships and Related Person Transactions — Tax Receivable Agreement.” See the section titled “Risk Factors — Risks Related to Our Organizational Structure” for more information.
Immediately following the completion of this offering and the application of net proceeds therefrom, Direct Digital Holdings will be a holding company and our principal asset will be the LLC Units we purchase from DDH LLC. As a result, Direct Digital Holdings will have no independent means of generating revenue. As the sole managing member of DDH LLC, Direct Digital Holdings will operate and control all of the business and affairs of DDH LLC and, through DDH LLC and its subsidiaries, conduct our business. Accordingly, we will have the sole voting interest in, and control the management of, DDH LLC. As a result, Direct Digital Holdings will consolidate DDH LLC in our consolidated financial statements and will report a non-controlling interest related to the LLC Units held by the Continuing LLC Owners on our consolidated financial statements. Direct Digital Holdings will have a board of directors and executive officers and employees.
DDH LLC will be treated as a partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes and, as such, will generally not be subject to U.S. federal income tax. Instead, taxable income will be allocated to holders of LLC Units, including Direct Digital Holdings. Accordingly, Direct Digital Holdings will incur income taxes on its allocable share of any net taxable income of DDH LLC. Pursuant to the DDH LLC Agreement, DDH LLC will make cash distributions to the owners of LLC Units in an amount sufficient to fund their tax obligations in respect of the cumulative taxable income in excess of cumulative taxable losses of DDH LLC that is allocated to them, to the extent previous distributions from DDH LLC have been insufficient. In addition to tax expenses, Direct Digital Holdings also will incur expenses related to its operations, plus payments under the Tax Receivable Agreement, which Direct Digital Holdings expects will be significant. Direct Digital Holdings intends to cause DDH LLC to make distributions or, in the case of certain expenses, payments in an amount sufficient to allow Direct Digital Holdings to pay its taxes and operating expenses, including distributions to fund any ordinary course payments due under the Tax Receivable Agreement.
As the sole managing member of DDH LLC, Direct Digital Holdings will have the right to determine when distributions will be made to the holders of LLC Units in DDH LLC and the amount of any such distributions (subject to the requirements with respect to the tax distributions described above). If Direct Digital Holdings authorizes a distribution, such distribution will be made to the holders of LLC Units, including Direct Digital Holdings, generally pro rata in accordance with their respective ownership of DDH LLC, provided that Direct Digital Holdings as sole managing member will be entitled to non-pro rata distributions for certain fees and expenses.
As noted above, the Continuing LLC Owners will also hold a number of shares of our Class B common stock equal to the number of LLC Units held by such person. Although these shares have no economic rights, they will allow such Continuing LLC Owners to directly exercise voting power at Direct Digital Holdings, the sole managing member of DDH LLC. Under Direct Digital Holdings’ amended and restated certificate of incorporation, each share of Class B common stock will be entitled to one vote per share.
 
58

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
The DDH LLC Agreement will provide that as a general matter a Continuing LLC Owner will not have the right to exchange LLC Units if Direct Digital Holdings determines that such exchange would be prohibited by law or regulation or would violate other agreements with us to which the Continuing LLC Owner may be subject, including the DDH LLC Agreement. Additionally, the DDH LLC Agreement contains restrictions on redemptions and exchanges intended to prevent DDH LLC from being treated as a “publicly traded partnership” for U.S. federal income tax purposes. These restrictions are modeled on certain safe harbors provided for under applicable U.S. federal income tax law. Direct Digital Holdings may impose additional restrictions on exchange that Direct Digital Holdings determines to be necessary or advisable so that DDH LLC is not treated as a “publicly traded partnership” for U.S. federal income tax purposes. As a holder redeems or exchanges LLC Units, the number of LLC Units held by Direct Digital Holdings is correspondingly increased, and if the redeeming or exchanging Continuing LLC Owner holds Class B common stock, a corresponding number of such shares of Class B common stock are cancelled. See the section titled “Certain Relationships and Related Person Transactions — DDH LLC Agreement” for more information. Subject to the foregoing, the Continuing LLC Owners of DDH LLC, from time to time following the completion of this offering, may, subject to the terms of the DDH LLC Agreement, exchange their LLC Units for common stock on a one-to-one basis in accordance with the terms of the DDH LLC Agreement, and a corresponding number of such shares of Class B common stock will be cancelled; provided that, at Direct Digital Holdings’ election, Direct Digital Holdings may effect a direct exchange of such Class A common stock.
Following This Offering
The Continuing LLC Owners of DDH LLC, from time to time following the completion of this offering, may, subject to the terms of the DDH LLC Agreement, exchange their LLC Units for common stock on a one-to-one basis in accordance with the terms of the DDH LLC Agreement, and a corresponding number of such shares of Class B common stock will be cancelled; provided that, at Direct Digital Holdings’ election, Direct Digital Holdings may effect a direct exchange of such Class A common stock. Any shares of Class B common stock will be cancelled on a one-for-one basis if we, at the election of the Continuing LLC Owners, redeem or exchange such LLC Units pursuant to the terms of the DDH LLC Agreement. These exchanges and redemptions are expected to result in increases in the tax basis of the assets of DDH LLC that otherwise would not have been available. Increases in tax basis resulting from such exchanges may reduce the amount of tax that Direct Digital Holdings would otherwise be required to pay in the future. This tax basis may also decrease the gains (or increase the losses) on future dispositions of certain assets to the extent tax basis is allocated to those assets.
Direct Digital Holdings will enter into a Tax Receivable Agreement with DDH LLC and each of the Continuing LLC Owners that will provide for the payment by Direct Digital Holdings of 85% of the amount of the calculated tax savings, if any, that Direct Digital Holdings realizes, or in some circumstances is deemed to realize, as a result of this existing and increased tax basis and certain other tax benefits related to it entering into the Tax Receivable Agreement, including tax benefits attributable to payments under the Tax Receivable Agreement. These payment obligations are obligations of Direct Digital Holdings and not of DDH LLC. See the section titled “Certain Relationships and Related Person Transactions — Tax Receivable Agreement” for additional information.
Direct Digital Holdings may accumulate cash balances in future years resulting from distributions from DDH LLC exceeding its tax or other liabilities. To the extent Direct Digital Holdings does not use such cash balances to pay a dividend on or repurchase shares of Class A common stock and instead decides to hold or recontribute such cash balances to DDH LLC for use in its operations, Continuing LLC Owners who exchange LLC Units and, if applicable, shares of Class B common stock for shares of Class A common stock in the future could also benefit from any value attributable to such accumulated cash balances.
See the section titled “Description of Capital Stock” for more information about our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and the terms of the Class A common stock and Class B common stock. See the section titled “Certain Relationships and Related Person Transactions” for more information about (i) the DDH LLC Agreement, including the terms of the LLC Units and the exchange and redemption right of the Continuing LLC Owners; and (ii) the Tax Receivable Agreement. See the section titled
 
59

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Liquidity and Capital Resources — Tax Receivable Agreement” for more information about expected payments under the Tax Receivable Agreement.
The diagram below depicts our organizational structure after giving effect to the Organizational Transactions, including this offering, assuming no exercise by the underwriters of their option to purchase additional shares of Class A common stock:
[MISSING IMAGE: TM2125950D10-FC_DIRECT4C.JPG]
 
60

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
CAPITALIZATION
The table below shows our cash and cash equivalents and capitalization as of September 30, 2021:

of DDH LLC on an actual basis;

of Direct Digital Holdings on a pro forma basis to give effect to the Organizational Transactions, excluding the effects of this offering; and

of Direct Digital Holdings on a pro forma as adjusted basis to give effect to the Organizational Transactions, including the sale of 4,000,000 shares by us in this offering at an assumed price to the public of $8.00 per share, which is the midpoint of the price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, resulting in net proceeds to us of approximately $13.0 million after deducting underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated offering expenses payable by us, and after giving effect to DDH LLC’s redemption of all of USDM’s outstanding LLC units for approximately $14.0 million.
The pro forma and pro forma as adjusted information below is illustrative only, and our capitalization following the closing of this offering will depend on the actual initial public offering price and other terms of this offering determined at pricing. You should read the following information together with the information contained under the heading “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and “Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Financial Information” and with our consolidated financial statements and the accompanying notes appearing elsewhere in this prospectus.
As of September 30, 2021
Actual
(unaudited)
Pro Forma for the
Organizational
Transactions
and
the offering
(unaudited)(1)
Cash and cash equivalents
$ 2,603,152 $ 15,589,432
Long-term debt
19,844,462 13,388,900
Members’/stockholders’ (deficit) equity:
Members’ (deficit) equity attributable to Direct Digital Holdings, LLC
(2,226,945) (2,817,634)
Units, 1,000,000 units authorized; 34,182 issued and outstanding
4,294,241
Class A common stock, $0.001 par value per share; no shares authorized, issued and outstanding, actual; and 160,000,000 shares authorized, 4,000,000 shares issued and outstanding, pro forma as adjusted
4,000
Class B common stock, $0.001 par value per share; no shares authorized, issued and outstanding, actual; and 20,000,000 shares authorized, 11,378,000 shares issued and outstanding, pro forma as
adjusted
11,378
Additional paid-in capital
24,311,394
Total members’/stockholders’ equity
2,067,296 21,509,138
Total capitalization
$ 21,911,758 $ 34,898,038
(1)
If the underwriters’ option to purchase up to an additional 600,000 shares of our Class A common stock is exercised in full, (i) an additional 600,000 shares of Class A common stock would be issued and we would receive approximately $4.5 million in additional net proceeds, based on the assumed initial public offering price per share of $8.00, which is the midpoint of the price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, after deducting estimated underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated offering expenses payable by us; and (ii) cash and cash equivalents, total stockholders’ equity and total capitalization would each also increase by approximately $4.5 million.
Each $1.00 increase (decrease) in the assumed initial public offering price per share of $8.00, which is the midpoint of the price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, assuming no change in the
 
61

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
number of shares to be sold, would increase (decrease) the net proceeds that we receive in this offering and each of total stockholders’ equity and total capitalization by approximately $3.7 million (or $4.3 million if the underwriters exercise the over-allotment option in full), after deducting underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated offering expenses payable by us. Similarly, an increase (decrease) of 1,000,000 shares of our Class A common stock offered by us in this offering, assuming no change in the offering price, would increase (decrease) the new proceeds that we receive in this offering and each of total stockholders’ equity and total capitalization by approximately $7.4 million, after deducting underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated offering expenses payable by us.
The number of our shares of Class A common stock to be outstanding immediately after this offering is based on 0 shares of Class A common stock outstanding as of September 30, 2021 and excludes the following (all of which are calculated based on the assumed initial public offering price per share of $8.00, which is the midpoint of the price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus):

11,378,000 shares of Class A common stock reserved as of the closing date of this offering for future issuance upon redemption or exchange of LLC Units by the Continuing LLC Owners;

1,500,000 shares of Class A common stock reserved for issuance under our 2022 Omnibus Incentive Plan; and

up to 230,000 shares of common stock issuable upon exercise of the representatives’ warrants issued in connection with this offering.
 
62

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DILUTION
The Continuing LLC Owners will maintain their LLC Units in DDH LLC after the Organizational Transactions. Because the Continuing LLC Owners do not own any Class A common stock or have any right to receive distributions from Direct Digital Holdings, we have presented dilution in pro forma net tangible book value per share after this offering assuming the Continuing LLC Owners had their LLC Units redeemed or exchanged for newly issued shares of Class A common stock on a one-for-one basis, and the cancellation for no consideration of all of its shares of Class B common stock (which are not entitled to distributions from Direct Digital Holdings), in order to more meaningfully present the dilutive impact on the investors in this offering. We refer to the assumed redemption or exchange of all LLC Units owned by the Continuing LLC Owners for shares of Class A common stock as described in the previous sentence as the “Assumed Redemption.” We also note that the effect of the Assumed Redemption is to increase the assumed number of shares of Class A common stock outstanding before the offering, thereby decreasing the pro forma net tangible book value per share before the offering and correspondingly increasing the dilution per share to new Class A common stock investors.
If you invest in our Class A common stock in this offering, your interest will be diluted to the extent of the difference between the initial public offering price per share of Class A common stock and the pro forma as adjusted net tangible book value per share immediately after this offering. Dilution is the amount by which the offering price paid by the purchasers of the Class A common stock in this offering exceeds the pro forma net tangible book value per share of Class A common stock after the offering.
DDH LLC’s pro forma net tangible book value (deficit) as of September 30, 2021 was $(20.5 million), or $(1.80) per share of Class A common stock. Our pro forma net tangible book value (deficit) per share represents the amount of our total tangible assets less our total liabilities, divided by the number of our shares of Class A common stock outstanding as of September 30, 2021 after giving effect to the Organizational Transactions.
After giving effect to the Organizational Transactions, the Assumed Redemption and the sale by us of 4,000,000 shares of Class A common stock in this offering, based on the assumed initial public offering price of $8.00 per share, which is the midpoint of the price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, and after deducting underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated offering expenses payable by us, our pro forma as adjusted net tangible book value (deficit) as of September 30, 2021 would have been $(1.1) million, or $(0.07) per share of Class A common stock. This amount represents an immediate dilution of $8.07 per share to new investors purchasing Class A common stock in this offering. We determine dilution by subtracting (adding) the pro forma as adjusted net tangible book value (deficit) per share after this offering from the initial public offering price per share paid by investors purchasing Class A common stock in this offering. The following table illustrates this dilution on a per share basis:
Assumed initial public offering price per share
$ 8.00
Pro forma net tangible book value (deficit) per share as of September 30, 2021(1)(2)
$ (1.80)
     
Increase (decrease) in pro forma as adjusted net tangible book value (deficit) per share attributable to new investors purchasing shares in this offering
$ 1.73
Pro forma as adjusted net tangible book value (deficit) per share after giving effect to this offering
$ (0.07)
Dilution per share to new investors in this offering
$ 8.07
(1)
The computation of pro forma net tangible book value (deficit) per share as of September 30, 2021 before this offering and after the Assumed Redemption is set forth below:
 
63

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
Numerator:
Book value of tangible assets
$7.3 million
Less: total liabilities
(27.8) million
Pro forma net tangible book value (deficit)(a)
$(20.5) million
Denominator:
Shares of Class A common stock outstanding immediately prior to this offering and after the Assumed Redemption
11,378,000
Pro forma net tangible book value (deficit) per share
$(1.80)
(a)
Gives pro forma effect to the Organizational Transactions (other than this offering) and the Assumed Redemption.
(2)
The computation of pro forma net tangible book value (deficit) per share as of September 30, 2021 after this offering and after the Assumed Redemption is set forth below:
Numerator:
Book value of tangible assets
$20.3 million
Less: total liabilities
(21.4) million
Pro forma net tangible book value (deficit)
$(1.1) million
Denominator:
Shares of Class A common stock outstanding immediately after this offering and after the Assumed Redemption
15,378,000
Pro forma net tangible book value (deficit) per share
$(0.07)
If the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional shares of our Class A common stock from us in full, our pro forma as adjusted net tangible book value would be $0.21 per share, and the dilution in pro forma net tangible book value per share to new investors in this offering would be $7.79 per share.
The following table summarizes, as of September 30, 2021 after giving effect to this offering, the Organizational Transactions and the differences between the Continuing LLC Owners and new investors in this offering with regard to:

the number of shares of Class A common stock purchased from us by investors in this offering and the number of shares issued to the Continuing LLC Owners after giving effect to the Assumed Redemption,

the total consideration paid to us in cash by investors purchasing shares of Class A common stock in this offering and by the Continuing LLC Owners, and

the average price per share of Class A common stock that such Continuing LLC Owners and new investors paid.

The table below is based on an assumed initial public offering price of $8.00 per share, which is the midpoint of the price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, before deducting the underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated offering expenses payable by us.
Shares of Class A
Common Stock
Purchased
Total Consideration
Average Price
Per Share
Number
Percent
Amount
Percent
Continuing LLC Owners
% $ $
New investors in this offering
4,000,000 100 32,000,000 100 8.00
Total
4,000,000 100% $ 32,000,000 100% $ 8.00
 
64

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
Except as otherwise indicated, the discussion and the tables above assume no exercise of the underwriters’ option to purchase additional shares of Class A common stock. The number of our shares of Class A common stock to be outstanding immediately after this offering is based on 0 shares of our Class A common stock outstanding as of September 30, 2021, and excludes the following (all of which are calculated based on the assumed initial public offering price per share of $8.00, which is the midpoint of the price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus):

11,378,000 shares of Class A common stock reserved as of the closing date of this offering for future issuance upon redemption or exchange of LLC Units by the Continuing LLC Owners;

1,500,000 shares of Class A common stock reserved for issuance under our 2022 Omnibus Incentive Plan; and

up to 230,000 shares of common stock issuable upon exercise of the representatives’ warrants issued in connection with this offering.
Notwithstanding the foregoing, to the extent there is an increase in the initial public offering price, the number of shares of Class A common stock outstanding and shares of Class A common stock issuable upon redemption of LLC Units would decrease from the amounts noted herein; to the extent there is a decrease in the public offering price, the number of shares of Class A common stock outstanding and shares of Class A common stock issuable upon redemption of LLC Units would increase. A $1.00 increase (decrease) in the assumed initial public offering price of $8.00 per share, the midpoint of the price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, would result in a net decrease (increase) of approximately 444,444 (571,429) in the aggregate number of shares of Class A common stock outstanding (excluding shares issuable if the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional shares of our Class A common stock from us). The relative magnitude of the change in shares of Class A common stock outstanding and shares of Class A common stock issuable upon redemption of LLC Units decreases as the per share price moves further away from the midpoint.
To the extent that options or other securities are issued under our equity incentive plans, or we issue additional shares of our Class A common stock or securities convertible into Class A common stock in the future, there will be further dilution to investors participating in this offering. In addition, we may choose to raise additional capital because of market conditions or strategic considerations, even if we believe that we have sufficient funds for our current or future operating plans. If we raise additional capital through the sale of equity or convertible securities, the issuance of these securities could result in further dilution to our stockholders.
 
65

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
UNAUDITED PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL INFORMATION
The unaudited pro forma consolidated balance sheet as of September 30, 2021 and December 31, 2020 and the unaudited pro forma consolidated statements of operations for the nine months ended September 30, 2020 and the year ended December 31, 2020 present our consolidated financial position and results of operations after giving pro forma effect to:
(1)
the acquisition of Orange142, as if such transaction had occurred on January 1, 2021 for the unaudited pro forma consolidated statement of operations for the nine months ended September 30, 2020;
(2)
the acquisition of Orange142, as if such transaction had occurred on January 1, 2020 for the unaudited pro forma consolidated statement of operations for the year ended December 31, 2020;
(3)
the Organizational Transactions described under the section titled “Organizational Transactions,” as if such transactions occurred on September 30, 2021 for the unaudited pro forma consolidated balance sheet as of September 30, 2021 and on January 1, 2021 for the unaudited pro forma consolidated statement of operations for the nine months ended September 30, 2020; and
(4)
the Organizational Transactions described under the section titled “Organizational Transactions,” as if such transactions occurred on December 31, 2020 for the unaudited pro forma consolidated balance sheet as of December 31, 2020 and on January 1, 2020 for the unaudited pro forma consolidated statement of operations for the year ended December 31, 2020.
Our historical consolidated financial information has been derived from the consolidated audited and unaudited financial statements of DDH LLC and its subsidiaries and accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this prospectus. Direct Digital Holdings was incorporated on August 23, 2021 and will have no material assets or results of operations until the completion of this offering. Therefore, its historical financial information is not included in the unaudited pro forma consolidated financial information.
The unaudited pro forma consolidated financial information has been prepared on the basis that we will be taxed as a corporation for U.S. federal and state income tax purposes and, accordingly, will become a taxpaying entity subject to U.S. federal, state and foreign income taxes. The unaudited pro forma consolidated financial information was prepared in accordance with Article 11 of SEC Regulation S-X. See the accompanying notes to the Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Financial Information for a discussion of assumptions made.
The unaudited pro forma consolidated financial information is not necessarily indicative of financial results that would have been attained had the described transactions occurred on the dates indicated above or that could be achieved in the future. The unaudited pro forma consolidated financial information also does not give effect to the potential impact of any anticipated synergies, operating efficiencies or cost savings that may result from the transactions or any integration costs that result from the Organizational Transactions or any costs that do not have a continuing impact. Future results may vary significantly from the results reflected in the unaudited pro forma consolidated statements of operations and should not be relied on as an indication of our results after the consummation of this offering and the other transactions contemplated by such unaudited pro forma consolidated financial information. However, our management believes that the assumptions provide a reasonable basis for presenting the significant effects of the transactions as contemplated and that the pro forma adjustments give appropriate effect to those assumptions and are properly applied in the unaudited pro forma consolidated financial information.
As a public company, we will be implementing additional procedures and processes for the purpose of addressing the standards and requirements applicable to public companies. We expect to incur additional annual expenses related to these steps and, among other things, additional directors’ and officers’ liability insurance, director fees, costs to comply with the reporting requirements of the SEC, transfer agent fees, hiring of additional accounting, legal and administrative personnel, increased auditing and legal fees and similar expenses. We have not included any pro forma adjustments relating to these costs.
As described in greater detail under the section titled “Certain Relationships and Related Person Transactions — Tax Receivable Agreement,” in connection with the consummation of this offering, we will
 
66

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
enter into the Tax Receivable Agreement with DDH LLC and the Continuing LLC Owners that will provide for the payment by Direct Digital Holdings to such Continuing LLC Owners of 85% of the amount of tax benefits, if any, that Direct Digital Holdings actually realized, or in certain circumstances is deemed to realize (calculated using certain assumptions) as a result of (i) increases in the tax basis of assets of DDH LLC resulting from (a) any future redemptions or exchanges of LLC Units described above under “— The Offering — Class B common stock exchange rights,” and (b) payments under the Tax Receivable Agreement and (ii) certain other tax benefits arising from payments under the Tax Receivable Agreement. Actual tax benefits realized by Direct Digital Holdings may differ from tax benefits calculated under the Tax Receivable Agreement as a result of the use of certain assumptions in the Tax Receivable Agreement, including the use of an assumed weighted-average state and local income tax rate to calculate tax benefits. This payment obligation is an obligation of Direct Digital Holdings but not of DDH LLC. See the section titled “Certain Relationships and Related Person Transactions — Tax Receivable Agreement.”
If we ever generate sufficient taxable income to utilize the tax benefits from the Organizational Transactions, we expect to benefit from the remaining 15% of cash savings, if any, that we realize. We do not expect to record a liability under the Tax Receivable Agreement as a result of the Organizational Transactions and the purchase of newly issued LLC Units from DDH LLC with a portion of the net proceeds from this offering. This is because the purchase of the LLC Units will not result in a taxable transaction, and we currently expect to record a full valuation allowance against the deferred tax asset created through the purchase of the LLC Units. Due to the uncertainty in the amount and timing of future redemptions or exchanges of LLC Units by the Continuing LLC Owners and purchases of LLC Units from the Continuing LLC Owners, the unaudited pro forma consolidated financial information assumes that no future redemptions or exchanges or purchases of LLC Units have occurred and therefore no increases in tax basis in the DDH LLC assets or other tax benefits that may be realized thereunder have been assumed in the unaudited pro forma consolidated financial information. However, if the Continuing LLC Owners were to redeem or exchange or sell us all of their LLC Units, we would recognize a deferred tax asset of approximately $35.6 million and a liability under the Tax Receivable Agreement of approximately $30.3 million, assuming: (i) all exchanges or purchases occurred on the same day; (ii) a price of $8.00 per share of Class A common stock (the midpoint of the price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus); (iii) a constant corporate tax rate of 21%; (iv) that we will have sufficient taxable income to utilize the tax benefits of our estimated deferred tax asset and (v) no material changes in tax law. For each 5% increase (decrease) in the amount of LLC Units exchanged by or purchased from the Continuing LLC Unitholders (or their transferees of LLC Units or other assignees), our deferred tax asset would increase (decrease) by approximately $(1.8) million and the related liability would increase (decrease) by approximately $(1.5) million, assuming that the price per share of Class A common stock and corporate tax rate remain the same.
For each $1.00 increase (decrease) in the assumed initial public offering price of $8.00 per share of Class A common stock, our deferred tax asset would increase (decrease) by approximately $5.3 million and the related liability would increase (decrease) by approximately $4.5 million, assuming that the number of LLC Units exchanged by or purchased from the Continuing LLC Unitholders (or their transferees of LLC Units and other assignees) and the corporate tax rate remain the same. These amounts are estimates and have been prepared for illustrative purposes only. The actual amount of deferred tax assets and liabilities under the Tax Receivable Agreement that we will recognize will differ based on, among other things, the timing of the exchanges and purchases, the price of our shares of Class A common stock at the time of the exchange or purchase, our ability to utilize the tax benefits from the Organizational Transactions, and the tax rates then in effect. The unaudited pro forma consolidated financial information should be read together with the sections titled “Risk Factors,” “Organizational Transactions,” “Capitalization,” “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and the audited consolidated financial statements of DDH LLC and related notes thereto as well as the interim unaudited consolidated financial statements of DDH LLC and related notes thereto included elsewhere in this prospectus.
Effective September 30, 2020, we acquired 100% of the equity interests of Orange142 valued at $26.2 million to further bolster the overall buy-side advertising platform and enhance our offerings across multiple industry verticals such as travel, healthcare, education, financial services, consumer products, etc. with particular emphasis on small- and mid-sized businesses transitioning into digital with growing digital media budgets. The total purchase price of $26.2 million was funded by a combination of cash, issuance of member common units, mandatorily redeemable preferred units, a facility term note and a revolving credit
 
67

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
facility (see Notes 3, 5 and 6 to the consolidated financial statements). The acquisition was accounted for using the acquisition method of accounting and, accordingly, the consolidated statements of operations includes the results of operations of Orange142 beginning September 30, 2020.
The acquisition of Orange142 was recorded by allocating the total purchase consideration to the fair value of the net tangible assets acquired, including goodwill and intangible assets in accordance with FASB Accounting Codification Standard (“ASC”) 805, Business Combinations (“ASC 805”). The purchase consideration exceeded the fair value of the net assets resulting in goodwill of $4.1 million and intangible assets of $18.0 million. Intangible assets consist of $13.0 million of 10-year amortizable customer relationships, $3.5 million of 10-year amortizable trademarks and tradenames, and $1.5 million of 5-year amortizable non-compete agreements. We record the amortization expense on a straight-line basis over the life of the identifiable intangible assets.
The tables below present our historical results of operations of DDH LLC, the historical results of operations of Orange142, the Orange142 acquisition and Organizational Transactions pro forma adjustments assuming the Orange142 acquisition and Organizational Transactions occurred on the dates indicated above:
 
68

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
September 30, 2020
December 31, 2020
Direct Digital
Holdings, LLC
(unaudited)
Orange142, LLC
(unaudited)
Pro forma
adjustments for
the Orange142
acquisition
(unaudited)
Notes
Pro Forma, as
adjusted, for the
Orange142
acquisition and
Organizational
Transactions
(unaudited)
Direct Digital
Holdings, LLC
Orange142, LLC
Pro forma
adjustments for
the Orange142
acquisition
(unaudited)
Notes
Pro Forma, as
adjusted, for the
Orange142
acquisition and
Organizational
Transactions
(unaudited)
Revenues
Buy-side advertising
$ 4,377,708 $ 17,938,081 $
$22,315,789
$ 9,656,165 $ 17,938,081 $ $ 27,594,246
Sell-side advertising
1,498,300
1,498,300
2,821,354 2,821,354
Total revenues
5,876,008 17,938,081
23,814,089
12,477,519 17,938,081 30,415,600
Cost of revenues
Buy-side advertising
2,836,035 5,267,463
8,103,498
4,864,234 5,267,463 10,131,697
Sell-side advertising
1,350,083
1,350,083
2,440,975 2,440,975
Total cost of revenues
4,186,118 5,267,463
9,453,581
7,305,209 5,267,463 12,572,672
Gross profit
1,689,890 12,670,618
14,360,508
5,172,310 12,670,618 17,842,928
Operating expenses
Compensation, taxes and benefits
1,324,196 4,038,610 (277,584) (1)
5,085,222
3,334,060 4,038,610 (277,584) (1) 7,095,086
General and administrative
600,543 757,540 2,185,364 (2),(3)
3,543,447
1,848,407 757,540 2,185,364 (2),(3) 4,791,311
Acquisition transaction
costs
650,000 (650,000) (4)
834,407 (834,407) (4)
Total operating expenses
2,574,739 4,796,150 1,257,780
8,628,669
6,016,874 4,796,150 1,073,373 11,886,397
(Loss) income from operations
(884,849) 7,874,468 (1,257,780)
5,731,839
(844,564) 7,874,468 (1,073,373) 5,956,531
Other income (expense)
Other income
134,761 11,900
146,661
134,776 11,900 146,676
Forgiveness of Paycheck Protection Program loan
277,100 277,100
Gain from revaluation and settlement of seller notes and earnout
liability
401,677
401,677
401,677 401,677
Loss on redemption of preferred units
(590,689)
(590,689)
Interest expense
(19,925) (2,209,178) (5)
(2,229,103)
(865,055) (2,071,951) (5) (2,937,006)
Total other income (expense)
516,513 11,900 (2,209,178)
(2,271,454)
(51,502) 11,900 (2,071,951) (2,702,242)
Tax expense
(12,154) (48,971) (6)
(61,125)
(12,124) (48,971) (6) (61,095)
Net (loss) income
$ (380,490) $ 7,837,397 $ (3,466,958)
$3,399,260
$ (908,190) $ 7,837,397 $ (3,145,324) $ 3,193,194
 
69

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
(1)
Represents the salaries paid to Mark Walker and Keith Smith that were reversed due to their consulting agreements entered into upon the acquisition. The amount paid to Messrs. Walker and Smith during the year ended December 31, 2020 for the period of January 1, 2020 through the acquisition date of September 30, 2020 was $277,584.
(2)
Represents the consulting agreements entered into upon the acquisition of Orange142 for Messrs. Walker and Smith and Leah Woolford. Mr. Walker serves as Chairman of the board of directors and Chief Executive Officer of the Company. Mr. Smith serves as manager of the board of DDH LLC and President of the Company. Ms. Woolford serves as manager of the board of, and Senior Advisor to, DDH LLC. In exchange, we pay Messrs. Walker and Smith annual fees of $450,000 each and employee benefits for their direct families. We pay Ms. Woolford $300 per hour for up to 50 hours per month and employee benefits for Ms. Woolford and her direct family. We paid Messrs. Walker and Smith and Ms. Woolford a total of $360,000 from September 30, 2020 through December 31, 2020, and the pro forma adjustment of $720,000 represents the consulting expense for the period of January 1, 2020 through September 30, 2020.
(3)
General and administrative expenses were increased $1,465,364 to record the amortization expense associated with the identifiable intangible assets acquired in the acquisition for the period of January 1, 2020 through September 30, 2020.
(4)
Represents acquisition transaction costs related to referral and legal fees that were reversed for the nine months ended September 30, 2020 and the year ended December 31, 2020.
(5)
In connection with the acquisition, we entered into a loan and security agreement that provides for a term loan in the principal amount of $12.825 million, which bears a fixed interest rate of 16% (see additional information under “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Liquidity and Capital Resources” below). We also issued mandatorily redeemable 10% preferred A units and 7% preferred B units, which are classified as liabilities in the consolidated balance sheets, and as such, the associated dividend payments are recorded as interest expense. Pro forma interest expense represents the adjustment to reflect the additional interest incurred under the term loan and preferred units.
(6)
Includes the effects of the tax receivable agreement to be entered into after this offering by and among the Company, DDH LLC and the Continuing LLC Owners. See the section titled “Certain Relationships and Related Person Transactions — Tax Receivable Agreement” for additional information.
 
70

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
As of September 30, 2021
As of December 31, 2020
Actual
(unaudited)
Notes
Pro forma
for the
Organizational
Transactions
(unaudited)
Actual
Notes
Pro forma
for the
Organizational
Transactions
(unaudited)
ASSETS
CURRENT ASSETS
Cash and cash equivalents
$ 2,603,152
   
$ 15,589,432 $ 1,611,998
   
$ 14,598,278
Accounts receivable, net
3,903,809 3,903,809 4,679,376 4,679,376
Prepaid expenses and other current assets
727,075 727,075 223,344      223,344
Total current assets
7,234,036 20,220,316 6,514,718 19,500,998
Goodwill
6,519,636 6,519,636 6,519,636 6,519,636
Intangible assets, net
16,080,032 16,080,032 17,545,396 17,545,396
Deferred financing costs, net
51,775 51,775 90,607 90,607
Other long-term assets
12,948 12,948 25,118 25,118
Total assets
$ 29,898,427 $ 42,884,707 $ 30,695,475 $ 43,681,755
LIABILITIES AND MEMBERS’/STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY
CURRENT LIABILITIES
Accounts payable
$ 3,110,281 $ 3,110,281 $ 3,263,326 $ 3,263,326
Accrued liabilities
1,510,563 1,510,563 1,392,520 1,392,520
Notes payable, current portion
2,611,685 2,611,685 1,206,750 1,206,750
Deferred revenues
684,303 684,303 308,682 608,682
Related party payables
69,837 69,837 70,801 70,801
Seller notes payable
315,509 315,509
Seller earnout payable
74,909 74,909
Total current liabilities
7,986,669 7,986,669 6,632,497 6,932,497
Notes payable, net of short-term portion and $286,741 and $501,796 of
deferred financing cost as of September 30, 2021 and December 31, 2020,
respectively
9,086,328 9,086,328 11,213,697 11,213,697
Mandatorily redeemable non-participating preferred units
9,913,940 3,458,378 9,913,940 3,458,378
Line of credit
407,051 407,051 407,051 407,051
Paycheck Protection Program loan
287,143 287,143 10,000 10,000
Economic Injury Disaster Loan
150,000 150,000 150,000 150,000
Total liabilities
27,831,131 21,375,569 28,327,185 22,171,623
MEMBERS’/STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY
Units, 1,000,000 units authorized as of September 30, 2021 and December 31, 2020; 34,182 units issued and outstanding as of September 30, 2021 and December 31, 2020
4,294,241 4,294,241
Class A common stock, par value $0.001 per share; no shares authorized, issued and outstanding, as of September 30, 2021 and December 31, 2020; 160,000,000 shares authorized, 4,000,000 shares issued and outstanding as of September 30, 2021 and December 31, 2020, pro forma
4,000 4,000
Class B common stock, par value $0.001 per share; no shares authorized,
issued and outstanding, as of September 30, 2021 and December 31,
2020; 20,000,000 shares authorized, 11,378,000 shares issued and
outstanding as of September 30, 2021 and December 31, 2020, pro forma
11,378 11,378
Additional paid-in-capital
24,311,394 24,311,394 24,311,394
Accumulated deficit
(2,226,945) (2,817,634) (1,925,951) (2,516,640)
Total members’/stockholders’ equity
2,067,296 21,509,138 2,368,290 21,810,132
Total liabilities and members’/stockholders’ equity
$ 29,898,427 $ 42,884,707 $ 30,695,475 $ 43,981,755
 
71

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
The following discussion and analysis of our financial condition and results of operations should be read in conjunction with the information included under “Business” and our consolidated financial statements and the accompanying notes included elsewhere in this prospectus. The discussion and analysis below are based on comparisons between our historical financial data for different periods and include certain forward-looking statements about our business, operations and financial performance. These forward-looking statements are subject to risks, uncertainties, assumptions and other factors described in “Risk Factors.” Our actual results may differ materially from those expressed in, or implied by, those forward-looking statements. See “Cautionary Note Regarding Forward-Looking Statements.” The following discussion does not give effect to the Organizational Transactions. See the sections titled “Organizational Transactions” and “Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Financial Information” included elsewhere in this prospectus for a description of the Organizational Transactions and their effect on our historical results of operations.
The following discussion contains references to calendar year 2019 and calendar year 2020, as well as to the nine months ended September 30, 2020 and 2019, which represent the consolidated financial results of our predecessor DDH LLC and its subsidiaries for the years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019, and the nine months ended September 30, 2021 and 2020, respectively. Unless we state otherwise or the context otherwise requires, the terms “we,” “us,” “our,” and “Direct Digital” and similar references refer: (1) on or following the consummation of the Organizational Transactions, including this offering, to Direct Digital Holdings, Inc. (“Holdings”) and its consolidated subsidiaries, including DDH LLC, and (2) prior to the consummation of the Organizational Transactions, including this offering, to DDH LLC and its consolidated subsidiaries.
Overview
Direct Digital Holdings, Inc. and its subsidiaries (collectively the “Company,” “DDH,” “we,” “us” and “our”), headquartered in Houston, Texas, is an end-to-end, full-service programmatic advertising platform primarily focused on providing advertising technology, data-driven campaign optimization and other solutions to underserved and less efficient markets on both the buy- and sell-side of the digital advertising ecosystem. DDH is the holding company that will, immediately following this offering, own newly issued common units of Direct Digital Holdings, LLC (“DDH LLC”), which operates the business formed in 2018 through the acquisition of Huddled Masses LLC (“Huddled Masses”) a buy-side marketing platform, and Colossus Media LLC (“Colossus Media”) a sell-side marketing platform. On September 30, 2020, DDH LLC acquired Orange142, LLC (“Orange142”) to further bolster its overall programmatic buy-side advertising platform and enhance its offerings across multiple industry verticals such as travel, healthcare, education, financial services, consumer products, etc. with particular emphasis on small- and mid-sized businesses (which we define as companies with revenue between $5 million and $500 million) transitioning into digital with growing digital media budgets.
The subsidiaries of DDH LLC are as follows:
Subsidiary
Current %
Ownership
Advertising
Solution and
Segment
Date of Formation
Date of Acquisition
Huddled Masses, LLC
100% Buy-side
November 13, 2012
June 21, 2018
Colossus Media, LLC
100% Sell-side
September 8, 2017
June 21, 2018
Orange142, LLC
100% Buy-side March 6, 2013
September 30, 2020
Both buy-side advertising businesses, Huddled Masses and Orange142, offer technology-enabled advertising solutions and consulting services to clients through multiple leading demand side platforms (“DSPs”). Colossus Media is our proprietary sell-side programmatic platform operating under the trademarked banner of Colossus SSP™ (“Colossus SSP”). Colossus SSP is a stand-alone tech-enabled, data- driven sell-side platform (“SSP”) that helps deliver targeted advertising to diverse and multicultural audiences, including African Americans, Latin Americans, Asian Americans and LGBTQ+ customers, as well as other specific audiences.
 
72

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
Providing both the front-end, buy-side advertising businesses coupled with our proprietary sell-side business, enables us to curate the first through the last mile in the ad tech ecosystem execution process to drive higher results.
Operating segments are components of an enterprise for which separate financial information is available and is evaluated regularly by our chief operating decision maker in deciding how to allocate resources and assessing performance. Our chief operating decision maker is our Chairman and Chief Executive Officer. We view our business as two reportable segments, buy-side advertising, which includes the results of Huddled Masses and Orange142, and sell-side advertising, which includes the results of Colossus Media.
Recent Developments
COVID-19 Industry Impact
The onset of the COVID-19 pandemic caused a material reduction in advertising spending across all channels. Advertising spending is estimated to have decreased 30-50% during the height of the lockdown with ad budgets reduced due to economic shock (e.g., lodging, restaurants) and the cancellation of major events (e.g., concerts, Olympics). The linear TV segment was among the hardest hit as small- and medium sized business owners cut back on local broadcast and cable advertising, cable networks couldn’t air live sports and the production of content ground to a halt. Cord cutting, the practice of ending a cable or satellite television service, is also expected to remain elevated. Research conducted by The Trade Desk estimated that approximately 27% of U.S. households would end their cable TV subscription by the end of 2021, roughly nine times the rate of cord cutting over the last few years. The connected television (“CTV”) and advertisement-based video on demand (“AVOD”) channels, which include televisions with integrated internet and ad-based streaming services, held up the best during the pandemic, but these channels remain less than 3% of total TV advertising spend. Overall, the industry is seeing an accelerated shift of advertisement spending from the traditional linear television channel to digital channels such as CTV and AVOD.
Direct Digital Holdings was incorporated in August 2021 for the purpose of this offering and has engaged to date only in activities in contemplation of this offering. Direct Digital Holdings will be a holding company and its sole material asset will be a controlling ownership interest in DDH LLC. For more information regarding our reorganization and holding company structure, see the section titled “Organizational Transactions.” Upon completion of this offering, all of our business will be conducted through DDH LLC and its consolidated subsidiaries. DDH LLC has been treated as a pass-through entity for U.S. federal and state income tax purposes and accordingly has not been subject to U.S. federal or state income tax. After consummation of this offering, DDH LLC will continue to be treated as a pass-through entity for U.S. federal and state income tax purposes. As a result of its ownership of LLC Units in DDH LLC, Direct Digital Holdings will become subject to U.S. federal, state and local income taxes with respect to its allocable share of any taxable income of DDH LLC and will be taxed at the prevailing corporate tax rates. In addition to tax expenses, we also will incur expenses related to our operations, and we will be required to make payments under the Tax Receivable Agreement with certain of the Continuing LLC Owners and DDH LLC. Due to the uncertainty of various factors, we cannot estimate the likely tax benefits we will realize as a result of LLC Units exchanges, and the resulting amounts we are likely to pay out to Continuing LLC Owners pursuant to the Tax Receivable Agreement; however, we estimate that such payments may be substantial in the event we are profitable. See the section titled “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Liquidity and Capital Resources — Tax Receivable Agreement” for more information about expected payments under the Tax Receivable Agreement.
Key Factors Affecting Our Performance
We believe our growth and financial performance are dependent on many factors, including those described below.
Buy-side advertising business
New Customer Acquisitions
On the buy-side of our business, our customers consist of purchasers of programmatic advertising inventory. We had approximately 150 direct customers with approximately 4,000 different campaigns during
 
73

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
the year ended December 31, 2020, and we had approximately 158 direct customers with approximately 1,824 different campaigns during the nine months ended September 30, 2021, consisting of advertising buyers, including small- and mid-sized companies, large advertising holding companies (which may manage several agencies), independent advertising agencies and mid-market advertising service organizations. We serve a variety of customers across multiple industries including travel/tourism (including destination marketing organizations (“DMOs”)), energy, consumer packaged goods, healthcare, education, financial services (including cryptocurrency technologies) and other industries.
We are focused on increasing the number of customers that use our buy-side advertising businesses for their advertising partner. Our long-term growth and results of operations will depend on our ability to attract more customers, including DMOs, across multiple geographies.
Expand Sales to Existing Customers
Our customers understand the independent nature of our platform and our relentless focus on driving results based on return on investment (“ROI”). Our value proposition is complete alignment across our entire digital supply platform beginning with the first dollar in and last dollar out. We are technology, DSP and media agnostic, and our clients trust us to provide the best opportunity for success of their brands and businesses. As a result, our clients have been loyal, with over 90% client retention from the fiscal year ended 2019 to the fiscal year ended 2020 among the clients that represent approximately 80% of our revenue. Our revenue from the top two largest customers accounted for approximately 41% and 25% of our total revenues in the fiscal years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively, and for approximately 33% and 51% of our total revenues in the nine months ended September 30, 2021 and 2020, respectively. Our revenue from our top ten largest customers accounted for approximately 59% and 75% of our total revenues in the fiscal years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively, and for approximately 69% and 92% of our total revenues in the nine months ended September 30, 2021 and 2020, respectively.
In addition, we cultivate client relationships through our pipeline of moderate and self-serve clients that conduct campaigns through our platform that eventually grow into managed service clients, which has resulted in their increased use of our platform over time. As our clients expand their usage of our technology platform, they often transition to our managed services delivery model, which in turn drives increased client loyalty. The managed services delivery model allows us to combine our technology with a highly personalized offering to strategically design and manage advertising campaigns, provide ad hoc support and recommend strategy adjustments as needed.
Shift to Digital Advertising
Media has increasingly become more digital as a result of three key items:

Advances in technology with more sophisticated digital content delivery across multiple platforms;

Changes in consumer behavior, including spending longer portions of the day using mobile and other devices; and

Better audience segmentation with more efficient targeting and measurable results.
The resulting shift has enabled a variety of options for advertisers to efficiently target and measure their advertising campaigns across nearly every media channel and device. These efforts have been led by big- budgeted, large, multi-national corporations incentivized to cast a broad advertising net to support national brands. Based on eMarketer data, 65% of small- and mid-sized companies expect to increase their programmatic advertising budget, and of those companies, 12% expect to increase their advertising budget by over 25%.
Increased Adoption of Digital Advertising by Small-and Mid-Sized Companies
Only recently small- and mid-sized businesses have begun to leverage the power of digital media in meaningful ways, as emerging technologies have enabled advertising across multiple channels in a highly localized nature. Campaign efficiencies yielding measurable results and higher advertising ROI, as well as the needs necessitated by the COVID-19 pandemic, have prompted these companies to begin utilizing digital
 
74

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
advertising on an accelerated pace. We believe this market is rapidly expanding, and that small-to-mid-sized advertisers will continue to increase their digital spend.
Seasonality
In general, the marketing industry experiences seasonal trends that affect the vast majority of participants in the digital marketing ecosystem. Our revenue base is weighted to DMOs and historically, marketing spend is higher in the second and third quarters of our fiscal year with the increase in marketing spend taking place over the summer months. As a result, the fourth and first quarters tend to reflect lower activity levels and lower performance. We generally expect these seasonality trends to continue and our ability to effectively manage our resources in anticipation of these trends may affect our operating results.
Sell-side advertising business
Increasing revenue from publishers and advertising spend from buyers
Colossus Media operates our proprietary sell-side programmatic platform operating under the trademarked banner of Colossus SSP. The buyers on our platform include DSPs, agencies and individual advertisers. We have broad exposure to the ecosystem of buyers, reaching on average approximately 56,025 advertisers per month during the nine months ended September 30, 2021, representing an increase from approximately 15,400 per month in 2020. As spending on programmatic advertising increasingly becomes a larger share of the overall ad spend, advertisers and agencies are seeking greater control of their digital advertising supply chains. To take advantage of this industry shift, we have entered into Supply Path Optimization agreements directly with buyers. As part of these agreements, we are providing advertisers and agencies with benefits ranging from custom data and workflow integrations, product features, volume-based business terms, and visibility into campaign performance data and methodology. As a result of these direct relationships, our existing advertisers and agencies are incentivized to allocate an increasing percentage of their advertising budgets to our platform.
We have broad exposure to the ecosystem of buyers, which has consistently increased since the formation of Colossus Media in September 2017. Our growing sales team seeks to increase our business with the addition of new and existing publishers as well as by increasing our universe of buyers. In addition, establishing multiple header bidding integrations by leveraging our technology capabilities allows us to maximize our access to publishers’ ad formats, devices and various properties that a publisher may own. We may also up-sell additional products to publisher customers including our header bidding management, identity, and audience solutions. Our business strategy on the sell-side advertising business represents growth potential, and we believe we are well positioned to be able to bring underserved multicultural publishers into the advertising ecosystem, thereby increasing our value proposition across all clients, including our large clients.
Monetizing ad impressions for publishers and buyers
We focus on monetizing digital impressions by coordinating daily real-time auctions and bids. The publisher makes its ad inventory available on Colossus SSP and invites advertisers to bid based on the user’s data received. Each time the publisher’s web page loads, an ad request is sent to multiple ad exchanges and, in some cases, to the demand side platform directly from Colossus SSP. In case of real-time bidding (or RTB) media buys, many DSPs would place bids to the impressions being offered by the publisher during the auction. The advertiser that bids a higher amount compared to other advertisers will win the bid and pay   the second highest price for the winning impression to serve the ads. We continuously review our available inventory from existing publishers across every format (mobile, desktop, digital video, over-the-top/connected TV (“OTT/CTV”) and rich media). The factors we consider when determining which impressions we process include transparency, viewability, and whether or not the impression is human sourced. By consistently applying these criteria, we believe the ad impressions we process will be valuable and marketable to advertisers.
Enhancing ad inventory quality
In August 2021, Colossus Media was ranked by MediaMath as 4th among the industry’s approximately 80 supply- side companies in terms of key quality measures such as transparency, fraud detection and
 
75

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
accountability. In the advertising industry, inventory quality is assessed in terms of invalid traffic (“IVT”) which can be impacted by fraud such as “fake eyeballs” generated by automated technologies set up to artificially inflate impression counts. As a result of our platform design and proactive IVT mitigation efforts, during each of the fiscal year ended December 31, 2020 and the nine months ended September 30, 2021, less than 1% of inventory was determined to be invalid, resulting in minimal financial impact to our customers. We address IVT on a number of fronts, including sophisticated technology, which detects and avoids invalid traffic on the front end; direct publisher and inventory relationships, for supply path optimization; and ongoing campaign and inventory performance review, to ensure inventory quality and brand protection controls are in place.
Growing access to valuable ad impressions
Our recent growth has been driven by a variety of factors including increased access to mobile web (display and video) and mobile app (display and video) impressions and desktop video impressions. Our performance is affected by our ability to maintain and grow our access to valuable ad impressions from current publishers as well as through new relationships with publishers. During the year ended December 31, 2020, we processed approximately 1.0 trillion bid requests and had 19 DSPs, and during the nine months ended September 30, 2021, we processed approximately 202 billion bid requests and had 32 DSPs.
Expanding and managing investments
Each impression or transaction occurs in a fraction of a second. Given that most transactions take place in an auction/bidding format, we continue to make investments across the platform to further reduce the processing time. In addition to the robust infrastructure supporting our platform, it is also critical that we align with key industry partners in the digital supply chain. The Colossus SSP is agnostic to any specific demand side platform.
We automate workflow processes whenever feasible to drive predictable and value-added outcomes for our customers and increase productivity of our organization. In the first quarter of 2022, we expect to transition our server platform to HPE Greenlake, which we expect will provide increased capacity, faster response time and expansion capabilities to align with growth in our business.
Managing industry dynamics
We operate in the rapidly evolving digital advertising industry. Due to the scale and complexity of the digital advertising ecosystem, direct sales via manual, person-to-person processes are insufficient for delivering a real-time, personalized ad experience, creating the need for programmatic advertising. In turn, advances in programmatic technologies have enabled publishers to auction their ad inventory to more buyers, simultaneously, and in real time through a process referred to as header bidding. Header bidding has also provided advertisers with transparent access to ad impressions. As advertisers keep pace with ongoing changes in the way that consumers view and interact with digital media we anticipate further innovation and expect that header bidding will be extended into new areas such as OTT/CTV. We believe our focus on publishers and buyers has allowed us to understand their needs and our ongoing innovation has enabled us to quickly adapt to changes in the industry, develop new solutions and do so cost effectively. Our performance depends on our ability to keep pace with industry changes such as header bidding and the evolving needs of our publishers and buyers while continuing our cost efficiency.
Seasonality
The advertising industry experiences seasonal trends that affect the vast majority of participants in the digital advertising ecosystem. Most notably, advertisers have historically spent relatively more in the fourth quarter of the calendar year to coincide with the holiday shopping season, and relatively less in the first quarter. We expect seasonality trends to continue, and our ability to manage our resources in anticipation of these trends will affect our operating results.
Components of Our Results of Operations
Revenue
On the buy-side advertising business, we generate revenue from clients that engage us to provide digital marketing and media services to purchase digital advertising, data, and other add-on features. Buy-side
 
76

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
revenue arrangements are evidenced by fully executed insertion orders (“IO”). Generally, IOs specify the number and type of advertising impressions to be delivered over a specified time at an agreed upon price and performance objectives for an ad campaign.
On the sell-side advertising business, we generate revenue from publishing clients by selling their advertising inventory to national and local advertisers. We generate revenue on the sell-side through the monetization of publisher ad impressions on our platform, which allows publishers to sell, in real time, ad impressions to buyers and provides automated inventory management and monetization tools to publishers across various device types and digital ad formats.
Our buy-side digital advertising purchasing process has the functionality to direct the fulfillment to our sell-side business through an independent third-party marketplace exchange.
We report revenue on a gross basis inclusive of all supplier costs because we bear the full obligation of any costs to provide our services. We pay suppliers for the cost of digital media, advertising inventory, data and any add-on services or features.
Our revenue recognition policies are discussed in more detail under “— Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates.”
Cost of Revenues
Cost of revenues for our buy-side advertising business consists primarily of digital media fees, third-party platform access fees and other third-party fees associated with providing services to our customers. For the sell- side advertising business, we pay publishers a fee, which is typically a percentage of the value of the ad impressions monetized through our platform. Cost of revenues consists primarily of publisher media fees and data center co-location costs. Media fees include the publishing and real time bidding costs to secure advertising space.
Operating Expenses
Operating expenses consists of compensation expenses related to our executive, sales, finance, and administrative personnel (including salaries, commissions, bonuses, benefits and taxes), general and administrative expenses for rent expense, professional fees, independent contractor costs, selling and marketing fees, and operating system subscription costs, as well as amortization expense related to our intangible assets. In fiscal year 2020, we acquired Orange142 and incurred transaction costs primarily consisting of legal fees.
Other (Expense) Income
Other income. Other income includes income associated with recovery of receivables and other miscellaneous credit card rebates.
Forgiveness of PPP Loan.   In 2020, we applied and were approved for a $287,100 loan pursuant to the Paycheck Protection Program (“PPP”), administered by the U.S. Small Business Administration (“SBA”). Forgiveness of PPP loans is recognized as a gain in the period it is granted. For the year ended December 31, 2020, we recognized $277,100 as a gain, and the remaining $10,000 gain was recognized in the nine months ended September 30, 2021. The PPP loans were entered into by DDH LLC and there are no PPP loans held by our subsidiaries.
Gain from revaluation and settlement of notes and earnout liability.   When Huddled Masses and Colossus Media were acquired, we entered into seller notes (“Seller Notes”) and seller earnout agreements (“Seller Earnouts”) with the former selling shareholders (“Former Shareholders”). During fiscal year 2020, we entered into a settlement agreement (“Settlement Agreement”) with the Former Shareholders, and as a result, recorded a net gain in the nine months ended September 30, 2020.
Interest Expense.   Interest expense is mainly related to our debt that was entered into by DDH LLC, which carries a variable interest rate. In connection with the acquisition of Orange142, we issued mandatorily redeemable non-participating preferred A and B units, and in accordance with Accounting Standards
 
77

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
Codification (“ASC”) 480, Distinguishing Liabilities from Equity, the value of these units are classified as a liability, and the corresponding distributions are recognized as interest expense.
Results of Operations
Comparison of the Fiscal Years Ended December 31, 2020 and 2019
The following tables set forth our consolidated results of operations for the periods presented. As noted above, we acquired Orange142 on September 30, 2020, and accordingly, three months of Orange142’s results are included in our financial results. The period-to-period comparison of results is not necessarily indicative of results for future periods.
Year Ended December 31,
Change
2020
2019
Amount
Pcnt
Revenues
Buy-side advertising
$ 9,656,165 $ 5,472,485 $ 4,183,680 76%
Sell-side advertising
2,821,354 798,622 2,022,732 253%
Total revenues
12,477,519 6,271,107 6,206,412 99%
Cost of revenues
Buy-side advertising
4,864,234 3,720,594 1,143,640 31%
Sell-side advertising
2,440,975 816,083 1,624,892 199%
Total cost of revenues
7,305,209 4,536,677 2,768,532 61%
Gross profit
5,172,310 1,734,430 3,437,880 198%
Operating expenses
6,016,874 2,606,898 3,409,976 130%
Loss from operations
(844,564) (872,468) 27,904 3%
Other (expense) income
(51,502) 27,837 (79,339) -285%
Tax expense
(12,124) (39,137) 27,012 69%
Net loss
$ (908,190) $ (883,768) $ (24,422) -3%
Adjusted EBITDA(1)
$ 613,074 $ (866,617) $ 1,479,690 171%
(1)
For a definition of Adjusted EBITDA, an explanation of our management’s use of this measure, and a reconciliation of Adjusted EBITDA to net income, see “Prospectus Summary — Non-GAAP Financial Measures.”
Revenues
Our revenues increased from $6.3 million in 2019 to $12.5 million in 2020, an increase of $6.2 million or 99%. Buy-side advertising revenue increased $4.2 million or 76%, while sell-side advertising revenue increased $2.0 million, or 253% over fiscal year 2019. The increase in our buy-side advertising revenue was primarily as a result of the acquisition of Orange142, which contributed $4.3 million of the increase, as Orange142’s revenues only were included in three months of our results of operations during fiscal year 2020. Organic buy-side advertising revenues declined by $0.1 million year over year due to $0.5 million of lower media revenue, partially offset by $0.4 million of higher consulting revenue. Our buy-side advertising business was also impacted by COVID-19, as our customer base experienced a slowdown in demand for products and services. The increase in our sell-side advertising revenue was the result of an overall increase in advertising spend by our customers.
Cost of Revenues
Along with the increase in gross sales across the platform, we correspondingly experienced an increase in cost of revenues from $4.5 million in 2019 to $7.3 million in 2020, an increase of $2.8 million or 61%. Buy- side advertising cost of revenues increased $1.1 million, or 31%, primarily due to the acquisition of Orange142, which contributed $1.3 million of the increase. Organic buy-side advertising cost of revenues
 
78

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
decreased $0.2 million from the prior year. Sell-side advertising cost of revenues increased $1.6 million, or 199%, over 2019 to provide increased advertising purchased by clients in fiscal year 2020. In fiscal year 2019, our sell- side advertising business had not yet met its breakeven point, and the fixed costs such as data center co- location and programming support caused the cost of revenues to exceed revenue for that period.
Gross Profit
Gross profit also increased in the year ended December 31, 2020 to $5.2 million, compared to $1.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2019, an increase of $3.4 million or 198%. Buy-side advertising gross profit increased $3.0 million, primarily due to the acquisition of Orange142. Organic buy-side advertising gross profit increased $0.1 million over the prior year. Sell-side advertising gross profit increased $0.4 million over 2019, primarily as a result of the increase in revenue.
Operating Expenses
The following table sets forth the components of operating expenses for the periods presented.
Year Ended December 31,
Change
2020
2019
Amount
Pcnt
Operating Expenses
Compensation, taxes and benefits
$ 3,334,060 $ 1,613,692 $ 1,720,368 107%
General and administrative
1,848,407 993,206 855,201 86%
Acquisition transaction costs
834,407 834,407 nm
Total operating expenses
$ 6,016,874 $ 2,606,898 $ 3,409,976 131%
Compensation, taxes and benefits
Compensation, taxes and benefits increased from $1.6 million in 2019 to $3.3 million in 2020, an increase of $1.7 million, or 107%. The increase was primarily due to $1.5 million of additional compensation and benefits paid to employees added in connection with the acquisition of Orange142, as well as an increase of $0.3 million attributable to higher commissions and hiring of additional personnel to support our growth.
General and Administrative Expenses
General and administrative (“G&A”) expenses also increased from 2019 to 2020, primarily due to the acquisition of Orange142 and the $0.5 million of amortization expense recorded in connection with the intangible assets identified in the valuation of the transaction. During the year ended December 31, 2019, our G&A costs were $1.0 million, compared to $1.9 million during the year ended December 31, 2020, an increase of $0.9 million or 86%. For the year ended December 31, 2019, G&A expenses as a percentage of revenue was 15.8% compared to 16.8% for the year ended December 31, 2020. For the year ended December 31, 2020, we recorded $0.5 million for intangible asset amortization expense, or 3.9% of revenue. During 2021, we have invested in systems and infrastructure and incurred additional consulting expenses.
We expect to invest in corporate infrastructure and incur additional expenses associated with our transition to and operation as a public company, including increased compensation associated with additional headcount to support our sales initiatives, legal and accounting costs, higher insurance premiums, and compliance costs associated with developing the requisite infrastructure required for internal controls. As a result, we expect G&A expenses to increase in absolute dollars in future periods.
Acquisition Transaction Costs
During the year ended December 31, 2020, the Company incurred $0.8 million in acquisition transaction costs related to the acquisition of Orange142. These expenses primarily related to legal fees and closing costs.
 
79

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
Other (Expense) Income
The following table sets forth the components of other income (expense) for the periods presented.
Year Ended December 31,
Change
2020
2019
Amount
Pcnt
Other (expense) income
Other income
$ 134,776 $ 5,851 $ 128,925 nm
Forgiveness of PPP loan
277,100 277,100 nm
Gain from revaluation and settlement of seller notes and earnout liability
401,677 79,091 322,586 408%
Interest expense
(865,055) (57,105) (807,950) nm
Total other (expense) income
$ (51,502) $ 27,837 $ (79,339) -285%
Other income for the year ended December 31, 2020 is comprised of approximately $0.1 million in other income as a result of recovery of a receivable, $0.3 million for forgiveness of the PPP loans, and a $0.4 million gain as a result of the Settlement Agreement with the Former Shareholders of Huddled Masses and Colossus Media for the Seller Earnouts and Seller Notes.
Other income for the year ended December 31, 2019 included $0.1 million of gain as a result of the revaluation of Seller Earnout liability with the Former Shareholders of Huddled Masses and Colossus Media.
Interest Expense
We experienced a net increase in interest expense of $0.8 million as interest expense increased from approximately $57,000 during the year ended December 31, 2019 to $0.9 million during the year ended December 31, 2020. The increase in interest expense was the result of financing activities related to the Orange142 acquisition and reflects approximately three months of interest expense in 2020.
Comparison of the Nine Months Ended September 30, 2021 and 2020
The following tables set forth our consolidated results of operations for the periods presented. As noted above, we acquired Orange142 on September 30, 2020, and accordingly, nine months of Orange142’s results are included in our financial results for the nine months ended September 30, 2021. The period-to-period comparison of results is not necessarily indicative of results for future periods.
Nine Months Ended September 30,
Change
2021
2020
Amount
Pcnt
Revenues
Buy-side advertising
$ 19,975,235 $ 4,377,708 $ 15,597,527 356%
Sell-side advertising
5,261,135 1,498,300 3,762,835 251%
Total revenues
25,236,370 5,876,008 19,360,362 329%
Cost of revenues
Buy-side advertising
7,480,727 2,836,035 4,644,692 164%
Sell-side advertising
4,348,756 1,350,083 2,998,673 222%
Total cost of revenues
11,829,483 4,186,118 7,643,365 183%
Gross profit
13,406,887 1,689,890 11,716,997 693%
Operating expenses
10,346,159 2,574,739 7,771,420 302%
Income (loss) from operations
3,060,728 (884,849) 3,945,577 446%
Other (expense) income
(2,382,149) 516,513 (2,898,662) -561%
Tax expense
(54,878) (12,154) (42,724) -352%
 
80

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
Nine Months Ended September 30,
Change
2021
2020
Amount
Pcnt
Net income (loss)
$ 623,701 $ (380,490) $ 1,004,191 264%
Adjusted EBITDA(1)
$ 4,545,278 $ (100,088) $ 4,645,366 464%
(1)
For a definition of Adjusted EBITDA, an explanation of our management’s use of this measure, and a reconciliation of Adjusted EBITDA to net income, see “Prospectus Summary — Non-GAAP Financial Measures.”
Revenues
Our revenues increased from $5.9 million for the nine months ended September 30, 2020 to $25.2 million for the nine months ended September 30, 2021, an increase of $19.4 million, or 329%. Buy-side advertising revenue increased $15.6 million, or 356%, while sell-side advertising revenue increased $3.8 million, or 251%, over the nine months ended September 30, 2020. The increase in our buy-side advertising revenue was as a result of the acquisition of Orange142, which contributed $15.9 million of the increase, as Orange142’s revenues were only included in our results of operations for the nine months ended September 30, 2021. Organic buy-side advertising revenues declined by $0.3 million from the prior period due to $1.6 million of lower consulting revenue, partially offset by $1.3 million of higher media revenue. The increase in our sell-side advertising revenue was the result of an overall increase in advertising spend by our customers.
Cost of Revenues
Along with the increase in gross sales across the platform, we correspondingly experienced an increase in cost of revenues from $4.2 million for the nine months ended September 30, 2020 to $11.8 million for the nine months ended September 30, 2021, an increase of $7.6 million, or 183%. Buy-side advertising cost of revenues increased $4.6 million, or 164%, primarily due to the acquisition of Orange142, which contributed $5.0 million of the increase. Organic buy-side advertising cost of revenues decreased $0.4 million from the prior period as a result of lower revenue. Sell-side advertising cost of revenues increased $3.0 million, or 222%, over the nine months ended September 30, 2020 to provide increased advertising purchased by clients during the nine months ended September 30, 2021.
Gross Profit
Gross profit also increased in the nine months ended September 30, 2021 to $13.4 million, compared to $1.7 million for the nine months ended September 30, 2020, an increase of $11.7 million, or 693%. Buy-side advertising gross profit increased $11.0 million, primarily due to the acquisition of Orange142. Organic buy-side advertising gross profit increased $0.1 million over the prior year period. Sell-side advertising gross profit increased $0.7 million over the nine months ended September 30, 2020, primarily as a result of the increase in revenue.
Operating Expenses
The following table sets forth the components of operating expenses for the periods presented.
Nine Months Ended September 30,
Change
2021
2020
Amount
Pcnt
Operating Expenses
Compensation, taxes and benefits
$ 6,131,930 $ 1,324,196 $ 4,807,734 363%
General and administrative
4,214,229 600,543 3,613,686 602%
Acquisition transaction costs
650,000 (650,000) nm
Total operating expenses
$ 10,346,159 $ 2,574,739 $ 7,771,420 302%
Compensation, taxes and benefits
Compensation, taxes and benefits increased from $1.3 million for the nine months ended September 30, 2020 to $6.1 million for the nine months ended September 30, 2021, an increase of $4.8 million, or 363%.
 
81

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
The increase was primarily due to $4.2 million of additional compensation and benefits paid to employees added in connection with the acquisition of Orange142, as well as an increase of $0.6 million attributable to higher commissions and hiring of additional personnel to support our growth.
General and Administrative Expenses
During the nine months ended September 30, 2020, our G&A expenses were $0.6 million, compared to $4.2 million during the nine months ended September 30, 2021, an increase of $3.6 million, or 602%, primarily due to the acquisition of Orange142, as well as higher professional fees. The acquisition of Orange142 and the amortization expense recorded in connection with the intangible assets identified in the valuation of the transaction represented $0.7 million and $1.5 million of the increase, respectively. For the nine months ended September 30, 2021, we have invested in systems and infrastructure and incurred additional professional fees and consulting expenses.
We expect to invest in corporate infrastructure and incur additional expenses associated with our transition to and operation as a public company, including increased compensation associated with additional headcount to support our sales initiatives, legal and accounting costs, higher insurance premiums, and compliance costs associated with developing the requisite infrastructure required for internal controls. As a result, we expect G&A expenses to increase in absolute dollars in future periods.
Acquisition Transaction Costs
During the nine months ended September 30, 2020, the Company incurred $0.7 million in acquisition transaction costs related to the acquisition of Orange142. These expenses primarily related to legal fees and closing costs.
Other (Expense) Income
The following table sets forth the components of other (expense) income for the periods presented.

Nine Months Ended September 30,
Change
2021
2020
Amount
Pcnt
Other income
$ 19,186 $ 134,761 $ (115,575) -86%
Forgiveness of PPP loan
10,000 10,000 nm
Gain from revaluation and settlement of seller notes and earnout liability
21,232 401,677 (380,445) -95%
Interest expense
(2,432,567) (19,925) (2,412,642) nm%
Total other (expense) income
$ (2,382,149) $ 516,513 $ (2,898,662) -561%
Other income for the nine months ended September 30, 2021 is comprised of approximately $19,000 primarily related to credit card cash rebates, $10,000 of forgiveness of PPP loans and a gain of approximately $21,000 as a result of the final earnout revaluation related to the Former Shareholders of Huddled Masses and Colossus Media for the Seller Earnouts.
Other income for the nine months ended September 30, 2020 included $0.1 million in other income as a result of recovery of a receivable, and $0.4 million of gain as a result of the revaluation of Seller Earnout liability with the Former Shareholders of Huddled Masses and Colossus Media.
Interest Expense
We experienced a net increase in interest expense of $2.4 million as interest expense increased from approximately $20,000 during the nine months ended September 30, 2020 to $2.4 million during the nine months ended September 30, 2021. The increase in interest expense was the result of financing activities related to the Orange142 acquisition and reflects nine months of interest expense in 2021.
 
82

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
Liquidity and Capital Resources
The following table summarizes our cash and cash equivalents, working capital (deficiency), and availability under our Revolving Credit Facility (as defined below) on September 30, 2021, December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019:
September 30, 2021
December 31, 2020
December 31, 2019
Cash and cash equivalents
$ 2,603,152 $ 1,611,998 $ 882,292
Working deficiency
$ (752,633) $ (117,779) $ (2,332,508)
Availability under Revolving Credit Facility
$ 592,949 $ 592,949 $
We anticipate funding our operations for the next twelve months using available cash, cash flow generated from operations, availability under our Revolving Credit Facility and proceeds from this offering. As of September 30, 2021 and December 31, 2020, we had cash and cash equivalents of approximately $2.6 and $1.6 million, respectively, and $0.6 million available under our Revolving Credit Facility. Based on projections of growth in revenue and operating results in the coming year, the available cash held by us and availability under our Revolving Credit Facility, we believe that we will have sufficient cash resources to finance our operations and service any maturing debt for at least the next twelve months. Depending on our growth and results of operations, we may have to raise additional capital through the issuance of additional equity and/or debt, which could have the effect of diluting our stockholders. Any equity or debt financings, if available at all, may be on terms which are not favorable to us. As our debt or credit facilities become due, we will need to repay, extend or replace such indebtedness. Our ability to do so will be subject to future economic, financial, business and other factors, many of which are beyond our control.
In September 2020, DDH LLC and each of its subsidiaries as co-borrowers entered into the Revolving Credit Facility and a loan and security agreement that provides for a term loan in the principal amount of $12.825 million (the “2020 Term Loan Facility”). The loans under the Revolving Credit Facility bear interest at the LIBOR rate plus 3.5% per annum, and on each of September 30, 2021 and December  31, 2020, the rate was 6.75% with a 0.5% unused line fee. The maturity date of the Revolving Credit Facility is September 30, 2022. The term loan under the 2020 Term Loan Facility bore interest at 15.0% per annum; provided, that from September 2020 through the payment date in September 2021, DDH LLC was required to pay cash interest at the rate of 12.0% per annum and would owe an additional 3.0% per annum which amount would be deferred and added to the outstanding principal balance of the term loan on each payment date thereafter. All accrued but unpaid interest under the Revolving Credit Facility is payable in monthly installments on each interest payment date until the maturity date when the outstanding principal balance, together with all accrued but unpaid interest, will be due. All accrued but unpaid interest under the 2020 Term Loan Facility was payable in monthly installments on each interest payment date, and DDH LLC was required to repay the outstanding principal balance on January  15 and July 15 of each calendar year in an amount equal to 37.5% of excess cash flow over the preceding six calendar months until the term loan was paid in full. In January 2021, we made a repayment of $1.2 million with respect to the period ending December 31, 2020. The maturity date of the 2020 Term Loan Facility was September 15, 2023; however, on December  3, 2021, DDH LLC entered into the Term Loan and Security Agreement (the “2021 Credit Facility”) with Lafayette Square Loan Servicing, LLC (“Lafayette Square”), as administrative agent, and the various lenders thereto. The term loan under the 2021 Credit Facility provides for a term loan in the principal amount of up to $32.0 million, consisting of a $22.0 million closing date term loan and an up to $10.0 million delayed draw term loan. The loans under the 2021 Credit Facility bear interest at LIBOR plus the applicable margin minus any applicable impact discount. The applicable margin under the 2021 Credit Facility is determined based on the consolidated total net leverage ratio of the Company and its consolidated subsidiaries, at a rate of 6.50% per annum if the consolidated total net leverage ratio is less than 2.00 to 1.00 and up to 9.00% per annum if the consolidated total net leverage ratio is greater than 4.00 to 1.00. The applicable impact discount under the 2021 Credit Facility is a discount of 0.05% per annum to the extent that DDH LLC adopts certain services intended to improve overall employee satisfaction and retention plus an additional discount of 0.05% per annum to the extent that DDH LLC maintains a B Corp certification by Standards Analysts at the non-profit B Lab (or a successor certification or administrator). The maturity date of the 2021 Credit Facility is December 3, 2026.
 
83

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
The obligations under the 2021 Credit Facility are secured by senior, first-priority liens on all or substantially all assets of DDH LLC and its subsidiaries and are guaranteed by the subsidiaries of DDH LLC, and include a pledge and guarantee by the Company. The 2021 Credit Facility is subject to an intercreditor agreement pursuant to which the Revolving Credit Facility has a priority lien on the trade accounts receivable of DDH LLC and its subsidiaries that constitute eligible accounts under the Revolving Credit Facility and related proceeds, and the 2021 Credit Facility has a priority lien on all other collateral. In connection with the entry into the 2021 Credit Facility, we paid off in full and terminated the 2020 Term Loan Facility.
The Revolving Credit Facility is secured by the trade accounts receivable of the Company and guaranteed by Holdings. The Revolving Credit Facility includes financial covenants, including (i) a minimum fixed charge coverage ratio of not less than 1.25 to 1.00 as of the end of each fiscal quarter, commencing with the fiscal quarter ending September 30, 2020, (ii) a maximum total net leverage ratio of 3.00 to 1.00 for the fiscal quarters ending December  31, 2020 and March 31, 2021, 2.75 to 1.00 for the fiscal quarters ending June 30, 2021 and September 30, 2021, 2.50 to 1.00 for the fiscal quarters ending December 31, 2021 and March 31, 2022, and 2.25 to 1.00 for the fiscal quarters ending thereafter and (iii) a minimum liquidity amount of at least $1.0 million for the period of September 30, 2020 to June 29, 2021, $1.1 million for the period of June 30, 2021 to December 30, 2021, $1.3 million for the period of December  31, 2021 to June 29, 2022 and $1.4 million thereafter. DDH LLC was in compliance with all of its financial covenants under the Revolving Credit Facility and the 2020 Term Loan Facility as of September 30, 2021 and December  31, 2020.
The Revolving Credit Facility and the 2021 Credit Facility contain customary events of default, including with respect to a failure to make payments when due, cross-default and cross-judgment default and certain bankruptcy and insolvency events. On each of September 30, 2021 and December 31, 2020, the Revolving Credit Facility had borrowings outstanding in the amount of $0.4 million, leaving $0.6 million of unused capacity. From time to time, we are required to post financial assurances to satisfy contractual and other requirements generated in the normal course of business. Some of these assurances are posted to comply with federal, state or other government agencies’ statutes and regulations.
Consolidated Statement of Cash Flow Data:
For the Nine Months Ended September 30,
For Year Ended December 31,
2021
2020
2020
2019
Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities
$ 3,204,641 $ (952,134) $ (574,527) $ 210,243
Net cash used in investing activities
(10,985,849) (10,985,849)
Net cash (used in) provided by financing activities
(2,213,487) 13,190,632 12,290,082 43,001
Net increase in cash and cash equivalents
$ 991,154 $ 1,252,649 $ 729,706 $ 253,244
Tax Receivable Agreement
After completion of this offering, Holdings will be a holding company and will have no material assets other than its ownership of LLC Units. Holdings has no independent means of generating revenue. The limited liability company agreement of DDH LLC that will be in effect at the time of this offering provides that certain distributions will be made to cover the taxes of the owners of LLC Units and Holdings’ obligations under the Tax Receivable Agreement. As described in the section titled “Certain Relationships and Related Person Transactions — Tax Receivable Agreement,” in connection with the Organizational Transactions, we will enter into the Tax Receivable Agreement with DDH LLC and each of the Continuing LLC Owners. Due to the uncertainty of various factors, we cannot precisely quantify the tax benefits we may realize as a result of LLC Unit exchanges and the resulting amounts we may need to pay out to certain of the Continuing LLC Owners pursuant to the Tax Receivable Agreement; however, we estimate that such payments may be substantial. For example, if we acquired all of the LLC Units of certain of the Continuing LLC Owners in taxable transactions as of this offering, based on an initial public offering price of $8.00 per share (the midpoint of the estimated initial public offering price range set forth on the cover
 
84

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
page of this prospectus) and on certain assumptions, including that (i) there are no material changes in relevant tax law and (ii) we earn sufficient taxable income in each year to realize on a current basis all tax benefits that are subject to the Tax Receivable Agreement, we expect that the resulting reduction in tax payments for us, as determined for purposes of the Tax Receivable Agreement, would aggregate to approximately $35.6 million, substantially all of which would be realized over the next 15 years, and we would be required to pay certain of the Continuing LLC Owners 85% of such amount, or $30.3 million, over the same period. The actual increases in tax basis with respect to future taxable redemptions, exchanges or purchases of LLC Units, as well as the amount and timing of any payments we will be required to make under the Tax Receivable Agreement in respect of the acquisition of LLC Units from certain Continuing LLC Owners in connection with this offering or future taxable redemptions, exchanges or purchases of LLC Units, may differ materially from the amounts set forth above because the potential future reductions in our tax payments, as determined for purposes of the Tax Receivable Agreement, and the payments we will be required to make under the Tax Receivable Agreement, will each depend on a number of factors, including the market value of our common stock at the time of redemption or exchange and the prevailing federal tax rates applicable to us over the life of the Tax Receivable Agreement. See “Certain Relationships and Related Person Transactions — Tax Receivable Agreement” and “Certain Relationships and Related Person Transactions — DDH LLC Agreement” for more information.
Cash Flows from Operating Activities
Our cash flows from operating activities are primarily influenced by growth in our operations, increases or decreases in collections from our customers and related payments to our buyers and suppliers of advertising media and data. Cash flows from operating activities have been affected by changes in our working capital, particularly changes in accounts receivable, accounts payable and accrued liabilities. The timing of cash receipts from customers and payments to suppliers can significantly impact our cash flows from operating activities. We typically pay suppliers in advance of collections from our customers, but our collection and payment cycles can vary from period to period. In addition, we expect seasonality to impact cash flows from operating activities on a quarterly basis.
For the Years Ended December 31, 2020 and 2019
Cash flows from operating activities decreased from $0.2 million provided by operating activities for the year ended December 31, 2019 to $0.6 million used in operating activities for the year ended December 31, 2020. The year-over-year decrease of $0.8 million was due to changes in operating assets and liabilities primarily driven by higher accounts payable payments to our vendors.
During the year ended December 31, 2020, cash used in operating activities of $0.6 million resulted primarily from net loss of $0.9 million, noncash add back adjustments to net income of $0.1 million for amortization of deferred financing costs, $0.5 million for amortization of intangible assets and $0.1 million of paid-in-kind interest, partially offset by the deduction of a $0.3 million gain from the forgiveness of the PPP loans as well as $0.4 million for a gain on the revaluation and settlement of the Seller Earnout liability. Working capital changes of $0.3 million were primarily driven by a $0.7 million decrease in accounts receivable, an increase in accrued liabilities of $0.5 million and related party payables of $0.1 million, partially offset by decreases in accounts payable of $0.5 million and deferred revenue of $0.4 million.
During the year ended December 31, 2019, net cash provided by operating activities of $0.2 million resulted primarily from net loss of $0.9 million and noncash add-back adjustments to net loss of $0.1 million for bad debt expense partially offset by a deduction of $0.1 million for a gain from the revaluation of the Seller Earnout liability. Working capital changes of $1.1 million were primarily driven by a cash inflow related to a decrease in accounts receivable of $0.4 million, an increase in accounts payable and accrued liabilities of $0.6 million and an increase in deferred revenue of $0.1 million.
For the Nine Months Ended September 30, 2021 and 2020
Cash flows from operating activities increased from $1.0 million used in operating activities for the nine months ended September 30, 2020 to $3.2 million provided by operating activities for the nine months ended September 30, 2021. The period-over-period increase of $4.2 million was primarily due to $1.5 million
 
85

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
and $1.0 million increases in amoritization of intangible assets and net income, respectively, as well as changes in operating assets and liabilities.
During the nine months ended September 30, 2021, cash provided by operating activities of $3.2 million resulted primarily from net income of $0.6 million, noncash add-back adjustments to net income of $1.5 million for amortization of intangible assets, $0.3 million for amortization of deferred financing costs, and $0.3 million of paid-in-kind interest.  Working capital cash inflows of $0.5 million were primarily driven by a $0.7 million decrease in accounts receivable, an increase in deferred revenue of $0.4 million and accrued liabilities of $0.1 million, partially offset by an increase in prepaid expenses of $0.5 million, a decrease in accounts payable of $0.1 million and a decrease in related party payables of $0.1 million.
During the nine months ended September 30, 2020, net cash used in operating activities of $1.0 million resulted primarily from net loss of $0.4 million and a noncash deduction of $0.4 million for a gain from the revaluation and settlement of the Seller Earnout liability. Working capital cash outflows of $0.2 million were primarily driven by an increase in accounts receivable of $0.3 million and a decrease in accounts payable of $0.4 million, partially offset by a $0.3 million and $0.2 million decrease in accrued liabilities and deferred revenue, respectively.
Cash Flows from Investing Activities
Effective September 30, 2020, DDH LLC acquired 100% of the equity interests of Orange142 valued at $26.2 million. The acquisition was funded by issuance of member common units, mandatorily redeemable preferred units, a facility term note, and a Revolving Credit Facility. The acquisition of Orange142 was recorded by allocating the total purchase consideration to the fair value of the net tangible assets acquired, including goodwill and intangible assets in accordance with ASC 805. The purchase consideration exceeded the fair value of the net assets resulting in goodwill of $4.1 million and intangible assets of $18.0 million.
Intangible assets consist of $13.0 million of 10-year amortizable customer relationships, $3.5 million of 10- year amortizable trademarks and tradename, and $1.5 million of 5-year amortizable non-complete agreements.
Cash paid to sellers
$ 12,000,000
Member units issued
4,294,041
Mandatorily redeemable units
9,913,940
Total purchase consideration
$ 26,207,981
Cash paid to sellers
$ 12,000,000
Cash acquired
(1,014,151)
Net cash used in acquisition
$ 10,985,849
The following table summarizes the allocations of the purchase consideration to the fair value of the net assets:
Fair value of assets acquired:
Cash and cash equivalents
$ 1,014,151
Accounts receivable
4,590,945
Prepaid expenses and other current assets
148,717
Other assets
9,618
Intangible assets
18,033,850
Goodwill
4,095,700
Total assets acquired
$ 27,892,981
Fair values of liabilities assumed:
Accounts payable
$ 683,521
Accrued liabilities
244,165
Deferred revenue
757,314
Total liabilities assumed
$ 1,685,000
Total fair value of net assets
$ 26,207,981
 
86

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
Cash Flows Provided by Financing Activities
December 31, 2020 and 2019
Our financing activities consisted primarily of proceeds from borrowings and repayments of our Revolving Credit Facility, payments of financing costs related to the 2020 Term Loan Facility, proceeds from government loans, as well as receipts from and distributions to the members of DDH LLC. Net cash provided by financing activities has been and will be used to finance our operations, including our investment in people and infrastructure, to support our growth.
Cash flows provided by financing activities increased from $43,000 for the year ended December 31, 2019 to $12.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2020. The year-over-year increase of $12.2 million was primarily due to the proceeds from the 2020 Term Loan Facility.
During the year ended December 31, 2020, net cash provided by financing activities of $12.3 million resulted primarily from the $12.8 million of proceeds of the 2020 Term Loan Facility in conjunction with the acquisition of Orange142, partially offset by $0.6 million paid for deferred financing costs in the transaction. We also paid off our line of credit with First Citizens Bank and entered into the Revolving Credit Facility with East West Bank. Borrowings under the Revolving Credit Facility totaled $1.1 million, and payments totaled $1.4 million. We also incurred $0.1 million in deferred financing fees associated with the Revolving Credit Facility. During the year ended December 31, 2020, we also received proceeds from the government for the PPP loans of $0.3 million as well as $0.2 million from the economic disaster recovery loan program. Members of DDH LLC received distributions of $0.1 million and repaid $0.4 million from advances. As a result of a litigation settlement with the Former Shareholders of Huddled Masses and Colossus, we paid $0.2 million and $18,000 to the Former Shareholders for amounts due under their Seller Notes and Seller Earnouts, respectively.
During the year ended December 31, 2019, cash provided by financing activities of $43,000 resulted primarily from $0.5 million of borrowings on the First Citizens Bank line of credit, partially offset by $0.1 million for payments towards Seller Notes and $0.3 million for advances to members.
September 30, 2021 and 2020
Cash flows (used in) provided by financing activities decreased from $13.2 million provided by financing activities for the nine months ended September 30, 2020, to $2.2 million used in financing activities for the nine months ended September 30, 2021. The period-over-period decrease of $15.4 million was primarily due to the $12.8 million of proceeds from the 2020 Term Loan Facility for the nine months ended September 30, 2020 compared to the $1.2 million repayment of our 2020 Term Loan Facility for the nine months ended September 30, 2021.
Our financing activities for the nine months ended September 30, 2021 consisted primarily of repayments of our 2020 Term Loan Facility and Seller Notes and Seller Earnouts, proceeds from government loans, as well as distributions to the members of DDH LLC. Net cash provided by financing activities has been and will be used to finance our operations, including our investment in people and infrastructure, to support our growth.
During the nine months ended September 30, 2020, net cash provided by financing activities of $13.2 million resulted primarily from the $12.8 million of proceeds of the 2020 Term Loan Facility in conjunction with the acquisition of Orange142, partially offset by $0.5 million paid for deferred financing costs in the transaction. We also incurred $0.1 million in deferred financing fees associated with the Revolving Credit Facility. During the nine months ended September 30, 2020, we also received proceeds from the government for the PPP loans of $0.3 million as well as $0.2 million from the economic disaster recovery loan program. Members of DDH LLC received distributions of $0.1 million and repaid $0.4 million from advances. As a result of a litigation settlement with the Former Shareholders of Huddled Masses and Colossus, we paid $0.2 million and approximately $18,000 to the Former Shareholders for amounts due under their Seller Notes and Seller Earnouts, respectively.
 
87

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
Contractual Obligations and Future Cash Requirements
Our principal contractual obligations consist of non-cancelable leases for our various facilities. We lease furniture and office space in Houston, Austin and Colorado Springs from an unrelated party under non- cancelable operating leases dating through December 2023.
As of December 31, 2020, future minimum payments under the operating leases were as follows for the years ending December 31:
2021
$ 143,211
2022
121,651
2023
90,138
$ 355,000
As of September 30, 2021, future minimum payments under the operating leases were as follows for the nine months ending September 30:
2021
$ 36,638
2022
121,651
2023
90,138
$ 248,427
Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements
Through September 30, 2021, we did not have any relationships with unconsolidated organizations or financial partnerships, such as structured finance or special purpose entities that would have been established for the purpose of facilitating off-balance sheet arrangements or other contractually narrow or limited purposes.
Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates
We prepare our consolidated financial statements in accordance with GAAP. The preparation of the consolidated financial statements requires us to make estimates and assumptions that affect the amounts of assets and liabilities reported, disclosures about contingent assets and liabilities, and reported amounts of revenue and expenses. We evaluate our estimates and assumptions on an ongoing basis using historical experience and other factors and adjust those estimates and assumptions when facts and circumstances dictate. Actual results could materially differ from these estimates and assumptions.
We believe estimates and assumptions associated with the evaluation of revenue recognition criteria, including the determination of revenue reporting as net versus gross in our revenue arrangements, as well as our determination of the fair value of goodwill and intangible assets, have the greatest potential impact on our consolidated financial statements. Therefore, we consider these to be our critical accounting policies and estimates.
Revenue recognition
We adopted Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) Accounting Standards Update (“ASU”) 2014-09, Revenue from Contracts with Customers (“Topic 606”), as of January 1, 2019, for all contracts not completed as of the date of adoption, which had no impact on our financial position or results of operations using the modified retrospective method. We recognize revenue using the following five steps:

Identification of a contract(s) with a customer;

Identification of the performance obligation(s) in the contract;

Determination of the transaction price;

Allocation of the transaction price to the performance obligation(s) in the contract; and,
 
88

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 

Recognition of revenue when, or as, the performance obligation(s) are satisfied.
Our revenues are derived primarily from two sources: buy-side advertising and sell-side advertising.
Buy-side advertising
We purchase media based on the budget established by our customers with a focus on leveraging data services, customer branding, real-time market analysis and micro-location advertising. We offer our platform on a fully managed and a self-serve basis, which is recognized over time using the output method when the performance obligation is fulfilled. An “impression” is delivered when an advertisement appears on pages viewed by users. The performance obligation is satisfied over time as the volume of impressions are delivered up to the contractual maximum for fully managed revenue and the delivery of media inventory for self-serve revenue. Many customers run several different campaigns throughout the year to capitalize on different seasons, special events and other happenings at their respective regions and localities. We provide digital advertising and media buying capabilities with a focus on generating measurable digital and financial life for our customers.
Revenue arrangements are evidenced by a fully executed IO. Generally, IOs specify the number and type of advertising impressions to be delivered over a specified time at an agreed upon price and performance objectives for an ad campaign. Performance objectives are generally a measure of targeting, as defined by the parties in advance, such as number of ads displayed, consumer clicks on ads or consumer actions (which may include qualified leads, registrations, downloads, inquiries or purchases). These payment models are commonly referred to as CPM (cost per impression), CPC (cost per click) and CPA (cost per action). The majority of our contracts are flat-rate, fee-based contracts.
In instances where we contract with third-party advertising agencies on behalf of their advertiser clients, a determination is made to recognize revenue on a gross or net basis based on an assessment of whether we are acting as the principal or an agent in the transaction. We are acting as the principal in these arrangements and therefore revenue earned and costs incurred are recognized on a gross basis, as we have control and are responsible for fulfilling the advertisement delivery, establishing the selling prices and delivering the advertisements for fully managed revenue and providing updates and performing billing and collection activities for our self-serve proprietary platform.
Sell-side advertising
We partner with publishers to sell advertising inventory to our existing buy-side clients, as well as our own Colossus Media-curated clients and the open markets (collectively referred to as “buyers”) seeking to access the general market as well as unique multi-cultural audiences. We generate revenue from the delivery of targeted digital media solutions, enabling advertisers to connect intelligently with their audiences across online display, video, social and mobile mediums using our proprietary programmatic SSP. We refer to our publishers, app developers and channel partners collectively as our publishers. We generate revenue through the monetization of publisher ad impressions on our platform. Our platform allows publishers to sell, in real time, ad impressions to buyers and provides automated inventory management and monetization tools to publishers across various device types and digital ad formats. We recognize revenue when an ad is delivered in response to a winning bid request from ad buyers. We are acting as the principal in these arrangements and therefore revenue earned and costs incurred are recognized on a gross basis as we have control and are responsible for fulfilling the advertisement delivery, establishing the selling prices and the delivery of the advertisements for fully managed revenue and providing updates and performing all billing and collection activities for our self-serve proprietary platform.
We maintain agreements with each DSP in the form of written service agreements, which set out the terms of the relationship, including payment terms (typically 30 to 90 days) and access to its platform. In an effort to reduce the risk of nonpayment, we have insurance with a third-party carrier for our accounts receivable.
Goodwill
Under the purchase method of accounting pursuant to ASC 805, goodwill is calculated as the excess of purchase price over the fair value of the net tangible and identifiable intangible assets acquired. In testing
 
89

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
goodwill for impairment, we have the option to begin with a qualitative assessment, commonly referred to as “Step 0,” to determine whether it is more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit containing goodwill is less than its carrying value. This qualitative assessment may include, but is not limited to, reviewing factors such as macroeconomic conditions, industry and market considerations, cost factors, entity-specific financial performance and other events, such as changes in our management, strategy and primary user base. If we determine that it is more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit is less than its carrying value, then a quantitative goodwill impairment analysis is performed which is referred to as “Step 1.” Depending upon the results of that measurement, the recorded goodwill may be written down, and impairment expense is recorded in the consolidated statements of operations when the carrying amount of the reporting unit exceeds the fair value of the reporting unit. Goodwill is reviewed annually and tested for impairment upon the occurrence of a triggering event. For the years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019, and for the nine months ended September 30, 3021 and 2020, we did not recognize any goodwill impairment losses.
Intangible assets, net
Our intangible assets consist of customer relationships, trademarks and non-compete agreements. Our intangible assets are recorded at fair value at the time of their acquisition and are stated within our consolidated balance sheets net of accumulated amortization. Intangible assets are amortized on a straight- line basis over their estimated useful lives or using an accelerated method. Amortization is recorded as depreciation and amortization under operating expenses within our consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive loss. Intangible assets are reviewed for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of the assets may not be recoverable. As of September 30, 2021, December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019, there were no events or changes in circumstances to indicate that the carrying amount of the assets may not be recoverable.
Recent Accounting Pronouncements
See Note 2 to our consolidated financial statements for recently adopted accounting pronouncements and recently issued accounting pronouncements not yet adopted.
Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk
We are exposed to certain market risks in the ordinary course of our business. These risks primarily include:
Interest Rate Risk
We had cash and cash equivalents of $2.6 million and $1.6 million as of September 30, 2021 and December 31, 2020, respectively, which consisted of bank deposits. The primary objective of our investment activities is to preserve principal while maximizing income without significantly increasing risk. Because our cash represents deposits at financial institutions, our portfolio’s fair value is relatively insensitive to interest rate changes. Our Revolving Credit Facility is at variable interest rates. We had $0.4 million outstanding under our Revolving Credit Facility as of September 30, 2021 and December 31, 2020. The 2020 Term Loan Facility accrued interest at a fixed rate. We do not believe that an increase or decrease in interest rates of 100 basis points would have a material effect on our operating results or financial condition. In future periods, we will continue to evaluate our investment policy relative to our overall objectives.
Currency Exchange Risk
Our consolidated results of operations and cash flows are not subject to fluctuations due to changes in foreign currency exchange rates because all of our transactions are in U.S. dollars.
Inflation Risk
We do not believe that inflation has had a material effect on our business, results of operations or financial condition. If our costs were to become subject to significant inflationary pressures, we might not be able to fully offset such higher costs through price increases. Our inability or failure to do so could adversely affect our business, results of operations and financial condition.
 
90

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
BUSINESS
Company Overview
We are an end-to-end, full-service programmatic advertising platform primarily focused on providing advertising technology, data-driven campaign optimization and other solutions to underserved and less efficient markets on both the buy- and sell-side of the digital advertising ecosystem. Direct Digital Holdings, Inc. is the holding company for the business formed by our founders in 2018 through the acquisitions of Huddled Masses and Colossus Media. Colossus Media operates our proprietary sell-side programmatic platform operating under the trademarked banner of Colossus SSP™. Huddled Masses is the platform for the buy-side of our business. In 2020 we acquired Orange142 to further bolster our overall programmatic buy-side advertising platform and enhance our offerings across multiple industry verticals such as travel, healthcare, education, financial services, consumer products, etc. with particular emphasis on small- and mid-sized businesses transitioning into digital with growing digital media budgets.
In the digital advertising space, buyers, particularly small- and mid-sized businesses, can potentially achieve significantly higher ROI on their advertising spend compared to traditional media advertising by leveraging data-driven OTT/CTV, video and display, in-app, native and audio advertisements that are delivered both at scale and on a highly targeted basis. Traditional (non-digital) advertising, such as broadcast TV or print media, follows the “spray and pray” approach to reach out to the public, but the ROI from using such traditional (non-digital) advertising campaigns is mostly unpredictable. On the other hand, digital advertising is heavily data-driven and can provide real-time details of targeted advertising campaigns and outcomes. On the sell-side, publishers can more successfully sell their advertising inventory in a programmatic manner by sharing data and information about their digital audiences at scale on an individualized basis, which helps buyers on SSPs such as our Colossus SSP to better target audiences.
[MISSING IMAGE: TM2125950D1-FC_PROGRAM4C.JPG]
We believe that we have a unique competitive advantage due to our data-driven technology that allows us to provide front-end, buy-side planning for our small- and mid-sized clients, coupled with our proprietary Colossus SSP where we can curate the last-mile in the execution process to drive higher ROI. Each month,
 
91

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
the Colossus SSP processes over 35 billion impressions and over 150 billion auction bid requests that seek to buy ad inventory from our publishers. In September 2021, Colossus SSP served over 39,386 clients. In our business and throughout this prospectus, we use the terms client and customer interchangeably.
We enable small- and mid-sized clients to leverage programmatic technology to engage their potential customers more directly, on a one-on-one basis, in any local market, with specificity to media device and footprint. Our technology leverages data to assess where our clients’ potential customers are in the decision-making process and manage campaign pacing and optimization based on data-driven analytics to drive the purchasing decision or encourage the call to action. The result is the mutual benefit to both our buy-side and sell-side clients, in that our buy-side clients enjoy a more even playing field compared to larger advertisers by driving more effective marketing and advertising in local markets that are compatible to their business footprint. In addition, our sell-side clients enjoy greater opportunity to monetize their ad inventory to new ad buyers that otherwise would be unavailable to them.
We have aligned our business strategy to capitalize on significant growth opportunities due to fundamental market shifts and industry inefficiencies. Several trends, happening in parallel, are revolutionizing the way that advertising is bought and sold. Specifically, the rise of the internet has led to a wholesale change in the way that media is consumed and monetized, as ads can be digitally delivered on a 1-to-1 basis. In traditional methods of advertising, such as broadcast TV, ads can target a specific network, program or geography, but not a single household or individual as digital and OTT/CTV ads can. Traditional television U.S. ad spending declined by 12.5% in 2020, while digital spend grew by 15% during the same period and is projected to grow approximately 25% in 2021. Additionally, we expect that the continued destabilization, including the phase out of digital “cookies” in 2023, will (i) create more opportunities for technology companies that provide next-generation CTV and digital solutions and (ii) minimize performance disruption for advertisers and agencies.
The buy-side component of our business is comprised of Huddled Masses, which has been in operation since 2012, and Orange142, which has been in operation since 2013. Both businesses offer technology-enabled advertising solutions and strategic planning to clients. In particular, our buy-side platform focuses on small-to-mid-sized clients. With marketing budgets typically more limited and operating footprints generally more local or state-to-state, we believe small- and mid-sized businesses are focused primarily on ROI-based results that deliver precise advertising and measurable campaign success to level the playing field with larger competitors. Serving the needs of hundreds of small- and mid-sized clients, with more than 4,000 campaigns annually, the buy-side of our business leverages the insights of leading DSPs, such as The Trade Desk, Xandr, Google DV360, MediaMath and others, to drive increased advertising ROI and reduced customer acquisition costs for our clients.
Colossus Media, which has been in operation since 2017, is our proprietary sell-side programmatic platform operating under the trademarked banner of Colossus SSP™. Colossus SSP is a stand-alone tech-enabled, data-driven platform that helps deliver targeted advertising to diverse and multicultural audiences, including African Americans, Latin Americans, Asian Americans and LGBTQ+ customers, as well as other specific audiences. We partner with both large publishers such as Hearst, Meredith, Gannett, Univision, and several others, as well as smaller publishers such as Ebony Magazine, People Magazine, Family Traveler, Dinero, Sailing World and many others.
Colossus SSP offers our publisher clients’ ad inventory to existing small- and mid-sized buy-side clients at Huddled Masses and Orange142, and other major DSP clients of Colossus Media, which enables our buy-side technology to curate and manage client outcomes more effectively. In addition, because it is a stand-alone platform, Colossus SSP offers its ad inventory to larger, multinational, clients seeking more authentic advertising access to unique, often diverse and multicultural, audiences.
Our proprietary Colossus SSP was custom developed with a view towards the specific challenges facing small- and mid-sized publishers with the belief that often smaller publishers offer a more engaged, highly-valued, unique following but experienced technological and budgetary constraints on the path to monetization. Connecting our buy-side business to Colossus SSP completes the end-to-end solution for our small-to-mid-sized buy-side customers while creating additional revenue opportunities for our Colossus SSP publishers.
Our business strategy on the sell-side also presents significant growth potential, as we believe we are well positioned to be able to bring underserved multicultural publishers into the advertising ecosystem,
 
92

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
thereby increasing our value proposition across all clients including our large clients. We have proprietary rights to the Colossus SSP via a license agreement with a third-party developer. We believe the Colossus SSP is the last-mile of delivery for our buy-side clients in that our technology curates unique, highly-optimized audiences informed by data analytics, artificial intelligence and algorithmic machine-learning technology, resulting in increased campaign performance.
Each impression or transaction occurs in a fraction of a second. Given that most transactions take place in an auction/bidding format, we continue to make investments across the platform to further reduce the processing time. In addition to the robust infrastructure supporting our platform, it is also critical that we align with key industry partners in the digital supply chain. The Colossus SSP is agnostic to any specific demand side platform.
We also leverage a sophisticated data management platform, which is DDH’s proprietary data collection and data marketing platform used to gather first-party data, market intelligence and audience segmentation information to support campaign optimization efforts for buy-side clients, Colossus SSP clients and third-party clients. Our combined platform offers results in an enhanced, highly loyal client base, particularly on the buy-side.
The Buy-Side Business: Huddled Masses & Orange142
The buy-side component of our business, operated through our Huddled Masses and Orange142 subsidiaries, enables us to provide the programmatic purchase of advertising on behalf of our clients. Programmatic advertising is rapidly taking market share from traditional ad sales channels, which require more staffing, offer less transparency and involve higher costs to buyers. Our buy-side platform provides the technology for first-party data management, media purchases, campaign execution and analytics, and therefore helps drive increased ROI across a wide array of digital media channels. Because our technology accesses all of the large DSP platforms, our platform is able to leverage customer insights across multiple DSPs to drive campaign performance and ROI for our clients. By taking this DSP-agnostic approach, our platform provides the broadest market access for our clients so that clients can easily buy ads on desktop, mobile, connected TV, linear TV, streaming audio and digital billboards. Additionally, our technology has unique visibility across inventory to create customized audience segments at scale. Depending on the client objective and DSP we choose, our buy-side platform provides forecasting and deep market insights to our clients to improve their return-on-advertising spend (“ROAS”) across channels.
The Sell-Side Platform: Colossus SSP
Our sell-side business maintains a proprietary platform, Colossus SSP, which is an advertising technology platform used by publishers to manage, sell and optimize available inventory (ad space) on their websites and mobile apps in an automated way. Each month, our platform processes over 35 billion impressions and over 150 billion auction bid requests that seek to buy ad inventory from our publishers. In September 2021, Colossus SSP served approximately 39,386 clients and processed more than 44 billion auction bid requests. Each impression or transaction occurs in a fraction of a second. Given that most transactions take place in an auction/bidding format, we continue to make investment across the platform to further reduce the processing time. In addition to the robust infrastructure supporting our platform, it is also critical that we align with key industry partners in the digital supply chain. The Colossus SSP is agnostic to any specific demand side platform. To that end, our proprietary Colossus SSP is integrated into several leading DSPs both directly, through Bidswitch, and indirectly, through such platforms as Xandr/AppNexus, The Trade Desk, Google 360, Verizon Media, MediaMath, Zeta Global, Samsung, Pulsepoint, Bidswitch and others. We continue to add new DSP partners especially where we believe the DSP might offer a unique advertising base seeking to target our multicultural audiences at scale. We help our advertiser clients efficiently reach diverse communities including African Americans, Latin Americans, Asian Americans and LGBTQ+ customers in highly targeted campaigns. This business began as a trading desk supporting advertisers’ desires to reach diverse audiences and has evolved into the preeminent ad tech platform to support this goal.
Our Industry and Trends
There are several key industry trends that are revolutionizing the way that advertising is bought and sold. We are well positioned to take advantage of the rapidly evolving industry trends in digital marketing and shifts in consumer behavior, including:
 
93

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
Shift to Digital Advertising.   Media has increasingly become more digital as a result of three key items:

Advances in technology with more sophisticated digital content delivery across multiple platforms;

Changes in consumer behavior, including spending longer portions of the day using mobile and other devices; and

Better audience segmentation with more efficient targeting and measurable results.
The resulting shift has enabled a variety of options for advertisers to efficiently target and measure their advertising campaigns across nearly every media channel and device. These efforts have been led by big-budgeted, large, multi-national corporations incentivized to cast a broad advertising net to support national brands. Based on eMarketer data, 65% of small- and mid-sized companies expect to increase their programmatic advertising budget, and of those companies, 12% expect to increase their advertising spending by over 25%.
Shift from Linear Broadcast to OTT/CTV.   According to eMarketer, as of the end of 2019, approximately 84 million U.S. households maintained a cable subscription which declined to approximately 78 million U.S. households at the end of 2020. However, advertising reach could access more than 104 million households via OTT/CTV channels. Consumers increasingly want the flexibility and freedom to consume content on their own terms resulting in access to premium content at lower prices and with fewer interruptions. Advertisers are recognizing these trends and reallocating their ad budgets accordingly to those companies that can access audiences through a variety of existing and new channels.
Increased Adoption of Digital Advertising by Small- and Mid-Sized Companies.   Only recently small- and mid-sized businesses have begun to leverage the power of digital media in meaningful ways, as emerging technologies have enabled advertising across multiple channels in a highly localized nature. Campaign efficiencies yielding measurable results and higher advertising ROI, as well as the needs necessitated by the COVID-19 pandemic, have prompted these companies to begin utilizing digital advertising on an accelerated pace. We believe this market is rapidly expanding, and that small-to-mid-sized advertisers will continue to increase their digital spend.
Significant Increase in Multicultural Audience and Targeted Content.   As digital media has grown and emerging marketing channels continue to gain adoption, audience segmentation, including on multicultural lines, has become more granular. A growing and increasing segment of those audiences is the multicultural audience, which has been traditionally underserved in the industry. According to the U.S. Census Bureau, racial minority and multi-racial consumers represent 42% of the U.S. population and are projected to be the numerical majority in the U.S. by 2044. When we expand the definition of multicultural to include LGBTQ+ customers, the numbers are significantly greater. Advertisers and publishers alike face the same challenge. Advertisers are seeking new avenues and opportunities to connect with multicultural audiences in their natural media consumption environments while publishers are producing unique content to attract loyal consumers. The advantage will go to those innovative companies able to directly connect both sides to those audiences and leverage the insights flowing from those connections.
Local Ad Buying Becoming More Programmatic.   Programmatic advertising enables advertisers to precisely target local audiences and increasingly an “audience of one.” Large amounts of inventory have been consolidated, allowing local advertisers to then be more selective about where, when and to whom they show their ads. The technology behind programmatic advertising, such as geotargeting, IP address identification, 1-3-5 radius store location advertising, has provided the opportunity for targeted local advertising to smaller advertisers, which technologies in the past have been more easily available to larger national advertisers. We believe being able to go into a programmatic platform and target the same audience across all digital inventory is a major competitive advantage. Additionally, we also believe that the ability to customize audiences to the needs of local providers is a significant benefit for local advertisers since they are able to deviate from the broad audience segments defined by national advertisers. Higher customer engagement translates into higher retention and extended customer lifecycle representing the opportunity to sell and upsell customers. We believe the local advertising market remains in the early stages of understanding and leveraging these capabilities.
 
94

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
Death of Cookies Will Likely Destabilize Small- to Mid-Size Business Ad Market.   As the advertising industry faces the eventual phasing out of third-party cookies, namely by Google, by 2023, small-to-mid-sized business will face potentially greater challenges in the adoption and transition to digital. While first-party data driven by first-party cookies will still have broad-based advertising support, more robust advertising efforts are expected to experience some level of performance degradation. Specifically, the inability to tie ad impressions to an identity will add to the list of challenges already being faced by small- to mid-sized businesses. We expect that the destabilization will create significant opportunities for next-generation technology companies that can provide media buying solutions and minimize performance disruption for advertisers and agencies.
The COVID-19 pandemic has put a greater focus on ROI on ad spend performance. Compared to traditional channels, digital ads are more measurable and flexible, which makes them more attractive and resilient.
(Based on data from eMarketer)
[MISSING IMAGE: TM2125950D3-BC_TOTAL4C.JPG]
Programmatic Advertising Technology (AdTech)
Advertising Technology (AdTech) consists of tools and software that enable the programmatic buying and selling of ads. Programmatic advertising is the automated system by which millions of ads can be served to millions of internet users across millions of websites in real-time. Moreover, the clicks and responses can be tracked, measured, and reported to the advertiser in real-time. The AdTech ecosystem consists of ad servers, trading desks, SSPs, DSPs, Data Management Platforms (DMP), ad networks, analytics and data suppliers.
The advertising ecosystem has two primary entities, which are the advertiser and the publisher. Advertisers’ main objectives are to produce and manage ad campaigns, target the right prospects, and track the ad spend and their results. Publishers are the owners of the websites, who are the digital equivalent of newspapers or magazines. They provide the space for ads to be shown, manage the ad inventory of different advertisers, collect campaign data and make sure that the customer experience is positive. With the entire process being dynamic and taking place in real-time, advertising technology steps in to serve as effective system serving both entities. We believe this ecosystem, which is illustrated below, produces a more efficient
 
95

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
advertising value chain through effectively reaching the consumer and driving performance. The value chain of the advertising ecosystem can be presented as follows:
[MISSING IMAGE: TM2125950D1-FC_ADVERTIS4CLR.JPG]
The Buy Side
On the buy side of the digital supply chain, digital advertising is the practice of delivering promotional content to users through various online and digital channels and leverages multiple channels, platforms such as social media, email, search engines, mobile applications and websites to display advertisements and messages to audiences. Traditional (non-digital) advertising follows the “spray and pray” approach to reach out to the public, but the ROI is mostly unpredictable. On the other hand, digital advertising is heavily data-driven and can give real-time details of advertising campaigns and outcomes. The availability of user data and rich targeting capabilities makes digital advertising an effective and important tool for businesses to connect with their audiences.
The Sell Side
On the sell side of the digital supply chain, the SSP or supply side platform is an ad technology platform used by publishers to sell, manage and optimize the ad inventory on their websites in an automated and effective way. The SSPs help the publishers monetize the display ads, video ads, native ads on their websites and mobile apps. The SSPs have enhanced their functionalities over the years and have included ad exchange mechanisms to efficiently manage their ad inventory. Also, SSPs allow the publishers to connect to DSPs directly instead of connecting through ad exchanges. This allows publishers to eliminate the ad exchanges and connect with advertisers directly to reduce the ad load time. SSPs sell ad inventories in many ways — for example, directly to ad networks, via direct deals with DSPs, and most commonly via real-time bidding (“RTB”) auctions. The publisher makes its ad inventory available on an SSP and invites advertisers to bid based on the user’s data received. Each time the publisher’s web page loads, an ad request is sent to multiple ad exchanges and, in some cases, to the demand side platform directly from the SSP. In the case of RTB media buys, many DSPs would place bids to the impressions being offered by the publisher during the auction. The advertiser that bids a higher amount compared to other advertisers will win the bid and pay the second highest price for the winning impression to serve the ads.
COVID-19 Industry Impact
The onset of the COVID-19 pandemic caused a material reduction in advertising spending across all channels. Advertising spending is estimated to have decreased 30-50% during the height of the lockdown with ad budgets reduced due to economic shock (e.g., lodging, restaurants) and the cancellation of major events (e.g., concerts, Olympics). The linear TV segment was among the hardest hit as small- and medium-sized business owners cut back on local broadcast and cable advertising, cable networks couldn’t air live sports, and the production of content ground to a halt. Cord cutting, the practice of ending a cable or satellite television service, is also expected to remain elevated. Research conducted by The Trade Desk estimated that
 
96

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
approximately 27% of U.S. households would end their cable TV subscription by the end of 2021, roughly nine times the rate of cord cutting over the last few years. The CTV and AVOD channels, which include televisions with integrated internet and ad-based streaming services, held up the best during the pandemic, but these channels remain less than 3% of total TV advertising spend. Overall, the industry is seeing an accelerated shift of advertisement spending from the tradition linear television channel to digital channels such as CTV and AVOD.
Our Customers
On the buy-side of our business, our customers consist of purchasers of programmatic advertising inventory. We had approximately 150 and 158 direct customers during the year ended December 31, 2020 and the nine months ended September 30, 2021, respectively, consisting of advertising buyers, including small- and mid-sized companies, large advertising holding companies (which may manage several agencies), independent advertising agencies and mid-market advertising service organizations. However, we work on over 4,000 campaigns annually, as many advertising agencies and advertising holding companies have decision-making that is generally highly decentralized, such that purchasing decisions are made, and relationships with advertisers are located, at the agency, local branch or division level. We serve a variety of customers across multiple industries including travel/tourism (including destination marketing organizations or DMOs), energy, consumer packaged goods (“CPG”) healthcare, education, financial services (including cryptocurrency technologies) and other industries. Some of the significant brands we work with on the buy-side include Curo, the U.S. Army, Just Energy, Bitcoin Depot, Visit Virginia Beach, Visit Colorado Springs and Pigeon Forge.
On the sell-side of our business, the Colossus SSP, the buyers on our platform include DSPs, agencies and individual advertisers. We have broad exposure to the ecosystem of buyers, reaching on average approximately 15,400 advertisers per month in 2020, which has increased to approximately 56,025 per month during the nine months ended September 30, 2021. As spending on programmatic advertising increasingly becomes a larger share of the overall ad spend, advertisers and agencies are seeking greater control of their digital advertising supply chains. To take advantage of this industry shift, we have entered into SPO agreements directly with buyers. As part of these agreements, we are providing advertisers and agencies with benefits ranging from custom data and workflow integrations, product features, volume-based business terms, and visibility into campaign performance data and methodology. As a result of these direct relationships, our existing advertisers and agencies are incentivized to allocate an increasing percentage of their advertising budgets to our platform.
Our Competitive Strengths
We believe the following attributes and capabilities form our core strengths and provide us with competitive advantages:

End-to-End, Technology-Driven Solution Focused on Providing Higher Value to Underserved Markets. Our small- and mid-sized client base is seeking high ROI, low customer acquisition costs and measurable results that grow their topline. Because we focus exclusively on the first and last miles of media delivery, we engage clients at the front-end of the digital supply chain with the first dollar of spend, in many cases prior to agency involvement, and drive data-driven results across the digital advertising ecosystem to optimize ROI. We offer an end-to-end solution that enables us to set and carry-out the digital campaign strategy of our clients in full, in a more efficient and less expensive manner than some of our competitors. Small- and mid-sized companies are looking for partners that can drive results across the entire digital supply chain. On the Colossus SSP, we offer a wide range of niche and general market publishers an opportunity to maximize advertising revenue driven by technology-enabled targeted advertising to multicultural and other audiences. We believe our technology’s ability to tailor our efforts to our clients-specific needs and inform those efforts with data and algorithmic learnings is a long-term advantage to serving this end of the market.

Comprehensive Processes Enhance Ad Inventory Quality and Reduce Invalid Traffic.   We operate what we believe to be one of the most comprehensive processes in the digital advertising ecosystem to enhance ad inventory quality. In August 2021, Colossus SSP was ranked by MediaMath as 4th among the industry’s approximately 80 supply-side companies in terms of key quality measures such as
 
97

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
transparency, fraud detection, and accountability. In the advertising industry, inventory quality is assessed in terms of IVT, which can be impacted by fraud such as “fake eyeballs” generated by automated technologies set up to artificially inflate impression counts. As a result of our platform design and proactive IVT mitigation efforts, in 2020, less than 1% of inventory was determined to be invalid, resulting in minimal financial impact to our customers. We address IVT on a number of fronts, including: sophisticated technology, which detects and avoids invalid traffic on the front end; direct publisher and inventory relationships, for supply path optimization; and ongoing campaign and inventory performance review, to ensure inventory quality and brand protection controls are in place.

Curated Data-Driven Sell-Side Platform to Support Buy-Side.   The Colossus SSP enables us to gather data to build and develop unique product offerings for our clients. The ability to curate our supply allows us to serve a broad range of clients with challenging and unique advertising needs and optimize campaign performance in a way that our siloed competitors are unable to do. This model, together with our infrastructure solutions and ability to quickly access excess server capacity, helps us scale up efficiently and allows us to grow our business at a faster pace than a pure buy-side solution would. In addition, our clients can easily buy targeted data from over 150 sources through our platform. We also provide clients access to our proprietary data through our data management platform, which only increases with continued use of our platform. We believe that the integration of data and decisioning within a single platform enables us to better serve our clients.

High Client Retention Rate and Cross Selling Opportunities.   During the nine months ended September 30, 2021, we had approximately 158 clients on the buy-side through 1,824 different campaigns and 56,025 clients on the sell-side. They understand the independent nature of our platform and relentless focus on driving ROI-based results. Our value proposition is complete alignment across our entire digital supply platform beginning with the first dollar in and last dollar out. We are technology and media agnostic, and our clients trust us to provide the best opportunity for success of their brands and businesses. As a result, our clients have been loyal, with over 90% client retention for the clients that represent approximately 80% of our revenues. In addition, we cultivate client relationships through our pipeline of moderate and self-serve clients that conduct campaigns within our platform that eventually grow into managed service clients, which has resulted in their increased use of our platform over time. As our clients expand their usage of our technology platform, they often transition to our managed services delivery model, which in turn drives increased client loyalty. The managed services delivery model allows us to combine our technology with a highly personalized offering to strategically design and manage advertising campaigns, provide ad hoc support and recommend strategy adjustments as needed.

Growing and Profitable Business Model.   We have grown our revenue steadily and profitably, which we believe demonstrates the power of our technology platform, the strength of our client relationships and the leverage inherent to our business model. For the year ended December 31, 2020, our sell-side advertising revenue increased to $2.8 million compared to $0.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2019, or an increase of 253%. For the nine months ended September 30, 2021, our sell-side advertising revenue increased to $5.3 million compared to $1.5 million for the nine months ended September 31, 2020, or an increase of 251%. On September 30, 2020, we acquired Orange142 to further bolster our overall buy-side advertising platform and enhance our offerings across multiple industry verticals such as travel, healthcare, education, financial services, consumer products and others, with particular emphasis on small- and mid-sized businesses transitioning into digital with growing digital media budgets. For the years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019, our net loss was flat at $(0.9) million for both periods. For the nine months ended September 30, 2021, net income was $0.6 million compared to net loss of $(0.4) million for the same period in 2020. For the year ended December 31, 2020, Adjusted EBITDA increased to $0.6 million compared to Adjusted EBTIDA of $(0.9) million for the year ended December 31, 2019, an increase of $1.5 million, or 171%. For the nine months ended September 30, 2021, Adjusted EBITDA increased to $4.5 million compared to Adjusted EBITDA of $(0.1) million for the nine months ended September 30, 2020 (see “Prospectus Summary — Non-GAAP Financial Measures” for more information about our use of non-GAAP financial measures).
 
98

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 

Solutions for the Destabilization of Advertising.   As a result of the impending phase out of third-party cookies by 2023 by Google, we have begun integrating identity resolution solutions in order to provide our clients with accurate, targeted advertising without cookies. These solutions provide higher CPM (cost per thousand impressions) advertising, thus resulting in higher revenues. Leveraging our third-party technology providers, our technology has a potential reach of over 250 million matched people online and is powered by over 600 million unique online authentication events per month. To cater to the need for precision and scale, we will be investing in artificial intelligence and machine learning technology to build out our own collection of identities, often referred to as an “ID Lake,” from first-party and third-party data sources, that will facilitate matches and relations between the disparate sets of data.

Experienced Management Team.   Our management team, led by our two founders, has significant experience in the digital advertising industry and with identifying and integrating acquired businesses. Specifically, our two founders, Chairman and Chief Executive Officer Mark Walker and President Keith Smith, have over 45 years of combined experience. The team has led digital marketing efforts for companies both large and small, with unique experience leading small- and mid-sized companies through the challenges of transitioning platforms into the programmatic advertising space. Our Chief Technology Officer, Anu Pillai, is experienced in developing digital platforms on both the buy-side and sell-side, ranging from CPG companies focused on e-commerce to publishers seeking to monetize their ad inventory. Our Chief Financial Officer, Susan Echard, a former senior auditor at Ernst & Young LLP, has significant experience working with public companies directly as well a strong background with mergers and acquisitions.

ESG-Centered Strategy.   We believe our business strategy promotes the ideals of an ESG-based business with particular focus on social and governance issues. Our unique focus has already resulted in numerous partnerships with both large and small advertisers as the multicultural market continues to grow and expand.
Social, Diversity and Governance
We believe it is essential for our organization, from top to bottom, to understand and relate to the issues our clients face on both the buy-side and sell-side. Our founding owners are of African-American descent and founded our Company on multicultural principles designed to alleviate the challenges that buyers and publishers face accessing an expansive multicultural market. Our management team reflects the tone and tenor of our multicultural audiences and our policies on gender equality and gender pay. More than 70% of our management are women and/or identify as being from a diverse background, including all four of our executive officers.
Environmental
Our platform requires significant amounts of information to be stored across multiple servers and we anticipate those amounts to increase significantly as we grow. We are committed to ensuring that we incorporate environmental excellence in our business mindset. Energy use, recycling practices and resource conservation are a few of the factors we take into consideration in building our technological infrastructure, selecting IT partners, and utilizing key suppliers. In the first quarter of 2022, we expect to transition our server platform to HPE Greenlake, which is centered on environmentally-friendly operations and marketed as “Greenlake-as-a-service,” through which we promote its energy conservation principles. We opted for HPE GreenLake’s as-a-service model because it represents a shift towards supplier responsibility for the elimination of wasted infrastructure and processing capacity. Our needs are metered and monitored, providing insights that can lead to significant resource and energy efficiencies by avoiding overprovisioning and optimizing the IT refresh cycle. This enables us to bring existing equipment to the highest levels of utilization and to eliminate idling equipment that drains energy and resources, yielding both environmental and financial savings.
Our Growth Strategy
We have a multi-pronged growth strategy designed to continue to build upon the momentum we have generated so far in order to create opportunities. Our key growth strategies include our plans to:

Continue to expand our highly productive “on the ground” buy-side and sell-side sales teams throughout the United States, with a particular focus on markets where we believe our client base is underserved.
 
99

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 

Utilize management’s experience to identify and close additional acquisition opportunities to accelerate expansion into new industry verticals, grow market share and enhance platform innovation capabilities.

Leveraging our end-to-end product offering as a differentiating factor to win new business and cross-sell to existing clients.

Aggressively grow the Colossus SSP advertising inventory, including both multicultural and general inventory. We aim to increase our omni-channel capabilities to focus on highest growth content formats such as OTT/CTV audio (such as podcasts, etc.), in-app and others.

Continued innovation and development of our data management platform and proprietary ID Lake and collection of first-party data to inform decision-making and optimize client campaigns.

Invest in further optimization of our infrastructure and technology solutions to maximize revenue and operating efficiencies.
Revenues
We generate revenues through a broad range of offerings throughout our technology platforms. On the buy-side of our business, our technology drives the design and execution of advertising strategies across an array of digital channels including programmatic display, social, paid search, mobile, native, email, video advertising, OTT/CTV, audio, digital out-of-home (“DOOH”) and more. In the world’s constantly shifting and expanding digital landscape, where it is easy for “set it and leave it” mentalities and impersonal algorithms to steer digital advertising campaigns, our data-driven technologies enable customized ROI-focused outcomes for our clients. Our team is made up of savvy digital strategists, skilled software developers, experienced ad buyers or traders, expert technicians and data analysts. We have a wide variety of small- and mid-sized companies representing numerous industry verticals such as travel, healthcare, education, financial services, and consumer goods and services. We are typically engaged on an “insertion order” or master services agreement, with the typical engagement driven by the campaign goals of the client. For the mid-sized clients, we typically engage on a long-term contractual basis ranging from one to five years, while our smaller clients tend to engage on a shorter duration of less than one year despite the fact that many of our smaller clients have been long term clients well in excess of one year.
On the sell-side of our business, through our proprietary Colossus SSP, we generate revenues by enabling programmatic media buyers to buy ad inventory from our host of publishers and content creators aggregated to provide access to buyers at scale. Advertisers and agencies often have a large portfolio of brands requiring a variety of campaign types and support for a wide array of inventory formats and devices, including OTT/CTV, video and display, in-app, native and audio. Our omni-channel proprietary technology platform is designed to maximize these various advertising channels, which we believe is a further driver of efficiency for our buyers. As of June 1, 2021, the platform is comprised of publishers across multiple channels including OTT/CTV, display, native, in-app, online video (“OLV”), audio and DOOH. Through our platform, media buyers are able to buy more than 2 billion daily impressions across many unique audiences including multicultural audiences at scale with 20% of those impressions being diverse and multicultural-focused, including African Americans, Latin Americans, Asian Americans and LGBTQ+ customers. We charge a standard fee to our publishers for providing access to a host of media buyers on a daily basis. Our publishers, through our platform, had access to more than 56,000 buyers of ad inventory in September 2021. We have a sales team working on behalf of our publishers to enlist more ad buyers across all media channels to generate more revenue for our publishers. The Colossus SSP continues to expand its capabilities to give our content providers more avenues to distribute ad inventory such as OTT/CTV, digital audio, DOOH, etc. and inform our publishers to enhance their ad selling needs by distributing content in various forms to meet the rising demands of the ad buying community.
Marketing, Sales, and Distribution
Our sales organization focuses on marketing our technology solution to increase the adoption of our products by existing and new buyers and sellers. We market our products and services to buyers and sellers through our national sales team that operates from various locations across the United States. This team leverages market knowledge and expertise to demonstrate the benefits of programmatic advertising and
 
100

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
how we can drive better performance and results for our clients. We are focused on expanding our national sales presence primarily by growing our sales personnel presence in certain states and regions around the country in which we currently operate and/or seeking to establish a presence. We typically seek to add experienced sales personnel with an established track record and/or verifiable book of business and client relationships.
For the buy-side platform, our sales team has three fundamental components: (1) a consulting services team that advises clients on a more enterprise level in the design and implementation of a digital media strategy; (2) a professional services team with each seller integration to assist sellers in getting the most value from our solution; and (3) our client services team that works closely with clients to manage and/or support campaigns. For Colossus SSP, our professional services team manages each new DSP or publisher/seller integration while the buyer team focuses on the unique challenges and issues arising with our inventory buys.
Our marketing initiatives are focused on managing our brand, increasing market awareness and driving advertising spend to our platform. We often present at industry conferences, create custom events and invest in public relations. In addition, our marketing team advertises online and in other forms of media, creates case studies, sponsors research, writes whitepapers, publishes marketing collateral, generates blog posts and undertakes client research studies.
Competition
Buy-Side Competition
The buy-side digital advertising industry is a very competitive, fast-paced industry with ongoing technological changes, new market entrants and behavioral changes in content consumption. Overall digital advertising spending historically has been highly concentrated in a small number of very large companies that have their own inventory, including Google, Facebook, Comcast, Verizon, AT&T and Amazon, with which we compete for digital advertising inventory and demand. Despite the dominance of large companies, there is still a large addressable market that is highly fragmented and includes many providers of transaction services with which we compete. There has been rapid evolution and consolidation in the advertising technology industry, and we expect these trends to continue, thereby increasing the capabilities and competitive posture of larger companies, particularly those that are already dominant in various ways, and enabling new or stronger competitors to emerge. Based on the current focus of our competitors, there is even more opportunity for engagement in the underserved and multicultural markets on which we focus.
Sell-Side Competition
On the sell-side of the digital advertising industry, competition is robust but more limited in that there were approximately 80 current SSPs in operation as of December 2020, according to Media Math. We continue to refine our offering so that it remains competitive in scope, ease of use, scalability, speed, data access, price, inventory quality, brand security, customer service, identity protection and other technological features that help sellers monetize their inventory and buyers increase the return on their advertising investment. While our industry is evolving rapidly and becoming increasingly competitive, we believe that our solution enables us to compete favorably on these factors. We achieve this by ensuring that we have the right integrations and implementations in place. Our traffic verification partner is directly integrated within our exchange to ensure inventory quality on a real-time basis. We partner with an accredited Media Rating Council vendor to provide an added layer of security through sophisticated IVT detection and filtration. Our verification with the Trustworthy Accountability Group indicates our status as a trusted player in the digital advertising ecosystem. Through our direct integration with The Media Trust’s Creative Quality Assurance (QA) product, we detect and eliminate the serving of malicious ads in real time, and by transacting on a universal cookie ID, consumers are served more relevant ads, advertisers reach more valuable users and publishers can match their audience data. In the end, we believe these factors enable our sales team to promote the advantages of our platform and drive greater adoption of Colossus SSP.
Seasonality in Our Business
In the advertising industry, companies commonly experience seasonal fluctuations in revenue. For example, many advertisers allocate the largest portion of their budgets to the fourth quarter of the calendar
 
101

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
year in order to coincide with increased holiday purchasing. Historically, the second and third quarters of the year reflect our highest levels of advertising activity and the first quarter reflects the lowest level of such activity. We expect our revenue to continue to fluctuate based on seasonal factors that affect the advertising industry as a whole.
Employees
As of September 30, 2021, we had 52 employees, all of whom are full-time employees. None of our employees are currently covered by a collective bargaining agreement. We have no labor-related work stoppages and believe our relations with our employees are good. We promote a diverse workforce and believe that it fosters innovation and cultivates an environment filled with unique perspectives. As a result, diversity and inclusion are part and parcel of our ability to meet the needs of our customers. Respect for human rights and a commitment to ethical business conduct are fundamental to our business model. In addition, we measure employee engagement on an ongoing basis, as we believe an engaged workforce leads to a more innovative, productive and profitable company. We obtain feedback from our employees to implement programs and processes designed to keep our employees connected with the Company.
Government Regulation
Privacy and data protection legislation and regulation play a significant role in our business. The U.S. Congress and state legislatures, along with federal regulatory authorities, have recently increased their attention to matters concerning the collection and use of consumer data, including in the area of internet-based advertising. These authorities have enacted or are considering enacting legislation that could significantly restrict our ability to collect, augment, analyze, use and share data collected through cookies and similar technologies, such as by regulating the level of consumer notice and consent required before a company can employ cookies or other electronic tools to track people online.
Digital advertising in the United States has mostly been subject to regulation by the FTC pursuant to Section 5 of the Federal Trade Commission Act, which prohibits companies from engaging in “unfair” or “deceptive” trade practices. The FTC has also commenced the examination of privacy issues that arise when marketers track consumers across multiple devices, otherwise known as cross-device tracking.
Data privacy legislation has also been introduced by individual states. First, California has enacted broad-based privacy legislation known as the CCPA. The CCPA came into force on January 1, 2020 and requires covered companies to, among other things, provide new disclosures to California consumers and grant such consumers a new right to opt-out of “sales” of personal information, a concept that is defined broadly. The CCPA is also subject to regulations issued by the California Attorney General, which were finalized and became effective in August 2020. The California Privacy Rights and Enforcement Act (“CPRA”), which was passed as a ballot initiative in November 2020 and comes into effect on January 1, 2023, expands upon the CCPA and, among other things, creates new categories of personal information with additional protections, creates new data subject rights such as a right of correction, creates a new state rulemaking and enforcement agency for the CPRA, expands potential liability for violations and gives consumers rights to opt out of additional forms of data sharing with third parties. It remains unclear how aspects of the CCPA (as amended by the CPRA) or its implementing regulations will be interpreted.
In March 2021, Virginia Governor Ralph Northam signed the Virginia Consumer Data Protection Act (“VCDPA”) into law, making Virginia the second state in the nation to enact comprehensive data privacy legislation. The VCDPA resembles and adopts some of the framework from the CCPA, the CPRA (which, as noted above, will amend and expand the CCPA), and the General Data Protection Regulation (“GDPR”). However, the VCDPA contains a number of unique provisions as well. For example, unlike the CCPA and CPRA, the VCDPA leaves enforcement entirely up to the Attorney General and does not provide a private right of action for consumers.
In addition to regulations in the United States, some of our operations may subject us to data privacy laws outside the United States. For example, in the EU, the GDPR took effect on May 25, 2018 and regulates transfers of personal data (subject to such laws) from the European Economic Area (“EEA”) and the UK to the U.S. as well as other third countries outside the EEA and the UK which are deemed not to provide adequate standards of data protection to the levels required by the GDPR. The GDPR and and its UK
 
102

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
equivalent commonly referred to as “UK GDPR” also impose numerous privacy-related obligations and requirements for companies operating in the EU and the UK, including requiring data controllers not to transfer personal data to U.S.-based processors unless they agree to certain legally binding processing obligations, greater control for data subjects (for example, the “right to be forgotten”), increased data portability for EU and UK consumers, data breach notification requirements and exposure to substantial fines for non-compliance.
Facilities
Our headquarters are located in Houston, Texas, where we occupy a facility with approximately 2,500 square feet under a lease that expires in June 2022. We have permanent offices and/or a co-work office presence in four other office locations across the United States: Austin, Atlanta, New York and Colorado Springs. These offices or workspaces are leased, and we do not own any real property. We believe that our current facilities are adequate to meet our needs for the immediate future, and that, should it be needed, suitable additional space will be available to accommodate any expansion of our operations.
Intellectual Property
The protection of our technology and intellectual property is an important component of our success. We rely on intellectual property laws, including trade secret, copyright, patent and trademark laws in the U.S. and abroad, and use contracts, confidentiality procedures, non-disclosure agreements, employee disclosure and invention assignment agreements and other contractual rights to protect our intellectual property.
We own intellectual property related to our owned sites. As of September 30, 2021, we owned approximately four websites and URLs in varying stages of development to support our marketers advertising efforts. We also hold six U.S. registered trademarks and one pending trademark registration application.
Legal Proceedings
As of the date hereof, we are not a party to any material legal or administrative proceedings. There are no proceedings in which any of our directors, executive officers or affiliates, or any registered or beneficial stockholder, is an adverse party or has a material interest adverse to our interest. We may from time to time be subject to various legal or administrative claims and proceedings arising in the ordinary course of business. Litigation or any other legal or administrative proceeding, regardless of the outcome, is likely to result in substantial cost and diversion of our resources, including our management’s time and attention.
 
103

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
MANAGEMENT
Executive Officers and Directors
The following table sets forth information regarding our executive officers and directors as of the date of this prospectus:
Name
Age
Position
Mark Walker
46
Chairman and Chief Executive Officer
Keith Smith
53
President and Director
Susan Echard
57
Chief Financial Officer
Anu Pillai
51
Chief Technology Officer
Richard Cohen
70
Independent Director
Antoinette R. Leatherberry
60
Independent Director
Executive Officers
Mark D. Walker.   Mr. Walker became our Chairman and Chief Executive Officer on August 23, 2021 and, from 2018 until the completion of the Organizational Transactions, served in the role of Managing Partner of the Company. Prior to founding Direct Digital Holdings with Mr. Smith, Mr. Walker worked at CVG Group, LLC, (“CVG Group”) a private equity firm, from October 2016 to May 2019 as the Chief Operating Officer responsible for the operations of the portfolio companies within CVG Group’s holdings. In this role, he was the Acting COO for Ebony Media Operations, (“Ebony Media”) where he was responsible for initiating and overseeing the digital transformation of Ebony Media from a print publication to a digital-first organization. Prior to CVG Group and Ebony Media, he worked for the largest retail electricity provider within the United States, NRG Energy, from 2005 to 2016, in positions of progressively increasing scope and responsibility. While at NRG Energy, he built multiple revenue streams through digital, retail and business development activities while increasing overall revenue to NRG Energy, where he represented approximately 40% of new revenue of NRG Energy Home division. Mr. Walker brings nearly 20 years of experience building relationships and revenue generating operations for Fortune 500 corporations, working in business development and marketing for Deloitte, and startup organizations. Throughout his career, Mr. Walker has sat on multiple advisory boards within the industry, such as Hitwise and Dentsu Aegis, and has written multiple articles and case studies that have been showcased in Jupiter Research and Search Engine Watch. We believe that Mr. Walker is qualified to serve as a member of our board of directors because of the perspective and experience he brings as our Chief Executive Officer and a founder of the Company, as well as his other extensive executive experience. Mr. Walker holds a B.A. in Economics from The University of Texas and was a member of the Board of Directors of the University of Texas Alumni Association.
Keith W. Smith.   Mr. Smith is a co-founder of the Company and became our President on August 23, 2021 and, from 2018 until the completion of the Organizational Transactions, served in the role of Managing Partner of the Company. Prior to founding Direct Digital Holdings, Mr. Smith was a Managing Partner at Parkview Advisors, LLC, and President and CEO of Parkview Capital Credit, Inc., from November 2014 to April 2020, where he invested and managed more than $75 million with small-and mid-sized businesses to provide acquisition and growth capital. Prior to Parkview, Mr. Smith served as Managing Director for a private equity, direct lending platform, Capital Point Partners, where he invested and managed more than $150 million in direct lending first lien, second lien and mezzanine investments, as well as complimentary minority equity investments. Prior to Capital Point Partners, he worked for Rabobank International (“RI”) from 2006 to 2009, where he was a Vice President and Portfolio Manager of more than $2 billion in direct lending and structured credit bank assets for one of the company’s special investment vehicles. He played a key role in originating new client transactions as well as managing a book of existing bank clients. Prior to RI, he was an Associate Director in the Structured Finance Group of Standard & Poor’s from 2003 to 2006, where he analyzed and rated transactions across a broad spectrum of asset types. In addition to his investment banking background, Mr. Smith also has over six years of legal experience as an attorney and has served on the boards of numerous portfolio companies. We believe that Mr. Smith is qualified to serve as a member of our board of directors because of the perspective and experience he brings as our Chief Financial Officer and a co-founder of the Company, as well as his other executive experience and financial, investment
 
104

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
and management experience. Mr. Smith holds a B.A. in Economics from The University of Texas at Austin; a J.D. from Southern Methodist University; and an M.B.A. from The Olin School of Business at Washington University in St. Louis.
Anu Pillai.    Anu Pillai was named Chief Technology Officer of Direct Digital Holdings in March 2021. Ms. Pillai brings extensive experience in defining and executing new product development solutions as well as large enterprise IT implementations and has successfully led global projects with complete responsibility for cross-functional teams in program management, product design, software development, system architecture, integration and implementation. Prior to serving at Digital Direct Holdings, Ms. Pillai held executive positions and led digital transformations at several companies, including BLK/OPL, a direct-to-consumer e-commerce cosmetic brand, from 2019 to 2021, where she served as SVP, Digital Technology & Ecommerce, and Ebony Media, publisher of the iconic EBONY magazine, from 2011 to 2019, where she served as SVP, Digital Technology & Monetization. She was responsible at both of these companies for the execution of all technology and digital initiatives including system design and architecture, development, project management, resource planning of onsite/offshore resources and monetization across all digital properties with specific emphasis on increasing revenues through various programmatic channels. Prior to that, Ms. Pillai held leadership roles with leading Fortune 50 technology and infrastructure companies, such as General Electric, from 2005 to 2007, where she served as an IT leaser; Intel Corporation, from 2000 to 2003, where she served as a Senior Software Engineer; and Motorola, from 1996 to 1998, where she served as an analyst, and we believe she has proven experience in managing and leading small and large global development teams with technology resources spread across the U.S., China, Mexico and India. Ms. Pillai holds a B.S. in Computer Science and Engineering from Bharathiar in India.
Susan Echard.   Susan Echard became our Chief Financial Officer in May 2021 while serving as a consultant at SeatonHill LLC (“SeatonHill”), where she was employed from February 2021 until joining the Company as a full time employee in January 2022. Prior to SeatonHill, Ms. Echard served as the Chief Financial Officer at Trinity Capital Inc., a Business Development Corporation, and, in such capacity, was responsible for all aspects of the firm’s financial matters, investor relations, legal and human resource management. Prior to joining Trinity, Ms. Echard served as the Chief Financial Officer at CUBEX LLC, a medical, dental and veterinary inventory management company, from 2017 to 2019. From 2016 to 2017, she served as the Chief Financial Officer at Datashield, a data security services company, and from 2015 to 2016, she served as the Corporate Controller at BeyondTrust, a provider of privileged access and identity management and data security. Prior to that, she served as Corporate Controller at AFS Technologies, Inc., a provider of software solutions for consumer goods companies, from 2014 to 2015, and was formerly a senior auditor at Ernst & Young LLP. Ms. Echard has over 30 years of accounting experience. She holds a Bachelor of Business Administration degree from the University of Michigan.
Non-Employee Directors
Richard Cohen.   Mr. Cohen became a member of our board of directors in November 2021. He has served as President of Richard M Cohen Consultants since 1996, where he provides corporate financial consulting services to a number of clients. Mr. Cohen served as Founder and Managing Partner of Chord Advisors from March 2012 to July 2015, a firm providing outsourced CFO services to both public and private companies. Prior to founding Chord Advisors, Mr. Cohen served as the Interim CEO, and as a member of the board of directors, of CorMedix Inc., from March 2012 to July 2015. Mr. Cohen has also served as a partner with Novation Capital from July 2001 to August 2012 until its sale to a private equity firm. He has served as a member of numerous boards and committees, including as a member of the audit committee of Rodman and Renshaw, an investment banking firm, from July 2008 to August 2012, and as a member of the board of directors of 20/20 GeneSystems Inc., a private company in the digital diagnostics sector, since 2018; Ondas Networks, Inc., a public company which provides private wireless data and drone solutions, since 2016; and Helix BioMedix, a former public company specializing in dermatology and consumer products, since 2005, where he has also served as a member of the audit committee. We believe that Mr. Cohen is qualified to serve as a member of our board of directors because of his extensive financial experience, as well as his leadership and management skills gained from his prior board experience. He holds a B.S. with honors in Economics from the University of Pennsylvania Wharton School and an M.B.A. from Stanford University.
Antoinette R. Leatherberry.   Ms. Leatherberry became a member of our board of directors in November 2021. Ms. Leatherberry retired from Deloitte, a consulting, audit, tax and advisory services
 
105

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
company, in September 2020, where she served in a number of roles during her 30-year career, including Board Relations Leader for the Risk and Financial Advisory practice, from September 2017 to September 2020, and Principal, Technology Strategy, from 2008 to August 2017. She also served as President of the Deloitte Foundation, from 2016 until her retirement. Ms. Leatherberry has served as a member of the board of directors, audit committee, and human resource committee of Zoetis Inc., a public animal health company, since December 2020, and as a member of the board of directors, the nominating and governance committee, and the compensation committee of American Family Insurance Mutual Holding Company, Inc., a private mutual company, since January 2021. She has also served on the Widener University Board of Trustees, since 2015, and the Boston University Board of Trustees since September 2020. She previously served as chair of The Executive Leadership Council from January 2019 until December 2020. We believe that Ms. Leatherberry is qualified to serve as a member of our board of directors because of her extensive experience with complex technology transformations, her strategic digital technology experience, and her corporate governance expertise. She holds a B.S. in Mechanical Engineering from Boston University and an M.B.A. in Operations Management and Supervision from Northeastern University.
Family Relationships
There are no family relationships between or among any of our directors or executive officers.
Board Composition and Risk Oversight
Our board of directors is currently composed of four members. two of our directors are independent within the meaning of the listing requirements and rules of the Nasdaq Capital Market. Our certificate of incorporation and bylaws will provide that the number of our directors shall be fixed from time to time by resolution of our board of directors. There are no family relationships between or among any of our directors or executive officers.
Our board of directors has an active role, as a whole and also at the committee level, in overseeing the management of our risks. Our board of directors is responsible for general oversight of risks and regular review of information regarding our risks, including credit risks, liquidity risks and operational risks. Our compensation committee is responsible for overseeing the management of risks relating to our executive compensation plans and arrangements. Our audit committee is responsible for overseeing the management of our risks relating to accounting matters and financial reporting. Our nominating and corporate governance committee is responsible for overseeing the management of our risks associated with the independence of our board of directors and potential conflicts of interest. While each committee is responsible for evaluating certain risks and overseeing the management of such risks, our entire board of directors is regularly informed through discussions from committee members about such risks. Our board of directors believes its administration of its risk oversight function has not affected our board of directors’ leadership structure.
Director Independence
We have applied to list our Class A common stock on the Nasdaq Capital Market under the symbol “DRCT.” Under the rules of the Nasdaq Capital Market, independent directors must comprise a majority of a listed company’s board of directors within a specified period of the completion of this offering. In addition, the rules require that, subject to specified exceptions, each member of a listed company’s audit, compensation and nominating and corporate governance committees be independent. Audit committee members must also satisfy the independence criteria set forth in Rule 10A-3 under the Exchange Act (“Rule 10A-3”). Under the rules of the Nasdaq Capital Market, a director will only qualify as an “independent director” if, in the opinion of that company’s board of directors, that person does not have a relationship that would interfere with the exercise of independent judgment in carrying out the responsibilities of a director.
To be considered independent for purposes of Rule 10A-3, a member of an audit committee of a listed company may not, other than in his or her capacity as a member of the audit committee, the board of directors or any other board committee: (1) accept, directly or indirectly, any consulting, advisory or other compensatory fee from the listed company or any of its subsidiaries; or (2) be an affiliated person of the listed company or any of its subsidiaries. We intend to rely on the phase-in rules of Rule 10A-3 and the Nasdaq listing requirements with respect to the requirement that the audit committee be composed entirely of members
 
106

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
of our board of directors who satisfy the standards of independence established for independent directors under the Nasdaq rules and the additional independence standards applicable to audit committee members established pursuant to Rule 10A-3, as determined by our board of directors. We expect that by the first anniversary of our listing on Nasdaq, our audit committee will comply with the applicable independence requirements.
In January 2022, our board of directors undertook a review of its composition, the composition of its committees and the independence of our directors and considered whether any director has a material relationship with us that could compromise his or her ability to exercise independent judgment in carrying out his or her responsibilities. Based upon information requested from and provided by each director concerning his or her background, employment and affiliations, including family relationships, our board of directors has determined that none of our non-employee directors has a relationship that would interfere with the exercise of independent judgment in carrying out the responsibilities of a director and that each of these non-employee directors is “independent” as that term is defined under the rules of the Nasdaq Capital Market. In January 2022, our board of directors also determined that Mr. Cohen and Ms. Leatherberry, each of whom will sit on our audit committee, compensation committee and nominating and corporate governance committee, satisfy the independence standards for those committees established by applicable SEC rules and the rules of the Nasdaq Capital Market. In making this determination, our board of directors considered the relationships that each non-employee director has with us and all other facts and circumstances our board of directors deemed relevant in determining their independence, including the beneficial ownership of our capital stock by each non-employee director.
Board Leadership Structure
Mr. Walker, our Chief Executive Officer, is also the Chairman of our board of directors. Our board of directors determined that, at the present time, having our Chief Executive Officer also serve as the Chairman of our board of directors provides us with optimally effective leadership and is in our best interests and those of our stockholders. Mr. Walker co-founded the Company, and our board of directors believes that Mr. Walker’s years of management experience in our industry as well as his extensive understanding of our business, operations and strategy make him well qualified to serve as Chairman of our board of directors.
The Company’s Corporate Governance Guidelines provide our board of directors with flexibility to select the appropriate leadership structure at a particular time based on what our board of directors determines to be in the best interests of the Company. The Company’s Corporate Governance Guidelines provide that our board of directors has no established policy with respect to combining or separating the offices of chairman of the board of directors and principal executive officer.
In January 2022, our board of directors appointed Ms. Leatherberry to serve as our lead independent director. As lead independent director, Ms. Leatherberry presides over periodic meetings of our independent directors, serves as a liaison between the chairman of our board of directors and the independent directors and performs such additional duties as our board of directors may otherwise determine and delegate.
Committees of our Board of Directors
Our board of directors has established three standing committees: an audit committee, a compensation committee and a nominating and corporate governance committee, each of which has the composition and responsibilities described below. Following the closing of this offering, each committee’s charter will be posted on the investor relations section of our website. Directors serve on these committees until their resignation or until otherwise determined by our board of directors. Our board of directors may establish other committees as it deems necessary or appropriate from time to time.
Audit Committee
Our audit committee consists of Messrs. Cohen and Walker and Ms. Leatherberry. Under the Nasdaq listing rules and Rule 10A-3, the audit committee is required to be comprised of at least three directors who meet certain independence and experience standards, subject to transitional relief during the one-year period following the completion of an initial public offering. Our audit committee will initially consist of three directors. Our board of directors has determined that each of Mr. Cohen and Ms. Leatherberry satisfy
 
107

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
the independence requirements under the Nasdaq listing standards and Rule 10A-3. As required by the Nasdaq listing rules and Rule 10A-3, the audit committee will consist solely of independent directors following the applicable transition period. The chair of our audit committee is Mr. Cohen, whom our board of directors determined is an “audit committee financial expert” within the meaning of SEC regulations. Each member of our audit committee can read and understand fundamental financial statements in accordance with applicable requirements.
The primary purpose of the audit committee is to discharge the responsibilities of our board of directors with respect to our corporate accounting and financial reporting processes, systems of internal control and financial statement audits, and to oversee our independent registered public accounting firm. Specific responsibilities of our audit committee include:

helping our board of directors oversee our corporate accounting and financial reporting processes;

reviewing and discussing with management all press releases regarding our financial results and any other information provided to securities analysts and rating agencies, including any non-GAAP financial information;

managing the selection, engagement, qualifications, independence and performance of a qualified firm to serve as the independent registered public accounting firm to audit our financial statements;

discussing the scope and results of the audit with the independent registered public accounting firm, and reviewing, with management and the independent accountants, our interim and year-end operating results;

developing procedures for employees to submit concerns anonymously about questionable accounting or audit matters;

reviewing and approving any related-party transactions, after reviewing each such transaction for potential conflicts of interests and other improprieties;

obtaining and reviewing a report by the independent registered public accounting firm at least annually that describes our internal quality control procedures, any material issues with such procedures and any steps taken to deal with such issues when required by applicable law;

approving or, as permitted, pre-approving, audit and permissible non-audit services to be performed by the independent registered public accounting firm; and

reviewing and investigating conduct alleged to be in violation of our code of business conduct and ethics, and adopting, as necessary or appropriate, remedial, disciplinary, or other measures with respect to such conduct.
Our audit committee operates under a written charter that satisfies the applicable Nasdaq listing standards.
Compensation Committee
Our compensation committee consists of Mr. Cohen and Ms. Leatherberry, each of whom, our board of directors determined, is independent under the Nasdaq listing standards and is a “non-employee director” as defined in Rule 16b-3 promulgated under the Exchange Act. The chair of our compensation committee is Ms. Leatherberry.
The primary purpose of our compensation committee is to discharge the responsibilities of our board of directors in overseeing our compensation policies, plans and programs and to review and determine the compensation to be paid to our executive officers, directors and other senior management, as appropriate. Specific responsibilities of our compensation committee include:

reviewing and advising the board of directors concerning our overall compensation, philosophy, policies and plans, including reviewing both regional and industry compensation practices and trends;

reviewing and approving corporate and personal performance goals and objectives relevant to the compensation of the Company’s chief executive officer, and making recommendations to the board
 
108

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
of directors regarding all executive officer executive compensation (including but not limited to salary, bonus, incentive compensation, equity awards, benefits and perquisites);

reviewing, adopting, amending and terminating incentive compensation and equity plans, severance agreements, profit sharing plans, bonus plans, change-of-control protections and any other compensatory arrangements for our executive officers and other senior management;

reviewing and discussing with management the disclosures regarding executive compensation to be included in our public filings or shareholder reports;

reviewing and recommending to our board of directors the compensation paid to our directors; and

overseeing, jointly with the full board, engagement with proxy advisory firms on executive compensation matters.
Our compensation committee operates under a written charter that satisfies the applicable Nasdaq listing standards.
Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee
Our nominating and corporate governance committee consists of Mr. Cohen and Ms. Leatherberry, each of whom, our board of directors determined, is independent under the Nasdaq listing standards. The chair of our nominating and corporate governance committee is Ms. Leatherberry.
Specific responsibilities of our nominating and corporate governance committee include:

evaluating or recommending to our board of director nominees for each election of directors, except that if we are at any time legally required by contract or otherwise to provide any third party with the ability to nominate a director, our nominating and corporate governance committee need not evaluate or propose such nomination, unless required by contract or requested by our board of directors;

determining criteria for selecting new directors, including desired board skills, experience and attributes;

considering any nominations of director candidates validly made by our stockholders;

reviewing and making recommendations to our board of directors concerning qualifications, appointment and removal of committee members;

developing, recommending for approval by our board of directors and reviewing on an ongoing basis the adequacy of the corporate governance principles applicable to us, including, but not limited to, director qualification standards, director responsibilities, committee responsibilities, director access to management and independent advisors, director compensation, director orientation and continuing education, management succession and annual performance evaluation;

reviewing and making recommendations regarding the committee structure and composition;

reviewing and recommending to our board of directors changes to our bylaws as needed;

developing orientation materials for new directors and corporate governance-related continuing education for all directors; and

overseeing succession planning for executive officers.
Our nominating and corporate governance committee operates under a written charter that satisfies the applicable Nasdaq listing standards.
Non-Employee Director Compensation
In fiscal year 2020, we did not have a formal policy with respect to compensation payable to our non-employee directors for service as directors because we did not have any non-employee directors. In connection with this offering, we intend to approve and implement a compensation program for our non-employee directors that consists of annual retainer fees and long-term equity awards. Each non-employee director is
 
109

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
expected to receive an annual cash retainer for his or her services in an amount equal to $30,000 and an annual equity award with a grant date fair value equal to $80,000.
Directors who are also our employees will receive no additional compensation for their service as directors. Messrs. Walker and Smith were our only employee directors during fiscal year 2020. See the section titled “Executive Compensation” for additional information about the compensation paid to Messrs. Walker and Smith.
Code of Business Conduct and Ethics
We have adopted a written code of business conduct and ethics. Our code of business conduct and ethics is intended to document the principles of conduct and ethics to be followed by all of our directors, officers and employees. Its purpose is to promote honest and ethical conduct, including the ethical handling of actual or apparent conflicts of interest. Following the closing of this offering, the full text of our code of business conduct and ethics will be posted on the investor relations section of our website. We intend to disclose future amendments to certain provisions of our code of business conduct and ethics, or waivers of these provisions, on our website or in filings under the Exchange Act.
 
110

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION
We have opted to comply with the executive compensation disclosure rules applicable to “smaller reporting companies,” as such term is defined in the rules promulgated under the Securities Act. In accordance with these rules, our “named executive officers” for fiscal year 2021 were:

Mark Walker, Chairman and Chief Executive Officer;

Keith Smith, President and Interim Chief Financial Officer; and

Susan Echard, Chief Financial Officer.
This discussion may contain forward-looking statements that are based on our current plans, considerations, expectations and determinations regarding future compensation programs. Actual compensation programs that we adopt following the completion of this offering may differ materially from the currently planned programs and arrangements summarized in this discussion, including the terms of the Direct Digital Holdings 2022 Omnibus Incentive Plan, referred to below as the 2022 Plan, which became effective immediately prior to the consummation of this offering.
2021 Summary Compensation Table
The following table sets forth information concerning the compensation of our named executive officers for the fiscal years indicated below.
Name and Principal Position
Fiscal
Year
Salary ($)
All Other
Compensation
($)(1)
Total ($)
Mark Walker
2021
456,923
66,863
523,786
Chairman and Chief Executive Officer
Keith Smith
2021
456,923
99,624
556,547
President and Interim Chief Financial Officer
Susan Echard(2)
2021
Chief Financial Officer
(1)
This column includes the dollar value of premiums paid by the Company for group life insurance as well as Company-paid dental, medical and vision insurance premiums. For 2021, these amounts were as follows:
Name
Life
Insurance
Premiums
Ins.
Premiums
Mark Walker
66,863
Keith Smith
25,155
74,469
Susan Echard
(2)
Susan Echard, our Chief Financial Officer, was employed by SeatonHill Partners, LP, a consulting firm, to which we paid a total of $600,768 in fees in fiscal year 2021. We did not pay any compensation to Ms. Echard individually.
Elements of the Company’s Executive Compensation Program
Named Executive Officer Consulting Agreement
The Company previously entered into a Board Services and Consulting Agreement with each of Mark Walker and Keith Smith, effective September 30, 2020 (the “Walker Agreement” and the “Smith Agreement,” respectively, and collectively, the “Consulting Agreements”). Pursuant to the Walker Agreement, Mr. Walker serves as our Chief Executive Officer and, pursuant to the Smith Agreement, Mr. Smith serves as our President.
 
111

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
The Consulting Agreements entitle each of Mr. Walker and Mr. Smith to the following benefits:

base salary of $450,000, which will be reviewed annually and may be increased at our sole discretion;

annual performance review by the Company to determine whether a performance-based bonus shall be paid;

participation in all employee benefit plans maintained by the Company or any subsidiary; provided that, if no health, dental, short-term disability, long-term disability or life insurance is provided, the Company will reimburse the named executive officer for all out of pocket costs to purchase such coverage; and

reimbursement for reasonable out of pocket expenses.
Each Consulting Agreement may be terminated by either us or the applicable named executive officer; provided that, the applicable Consulting Agreement will be terminated automatically upon a named executive officer’s death.
Equity Compensation
In connection with this offering, we adopted the 2022 Plan, which became effective immediately prior to the consummation of this offering, in order to facilitate the grant of equity awards to our employees, consultants and directors for the purposes of obtaining and retaining services of these individuals, which we believe is essential to our long-term success. For additional information about the 2022 Plan, see “2022 Omnibus Incentive Plan” below.
Other Elements
We provide various employee benefit programs to our named executive officers, including health, disability and life insurance benefits, which are generally available to all of our employees. We also currently maintain a 401(k) retirement savings plan for our U.S. employees, including our U.S.-based named executive officers, who satisfy certain eligibility requirements.
2021 Outstanding Equity Awards at Fiscal Year-End
None of the named executive officers held any outstanding equity awards as of December 31, 2021.
2022 Omnibus Incentive Plan
General Information About the 2022 Plan
On January 17, 2022, our board of directors adopted and our stockholders approved the 2022 Plan. The purpose of the 2022 Plan is to enable the Company to attract, retain and motivate its employees by providing for or increasing their proprietary interests in the Company.
The 2022 Plan is a stock incentive plan under which we may offer securities of the Company to our employees. The 2022 Plan is not subject to any provisions of the U.S. Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974 and is not qualified under Section 401(a) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “Code”). The 2022 Plan permits the Company to satisfy any awards under the 2022 Plan by distributing to participants (1) authorized and unissued shares of the Company’s common stock, (2) shares of common stock held in the Company treasury, (3) shares of the Company’s common stock purchased on the open market or (4) shares of the Company’s common stock acquired through private purchase.
Eligibility
Employees, directors, officers and consultants or advisors of the Company and its affiliates are eligible for awards under the 2022 Plan. The Committee (as discussed below) has the sole and complete authority to determine who will be granted awards under the 2022 Plan.
Eligible individuals are not required to make contributions to the 2022 Plan in order to participate. However, as described below, depending on what method is chosen to exercise any stock options granted, an
 
112

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
individual may be required to make a cash payment to the Company upon that exercise. In addition, the Company may require payment of some amount for the shares subject to a restricted stock award.
Administration
The 2022 Plan is administered by the Committee, which consists of the members of our compensation committee, or if our board of directors is acting as our compensation committee, the individuals constituting “eligible” directors of our board of directors. The Committee administers the 2022 Plan, except in the case of awards to non-employee directors. Awards to non-employee directors are administered by our board of directors. The Committee in its discretion may delegate any and all of its duties to officers of the Company. The Committee or, in the case of awards to non-employee directors, our board of directors, has the authority to determine the terms and conditions of any agreements relating to awards granted under the 2022 Plan (agreements may differ among participants), and to adopt, alter and repeal rules, guidelines and practices relating to the 2022 Plan. The Committee or, in the case of awards to non-employee directors, our board of directors, has full discretion to administer and interpret the 2022 Plan, and to adopt whatever rules, regulations and procedures it deems necessary or advisable. The Committee or, in the case of awards to non-employee directors, our board of directors, also has full discretion to determine, among other things, the times at which the awards may be exercised and under what circumstances an award may be exercised.
Duration; Plan Amendments
The 2022 Plan expires by its terms on the tenth anniversary of the effective date of the 2022 Plan. However, our board of directors may terminate the 2022 Plan before that date. No awards can be granted under the 2022 Plan after the 2022 Plan has terminated. However, awards granted prior to the date on which the 2022 Plan terminates will not be affected by the termination and the terms and conditions of the 2022 Plan will continue to apply to those awards.
Our board of directors has the right to amend, alter, suspend, or terminate the 2022 Plan, even before the date on which the 2022 Plan is otherwise scheduled to terminate. The Committee may also amend outstanding awards or cancel any award and provide a substitute award, subject to the participants’ consent. However, neither our board of directors nor the Committee may amend or terminate the 2022 Plan or any outstanding awards in a manner that would impair rights of award holders without their written consent, unless the amendment is made to comply with applicable law, stock exchange rules, or accounting rules. (As discussed below, however, awards may be cancelled in return for a cash payment upon the occurrence of a change in control and under certain other circumstances.).
Shares Available for Awards
Shares Available for Issuance
The maximum number of shares of common stock that may be issued pursuant to awards granted under the 2022 Plan is 1,500,000, subject to certain adjustments for corporate transactions, as described in the section entitled “— Additional Information — Adjustments” below. On termination, forfeiture, or expiration of an unexercised stock option grant or other award, in whole or in part, the number of shares of common stock subject to such unexercised stock option grant or other award will become available again for grant under the 2022 Plan. Also, shares subject to a stock option grant or other award that are not delivered to a participant because they are used to satisfy a tax withholding obligation or that are withheld to pay all or a portion of an option’s exercise price will again become available for grant under the 2022 Plan. In addition, shares of the Company’s common stock will not be considered used if the award to which they relate is settled in cash. Further, shares subject to awards granted in assumption or substitution of outstanding awards of an acquired entity shall not be counted against the shares of our common stock available for issuance under the 2022 Plan.
Awards
Stock Options
Stock options may be granted under the 2022 Plan. The Committee sets the terms of the stock option grant at the time the grant is made. These terms are described in a stock option award agreement.
 
113

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
The Committee, in its discretion, may designate stock options granted under the 2022 Plan as either nonqualified stock options or incentive stock options (“ISOs”). ISOs have certain unique tax characteristics discussed below. The stock option agreement will indicate whether the stock options are nonqualified stock options or ISOs. Please note, however, that, even if all of the stock options are designated as ISOs, only those stock options so designated that first become vested and exercisable in a calendar year having an aggregate fair market value (determined at the date of grant) of $100,000 will be eligible to receive ISO tax treatment. Any additional stock options that first become vested during that calendar year will be treated as nonqualified stock options for tax purposes.
Once a stock option vests, holders of stock options granted pursuant to the 2022 Plan will be able to exercise that stock option for a period determined by the Committee and set forth in their stock option agreement. Although the period during which an option may be exercised may vary from award to award, the longest period of time for which an option will remain exercisable is ten years from the date it is granted. If a participant’s employment terminates, the period during which they can exercise their vested stock options may change depending on the terms of their option agreement.
Restricted Stock Awards
Restricted stock awards may be granted under the 2022 Plan. The Committee will set the terms of the restricted stock award at the time of grant and will describe these terms in a restricted stock award agreement.
If the specified performance criteria are not achieved within the established time frame, the shares will be forfeited, unless the terms of the applicable restricted stock award agreement also provide for service-based vesting, catch-up vesting or otherwise specifically alter this treatment.
Restricted Stock Units
Restricted stock unit awards may be granted under the 2022 Plan. The Committee will set the terms of the restricted stock unit award at the time of grant and will describe these terms in a restricted stock unit agreement.
Stock Bonus Awards
Participants may receive under the 2022 Plan a grant of unrestricted shares of the Company’s common stock or other awards, including fully-vested deferred stock units, denominated in common stock, as determined by the Committee.
Cash Bonus Awards
Participants may also receive under the 2022 Plan a cash bonus award. Any such award may be subject to a performance period, performance goals or such other terms and conditions as the Committee may designate in the applicable award agreement.
Stock Appreciation Rights
Stock appreciation rights may be granted under the 2022 Plan. The Committee will set the terms of the stock appreciation right at the time of grant and will describe these terms in the applicable award agreement.
Additional Information
Adjustments
The 2022 Plan provides for appropriate adjustments in the number of shares of common stock subject to awards and available for future awards, the exercise price of outstanding awards, as well as the maximum award limits under the 2022 Plan, in the event of changes in our outstanding common stock by reason of a merger, stock split, reorganization, recapitalization or similar events. The Committee may also make these types of adjustments if a change in law or circumstances would result in any substantial dilution or enlargement of the rights of participants under the 2022 Plan.
 
114

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
Repricing
Repricing of options and SARs (as defined in the 2022 Plan) is generally prohibited under the 2022 Plan without approval of our stockholders.
Change in Control
Unless the applicable award agreement provides otherwise, in the event of a “change in control” ​(as defined in the 2022 Plan),

if a participant’s employment or service with the Company is terminated by the Company without “cause” ​(as defined in the 2022 Plan) or by the participant for “good reason” ​(as defined in the 2022 Plan) within twelve months of a change in control of the Company or in contemplation of a change in control, all awards held by such participant become fully vested and immediately exercisable, and any applicable restricted period ends on the termination date;

all incomplete performance periods in effect on the date the change in control occurs will end on the date of the change in control, and the Committee will determine the extent to which performance goals with respect to each such award period have been met based upon such audited or unaudited financial information then available as it deems relevant; and each participant will be paid partial or full awards with respect to performance goals for each relevant award period based upon the Committee’s determination of the degree of attainment of any performance goals;

the acquiring entity may choose to either (i) continue the terms and conditions of each award under the 2022 Plan, or (ii) replace the outstanding awards with a substantially equivalent award with respect to the acquiring entity’s stock; and

if an excise tax under Code Section 4999 will be triggered by any payments owed to a participant in connection with or contingent upon the change in control, the Company will reduce the aggregate amount of the payments payable to the participant such that no excise tax will be assessed, unless the after-tax payment, even with the excise tax, will be a greater value than the value resulting from the reduction and avoidance of the excise tax.
In the event of a change in control, the Committee may in its discretion also make adjustments to the stock options and restricted stock units granted under the 2022 Plan. The Committee may substitute shares of the surviving entity or another corporation that is party to the transaction for shares of Company common stock. In connection with such an event, the Committee may also determine that outstanding awards will be cancelled in return for a cash payment equal to the value of the cancelled awards. In the event that the Committee decides to cancel outstanding awards, holders of outstanding awards will receive reasonable advanced notice.
Tax withholding
Participants, other than non-employee directors, in the 2022 Plan must make a cash payment to the Company, or make other arrangements satisfactory to the Committee, to satisfy the tax withholding obligations that arise under applicable law with respect to a stock option or other award granted under the 2022 Plan, including without limitation any U.S. federal income and employment taxes and other applicable state and local taxes. Under certain circumstances, participants may be permitted to satisfy their tax withholding obligation, in whole or in part, by having us withhold from the shares of common stock otherwise deliverable to them on the exercise of a stock option, restricted stock unit or stock appreciation right, or by surrendering shares having a fair market value on the date of exercise equal to the exercise price.
Transferability and assignment
In general, participants in the 2022 Plan can exercise an option or other award received under the 2022 Plan only during their lifetime. Unless the agreement under which the stock option or other award was granted provides otherwise, participants cannot transfer stock options or other awards (except for shares that are not subject to a restricted period), except by will or the laws of descent and distribution or pursuant to a domestic relations order issued by a court of competent jurisdiction.
 
115

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
Award Termination; Forfeiture
The Committee will have full power and authority to determine whether, to what extent and under what circumstances any award will be terminated or forfeited. To the extent provided in the award agreement, if a participant is terminated for “cause” ​(as defined in the 2022 Plan), then any stock options or restricted stock units granted to such participant may be cancelled. Awards granted under the 2022 Plan are also subject to any clawback, compensation recovery policy or minimum stock holding period requirement adopted by the Company.
 
116

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED PERSON TRANSACTIONS
There have been no transactions since January 1, 2019 to which we have been a participant that involved amounts that exceeded or will exceed the lesser of (i) $120,000 or (ii) one percent of the average of our total assets at December 31, 2019 and December 31, 2020, and in which any of our directors, executive officers or any other “related person” as defined in Item 404(a) of Regulation S-K had or will have a direct or indirect material interest.
Our Policy Regarding Related Party Transactions
Following the completion of this offering, our Audit Committee will have the primary responsibility for reviewing and approving or disapproving “related party transactions,” which are transactions between us and related persons in which the aggregate amount involved exceeds or may be expected to exceed the lesser of $120,000 or one percent of the average of our total assets at year end for the last two completed fiscal years, and in which a related person has or will have a direct or indirect material interest. Upon completion of this offering, our policy regarding transactions between us and related persons will provide that a related person is defined as a director, executive officer, nominee for director or greater than 5% beneficial owner of our Class A common stock, in each case since the beginning of the most recently completed year, and any of their immediate family members.
Tax Receivable Agreement
We expect to obtain an increase in our share of the tax basis of the assets of DDH LLC when (as described below under “— DDH LLC Agreement — LLC Unit Redemption Right”) the Continuing LLC Owners (a) redeem or exchange their LLC Units for newly issued shares of our Class A common stock on a one-for-one basis and (b) receive payments under the Tax Receivable Agreement (such basis increase, a “Basis Adjustment”). We intend to treat such redemptions or exchanges of LLC Units as the direct purchase of LLC Units by Direct Digital Holdings from such Continuing LLC Owners for U.S. federal income and other applicable tax purposes, regardless of whether such LLC Units are surrendered by such Continuing LLC Owners to DDH LLC for redemption or sold to Direct Digital Holdings upon the exercise of our election to acquire such LLC Units directly. A Basis Adjustment may have the effect of reducing the amounts that we would otherwise pay in the future to various tax authorities to the extent that we have positive taxable income in a future tax period that is offset by tax depreciation or amortization deductions arising from such Basis Adjustment. The Basis Adjustments may also decrease gains (or increase losses) on future dispositions of certain capital assets to the extent tax basis is allocated to those capital assets, which could also generate tax savings for us.
In connection with the Organizational Transactions described above, we will enter into the Tax Receivable Agreement with DDH LLC and each of the Continuing LLC Owners. The Tax Receivable Agreement will provide for our payment to the Continuing LLC Owners of 85% of the amount of tax benefits, if any, that we actually realize, or in some circumstances, are deemed to realize (calculated using certain assumptions), as a result of any Basis Adjustments and certain other tax benefits arising from payments under the Tax Receivable Agreement. DDH LLC will have in effect an election under Section 754 of the Code effective for each taxable year in which a redemption or exchange (including deemed exchange) of LLC Units for shares of our Class A common stock occurs. These Tax Receivable Agreement payments are not conditioned upon any continued ownership interest in either DDH LLC or us by such Continuing LLC Owners. The rights of such Continuing LLC Owners under the Tax Receivable Agreement are assignable to transferees of their LLC Units (other than Direct Digital Holdings as transferee pursuant to subsequent redemptions (or exchanges) of the transferred LLC Units); provided, however, no Continuing LLC Owner may, directly or indirectly, assign or otherwise transfer its rights under the Tax Receivable Agreement to any Person (as defined in the Tax Receivable Agreement) (other than to certain “Permitted Transferees” specified in the DDH LLC Agreement) without the express prior written consent of Direct Digital Holdings, and without such Person (including a permitted transferee) executing and delivering a joinder to the Tax Receivable Agreement agreeing to become a party to the Tax Receivable Agreement. We expect to benefit from the remaining 15% of tax benefits, if any, that we may realize. Actual tax benefits realized by us may differ from tax benefits calculated under the Tax Receivable Agreement as a result of the use of certain assumptions in the Tax Receivable Agreement, including the use of an assumed weighted-average state and local income tax rate to calculate tax benefits.
 
117

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
The Basis Adjustments, as well as any amounts paid to the Continuing LLC Owners under the Tax Receivable Agreement, will vary depending on a number of factors, including:

the timing of any subsequent redemptions or exchanges — for instance, the increase in any tax deductions will vary depending on the fair value, which may fluctuate over time, of the depreciable or amortizable assets of DDH LLC at the time of each redemption or exchange;

the price of shares of our Class A common stock at the time of redemptions or exchanges — the Basis Adjustments, as well as any related increase in any tax deductions, are directly related to the price of shares of our Class A common stock at the time of each redemption or exchange;

the extent to which such redemptions or exchanges are taxable — if a redemption or exchange is not taxable for any reason, increased tax deductions will not be available; and

the amount and timing of our taxable income (prior to taking into account the tax depreciation or amortization deductions arising from the Basis Adjustments) — the Tax Receivable Agreement generally will require Direct Digital Holdings to pay 85% of the tax benefits as and when those benefits are treated as realized under the terms of the Tax Receivable Agreement. Except as discussed below, in cases of (i) a material breach of a material obligation under the Tax Receivable Agreement, (ii) a change of control or (iii) an early termination of the Tax Receivable Agreement, if Direct Digital Holdings does not have taxable income, it will generally not be required to make payments under the Tax Receivable Agreement for that taxable year because no tax benefits will have been realized. However, any tax benefits that do not result in realized tax benefits in a given taxable year may generate tax attributes that may be utilized to generate tax benefits in future taxable years. The utilization of any such tax attributes will result in payments under the Tax Receivable Agreement.
For purposes of the Tax Receivable Agreement, cash savings in income tax will be computed by comparing Direct Digital Holdings’ actual income tax liability to the amount of such taxes that it would have been required to pay had there been no Basis Adjustments and had the Tax Receivable Agreement not been entered into. The Tax Receivable Agreement will generally apply to each of our taxable years, beginning with the first taxable year ending after the consummation of the offering. The actual and hypothetical tax liabilities determined in the Tax Receivable Agreement will be calculated using the actual U.S. federal income tax rate in effect for the applicable period and an assumed, weighted-average state and local income tax rate based on apportionment factors for the applicable period (along with the use of certain other assumptions). There is no maximum term for the Tax Receivable Agreement; however, the Tax Receivable Agreement may be terminated by us pursuant to an early termination procedure that requires us to pay the Continuing LLC Owners an agreed upon amount equal to the estimated present value of the remaining payments to be made under the agreement (calculated based on certain assumptions, including regarding tax rates and utilization of the Basis Adjustments).
The payment obligations under the Tax Receivable Agreement are obligations of Direct Digital Holdings and not of DDH LLC. Although the actual timing and amount of any payments that may be made under the Tax Receivable Agreement will vary, we expect that the payments that we may be required to make to the Continuing LLC Owners could be significant. For example, if we acquired all of the LLC Units of the Continuing LLC Owners in taxable transactions as of this offering, based on an initial public offering price of $8.00 per share (the midpoint of the estimated initial public offering price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus) and on certain assumptions, including that (i) there are no material changes in relevant tax law and (ii) we earn sufficient taxable income in each year to realize on a current basis all tax benefits that are subject to the Tax Receivable Agreement, we expect that the resulting reduction in tax payments for us, as determined for purposes of the Tax Receivable Agreement, would aggregate to approximately $35.6 million, substantially all of which would be realized over the next 15 years, and we would be required to pay the Continuing LLC Owners 85% of such amount, or $30.3 million, over the same period. The actual increases in tax basis with respect to future taxable redemptions, exchanges or purchases of LLC Units, as well as the amount and timing of any payments we are required to make under the Tax Receivable Agreement in respect of the acquisition of LLC Units from certain of Continuing LLC Owners in connection with this offering or future taxable redemptions, exchanges or purchases of LLC Units, may differ materially from the amounts set forth above because the potential future reductions in our tax payments, as determined for purposes of the Tax Receivable Agreement, and the payments we will be required to make under the Tax Receivable Agreement, will each depend on a number of factors, including
 
118

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
the market value of our Class A common stock at the time of redemption or exchange, the prevailing federal tax rates applicable to us over the life of the Tax Receivable Agreement (as well as the assumed combined state and local tax rate), the amount and timing of the taxable income that we generate in the future and the extent to which future redemptions, exchanges or purchases of LLC Units are taxable transactions. See the section titled “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Liquidity and Capital Resources — Tax Receivable Agreement” for more information about expected payments under the Tax Receivable Agreement.
There may be a material negative effect on our liquidity if, as described below, the payments made by us to the Continuing LLC Owners under the Tax Receivable Agreement exceed the actual benefits we receive in respect of the tax attributes subject to the Tax Receivable Agreement and/or distributions to us by DDH LLC are not sufficient to permit us to make payments under the Tax Receivable Agreement. To the extent that we are unable to make payments under the Tax Receivable Agreement for any reason, the unpaid amounts generally will be deferred and will possibly accrue interest until paid by us. Decisions made by us in the course of running our business, such as with respect to mergers, asset sales, other forms of business combinations or other changes in control, may influence the timing and amount of payments that are received by the Continuing LLC Owners under the Tax Receivable Agreement. For example, the earlier disposition of assets following a transaction that results in a Basis Adjustment will generally accelerate payments under the Tax Receivable Agreement and increase the present value of such payments.
In addition, although we are not aware of any issue that would cause the IRS to challenge the tax basis increases or other benefits arising under the Tax Receivable Agreement, the Continuing LLC Owners who are parties to the Tax Receivable Agreement will not reimburse us for any payments previously made if such tax basis increases or other tax benefits are subsequently disallowed, except that any excess payments made to the Continuing LLC Owners who are parties to the Tax Receivable Agreement will be netted against future payments otherwise to be made under the Tax Receivable Agreement, if any, after our determination of such excess. In addition, a challenge to any tax benefits initially claimed by us may not arise for a number of years following the initial time of such payment. As a result, in such circumstances we could make payments to the Continuing LLC Owners under the Tax Receivable Agreement that are greater than our actual cash tax savings and may not be able to recoup those payments, which could negatively impact our liquidity.
In addition, the Tax Receivable Agreement provides that, upon certain mergers, asset sales or other forms of business combination or certain other changes of control, our or our successor’s obligations with respect to tax benefits would be based on certain assumptions, including that we or our successor would have sufficient taxable income to fully utilize the benefits arising from the increased tax deductions and tax basis and other benefits covered by the Tax Receivable Agreement. As a result, upon a change of control, we could be required to make payments under the Tax Receivable Agreement that are greater than or less than the specified percentage of our actual cash tax savings, which could negatively impact our liquidity.
This provision of the Tax Receivable Agreement may result in situations where the Continuing LLC Owners have interests that differ from or are in addition to those of our other stockholders. In addition, we could be required to make payments under the Tax Receivable Agreement that are substantial and in excess of our, or a potential acquirer’s, actual cash savings in income tax.
Finally, because we are a holding company with no operations of our own, our ability to make payments under the Tax Receivable Agreement is dependent on the ability of DDH LLC to make distributions to us. To the extent that we are unable to make payments under the Tax Receivable Agreement for any reason, such payments will be deferred and will possibly accrue interest until paid.
DDH LLC Agreement
We will operate our business through DDH LLC and its subsidiaries. In connection with the completion of this offering, we and the Continuing LLC Owners will enter into DDH LLC’s amended and restated limited liability company agreement, which we refer to as the “DDH LLC Agreement.” The operations of DDH LLC, and the rights and obligations of the holders of LLC Units, will be set forth in the DDH LLC Agreement.
 
119

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
Appointment as Manager
Under the DDH LLC Agreement, we will become a member and the sole manager of DDH LLC. As the sole manager, we will be able to control all of the day-to-day business affairs and decision-making of DDH LLC. As such, we, through our officers and directors, will be responsible for all operational and administrative decisions of DDH LLC and the day-to-day management of DDH LLC’s business. Pursuant to the terms of the DDH LLC Agreement, we cannot, under any circumstances, be removed as the sole manager of DDH LLC except by our election.
Compensation
We will not be entitled to compensation for our services as manager. We will be entitled to reimbursement or capital contribution credit by DDH LLC for fees and expenses incurred on behalf of DDH LLC, including all expenses associated with this offering and maintaining our corporate existence.
Distributions
The DDH LLC Agreement will require “tax distributions” to be made by DDH LLC to its members, as that term is defined in the agreement. Tax distributions will be made to members on a pro rata basis, including us, in amounts intended to be sufficient to allow the members, including us, to pay taxes owed in respect of income allocated by DDH LLC and to allow us to meet our obligations under the Tax Receivable Agreement (as described above under “— Tax Receivable Agreement”). The DDH LLC Agreement will also allow for distributions to be made by DDH LLC to its members on a pro rata basis out of “distributable cash,” as that term is defined in the agreement. We expect DDH LLC may make distributions out of distributable cash periodically to the extent permitted by our agreements governing our indebtedness and necessary to enable us to cover our operating expenses and other obligations, including our tax liability and obligations under the Tax Receivable Agreement, as well as to make dividend payments, if any, to the holders of our Class A common stock.
LLC Unit Redemption Right
The DDH LLC Agreement will provide a redemption right to the Continuing LLC Owners which will entitle them to have their LLC Units redeemed, from time to time at their election (subject to the terms of the DDH LLC Agreement), for newly issued shares of our Class A common stock on a one-for-one basis (subject to customary adjustments, including for stock splits, stock dividends and reclassifications). Upon the exercise of the redemption right, the redeeming member will surrender its LLC Units to DDH LLC for cancellation. The DDH LLC Agreement will require that we contribute shares of our Class A common stock to DDH LLC in exchange for an amount of newly issued LLC Units in DDH LLC that will be issued to us equal to the number of LLC Units redeemed from the Continuing LLC Owners. DDH LLC will then distribute the shares of our Class A common stock to the Continuing LLC Owners to complete the redemption. In the event of such a redemption election by Continuing LLC Owners, Direct Digital Holdings may effect a direct exchange of Class A common stock. Whether by redemption or exchange, we will be obligated to ensure that at all times the number of LLC Units that we own equals the number of shares of Class A common stock issued by us (subject to certain exceptions for treasury shares and shares underlying certain convertible or exchangeable securities).
Indemnification
The DDH LLC Agreement will provide for indemnification of the manager, members and officers of DDH LLC and their respective subsidiaries or affiliates.
 
120

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
PRINCIPAL STOCKHOLDERS
The following table sets forth the beneficial ownership of our Class A common stock and Class B common stock, after giving effect to the Organizational Transactions, by:

each person, or group of affiliated persons, who is known to beneficially own more than 5% of either our Class A common stock or our Class B common stock;

each of our named executive officers for fiscal year 2021;

each of our current directors; and

all of our current directors and executive officers as a group.
Beneficial ownership is determined in accordance with the rules of the SEC. These rules generally attribute beneficial ownership of securities to persons who possess sole or shared voting power or investment power with respect to such securities.
As described in the sections titled “Organizational Transactions” and “Certain Relationships and Related Person Transactions,” the Continuing LLC Owners will be entitled to have their LLC Units redeemed for shares of Class A common stock on a one-for-one basis (subject to customary adjustments, including for stock splits, stock dividends and reclassifications) in accordance with the terms of the DDH LLC Agreement; provided that, at Direct Digital Holdings’ election, Direct Digital Holdings may effect a direct exchange of such Class A common stock. In connection with this offering, we will issue to the Continuing LLC Owners one share of Class B common stock for each LLC Unit they own. As a result, the number of shares of Class B common stock listed in the table below will correlate to the number of LLC Units the Continuing LLC Owners will own immediately prior to and after this offering (but after giving effect to the Organizational Transactions other than this offering). See the section titled “Organizational Transactions.”
The percentage of beneficial ownership of shares of our Class A common stock and our Class B common stock outstanding before the offering set forth below is based on the number of shares of our common stock to be issued and outstanding immediately following the Organizational Transactions without giving effect to this offering. The percentage of beneficial ownership of our Class A common stock and our Class B common stock after the offering set forth below is based on 16,308,000 shares of our common stock to be issued and outstanding immediately after the offering.
Immediately following the consummation of this offering, the Continuing LLC Owners will hold all of the issued and outstanding shares of our Class B common stock. The shares of Class B common stock will have no economic rights, but each share will entitle the holder to one vote per share on all matters on which stockholders of Direct Digital Holdings are entitled to vote generally. The voting power afforded to the Continuing LLC Owners by their shares of Class B common stock will be automatically and correspondingly reduced as they exchange shares of Class B common stock, together with a corresponding number of LLC Units, as applicable, for shares of Class A common stock of Direct Digital Holdings. See the sections titled “Certain Relationships and Related Person Transactions — DDH LLC Agreement,” and “Description of Capital Stock.”
Except as otherwise indicated, all persons listed below have sole voting and investment power with respect to the shares beneficially owned by them, subject to applicable community property laws. Unless otherwise indicated, the address of each person or entity named in the table below is 1233 West Loop S #1170, Houston, TX 77027.
 
121

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
Shares of Class A Common Stock
Beneficially Owned
Shares of Class B Common Stock
Beneficially Owned
Total Common Stock Beneficially
Owned
After Giving
Effect to the
Organizational
Transactions
and
Before the
Offering
After Giving
Effect to the
Organizational
Transactions
and After the
Offering
After Giving
Effect to the
Organizational
Transactions
and Before the
Offering
After Giving
Effect to the
Organizational
Transactions
and After the
Offering
After Giving
Effect to the
Organizational
Transactions
and Before the
Offering
After Giving
Effect to the
Organizational
Transactions
and After the
Offering
No.
Percent
No.
Percent
No.
Percent
No.
Percent
No.
Percent
No.
Percent
5% Stockholders 
Direct Digital Management, LLC(1)
% 11,378,000 100% % 11,378,000 100%
Named Executive Officers and Directors
Mark Walker(2)
% % 5,689,000 50% % 5,689,000 50%
Keith Smith(2)
% % 5,689,000 50% % 5,689,000 50%
Susan Echard
% % % %
Anu Pillai
% % % %
Richard Cohen
% % % %
Antoinette R. Leatherberry
% % % %
All executive officers and directors as a group (6 persons)(3)
% % 11,378,000 100% % 11,378,000 100%
* Less than 1%.
(1)
Direct Digital Management, LLC is a holding company in which Mark Walker, our Chairman and Chief Executive Officer, and Keith Smith, our President, each indirectly hold a 50% economic and voting interest. AJN Energy & Transport Ventures, LLC and SKW Financial LLC each own 50% of the equity interests in Direct Digital Management, LLC. Mr. Walker and his wife share voting and dispositive power with respect to the shares of Class B common stock held by AJN Energy & Transport Ventures, LLC. Mr. Smith and his wife share voting and dispositive power with respect to the shares of Class B common stock held by SKW Financial LLC.
(2)
Each of Messrs. Walker and Smith indirectly hold a 50% economic and voting interest in Direct Digital Management, LLC. AJN Energy & Transport Ventures, LLC and SKW Financial LLC each own 50% of the equity interests in Direct Digital Management, LLC. Mr. Walker and his wife share voting and dispositive power with respect to the shares of Class B common stock held by AJN Energy & Transport Ventures, LLC. Mr. Smith and his wife share voting and dispositive power with respect to the shares of Class B common stock held by SKW Financial LLC.
(3)
Includes our two independent directors and all four of our executive officers.
 
122

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DESCRIPTION OF CAPITAL STOCK
The following is a description of the material terms of our certificate of incorporation and bylaws, each of which will become effective prior to the consummation of this offering, and of specific provisions of Delaware law. The following description also assumes the completion of the Organizational Transactions unless the context requires otherwise. The following description is intended as a summary only and is qualified in its entirety by reference to our certificate of incorporation, our bylaws and the Delaware General Corporation Law (the “DGCL”).
General
Our current authorized capital stock consists of 1,000 shares of common stock, no par value per share. Upon the closing of this offering and the filing of our certificate of incorporation, we will be authorized to issue 160,000,000 shares of Class A common stock, par value $0.001 per share, 20,000,000 shares of Class B common stock, par value $0.001 per share and 10,000,000 shares of preferred stock, par value $0.001 per share.
Common Stock
Immediately after this offering, there will be 4,000,000 shares of our Class A common stock issued and outstanding (or 4,600,000 shares if the option to purchase additional shares from us is exercised in full) and 11,378,000 shares of our Class B common stock issued and outstanding.
Class A Common Stock
Voting Rights
Holders of our Class A common stock will be entitled to cast one vote per share. Holders of our Class A common stock will not be entitled to cumulate their votes in the election of directors. Generally, all matters to be voted on by stockholders must be approved by a majority (or, in the case of election of directors, by a plurality) of the votes entitled to be cast by all holders of Class A common stock and Class B common stock present in person or represented by proxy, voting together as a single class. Except as otherwise provided by law, amendments to the amended and restated certificate of incorporation must be approved by a majority of the combined voting power of all shares of Class A common stock and Class B common stock, voting together as a single class.
Dividend Rights
Any dividend or distribution paid or payable to the holders of shares of Class A common stock shall be paid pro rata, on an equal priority, pari passu basis; provided, however, that if a dividend or distribution is paid in the form of Class A common stock (or rights to acquire shares of Class A common stock), then the holders of the Class A common stock shall receive Class A common stock (or rights to acquire shares of Class A common stock).
Liquidation Rights
In the event of our liquidation, dissolution or winding-up, upon the completion of the distributions required with respect to any series of redeemable convertible preferred stock that may then be outstanding, our remaining assets legally available for distribution to stockholders shall be distributed on an equal priority, pro rata basis to the holders of Class A common stock, unless different treatment is approved by the majority of the voting power of the outstanding shares of Class A common stock and Class B common stock.
Other Matters
No shares of Class A common stock will be subject to redemption or have preemptive rights to purchase additional shares of Class A common stock. Holders of shares of our Class A common stock do not have subscription, redemption or conversion rights. There will be no redemption or sinking fund provisions
 
123

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
applicable to the Class A common stock. Upon consummation of this offering, all the outstanding shares of Class A common stock will be validly issued, fully paid and non-assessable.
Class B Common Stock
Issuance of Class B Common Stock with LLC Units
Shares of Class B common stock will only be issued in the future to the extent necessary to maintain a one-to-one ratio between the number of LLC Units held by the Continuing LLC Owners and the number of shares of Class B common stock issued to the Continuing LLC Owners. Shares of Class B common stock are transferable only together with an equal number of LLC Units. Shares of Class B common stock will be cancelled on a one-for-one basis if we, at the election of the Continuing LLC Owners, redeem or exchange their LLC Units pursuant to the terms of the DDH LLC Agreement.
Voting Rights
Holders of Class B common stock will be entitled to cast one vote per share, with the number of shares of Class B common stock held by each Continuing LLC Owner being equivalent to the number of LLC Units held by such Continuing LLC Owner. Holders of our Class B common stock will not be entitled to cumulate their votes in the election of directors. The voting power afforded to Continuing LLC Owners by their shares of Class B common stock will be automatically and correspondingly reduced as they redeem their LLC Units because an equal number of their shares of Class B common stock will be cancelled.
Generally, all matters to be voted on by stockholders must be approved by a majority (or, in the case of election of directors, by a plurality) of the votes entitled to be cast by all Class A and Class B stockholders present in person or represented by proxy, voting together as a single class. Except as otherwise provided by law, amendments to the amended and restated certificate of incorporation must be approved by a majority of the combined voting power of all shares of Class A common stock and Class B common stock, voting together as a single class. There will be a separate vote of the Class B common stock in the following circumstances:

if we amend, alter or repeal any provision of the amended and restated certificate of incorporation or the amended and restated bylaws in a manner that modifies the voting, conversion or other powers, preferences, or other special rights or privileges, or restrictions of the Class B common stock;

if we reclassify any outstanding shares of Class A common stock into shares having rights as to dividends or liquidation that are senior to the Class B common stock or, in the case of Class A common stock, the right to more than one vote for each share thereof; or

if we authorize any shares of preferred stock with rights as to dividends or liquidation that are senior to the Class B common stock or the right to more than one vote for each share thereof.
Dividend Rights
The shares of Class B common stock have no economic rights. Holders of shares of our Class B common stock do not have any rights to receive dividends.
Liquidation Rights
On our liquidation, dissolution or winding up, holders of Class B common stock will not be entitled to receive any distribution of our assets.
Transfers
Pursuant to the DDH LLC Agreement, each holder of Class B common stock agrees that:

the holder will not transfer any shares of Class B common stock to any person unless the holder transfers an equal number of LLC Units to the same person; and

in the event the holder transfers any LLC Units to any person, the holder will transfer an equal number of shares of Class B common stock to the same person.
 
124

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
Other Matters
No shares of Class B common stock will have preemptive rights to purchase additional shares of Class B common stock. Holders of shares of our Class B common stock do not have subscription, redemption or conversion rights. There will be no redemption or sinking fund provisions applicable to the Class B common stock. Upon consummation of this offering, all outstanding shares of Class B common stock will be validly issued, fully paid and nonassessable.
Preferred Stock
Our board of directors will have the authority, subject to limitations prescribed by Delaware law, to issue up to 10,000,000 shares of “blank check” preferred stock in one or more series, to establish from time to time the number of shares to be included in each series and to fix the designation, powers, preferences and rights of the shares of each series and any of its qualifications, limitations or restrictions, in each case without further vote or action by our stockholders. Our board of directors can also increase or decrease the number of shares of any series of preferred stock, but not below the number of shares of that series then outstanding, without any further vote or action by our stockholders. Our board of directors may authorize the issuance of preferred stock with voting or conversion rights that could adversely affect the voting power or other rights of the holders of our Class A common stock. The issuance of preferred stock, while providing flexibility in connection with possible acquisitions and other corporate purposes, could, among other things, have the effect of delaying, deferring or preventing a change in control of our Company and might adversely affect the market price of our Class A common stock and the voting and other rights of the holders of our Class A common stock. We have no current plan to issue any shares of preferred stock.
Representatives’ Warrants
Upon the closing of this offering, there will be up to 230,000 shares of common stock issuable upon exercise of the representatives’ warrants.
Anti-Takeover Provisions
Certain provisions of Delaware law, as well as our certificate of incorporation and our bylaws that will become effective immediately prior to the completion of this offering, may have the effect of delaying, deferring or discouraging another person from acquiring control of us. These provisions include the items described below. They are also designed, in part, to encourage persons seeking to acquire control of us to negotiate first with our board of directors. We believe that the benefits of increased protection of our potential ability to negotiate with an unfriendly or unsolicited acquirer outweigh the disadvantages of discouraging a proposal to acquire us because negotiation of these proposals could result in an improvement of their terms.
Delaware Law
When we have a class of voting stock that is either listed on a national securities exchange or held of record by more than 2,000 stockholders, we will become subject to the provisions of Section 203 of the DGCL (“Section 203”). In general, Section 203 prohibits a public Delaware corporation from engaging in a “business combination” with an “interested stockholder” for a period of three years after the date of the transaction in which the person became an interested stockholder, unless:

the business combination or transaction which resulted in the stockholder becoming an interested stockholder was approved by the board of directors prior to the time that the stockholder became an interested stockholder;

upon consummation of the transaction which resulted in the stockholder becoming an interested stockholder, the interested stockholder owned at least 85% of the voting stock of the corporation outstanding at the time the transaction commenced, excluding shares owned by directors who are also officers of the corporation and shares owned by employee stock plans in which employee participants do not have the right to determine confidentially whether shares held subject to the plan will be tendered in a tender or exchange offer; or
 
125

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 

at or subsequent to the time the stockholder became an interested stockholder, the business combination was approved by the board of directors and authorized at an annual or special meeting of the stockholders, and not by written consent, by the affirmative vote of at least two-thirds of the outstanding voting stock which is not owned by the interested stockholder.
In general, Section 203 defines a “business combination” to include mergers, asset sales and other transactions resulting in financial benefit to a stockholder and an “interested stockholder” as a person who, together with affiliates and associates, owns, or within three years did own, 15% or more of the corporation’s outstanding voting stock.
A Delaware corporation may “opt out” of these provisions with an express provision in its original certificate of incorporation or an express provision in its certificate of incorporation or bylaws resulting from an amendment approved by at least a majority of the outstanding voting shares. We have not opted out of these provisions. As a result, mergers or other takeover or change in control attempts of us may be discouraged or prevented. These provisions may have the effect of delaying, deferring or preventing changes in control of our Company.
Certificate of Incorporation and Bylaw Provisions
Our certificate of incorporation and our bylaws, which will become effective immediately prior to the completion of this offering, include a number of provisions that could deter hostile takeovers or delay or prevent changes in control of our board of directors or management team, including the following:
Board of Directors Vacancies
Each director is to hold office until the next election of the class for which such director shall have been chosen and until his or her successor is duly elected and qualified or until his or her earlier death, resignation or removal. Our certificate of incorporation and bylaws will authorize only our board of directors to fill vacant directorships, including newly created seats. In addition, the number of directors constituting our board of directors will be permitted to be set only by a resolution adopted by a majority vote of our entire board of directors. These provisions would prevent a stockholder from increasing the size of our board of directors and then gaining control of our board of directors by filling the resulting vacancies with its own nominees. This makes it more difficult to change the composition of our board of directors and promotes continuity of management.
Advance Notice Requirements for Stockholder Proposals and Director Nominations
Our bylaws will provide advance notice procedures for stockholders seeking to bring business before our annual meeting of stockholders or to nominate candidates for election as directors at our annual meeting of stockholders. Our bylaws also will specify certain requirements regarding the form and content of a stockholder’s notice. These provisions might preclude our stockholders from bringing matters before our annual meeting of stockholders or from making nominations for directors at our annual meeting of stockholders if the proper procedures are not followed. We expect that these provisions may also discourage or deter a potential acquirer from conducting a solicitation of proxies to elect the acquirer’s own slate of directors or otherwise attempting to obtain control of our Company.
Removal of Directors
Our certificate of incorporation will provide that directors may only be removed for cause and upon the affirmative vote of two-thirds of the outstanding voting power of our capital stock. Any vacancy on our board of directors, including a vacancy resulting from an enlargement of our board of directors, may be filled only by vote of a majority of our directors then in office.
The limitations on the removal of directors and filling of vacancies could make it more difficult for a third party to acquire, or discourage a third party from seeking to acquire, control of our Company.
No Cumulative Voting
The DGCL provides that stockholders are not entitled to cumulate votes in the election of directors unless a corporation’s certificate of incorporation provides otherwise. Our certificate of incorporation does not provide for cumulative voting.
 
126

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
Amendment of Certificate of Incorporation and Bylaws Provisions
Amendments to certain provisions of our certificate of incorporation will require the approval of a two-thirds majority of the outstanding voting power of our capital stock. Our certificate of incorporation and bylaws will provide that approval of stockholders holding a two-thirds majority of our outstanding voting power is required for stockholders to amend or adopt any provision of our bylaws.
Exclusive Forum
Our bylaws will provide that, unless we consent in writing to the selection of an alternative forum, to the fullest extent permitted by law, the sole and exclusive forum for (i) any derivative action or proceeding brought on our behalf, (ii) any action asserting a claim of breach of a fiduciary duty owed by any of our directors or officers to us or our stockholders, (iii) any action asserting a claim against us arising pursuant to any provision of the DGCL or our certificate of incorporation or bylaws or (iv) any action asserting a claim that is governed by the internal affairs doctrine, shall be the Court of Chancery of the State of Delaware; provided that, the exclusive forum provision will not apply to suits brought to enforce any liability or duty created by the Exchange Act or any other claim for which the federal courts have exclusive jurisdiction; and provided further that, if and only if the Court of Chancery of the State of Delaware dismisses any such action for lack of subject matter jurisdiction, such action may be brought in another state or federal court sitting in the State of Delaware. Our bylaws also will provide that the federal district courts of the United States of America will be the exclusive forum for the resolution of any complaint asserting a cause of action against us or any of our directors, officers, employees or agents arising under the Securities Act. Any person or entity purchasing or otherwise acquiring any interest in our securities shall be deemed to have notice of and consented to this provision. Although we believe these provisions will benefit us by providing increased consistency in the application of Delaware law for the specified types of actions and proceedings, the provisions may have the effect of discouraging lawsuits against us or our directors and officers. There is uncertainty as to whether a court would enforce such provisions, and the enforceability of similar choice of forum provisions in other companies’ charter documents has been challenged in legal proceedings. While the Delaware courts have determined that such choice of forum provisions are facially valid, a stockholder may nevertheless seek to bring a claim in a venue other than those designated in the exclusive forum provisions, and there can be no assurance that such provisions will be enforced by a court in those other jurisdictions. We note that investors cannot waive compliance with the federal securities laws and the rules and regulations thereunder.
Listing
We have applied to list our Class A common stock on the Nasdaq Capital Market under the symbol “DRCT.”
Transfer Agent and Registrar
The transfer agent and registrar for our capital stock is American Stock Transfer & Trust Company, LLC.
 
127

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
SHARES ELIGIBLE FOR FUTURE SALE
Based on the number of shares outstanding as of September 30, 2021, upon completion of this offering and after giving effect to the Organizational Transactions, 4,000,000 shares of Class A common stock will be outstanding. Of these outstanding shares, all 4,000,000 shares sold in this offering will be freely tradable without restrictions or further registration under the Securities Act, except for any shares held by our “affiliates,” as that term is defined under Rule 144 promulgated under the Securities Act. Restricted securities may be sold in the public market only if the resale is registered or if their resale qualifies for exemption from registration described below under Rule 144 or another available exemption.
Rule 144
In general, under Rule 144, as currently in effect, once we have been subject to public company reporting requirements of Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Exchange Act for at least 90 days, an eligible stockholder is entitled to sell such shares without complying with the manner of sale, volume limitation or notice provisions of Rule 144, subject to compliance with the public information requirements of Rule 144. To be an eligible stockholder under Rule 144, such stockholder must not be deemed to have been one of our affiliates for purposes of the Securities Act at any time during the 90 days preceding a sale and must have beneficially owned the shares proposed to be sold for at least six months, including the holding period of any prior owner other than our affiliates. If such a person has beneficially owned the shares proposed to be sold for at least one year, including the holding period of any prior owner other than our affiliates, then such person is entitled to sell such shares without complying with any of the requirements of Rule 144, subject to compliance with the public information requirements of Rule 144 and the expiration of the lock-up agreements described below.
In general, under Rule 144, as currently in effect, our affiliates, or persons selling shares on behalf of our affiliates, are entitled to sell shares on expiration of the lock-up agreements described below. Beginning 90 days after the date of this prospectus, within any three-month period, such stockholders may sell a number of shares that does not exceed the greater of:

1% of the number of shares of our Class A common stock then outstanding, which will equal approximately 40,000 shares immediately after this offering, assuming no exercise of the underwriters’ option to purchase additional shares of our Class A common stock from us; or

the average weekly trading volume of our Class A common stock on the Nasdaq Capital Market during the four calendar weeks preceding the filing of a notice on Form 144 with respect to such sale.
Sales under Rule 144 by our affiliates or persons selling shares on behalf of our affiliates are also subject to certain manner of sale provisions and notice requirements and to the availability of current public information about us.
Omnibus Incentive Plan
We intend to file a registration statement on Form S-8 under the Securities Act to register all shares of our common stock issuable under the 2022 Plan shortly after the date of this prospectus, permitting the sale of such shares, subject to applicable vesting conditions, by nonaffiliates in the public market without restriction under the Securities Act and by affiliates in the public market, subject to compliance with the resale provisions of Rule 144.
Lock-Up Arrangements
We, each of our directors and officers and our stockholders have agreed not to offer, sell, agree to sell, directly or indirectly, or otherwise dispose of any shares of Class A common stock or any securities convertible into or exchangeable for shares of Class A common stock without the prior written consent of the representatives for a period of 180 days from the closing. These lock-up agreements provide limited exceptions, and their restrictions may be waived at any time by the representatives.
 
128

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
CERTAIN MATERIAL UNITED STATES FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSIDERATIONS
FOR NON-U.S. HOLDERS
The following is a summary of certain material U.S. federal income tax consequences of the purchase, ownership and disposition of our Class A common stock issued pursuant to this offering by non-U.S. holders (as defined below), but does not purport to be a complete analysis of all the potential tax considerations relating thereto. This summary is based upon the provisions of the Code, Treasury regulations promulgated or proposed thereunder, judicial decisions, and published rulings and administrative pronouncements of the IRS, in each case in effect as of the date hereof. These authorities may be changed, possibly with retroactive effect, so as to result in U.S. federal income tax consequences different from those set forth below. We have not sought, and will not seek, either an opinion from legal counsel, or any rulings from the IRS regarding the matters discussed below, and there can be no assurance that the IRS will not take a position contrary to those discussed below or that any position taken by the IRS will not be sustained.
This summary is limited to non-U.S. holders who purchase our Class A common stock pursuant to this offering and who hold shares of our Class A common stock as capital assets within the meaning of Section 1221 of the Code (generally, property held for investment purposes). This summary does not address the tax consequences arising under the laws of any non-U.S., state, or local jurisdiction or under U.S. federal gift and estate tax laws or the effect, if any, of the alternative minimum tax or the Medicare contribution tax imposed on net investment income. In addition, this discussion does not address tax considerations applicable to a non-U.S. holder’s particular circumstances or to a non-U.S. holder that may be subject to special tax rules, including, without limitation:

banks, insurance companies, or other financial institutions;

partnerships or other entities or arrangements classified as partnerships for U.S. federal income tax purposes and investors therein;

tax-exempt organizations or governmental organizations;

persons required for U.S. federal income tax purposes to conform the timing of income accruals to their financial statements under Section 451 of the Code;

controlled foreign corporations, passive foreign investment companies, and corporations that accumulate earnings to avoid U.S. federal income tax;

brokers or dealers in securities or currencies;

traders in securities that elect to use a mark-to-market method of accounting for their securities holdings;

U.S. expatriates and former citizens or former long-term residents of the United States;

persons who hold our Class A common stock as a position in a hedging transaction, “straddle,” “conversion transaction,” or other risk reduction transaction;

persons who hold or receive our Class A common stock pursuant to the exercise of any employee stock option or otherwise as compensation;

tax-qualified retirement plans;

qualified foreign pension funds as defined in Section 897(l)(2) of the Code and entities all of the interest of which are held by qualified foreign pension funds; and

persons deemed to sell our Class A common stock under the constructive sale provisions of the Code.
In addition, if a partnership (including an entity or arrangement classified as a partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes) holds our Class A common stock, the tax treatment of a partner generally will depend on the status of the partner and upon the activities of the partner and the partnership. Accordingly, partnerships (and entities treated as such for U.S. federal income tax purposes) that hold our Class A common stock, and partners in such partnerships, should consult their tax advisors regarding the U.S. federal income tax treatment to them in light of their particular circumstances.
 
129

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
      PROSPECTIVE INVESTORS ARE ENCOURAGED TO CONSULT WITH AND RELY SOLELY UPON THEIR TAX ADVISORS WITH RESPECT TO THE APPLICATION OF THE U.S. FEDERAL INCOME TAX LAWS TO THEIR PARTICULAR SITUATIONS, AS WELL AS ANY TAX CONSEQUENCES OF THE PURCHASE, OWNERSHIP AND DISPOSITION OF OUR CLASS A COMMON STOCK ARISING UNDER THE U.S. FEDERAL ESTATE OR GIFT TAX LAWS OR UNDER THE LAWS OF ANY STATE, LOCAL, NON-U.S. OR OTHER TAXING JURISDICTION OR UNDER ANY APPLICABLE INCOME TAX TREATY.
Non-U.S. Holder Defined
For purposes of this discussion, you are a “non-U.S. holder” if you are a beneficial owner of our Class A common stock and you are neither a “U.S. person” nor an entity or arrangement classified as a partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes. A U.S. person is any person that, for U.S. federal income tax purposes, is or is treated as any of the following:

an individual who is a citizen or resident of the United States;

a corporation or other entity taxable as a corporation created or organized under the laws of the United States, any state thereof, or the District of Columbia;

an estate whose income is subject to U.S. federal income tax regardless of its source; or

a trust (x) whose administration is subject to the primary supervision of a U.S. court and which has one or more “United States persons” ​(within the meaning of Section 7701(a)(30) of the Code) who has the authority to control all substantial decisions of the trust or (y) which has made a valid election under applicable Treasury regulations to be treated as a United States person for U.S. federal income tax purposes.
If a partnership (including an entity or arrangement treated as a partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes) holds our Class A common stock, the tax treatment of a partner in the partnership generally will depend upon the status of the partner, upon the activities of the partnership and upon certain determinations made at the partner level. Accordingly, we urge partners in partnerships (including entities or arrangements treated as partnerships for U.S. federal income tax purposes) considering the purchase of our Class A common stock to consult with and rely solely upon their tax advisors regarding the U.S. federal income tax considerations of the purchase, ownership and disposition of our Class A common stock by such partnership.
Distributions
As described in the section entitled “Dividend Policy,” we do not expect to make any distributions on our Class A common stock for the foreseeable future. However, if we do make distributions on our Class A common stock or rights to acquire our Class A common stock, other than certain pro rata distributions of Class A common stock, such distributions will constitute dividends for U.S. federal income tax purposes to the extent paid from our current or accumulated earnings and profits, as determined under U.S. federal income tax principles. To the extent distributions exceed both our current and our accumulated earnings and profits, such distributions will first constitute a tax-free return of capital and will reduce your adjusted tax basis in our Class A common stock (determined on a share-by-share basis), but not below zero, and, thereafter, any excess will be treated as capital gain from the sale of our Class A common stock, subject to the tax treatment described below in “Certain Material United States Federal Income Tax Considerations for Non-U.S. Holders — Gain on Sale or Other Taxable Disposition of Class A Common Stock.”
Any dividend paid to you generally will be subject to U.S. federal withholding tax at a rate of 30% of the gross amount of the dividend, or such lower rate as may be specified by an applicable income tax treaty, except to the extent that the dividends are “effectively connected” dividends, as described below. In order to claim treaty benefits to which you are entitled, you must timely provide us with a properly completed IRS Form W-8BEN or W-8BEN-E (or other applicable or successor form) certifying under penalty of perjury that you (i) are not a “United States person” as defined under the Code, and (ii) qualify for the reduced treaty rate. If you do not timely furnish the required documentation, but are otherwise eligible for a reduced rate of U.S. federal withholding tax pursuant to an income tax treaty, you may obtain a refund of any excess
 
130

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
amounts withheld by timely filing an appropriate claim for refund with the IRS. If you hold our Class A common stock through a financial institution or other agent acting on your behalf, you will be required to provide appropriate documentation to the agent, who then will be required to provide certification to us or our paying agent, either directly or through other intermediaries. This certification must be provided to us (or, if applicable, our paying agent) prior to the payment to you of any dividends and may be required to be updated periodically. Non-U.S. holders should consult their own tax advisors regarding their potential entitlement to benefits under any applicable income tax treaty.
To the extent provided for in the applicable Treasury regulations we may withhold up to 30% of the gross amount of an entire distribution, even if the amount of the entire distribution is greater than the amount of such distribution constituting a dividend. If tax is withheld on the amount of a distribution in excess of the amount constituting a dividend, then a refund of any such excess amounts may be obtained by you by timely filing a claim for refund with the IRS.
Dividends received by you that are effectively connected with your conduct of a trade or business within the United States (and, if an applicable income tax treaty requires, attributable to a permanent establishment or fixed place of business maintained by you in the United States) are exempt from the U.S. federal withholding tax described above. In order to claim this exemption, you must provide us (or, if applicable, our paying agent) with an IRS Form W-8ECI (or a successor form) properly certifying that the dividends are effectively connected with your conduct of a trade or business within the United States. Such “effectively connected dividends,” although not subject to U.S. federal withholding tax, are generally taxed at the same U.S. federal income tax rates applicable to U.S. persons, net of certain deductions and credits (except as provided by an applicable income tax treaty). In addition, if you are a corporate non-U.S. holder, you may also be subject to a branch profits tax at a rate of 30% (or such lower rate as may be specified by an applicable income tax treaty) on your effectively connected earnings and profits for the taxable year that are attributable to such dividends, as adjusted for certain items.
Gain on Sale or Other Taxable Disposition of Class A Common Stock
Subject to the discussions below regarding FATCA (as defined below) and backup withholding, you generally will not be required to pay U.S. federal income tax on any gain realized upon the sale or other taxable disposition of our Class A common stock unless:

the gain is effectively connected with your conduct of a U.S. trade or business (and, if an applicable income tax treaty requires, the gain is attributable to a permanent establishment or fixed place of business maintained by you in the United States);

you are a nonresident individual who is present in the United States for a period or periods aggregating 183 days or more during the taxable year in which the sale or disposition occurs, and certain other conditions are met; or

our Class A common stock constitutes a U.S. real property interest by reason of our status as a “United States real property holding corporation,” or a “USRPHC,” for U.S. federal income tax purposes, at any time during the shorter of the five-year period ending on the date of the sale or other taxable disposition of our Class A common stock or your holding period for our Class A common stock, and certain other conditions are met.
If you are a non-U.S. holder described in the first bullet above, you generally will be subject to U.S. federal income tax on the gain derived from the sale or other taxable disposition (net of certain deductions or credits) under the U.S. federal income tax rates generally applicable to U.S. persons (except as provided by an applicable income tax treaty), and corporate non-U.S. holders described in the first bullet above also may be subject to branch profits tax at a 30% rate or such lower rate as may be specified by an applicable income tax treaty.
If you are an individual non-U.S. holder described in the second bullet above, you will be subject to U.S. federal income tax at a rate of 30% (or such lower rate as may be specified by an applicable income tax treaty) on the gain derived from the sale or other taxable disposition, which may be offset by U.S. source capital losses for that taxable year (even though you are not considered a resident of the United States), provided that you have timely filed U.S. federal income tax returns with respect to such losses.
 
131

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
With respect to the third bullet above, in general, we would be a USRPHC if our “U.S. real property interests” comprised at least 50% of the sum of the fair market value of our worldwide real property interests plus our other assets used or held in our trade or business. We believe that we are not currently and (based upon our projections as to our business) will not become a USRPHC. However, because the determination of whether we are a USRPHC depends on the fair market value of our U.S. real property interests relative to the fair market value of our non-U.S. real property interests and our other business assets, there can be no assurance that we will not become a USRPHC in the future. Even if we are or were to become a USRPHC, gain arising from the sale or other taxable disposition by a non-U.S. holder of our Class A common stock would not be subject to U.S. federal income tax if our Class A common stock is “regularly traded” ​(within the meaning of applicable Treasury regulations) on an established securities market, and such non-U.S. holder has owned, actually and constructively, five percent or less of our Class A common stock at all times during the applicable period described above. No assurances can be provided that our Class A common stock will be treated as regularly traded on an established securities market for purposes of the rules described above. Non-U.S. holders are encouraged to consult their own tax advisors with respect to the application of the foregoing rules to their ownership and disposition of our Class A common stock, including any potential entitlement to benefits under any applicable income tax treaty.
Backup Withholding and Information Reporting
Payments of dividends on our Class A common stock will not be subject to backup withholding provided you either certify under penalties of perjury your non-U.S. status, such as by furnishing a valid IRS Form W-8BEN, W-8BEN-E or W-8ECI (or a successor form), or otherwise establish an exemption. However, information returns are required to be filed with the IRS in connection with any distributions on our Class A common stock paid to you, regardless of whether any tax is subject to backup withholding, and whether such distributions constitute dividends.
In addition, proceeds from the sale or other taxable disposition of our Class A common stock within the United States or conducted through certain U.S.-related brokers generally will not be subject to backup withholding or information reporting, if the applicable withholding agent receives the certification described above, or you otherwise establish an exemption. Proceeds from a disposition of our Class A common stock conducted through a non-U.S. office of a non-U.S. broker generally will not be subject to backup withholding or information reporting.
Copies of information returns that are filed with the IRS may also be made available under the provisions of an applicable treaty or agreement to tax authorities in your country of residence, establishment, or organization.
Backup withholding is not an additional tax. Any amounts withheld under the backup withholding rules may be allowed as a refund or credit against a non-U.S. holder’s U.S. federal income tax liability, provided that the required information is timely furnished by such non-U.S. holder to the IRS.
Additional Withholding Tax on Payments Made Respecting Foreign Accounts
Sections 1471 through 1474 of the Code, enacted pursuant to the Foreign Account Tax Compliance Act and the rules and regulations promulgated thereunder (collectively, “FATCA”) impose withholding tax at a rate of 30% on dividends on our Class A common stock paid to a “foreign financial institution” ​(as defined in the Code), unless such institution enters into an agreement with the U.S. government to withhold on certain payments and to collect and provide to the U.S. tax authorities substantial information regarding the U.S. account holders of such institution (which includes certain equity and debt holders of such institution, as well as certain account holders that are foreign entities with U.S. owners) or otherwise establishes an exemption. FATCA also generally imposes a U.S. federal withholding tax of 30% on dividends on our Class A common stock paid to a “non-financial foreign entity” ​(as defined in the Code) unless such entity provides the withholding agent with a certification identifying certain substantial direct and indirect U.S. owners of the entity, certifies that there are none or otherwise establishes an exemption. Additionally, although FATCA withholding would have applied also to gross proceeds of a disposition of the Class A common stock, recently proposed regulations, which taxpayers are permitted to rely on until final regulations are issued, eliminate withholding on such gross proceeds. The withholding provisions under FATCA generally apply to dividends on our Class A common stock. Under certain circumstances, a non-U.S.
 
132

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
holder might be eligible for refunds or credits of such taxes. An intergovernmental agreement between the United States and an applicable foreign country may modify the requirements described in this paragraph. Non-U.S. holders are encouraged to consult their own tax advisors regarding the possible implications of FACTA on their investment in our Class A common stock.
THE PRECEDING DISCUSSION OF U.S. FEDERAL TAX CONSEQUENCES IS FOR GENERAL INFORMATION ONLY. THIS DISCUSSION IS NOT TAX ADVICE. PROSPECTIVE INVESTORS CONSIDERING THE PURCHASE OF OUR CLASS A COMMON STOCK ARE URGED TO CONSULT WITH AND RELY SOLELY UPON THEIR OWN TAX ADVISORS REGARDING THE APPLICATION OF THE U.S. FEDERAL INCOME TAX LAWS TO THEIR PARTICULAR SITUATIONS AND THE APPLICABILITY AND EFFECT OF U.S. FEDERAL ESTATE AND GIFT TAX LAWS AND ANY STATE, LOCAL OR NON-U.S. TAX LAWS AND TAX TREATIES, INCLUDING THE CONSEQUENCES OF ANY PROPOSED CHANGE IN APPLICABLE LAWS.
 
133

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
UNDERWRITING
We are offering the shares of Class A common stock described in this prospectus through the underwriters listed below. Subject to the terms of the underwriting agreement, the underwriters named below have agreed to buy, severally and not jointly, the number of shares of Class A common stock listed opposite their names below. The underwriters are committed to purchase and pay for all of the shares if any are purchased, other than those shares covered by the over-allotment option described below. The Benchmark Company, LLC and Roth Capital Partners, LLC are acting as the joint book-running managers of this offering and representatives of the underwriters.
Underwriter
Number
of Shares
The Benchmark Company, LLC
Roth Capital Partners, LLC
Total
The underwriters have advised us that they propose to initially offer the shares of Class A common stock to the public at a price of $      per share. The underwriters propose to offer the shares of Class A common stock to certain dealers at the same price less a concession of not more than $      per share. After the initial offering, these figures may be changed by the underwriters.
The shares sold in this offering are expected to be ready for delivery against payment in immediately available funds on or about           , 2022, subject to customary closing conditions. The underwriters may reject all or part of any order.
We have granted to the underwriters an option to purchase up to an additional 600,000 shares of Class A common stock from us at the same price to the public, and with the same underwriting discount, as set forth in the table below. The underwriters may exercise this option any time during the 45-day period after the date of this prospectus, but only to cover over-allotments, if any. To the extent the underwriters exercise the option, the underwriters will become obligated, subject to certain conditions, to purchase the shares for which they exercise the option.
Commissions and Discounts
The table below summarizes the underwriting discount that we will pay to the underwriters. These amounts are shown assuming both no exercise and full exercise of the over-allotment option. In addition to the underwriting discount, we have agreed to pay up to $200,000 of the fees and expenses of the underwriters, which may include up to $175,000 of fees and expenses of counsel to the underwriters. The fees and expenses of the underwriters that we have agreed to reimburse are not included in the underwriting discount set forth in the table below.
Except as disclosed in this prospectus, the underwriters have not received and will not receive from us any other item of compensation or expense in connection with this offering considered by the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority, Inc. (“FINRA”) to be underwriting compensation under FINRA Rule 5110. The underwriting discount was determined through an arms’ length negotiation between us and the underwriters.
Per Share
Total with
No
Over-
Allotment
Total with
Over-
Allotment
Underwriting discount to be paid by us
We estimate that the total expenses of this offering, excluding underwriting discounts, will be approximately $2.0 million. This includes $200,000 of fees and expenses of the underwriters. These expenses are payable by us.
Indemnification
We also have agreed to indemnify the underwriters against certain liabilities, including civil liabilities under the Securities Act, or to contribute to payments that the underwriters may be required to make in respect of those liabilities.
 
134

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
No Sales of Class A Common Stock
We, each of our directors and officers and our stockholders have agreed not to offer, sell, agree to sell, directly or indirectly, or otherwise dispose of any shares of Class A common stock or any securities convertible into or exchangeable for shares of Class A common stock without the prior written consent of the representatives for a period of 180 days after the date of this prospectus. These lock-up agreements provide limited exceptions, and their restrictions may be waived at any time by the representatives.
Determination of Offering Price
The underwriters have advised us that they propose to offer the shares of Class A common stock directly to the public at the estimated initial public offering price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus. That price range and the initial public offering price are subject to change as a result of market conditions and other factors. Prior to this offering, no public market exists for our Class A common stock. The initial public offering price of the shares was determined by negotiation between us and the underwriters. The principal factors considered in determining the initial public offering price of the shares included, among others:

the information in this prospectus and otherwise available to the underwriters, including our financial information;

the history and the prospects for the industry in which we compete;

the ability and experience of our management;

the prospects for our future earnings;

the present state of our development and our current financial condition;

the general condition of the economy and the securities markets in the United States at the time of this initial public offering;

the recent market prices of, and the demand for, publicly-traded securities of generally comparable companies; and

other factors as were deemed relevant.
We cannot be sure that the initial public offering price will correspond to the price at which the shares of Class A common stock will trade in the public market following this offering or that an active trading market for the shares of Class A common stock will develop or continue after this offering.
Price Stabilization, Short Positions and Penalty Bids
To facilitate this offering, the underwriters may engage in transactions that stabilize, maintain or otherwise affect the price of our Class A common stock during and after the offering. Specifically, the underwriters may create a short position in our Class A common stock for their own accounts by selling more shares of Class A common stock than we have sold to the underwriters. The underwriters may close out any short position by purchasing shares in the open market.
In addition, the underwriters may stabilize or maintain the price of our Class A common stock by bidding for or purchasing shares in the open market and may impose penalty bids. If penalty bids are imposed, selling concessions allowed to broker-dealers participating in this offering are reclaimed if shares previously distributed in this offering are repurchased, whether in connection with stabilization transactions or otherwise. The effect of these transactions may be to stabilize or maintain the market price of our Class A common stock at a level above that which might otherwise prevail in the open market. The imposition of a penalty bid may also affect the price of our Class A common stock to the extent that it discourages resales of our Class A common stock. The magnitude or effect of any stabilization or other transactions is uncertain. These transactions may be effected on the Nasdaq Capital Market or otherwise and, if commenced, may be discontinued at any time.
In connection with this offering, the underwriters and selling group members may also engage in passive market making transactions in our Class A common stock on the Nasdaq Capital Market. Passive
 
135

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
market making consists of displaying bids on the Nasdaq Capital Market limited by the prices of independent market makers and effecting purchases limited by those prices in response to order flow. Rule 103 of Regulation  M promulgated by the SEC limits the amount of net purchases that each passive market maker may make and the displayed size of each bid. Passive market making may stabilize the market price of our Class A common stock at a level above that which might otherwise prevail in the open market and, if commenced, may be discontinued at any time.
Neither we nor the underwriters make any representation or prediction as to the direction or magnitude of any effect that the transactions described above may have on the price of our Class A common stock. In addition, neither we nor the underwriters make any representation that the underwriters will engage in these transactions or that any transaction, if commenced, will not be discontinued without notice.
Representatives’ Warrants
Upon the closing of this offering, we have agreed to issue to the representatives warrants, or the representatives’ warrants, to purchase a number of shares of common stock equal to 5% of the total shares sold in this public offering. The representatives’ warrants will be exercisable at a per share exercise price equal to 120% of the public offering price per share of common stock sold in this offering. The representatives’ warrants are exercisable at any time and from time to time, in whole or in part, during the four-and-½-year period commencing six months after the effective date of the registration statement related to this offering.
The representatives’ warrants and the shares of common stock underlying the representatives’ warrants have been deemed compensation by the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority, or FINRA, and are therefore subject to a 180-day lock-up pursuant to Rule 5110(g)(1) of FINRA. The representatives, or permitted assignees under such rule, may not sell, transfer, assign, pledge, or hypothecate the representatives’ warrants or the securities underlying the representatives’ warrants, nor will the representatives engage in any hedging, short sale, derivative, put, or call transaction that would result in the effective economic disposition of the representatives’ warrants or the underlying shares for a period of 180 days from the effective date of the registration statement. Additionally, the representatives’ warrants may not be sold transferred, assigned, pledged or hypothecated for a 180-day period following the effective date of the registration statement except to any underwriter and selected dealer participating in this offering and their bona fide officers or partners. The representatives’ warrants will provide for adjustment in the number and price of the representatives’ warrants and the shares of common stock underlying such representatives’ warrants in the event of recapitalization, merger, stock split or other structural transaction, or a future financing undertaken by us.
Electronic Offer, Sale and Distribution of Shares
The underwriters or syndicate members may facilitate the marketing of this offering online directly or through one of their respective affiliates. In those cases, prospective investors may view offering terms and a prospectus online and place orders online or through their financial advisors. Such websites and the information contained on such websites, or connected to such sites, are not incorporated into and are not a part of this prospectus.
Other Relationships
The underwriters and their affiliates are full service financial institutions engaged in various activities, which may include securities trading, commercial and investment banking, financial advisory, investment management, investment research, principal investment, hedging, financing and brokerage activities. The underwriters may in the future engage in investment banking and other commercial dealings in the ordinary course of business with us or our affiliates. The underwriters may in the future receive customary fees and commissions for these transactions.
In the ordinary course of their various business activities, the underwriters and their affiliates may make or hold a broad array of investments and actively trade debt and equity securities (or related derivative securities) and financial instruments (including bank loans) for their own account and for the accounts of their customers, and such investment and securities activities may involve securities and/or instruments of the issuer. The underwriters and their affiliates may also make investment recommendations and/or publish or
 
136

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
express independent research views in respect of such securities or instruments and may at any time hold, or recommend to clients that they acquire, long and/or short positions in such securities and instruments.
Listing
In connection with this offering, we have applied to have our Class A common stock listed on the Nasdaq Capital Market under the symbol “DRCT.” There is no assurance, however, that our Class A common stock will ever be listed on the Nasdaq Capital Market or any other national securities exchange.
Transfer Agent and Registrar
Our transfer agent and registrar is American Stock Transfer & Trust Company, LLC.
Selling Restrictions
No action has been taken in any jurisdiction except the United States that would permit a public offering of our Class A common stock, or the possession, circulation or distribution of this prospectus or any other material relating to us or our Class A common stock in any jurisdiction where action for that purpose is required. Accordingly, the shares may not be offered or sold, directly or indirectly, and neither this prospectus nor any other offering material or advertisements in connection with the shares may be distributed or published, in or from any country or jurisdiction except in compliance with any applicable rules and regulations of any such country or jurisdiction.
Canada
The securities may be sold in Canada only to purchasers purchasing, or deemed to be purchasing, as principal that are accredited investors, as defined in National Instrument 45-106 Prospectus Exemptions or subsection 73.3(1) of the Securities Act (Ontario), and are permitted clients, as defined in National Instrument 31-103 Registration Requirements, Exemptions and Ongoing Registrant Obligations. Any resale of the securities must be made in accordance with an exemption from, or in a transaction not subject to, the prospectus requirements of applicable securities laws.
Securities legislation in certain provinces or territories of Canada may provide a purchaser with remedies for rescission or damages if this prospectus (including any amendment thereto) contains a misrepresentation, provided that the remedies for rescission or damages are exercised by the purchaser within the time limit prescribed by the securities legislation of the purchaser’s province or territory. The purchaser should refer to any applicable provisions of the securities legislation of the purchaser’s province or territory for particulars of these rights or consult with a legal advisor.
Pursuant to section 3A.3 of National Instrument 33-105 Underwriting Conflicts (“NI 33-105”), the underwriters are not required to comply with the disclosure requirements of NI 33-105 regarding underwriter conflicts of interest in connection with this offering.
United Kingdom
Each of the underwriters has, separately and not jointly, represented and agreed that:

it has not made or will not make an offer of the securities to the public in the United Kingdom within the meaning of section 102B of the Financial Services and Markets Act 2000 (as amended) (“FSMA”), except to legal entities which are authorized or regulated to operate in the financial markets or, if not so authorized or regulated, whose corporate purpose is solely to invest in securities or otherwise in circumstances which do not require the publication by us of a prospectus pursuant to the Prospectus Rules of the Financial Services Authority;

it has only communicated or caused to be communicated and will only communicate or cause to be communicated an invitation or inducement to engage in investment activity (within the meaning of section 21 of FSMA) to persons who have professional experience in matters relating to investments falling within Article 19(5) of the Financial Services and Markets Act 2000 (Financial Promotion) Order 2005 or in circumstances in which section 21 of FSMA does not apply to us; and
 
137

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 

it has complied with and will comply with all applicable provisions of FSMA with respect to anything done by it in relation to the securities in, from or otherwise involving the United Kingdom.
Switzerland
The securities will not be offered, directly or indirectly, to the public in Switzerland and this prospectus does not constitute a public offering prospectus as that term is understood pursuant to article 652a or 1156 of the Swiss Federal Code of Obligations.
Israel
In the State of Israel this prospectus shall not be regarded as an offer to the public to purchase shares of Class A common stock under the Israeli Securities Law, 5728—1968, which requires a prospectus to be published and authorized by the Israel Securities Authority, if it complies with certain provisions of Section 15 of the Israeli Securities Law, 5728—1968, including, inter alia, if: (i) the offer is made, distributed or directed to not more than 35 investors, subject to certain conditions (the “Addressed Investors”); or (ii) the offer is made, distributed or directed to certain qualified investors defined in the First Addendum of the Israeli Securities Law, 5728—1968, subject to certain conditions (the “Qualified Investors”). The Qualified Investors shall not be taken into account in the count of the Addressed Investors and may be offered to purchase securities in addition to the 35 Addressed Investors. We have not and will not take any action that would require us to publish a prospectus in accordance with and subject to the Israeli Securities Law, 5728—1968. We have not and will not distribute this prospectus or make, distribute or direct an offer to subscribe for our securities to any person within the State of Israel, other than to Qualified Investors and up to 35 Addressed Investors.
Qualified Investors may have to submit written evidence that they meet the definitions set out in of the First Addendum to the Israeli Securities Law, 5728—1968. In particular, we may request, as a condition to be offered securities, that Qualified Investors will each represent, warrant and certify to us and/or to anyone acting on our behalf: (i) that it is an investor falling within one of the categories listed in the First Addendum to the Israeli Securities Law, 5728—1968; (ii) which of the categories listed in the First Addendum to the Israeli Securities Law, 5728—1968 regarding Qualified Investors is applicable to it; (iii) that it will abide by all provisions set forth in the Israeli Securities Law, 5728—1968 and the regulations promulgated thereunder in connection with the offer to be issued securities; (iv) that the securities that it will be issued are, subject to exemptions available under the Israeli Securities Law, 5728—1968: (a) for its own account; (b) for investment purposes only; and (c) not issued with a view to resale within the State of Israel, other than in accordance with the provisions of the Israeli Securities Law, 5728—1968; and (v) that it is willing to provide further evidence of its Qualified Investor status. Addressed Investors may have to submit written evidence in respect of their identity and may have to sign and submit a declaration containing, inter alia, the Addressed Investor’s name, address and passport number or Israeli identification number.
European Economic Area
In relation to each Member State of the EEA (each, a “Relevant Member State”), no offer of securities may be made to the public in that Relevant Member State other than:
(a)
to any legal entity which is a “qualified investor” as defined in the Prospectus Directive;
(b)
to fewer than 150 natural or legal persons (other than qualified investors as defined in the Prospectus Directive), as permitted under the Prospectus Directive, subject to obtaining the prior consent of the representatives; or
(c)
in any other circumstances falling within Article 3(2) of the Prospectus Directive, provided that no such offer of shares shall require us or the representatives to publish a prospectus pursuant to Article 3 of the Prospectus Directive or supplement a prospectus pursuant to Article 16 of the Prospectus Directive,
Each person in a Relevant Member State who initially acquires any shares or to whom any offer is made will be deemed to have represented, acknowledged and agreed to and with the representatives and us
 
138

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
that it is a “qualified investor” within the meaning of the law in that Relevant Member State implementing Article 2(1)(e) of the Prospectus Directive. In the case of any shares being offered to a financial intermediary as that term is used in Article 3(2) of the Prospectus Directive, each such financial intermediary will be deemed to have represented, acknowledged and agreed that the shares acquired by it in the offer have not been acquired on a non-discretionary basis on behalf of, nor have they been acquired with a view to their offer or resale to, persons in circumstances which may give rise to an offer of any shares to the public other than their offer or resale in a Relevant Member State to qualified investors as so defined or in circumstances in which the prior consent of the representatives has been obtained to each such proposed offer or resale.
For the purposes of this provision, the expression an “offer of shares to the public” in relation to any shares in any Relevant Member State means the communication in any form and by any means of sufficient information on the terms of the offer and the shares to be offered so as to enable an investor to decide to purchase or subscribe the shares, as the same may be varied in the Relevant Member State by any measure implementing the Prospectus Directive in the Relevant Member State and the expression “Prospectus Directive” means Directive 2003/71/EC (as amended by Directive 2010/73/EU), and includes any relevant implementing measure in the Relevant Member State.
Hong Kong
The contents of this document have not been reviewed or approved by any regulatory authority in Hong Kong. This document does not constitute an offer or invitation to the public in Hong Kong to acquire shares. Accordingly, unless permitted by the securities laws of Hong Kong, no person may issue or have in its possession for the purposes of issue, this document or any advertisement, invitation or document relating to the shares, whether in Hong Kong or elsewhere, which is directed at, or the contents of which are likely to be accessed or read by, the public in Hong Kong other than in relation to shares which are intended to be disposed of only to persons outside Hong Kong or only to “professional investors” ​(as such term is defined in the Securities and Futures Ordinance (Cap. 571, Laws of Hong Kong) (“SFO”) and the subsidiary legislation made thereunder); or in circumstances which do not result in this document being a “prospectus” as defined in the Companies (Winding Up and Miscellaneous Provisions) Ordinance (Cap. 32, Laws of Hong Kong) (“CO”); or which do not constitute an offer or an invitation to the public for the purposes of the SFO or the CO. The offer of the shares is personal to the person to whom this document has been delivered, and a subscription for shares will only be accepted from such person. No person to whom a copy of this document is issued may issue, circulate or distribute this document in Hong Kong, or make or give a copy of this document to any other person. You are advised to exercise caution in relation to the offer. If you are in any doubt about any of the contents of this document, you should obtain independent professional advice.
Singapore
This prospectus has not been registered as a prospectus with the Monetary Authority of Singapore. Accordingly, this prospectus and any other document or material in connection with the offer or sale, or invitation for subscription or purchase, of the shares may not be circulated or distributed, nor may the shares be offered or sold, or be made the subject of an invitation for subscription or purchase, whether directly or indirectly, to persons in Singapore other than (i) to an institutional investor pursuant to Section 274 of the Securities and Futures Act, Chapter 289 of Singapore (“SFA”), (ii) to a relevant person (as defined in Section 275(2) of the SFA), or any person pursuant to Section 275(1A) of the SFA, and in accordance with the conditions, specified in Section 275 of the SFA, or (iii) otherwise pursuant to, and in accordance with the conditions of, any other applicable provision of the SFA.
Where the shares are subscribed or purchased pursuant to an offer made in reliance on Section 275 of the SFA by a relevant person which is:
(a)
a corporation (which is not an accredited investor) the sole business of which is to hold investments and the entire share capital of which is owned by one or more individuals, each of whom is an accredited investor; or
(b)
a trust (where the trustee is not an accredited investor) whose sole purpose is to hold investments and each beneficiary is an accredited investor;
 
139

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
shares, debentures and units of shares, and debentures of that corporation, or the beneficiaries’ rights and interest (howsoever described) in that trust shall not be transferable for six months after that corporation or that trust has acquired the shares under Section 275 except:
(1)
to an institutional investor or to a relevant person (as defined in Section 275(2) of the SFA), or any person pursuant to Section 275(1A) of the SFA (in the case of that corporation) or Section 276(4)(i)(B) of the SFA (in the case of that trust);
(2)
where no consideration is or will be given for the transfer; or
(3)
where the transfer is by operation of law.
 
140

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
LEGAL MATTERS
The validity of the shares of our Class A common stock offered hereby will be passed upon for us by McGuireWoods LLP, New York, New York. The underwriters are being represented by Faegre Drinker Biddle & Reath LLP.
EXPERTS
The financial statements of Direct Digital Holdings, Inc. as of August 26, 2021 appearing in this prospectus and registration statement have been audited by Marcum LLP, our independent registered public accounting firm, as set forth in its report thereon appearing elsewhere herein, and are included in reliance upon such report given on the authority of such firm as experts in accounting and auditing.
The consolidated financial statements of Direct Digital Holdings, LLC as of December 31, 2020 and 2019, and for each of the two years in the period ended December 31, 2020, appearing in this prospectus and registration statement have been audited by Marcum LLP, our independent registered public accounting firm, as set forth in its report thereon appearing elsewhere herein, and are included in reliance upon such report given on the authority of such firm as experts in accounting and auditing.
The consolidated financial statements of Orange142, LLC as of December 31, 2019 and 2018, and for each of the two years in the period ended December 31, 2019, appearing in this prospectus and registration statement have been audited by Baker Tilly US, LLP, independent registered public accounting firm to Orange142, as set forth in its report thereon appearing elsewhere herein, and are included in reliance upon such report given on the authority of such firm as experts in accounting and auditing.
WHERE YOU CAN FIND ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
We have filed a registration statement on Form S-1 under the Securities Act with the SEC to register with the SEC the shares of our Class A common stock being offered in this prospectus. This prospectus, which constitutes a part of the registration statement, does not contain all of the information set forth in the registration statement or the exhibits and schedules filed with it. For further information about us and our Class A common stock, reference is made to the registration statement and the exhibits and schedules filed with it. Statements contained in this prospectus regarding the contents of any contract or any other document that is filed as an exhibit to the registration statement are not necessarily complete, and each such statement is qualified in all respects by reference to the full text of such contract or other document filed as an exhibit to the registration statement.
When we complete this offering, we will also be required to file annual, quarterly and special reports, proxy statements and other information with the SEC. Our filings, including the registration statement, will also be available to you on the internet website maintained by the SEC at www.sec.gov. We also maintain an internet website at www.directdigitalholdings.com. Upon completion of this offering, you may access these materials free of charge as soon as reasonably practicable after they are electronically filed with, or furnished to, the SEC. Our website and the information contained therein or connected thereto shall not be deemed to be incorporated into this prospectus or the registration statement of which it forms a part.
 
141

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
INDEX TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Page
Audited Financial Statements of Direct Digital Holdings, Inc.
F-4
F-5
F-6
Audited Consolidated Financial Statements of Direct Digital Holdings, LLC
F-9
Unaudited Consolidated Financial Statements of Direct Digital Holdings, LLC
Audited Consolidated Financial Statements of Orange142, LLC
Unaudited Consolidated Financial Statements of Orange142, LLC
 
F-1

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
[MISSING IMAGE: LG_DIRECTDIGITALWHITE-4CLR.JPG]
Direct Digital Holdings, Inc.
Audited Financial Statements
of Direct Digital Holdings, Inc.
As of August 26, 2021
 

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, INC
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS TABLE OF CONTENTS
AUGUST 26, 2021
Page
F-4
Financial Statement
F-5
F-6
 
F-3

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
To the Shareholder of
Direct Digital Holdings, Inc.
Opinion on the Financial Statement
We have audited the accompanying balance sheet of Direct Digital Holdings, Inc. (the “Company”) as of August 26, 2021, and the related notes (collectively referred to as the “financial statement”). In our opinion, the financial statement presents fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the Company as of August 26, 2021, in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.
Basis for Opinion
This financial statement is the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s financial statement based on our audit. We are a public accounting firm registered with the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (“PCAOB”) and are required to be independent with respect to the Company in accordance with the U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.
We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statement is free of material misstatement, whether due to error or fraud. The Company is not required to have, nor were we engaged to perform, an audit of its internal control over financial reporting. As part of our audit, we are required to obtain an understanding of internal control over financial reporting but not for the purpose of expressing an opinion on the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting. Accordingly, we express no such opinion.
Our audit included performing procedures to assess the risks of material misstatement of the financial statement, whether due to error or fraud, and performing procedures that respond to those risks. Such procedures included examining, on a test basis, evidence regarding the amounts and disclosures in the financial statement. Our audit also included evaluating the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the financial statement. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.
/s/ Marcum LLP
Marcum LLP
We have served as the Company’s auditor since 2021.
Houston, Texas
September 9, 2021
 
F-4

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, INC.
BALANCE SHEET
As of August 26, 2021
ASSETS:
Cash
$ 200
Total Assets
$ 200
Commitments and contingencies
STOCKHOLDER’S EQUITY:
Common stock, $0 par value per share, 1,000 shares authorized, issued and outstanding
$
Additional paid-in-capital
200
Total stockholder’s equity
$ 200
 
F-5

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, INC.
NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENT
Note 1 — Organization
Direct Digital Holdings, Inc. (the “Company”) was formed as a Delaware corporation on August 23, 2021. The Company was formed for the purpose of completing a public offering and related transactions in order to carry on the business of Direct Digital Holdings, LLC and its subsidiaries (“DDH LLC”). As the manager of DDH LLC, the Company is expected to operate and control all of the business and affairs of DDH LLC, and through DDH LLC, continue to conduct the business now conducted by these subsidiaries.
Note 2 — Summary of Significant Accounting Policies
Basis of Presentation and Accounting
The financial statement has been prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America (“GAAP”). Separate statements of operations, comprehensive income, changes in stockholder’s equity, and cash flows have not been presented because there have been no activities in this entity as of August 26, 2021.
These financial statements have been prepared assuming the Company will continue as a going concern, which contemplates, among other things, the realization of assets and satisfaction of liabilities in the normal course of business.
Use of Estimates
The preparation of financial statements in conformity with GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the balance sheet. Actual results could differ from those estimates.
Cash
Cash consists of a deposit in-transit.
Note 3 — Common Stock
On August 23, 2021, the Company was authorized to issue 1,000 shares of common stock, with no par value per share, all of which have been issued or are outstanding. On the balance sheet date, the Company issued 1,000 shares at a purchase price of $0.20 per share for aggregate gross proceeds of $200 to DDH LLC. As of the balance sheet date, the Company had outstanding 1,000 shares of which were owned by DDH LLC.
Note 4 — Subsequent Events
The Company has evaluated subsequent events through August 26, 2021, the date these financial statements were available to be issued. The Company has concluded that no subsequent event has occurred that requires disclosure.
 
F-6

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
[MISSING IMAGE: LG_DIRECTDIGITALWHITE-4CLR.JPG]
Direct Digital Holdings, LLC
and Subsidiaries
Consolidated Financial Statements
with Report of Independent Registered
Public Accounting Firm
December 31, 2020 and 2019
 

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS TABLE OF CONTENTS
DECEMBER 31, 2020 AND 2019
Page
F-9
Consolidated Financial Statements
F-10
F-11
F-12
F-13
F-14
 
F-8

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
To the Members of
Direct Digital Holdings, LLC
Opinion on the Financial Statements
We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Direct Digital Holdings, LLC (the “Company”) as of December 31, 2020 and 2019, the related consolidated statements of operations, changes in equity (deficit) and cash flows for each of the two years in the period ended December 31, 2020, and the related notes (collectively referred to as the “financial statements”). In our opinion, the financial statements present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the Company as of December 31, 2020 and 2019, and the results of its operations and its cash flows for each of the two years in the period ended December 31, 2020, in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.
Basis for Opinion
These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s financial statements based on our audits. We are a public accounting firm registered with the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (“PCAOB”) and are required to be independent with respect to the Company in accordance with the U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.
We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audits to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement, whether due to error or fraud. The Company is not required to have, nor were we engaged to perform, an audit of its internal control over financial reporting. As part of our audits we are required to obtain an understanding of internal control over financial reporting but not for the purpose of expressing an opinion on the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting. Accordingly, we express no such opinion.
Our audits included performing procedures to assess the risks of material misstatement of the financial statements, whether due to error or fraud, and performing procedures that respond to those risks. Such procedures included examining, on a test basis, evidence regarding the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. Our audits also included evaluating the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the financial statements. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.
/s/ Marcum LLP
Marcum LLP
We have served as the Company’s auditor since 2021.
Houston, Texas
September 9, 2021
 
F-9

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
DECEMBER 31, 2020 AND 2019
December 31,
2020
2019
ASSETS
CURRENT ASSETS
Cash and cash equivalents
$ 1,611,998 $ 882,292
Accounts receivable
4,679,376 834,071
Prepaid expenses and other current assets
223,344 67,535
Total current assets
6,514,718 1,783,898
Goodwill
6,519,636 2,423,936
Intangible assets, net
17,545,396
Deferred financing costs, net
90,607
Other long-term assets
25,118 15,500
Total assets
$ 30,695,475 $ 4,223,334
LIABILITIES AND MEMBERS’ EQUITY
CURRENT LIABILITIES
Accounts payable
$ 3,263,326 $ 3,096,495
Accrued liabilities
1,392,520 608,324
Notes payable, current portion
1,206,750
Deferred revenues
308,682 41,945
Related party payables (Note 7)
70,801
Seller notes payable
315,509
Seller earnout payable
74,909 369,642
Total current liabilities
6,632,497 4,116,406
Notes payable, net of short-term portion and $501,796 deferred financing cost
11,213,697
Mandatorily redeemable non-participating preferred units
9,913,940
Line of credit
407,051 727,000
Seller notes payable
526,403
Seller earnout payable, net of short-term portion
124,367
Paycheck Protection Program loan
10,000
Economic Injury Disaster Loan
150,000
Total liabilities
28,327,185 5,494,176
COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES (Note 8)
MEMBERS’ EQUITY (DEFICIT)
Units, 1,000,000 units authorized at December 31, 2020 and 2019 34,182 and 28,545 units issued and outstanding as of December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively
4,294,241 200
Receivable from members (Note 7)
(370,789)
Accumulated deficit
(1,925,951) (900,253)
Total members’ equity (deficit)
2,368,290 (1,270,842)
Total liabilities and members’ equity (deficit)
$ 30,695,475 $ 4,223,334
See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements.
F-10

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS
DECEMBER 31, 2020 AND 2019
December 31,
2020
2019
Revenues
Buy-side advertising
$ 9,656,165 $ 5,472,485
Sell-side advertising
2,821,354 798,622
Total revenues
12,477,519 6,271,107
Cost of revenues
Buy-side advertising
4,864,234 3,720,594
Sell-side advertising
2,440,975 816,083
Total cost of revenues
7,305,209 4,536,677
Gross profit
5,172,310 1,734,430
Operating expenses
Compensation, taxes and benefits
3,334,060 1,613,692
General and administrative
1,848,407 993,206
Acquisition transaction costs
834,407
Total operating expenses
6,016,874 2,606,898
Loss from operations
(844,564) (872,468)
Other (expense) income
Other income
134,776 5,851
Forgiveness of Paycheck Protection Program loan
277,100
Gain from revaluation and settlement of seller notes and earnout liability
401,677 79,091
Interest expense
(865,055) (57,105)
Total other (expense) income
(51,502) 27,837
Tax expense
(12,124) (39,137)
Net loss
$ (908,190) $ (883,768)
Net loss per common unit:
Basic and diluted
$ (30.32) $ (30.96)
Weighted-average common units outstanding:
Basic and diluted
29,954 28,545
See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements.
F-11

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN MEMBERS’ EQUITY (DEFICIT)
DECEMBER 31, 2020 AND 2019
Common Units
Receivable
from
members
Accumulated
equity (deficit)
Members’
equity (deficit)
Units
Amount
Balance, January 1, 2019
28,545 $ 200 $ (58,500) $ 5,515 $ (52,785)
Advances to members
(312,289) (312,289)
Distributions to members
(22,000) (22,000)
Net loss
(883,768) (883,768)
Balance, December 31, 2019
28,545 200 (370,789) (900,253) (1,270,842)
Receipts from members
370,789 370,789
Distribution to members
(117,508) (117,508)
Shares issued for acquisition of Orange142, LLC
5,637 4,294,041 4,294,041
Net loss
(908,190) (908,190)
Balance, December 31, 2020
34,182 $ 4,294,241 $ $ (1,925,951) $ 2,368,290
See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements.
F-12

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
DECEMBER 31, 2020 AND 2019
December 31,
2020
2019
Cash Flows (Used In) Provided By Operating Activities:
Net loss
$ (908,190) $ (883,768)
Adjustments to reconcile net loss to net cash (used in) provided by operating activities:
Amortization of deferred financing costs
84,629
Amortization of intangible assets
488,454
Forgiveness of Paycheck Protection Program loan
(277,100)
Paid-in-kind interest
97,243
Gain from revaluation and settlement of earnout liability
(401,677) (79,091)
Bad debt expense
8,086 109,777
Changes in operating assets and liabilities:
Accounts receivable
737,554 390,986
Prepaid expenses and other current assets
(7,093) 965
Accounts payable
(516,690) 352,210
Accrued liabilities
540,033 280,375
Deferred revenues
(490,577) 38,789
Related party payable
70,801
Net cash (used in) provided by operating activities
(574,527) 210,243
Cash Flows Used In Investing Activities:
Cash paid for acquisition of Orange142, net of cash acquired
(10,985,849)
Net cash used in investing activities
(10,985,849)
Cash Flows Provided By Financing Activities:
Proceeds from note payable
12,825,000 (200,082)
Payments of litigation settlement
(210,000)
Proceeds from lines of credit
1,083,051 1,040,000
Payments on lines of credit
(1,403,000) (313,000)
Payment of deferred financing costs
(677,032)
Proceeds from Paycheck Protection Program loan
287,100
Proceeds from Economic Injury Disaster Loan
150,000
Receipts from (advances to) members
370,789 (312,289)
Payments on seller notes and earnouts payable
(18,318) (149,628)
Distributions to members
(117,508) (22,000)
Net cash provided by financing activities
12,290,082 43,001
Net increase in cash and cash equivalents
729,706 253,244
Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of the year
882,292 629,048
Cash and cash equivalents, end of the year
$ 1,611,998 $ 882,292
Non-cash Investing and Financing:
Issuance of members’ units as purchase consideration (Note 3)
$ 14,207,981 $
Supplemental Disclosure of Cash Flow Information:
Cash paid for taxes
$ 12,124 $ 39,137
Cash paid for interest
$ 620,474 $ 31,735
See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements.
F-13

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
DECEMBER 31, 2020 AND 2019
Note 1 — Organization and Description of Business
Direct Digital Holdings, LLC and its subsidiaries (collectively the “Company”, “DDH”, “we”, “us” and “our”), headquartered in Houston, Texas, is an end-to-end, full-service programmatic advertising platform primarily focused on providing advertising technology, data-driven campaign optimization and other solutions to underserved and less efficient markets on both the buy- and sell-side of the digital advertising ecosystem. Direct Digital Holdings, LLC (or “Holdings”) is the holding company for the business formed by its founders in 2018 through the acquisition of Huddled Masses, LLC (“Huddled Masses”) and Colossus Media, LLC (“Colossus Media”). In late September 2020, Holdings acquired Orange142, LLC (“Orange142”) to further bolster its overall programmatic buy-side advertising platform and to enhance its offerings across multiple industry verticals such as travel, healthcare, education, financial services, consumer products, etc. with particular emphasis on small and mid-sized businesses transitioning into digital with growing digital media budgets. All of the subsidiaries are incorporated in the state of Delaware.
Subsidiary
Current %
Ownership
Advertising
Solution
Date of Formation
Date of
Acquisition
Huddled Masses, LLC
100% Buy-side
November 13, 2012
June 21, 2018
Colossus Media, LLC
100% Sell-side
September 8, 2017
June 21, 2018
Orange142, LLC
100% Buy-side
March 6, 2013
September 30, 2020
Both buy-side businesses, Huddled Masses and Orange142, offer technology-enabled advertising solutions and consulting services to clients through multiple leading demand side platforms (“DSPs”). Colossus Media is our proprietary sell-side programmatic platform operating under the trademarked banner of Colossus SSP™ (“Colossus SSP”). Colossus SSP is a stand-alone tech-enabled, data-driven platform that helps deliver targeted advertising to diverse and multicultural audiences, including African Americans, Latin Americans, Asian Americans and LGBTQ+ customers, as well as other specific audiences.
Providing both the front-end, buy-side businesses coupled with our proprietary sell-side business, enables us to curate the first through the last mile in the ad tech ecosystem execution process to drive higher results.
Note 2 — Basis of Presentation and Summary of Significant Accounting Policies
Basis of presentation
The Company’s consolidated financial statements are presented in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America (“U.S. GAAP”) and reflect the financial position, results of operations and cash flows for all periods presented.
The Company is an emerging growth company, as defined in the Jumpstart Our Business Startups Act of 2012 (the “JOBS Act”). Under the JOBS Act, emerging growth companies can delay adopting new or revised accounting standards issued subsequent to the enactment of the JOBS Act until such time as those standards apply to private companies. The Company has elected to use this extended transition period for complying with new or revised accounting standards that have different effective dates for public and private companies until the earlier of the date that it (i) is no longer an emerging growth company or (ii) it affirmatively and irrevocably opts out of the extended transition period provided in the JOBS Act. As a result, these financial statements may not be comparable to companies that comply with the new or revised accounting pronouncements as of public company effective dates. The adoption dates discussed below reflect this election.
Basis of consolidation
The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of Direct Digital Holdings, LLC and its wholly owned subsidiaries. All material intercompany accounts and transactions have been eliminated in consolidation.
 
F-14

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
DECEMBER 31, 2020 AND 2019
Business combinations
The Company analyzes acquisitions to determine if the acquisition should be recorded as an asset acquisition or a business combination. The Company accounts for acquired businesses using the acquisition method of accounting under Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) Accounting Standards Codification (“ASC”) 805, Business Combinations, (“ASC 805”), which requires that assets acquired, and liabilities assumed be recorded at the date of acquisition at their respective fair values. The fair value of the consideration paid, including any contingent consideration as applicable, is assigned to the underlying net assets of the acquired business based on their respective fair values based on widely accepted valuation techniques in accordance with ASC Topic 820, Fair Value Measurement, as of the closing date. Any excess of the purchase price over the estimated fair values of the net tangible assets and identifiable intangible assets acquired is recorded as goodwill.
Significant judgments are used in determining the estimated fair values assigned to the assets acquired and liabilities assumed and in determining estimates of useful lives of long-lived assets. Fair value determinations and useful life estimates are based on, among other factors, estimates of expected future net cash flows, estimates of appropriate discount rates used to present value expected future net cash flows, the assessment of each asset’s life cycle, and the impact of competitive trends on each asset’s life cycle and other factors. These judgments can materially impact the estimates used to allocate acquisition date fair values to assets acquired and liabilities assumed, and the resulting timing and amounts charged to, or recognized in, current and future operating results. For these and other reasons, actual results may vary significantly from estimated results.
On September 30, 2020, the Company completed the acquisition of Orange142, which was accounted for under ASC 805. See Note 3 — Business Acquisition.
Use of estimates
The preparation of financial statements in conformity with U.S. GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenue and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from these estimates. Significant estimates include the allocation of purchase price consideration in the business combination and the related valuation of acquired assets and liabilities, intangible assets, and goodwill impairment testing. The Company bases its estimates on past experiences, market conditions, and other assumptions that the Company believes are reasonable under the circumstances, and the Company evaluates these estimates on an ongoing basis.
Cash and cash equivalents
Cash and cash equivalents consist of funds deposited with financial institutions and highly liquid instruments with original maturities of three months or less. Such deposits may, at times, exceed federally insured limits. The Company has not experienced any losses in such amounts and believes it is not exposed to any significant credit risk to cash.
Accounts receivable
Accounts receivable primarily consist of billed amounts for products and services rendered to customers under normal trade terms. The Company performs credit evaluations of its customers’ financial condition and generally does not require collateral. Accounts receivables are stated at net realizable value. The Company began insuring its accounts receivable with unrelated third-party insurance companies in an effort to mitigate any future write-offs and establish an allowance for doubtful accounts as deemed necessary for accounts not covered by this insurance. As of December 31, 2020, and 2019, the Company estimated the allowance for doubtful accounts to be zero. Management periodically reviews outstanding accounts receivable
 
F-15

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
DECEMBER 31, 2020 AND 2019
for reasonableness. If warranted, the Company processes a claim with the third-party insurance company to recover uncollected balances, rather than writing the balances off to bad debt expense. The guaranteed recovery for the claim is approximately 90% of the original balance, and if the full amount is collected by the insurance company, the remaining 10% is remitted to the Company. If the insurance company is unable to collect the full amount, the Company records the remaining 10% to bad debt expense. Bad debt expense was $8,086 and $109,777 for the years ended December 31, 2020, and 2019, respectively.
On November 4, 2019, the Company entered into a factoring agreement with Associated Receivables Funding, Inc. (“A/R Funding”). Of the assigned accounts receivable, 90% is funded to the Company with the remaining 10% held in a reserve escrow account until such time as A/R Funding receives customers’ payments. On September 25, 2020, the Company terminated the agreement with A/R Funding and all remaining funds were released from escrow. At December 31, 2019, the reserve escrow balance was $16,220 and is recorded in accounts receivable in the consolidated balance sheets.
Concentrations of credit risk
The Company has customers on both the buy-and sell-side of its business. With the acquisition of Orange142 in September 2020, the mix of our concentrations changed year over year. The following table sets forth our consolidated concentration of accounts receivable:
December 31,
2020
2019
Customer A
40.4% 0.0%
Customer B
18.4% 8.3%
Customer C
7.4% 13.8%
Customer D
0.0% 22.1%
Customer E
0.0% 20.3%
Customer F
0.0% 10.0%
Property and equipment, net
Property and equipment are recognized in the consolidated balance sheets at cost less accumulated depreciation and amortization. The Company capitalizes purchases and depreciates its property and equipment using the straight-line method of depreciation over the estimated useful lives of the respective assets, generally ranging from three to five years. Leasehold improvements are amortized over the shorter of their useful lives or the remaining terms of the related leases. As of December 31, 2020 and 2019, the Company has fully depreciated all property and equipment.
The cost of repairs and maintenance are expensed as incurred. Major renewals or improvements that extend the useful lives of the assets are capitalized. When assets are retired or disposed of, the cost and accumulated depreciation thereon are removed, and any resulting gain or loss is recognized in the consolidated statements of operations.
Goodwill
Under the purchase method of accounting pursuant to ASC 805, goodwill is calculated as the excess of purchase price over the fair value of the net tangible and identifiable intangible assets acquired. In testing goodwill for impairment, we have the option to begin with a qualitative assessment, commonly referred to as “Step 0”, to determine whether it is more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit containing goodwill is less than its carrying value. This qualitative assessment may include, but is not limited to, reviewing factors such as macroeconomic conditions, industry and market considerations, cost factors, entity-specific financial performance and other events, such as changes in our management, strategy and primary
 
F-16

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
DECEMBER 31, 2020 AND 2019
user base. If the Company determines that it is more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit is less than its carrying value, then a quantitative goodwill impairment analysis is performed, which is referred to as “Step 1”. Depending upon the results of that measurement, the recorded goodwill may be written down, and impairment expense is recorded in the consolidated statements of operations when the carrying amount of the reporting unit exceeds the fair value of the reporting unit. Goodwill is reviewed annually and tested for impairment upon the occurrence of a triggering event. For the years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019, we did not recognize any goodwill impairment losses.
As of December 31, 2019, goodwill totaled $2,423,936 as a result of the acquisition of Huddled Masses and Colossus Media in 2018. In connection with the acquisition of Orange142, the Company recorded $4,095,700 of goodwill for a total of $6,519,636 as of December 31, 2020.
Intangible assets, net
Our intangible assets consist of customer relationships, trademarks and non-compete agreements. Our intangible assets are recorded at fair value at the time of their acquisition and are stated within our consolidated balance sheets net of accumulated amortization. Intangible assets are amortized on a straight-line basis over their estimated useful lives and recorded as amortization expense within general and administrative expenses in our consolidated statements of operations.
Impairment of long-lived assets
The Company evaluates long-lived assets, including property and equipment, and acquired intangible assets consisting of customer relationships, trademarks and trade names, and non-compete agreements, for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying value of an asset may not be recoverable. Recoverability is assessed based on the future cash flows expected to result from the use of the asset and its eventual disposition. If the sum of the undiscounted cash flows is less than the carrying amount of the asset, an impairment loss is recognized. Any impairment loss, if indicated, is measured as the amount by which the carrying amount of the asset exceeds its estimated fair value and is recognized as a reduction in the carrying amount of the asset. As of December 31, 2020 and 2019, there were no events or changes in circumstances to indicate that the carrying amount of the assets may not be recoverable.
Fair value measurements
The Company follows ASC 820-10, Fair Value Measurement, (“ASC 820-10”), which defines fair value, establishes a framework for measuring fair value in U.S. GAAP, and requires certain disclosures about fair value measurements. ASC 820-10 defines fair value as the exchange price that would be received for an asset or paid to transfer a liability (an exit price) in the most advantageous market for the asset or liability in an orderly transaction. Fair value measurement is based on a hierarchy of observable or unobservable inputs. The standard describes three levels of inputs that may be used to measure fair value.
Level 1 — 
Inputs to the valuation methodology are quoted prices available in active markets for identical securities as of the reporting date;
Level 2 — 
Inputs to the valuation methodology are other significant observable inputs, including quoted prices for similar securities, interest rates, credit risk etc. as of the reporting date, and the fair value can be determined through the use of models or other valuation methodologies; and
Level 3 — 
Inputs to the valuation methodology are unobservable inputs in situations where there is little or no market activity of the securities and the reporting entity makes estimates and assumptions relating to the pricing of the securities, including assumptions regarding risk.
 
F-17

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
DECEMBER 31, 2020 AND 2019
We segregate all financial assets and liabilities that are measured at fair value on a recurring basis into the most appropriate level within the fair value hierarchy based on the inputs used to determine the fair value at the measurement date.
Deferred financing costs
The Company records costs related to its line of credit and the issuance of debt obligations as deferred financing costs. These costs are deferred and amortized to interest expense using the straight-line method over the life of the debt. Unamortized deferred financing costs related to the line of credit with East West Bank (see Note 5 — Long Term Debt), was $90,607 and $0 as of December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively, and due to the revolving nature of this debt, was classified as an asset on the consolidated balance sheets. Deferred financing costs for the note payable to SilverPeak Credit Partners, LP (“SilverPeak”) (see Note 5 — Long-Term Debt) was $501,796 as of December 31, 2020 and netted against the outstanding debt on the consolidated balance sheets.
Revenue recognition
The Company adopted FASB Accounting Standards Update (“ASU”) 2014-09, Revenue from Contracts with Customers, (“Topic 606”), as of January 1, 2019, for all contracts not completed as of the date of adoption which had no impact on its financial position or results of operations using the modified retrospective method. The Company recognizes revenue using the following five steps:

Identification of a contract(s) with a customer;

Identification of the performance obligation(s) in the contract;

Determination of the transaction price;

Allocation of the transaction price to the performance obligation(s) in the contract; and

Recognition of revenue when, or as, the performance obligation(s) are satisfied.
The Company’s revenues are derived primarily from two sources: buy-side advertising and sell-side advertising.
Buy-side advertising
The Company purchases media based on the budget established by its customers with a focus on leveraging data services, customer branding, real-time market analysis and micro-location advertising. The Company offers its platform on a fully managed and a self-serve basis, which is recognized over time using the output method when the performance obligation is fulfilled. An “impression” is delivered when an advertisement appears on pages viewed by users. The performance obligation is satisfied over time as the volume of impressions are delivered up to the contractual maximum for fully managed revenue and the delivery of media inventory for self-serve revenue. Many customers run several different campaigns throughout the year to capitalize on different seasons, special events and other happenings at their respective regions and localities. The Company provides digital advertising and media buying capabilities with a focus on generating measurable digital and financial life for its customers.
Revenue arrangements are evidenced by a fully executed insertion order (“IO”). Generally, IOs specify the number and type of advertising impressions to be delivered over a specified time at an agreed upon price and performance objectives for an ad campaign. Performance objectives are generally a measure of targeting, as defined by the parties in advance, such as number of ads displayed, consumer clicks on ads or consumer actions (which may include qualified leads, registrations, downloads, inquiries or purchases). These payment models are commonly referred to as CPM (cost per impression), CPC (cost per click) and CPA (cost per action). The majority of the Company’s contracts are flat-rate, fee-based contracts.
 
F-18

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
DECEMBER 31, 2020 AND 2019
In instances where the Company contracts with third-party advertising agencies on behalf of their advertiser clients, a determination is made to recognize revenue on a gross or net basis based on an assessment of whether the Company is acting as the principal or an agent in the transaction. The Company is acting as the principal in these arrangements and therefore revenue earned and costs incurred are recognized on a gross basis as the Company has control and is responsible for fulfilling the advertisement delivery, establishing the selling prices and delivering the advertisements for fully managed revenue and providing updates and performing all billing and collection activities for the self-serve proprietary platform.
Cash payments received prior to the Company’s delivery of its services are recorded to deferred revenue until the performance obligation is satisfied. The Company recorded deferred revenue (contract liabilities) to account for billings in excess of revenue recognized, primarily related to contractual minimums billed in advance and customer prepayment, of $308,682 and $41,945 as of December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively.
Sell-side advertising
The Company partners with publishers to sell advertising inventory to its existing buy-side clients, as well as its own Colossus Media-curated clients and the open markets (collectively referred to as “buyers”) seeking to access the general market as well as unique multi-cultural audiences. The Company generates revenue from the delivery of targeted digital media solutions, enabling advertisers to connect intelligently with their audiences across online display, video, social and mobile mediums using its proprietary programmatic sell-side platform (“SSP”). The Company refers to its publishers, app developers, and channel partners collectively as its publishers. The Company generates revenue through the monetization of publisher ad impressions on its platform. The Company’s platform allows publishers to sell, in real time, ad impressions to buyers and provides automated inventory management and monetization tools to publishers across various device types and digital ad formats. The Company recognizes revenue when an ad is delivered in response to a winning bid request from ad buyers. The Company is acting as the principal in these arrangements and therefore revenue earned and costs incurred are recognized on a gross basis, as the Company has control and is responsible for fulfilling the advertisement delivery, establishing the selling prices and delivering the advertisements for fully managed revenue and providing updates and performing all billing and collection activities for its self-serve proprietary platform.
The Company maintains agreements with each DSP in the form of written service agreements, which set out the terms of the relationship, including payment terms (typically 30 to 90 days) and access to its platform. In an effort to reduce the risk of nonpayment, the Company has insurance with a third-party carrier for its accounts receivable as noted above.
The following table sets forth our concentration of revenue sources as a percentage of total net revenues on a consolidated basis. With the acquisition of Orange142 in September 2020, the mix of our concentrations changed year-over-year.
December 31,
2020
2019
Customer B
14.0% 3.5%
Customer E
11.2% 28.4%
Customer G
9.5% 0.0%
Customer C
7.1% 9.5%
Customer F
2.9% 12.4%
Customer D
0.6% 9.3%
 
F-19

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
DECEMBER 31, 2020 AND 2019
Cost of revenues
Buy-side advertising
Cost of revenues consists primarily of digital media fees, third-party platform access fees, and other third-party fees associated with providing services to our customers.
Sell-side advertising
The Company pays publishers a fee, which is typically a percentage of the value of the ad impressions monetized through the Company’s platform. Cost of revenues consists primarily of publisher media fees and data center co-location costs. Media fees include the publishing and real-time bidding costs to secure advertising space.
Advertising costs
The Company expenses advertising costs as incurred. Advertising expense incurred during years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019 was $8,056 and $13,773, respectively. These costs are included in general and administrative expenses in the consolidated statements of operations.
Income taxes
The Company is a limited liability company and is not required to pay federal income tax. Accordingly, no federal income tax expense has been recorded in the consolidated financial statements for the years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019. Taxable income or losses are reported to the individual members for inclusion in their respective individual federal income tax returns. The Company is subject to state income taxes as applicable. Taxes on the consolidated statements of operations represent franchise taxes for the State of Texas.
The Company applies ASC 740-10, Income Taxes (“ASC 740-10”), in establishing standards for accounting for uncertain tax positions. The Company evaluates uncertain tax positions with the presumption of audit detection and applies a “more likely than not” standard to evaluate the recognition of tax benefits or provisions. ASC 740-10 applies a two-step process to determine the amount of tax benefits or provisions to record in the consolidated financial statements. First, the Company determines whether any amount may be recognized and then determines how much of a tax benefit or provision should be recognized. As of December 31, 2020 and 2019, the Company had no uncertain tax positions. Accordingly, the Company has not recognized any penalty, interest or tax impact related to uncertain tax positions. If the Company were to incur an income tax liability in the future, interest on any income tax liability would be reported as interest expense and penalties on any income tax liability would be reported as income taxes. The Company’s conclusions regarding uncertain tax positions may be subject to review and adjustments at a later date based upon ongoing analyses of tax laws, regulations and interpretations thereof as well as other factors.
Segment information
Operating segments are components of an enterprise for which separate financial information is available and is evaluated regularly by the Company’s chief operating decision maker in deciding how to allocate resources and assessing performance. The Company’s chief operating decision maker is its Chairman and Chief Executive Officer. The Company views its business as two reportable segments, buy-side advertising, which includes the results of Huddled Masses and Orange142, and sell-side advertising, which includes the results of Colossus Media.
Recently adopted accounting pronouncements
In May 2014, the FASB issued Topic 606. Subsequent to the issuance of Topic 606, the FASB clarified the guidance through several ASUs (collectively, “ASC 606”). This guidance represents a comprehensive
 
F-20

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
DECEMBER 31, 2020 AND 2019
new revenue recognition model that requires a company to recognize revenue to depict the transfer of promised goods or services to customers in an amount that reflects the consideration which that company expects to be entitled to receive in exchange for those goods or services. This update sets forth a new five-step revenue recognition model which replaces the prior revenue recognition guidance in its entirety.
On January 1, 2019, the Company adopted Topic 606 using the modified retrospective method, applied to all contracts not completed as of the date of adoption. This method requires the cumulative effect of the adoption to be recognized as an adjustment to opening retained earnings or accumulated deficit in the period of adoption. The adoption of Topic 606 using the modified retrospective method led the Company to evaluate all contracts not completed as of January 1, 2019. Part of that assessment was to calculate the cumulative effect of adopting the new revenue recognition standard. A majority of the Company’s contracts are usage based or have commitments that refresh quarterly and monthly. The Company has a small population of contracts for which pricing is variable through tiered pricing arrangements or that include annual base fees that do not coincide with the calendar year, requiring an estimate of the transaction price attributable to each year. The Company calculated the transaction price related to these contracts to determine the cumulative effect of adoption as of January 1, 2019, and recorded the adjustment, net of tax, to retained earnings and deferred revenue. The adoption of Topic 606 did not have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.
In January 2017, the FASB issued ASU 2017-01, Business Combinations (Topic 805): Clarifying the Definition of a Business (“ASU 2017-01”), which provides guidance on evaluating whether transactions should be accounted for as acquisitions (or disposals) of assets or businesses. The definition of a business affects many areas of accounting, including acquisitions, disposals, goodwill, and consolidation. The new guidance amends ASC 805 to provide a more robust framework to use in determining when a set of assets and activities is a business. In addition, the amendments provide more consistency in applying the guidance, reduce the costs of application, and make the definition of a business more operable. The guidance is effective for annual periods beginning after December 15, 2018 and interim periods within annual periods beginning after December 15, 2019. The adoption of ASU 2017-01 did not have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.
In January 2017, the FASB issued ASU 2017-04, Intangibles — Goodwill and Other (Topic 350): Simplifying the Test for Goodwill Impairment (“ASU 2017-04”). The amendments in ASU 2017-04 simplify the accounting for goodwill impairment for all entities by requiring impairment charges to be based on the first step in the current two-step impairment test. An impairment charge for the amount by which the carrying amount exceeds the reporting unit’s fair value should be recognized; however, the loss recognized should not exceed the total amount of goodwill allocated to that reporting unit. Early adoption is permitted, and the Company early adopted on January 1, 2019. ASU 2017-04 did not have an impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.
Accounting pronouncements not yet adopted
In February 2016, the FASB issued ASU 2016-02, Leases (Topic 842). Under the new guidance, lessees will be required to put most leases on their balance sheets but to recognize expenses in the income statement in a manner similar to current accounting. The guidance also eliminates the current real estate-specific provisions and changes the guidance on sale-leaseback transactions, initial direct costs, and lease executory costs for all entities. The updated guidance will be effective for the Company beginning January 1, 2022, with early adoption permitted. Upon adoption, entities will be required to use the modified retrospective approach for leases that exist, or are entered into, after the beginning of the earliest comparative period in the financial statements. In July 2018, the FASB issued ASU 2018-11, Leases (Topic 842): Targeted Improvements, which allows entities to not apply the new leases standard, including its disclosure requirements, in the comparative periods they present in their financial statements in the year of adoption. The Company is currently evaluating the potential effect that adopting this guidance will have on its consolidated financial statements.
 
F-21

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
DECEMBER 31, 2020 AND 2019
In June 2016, the FASB issued ASU No. 2016-13, Financial Instruments — Credit Losses (Topic 326), Measurement of Credit Losses on Financial Instruments, as amended, which requires, among other things, the use of a new current expected credit loss (“CECL”) model in order to determine the Company’s allowances for doubtful accounts with respect to accounts receivable. The CECL model requires that the Company estimates its lifetime expected credit loss with respect to its receivables and contract assets and record allowances that, when deducted from the balance of the receivables, represent the net amounts expected to be collected. The Company will also be required to disclose information about how it developed the allowances, including changes in the factors that influenced its estimate of expected credit losses and the reasons for those changes. This ASU is effective for annual periods, including interim periods within those annual periods, beginning after December 15, 2022. The Company is currently evaluating the potential effect that adopting this guidance will have on its consolidated financial statements.
Risks and Uncertainties
Management is currently evaluating the impact of the COVID-19 pandemic and has concluded that while it is reasonably possible that the virus could have a negative effect on the Company’s financial position and results of its operations, the specific impact is not readily determinable as of the date of these financial statements. The financial statements do not include any adjustments that might result from the outcome of this uncertainty.
Liquidity and capital resources
As of December 31, 2020, we had cash and cash equivalents of $1,611,998 and availability under our Revolving Credit Facility (see Note 5 — Long-Term Debt) of $592,949. Based on projections of growth in revenue and operating results in the coming year, the available cash held by us and availability under our Revolving Credit Facility, we believe that we will have sufficient cash resources to finance our operations and service any maturing debt obligations for at least the next twelve months.
Note 3 — Business Acquisition
Effective September 30, 2020, the Company acquired 100% of the equity interests of Orange142 for a purchase price of $26,207,981. The acquisition was funded by a combination of cash, issuance of member common units, mandatorily redeemable preferred units (see Note 6 — Mandatorily Redeemable Preferred Units), a facility term note, and a revolving credit facility (see Note 5 — Long-Term Debt). The Company paid $12,000,000 in cash and issued (i) 5,637 member common units fair valued at $4,294,041, (ii) 3,500 non-participating preferred A units (“Class A Preferred Units”) at a redemption value of $3,500,000, and a fair value of $3,458,378, and (iii) 7,046 non-participating preferred B units (“Class B Preferred Units”) at a redemption value of $7,046,251, and a fair value of $6,455,562. The acquisition was accounted for using the acquisition method of accounting and, accordingly, the consolidated statements of operations include the results of operations of Orange142 beginning September 30, 2020.
The acquisition of Orange142 was recorded by allocating the total purchase consideration to the fair value of the net tangible assets acquired, including goodwill and intangible assets, in accordance with ASC 805. The purchase consideration exceeded the fair value of the net assets, resulting in goodwill of $4,095,700 and intangible assets of $18,033,850. Intangible assets consist of $13,028,320 of 10-year amortizable customer relationships, $3,501,200 of 10-year amortizable trademarks and tradenames, and $1,504,330 of 5-year amortizable non-compete agreements. The Company records amortization expense on a straight-line basis over the life of the identifiable intangible assets. For the year ended December 31, 2020, amortization expense of $488,454 was recognized, and as of December 31, 2020, intangible assets net of accumulated amortization was $17,545,396.
 
F-22

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
DECEMBER 31, 2020 AND 2019
Intangible assets and the related accumulated amortization and future amortization expense are as follows:
Customer lists
Trademarks and
tradenames
Non-compete
agreements
Total
Fair value at acquisition date
$ 13,028,320 $ 3,501,200 $ 1,504,330 $ 18,033,850
Accumulated amortization
(325,708) (87,530) (75,217) (488,455)
Intangibles, net as of December 31, 2020
$ 12,702,612 $ 3,413,670 $ 1,429,114 $ 17,545,396
Estimated life (years)
10 10 5
Weighted-average remaining life (years) at December 31, 2020
9.75 9.75 4.75
Total
2021
$ 1,953,818
2022
1,953,818
2023
1,953,818
2024
1,953,818
2025
1,878,602
Thereafter
7,851,522
Total
$ 17,545,396
The Company paid $12,000,000 in cash and acquired cash of $1,014,151 for net cash used in the acquisition of $10,985,849. Total purchase consideration and fair value of the equity units issued is as follows:
Cash paid to sellers
$ 12,000,000
Member units issued
4,294,041
Mandatorily redeemable units
9,913,940
      Total purchase consideration
$ 26,207,981
 
F-23

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
DECEMBER 31, 2020 AND 2019
The following table summarizes the allocations of the purchase consideration to the fair value of the net assets:
Fair value of assets acquired:
Cash and cash equivalents
$ 1,014,151
Accounts receivable
4,590,945
Prepaid expenses and other current assets
148,717
Other assets
9,618
Intangible assets
18,033,850
Goodwill
4,095,700
Total assets acquired
27,892,981
Fair values of liabilities assumed:
Accounts payable
$ 683,521
Accrued liabilities
244,165
Deferred revenue
757,314
Total liabilities assumed
1,685,000
Total fair value of net assets
$ 26,207,981
During the year ended December 31, 2020, the Company incurred $834,407 in acquisition transaction costs related to the acquisition of Orange142. These expenses primarily related to referral and legal fees. The Company does expect to deduct goodwill for tax purposes in future years. The factors that make up goodwill include entry into new markets not previously accessible and generation of future growth opportunities.
The table below presents the unaudited pro forma revenue and net loss of the Company for the fiscal years ended December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019, assuming the acquisition had occurred on January 1, 2019, pursuant to ASC 805. This unaudited pro forma consolidated financial information does not purport to represent what the actual results of operations of the Company would have been had the acquisition occurred on that date, nor does it purport to predict the results of operations for future periods. This pro forma financial information does not give effect to any anticipated synergies, operating efficiencies or cost savings or any integration costs related to the acquisition. The unaudited pro forma consolidated financial information excludes transaction costs recorded as general and administrative expenses of $834,407 during the year ended December 31, 2020.
For the Years Ended December 31,
2020
2019
Revenue – pro forma combined
$ 30,415,600 $ 23,226,165
Net income (loss) – pro forma combined
$ 3,783,883 $ (1,140,754)
For the Years Ended December 31,
2020
2019
Revenue
$ 12,477,519 $ 6,271,107
Add: revenue, Orange142
17,938,081 16,955,058
Revenue – pro forma combined
$ 30,415,600 $ 23,226,165
 
F-24

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
DECEMBER 31, 2020 AND 2019
Note 4 — Accrued Liabilities
Accrued liabilities consisted of the following:
December 31,
2020
2019
Accrued compensation and benefits
$ 482,436 $ 80,294
Accrued litigation fees
501,078 501,078
Accrued expenses
317,401
Accrued interest
91,605 26,952
Total accrued liabilities
$ 1,392,520 $ 608,324
Note 5 — Long-Term Debt
Revolving Line of Credit
East West Bank
On September 30, 2020, the Company entered into a credit agreement that provides for a revolving credit facility with East West Bank in the amount of $4,500,000 and initial availability of $1,000,000 (the “Revolving Credit Facility”). The loans under the Revolving Credit Facility bear interest at the LIBOR rate plus 3.5% per annum, and at December 31, 2020, the rate was 6.75%, with a 0.50% unused line fee. The maturity date of the Revolving Credit Facility is September 30, 2022. All accrued but unpaid interest under the Revolving Credit Facility is payable in monthly installments on each interest payment date until the maturity date when the outstanding principal balance, together with all accrued but unpaid interest will be due. As of December 31, 2020, the Revolving Credit Facility had borrowings outstanding of $407,051, and a deferred financing cost of $90,607 was classified as an asset on the consolidated balance sheets.
The Revolving Credit Facility is secured by the trade accounts receivable of the Company and guaranteed by Holdings. The Revolving Credit Facility includes financial covenants, and as of December 31, 2020, the Company was in compliance with all of its financial covenants.
First Citizens Bank
On May 17, 2019, the Company entered into a line of credit agreement with First Citizens Bank in the amount of $750,000, and as of December 31, 2019, borrowings of $727,000 was outstanding. The line of credit bears fixed interest of 3.15% and expired on May 17, 2020. The agreement was renewed for one additional year through May 17, 2021. The line of credit was secured by a deposit account which had a balance of $750,000 on December 31, 2019. On October 2, 2020, the line of credit was fully repaid.
The components of interest expense and related fees for the lines of credit are as follows:
December 31,
2020
2019
Interest expense – East West Bank
$ 9,391 $
Interest expense – First Citizens Bank
19,158 4,544
Amortization of deferred financing costs
12,944
Total interest expense and amortization of deferred financing costs
$ 41,493 $ 4,544
Accrued and unpaid interest as of December 31, 2020 for the East West Bank was $5,230 related to the unused line fee. As of December 31, 2019 there was no accrued and unpaid interest for the First Citizens Bank line of credit.
 
F-25

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
DECEMBER 31, 2020 AND 2019
Term Loan Facility
SilverPeak
In conjunction with the acquisition of Orange142 (see Note 3 — Business Acquisition), on September 30, 2020, the Company entered into a loan and security agreement (the “Term Loan Facility”) with SilverPeak in the amount of $12,825,000, maturing on September 15, 2023. Interest in year one is 15%, of which 12% is payable monthly and 3% is paid-in-kind (“PIK”). All accrued but unpaid interest under the Term Loan Facility is payable in monthly installments on each interest payment date, and the Company is required to repay the outstanding principal balance on January 15 and July 15 of each calendar year in an amount equal to 37.5% of excess cash flow over the preceding six calendar months until the term loan is paid in full. The remaining principal balance, and all accrued but unpaid interest is due on the maturity date.
The obligations under the Term Loan Facility are secured by first-priority liens on all or substantially all assets of the Company and its subsidiaries. The Term Loan Facility contains a number of financial covenants and customary affirmative covenants. In addition, the Term Loan Facility includes a number of negative covenants, including (subject to certain exceptions) limitations on (among other things): indebtedness, liens, investments, acquisitions, dispositions, and restricted payments. Each of Mark Walker (“Walker”), Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer, and Keith Smith (“Smith”), President, have provided limited guarantees of the obligations under the Term Loan Facility. As of December 31, 2020, the Company was in compliance with these covenants.
As of December 31, 2020, the Company owed a balance on the Term Loan Facility of $12,922,243, which includes principal and $97,243 of accrued PIK interest. Financing costs incurred in the transaction were $573,481 and unamortized deferred financing costs as of December 31, 2020 were $501,796. Accrued and unpaid interest was $73,542 as of December 31, 2020 and is included in accrued expenses on the consolidated balance sheets.
The components of interest expense and related fees for the Term Loan Facility are as follows:
December 31,
2020
2019
Interest expense
$ 518,622 $
Amortization of deferred financing costs
71,685
Total interest expense and amortization of deferred financing costs
$ 590,307 $
U.S. Small Business Administration Loans
Economic Injury Disaster Loan
In 2020, the Company applied and was approved for a loan pursuant to the Economic Injury Disaster Loan (“EIDL”), administered by the U.S. Small Business Administration (“SBA”). The Company received the loan proceeds of $150,000 on June 15, 2020. The loan bears interest at a rate of 3.75% and matures on June 15, 2050. Installment payments, including principal and interest, of $731 will be payable monthly beginning June 15, 2022. Each payment will first be applied to pay accrued interest, then the remaining balance will be used to reduce principal. The loan is secured by substantially all assets of the Company. Accrued and unpaid interest expense as of December 31, 2020 was $3,041 and is included in accrued expenses on the consolidated balance sheets.
Paycheck Protection Program
In 2020, the Company applied and was approved for a loan pursuant to the Paycheck Protection Program (“PPP”), administered by the SBA. The PPP was authorized in the Coronavirus Aid, Relief, and
 
F-26

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
DECEMBER 31, 2020 AND 2019
Economic Security (“CARES”) Act and was designed to provide a direct financial incentive for qualifying business to keep their workforce employees. The SBA made PPP loans available to qualifying businesses in amounts up to 2.5 times their average monthly payroll expenses, and loans should be forgivable after a “covered period” ​(eight or twenty-four weeks) as long as the borrower maintains its payroll and utilities. The forgiveness amount will be reduced if the borrower terminates employees or reduces salaries and wages more than 25% during the covered period. Any unforgiven portion is payable over two years if issued before, or five years if issued after, June 5, 2020 at an interest rate of 1.0% with payments deferred until the SBA remits the borrower’s loan forgiveness amount to the lender, or if the borrower does not apply for forgiveness, then months after the end of the covered period.
The Company received the PPP loan proceeds on May 8, 2020. The principal amount of the loan was $287,100 and there are no collateral or guarantee requirements. Under the terms of the PPP, payments were deferred until December 8, 2020. The loan will bear interest at 1% per annum and will mature on May 8, 2022. On October 6, 2020, the Company applied for forgiveness of the loan. On November 30, 2020, $277,100 of the loan was forgiven. On February 16, 2021, the remaining $10,000 balance of the loan was forgiven. The Company recognized $277,100 as other income for the year ended December 31, 2020.
As of December 31, 2020, future minimum payments related to long-term debt is as follows for the years ending December 31:
2021
$ 1,206,750
2022
4,677,123
2023
7,455,421
2024
2025
473
Thereafter
149,527
Total
13,489,294
Less current portion
(1,206.750)
Less deferred financing costs
(501,796)
Long-term debt, net
$ 11,780,748
Note 6 — Mandatorily Redeemable Preferred Units
ASC 480, Distinguishing Liabilities from Equity, (“ASC 480”), defines mandatorily redeemable financial instruments as any financial instruments issued in the form of shares that have an unconditional obligation requiring the issuer to redeem the instrument by transferring its assets at a specified or determinable date (or dates) or upon an event that is certain to occur. A mandatorily redeemable financial instrument shall be classified as a liability unless the redemption is required to occur only upon the liquidation or termination of the reporting entity. Under ASC 480, mandatorily redeemable financial instruments shall be measured initially at fair value.
In connection with the acquisition of Orange142, the Company issued mandatorily redeemable preferred units which are only redeemable for a fixed amount of cash at a date specific to each class. Due to the mandatory redemption feature, ASC 480 requires that these preferred units be classified as a liability rather than as a component of equity, with preferred annual returns being accrued and recorded as interest expense.
Class A Preferred Units
In connection with the Orange142 acquisition (see Note 3 — Business Combination), the Company issued 3,500 non-voting Class A Preferred Units at a purchase price of $3,500,000, and a fair value of
 
F-27

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
DECEMBER 31, 2020 AND 2019
$3,458,378. Class A Preferred Units are entitled to certain approval rights and are mandatorily redeemable for $3,500,000 on September 30, 2022, with 10% preferred annual returns paid on a quarterly basis. Due to the mandatory redemption feature, ASC 480, requires that the Class A Preferred Units be classified as a liability rather than as a component of equity, with the preferred annual returns being accrued and recorded as interest expense. For the year ended December 31, 2020, the Company recorded interest expense relating to the Class A Preferred Units of $88,219.
Class B Preferred Units
In connection with the Orange142 acquisition (see Note 3 — Business Combination), the Company issued 7,046 non-voting Class B Preferred Units at a purchase price of $7,046,251, and a fair value of $6,455,562. Class B Preferred Units are mandatorily redeemable for $7,046,251 on September 30, 2024, with 7% preferred annual returns paid on a quarterly basis. Due to the mandatory redemption feature, ASC 480 requires that the Class B Preferred Units be classified as a liability rather than as a component of equity, with the preferred annual returns being accrued and recorded as interest expense. For the year ended December 31, 2020, the Company recorded interest expense relating to the Class B Preferred Units of $124,323.
Note 7 — Related Party Transactions
Related Party Debt
Seller Notes
In conjunction with the acquisition of Huddled Masses and Colossus Media on June 21, 2018, the Company issued seller notes (“Seller Notes”), to shareholders of Huddled Masses and Colossus Media (“Former Shareholders”) for a total of $500,000. The Seller Notes bear interest of 5% and matured on June 21, 2021. Also, in conjunction with the acquisition, the Company entered into a $350,000 seller payable (“Seller Payable”) with a Former Shareholder that is due in twelve monthly installments of $29,167. During the year ended December 31, 2019, the Company paid $149,628 towards the Seller Payable. The outstanding balance of the Seller Notes was $315,509 and $526,403 as of December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively. During the year ended December 31, 2020, the Company entered into a settlement agreement (“Settlement Agreement”) with the Former Shareholders, and as a result, recorded a net gain of $894 comprised of Seller Note forgiveness of $184,491, Seller Payable forgiveness of $26,403, offset by a $210,000 payment to settle credit card indebtedness. Accrued and unpaid interest was $9,792 and $26,952 as of December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively. Interest expense related to the Seller Notes was $17,309 and $25,370 for the years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively.
Seller Earnouts
In conjunction with the acquisition of Huddled Masses and Colossus Media on June 21, 2018, the Company entered into an agreement to pay each of the Former Shareholders a seller earnout (“Seller Earnouts”) based on gross revenue generated for each of the three years following the acquisition. The Seller Earnouts were recorded at their estimated fair value at the date of grant and adjusted annually for actual revenues generated as well as estimates of future revenues. The Seller Earnouts are to be paid on June 21, 2021. For the year ended December 31, 2019, the Seller Earnouts were adjusted for actual earnings, and as a result, the Company recorded $79,091 as a gain in the consolidated statements of operations. As a result of the Settlement Agreement in the year ended December 31, 2020 noted above, the Company recognized a gain of $400,783 for the termination of certain seller payouts and paid $18,318 to the Former Shareholders. The outstanding balance of the Seller Earnouts was $74,909 and $494,009 as of December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively.
 
F-28

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
DECEMBER 31, 2020 AND 2019
Related Party Transactions
Member Payable
As of December 31, 2020, the Company had a net payable to members that totaled $70,801, which is included as a related party payable on the consolidated balance sheets. As of December 31, 2019, the Company had a net receivable from members that totaled $370,789, which is included as a component of equity on the consolidated balance sheets.
Board Services and Consulting Agreement
On September 30, 2020, the Company entered into board services and consulting agreements with Walker, Smith and Leah Woolford (“Woolford”). Walker, Smith and Woolford are members of the Company. Walker serves as Manager of the Board of Holdings and Chief Executive Officer of the Company. Smith serves as Manager of the Board of Holdings and President of the Company. Woolford serves as Manager of the Board of Holdings and Senior Advisor of the Company. In exchange, the Company pays Walker and Smith annual fees of $450,000 each and employee benefits for their direct families. The Company pays Woolford $300 per hour for up to 50 hours per month and employee benefits for Woolford and her direct family. For the year ended December 31, 2020, total fees paid to Walker, Smith and Woolford were $136,167, $137,942, and $49,670, respectively.
Note 8 — Commitments and Contingencies
Operating Leases
The Company leases furniture and office space in Houston, Austin, and Colorado Springs from an unrelated party under non-cancelable operating leases dating through December 2023. Rent expense for the years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019 was $94,806 and $105,997, respectively.
As of December 31, 2020, future minimum payments under the operating leases were as follows for the year ending December 31:
2021
$ 143,211
2022
121,651
2023
90,138
$ 355,000
Litigation
The Company may from time to time be subject to various legal or administrative claims and proceedings arising in the ordinary course of business. In management’s opinion, the outcome of any such litigation will not materially affect the Company’s financial condition. Nevertheless, due to uncertainties in the settlement process, it is at least reasonably possible that management’s view of the outcome could change materially in the near term.
Huddled Masses was named as a defendant in a lawsuit on July 10, 2019 related to a delinquent balance to a vendor. The matter is currently underway, and the Company has estimated a potential liability of approximately $500,000. Such liability has been recorded and included in accrued liabilities on the consolidated balance sheets as of December 31, 2020 and 2019. The Company entered into mediation discussions beginning April 2021 and expects to resolve the matter during 2021.
 
F-29

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
DECEMBER 31, 2020 AND 2019
Note 9 — Members’ Equity (Deficit)
The Company is authorized to issue common units, Class A Preferred Units and Class B Preferred Units. As further described in Note 3 — Business Acquisition and Note 6 — Mandatorily Redeemable Preferred Units, in connection with the acquisition of Orange142, the Company issued 5,637 common units, 3,500 Class A Preferred Units and 7,046 Class B Preferred Units. The common units were valued at $4,294,041 and Class A and Class B Preferred Units were valued at a total of $9,913,940. As of December 31, 2020 and 2019, the total outstanding common units were 34,182 and 28,545, respectively. The common units have voting rights, as well as certain redemption features at the option of the Company. In accordance with ASC 480, as of December 31, 2020, the Company has classified the preferred units as a liability in the consolidated balance sheets.
Note 10 — Loss Per Unit
Basic loss per unit is calculated by dividing the net loss for the year by the weighted average number of units outstanding during the period. The Company does not have any dilutive units, and therefore the diluted weighted average number of units outstanding are equal to the basic weighted average number of units.
Year Ended December 31,
2020
2019
Net loss per unit attributable to members
$ (908,190) $ (883,768)
Number of units outstanding at the beginning of the year
28,545 28,545
Weighted average units issued during the year
1,409
Number of units outstanding at the end of the year, basic and diluted
29,954 28,545
Net loss per unit, basic and diluted
$ (30.32) $ (30.96)
Note 11 — Employee Benefit Plans
The Company sponsors a safe harbor, defined contribution 401(k) and profit-sharing plan (the “Plan”) that allows eligible employees to contribute a percentage of their compensation. The Company matches employee contributions up to a maximum of 100% of the participant’s salary deferral, limited to 4% of the employee’s salary. For the year ended December 31, 2020 and 2019, the Company matching contributions were $52,673 and $22,173, respectively. Additionally, the Company may make a discretionary profit-sharing contribution to the Plan. During the years ended December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019, no profit-sharing contributions were made.
The Company has an Employee Benefit Plan Trust (the “Trust”) to provide for the payment or reimbursement of all or a portion of covered medical, dental and prescription expenses for the employees of Orange142. The Trust is funded with contributions made by the Company and participating employees at amounts sufficient to keep the Trust on an actuarially sound basis. The self-funded plan has an integrated stop loss insurance policy for the funding of the Trust benefits in excess of the full funding requirements. As of December 31, 2020 and 2019, there were no unpaid claims for the Company’s employees.
Note 12 — Segment Information
Operating segments are components of an enterprise for which separate financial information is available and is evaluated regularly by the Company’s chief operating decision maker in deciding how to allocate resources and assess performance. The Company’s chief operating decision maker is its Chairman and Chief Executive Officer. The Company views its business as two reportable segments, buy-side advertising,
 
F-30

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
DECEMBER 31, 2020 AND 2019
which includes the results of Huddled Masses and Orange142, and sell-side advertising, which includes the results of Colossus Media. All of the Company’s revenues are attributed to the United States.
Revenue by business segment is as follows:
For the Year Ended December 31,
2020
2019
Buy-side advertising
$ 9,656,165 $ 5,472,485
Sell-side advertising
2,821,354 798,622
Total revenues
$ 12,477,519 $ 6,271,107
Operating loss by business segment is as follows:
For the Year Ended December 31,
2020
2019
Buy-side advertising
$ 1,171,324 $ 108,978
Sell-side advertising
29,633 (497,276)
Corporate office expenses
(2,045,521) (484,170)
Consolidated operating loss
$ (844,564) $ (872,468)
Total assets by business segment are as follows:
At December 31,
2020
2019
Buy-side advertising
$ 27,622,180 $ 1,962,895
Sell-side advertising
2,641,325 1,484,711
Corporate office
431,970 775,728
Total assets
$ 30,695,475 $ 4,223,334
Note 13 — Subsequent Events
The Company has evaluated events and transactions occurring subsequent to December 31, 2020 through the date of this report and determined there were no events or transactions that would impact the consolidated financial statements for the year ended December 31, 2020.
On January 15, 2021, and July 15, 2021, the Company made its scheduled Term Loan Facility payment of $77,800 and $1,128,950, respectively.
On February 16, 2021, the remaining $10,000 balance of the PPP loan was forgiven by the SBA. On March 11, 2021, the Company was approved for an additional loan in the amount of $287,163 under the PPP administered by the SBA. Payments will be deferred until June 11, 2022. The PPP loan bears interest at the rate of 1.0% and matures on March 11, 2026.
On June 15, 2021, the remaining $315,509 of the Seller Notes was paid to the Former Shareholders (see Note 7 — Related Party Transactions).
On July 15, 2021, the Company calculated the final Seller Earnouts due, and paid $53,676 to the Former Shareholders (see Note 7 — Related Party Transactions).
 
F-31

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
[MISSING IMAGE: LG_DIRECTDIGITALWHITE-4CLR.JPG]
Direct Digital Holdings, LLC
and Subsidiaries
Consolidated Financial Statements
(unaudited)
September 30, 2021 and 2020
 

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
TABLE OF CONTENTS
SEPTEMBER 30, 2021 AND 2020
Page
Unaudited Consolidated Financial Statements of Direct Digital Holdings, LLC
F-34
F-35
F-36
F-37
F-38
 
F-33

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
SEPTEMBER 30, 2021 AND DECEMBER 31, 2020
September 30,
2021
(unaudited)
December 31,
2020
(audited)
ASSETS
CURRENT ASSETS
Cash and cash equivalents
$ 2,603,152 $ 1,611,998
Accounts receivable, net
3,903,809 4,679,376
Prepaid expenses and other current assets
727,075 223,344
Total current assets
7,234,036 6,514,718
Goodwill
6,519,636 6,519,636
Intangible assets, net
16,080,032 17,545,396
Deferred financing costs, net
51,775 90,607
Other long-term assets
12,948 25,118
Total assets
$ 29,898,427 $ 30,695,475
LIABILITIES AND MEMBERS’ EQUITY
CURRENT LIABILITIES:
Accounts payable
$ 3,110,281 $ 3,263,326
Accrued liabilities
1,510,563 1,392,520
Notes payable, current portion
2,611,685 1,206,750
Deferred revenues
684,303 308,682
Related party payables (Note 7)
69,837 70,801
Seller notes payable
315,509
Seller earnout payable
74,909
Total current liabilities
7,986,669 6,632,497
Notes payable, net of short-term portion and $286,741 and $501,796 deferred financing cost as of September 30, 2021 and December 31, 2020, respectively
9,086,328 11,213,697
Mandatorily redeemable non-participating preferred units
9,913,940 9,913,940
Line of credit
407,051 407,051
Paycheck Protection Program loan
287,143 10,000
Economic Injury Disaster Loan
150,000 150,000
Total liabilities
27,831,131 28,327,185
COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES (Note 8)
MEMBERS’ EQUITY
Units, 1,000,000 units authorized at September 30, 2021 and December 31,
2020; 34,182 units issued and outstanding as of September 30, 2021 and
December 31, 2020
4,294,241 4,294,241
Accumulated deficit
(2,226,945) (1,925,951)
Total members’ equity
2,067,296 2,368,290
Total liabilities and members’ equity
$ 29,898,427 $ 30,695,475
See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements.
F-34

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS
FOR THE NINE MONTHS ENDED SEPTEMBER 30, 2021 AND 2020
For the Nine Months Ended
September 30,
2021
(unaudited)
2020
(unaudited)
Revenues
Buy-side advertising
$ 19,975,235 $ 4,377,708
Sell-side advertising
5,261,135 1,498,300
Total revenues
25,236,370 5,876,008
Cost of revenues
Buy-side advertising
7,480,727 2,836,035
Sell-side advertising
4,348,756 1,350,083
Total cost of revenues
11,829,483 4,186,118
Gross profit
13,406,887 1,689,890
Operating expenses
Compensation, taxes and benefits
6,131,930 1,324,196
General and administrative
4,214,229 600,543
Acquisition transaction costs
650,000
Total operating expenses
10,346,159 2,574,739
Income (loss) from operations
3,060,728 (884,849)
Other (expense) income
Other income
19,186 134,761
Forgiveness of Paycheck Protection Program loan
10,000
Gain from revaluation and settlement of seller
notes and earnout liability
21,232 401,677
Interest expense
(2,432,567) (19,925)
Total other (expense) income
(2,382,149) 516,513
Tax expense
(54,878) (12,154)
Net income (loss)
$ 623,701 $ (380,490)
Net income (loss) per common unit:
Basic and diluted
$ 18.25 $ (13.32)
Weighted-average common units outstanding:
Basic and diluted
34,182 28,566
See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements.
F-35

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN MEMBERS’ EQUITY
FOR THE NINE MONTHS ENDED SEPTEMBER 30, 2020
Common Units
Shares
Amount
Receivable
from
members
Accumulated
equity
Members’ equity
Balance, December 31, 2019 (audited)
28,545 $ 200 $ (370,789) $ (900,253) $ (1,270,842)
Receipts from members
370,789 370,789
Distribution to members
(116,958) (116,958)
Shares issued for acquisition of
Orange142, LLC
5,637 4,294,041 4,294,041
Net loss
(380,490) (380,490)
Balance, September 30, 2020 (unaudited)
34,182 $ 4,294,241 $ $ (1,397,701) $ 2,896,540
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN MEMBERS’ EQUITY
FOR THE NINE MONTHS ENDED SEPTEMBER 30, 2021
Common Units
Shares
Amount
Receivable
from
members
Accumulated
equity
Members’ equity
Balance, December 31, 2019 (audited)
28,545 $ 200 $ (370,789) $ (900,253) $ (1,270,842)
Receipts from members
370,789 370,789
Distribution to members
(117,508) (117,508)
Shares issued for acquisition of
Orange142, LLC
5,637 4,294,041 4,294,041
Net loss
(908,190) (908,190)
Balance, December 31, 2020 (audited)
34,182 4,294,241 (1,925,951) 2,368,290
Distribution to members
(924,695) (924,695)
Net income
623,701 623,701
Balance, September 30, 2021 (unaudited)
34,182 $ 4,294,241 $ $ (2,226,945) $ 2,067,296
See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements.
F-36

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
FOR THE NINE MONTHS ENDED SEPTEMBER 30, 2021 AND 2020
For the Nine Months Ended
September 30,
2021
(unaudited)
2020
(unaudited)
Cash Flows Provided By (Used In) Operating Activities:
Net income (loss)
$ 623,701 $ (380,490)
Adjustments to reconcile net income (loss) to net cash provided by (used
in) operating activities:
Amortization of deferred financing costs
253,887
Amortization of intangible assets
1,465,364
Forgiveness of Paycheck Protection Program loan
(10,000)
Paid-in-kind interest
269,260
Gain from revaluation and settlement of earnout liability
(21,232) (401,677)
Bad debt expense
67,541 8,086
Changes in operating assets and liabilities:
Accounts receivable
708,025 (342,221)
Prepaid expenses and other current assets
(491,560) 17,298
Accounts payable
(153,045) (424,001)
Accrued liabilities
118,043 257,908
Deferred revenues
375,621 242,162
Related party payable
(964) 70,801
Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities
3,204,641 (952,134)
Cash Flows Used In Investing Activities:
Cash paid for acquisition of Orange142, net of cash acquired
(10,985,849)
Net cash used in investing activities
(10,985,849)
Cash Flows (Used In) Provided By Financing Activities:
Proceeds from note payable
12,825,000
Payments on note payable
(1,206,750)
Payments of litigation settlement
(210,000)
Proceeds from lines of credit
430,051
Payment of deferred financing costs
(527,032)
Proceeds from Paycheck Protection Program loan
287,143 287,100
Proceeds from Economic Injury Disaster Loan
150,000
Receipts from members
370,789
Payments on seller notes and earnouts payable
(369,185) (18,318)
Distributions to members
(924,695) (116,958)
Net cash (used in) provided by financing activities
(2,213,487) 13,190,632
Net increase in cash and cash equivalents
991,154 1,252,649
Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of the period
1,611,998 882,292
Cash and cash equivalents, end of the period
$ 2,603,152 $ 2,134,941
Non-cash Investing and Financing:
Issuance of members’ units as purchase consideration (Note 3)
$ $ 14,592,689
Supplemental Disclosure of Cash Flow Information:
Cash paid for taxes
$ 14,878 $ 12,154
Cash paid for interest
$ 3,111,628 $ 51,133
See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements.
F-37

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
SEPTEMBER 30, 2021 AND 2020
Note 1 — Organization and Description of Business
Direct Digital Holdings, LLC and its subsidiaries (collectively the “Company”, “DDH”, “we”, “us” and “our”), headquartered in Houston, Texas, is an end-to-end, full-service programmatic advertising platform primarily focused on providing advertising technology, data-driven campaign optimization and other solutions to underserved and less efficient markets on both the buy- and sell-side of the digital advertising ecosystem. Direct Digital Holdings, LLC (or “Holdings”) is the holding company for the business formed by its founders in 2018 through the acquisition of Huddled Masses, LLC (“Huddled Masses”) and Colossus Media, LLC (“Colossus Media”). In late September 2020, Holdings acquired Orange142, LLC (“Orange142”) to further bolster its overall programmatic buy-side advertising platform and to enhance its offerings across multiple industry verticals such as travel, healthcare, education, financial services, consumer products, etc. with particular emphasis on small and mid-sized businesses transitioning into digital with growing digital media budgets. All of the subsidiaries are incorporated in the state of Delaware.
Subsidiary
Current %
Ownership
Advertising
Solution
Date of Formation
Date of
Acquisition
Huddled Masses, LLC
100%
Buy-side
November 13, 2012
June 21, 2018
Colossus Media, LLC
100%
Sell-side
September 8, 2017
June 21, 2018
Orange142, LLC
100%
Buy-side
March 6, 2013
September 30, 2020
Both buy-side businesses, Huddled Masses and Orange142, offer technology-enabled advertising solutions and consulting services to clients through multiple leading demand side platforms (“DSPs”). Colossus Media is our proprietary sell-side programmatic platform operating under the trademarked banner of Colossus SSP™ (“Colossus SSP”). Colossus SSP is a stand-alone tech-enabled, data-driven platform that helps deliver targeted advertising to diverse and multicultural audiences, including African Americans, Latin Americans, Asian Americans and LGBTQ+ customers, as well as other specific audiences.
Providing both the front-end, buy-side businesses coupled with our proprietary sell-side business, enables us to curate the first through the last mile in the ad tech ecosystem execution process to drive higher results.
Note 2 — Basis of Presentation and Summary of Significant Accounting Policies
Basis of presentation
The Company’s consolidated financial statements are presented in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America (“U.S. GAAP”) and reflect the financial position, results of operations and cash flows for all periods presented.
The Company is an emerging growth company, as defined in the Jumpstart Our Business Startups Act of 2012 (the “JOBS Act”). Under the JOBS Act, emerging growth companies can delay adopting new or revised accounting standards issued subsequent to the enactment of the JOBS Act until such time as those standards apply to private companies. The Company has elected to use this extended transition period for complying with new or revised accounting standards that have different effective dates for public and private companies until the earlier of the date that it (i) is no longer an emerging growth company or (ii) it affirmatively and irrevocably opts out of the extended transition period provided in the JOBS Act. As a result, these financial statements may not be comparable to companies that comply with the new or revised accounting pronouncements as of public company effective dates. The adoption dates discussed below reflect this election.
Basis of consolidation
The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of Direct Digital Holdings, LLC and its wholly owned subsidiaries. All material intercompany accounts and transactions have been eliminated in consolidation.
 
F-38

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
SEPTEMBER 30, 2021 AND 2020
Business combinations
The Company analyzes acquisitions to determine if the acquisition should be recorded as an asset acquisition or a business combination. The Company accounts for acquired businesses using the acquisition method of accounting under Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) Accounting Standards Codification (“ASC”) 805, Business Combinations, (“ASC 805”), which requires that assets acquired, and liabilities assumed be recorded at the date of acquisition at their respective fair values. The fair value of the consideration paid, including any contingent consideration as applicable, is assigned to the underlying net assets of the acquired business based on their respective fair values based on widely accepted valuation techniques in accordance with ASC Topic 820, Fair Value Measurement, as of the closing date. Any excess of the purchase price over the estimated fair values of the net tangible assets and identifiable intangible assets acquired is recorded as goodwill.
Significant judgments are used in determining the estimated fair values assigned to the assets acquired and liabilities assumed and in determining estimates of useful lives of long-lived assets. Fair value determinations and useful life estimates are based on, among other factors, estimates of expected future net cash flows, estimates of appropriate discount rates used to calculate the present value of expected future net cash flows, the assessment of each asset’s life cycle, and the impact of competitive trends on each asset’s life cycle and other factors. These judgments can materially impact the estimates used to allocate acquisition date fair values to assets acquired and liabilities assumed, and the resulting timing and amounts charged to, or recognized in, current and future operating results. For these and other reasons, actual results may vary significantly from estimated results.
On September 30, 2020, the Company completed the acquisition of Orange142, which was accounted for under ASC 805. See Note 3 — Business Acquisition.
Use of estimates
The preparation of financial statements in conformity with U.S. GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenue and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from these estimates. Significant estimates include the allocation of purchase price consideration in the business combination and the related valuation of acquired assets and liabilities, intangible assets, and goodwill impairment testing. The Company bases its estimates on past experiences, market conditions, and other assumptions that the Company believes are reasonable under the circumstances, and the Company evaluates these estimates on an ongoing basis.
Cash and cash equivalents
Cash and cash equivalents consist of funds deposited with financial institutions and highly liquid instruments with original maturities of three months or less. Such deposits may, at times, exceed federally insured limits. The Company has not experienced any losses in such amounts and believes it is not exposed to any significant credit risk to cash.
Accounts receivable
Accounts receivable primarily consist of billed amounts for products and services rendered to customers under normal trade terms. The Company performs credit evaluations of its customers’ financial condition and generally does not require collateral. Accounts receivables are stated at net realizable value. The Company began insuring its accounts receivable with unrelated third-party insurance companies in an effort to mitigate any future write-offs and establish an allowance for doubtful accounts as deemed necessary for accounts not covered by this insurance. As of September 30, 2021 and December 31, 2020, the Company’s allowance for doubtful accounts was $34,833 and $0, respectively. Management periodically reviews
 
F-39

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
SEPTEMBER 30, 2021 AND 2020
outstanding accounts receivable for reasonableness. If warranted, the Company processes a claim with the third-party insurance company to recover uncollected balances, rather than writing the balances off to bad debt expense. The guaranteed recovery for the claim is approximately 90% of the original balance, and if the full amount is collected by the insurance company, the remaining 10% is remitted to the Company. If the insurance company is unable to collect the full amount, the Company records the remaining 10% to bad debt expense. Bad debt expense was $67,541 and $8,086 for the nine months ended September 30, 2021 and 2020, respectively.
On November 4, 2019, the Company entered into a factoring agreement with Associated Receivables Funding, Inc. (“A/R Funding”). Of the assigned accounts receivable, 90% is funded to the Company with the remaining 10% held in a reserve escrow account until such time as A/R Funding receives customers’ payments. On September 25, 2020, the Company terminated the agreement with A/R Funding and all remaining funds were released from escrow.
Concentrations of credit risk
The Company has customers on both the buy-and sell-side of its business. The following table sets forth our consolidated concentration of accounts receivable:
September 30,
2021
December 31,
2020
Customer A
49.9% 7.4%
Customer B
6.0% 40.4%
Customer C
5.3% 18.4%
Property and equipment, net
Property and equipment are recognized in the consolidated balance sheets at cost less accumulated depreciation and amortization. The Company capitalizes purchases and depreciates its property and equipment using the straight-line method of depreciation over the estimated useful lives of the respective assets, generally ranging from three to five years. Leasehold improvements are amortized over the shorter of their useful lives or the remaining terms of the related leases. As of September 30, 2021 and December 31, 2020, the Company has fully depreciated all property and equipment.
The cost of repairs and maintenance are expensed as incurred. Major renewals or improvements that extend the useful lives of the assets are capitalized. When assets are retired or disposed of, the cost and accumulated depreciation thereon are removed, and any resulting gain or loss is recognized in the consolidated statements of operations.
Goodwill
Under the purchase method of accounting pursuant to ASC 805, goodwill is calculated as the excess of purchase price over the fair value of the net tangible and identifiable intangible assets acquired. In testing goodwill for impairment, we have the option to begin with a qualitative assessment, commonly referred to as “Step 0”, to determine whether it is more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit containing goodwill is less than its carrying value. This qualitative assessment may include, but is not limited to, reviewing factors such as macroeconomic conditions, industry and market considerations, cost factors, entity-specific financial performance and other events, such as changes in our management, strategy and primary user base. If the Company determines that it is more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit is less than its carrying value, then a quantitative goodwill impairment analysis is performed, which is referred to as “Step 1”. Depending upon the results of that measurement, the recorded goodwill may be written down, and impairment expense is recorded in the consolidated statements of operations when the
 
F-40

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
SEPTEMBER 30, 2021 AND 2020
carrying amount of the reporting unit exceeds the fair value of the reporting unit. Goodwill is reviewed annually and tested for impairment upon the occurrence of a triggering event. For the nine months ended September 30, 2021 and 2020, we did not recognize any goodwill impairment losses.
As of September 30, 2021, goodwill was $6,519,636, which included $2,423,936 as a result of the acquisition of Huddled Masses and Colossus Media in 2018 and $4,095,700 of goodwill recognized from the acquisition of Orange142 in September 2020.
Intangible assets, net
Our intangible assets consist of customer relationships, trademarks and non-compete agreements. Our intangible assets are recorded at fair value at the time of their acquisition and are stated within our consolidated balance sheets net of accumulated amortization. Intangible assets are amortized on a straight-line basis over their estimated useful lives and recorded as amortization expense within general and administrative expenses in our consolidated statements of operations.
Impairment of long-lived assets
The Company evaluates long-lived assets, including property and equipment, and acquired intangible assets consisting of customer relationships, trademarks and trade names, and non-compete agreements, for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying value of an asset may not be recoverable. Recoverability is assessed based on the future cash flows expected to result from the use of the asset and its eventual disposition. If the sum of the undiscounted cash flows is less than the carrying amount of the asset, an impairment loss is recognized. Any impairment loss, if indicated, is measured as the amount by which the carrying amount of the asset exceeds its estimated fair value and is recognized as a reduction in the carrying amount of the asset. As of September 30, 2021 and December 31, 2020, there were no events or changes in circumstances to indicate that the carrying amount of the assets may not be recoverable.
Fair value measurements
The Company follows ASC 820-10, Fair Value Measurement, (“ASC 820-10”), which defines fair value, establishes a framework for measuring fair value in U.S. GAAP, and requires certain disclosures about fair value measurements. ASC 820-10 defines fair value as the exchange price that would be received for an asset or paid to transfer a liability (an exit price) in the most advantageous market for the asset or liability in an orderly transaction. Fair value measurement is based on a hierarchy of observable or unobservable inputs. The standard describes three levels of inputs that may be used to measure fair value.
Level 1 — 
Inputs to the valuation methodology are quoted prices available in active markets for identical securities as of the reporting date;
Level 2 — 
Inputs to the valuation methodology are other significant observable inputs, including quoted prices for similar securities, interest rates, credit risk etc. as of the reporting date, and the fair value can be determined through the use of models or other valuation methodologies; and
Level 3 — 
Inputs to the valuation methodology are unobservable inputs in situations where there is little or no market activity of the securities and the reporting entity makes estimates and assumptions relating to the pricing of the securities, including assumptions regarding risk.
We segregate all financial assets and liabilities that are measured at fair value on a recurring basis into the most appropriate level within the fair value hierarchy based on the inputs used to determine the fair value at the measurement date.
 
F-41

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
SEPTEMBER 30, 2021 AND 2020
Deferred financing costs
The Company records costs related to its line of credit and the issuance of debt obligations as deferred financing costs. These costs are deferred and amortized to interest expense using the straight-line method over the life of the debt. Unamortized deferred financing costs related to the line of credit with East West Bank (see Note 5 — Long Term Debt), was $51,775 and $90,607 as of September 30, 2021 and December 31, 2020, respectively, and due to the revolving nature of this debt, was classified as an asset on the consolidated balance sheets.
Deferred financing costs for the note payable to SilverPeak Credit Partners, LP (“SilverPeak”) (see Note 5 — Long-Term Debt) was $286,741 and $501,796 as of September 30, 2021 and December 31, 2020, respectively, and netted against the outstanding debt on the consolidated balance sheets.
Revenue recognition
The Company adopted FASB Accounting Standards Update (“ASU”) 2014-09, Revenue from Contracts with Customers, (“Topic 606”), as of January 1, 2019, for all contracts not completed as of the date of adoption which had no impact on its financial position or results of operations using the modified retrospective method. The Company recognizes revenue using the following five steps:

Identification of a contract(s) with a customer;

Identification of the performance obligation(s) in the contract;

Determination of the transaction price;

Allocation of the transaction price to the performance obligation(s) in the contract; and

Recognition of revenue when, or as, the performance obligation(s) are satisfied.
The Company’s revenues are derived primarily from two sources: buy-side advertising and sell-side advertising.
Buy-side advertising
The Company purchases media based on the budget established by its customers with a focus on leveraging data services, customer branding, real-time market analysis and micro-location advertising. The Company offers its platform on a fully managed and a self-serve basis, which is recognized over time using the output method when the performance obligation is fulfilled. An “impression” is delivered when an advertisement appears on pages viewed by users. The performance obligation is satisfied over time as the volume of impressions are delivered up to the contractual maximum for fully managed revenue and the delivery of media inventory for self-serve revenue. Many customers run several different campaigns throughout the year to capitalize on different seasons, special events and other happenings at their respective regions and localities. The Company provides digital advertising and media buying capabilities with a focus on generating measurable digital and financial life for its customers.
Revenue arrangements are evidenced by a fully executed insertion order (“IO”). Generally, IOs specify the number and type of advertising impressions to be delivered over a specified time at an agreed upon price and performance objectives for an ad campaign. Performance objectives are generally a measure of targeting, as defined by the parties in advance, such as number of ads displayed, consumer clicks on ads or consumer actions (which may include qualified leads, registrations, downloads, inquiries or purchases). These payment models are commonly referred to as CPM (cost per impression), CPC (cost per click) and CPA (cost per action). The majority of the Company’s contracts are flat-rate, fee-based contracts.
In instances where the Company contracts with third-party advertising agencies on behalf of their advertiser clients, a determination is made to recognize revenue on a gross or net basis based on an assessment
 
F-42

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
SEPTEMBER 30, 2021 AND 2020
of whether the Company is acting as the principal or an agent in the transaction. The Company is acting as the principal in these arrangements and therefore revenue earned and costs incurred are recognized on a gross basis as the Company has control and is responsible for fulfilling the advertisement delivery, establishing the selling prices and delivering the advertisements for fully managed revenue and providing updates and performing all billing and collection activities for the self-serve proprietary platform.
Cash payments received prior to the Company’s delivery of its services are recorded to deferred revenue until the performance obligation is satisfied. The Company recorded deferred revenue (contract liabilities) to account for billings in excess of revenue recognized, primarily related to contractual minimums billed in advance and customer prepayment, of $684,303 and $308,682 as of September 30, 2021 and December 31, 2020, respectively.
Sell-side advertising
The Company partners with publishers to sell advertising inventory to its existing buy-side clients, as well as its own Colossus Media-curated clients and the open markets (collectively referred to as “buyers”) seeking to access the general market as well as unique multi-cultural audiences. The Company generates revenue from the delivery of targeted digital media solutions, enabling advertisers to connect intelligently with their audiences across online display, video, social and mobile mediums using its proprietary programmatic sell-side platform (“SSP”). The Company refers to its publishers, app developers, and channel partners collectively as its publishers. The Company generates revenue through the monetization of publisher ad impressions on its platform. The Company’s platform allows publishers to sell, in real time, ad impressions to buyers and provides automated inventory management and monetization tools to publishers across various device types and digital ad formats. The Company recognizes revenue when an ad is delivered in response to a winning bid request from ad buyers. The Company is acting as the principal in these arrangements and therefore revenue earned and costs incurred are recognized on a gross basis, as the Company has control and is responsible for fulfilling the advertisement delivery, establishing the selling prices and delivering the advertisements for fully managed revenue and providing updates and performing all billing and collection activities for its self-serve proprietary platform.
The Company maintains agreements with each DSP in the form of written service agreements, which set out the terms of the relationship, including payment terms (typically 30 to 90 days) and access to its platform. In an effort to reduce the risk of nonpayment, the Company has insurance with a third-party carrier for its accounts receivable as noted above.
The following table sets forth our concentration of revenue sources as a percentage of total net revenues on a consolidated basis. With the acquisition of Orange142 in September 2020, the mix of our concentrations changed year-over-year.
For the Nine Months Ended
September 30,
2021
2020
Customer E
16.8% 0.0%
Customer A
16.7% 9.1%
Customer D
15.4% 0.0%
Customer C
3.0% 15.2%
Customer F
0.0% 35.6%
Customer G
2.8% 12.4%
 
F-43

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
SEPTEMBER 30, 2021 AND 2020
Cost of revenues
Buy-side advertising
Cost of revenues consists primarily of digital media fees, third-party platform access fees, and other third-party fees associated with providing services to our customers.
Sell-side advertising
The Company pays publishers a fee, which is typically a percentage of the value of the ad impressions monetized through the Company’s platform. Cost of revenues consists primarily of publisher media fees and data center co-location costs. Media fees include the publishing and real-time bidding costs to secure advertising space.
Advertising costs
The Company expenses advertising costs as incurred. Advertising expense incurred during the nine months ended September 30, 2021 and 2020 was $145,609 and $5,388, respectively. These costs are included in general and administrative expenses in the consolidated statements of operations.
Income taxes
The Company is a limited liability company and is not required to pay federal income tax. Accordingly, no federal income tax expense has been recorded in the consolidated financial statements for the nine months ended September 30, 2021 and 2020. Taxable income or losses are reported to the individual members for inclusion in their respective individual federal income tax returns. The Company is subject to state income taxes as applicable. Taxes on the consolidated statements of operations represent franchise taxes for the State of Texas.
The Company applies ASC 740-10, Income Taxes (“ASC 740-10”), in establishing standards for accounting for uncertain tax positions. The Company evaluates uncertain tax positions with the presumption of audit detection and applies a “more likely than not” standard to evaluate the recognition of tax benefits or provisions. ASC 740-10 applies a two-step process to determine the amount of tax benefits or provisions to record in the consolidated financial statements. First, the Company determines whether any amount may be recognized and then determines how much of a tax benefit or provision should be recognized. As of September 30, 2021 and December 31, 2020, the Company had no uncertain tax positions. Accordingly, the Company has not recognized any penalty, interest or tax impact related to uncertain tax positions. If the Company were to incur an income tax liability in the future, interest on any income tax liability would be reported as interest expense and penalties on any income tax liability would be reported as income taxes. The Company’s conclusions regarding uncertain tax positions may be subject to review and adjustments at a later date based upon ongoing analyses of tax laws, regulations and interpretations thereof as well as other factors.
Segment information
Operating segments are components of an enterprise for which separate financial information is available and is evaluated regularly by the Company’s chief operating decision maker in deciding how to allocate resources and assessing performance. The Company’s chief operating decision maker is its Chairman and Chief Executive Officer. The Company views its business as two reportable segments, buy-side advertising, which includes the results of Huddled Masses and Orange142, and sell-side advertising, which includes the results of Colossus Media.
 
F-44

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
SEPTEMBER 30, 2021 AND 2020
Accounting pronouncements not yet adopted
In February 2016, the FASB issued ASU 2016-02, Leases (Topic 842). Under the new guidance, lessees will be required to put most leases on their balance sheets but to recognize expenses in the income statement in a manner similar to current accounting. The guidance also eliminates the current real estate-specific provisions and changes the guidance on sale-leaseback transactions, initial direct costs, and lease executory costs for all entities. The updated guidance will be effective for the Company beginning January 1, 2022, with early adoption permitted. Upon adoption, entities will be required to use the modified retrospective approach for leases that exist, or are entered into, after the beginning of the earliest comparative period in the financial statements. In July 2018, the FASB issued ASU 2018-11, Leases (Topic 842): Targeted Improvements, which allows entities to not apply the new leases standard, including its disclosure requirements, in the comparative periods they present in their financial statements in the year of adoption. The Company is currently evaluating the potential effect that adopting this guidance will have on its consolidated financial statements.
In June 2016, the FASB issued ASU No. 2016-13, Financial Instruments — Credit Losses (Topic 326), Measurement of Credit Losses on Financial Instruments, as amended, which requires, among other things, the use of a new current expected credit loss (“CECL”) model in order to determine the Company’s allowances for doubtful accounts with respect to accounts receivable. The CECL model requires that the Company estimates its lifetime expected credit loss with respect to its receivables and contract assets and record allowances that, when deducted from the balance of the receivables, represent the net amounts expected to be collected. The Company will also be required to disclose information about how it developed the allowances, including changes in the factors that influenced its estimate of expected credit losses and the reasons for those changes. This ASU is effective for annual periods, including interim periods within those annual periods, beginning after December 15, 2022. The Company is currently evaluating the potential effect that adopting this guidance will have on its consolidated financial statements.
Risks and Uncertainties
Management is currently evaluating the impact of the COVID-19 pandemic and has concluded that while it is reasonably possible that the virus could have a negative effect on the Company’s financial position and results of its operations, the specific impact is not readily determinable as of the date of these financial statements. The financial statements do not include any adjustments that might result from the outcome of this uncertainty.
Liquidity and capital resources
As of September 30, 2021, we had cash and cash equivalents of $2,603,152 and availability under our Revolving Credit Facility (see Note 5 — Long-Term Debt) of $592,949. Based on projections of growth in revenue and operating results in the coming year, the available cash held by us and availability under our Revolving Credit Facility, we believe that we will have sufficient cash resources to finance our operations and service any maturing debt obligations for at least the next twelve months.
Note 3 — Business Acquisition
Effective September 30, 2020, the Company acquired 100% of the equity interests of Orange142 for a purchase price of $26,207,981. The acquisition was funded by a combination of cash, issuance of member common units, mandatorily redeemable preferred units (see Note 6 — Mandatorily Redeemable Preferred Units), a facility term note, and a revolving credit facility (see Note 5 — Long-Term Debt). The Company paid $12,000,000 in cash and issued (i) 5,637-member common units fair valued at $4,294,041, (ii) 3,500 non-participating preferred A units (“Class A Preferred Units”) at a redemption value of $3,500,000, and a fair value of $3,458,378, and (iii) 7,046 non-participating preferred B units (“Class B Preferred Units”) at a redemption value of $7,046,251, and a fair value of $6,455,562. The acquisition was accounted for using
 
F-45

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
SEPTEMBER 30, 2021 AND 2020
the acquisition method of accounting and, accordingly, the consolidated statements of operations include the results of operations of Orange142 beginning September 30, 2020.
The acquisition of Orange142 was recorded by allocating the total purchase consideration to the fair value of the net tangible assets acquired, including goodwill and intangible assets, in accordance with ASC 805. The purchase consideration exceeded the fair value of the net assets, resulting in goodwill of $4,095,700 and intangible assets of $18,033,850. Intangible assets consist of $13,028,320 of 10-year amortizable customer relationships, $3,501,200 of 10-year amortizable trademarks and tradenames, and $1,504,330 of 5-year amortizable non-compete agreements. The Company records amortization expense on a straight-line basis over the life of the identifiable intangible assets. For the nine months ended September 30, 2021, amortization expense of $1,465,364 was recognized, and as of September 30, 2021, intangible assets net of accumulated amortization was $16,080,032.
Intangible assets and the related accumulated amortization and future amortization expense are as follows:
Trademarks and Non-compete
Customer lists
Trademarks and
tradenames
Non-compete
agreements
Total
Fair value at acquisition date
$ 13,028,320 $ 3,501,200 $ 1,504,330 $ 18,033,850
Accumulated amortization
(1,302,832) (350,120) (300,866) (1,953,818)
Intangibles, net as of September 30, 2021
$ 11,725,488 $ 3,151,080 $ 1,203,464 $ 16,080,032
Estimated life (years)
10 10 5
Weighted-average remaining life (years) at September 30, 2021
9.0 9.0 4.0
Total
2021
$ 488,454
2022
1,953,818
2023
1,953,818
2024
1,953,818
2025
1,878,602
Thereafter
      7,851,522
Total
$ 16,080,032
The Company paid $12,000,000 in cash and acquired cash of $1,014,151 for net cash used in the acquisition of $10,985,849. Total purchase consideration and fair value of the equity units issued is as follows:
Cash paid to sellers
$ 12,000,000
Member units issued
4,294,041
Mandatorily redeemable units
      9,913,940
Total purchase consideration
$ 26,207,981
The following table summarizes the allocations of the purchase consideration to the fair value of the net assets:
Fair value of assets acquired:
Cash and cash equivalents
$ 1,014,151
 
F-46

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
SEPTEMBER 30, 2021 AND 2020
Accounts receivable
4,590,945
Prepaid expenses and other current assets
148,717
Other assets
9,618
Intangible assets
18,033,850
Goodwill
      4,095,700
Total assets acquired
27,892,981
Fair values of liabilities assumed:
Accounts payable
$ 683,521
Accrued liabilities
244,165
Deferred revenue
757,314
Total liabilities assumed
      1,685,000
Total fair value of net assets
$ 26,207,981
During the nine months ended September 30, 2020, the Company incurred $650,000 in acquisition transaction costs related to the acquisition of Orange142. These expenses primarily related to referral and legal fees.
The Company does expect to deduct goodwill for tax purposes in future years. The factors that make up goodwill include entry into new markets not previously accessible and generation of future growth opportunities.
The table below presents the unaudited pro forma revenue and net loss of the Company for the nine months ended September 30, 2020, assuming the acquisition had occurred on January 1, 2019, pursuant to ASC 805. This unaudited pro forma consolidated financial information does not purport to represent what the actual results of operations of the Company would have been had the acquisition occurred on that date, nor does it purport to predict the results of operations for future periods. This pro forma financial information does not give effect to any anticipated synergies, operating efficiencies or cost savings or any integration costs related to the acquisition. The unaudited pro forma consolidated financial information excludes transaction costs recorded as general and administrative expenses of $650,000 during the nine months ended September 30, 2020.
For the
Nine Months
Ended
September 30,
2020
Revenue — pro forma combined
$ 23,814,089
Net income — pro forma combined
$ 3,989,949
For the
Nine Months
Ended
September 30,
2020
Revenue
$ 5,876,008
Add: revenue, Orange142
17,938,081
Revenue — pro forma combined
$ 23,814,089
 
F-47

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
SEPTEMBER 30, 2021 AND 2020
Note 4 — Accrued Liabilities
Accrued liabilities consisted of the following:
September 30,
2021
December 31,
2020
Accrued compensation and benefits
$ 610,166 $ 482,436
Accrued litigation fees
501,078 501,078
Accrued expenses
313,287 317,401
Accrued interest
86,032       91,605
Total accrued liabilities
$ 1,510,563 $ 1,392,520
Note 5 — Long-Term Debt
Revolving Line of Credit
East West Bank
On September 30, 2020, the Company entered into a credit agreement that provides for a revolving credit facility with East West Bank in the amount of $4,500,000 and initial availability of $1,000,000 (the “Revolving Credit Facility”). The loans under the Revolving Credit Facility bear interest at the LIBOR rate plus 3.5% per annum, and at September 30, 2021, the rate was 6.75%, with a 0.50% unused line fee. The maturity date of the Revolving Credit Facility is September 30, 2022. All accrued but unpaid interest under the Revolving Credit Facility is payable in monthly installments on each interest payment date until the maturity date when the outstanding principal balance, together with all accrued but unpaid interest will be due. As of each of September 30, 2021 and December 31, 2020, the Revolving Credit Facility had borrowings outstanding of $407,051 and the deferred financing cost of $51,775 and $90,607 as of September 30, 2021 and December 31, 2020, respectively, was classified as an asset on the consolidated balance sheets.
The Revolving Credit Facility is secured by the trade accounts receivable of the Company and guaranteed by Holdings. The Revolving Credit Facility includes financial covenants, and as of September 30, 2021 and December 31, 2020, the Company was in compliance with all of its financial covenants.
First Citizens Bank
On May 17, 2019, the Company entered into a line of credit agreement with First Citizens Bank in the amount of $750,000, and as of December 31, 2019, borrowings of $727,000 were outstanding. The line of credit bears fixed interest of 3.15% and expired on May 17, 2020. The agreement was renewed for one additional year through May 17, 2021. The line of credit was secured by a deposit account which had a balance of $750,000 on December 31, 2019. On October 2, 2020, the line of credit was fully repaid.
The components of interest expense and related fees for the lines of credit are as follows:
For the Nine Months Ended
September 30,
2021
2020
Interest expense — East West Bank
$ 28,368 $
Interest expense — First Citizens Bank
18,297
Amortization of deferred financing costs
38,832
Total interest expense and amortization of deferred financing costs
$ 67,200 $ 18,297
 
F-48

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
SEPTEMBER 30, 2021 AND 2020
Accrued and unpaid interest as of September 30, 2021 for the East West Bank was $5,100 related to the unused line fee. As of December 31, 2020 there was no accrued and unpaid interest for the First Citizens Bank line of credit.
Term Loan Facility
SilverPeak
In conjunction with the acquisition of Orange142 (see Note 3 — Business Acquisition), on September 30, 2020, the Company entered into a loan and security agreement (the “Term Loan Facility”) with SilverPeak in the amount of $12,825,000, maturing on September 15, 2023. Interest in year one is 15%, of which 12% is payable monthly and 3% is paid-in-kind (“PIK”). All accrued but unpaid interest under the Term Loan Facility is payable in monthly installments on each interest payment date, and the Company is required to repay the outstanding principal balance on January 15 and July 15 of each calendar year in an amount equal to 37.5% of excess cash flow over the preceding six calendar months until the term loan is paid in full. The remaining principal balance, and all accrued but unpaid interest is due on the maturity date.
The obligations under the Term Loan Facility are secured by first-priority liens on all or substantially all assets of the Company and its subsidiaries. The Term Loan Facility contains a number of financial covenants and customary affirmative covenants. In addition, the Term Loan Facility includes a number of negative covenants, including (subject to certain exceptions) limitations on (among other things): indebtedness, liens, investments, acquisitions, dispositions, and restricted payments. Each of Mark Walker (“Walker”), Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer, and Keith Smith (“Smith”), President, have provided limited guarantees of the obligations under the Term Loan Facility. As of September 30, 2021 and December 31, 2020, the Company was in compliance with these covenants.
As of September 30, 2021 and December 31, 2020, the Company owed a balance on the Term Loan Facility of $11,984,754 and $12,922,243, respectively, which includes principal and $366,504 and $97,243, respectively, of accrued PIK interest. Financing costs incurred in the transaction were $573,481 and unamortized deferred financing costs as of September 30, 2021 and December 31, 2020 were $286,741 and $501,796, respectively. Accrued and unpaid interest was $73,697 and $73,542 as of September 30, 2021 and December 31, 2020, respectively and is included in accrued expenses on the consolidated balance sheets.
The components of interest expense and related fees for the Term Loan Facility are as follows:
For the Nine Months Ended
September 30,
2021
2020
Interest expense
$ 1,509,752 $
Amortization of deferred financing costs
215,055
Total interest expense and amortization of deferred financing costs
$ 1,724,807 $
U.S. Small Business Administration Loans
Economic Injury Disaster Loan
In 2020, the Company applied and was approved for a loan pursuant to the Economic Injury Disaster Loan (“EIDL”), administered by the U.S. Small Business Administration (“SBA”). The Company received the loan proceeds of $150,000 on June 15, 2020. The loan bears interest at a rate of 3.75% and matures on June 15, 2050. Installment payments, including principal and interest, of $731 will be payable monthly
 
F-49

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
SEPTEMBER 30, 2021 AND 2020
beginning June 15, 2022. Each payment will first be applied to pay accrued interest, then the remaining balance will be used to reduce principal. The loan is secured by substantially all assets of the Company.
Accrued and unpaid interest expense as of September 30, 2021 and December 31, 2020 was $7,235 and $3,041, respectively, and is included in accrued expenses on the consolidated balance sheets.
Paycheck Protection Program
In 2020, the Company applied and was approved for a loan pursuant to the Paycheck Protection Program (“PPP”), administered by the SBA (the “PPP-1 Loan”). The PPP was authorized in the Coronavirus Aid, Relief, and Economic Security (“CARES”) Act and was designed to provide a direct financial incentive for qualifying business to keep their workforce employees. The SBA made PPP loans available to qualifying businesses in amounts up to 2.5 times their average monthly payroll expenses, and loans should be forgivable after a “covered period” ​(eight or twenty-four weeks) as long as the borrower maintains its payroll and utilities.
The forgiveness amount will be reduced if the borrower terminates employees or reduces salaries and wages more than 25% during the covered period. Any unforgiven portion is payable over two years if issued before, or five years if issued after, June 5, 2020 at an interest rate of 1.0% with payments deferred until the SBA remits the borrower’s loan forgiveness amount to the lender, or if the borrower does not apply for forgiveness, then months after the end of the covered period.
The Company received the PPP-1 Loan proceeds on May 8, 2020. The principal amount of the PPP-1 Loan was $287,100 and there are no collateral or guarantee requirements. Under the terms of the PPP-1 Loan, payments were deferred until December 8, 2020. The loan bears interest at 1% per annum and matures on May 8, 2022. On October 6, 2020, the Company applied for forgiveness of the PPP-1 Loan. On November 30, 2020, $277,100 of the PPP-1 Loan was forgiven. On February 16, 2021, the remaining $10,000 balance of the PPP-1 Loan was forgiven.
In March 2021, the Company applied for and received another PPP loan (the “PPP-2 Loan”) for a principal amount of $287,143 and there are no collateral or guarantee requirements. Under the terms of the PPP-2 Loan, monthly payments of $6,440 are due starting June 11, 2022, and the loan bears interest at 1% per annum and matures on March 11, 2026.
As of September 30, 2021, future minimum payments related to long-term debt is as follows for the years ended December 31:
2021
$
2022
3,062,435
2023
9,447,981
2024
74,912
2025
75,385
Thereafter
168,235
Total
12,828,948
Less current portion
(2,611,685)
Less deferred financing costs
(286,741)
Long-term debt, net
$ 9,930,522
Note 6 — Mandatorily Redeemable Preferred Units
ASC 480, Distinguishing Liabilities from Equity, (“ASC 480”), defines mandatorily redeemable financial instruments as any financial instruments issued in the form of shares that have an unconditional obligation
 
F-50

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
SEPTEMBER 30, 2021 AND 2020
requiring the issuer to redeem the instrument by transferring its assets at a specified or determinable date (or dates) or upon an event that is certain to occur. A mandatorily redeemable financial instrument shall be classified as a liability unless the redemption is required to occur only upon the liquidation or termination of the reporting entity. Under ASC 480, mandatorily redeemable financial instruments shall be measured initially at fair value.
In connection with the acquisition of Orange142, the Company issued mandatorily redeemable preferred units which are only redeemable for a fixed amount of cash at a date specific to each class. Due to the mandatory redemption feature, ASC 480 requires that these preferred units be classified as a liability rather than as a component of equity, with preferred annual returns being accrued and recorded as interest expense.
Class A Preferred Units
In connection with the Orange142 acquisition (see Note 3 — Business Combination), the Company issued 3,500 non-voting Class A Preferred Units at a purchase price of $3,500,000, and a fair value of $3,458,378. Class A Preferred Units are entitled to certain approval rights and are mandatorily redeemable for $3,500,000 on September 30, 2022, with 10% preferred annual returns paid on a quarterly basis. Due to the mandatory redemption feature, ASC 480, requires that the Class A Preferred Units be classified as a liability rather than as a component of equity, with the preferred annual returns being accrued and recorded as interest expense. For the nine months ended September 30, 2021 and 2020, the Company recorded interest expense relating to the Class A Preferred Units of $261,781 and $0, respectively.
Class B Preferred Units
In connection with the Orange142 acquisition (see Note 3 — Business Combination), the Company issued 7,046 non-voting Class B Preferred Units at a purchase price of $7,046,251, and a fair value of $6,455,562. Class B Preferred Units are mandatorily redeemable for $7,046,251 on September 30, 2024, with 7% preferred annual returns paid on a quarterly basis. Due to the mandatory redemption feature, ASC 480 requires that the Class B Preferred Units be classified as a liability rather than as a component of equity, with the preferred annual returns being accrued and recorded as interest expense. For the nine months ended September 30, 2021 and 2020, the Company recorded interest expense relating to the Class B Preferred Units of $368,915 and $0, respectively.
Note 7 — Related Party Transactions
Related Party Debt
Seller Notes
In conjunction with the acquisition of Huddled Masses and Colossus Media on June 21, 2018, the Company issued seller notes (“Seller Notes”), to shareholders of Huddled Masses and Colossus Media (“Former Shareholders”) for a total of $500,000. The Seller Notes bore interest of 5% and matured on June 21, 2021. The Company paid $323,715 during the nine months ended September 30, 2021 for principal and interest on the Seller Notes. Also, in conjunction with the acquisition, the Company entered into a $350,000 seller payable (“Seller Payable”) with a Former Shareholder that is due in twelve monthly installments of $29,167. The outstanding balance of the Seller Notes was $6,019 and $315,509 as of September 30, 2021 and December 31, 2020, respectively. During the nine months ended September 30, 2020, the Company entered into a settlement agreement (“Settlement Agreement”) with the Former Shareholders, and as a result, recorded a net gain of $894 comprised of Seller Note forgiveness of $184,491, Seller Payable forgiveness of $26,403, offset by a $210,000 payment to settle credit card indebtedness. Accrued and unpaid interest
 
F-51

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
SEPTEMBER 30, 2021 AND 2020
was $916 and $9,792 as of September 30, 2021 and December 31, 2020, respectively. Interest expense related to the Seller Notes was $5,359 and $0 for the nine months ended September 30, 2021 and 2020, respectively.
Seller Earnouts
In conjunction with the acquisition of Huddled Masses and Colossus Media on June 21, 2018, the Company entered into an agreement to pay each of the Former Shareholders a seller earnout (“Seller Earnouts”) based on gross revenue generated for each of the three years following the acquisition. The Seller Earnouts were recorded at their estimated fair value at the date of grant and adjusted annually for actual revenues generated as well as estimates of future revenues. The Seller Earnouts were paid on June 21, 2021. As a result of the Settlement Agreement, the Company recognized a gain of $21,232 and $400,783, during the nine months ended September 30, 2021 and September 30, 2020, respectively, for the termination of certain seller payouts and paid $68,729 and $18,318, respectively, to the Former Shareholders. The outstanding balance of the Seller Earnouts was $3,276 and $74,909 as of September 30, 2021 and December 31, 2020, respectively.
Related Party Transactions
Member Payable
As of September 30, 2021 and December 31, 2020, the Company had a net payable to members that totaled $69,837 and $70,801, respectively, which is included as a related party payable on the consolidated balance sheets.
Board Services and Consulting Agreement
On September 30, 2020, the Company entered into board services and consulting agreements with Walker, Smith and Leah Woolford (“Woolford”). Walker, Smith and Woolford are members of the Company. Walker serves as Manager of the Board of Holdings and Chief Executive Officer of the Company. Smith serves as Manager of the Board of Holdings and President of the Company. Woolford serves as Manager of the Board of Holdings and Senior Advisor of the Company. In exchange, the Company pays Walker and Smith annual fees of $450,000 each and employee benefits for their direct families. The Company pays Woolford $300 per hour for up to 50 hours per month and employee benefits for Woolford and her direct family. For the nine months ended September 30, 2021, total fees paid to Walker, Smith and Woolford were $328,846, $328,846, and $135,000, respectively. There were no fees paid for the nine months ended September 30, 2020.
Note 8 — Commitments and Contingencies
Operating Leases
The Company leases furniture and office space in Houston, Austin, and Colorado Springs from an unrelated party under non-cancelable operating leases dating through December 2023. Rent expense for the nine months ended September 30, 2021 and 2020 was $165,731 and $40,473, respectively.
As of September 30, 2021, future minimum payments under the operating leases were as follows for the year ending December 31:
2021
$ 36,638
2022
121,651
2023
90,138
$ 248,427
 
F-52

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
SEPTEMBER 30, 2021 AND 2020
Litigation
The Company may from time to time be subject to various legal or administrative claims and proceedings arising in the ordinary course of business. In management’s opinion, the outcome of any such litigation will not materially affect the Company’s financial condition. Nevertheless, due to uncertainties in the settlement process, it is at least reasonably possible that management’s view of the outcome could change materially in the near term.
Huddled Masses was named as a defendant in a lawsuit on July 10, 2019 related to a delinquent balance to a vendor. The matter is currently underway, and the Company has estimated a potential liability of approximately $500,000. Such liability has been recorded and included in accrued liabilities on the consolidated balance sheets as of September 30, 2021 and December 31, 2020. The Company entered into mediation discussions beginning April 2021 and expects to resolve the matter during 2021.
Note 9 — Members’ Equity
The Company is authorized to issue common units, Class A Preferred Units and Class B Preferred Units. As further described in Note 3 — Business Acquisition and Note 6 — Mandatorily Redeemable Preferred Units, in connection with the acquisition of Orange142, the Company issued 5,637 common units, 3,500 Class A Preferred Units and 7,046 Class B Preferred Units. The common units were valued at $4,294,041 and Class A and Class B Preferred Units were valued at a total of $9,913,940. As of each of September 30, 2021 and December 31, 2020, the total outstanding common units were 34,182. The common units have voting rights, as well as certain redemption features at the option of the Company. In accordance with ASC 480, as of September 30, 2021 and December 31, 2020, the Company has classified the preferred units as a liability in the consolidated balance sheets.
Note 10 — Income (Loss) Per Unit
Basic income (loss) per unit is calculated by dividing the net income (loss) for the year by the weighted average number of units outstanding during the period. The Company does not have any dilutive units, and therefore the diluted weighted average number of units outstanding are equal to the basic weighted average number of units.
For the Nine Months Ended September 30,
2021
2020
Net income (loss) per unit attributable to members
$ 623,701 $ (380,490)
Number of units outstanding at the beginning of the year
34,182 28,545
Weighted average units issued during the year
21
Number of units outstanding at the end of the year, basic and diluted
34,182 28,566
Net income (loss) per unit, basic and diluted
$ 18.25 $ (13.32)
Note 11 — Employee Benefit Plans
The Company sponsors a safe harbor, defined contribution 401(k) and profit-sharing plan (the “Plan”) that allows eligible employees to contribute a percentage of their compensation. The Company matches employee contributions up to a maximum of 100% of the participant’s salary deferral, limited to 4% of the employee’s salary. For the nine months ended September 30, 2021 and 2020, the Company matching contributions were $122,792 and $20,659, respectively. Additionally, the Company may make a discretionary profit- sharing contribution to the Plan. During the nine months ended September 30, 2021 and 2020, no profit-sharing contributions were made.
 
F-53

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
SEPTEMBER 30, 2021 AND 2020
The Company has an Employee Benefit Plan Trust (the “Trust”) to provide for the payment or reimbursement of all or a portion of covered medical, dental and prescription expenses for the employees of Orange142. The Trust is funded with contributions made by the Company and participating employees at amounts sufficient to keep the Trust on an actuarially sound basis. The self-funded plan has an integrated stop loss insurance policy for the funding of the Trust benefits in excess of the full funding requirements. As of September 30, 2021 and December 31, 2020, there were no unpaid claims for the Company’s employees.
Note 12 — Segment Information
Operating segments are components of an enterprise for which separate financial information is available and is evaluated regularly by the Company’s chief operating decision maker in deciding how to allocate resources and assess performance. The Company’s chief operating decision maker is its Chairman and Chief Executive Officer. The Company views its business as two reportable segments, buy-side advertising, which includes the results of Huddled Masses and Orange142, and sell-side advertising, which includes the results of Colossus Media. All of the Company’s revenues are attributed to the United States.
Revenue by business segment is as follows:
For the Nine Months Ended
September 30,
2021
2020
Buy-side advertising
$ 19,975,235 $ 4,377,708
Sell-side advertising
      5,261,135 1,498,300
Total revenues
$ 25,236,370 $ 5,876,008
Operating income (loss) by business segment is as follows:
For the Nine Months Ended
September 30,
2021
2020
Buy-side advertising
$ 4,705,408 $ 536,181
Sell-side advertising
277,293       (95,655)
Corporate office
(1,921,973) (1,325,375)
Consolidated operating income (loss)
$ 3,060,728 $ (884,849)
Total assets by business segment are as follows:
At
September 30,
2021
At
December 31,
2020
Buy-side advertising
$ 25,653,242 $ 27,622,180
Sell-side advertising
3,608,434 2,641,325
Corporate office
636,751 431,970
Total Assets
$ 29,898,427 $ 30,695,475
Note 13 — Subsequent Events
The Company has evaluated events and transactions occurring subsequent to September 30, 2021 through the date of this report and determined there were no events or transactions that would impact the consolidated financial statements for the nine months ended September 30, 2021.
 
F-54

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
Orange142, LLC
Financial Statements
(with Independent Auditors Report Thereon)
December 31, 2019 and 2018
[MISSING IMAGE: LG_BAKERTILLY-BW.JPG]
 

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
Orange142, LLC
Table of Contents
Page
F-57
Financial Statements:
F-59
F-60
F-61
 
F-56

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
[MISSING IMAGE: LG_BAKERTILLY-BW.JPG]  
INDEPENDENT AUDITOR’S REPORT
To the Board of Directors of
Orange142, LLC:
We have audited the accompanying financial statements of Orange142, LLC (the “Company”), which comprise the balance sheets as of December 31, 2019 and 2018, and the related statements of operations and changes in members’ equity, and cash flows for the years then ended, and the related notes to the financial statements.
Management’s Responsibility for the Financial Statements
Management is responsible for the preparation and fair presentation of these financial statements in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America; this includes the design, implementation, and maintenance of internal control relevant to the preparation and fair presentation of financial statements that are free from material misstatement, whether due to fraud or error.
Auditor’s Responsibility
Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits. We conducted our audits in accordance with auditing standards generally accepted in the United States of America. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audits to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free from material misstatement.
An audit involves performing procedures to obtain audit evidence about the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. The procedures selected depend on the auditor’s judgment, including the assessment of the risks of material misstatement of the financial statements, whether due to fraud or error. In making those risk assessments, the auditor considers internal control relevant to the entity’s preparation and fair presentation of the financial statements in order to design audit procedures that are appropriate in the circumstances, but not for the purpose of expressing an opinion on the effectiveness of the entity’s internal control. Accordingly, we express no such opinion. An audit also includes evaluating the appropriateness of accounting policies used and the reasonableness of significant accounting estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the financial statements.
We believe that the audit evidence we have obtained is sufficient and appropriate to provide a basis for our audit opinion.
Opinion
In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the Company as of December 31, 2019 and 2018, and the results of its operations and its cash flows for the years then ended in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.
Baker Tilly Virchow Krause, LLP trading as Baker Tilly is a member of the global network of Baker Tilly International
Ltd., the members of which are separate and independent legal entities. © 2018 Baker Tilly Virchow Krause, LLP
F-57

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
[MISSING IMAGE: LG_BAKERTILLY-BW.JPG]
Emphasis of Matter
The Company is a part of a consolidated group. These financial statements are presented on a standalone historical basis and do not include the financial position and results of operations of the consolidated group, and should be read in conjunction with the auditor’s report on the consolidated financial statements of the group. Effective January 1, 2019, USDM LLC and Orange142 Advertising Canada, Inc. became wholly owned subsidiaries of Orange142, LLC via a transfer of ownership; and USDM LLC was subsequently dissolved. The prior year financial statements were not restated to reflect this. Our opinion is not modified with respect to these matters.
/s/ BAKER TILLY VIRCHOW KRAUSE, LLP
Baker tilly virchow krause, LLP
Plano, Texas
April 1, 2020
Baker Tilly Virchow Krause, LLP trading as Baker Tilly is a member of the global network of Baker Tilly International
Ltd., the members of which are separate and independent legal entities. © 2018 Baker Tilly Virchow Krause, LLP
F-58

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
Orange142, LLC
Balance Sheets
December 31, 2019 and 2018
2019
2018
ASSETS
CURRENT ASSETS:
Cash and cash equivalents
$ 614,048 $ 897,479
Accounts receivable, net
3,154,887 1,636,790
Prepaid expenses and other current assets
250,201 58,839
Total current assets
4,019,136 2,593,108
Other assets
9,618 26,483
TOTAL ASSETS
$
4,028,754
$ 2,619,591
LIABILITIES AND MEMBERS’ EQUITY
CURRENT LIABILITIES:
Accounts payable
$ 570,226 $ 165,593
Accrued liablilities
366,566 419,127
Deferred revenue
375,794 845,211
Total current liabilities
1,312,586 1,429,931
Total liabilities
1,312,586 1,429,931
MEMBERS’ EQUITY
2,716,168 1,189,660
TOTAL LIABILITIES AND MEMBERS’ EQUITY
$
4,028,754
$ 2,619,591
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements.
F-59

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
Orange142, LLC
Statements of Operations and Changes in Members’ Equity
for the Years Ended December 31, 2019 and 2018
2019
2018
ADVERTISING REVENUES
$ 14,043,423 $ 10,002,965
MARKETING REVENUES
2,911,636 36,441
TOTAL REVENUES
16,955,059 10,039,406
COST OF SALES
5,296,385 4,125,520
GROSS PROFIT
11,658,674 5,913,886
OPERATING EXPENSES:
Payroll related costs
4,594,768 2,495,993
General and administrative
1,512,376 1,229,738
Total operating expenses
6,107,144 3,725,731
Income from operations
5,551,530 2,188,155
OTHER INCOME:
Interest income
240 241
Gain on sale of property and equipment
11,200
Total other income
11,440 241
Income before tax provision
5,562,970 2,188,396
Provision for taxes
(51,638) (28,872)
Net income
$ 5,511,332 $ 2,159,524
Members’ equity, beginning of year
$ 1,189,660 $ 1,319,951
Equity transferred from USDM LLC
76,638
Distribution to parent
(4,061,462) (2,289,815)
Net income
5,511,332 2,159,524
Members’ equity, end of year
$ 2,716,168 $ 1,189,660
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements.
F-60

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
Orange142, LLC
Statements of Cash Flows
for the Years Ended December 31, 2019 and 2018
2019
2018
CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES:
Net income
$ 5,511,332 $ 2,159,524
Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating activities:
Gain on sale of property and equipment
(11,200)
Changes in operating assets and liabilities:
Accounts receivable
(1,518,097) (790,602)
Prepaid expenses and other assets
(174,497) (14,909)
Accounts payable and accrued liabilities
352,072 (18,010)
Deferred revenues
(469,417) 444,503
Related-party receivable
296,300
Net cash provided by operating activities
3,690,193 2,076,806
CASH FLOWS FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES:
Cash proceeds from sale of property and equipment
11,200
Net cash provided by investing activities
11,200
CASH FLOWS FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES:
Distributions to parent
(4,061,462) (2,289,815)
Equity transferred from USDM LLC
76,638
Net cash used in financing activities
(3,984,824) (2,289,815)
Net decrease in cash and cash equivalents
(283,431) (213,009)
Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of year
897,479 1,110,488
Cash and cash equivalents, end of year
$ 614,048 $ 897,479
SUPPLEMENTAL INFORMATION:
Cash paid for income taxes
$ 51,638 $ 28,872
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements.
F-61

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
Orange142, LLC
Notes to the Financial Statements
December 31, 2019 and 2018
Note 1 — Nature of Operations
Orange142, LLC (the “Company”) was formed in the state of Delaware on March 6, 2013. Effective January 1, 2019, USDM LLC and Orange142 Advertising Canada, Inc. became wholly owned subsidiaries of the Company via a transfer of ownership; and USDM LLC was subsequently dissolved. The Company is a digital media and marketing company that delivers targeted advertising messaging using digital and traditional tactics. Its clients include private, public, and government entities. The Company is headquartered in Austin, Texas.
Note 2 — Summary of Significant Accounting Policies
Recently Adopted Accounting Policies
On January 1, 2019, the company adopted the Financial Accounting Standards Board’s (“FASB”) Accounting Standards Update (“ASU”) 2014-09, Revenue from Contracts with Customers (“Topic 606”), and all related amendments using the modified retrospective transition method. Under the modified retrospective transition method, the Company’s 2018 financial statements continue to be accounted for under the FASB’s Topic 605 and have not been adjusted.
ASU 2014-09 created Accounting Standards Codification Topic 340-40, Contracts with Customers, which requires that costs to obtain a contract that would have been incurred regardless of whether the contract was obtained are to be expensed when incurred. No such costs require capitalization with the adoption of Topic 606 at December 31, 2019.
Other than the aforementioned application of Topic 340-40, the adoption of Topic 606 did not have a significant impact on the Company’s financial position or results of operations. There were no adjustments made to the Company’s 2019 financial statements as a result of the adoption of Topic 606.
In February 2016, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) issued Accounting Standards Update (“ASU”) No. 2016-02 “Leases” “ASC 842” under which lessees will recognize most leases on the balance sheet. The effective dates were for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2019. On August 15, 2019, the FASB proposed a one-year delay and the effective date for non-public business entities was deferred until fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2020. The Company is evaluating the effect of adopting ASU 2016-02.
Use of Estimates
The preparation of financial statements in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America (“GAAP”) requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Significant estimates include management’s assessment of the allowance for doubtful accounts. Actual results could differ from those estimates.
Cash and Cash Equivalents
The Company considers all highly liquid investments with an original maturity of three months or less to be cash equivalents. The Company maintains cash deposits with federally insured financial institutions that may at times exceed federally insured limits. The Company has not incurred any losses from such accounts, and management considers the risk to be minimal.
Accounts Receivable
Accounts receivable primarily consist of billings for products and services rendered to customers under normal trade terms. The Company performs credit evaluations of its customers’ financial condition and generally does not require collateral.
 
F-62

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
Orange142, LLC
Notes to the Financial Statements
December 31, 2019 and 2018
Note 2 — Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (continued)
The Company carries its accounts receivable at net realizable value. During 2016, the Company began insuring its accounts receivable with an unrelated third-party insurance company in an effort to mitigate any future write-offs and thereby eliminating the need for an allowance for doubtful accounts. Management periodically reviews outstanding accounts receivable for reasonableness. After all attempts to collect have failed, the Company processes a claim with the third-party insurance company to recover uncollected balances, rather than writing the balances off to bad debt expense. The guaranteed recovery for the claim is 90% of the original balance.
Property and Equipment
Property and equipment is stated at cost, less accumulated depreciation. Property and equipment is depreciated on a straight-line basis over the estimated useful lives of the assets. Expenditures for repairs and maintenance are charged to expense as incurred. Expenditures for major renewals and betterments, which extend the useful lives of the existing property and equipment, are capitalized and depreciated. Upon retirement or disposition of property and equipment, the cost and related accumulated depreciation are removed from the accounts and any gain or loss is recognized in the statement of operations.
Impairment of Long-Lived Assets
Long-lived assets and intangible assets are reviewed for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of an asset may not be fully recoverable, at least annually. Recoverability of assets to be held and used is measured by a comparison of the carrying amount of the assets to their fair value, which is normally determined through analysis of the future net cash flows expected to be generated by the assets. If such assets are considered to be impaired, the impairment to be recognized is measured by the amount that the carrying amount of the assets exceeds the fair value of the assets. There was no impairment loss for the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018.
Fair Value of Financial Instruments
In accordance with the reporting requirements of ASC 825-10-50, “Disclosures about Fair Value of Financial Instruments”, the Company calculates the fair value of its assets and liabilities which qualify as financial instruments under this statement and includes this additional information in the notes to the financial statements when the fair value is different than the carrying value of those financial instruments. The estimated value of accounts receivable are based on management’s assessment of net realizable value. The estimated fair value of accounts payable approximates their carrying amounts due to the short maturity of these liabilities.
Revenue Recognition
Prior to January 1, 2019
The Company provides complete turn-key digital advertising and strategy services with the focus on generating measurable digital and financial lift for its customers.
The advertising campaigns are billed and revenue recognized at intervals throughout the life of the advertising campaign. In an effort to reduce the risk of nonpayment, the Company has AR insurance in place, or sometimes clients pay for advertising campaigns prior to the campaign launch. Customer billings on advertising campaigns in the development process at December 31, 2019 and 2018 were included in deferred revenue.
 
F-63

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
Orange142, LLC
Notes to the Financial Statements
December 31, 2019 and 2018
Note 2 — Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (continued)
January 1, 2019 and After
The Company’s revenues are comprised of digital and print advertising campaigns. All revenue is recognized when the Company satisfies its performance obligation(s) under the contract (either implicit or explicit) by transferring the promised product to its customer when its customer obtains control of the product. A performance obligation is a promise in a contract to transfer a distinct product or service to a customer. A contract’s transaction price is allocated to each distinct performance obligation.
Revenue is measured as the amount of consideration the Company expects to receive in exchange for transferring products or providing services. The nature of the Company’s contracts do not give rise to any notable amounts of variable consideration with the customers. Neither the type of product or service sold or the location of sale significantly impacts nature, amount, timing or uncertainty of revenue and cash flows.
Sales, value add, and other taxes collected from customers and remitted to governmental authorities are accounted for on a net (excluded from revenues) basis.
A contract’s transaction price is allocated to each distinct performance obligation within the contract. Substantially all of the Company’s contracts have a single performance obligation. In instances where multiple performance obligations may exist, due to the short duration of the arrangements or the insignificance of certain performance obligations, in substantially all cases it is not necessary to allocate the transaction price to the distinct performance obligations as the allocation would not result in a different accounting outcome.
Payments for advertising campaigns are typically received in advance of the service period, recorded as deferred revenue and revenue recognized over time of the period of the campaign.
The Company does not have any contract assets as of December 31, 2019. The Company has elected to expense all contract costs as incurred. At December 31, 2019, the Company did not record any contract liabilities.
Deferred revenue as of December 31, 2019 and 2018 was $375,794 and $845,211, respectively.
Income Taxes
The Company is organized as a limited liability company. The financial statements of the Company for the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018 contain no federal income tax provision as taxable income is included in the personal tax returns of the members. The Company is subject to state income tax and has made a provision for them based on the estimated taxes due. For the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018, the provision for taxes was $51,638 and $28,872, respectively.
The Company applies ASC 740-10, “Income Taxes”, in establishing standards for accounting for uncertain tax positions. The Company evaluates uncertain tax positions with the presumption of audit detection and applies a “more likely than not” standard to evaluate the recognition of tax benefits or provisions. ASC 740-10 applies a two-step process to determine whether any amount may be recognized and then determines how much of a tax benefit or provision should be recognized. As of December 31, 2019 and 2018, the Company has no uncertain tax positions.
Concentrations
As of December 31, 2019, one customer accounted for approximately 52% of total accounts receivable. As of December 31, 2018, three customers accounted for approximately 40% of total accounts receivable. During the year ended December 31, 2019, four customers accounted for 53% of total sales. During the year ended December 31, 2018, four customers accounted for approximately 57% of total sales. Management
 
F-64

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
Orange142, LLC
Notes to the Financial Statements
December 31, 2019 and 2018
Note 2 — Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (continued)
continuously evaluates the credit worthiness of its customers’ financial condition and has policies to minimize potential risk. As of December 31, 2019, two vendors accounted for approximately 92% of total accounts payable. As of December 31, 2018, two vendors accounted for approximately 73% of total accounts payable.
Note 3 — Accrued Expenses
Accrued expenses consisted of the following at December 31, 2019 and 2018:
2019
2018
Bonus payable
$ 59,013 $ 90,576
Other payable media
241,222
Other accrued expenses
21,035 39,913
Customer deposits
113,799
Commissions Payable
172,719 47,416
$ 366,566 $ 419,127
Note 4 — Related Party Transactions
The Company has an informal agreement with USDM, LLC (“USDM”), which shares common ownership with the Company, whereby each entity can sell the other’s services. In exchange for selling these services, the related entity receives a 15% commission on select services. The commission is reviewed on an annual basis in January to ensure it properly reflects the work effort and current market conditions. For the year ended December 31, 2018, USDM paid total commission to the Company of $1,393,025. The commissions are included in marketing revenues in the statements of operations and changes in members’ equity. Effective January 1, 2019, this related party transaction no longer existed when USDM LLC merged into Orange142, LLC and subsequently dissolved.
Note 5 — Line of Credit
In July 2017, the Company obtained a cash-backed line of credit from a financial institution in the amount of $300,000. The line of credit is guaranteed by the Company. The line of credit bears interest at the prime rate plus 0.75% and expires on August 13, 2117. As of December 31, 2019 and 2018, the line of credit had not been used.
Note 6 — Employee Retirement Plans
The Company sponsors a safe harbor, defined contribution 401(k) and profit sharing plan that allows employees to contribute a percentage of their compensation. The Company matches employee contributions up to a maximum of 100% of the participant’s salary deferral, limited to 4% of the employee’s salary. For the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018, the Company’s matching contributions were $79,924 and $44,398, respectively. Additionally, the Company may make a discretionary profit sharing contribution to the Plan. During the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018, no profit sharing contribution was made.
Note 7 — Commitments and Contingencies
Operating Leases
The Company leases office and equipment under noncancelable operating lease agreements expiring on various dates through December 2021.
 
F-65

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
Orange142, LLC
Notes to the Financial Statements
December 31, 2019 and 2018
Note 7 — Commitments and Contingencies (continued)
At December 31, 2019, future minimum lease payments under noncancelable operating leases were as follows:
For the years ending December 31,
2020
$ 78,000
2021
80,400
Total
$ 158,400
Rent expense relating to the office lease and other operating agreements was $142,373 and $111,221 for the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018, respectively.
Litigation
The Company is subject to legal proceedings, claims, and litigation arising from the normal course of business. Although occasional adverse decisions or settlements may occur, management believes that the ultimate outcome of any such matters will not have a material adverse impact on the company’s financial position at December 31, 2019 and 2018.
Note 8 — Subsequent Events
In accordance with ASC 855, “Subsequent Events”, the Company has evaluated events and transactions occurring subsequent to December 31, 2019, the balance sheet date, through April 1, 2020, the date the financial statements were available to be issued, and determined there were no events or transactions that would impact the financial statements for the year ended December 31, 2019, other than the following:
In December 2019, a novel strain of coronavirus was reported in Wuhan, Hubei province, China. In the first several months of 2020, the virus, SARS-CoV-2, and resulting disease, COVID-19, spread to the United States. The COVID-19 pandemic is having significant effects on global markets, supply chains, businesses, and communities. The Company’s evaluation of the effects of these events is ongoing as of the date the accompanying financial statements were available to be issued. COVID-19 may impact various parts of the Company’s 2020 operations and financial performance including but not limited to potential shortages of personnel, closure of certain facilities or service lines, or declines in revenue related to decreases in volumes of certain revenue streams. The extent of the impact will depend on future developments, including the duration and spread of the outbreak and related governmental or other regulatory actions.
 
F-66

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
Orange142, LLC
Financial Statements
(unaudited)
September 30, 2020 and 2019
 

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
ORANGE142, LLC
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Page
Financial Statements
F-69
F-70
F-71
F-72
F-73
 
F-68

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
ORANGE142, LLC
BALANCE SHEETS
SEPTEMBER 30, 2020 and DECEMBER 31, 2019
September 30,
2020
December 31,
2019
(Unaudited)
(Audited)
ASSETS
CURRENT ASSETS
Cash and cash equivalents
$ 1,014,151 $ 614,048
Accounts receivable, net
4,590,945 3,154,887
Prepaid expenses and other current assets
148,717 250,201
Total current assets
5,753,813 4,019,136
Other long-term assets
9,618 9,618
Total assets
$ 5,763,431 $ 4,028,754
LIABILITIES AND MEMBERS’ EQUITY
CURRENT LIABILITIES
Accounts payable
$ 683,521 $ 570,226
Accrued liabilities
244,165 366,566
Deferred revenues
757,314 375,794
Total current liabilities
1,685,000 1,312,586
MEMBERS’ EQUITY
4,078,431 2,716,168
Total liabilities and members’ equity
$ 5,763,431 $ 4,028,754
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements.
F-69

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
ORANGE142, LLC
STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS
FOR THE NINE MONTHS ENDED SEPTEMBER 30, 2020 AND 2019
For the Nine Months Ended
September 30, 2020
For the Nine Months Ended
September 30, 2019
Revenues
Advertising revenues
$ 14,887,635 $ 9,443,989
Marketing revenues
3,050,446 2,161,962
Total revenues
17,938,081 11,605,951
Cost of revenues
5,267,463 3,750,595
Gross profit
12,670,618 7,855,356
Operating expenses
Compensation, taxes and benefits
4,038,610 3,028,255
General and administrative
757,540 1,128,554
Total operating expenses
4,796,150 4,156,809
Income from operations
7,874,468 3,698,547
Other income
11,900 11,380
Total other income
11,900 11,380
Tax expense
(48,971)
Net income
$ 7,837,397 $ 3,709,927
See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements.
F-70

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
ORANGE142, LLC
STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN MEMBERS’ EQUITY
FOR THE NINE MONTHS ENDED SEPTEMBER 30, 2019
Common Units
Accumulated
equity
Members’
equity
Shares
Amount
Balance, December 31, 2018 (audited)
1,000 $ 10 $ 1,189,648 $ 1,189,658
Equity transfer from USDM LLC
76,638 76,638
Distribution to members
(3,235,600) (3,235,600)
Net income
3,709,927 3,709,927
Balance, September 30, 2019 (unaudited)
1,000 $ 10 $ 1,740,613 $ 1,740,623
ORANGE142, LLC
STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN MEMBERS’ EQUITY
FOR THE NINE MONTHS ENDED SEPTEMBER 30, 2020
Common Units
Accumulated
equity
Members’
equity
Shares
Amount
Balance, December 31, 2018 (audited)
1,000 $ 10 $ 1,189,648 $ 1,189,658
Equity transfer from USDM LLC
76,638 76,638
Distribution to members
(4,061,462) (4,061,462)
Net income
5,511,332 5,511,332
Balance, December 31, 2019 (audited)
1,000 10 2,716,156 2,716,166
Distribution to members
(6,475,132) (6,475,132)
Net income
7,837,397 7,837,397
Balance, September 30, 2020 (unaudited)
1,000 $ 10 $ 4,078,421 $ 4,078,431
See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements.
F-71

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
ORANGE142, LLC
STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
FOR THE NINE MONTHS ENDED SEPTEMBER 30, 2020 AND 2019
(Unaudited)
September 30,
2020
September 30,
2019
Cash Flows From Operating Activities:
Net income
$ 7,837,397 $ 3,709,927
Adjustments to reconcile net loss to net cash provided by operating activities:
Changes in operating assets and liabilities:
Accounts receivable
(1,436,059) (758,546)
Prepaid expenses and other current assets
101,484 (212,319)
Other long-term assets
16,865
Accounts payable
113,293 257,304
Accrued liabilities
(122,400) 111,090
Deferred revenues
381,520 232,803
Net cash provided by operating activities
6,875,235 3,357,124
Cash Flows (Used In) Provided By Financing Activities: 
Distributions to members
(6,475,132) (3,235,600)
Equity transferred from USDM LLC
76,638
Net cash used in financing activities
(6,475,132) (3,158,962)
Net increase in cash and cash equivalents
400,103 198,162
Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of the period
614,048 897,479
Cash and cash equivalents, end of the period
$ 1,014,151 $ 1,095,641
See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements.
F-72

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
ORANGE142, LLC
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
SEPTEMBER 30, 2020 AND 2019
(Unaudited)
NOTE 1 — ORGANIZATION
Orange142, LLC (the “Company”) was formed in the state of Delaware on March 6, 2013. Effective January 1, 2019, USDM LLC and Orange142 Advertising Canada, Inc. became wholly owned subsidiaries of the Company via a transfer of ownership; and USDM LLC was subsequently dissolved. The Company is a digital media and marketing company that delivers targeted advertising messaging using digital and traditional tactics. Its clients include private, public, and government entities. The Company is headquartered in Austin, Texas.
NOTE 2 — SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES
Basis of consolidation
The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of Orange142, LLC and its wholly owned subsidiaries. All material intercompany accounts and transactions have been eliminated in consolidation.
Use of estimates
The preparation of financial statements in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America (“GAAP”) requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Significant estimates include management’s assessment of the allowance for doubtful accounts. Actual results could differ from those estimates.
Cash and cash equivalents
The Company considers all highly liquid investments with an original maturity of three months or less to be cash equivalents. The Company maintains cash deposits with federally insured financial institutions that may at times exceed federally insured limits. The Company has not incurred any losses from such accounts, and management considers the risk to be minimal.
Accounts receivable
Accounts receivable primarily consist of billings for products and services rendered to customers under normal trade terms. The Company performs credit evaluations of its customers’ financial condition and generally does not require collateral.
The Company carries its accounts receivable at net realizable value. During 2016, the Company began insuring its accounts receivable with an unrelated third-party insurance company in an effort to mitigate any future write-offs and thereby eliminating the need for an allowance for doubtful accounts. Management periodically reviews outstanding accounts receivable for reasonableness. After all attempts to collect have failed, the Company processes a claim with the third-party insurance company to recover uncollected balances, rather than writing the balances off to bad debt expense. The guaranteed recovery for the claim in 90% of the original balance.
Property and equipment
Property and equipment is stated at cost, less accumulated depreciation. Property and equipment is depreciated on a straight-line basis over the estimated useful lives of the assets. Expenditures for repairs and maintenance are charged to expense as incurred. Expenditures for major renewals and betterments, which extend the useful lives of the existing property and equipment, are capitalized and depreciated. Upon retirement or disposition of property and equipment, the cost and related accumulated depreciation are
 
F-73

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
ORANGE142, LLC
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
SEPTEMBER 30, 2020 AND 2019
(Unaudited)
removed from the accounts and any gain or loss is recognized in the statement of operations. As of September 30, 2020 and December 31, 2019, the Company had fully depreciated all property and equipment.
Impairment of long-lived assets
Long-lived assets and intangible assets are reviewed for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of an asset may not be fully recoverable, at least annually. Recoverability of assets to be held and used is measured by a comparison of the carrying amount of the assets to their fair value, which is normally determined through analysis of the future net cash flows expected to be generated by the assets. If such assets are considered to be impaired, the impairment to be recognized is measured by the amount that the carrying amount of the assets exceeds the fair value of the assets. There was no impairment loss for the nine months ended September 30, 2020 and 2019.
Fair value of financial instruments
In accordance with the reporting requirements of ASC 825-10-50, Disclosures about Fair Value of Financial Instruments, the Company calculates the fair value of its assets and liabilities which qualify as financial instruments under this statement and includes this additional information in the notes to the financial statements when the fair value is different than the carrying value of those financial instruments. The estimated values of accounts receivable are based on management’s assessment of net realizable value. The estimated fair values of accounts payable approximate their carrying amounts due to the short maturity of these liabilities.
Revenue recognition
The Company’s revenues are comprised of digital and print advertising campaigns. All revenue is recognized when the Company satisfies its performance obligation(s) under the contract (either implicit or explicit) by transferring the promised product to its customer when its customer obtains control of the product. A performance obligation is a promise in a contract to transfer a distinct product or service to a customer. A contract’s transaction price is allocated to each distinct performance obligation.
Revenue is measured as the amount of consideration the Company expects to receive in exchange for transferring products or providing services. The nature of the Company’s contracts do not give rise to any notable amounts of variable consideration with the customers. Neither the type of product or service sold or the location of sale significantly impacts the nature, amount, timing or uncertainty of revenue and cash flows.
Sales, value add, and other taxes collected from customers and remitted to governmental authorities are accounted for on a net (excluded from revenues) basis.
A contract’s transaction price is allocated to each distinct performance obligation within the contracts. Substantially all of the Company’s contracts have a single performance obligation. In instances where multiple performance obligations may exist, due to the short duration of the arrangements or the insignificance of certain performance obligations, in substantially all cases it is not necessary to allocate the transaction price to the distinct performance obligations as the allocation would not result in a different accounting outcome.
Payments for advertising campaigns are typically received in advance of the service period, recorded as deferred revenue and revenue is recognized over the time of the period of the campaign. Deferred revenue as of September 30, 2020 and December 31, 2019 was $757,314 and $375,794, respectively.
Income taxes
The Company is organized as a limited liability company. The financial statements of the Company for the nine months ended September 30, 2020 and 2019 contain no federal income tax provision as taxable
 
F-74

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
ORANGE142, LLC
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
SEPTEMBER 30, 2020 AND 2019
(Unaudited)
income is included in the personal tax returns of the members. The Company is subject to state income tax and has made provision for them based on the estimated taxes due. For the nine months ended September 30, 2020 and 2019, the provision for taxes was $48,971 and $0, respectively.
The Company applies ASC 740-10, Income Taxes, in establishing standards for accounting for uncertain tax positions. The Company evaluates uncertain tax positions with the presumption of audit detection and applies a “more likely than not” standard to evaluate the recognition of tax benefits or provisions. ASC 740-10 applies a two-step process to determine whether any amount may be recognized and then determines how much of a tax benefit or provision should be recognized. As of September 30, 2020 and December 31, 2019, the Company has no uncertain tax positions. If the Company were to incur an income tax liability in the future, interest on any income tax liability would be reported as interest expense and penalties on any income tax liability would be reported as income taxes. The Company’s conclusions regarding uncertain tax positions may be subject to review and adjustments at a later date based upon ongoing analyses of tax laws, regulations and interpretations thereof as well as other factors.
Recently issued accounting pronouncements
In February 2016, the FASB issued ASU 2016-02, Leases (Topic 842). Under the new guidance, lessees will be required to put most leases on their balance sheets but to recognize expenses in the income statement in a manner similar to current accounting. The guidance also eliminated the current real estate-specific provisions and changed the guidance on sale-leaseback transactions, initial direct costs, and lease executory costs for all entities. The updated guidance will be effective for the Company beginning January 1, 2022, with early adoption permitted. Upon adoption, entities will be required to use the modified retrospective approach for leases that exist, or are entered into, after the beginning of the earliest comparative period in the financial statements. In July 2018, the FASB issued ASU 2018-11, Leases (Topic 842), Targeted Improvements”, which allows entities to not apply the new leases standard, including its disclosure requirements, in the comparative periods they present in their financial statements in the year of adoption. The Company is currently evaluating the potential effect that adopting this guidance will have on its consolidated financial statements.
NOTE 3 — ACCRUED LIABILITIES
Accrued liabilities consisted of the following at September 30, 2020 and December 31, 2019:
September 30,
2020
December 31,
2019
Accrued commissions
$ 136,525 $ 172,719
Other accrued expenses
99,835 21,035
Accrued bonus
6,185 59,013
Customer deposits
1,620 113,799
Total accrued liabilities
$ 244,165 $ 366,566
NOTE 4 — EMPLOYEE RETIREMENT PLANS
The Company sponsors a safe harbor, defined contribution 401(k) and profit-sharing plan (the “Plan”) that allows employees to contribute a percentage of their compensation. The Company matches employee contributions up to a maximum of 100% of the participant’s salary deferral, limited to 4% of the employee’s salary. For the nine months ended September 30, 2020 and 2019, the Company’s matching contributions were $74,886 and $59,139, respectively. Additionally, the Company may make a discretionary profit-sharing contribution to the Plan. During the nine months ended September 30, 2020 and 2019, no profit-sharing contributions were made.
 
F-75

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
ORANGE142, LLC
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
SEPTEMBER 30, 2020 AND 2019
(Unaudited)
NOTE 5 — SUBSEQUENT EVENTS
Effective September 30, 2020, Direct Digital Holdings, LLC (“Holdings”) acquired 100% of the equity interests of the Company for a purchase price of $26,207,981. The acquisition was funded by issuance of Holdings’ member common units, mandatorily redeemable preferred units, a facility term note, and a revolving credit facility by Holdings. The acquisition was accounted for using the acquisition method of accounting and, accordingly, the results of operations of the Company were consolidated into Holdings beginning October 1, 2020.
 
F-76

TABLE OF CONTENTS
4,000,000 Shares
Class A Common Stock
[MISSING IMAGE: LG_DIRECTDIGITALBLACK-4CLR.JPG]
Preliminary Prospectus
Joint Book-Running Managers
The Benchmark CompanyRoth Capital Partners
                 , 2022

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
Part II — INFORMATION NOT REQUIRED IN PROSPECTUS
Item 13.    Other Expenses of Issuance and Distribution.
The following table indicates the expenses to be incurred in connection with the offering described in this registration statement, other than underwriting discounts and commissions, all of which will be paid by us. All amounts are estimated except the SEC registration fee, the Nasdaq Capital Market listing fee and the FINRA filing fee.
Amount
SEC registration fee
$ 4,068
Nasdaq listing fee
6,500
FINRA filing fee
11,750
Accountants’ fees and expenses
410,000
Legal fees and expenses
1,200,000
Transfer Agent’s fees and expenses
4,500
Printing expenses
90,000
Underwriters reimbursable expenses
200,000
Miscellaneous
82,500
Total expenses
$ 2,009,318
Item 14.    Indemnification of Directors and Officers.
Section 145(a) of the DGCL provides, in general, that a Delaware corporation may indemnify any person who was or is a party, or is threatened to be made a party, to any threatened, pending or completed action, suit or proceeding, whether civil, criminal, administrative or investigative (other than an action by or in the right of the corporation) because that person is or was a director, officer, employee or agent of the corporation, or is or was serving at the request of the corporation as a director, officer, employee or agent of another corporation or other enterprise. The indemnity may include expenses (including attorneys’ fees), judgments, fines and amounts paid in settlement actually and reasonably incurred by the person in connection with such action, so long as the person acted in good faith and in a manner he or she reasonably believed was in or not opposed to the corporation’s best interests, and, with respect to any criminal action or proceeding, had no reasonable cause to believe his or her conduct was unlawful.
Section 145(b) of the DGCL provides, in general, that a Delaware corporation may indemnify any person who was or is a party, or is threatened to be made a party, to any threatened, pending or completed action or suit by or in the right of the corporation to obtain a judgment in its favor because the person is or was a director, officer, employee or agent of the corporation, or is or was serving at the request of the corporation as a director, officer, employee or agent of another corporation or other enterprise. The indemnity may include expenses (including attorneys’ fees) actually and reasonably incurred by the person in connection with the defense or settlement of such action, so long as the person acted in good faith and in a manner the person reasonably believed was in or not opposed to the corporation’s best interests, except that no indemnification shall be permitted without judicial approval if a court has determined that the person is to be liable to the corporation with respect to such claim. Section 145(c) of the DGCL provides that, if a present or former director or officer has been successful in defense of any action referred to in Sections 145(a) and (b) of the DGCL, the corporation must indemnify such officer or director against the expenses (including attorneys’ fees) he or she actually and reasonably incurred in connection with such action.
Section 145(g) of the DGCL provides, in general, that a corporation may purchase and maintain insurance on behalf of any person who is or was a director, officer, employee or agent of the corporation, or is or was serving at the request of the corporation as a director, officer, employee or agent of another corporation or other enterprise against any liability asserted against and incurred by such person, in any such capacity, or arising out of his or her status as such, whether or not the corporation could indemnify the person against such liability under Section 145 of the DGCL.
 
II-1

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
Our certificate of incorporation, and our bylaws will provide for the indemnification of our directors and officers to the fullest extent permitted under the DGCL.
We also maintain a directors’ and officers’ insurance policy pursuant to which our directors and officers are insured against liability for actions taken in their capacities as directors and officers.
We have entered into an underwriting agreement in connection with this offering, which provides for indemnification by the underwriter of us, our officers and directors, for certain liabilities, including liabilities arising under the Securities Act.
Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act may be permitted to directors, officers and controlling persons of the registrant pursuant to the foregoing provisions or otherwise, the registrant has been advised that in the opinion of the SEC such indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act and is, therefore, unenforceable.
Item 15.    Recent Sales of Unregistered Securities.
Set forth below is information regarding all securities sold by us within the last three years which were not registered under the Securities Act.
HMC Operations, LLC, a former subsidiary of the Company, issued a number of promissory notes in connection with the Company’s acquisition of Huddled Masses. The promissory notes were issued on June 21, 2018 in the aggregate principal amount of approximately $250,000 at an interest rate of 5% with a maturity date of June 21, 2021. The promissory notes were issued to various individuals and entities.
HMC Operations, LLC, a former subsidiary of the Company, issued a promissory note in conjunction with the acquisition of Colossus Media, LLC. The promissory note was issued on June 21, 2018 in the amount of $250,000 at an interest rate of 5% per year with a maturity date of June 21, 2021. The promissory note was issued to Cantu Holdings, LLC as agent and representative for itself, Hoyne LLC, and other membership interest holders of Colossus Media, LLC.
The Company issued 3,500 units of its Class A preferred equity securities, 7,046 units of its Class B preferred equity securities and 5,637 units of common equity securities in connection with the acquisition of Orange142, LLC. The Class A preferred units had a value of $3,500,000 and were issued on September 30, 2020 with an annual dividend rate of 10% and a mandatory redemption on September 30, 2022. The Class B preferred units had a value of $7,046,251 and were issued on September 30, 2020 with an annual dividend rate of 7% with a mandatory redemption on September 30, 2024. The Common Units had a value of $5,636,563 and were issued on September 30, 2020 and have a mandatory call feature to be exercised by the issuer prior to September 30, 2025. The Class A preferred units, the Class B preferred units and the Common Units were all issued to USDM Holdings, Inc.
No underwriters or placement agents were used in connection with any of the foregoing transactions. These issuances were made in reliance on an exemption from registration set forth in Section 4(a)(2) of the Securities Act, as transactions by an issuer not involving a public offering. The purchasers of securities in each such transaction represented their intention to acquire the securities for investment only and not with a view to offer or sell, in connection with any distribution of the securities.
 
II-2

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
Item 16.    Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules.
(a) Exhibits.    The list of exhibits is set forth below and is incorporated by reference herein.
Exhibit No.
Description
 1.1* Form of Underwriting Agreement.
 3.1**
 3.2**
 3.3
 3.4
 4.1
 4.2* Form of Representatives’ Warrant (included in Exhibit 1.1)
 5.1* Opinion of McGuireWoods LLP.
10.1* Form of Amended and Restated Limited Liability Company Agreement of Direct Digital Holdings, LLC.
10.2
10.3+* Direct Digital Holdings, LLC 2022 Omnibus Incentive Plan.
10.4**
10.5** Revolving Credit Note, dated as of September 30, 2020, by and among Direct Digital Holdings, LLC, Colossus Media, LLC, Huddled Masses, LLC, Orange142, LLC, and Universal Standards for Digital Marketing, LLCand East West Bank.
10.6**
10.7 Amendment to Credit Agreement, dated as of December 17, 2021, by and among Direct Digital Holdings, LLC, Colossus Media, LLC, Huddled Masses LLC, Orange142, LLC, Universal Standards for Digital Marketing, LLC and East West Bank.
10.8**
10.9**
10.10+**
10.11+**
10.12+**
10.13+**
10.14+
10.15+* Form of Executive Employment Agreement by and between Direct Digital Holdings, Inc. and
 
II-3

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
Exhibit No.
Description
Susan Echard.
10.16+* Form of Executive Employment Agreement by and between Direct Digital Holdings, Inc. and Anu Pillai.
10.17#
10.18
10.19
21.1
23.1
23.2
23.3
23.4* Consent of McGuireWoods LLP (included in Exhibit 5.1).
24.1
*
To be filed by amendment.
**
Previously filed.
#
Schedules and exhibits have been omitted pursuant to Item 601(b)(10) of Regulation S-K. The Company hereby agrees to furnish supplementary copies of any of the omitted schedules or exhibits upon request by the Commission.
+
Indicates management contract or compensatory plan.
(b) Financial Statement Schedules.    Schedules not listed above have been omitted because the information required to be set forth therein is not applicable or is shown in the financial statements or notes thereto.
Item 17.    Undertakings.
The undersigned registrant hereby undertakes to provide to the underwriters at the closing specified in the underwriting agreement certificates in such denominations and registered in such names as required by the underwriters to permit prompt delivery to each purchaser.
Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act may be permitted to directors, officers and controlling persons of the registrant pursuant to the foregoing provisions, or otherwise, the registrant has been advised that, in the opinion of the SEC, such indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act and is, therefore, unenforceable. In the event that a claim for indemnification against such liabilities (other than the payment by the registrant of expenses incurred or paid by a director, officer or controlling person of the registrant in the successful defense of any action, suit or proceeding) is asserted by such director, officer or controlling person in connection with the securities being registered, the registrant will, unless in the opinion of its counsel the matter has been settled by controlling precedent, submit to a court of appropriate jurisdiction the question whether such indemnification by it is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act and will be governed by the final adjudication of such issue.
 
II-4

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
The registrant hereby further undertakes that:
      (1) For purposes of determining any liability under the Securities Act, the information omitted from the form of prospectus filed as part of this Registration Statement in reliance upon Rule 430A and contained in a form of prospectus filed by the Registrant pursuant to Rule 424(b)(1) or (4) or 497(h) under the Securities Act shall be deemed to be part of this Registration Statement as of the time it was declared effective.
      (2) For purposes of determining any liability under the Securities Act, each post-effective amendment that contains a form of prospectus shall be deemed to be a new registration statement relating to the securities offered therein, and the offering of such securities at that time shall be deemed to be the initial bona fide offering thereof.
 
II-5

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
SIGNATURES
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act, the registrant has duly caused this registration statement to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Houston, State of Texas, on this 18th day of January, 2022.
DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, INC.
By: 
/s/ Mark D. Walker
Mark D. Walker, Chairman and Chief Executive Officer
SIGNATURES AND POWER OF ATTORNEY
KNOW ALL BY THESE PRESENTS, that each person whose signature appears below hereby constitutes and appoints Mark Walker and Keith Smith, and each of them, his or her true and lawful agent, proxy and attorney-in-fact, with full power of substitution and resubstitution, for him or her and in his or her name, place and stead, in any and all capacities, to (i) act on, sign and file with the Securities and Exchange Commission any and all amendments (including post-effective amendments) to this registration statement together with all schedules and exhibits thereto and any subsequent registration statement filed pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, together with all schedules and exhibits thereto, (ii) act on, sign and file such certificates, instruments, agreements and other documents as may be necessary or appropriate in connection therewith, (iii) act on and file any supplement to any prospectus included in this registration statement or any such amendment or any subsequent registration statement filed pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and (iv) take any and all actions which may be necessary or appropriate to be done, as fully for all intents and purposes as he or she might or could do in person, hereby approving, ratifying and confirming all that such agent, proxy and attorney-in-fact or any of his or her substitutes may lawfully do or cause to be done by virtue thereof.
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this registration statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities held on the dates indicated.
Signature
Title
Date
/s/ Mark D. Walker
Mark D. Walker
Chairman, Chief Executive Officer, and Director
(Principal Executive Officer)
January 18, 2022
/s/ Susan Echard
Susan Echard
Chief Financial Officer
(Principal Financial Officer)
January 18, 2022
/s/ Keith Smith
Keith Smith
President and Director
January 18, 2022
/s/ Richard Cohen
Richard Cohen
Director
January 18, 2022
/s/ Antoinette R. Leatherberry
Antoinette R. Leatherberry
Director
January 18, 2022
 
II-6

 

Exhibit 3.3

 

AMENDED AND RESTATED CERTIFICATE OF INCORPORATION

OF

DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGSINC.

 

Direct Digital Holdings, Inc., a Delaware corporation, hereby certifies that:

 

ONE: The name of this corporation is Direct Digital Holdings, Inc. This corporation filed its original Certificate of Incorporation with the Secretary of State of the State of Delaware on August 23, 2021.

 

TWO: The board of directors of the corporation (the “Board”) adopted resolutions proposing to amend and restate the original Certificate of Incorporation, and the sole stockholder of the corporation has duly approved the amendment and restatement by written consent pursuant to and in accordance with Section 228 of the DGCL.

 

THREE: This Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation has been duly adopted in accordance with Sections 228, 242 and 245 of the General Corporation Law of the State of Delaware.

 

FOURTH: The Certificate of Incorporation of this corporation is hereby amended and restated to read as follows:

 

ARTICLE I

 

NAME

 

The name of this corporation is Direct Digital Holdings, Inc. (the “Company”).

 

ARTICLE II

 

REGISTERED AGENT

 

The address of the registered office of the Company in the State of Delaware is 1209 Orange Street – Corporation Trust Center, City of Wilmington, County of New Castle, Delaware 19801, and the name of the registered agent of the Company in the State of Delaware at such address is The Corporation Trust Company.

 

ARTICLE III

 

PURPOSE

 

The purpose of the Company is to engage in any lawful act or activity for which corporations may be organized under the Delaware General Corporation Law (the “DGCL”).

 

 

 

 

ARTICLE IV

 

AUTHORIZED STOCK

 

1.            Number of Shares; Reclassification. The total number of shares of all classes of stock that the Company shall have authority to issue is 190,000,000 shares, consisting of three classes as follows: (a) 160,000,000 shares of Class A common stock, with the par value of $0.001 per share (the “Class A Common Stock”); (b) 20,000,000 shares of Class B common stock, with the par value of $0.001 per share (the “Class B Common Stock” and, together with Class A Common Stock, the “Common Stock”); and (c) 10,000,000 shares of preferred stock, with the par value of $0.001 per share (the “Preferred Stock”). Effective upon the effectiveness of the filing of this Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation with the Secretary of State of the State of Delaware (the “Reclassification Effective Time”), each share of common stock, no par value (the “Old Common Stock”), issued and outstanding immediately prior to the Reclassification Effective Time, shall automatically, without further action on the part of the Company or any holder of such Old Common Stock, be reclassified as and become one (1) validly issued, fully paid and non-assessable share of Class A Common Stock.

 

2.            Increases or Decreases. Subject to the rights of the holders of any one or more series of Preferred Stock then outstanding, the number of authorized shares of any class of the Common Stock or the Preferred Stock may be increased or decreased, in each case by the affirmative vote of the holders of a majority of the total voting power of the outstanding shares of capital stock of the Company entitled to vote thereon, voting together as a single class, irrespective of the provisions of Section 242(b)(2) of the DGCL, and no vote of the holders of any class of the Common Stock or the Preferred Stock voting separately as a class will be required therefor. Notwithstanding the immediately preceding sentence, the number of authorized shares of any particular class may not be decreased below the number of shares of such class then outstanding, plus:

 

2.1          in the case of Class A Common Stock, the number of shares of Class A Common Stock issuable in connection with (x) the redemption or exchange of all outstanding LLC Units (as defined below) corresponding to shares of Class B Common Stock, pursuant to the LLC Agreement and (y) the exercise of outstanding options, warrants, exchange rights, conversion rights or similar rights for Class A Common Stock;

 

2.2            in the case of Class B Common Stock, the number of shares of Class B Common Stock issuable in connection with the exercise of outstanding options, warrants, exchange rights, conversion rights or similar rights for Class B Common Stock.

 

ARTICLE V

 

TERMS OF CLASSES AND SERIES OF STOCK

 

The powers, preferences and rights, and the qualifications, restrictions and limitations thereof, relating to the capital stock of the Company are as follows:

 

1.            Definitions. For purposes of this Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation, the following definitions apply:

 

1.1            “Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation” shall mean this Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of the Company, as may be amended and/or restated from time to time.

 

1.2           “Independent Directors” mean the members of the Board designated as independent directors in accordance with the requirements of any national stock exchange under which the Company’s equity securities are listed for trading that are generally applicable to companies with common equity securities listed thereon.

 

1.3            “IPO” means the initial public offering of the Company’s Class A Common Stock.

 

- 2

 

 

1.4           “LLC Units” means the outstanding Class A Common Units of Direct Digital Holdings, LLC that are issued under the LLC Agreement.

 

1.5            “LLC Agreement” means the Seconded Amended and Restated Limited Liability Company Agreement of Direct Digital Holdings, LLC dated on or about the date of the closing of the IPO, as the same may be amended, amended and restated and otherwise modified from time to time.

 

1.6          “Person” means any individual, partnership, firm, corporation, limited liability company, association, trust, unincorporated organization or other entity.

 

2.            Voting Rights.

 

2.1            Common Stock.

 

(a)            Class A Common Stock. Each holder of shares of Class A Common Stock will be entitled to one (1) vote for each share thereof held at the applicable record date.

 

(b)            Class B Common Stock. Each holder of shares of Class B Common Stock will be entitled to one (1) vote for each share thereof held at the applicable record date.

 

2.2          General. Except as otherwise expressly provided in this Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation (including any Certificate of Designation) or as required by law, the holders of Class A Common Stock and Class B Common Stock will vote together as a single class and not as separate series or classes; provided, however, that any holders of Preferred Stock are entitled to vote together with the holders of Common Stock, as a single class with the holders of Preferred Stock.

 

2.3            Class B Common Stock Protective Provisions. So long as any shares of Class B Common Stock remain outstanding, the Company shall not, without the affirmative approval by vote or written consent of the holders of a majority of the voting power of the Class B Common Stock then outstanding, voting together as a single class, directly or indirectly, or whether by amendment, or through merger, recapitalization, reclassification, consolidation or otherwise, amend, alter, or repeal any provision of this Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation or the bylaws of the Company in a manner that modifies the voting, conversion or other powers, preferences, or other special rights or privileges, or restrictions of, or increase or decrease the number of authorized shares of, the Class B Common Stock.

 

3.            Stock Splits or Combinations. In no event will any stock dividend, stock split, reverse stock split, combination of stock, reclassification or recapitalization be declared or made on any class of Common Stock (each, a “Stock Adjustment”) unless (a) a corresponding Stock Adjustment for all other classes of Common Stock not so adjusted at the time outstanding is made in the same proportion and the same manner and (b) the Stock Adjustment has been reflected in the same economically equivalent manner on all LLC Units. Stock dividends with respect to each class of Common Stock may only be paid with shares of stock of the same class of Common Stock.

 

4.            Liquidation Rights. In the event of any voluntary or involuntary liquidation, dissolution or winding-up of the affairs of the Company, after payment or provision for payment of the debts and other liabilities of the Company and of the preferential and other amounts, if any, to which the holders of Preferred Stock are entitled, the holders of all outstanding shares of Class A Common Stock will be entitled to receive the assets of the Company available for distribution ratably in proportion to the number of shares of Class A Common Stock. Without limiting the rights of the holders of Class B Common Stock to exchange their LLC Units for shares of Class A Common Stock in accordance with the LLC Agreement (or for the consideration payable in respect of shares of Class A Common Stock in such voluntary or involuntary liquidation, dissolution or winding-up), the holders of shares of Class B Common Stock, as such, will not be entitled to receive, with respect to such shares, any assets of the Company in excess of the par value thereof in the event of any voluntary or involuntary liquidation, dissolution or winding up of the affairs of the Company.

 

- 3

 

 

5.            Transfer Restriction; Cancellation of Class B Common Stock.

 

5.1            Issuance of the Class B Common Stock. No shares of Class B Common Stock may be issued by the Company except to a holder of LLC Units in Direct Digital Holdings, LLC (other than the Company, Direct Digital Holdings, LLC or any other subsidiary of the Company that is a holder of LLC Units), such that after such issuance of Class B Common Stock such holder of LLC Units holds an identical number of LLC Units and shares of Class B Common Stock. No shares of Class B Common Stock may be transferred of record by the holder thereof except (i) for no consideration to the Company upon which transfer such shares shall automatically, without further action by the holder thereof, be cancelled, or (ii) together with the transfer of an identical number of LLC Units made to the transferee of such LLC Units made in compliance with the LLC Agreement and the provisions set forth herein.

 

5.2            Cancellation of the Class B Common Stock. Immediately upon the effective time of an exchange of an LLC Unit (together with a share of Class B Common Stock) for Class A Common Stock pursuant to the terms of the LLC Agreement, such share of Class B Common Stock held by such exchanging holder of LLC Units shall automatically, without further action by the Company or the holder thereof, be canceled with no consideration being paid or issued with respect thereto. Any such canceled shares of Class B Common Stock shall be automatically retired and all rights with respect to such shares shall automatically cease and terminate.

 

6.            Preferred Stock. Shares of Preferred Stock may be issued from time to time in one or more series of any number of shares, provided that the aggregate number of shares issued of any and all such series shall not exceed the total number of shares of Preferred Stock hereinabove authorized, and with such powers, including voting powers, if any, and the designations, preferences and relative, participating, optional or other special rights, if any, and any qualifications, limitations or restrictions thereof, all as shall hereafter be stated and expressed in the resolution or resolutions providing for the designation and issue of such shares of Preferred Stock from time to time adopted by the Board pursuant to authority so to do which is hereby expressly vested in the Board. The powers, including voting powers, if any, preferences and relative, participating, optional and other special rights of each series of Preferred Stock, and the qualifications, limitations or restrictions thereof, if any, may differ from those of any and all other series at any time outstanding. Each series of shares of Preferred Stock: (i) may have such voting rights or powers, full or limited, if any; (ii) may be subject to redemption at such time or times and at such prices, if any; (iii) may be entitled to receive dividends (which may be cumulative or noncumulative) at such rate or rates, on such conditions and at such times, and payable in preference to, or in such relation to, the dividends payable on any other class or classes or series of stock, if any; (iv) may have such rights upon the voluntary or involuntary liquidation, winding-up or dissolution of, upon any distribution of the assets of, or in the event of any merger, sale or consolidation of, the Company, if any; (v) may be made convertible into or exchangeable for, shares of any other class or classes or of any other series of the same or any other class or classes of stock of the Company (or any other securities of the Company or any other Person) at such price or prices or at such rates of exchange and with such adjustments, if any; (vi) may be entitled to the benefit of a sinking fund to be applied to the purchase or redemption of shares of such series in such amount or amounts, if any; (vii) may be entitled to the benefit of conditions and restrictions upon the creation of indebtedness of the Company or any subsidiary, upon the issue of any additional shares (including additional shares of such series or of any other series) and upon the payment of dividends or the making of other distributions on, and the purchase, redemption or other acquisition by the Company or any subsidiary of, any outstanding shares of the Company, if any; (viii) may be subject to restrictions on transfer or registration of transfer, or on the amount of shares that may be owned by any Person or group of Persons; and (ix) may have such other relative, participating, optional or other special rights, qualifications, limitations or restrictions thereof, if any; all as shall be stated in said resolution or resolutions of the Board providing for the designation and issue of such shares of Preferred Stock.

 

- 4

 

 

7.          Reservation of Stock Issuable Upon Conversion. The Company will at all times reserve and keep available out of its authorized but unissued shares of Class A Common Stock, such number of shares of Class A Common Stock that shall from time to time be sufficient to effect the exchange of all outstanding LLC Units (along with Class B Common Stock and excluding those LLC Units held by Direct Digital Holdings, LLC) into shares of Class A Common Stock.

 

8.            Miscellaneous.

 

8.1            No Reissuance of Class B Common Stock. No share or shares of Class B Common Stock acquired by the Company by reason of redemption, purchase, conversion, retirement or otherwise shall be reissued, and all such shares shall be cancelled, retired and eliminated from the shares that the Company shall be authorized to issue.

 

8.2            Additional Issuances of Class B Common Stock. Except as set forth in Sections 5.1 and 9.3, the Company shall not at any time after the effectiveness of this Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation under the DGCL issue any additional shares of Class B Common Stock, unless such issuance is approved by the affirmative vote of the holders of a majority of the outstanding shares of Class B Common Stock.

 

8.3            Preemptive Rights. No stockholder of the Company shall have a right to purchase shares of capital stock of the Company sold or issued by the Company except to the extent that such a right may from time to time be set forth in a written agreement between the Company and a stockholder; provided, however, that to the extent LLC Units are issued pursuant to the LLC Agreement to anyone other than the Company or a wholly owned subsidiary of the Company, an equivalent number of shares of Class B Common Stock (subject to adjustment as set forth herein) shall concurrently be issued to the same Person to whom such LLC Units are issued.

 

ARTICLE VI

 

DIRECTOR LIABILITY

 

1.            Limitation of Liability. The liability of the directors of the Company for monetary damages shall be eliminated to the fullest extent under applicable law. If applicable law is amended after approval by the stockholders of this Article VI to authorize corporate action further eliminating or limiting the personal liability of directors, then the liability of a director to the Company shall be eliminated or limited to the fullest extent permitted by applicable law as so amended.

 

2.           Indemnification and Advancement. To the fullest extent permitted by applicable law, the Company is authorized to provide indemnification of (and advancement of expenses to) directors, officers, employees and agents of the Company (and any other persons to which applicable law permits the Company to provide indemnification) through (a) the Company’s Bylaws, (b) agreements with such directors, officers, agents or other persons or (c) the vote of stockholders or disinterested directors.

 

3.            Amendment to Article VI. Any amendment, elimination, impairment, repeal or modification of this Article VI shall only be prospective and shall not affect the rights or protections or increase the liability of any director under this Article VI in effect at the time of the alleged occurrence of any act or omission to act giving rise to liability or indemnification.

 

- 5

 

 

ARTICLE VII

 

BUSINESS COMBINATIONS WITH INTERESTED STOCKHOLDERS

 

The Company hereby elects not to be subject to or governed by Section 203 of the DGCL.

 

ARTICLE VIII

 

CORPORATE OPPORTUNITY RENOUNCEMENT

 

To the extent permitted by law, the Company renounces any interest or expectancy of the Company in, or in being offered an opportunity to participate in, any Specified Opportunity presented to a Covered Person and waives any claim that the Specified Opportunity constitutes a corporate opportunity that should have been presented by the Covered Person to the Company; provided, however, that the Covered Person acts in good faith. A “Covered Person” is any officer, member of the Board or stockholder (or affiliate thereof) who is not an employee of the Company or any of its subsidiaries. A “Specified Opportunity” is any transaction or other business opportunity that is not presented to the Covered Person solely in his or her capacity as an officer, member of the Board or stockholder of the Company (or affiliate thereof).

 

ARTICLE IX

 

MISCELLANEOUS

 

For the management of the business and for the conduct of the affairs of the Company, and in further definition, limitation and regulation of the powers of the Company, of its directors and of its stockholders or any class or series thereof, as the case may be, it is further provided that:

 

1.            Management in Board. The management of the business and the conduct of the affairs of the Company shall be vested in its Board. The number of directors that shall constitute the Board shall be fixed from time to time by resolution of the Board, subject to any restrictions which may be set forth in this Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation.

 

2.              Bylaws. The Board is expressly empowered to adopt, amend or repeal the bylaws of the Company, subject to any restrictions that may be set forth in this Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation. The stockholders shall also have the power to adopt, amend or repeal the bylaws of the Company, subject to any restrictions that may be set forth in this Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation.

 

3.            Special Meetings of Stockholders. Special meetings of the stockholders may be called only by (i) the Board; (iii) the chairperson of the Board; or (iv) the chief executive officer of the Company.

 

4.           Written Consent Prohibition. Except as otherwise provided for or fixed pursuant to the provisions of Article V of this Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation relating to the rights of holders of any series of Preferred Stock, no action that is required or permitted to be taken by the stockholders of the Company at any annual or special meeting of stockholders may be effected by written consent of stockholders in lieu of a meeting of stockholders, unless the action to be effected by written consent of stockholders and the taking of such action by such written consent have expressly been approved in advance by the Board.

 

- 6

 

 

5.            Director Nominations. Advance notice of nominations for the election of directors and of any other business to be brought by stockholders before any meeting of the stockholders of the Company will be given in the manner and to the extent provided in the bylaws of the Company.

 

6.            Election.

 

6.1            Written Ballot. The directors of the Company need not be elected by written ballot unless the bylaws so provide.

 

6.2            Cumulative Voting. No stockholder entitled to vote at an election for directors may cumulate votes to which such stockholder is entitled unless required by applicable law at the time of such election.

 

6.3            Director Removal. Subject to any limitation imposed by applicable law, any individual director or directors may be removed only with cause, in each case, by the affirmative vote of the holders of at least two-thirds (2/3) of the voting power of all then-outstanding shares of capital stock of the Company entitled to vote generally at an election of directors.

 

6.4           Vacancies. Subject to any limitations imposed by applicable law, any vacancies on the Board resulting from death, resignation, disqualification, removal or other causes and any newly created directorships resulting from any increase in the number of directors, shall be filled by the affirmative vote of a majority of the directors then in office, even though less than a quorum of the Board, or by a sole remaining director. Any director elected in accordance with the preceding sentence shall hold office for the remainder of the full term of the director for which the newly created directorship or vacancy was created or occurred and until such director’s successor shall have been elected and qualified.

 

6.5            Adoption, Amendment and/or Repeal of By-Laws. In furtherance and not in limitation of the powers conferred by the laws of the State of Delaware, the Board is expressly authorized to make, alter and repeal the By-laws, subject to the power of the stockholders of the Company to alter or repeal any By-laws whether adopted by them or otherwise. Notwithstanding any other provisions of this Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation or the By-laws (and notwithstanding the fact that a lesser percentage may be permitted by applicable law, this Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation or the By-laws), but in addition to any affirmative vote of the holders of any particular class of stock of the Company required by applicable law or this Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation, the affirmative vote of the holders of at least 66 2/3% of the voting power of the shares of the then-outstanding voting stock of the Company, voting together as a single class, shall be required to adopt new By-laws or to alter, amend or repeal the By-laws.

 

6.6            Certificate Amendments. The Company reserves the right at any time, and from time to time, to amend, alter, change or repeal any provision contained in this Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation. In addition, other provisions authorized by the laws of the State of Delaware at the time in force may be added or inserted, in the manner now or hereafter prescribed by applicable law. All rights, preferences and privileges of whatsoever nature conferred upon stockholders, members of the board of directors or any other persons whomsoever by and pursuant to this Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation in its present form or as hereafter amended are granted and held subject to the rights the Company has reserved in this Section 6.6 of Article IX. Notwithstanding any other provisions of this Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation or the By-laws (and notwithstanding the fact that a lesser percentage may be permitted by applicable law, this Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation or the By-laws), but in addition to any affirmative vote of the holders of any particular class of stock of the Corporation required by applicable law or this Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation, the affirmative vote of the holders of at least 66 2/3% of the voting power of the shares of the then outstanding voting stock of the Corporation, voting together as a single class, shall be required to amend or repeal, or adopt any provisions inconsistent with Article VI, Article VIII and Sections 3, 6.5 and 6.6 of Article IX of this Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation.

 

- 7

 

 

6.7            Exclusive Forum. Unless the Company consents in writing to the selection of an alternative forum, the Court of Chancery of the State of Delaware (or, if and only if the Court of Chancery of the State of Delaware lacks subject matter jurisdiction, any state court located within the State of Delaware or, if and only if all such state courts lack subject matter jurisdiction, the federal district court for the District of Delaware) and any appellate court therefrom shall be the sole and exclusive forum for the following claims or causes of action under the Delaware statutory or common law: (A) any derivative claim or cause of action brought on behalf of the Company; (B) any claim or cause of action for breach of a fiduciary duty owed by any current or former director, officer, other employee or stockholder of the Company, to the Company or the Company’s stockholders; (C) any claim or cause of action arising out of or pursuant to any provision of the DGCL, this Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation or the bylaws of the Company (as each may be amended from time to time); (D) any claim or cause of action seeking to interpret, apply, enforce or determine the validity of this Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation or the bylaws of the Company (as each may be amended from time to time, including any right, obligation, or remedy thereunder); (E) any claim or cause of action as to which the DGCL confers jurisdiction on the Court of Chancery of the State of Delaware; and (F) any claim or cause of action governed by the internal-affairs doctrine, in all cases to the fullest extent permitted by law and subject to the court having personal jurisdiction over the indispensable parties named as defendants. This first paragraph of Section 5.5 of Article IX shall not apply to claims or causes of action brought to enforce a duty or liability created by the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, or the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, or any other claim for which the federal courts have exclusive jurisdiction.

 

Unless the Company consents in writing to the selection of an alternative forum, to the fullest extent permitted by law, the federal district courts of the United States of America shall be the exclusive forum for the resolution of any complaint asserting a cause of action arising under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, including all causes of action asserted against any defendant named in such complaint. For the avoidance of doubt, this provision is intended to benefit and may be enforced by the Company, its officers and directors, the underwriters to any offering giving rise to such complaint, and any other professional entity whose profession gives authority to a statement made by that person or entity and who has prepared or certified any part of the documents underlying the offering.

 

Any person or entity holding, owning or otherwise acquiring any interest in any security of the Company shall be deemed to have notice of and consented to the provisions of this Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation.

 

[Signature Page Follows]

 

- 8

 

 

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, Direct Digital Holdings, Inc. has caused this Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation to be signed by its Chief Executive Officer this [ ] day of January, 2022.

 

  DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, INC.
     
  By:  
    Mark Walker
    Chief Executive Officer

 

 

 

Exhibit 3.4

 

AMENDED AND RESTATED BYLAWS

 

OF

 

DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGSINC.

(A DELAWARE CORPORATION)

 

As adopted by the Board of Directors as of January [_], 2022

 

 

 

Table of Contents

 

Page

 

ARTICLE I OFFICES 3
     
Section 1. Registered Office 3
     
Section 2. Other Offices 3
     
ARTICLE II CORPORATE SEAL 3
     
Section 3. Corporate Seal 3
     
ARTICLE III STOCKHOLDERS’ MEETINGS 3
     
Section 4. Place of Meetings 3
     
Section 5. Annual Meeting. 3
     
Section 6. Special Meetings. 7
     
Section 7. Notice of Meetings 8
     
Section 8. Quorum 8
     
Section 9. Adjournment and Notice of Adjourned Meetings 9
     
Section 10. Voting Rights 9
     
Section 11. Joint Owners of Stock 9
     
Section 12. List of Stockholders 9
     
Section 13. Action Without Meeting 9
     
Section 14. Organization. 10
     
ARTICLE IV DIRECTORS 10
     
Section 15. Number and Term of Office 10
     
Section 16. Powers 10
     
Section 17. Term of Directors 10
     
Section 18. Vacancies 11
     
Section 19. Resignation 11
     
Section 20. Removal 11
     
Section 21. Meetings. 11
     
Section 22. Quorum and Voting. 12
     
Section 23. Action Without Meeting 12
     
Section 24. Fees and Compensation 12
     
Section 25. Committees. 13
     
Section 26. Duties of Chairperson of the Board of Directors and Lead Independent Director. 13
     
Section 27. Organization 14
     
ARTICLE V OFFICERS 14

 

-i-

 

 

TABLE OF CONTENTS

(continued)

 

Page

 

     
Section 28. Officers Designated 14
     
Section 29. Tenure and Duties of Officers. 14
     
Section 30. Delegation of Authority 16
     
Section 31. Resignations 16
     
Section 32. Removal 16
     
ARTICLE VI EXECUTION OF CORPORATE INSTRUMENTS AND VOTING OF SECURITIES OWNED BY THE CORPORATION 16
     
Section 33. Execution of Corporate Instruments 16
     
Section 34. Voting of Securities Owned by the Corporation 16
     
ARTICLE VII SHARES OF STOCK 17
     
Section 35. Form and Execution of Certificates 17
     
Section 36. Lost Certificates 17
     
Section 37. Transfers. 17
     
Section 38. Fixing Record Dates. 17
     
Section 39. Registered Stockholders 18
     
ARTICLE VIII OTHER SECURITIES OF THE CORPORATION  
     
Section 40. Execution of Other Securities 18
   
ARTICLE IX DIVIDENDS 18
     
Section 41. Declaration of Dividends 18
     
Section 42. Dividend Reserve 19
     
ARTICLE X FISCAL YEAR 19
     
Section 43. Fiscal Year 19
     
ARTICLE XI INDEMNIFICATION 19
     
Section 44. Indemnification of Directors, Executive Officers, Other Officers, Employees and Other Agents. 19
     
ARTICLE XII NOTICES 22
     
Section 45. Notices. 22
     
ARTICLE XIII AMENDMENTS 23
     
Section 46. Amendments 23

 

-ii-

 

 

AMENDED AND RESTATED BYLAWS

 

OF

 

DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGSINC.

(A DELAWARE CORPORATION)

 

ARTICLE I

 

OFFICES

 

Section 1.           Registered Office. The registered office of the corporation in the State of Delaware is 1209 Orange Street – Corporation Trust Ce nter, City of Wilmington, County of New Castle, 19801 or in such other location as the Board of Directors of the corporation (the “Board of Directors”) may from time to time determine or the business of the corporation may require.

 

Section 2.           Other Offices. The corporation shall also have and maintain an office or principal place of business at such place as may be fixed by the Board of Directors, and may also have offices at such other places, both within and without the State of Delaware as the Board of Directors may from time to time determine or the business of the corporation may require.

 

ARTICLE II

 

CORPORATE SEAL

 

Section 3.           Corporate Seal. The Board of Directors may adopt a corporate seal. If adopted, the corporate seal shall consist of a die bearing the name of the corporation and the inscription, “Corporate Seal-Delaware.” Said seal may be used by causing it or a facsimile thereof to be impressed or affixed or reproduced or otherwise.

 

ARTICLE III

 

STOCKHOLDERS’ MEETINGS

 

Section 4.           Place of Meetings. Meetings of the stockholders of the corporation may be held at such place, either within or without the State of Delaware, as may be determined from time to time by the Board of Directors. The Board of Directors may, in its sole discretion, determine that the meeting shall not be held at any place, but may instead be held solely by means of remote communication as provided under the Delaware General Corporation Law (“DGCL”).

 

Section 5.           Annual Meeting.

 

(a)         The annual meeting of the stockholders of the corporation, for the purpose of election of directors and for such other business as may properly come before it, shall be held on such date and at such time as may be designated from time to time by the Board of Directors. Nominations of persons for election to the Board of Directors of the corporation and proposals of business to be considered by the stockholders may be made at an annual meeting of stockholders: (i) with respect to business other than nominations, pursuant to the corporation’s notice of meeting of stockholders (or any supplement thereto); (ii) if brought specifically by or at the direction of the Board of Directors or any duly authorized committee thereof; or (iii) by any stockholder of the corporation who was a stockholder of record at the time of giving the stockholder’s notice provided for in Section 5(b) below, who is entitled to vote at the meeting and who complied with the notice procedures set forth in this Section 5. For the avoidance of doubt, clause (iii) above shall be the exclusive means for a stockholder to make nominations and submit other business (other than matters properly included in the corporation’s notice of meeting of stockholders and proxy statement under Rule 14a-8 under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, and the rules and regulations thereunder (the “Exchange Act”) before an annual meeting of stockholders.

 

- 3 -

 

 

(b)         At an annual meeting of the stockholders, only such business shall be conducted as is a proper matter for stockholder action under Delaware law and, with respect to nominations and business to be brought before an annual meeting by a stockholder pursuant to Section 5(a)(iii), as shall have been properly brought before the meeting in accordance with the procedures below.

 

(i)            For nominations for the election to the Board of Directors to be properly brought before an annual meeting by a stockholder pursuant to Section 5(a)(iii), the stockholder must deliver personally or send by certified or registered mail, return receipt requested, written notice to the Secretary at the principal executive offices of the corporation on a timely basis as set forth in Section 5(b)(iii) and must update and supplement such written notice on a timely basis as set forth in Section 5(c). The number of nominees a stockholder may nominate for election at the annual meeting (or in the case of a stockholder giving the notice on behalf of a beneficial owner, the number of nominees a stockholder may nominate for election at the annual meeting on behalf of such beneficial owner) shall not exceed the number of directors to be elected at such annual meeting. Such stockholder’s notice shall set forth: (A) as to each nominee such stockholder proposes to nominate at the meeting: (1) the name, age, business address and residence address of such nominee, (2) the principal occupation or employment of such nominee, (3) the class and number of shares of each class of capital stock of the corporation which are owned of record and beneficially by such nominee, (4) the date or dates on which such shares were acquired and the investment intent of such acquisition, (5) such other information concerning such nominee as would be required to be disclosed in a proxy statement soliciting proxies for the election of such nominee as a director in an election contest (even if an election contest is not involved), or that is otherwise required to be disclosed pursuant to Section 14 of the Exchange Act (including such person’s written consent to being named as a nominee and to serving as a director if elected) and (6) such person’s written consent to being named in the corporation’s proxy statement and proxy card as a nominee of the stockholder making the nomination; and (B) the information required by Section 5(b)(iv). The corporation may require any proposed nominee to furnish such other information as it may reasonably require to determine the eligibility of such proposed nominee to serve as an independent director of the corporation or that could be material to a reasonable stockholder’s understanding of the independence, or lack thereof, of such proposed nominee.

 

(ii)            Other than proposals sought to be included in the corporation’s proxy materials pursuant to Rule 14a-8 under the Exchange Act, for business other than nominations for the election to the Board of Directors to be properly brought before an annual meeting by a stockholder pursuant to Section 5(a)(iii), the stockholder must deliver personally or send by certified or registered mail, return receipt requested, written notice to the Secretary at the principal executive offices of the corporation on a timely basis as set forth in Section 5(b)(iii), and must update and supplement such written notice on a timely basis as set forth in Section 5(c). Such stockholder’s notice shall set forth: (A) as to each matter such stockholder proposes to bring before the meeting, the text of the proposal or business (including the text of any resolutions proposed for consideration and, in the event that such business includes a proposal to amend the bylaws of the corporation, the language of the proposed amendment), the reasons for conducting such business at the meeting, and any material interest (including any anticipated benefit of such business to any Proponent (as defined below) other than solely as a result of its ownership of the corporation’s capital stock, that is material to any Proponent individually, or to the Proponents in the aggregate) in such business of any Proponent; and (B) the information required by Section 5(b)(iv).

 

- 4 -

 

 

(iii)            To be timely, the written notice required by Section 5(b)(i) or (ii) must be received by the Secretary at the principal executive offices of the corporation not later than the close of business on the ninetieth (90th) day nor earlier than the close of business on the one hundred twentieth (120th) day prior to the first anniversary of the preceding year’s annual meeting; provided, however, that, subject to the last sentence of this Section 5(b)(iii), in the event that the date of the annual meeting is advanced more than thirty (30) days prior to or delayed by more than thirty (30) days after the anniversary of the preceding year’s annual meeting, notice by the stockholder to be timely must be so received not earlier than the close of business on the one hundred twentieth (120th) day prior to such annual meeting and not later than the close of business on the later of the ninetieth (90th) day prior to such annual meeting or the tenth (10th) day following the day on which public announcement of the date of such meeting is first made. In no event shall an adjournment or a postponement of an annual meeting for which notice has been given, or the public announcement thereof has been made, commence a new time period for the giving of a stockholder’s notice as described above.

 

(iv)            The written notice required by Section 5(b)(i) or (ii) shall also set forth, as of the date of the notice and as to the stockholder giving the notice and the beneficial owner, if any, on whose behalf the nomination or proposal is made (each, a “Proponent” and collectively, the “Proponents”): (A) the name and address of each Proponent, as they appear on the corporation’s books; (B) the class, series and number of shares of the corporation that are owned beneficially and of record by each Proponent; (C) a description of any agreement, arrangement or understanding (whether oral or in writing) with respect to such nomination or proposal between or among any Proponent and any of its affiliates or associates, and any others (including their names) acting in concert, or otherwise under the agreement, arrangement or understanding, with any of the foregoing; (D) a representation that the Proponents are holders of record or beneficial owners, as the case may be, of shares of the corporation entitled to vote at the meeting and intend to appear in person or by proxy at the meeting to nominate the person or persons specified in the notice (with respect to a notice under Section 5(b)(i)) or to propose the business that is specified in the notice (with respect to a notice under Section 5(b)(ii)), it being understood that if the Proponent is an entity, appearance in person at the meeting, shall require the presence of a duly authorized officer, manager or partner of such Proponent; (E) a representation as to whether the Proponents intend to deliver a proxy statement and form of proxy to holders of a sufficient number of holders of the corporation’s voting shares to elect such nominee or nominees (with respect to a notice under Section 5(b)(i)) or to carry such proposal (with respect to a notice under Section 5(b)(ii)) and/or otherwise solicit proxies or votes from stockholders in support of such nominee or nominees or proposal; (F) to the extent known by any Proponent, the name and address of any other stockholder supporting the proposal on the date of such stockholder’s notice; and (G) a description of all Derivative Transactions (as defined below) by each Proponent during the previous twelve (12) month period, including the date of the transactions and the class, series and number of securities involved in, and the material economic terms of, such Derivative Transactions.

 

(c)          A stockholder providing written notice required by Section 5(b)(i) or (ii) shall update and supplement such notice in writing, if necessary, so that the information provided or required to be provided in such notice is true and correct in all material respects as of (i) the record date for the meeting and (ii) the date that is five (5) business days prior to the meeting and, in the event of any adjournment or postponement thereof, five (5) business days prior to such adjourned or postponed meeting. In the case of an update and supplement pursuant to clause (i) of this Section 5(c), such update and supplement shall be received by the Secretary at the principal executive offices of the corporation not later than five (5) business days after the record date for the meeting. In the case of an update and supplement pursuant to clause (ii) of this Section 5(c), such update and supplement shall be received by the Secretary at the principal executive offices of the corporation not later than two (2) business days prior to the date for the meeting, and, in the event of any adjournment or postponement thereof, two (2) business days prior to such adjourned or postponed meeting.

 

- 5 -

 

 

(d)         Notwithstanding anything in Section 5(b)(iii) to the contrary, in the event that the number of directors whose term is expiring at the next annual meeting is increased and there is no public announcement of the appointment of a director to fill such new seat, or, if no appointment was made, of the vacancy in such class, made by the corporation at least ten (10) days before the last day a stockholder may deliver a notice of nomination in accordance with Section 5(b)(iii), a stockholder’s notice required by this Section 5 and which complies with the requirements in Section 5(b)(i), other than the timing requirements in Section 5(b)(iii), shall also be considered timely, but only with respect to nominees for any new positions on the Board created by such increase, if it shall be received by the Secretary at the principal executive offices of the corporation not later than the close of business on the tenth (10th) day following the day on which such public announcement is first made by the corporation.

 

(e)         A person shall not be eligible for election or re-election as a director unless the person is nominated either in accordance with Section 5(a)(ii), or in accordance with Section 5(a)(iii). Except as otherwise required by law, the chairperson of the meeting shall have the power and duty to determine whether a nomination or any business proposed to be brought before the meeting was made, or proposed, as the case may be, in accordance with the procedures set forth in these Bylaws and, if any proposed nomination or business is not in compliance with these Bylaws, or the Proponent does not act in accordance with the representations in Section 5(b)(iv)(D) (it being understood, for the avoidance of doubt, that the Proponent’s absence at the meeting in person or by proxy shall be deemed to be an act not in accordance with Section 5(b)(iv)(D)) and (E), to declare that such proposal or nomination shall not be presented for stockholder action at the meeting and shall be disregarded, notwithstanding that proxies in respect of such nominations or such business may have been solicited or received.

 

(f)         Notwithstanding the foregoing provisions of this Section 5, in order to include information with respect to a stockholder proposal in the proxy statement and form of proxy for a stockholders’ meeting, a stockholder must also comply with all applicable requirements of the Exchange Act. Nothing in these Bylaws shall be deemed to affect any rights of stockholders to request inclusion of proposals in the corporation’s proxy statement pursuant to Rule 14a-8 under the Exchange Act; provided, however, that any references in these Bylaws to the Exchange Act are not intended to and shall not limit the requirements applicable to proposals and/or nominations to be considered pursuant to Section 5(a)(iii).

 

(g)         For purposes of Sections 5 and 6,

 

(i)            “affiliates” and “associates” shall have the meanings set forth in Rule 405 under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and the rules and regulations thereunder (the “1933 Act”).

 

(ii)            a “Derivative Transaction” means any agreement, arrangement, interest or understanding entered into by, or on behalf or for the benefit of, any Proponent or any of its affiliates or associates, whether record or beneficial:

 

(w)            the value of which is derived in whole or in part from the value of any class of shares or other securities of the corporation,

 

(x)            which otherwise provides any direct or indirect opportunity to gain or share in any gain derived from a change in the value of securities of the corporation,

 

(y)            the effect or intent of which is to mitigate loss, manage risk or benefit of security value or price changes, or

 

- 6 -

 

 

(z)            which provides the right to vote or increase or decrease the voting power of, such Proponent, or any of its affiliates or associates, with respect to any securities of the corporation,

 

which agreement, arrangement, interest or understanding may include, without limitation, any option, warrant, debt position, note, bond, convertible security, swap, stock appreciation right, short position, profit interest, hedge, right to dividends, voting agreement, performance-related fee or arrangement to borrow or lend shares (whether or not subject to payment, settlement, exercise or conversion in any such class), and any proportionate interest of such Proponent in the securities of the corporation held by any general or limited partnership, or any limited liability company, of which such Proponent is, directly or indirectly, a general partner or managing member; and

 

(iii)            “public announcement” shall mean disclosure in a press release reported by the Dow Jones News Service, Associated Press or comparable national news service or in a document publicly filed by the corporation with the Securities and Exchange Commission pursuant to Section 13, 14 or 15(d) of the Exchange Act.

 

Section 6.           Special Meetings.

 

(a)         Special meetings of the stockholders may be called, for any purpose as is a proper matter for stockholder action under Delaware law only by (i) the Board; (iii) the chairperson of the Board; or (iv) the chief executive officer of the Company.

 

(b)         For a special meeting called pursuant to Section 6(a), the Board of Directors shall determine the time and place, if any, of such special meeting. Upon determination of the time and place, if any, of the meeting, the Secretary shall cause a notice of meeting to be given to the stockholders entitled to vote, in accordance with the provisions of Section 7.

 

(c)         Nominations of persons for election to the Board of Directors may be made at a special meeting of stockholders at which directors are to be elected pursuant to the corporation’s notice of meeting (i) by or at the direction of the Board of Directors or (ii) provided that the Board of Directors shall have determined that directors shall be elected at such meeting, by any stockholder of the corporation who is a stockholder of record at the time of giving notice provided for in this paragraph, who shall be entitled to vote at the meeting and who delivers personally or sends by certified or registered mail, return receipt requested, written notice to the Secretary of the corporation setting forth the information required by Section 5(b)(i). In the event the corporation calls a special meeting of stockholders for the purpose of electing one or more directors to the Board of Directors, any such stockholder of record may nominate a person or persons (as the case may be, provided that the number of nominees a stockholder may nominate (or in the case of a stockholder giving the notice on behalf of a beneficial owner, the number of nominees a stockholder may nominate on behalf of such beneficial owner) shall not exceed the number of directors to be elected at such special meeting), for election to such position(s) as specified in the corporation’s notice of meeting, if written notice setting forth the information required by Section 5(b)(i) shall be received by the Secretary at the principal executive offices of the corporation not later than the close of business on the later of the ninetieth (90th) day prior to such meeting or the tenth (10th) day following the day on which public announcement is first made of the date of the special meeting and of the nominees proposed by the Board of Directors to be elected at such meeting. The stockholder shall also update and supplement such information as required under Section 5(c). In no event shall an adjournment or a postponement of a special meeting for which notice has been given, or the public announcement thereof has been made, commence a new time period for the giving of a stockholder’s notice as described above.

 

- 7 -

 

 

(d)         Notwithstanding the foregoing provisions of this Section 6, a stockholder must also comply with all applicable requirements of the Exchange Act with respect to matters set forth in this Section 6. Nothing in these Bylaws shall be deemed to affect any rights of stockholders to request inclusion of proposals in the corporation’s proxy statement pursuant to Rule 14a-8 under the Exchange Act; provided, however, that any references in these Bylaws to the Exchange Act are not intended to and shall not limit the requirements applicable to nominations for the election to the Board of Directors or proposals of other business to be considered pursuant to Section 6(a)(ii) or (c).

 

Section 7.           Notice of Meetings. Except as otherwise provided by law, notice, given in writing or by electronic transmission, of each meeting of stockholders shall be given not less than ten (10) nor more than sixty (60) days before the date of the meeting to each stockholder entitled to notice of such meeting, such notice to specify the place, if any, date and hour, in the case of special meetings, the purpose or purposes of the meeting, and the means of remote communications, if any, by which stockholders and proxy holders may be deemed to be present in person and vote at any such meeting. If mailed, notice is given when deposited in the United States mail, postage prepaid, directed to the stockholder at such stockholder’s address as it appears on the records of the corporation. Notice of the time, place, if any, and purpose of any meeting of stockholders (to the extent required) may be waived in writing, signed by the person entitled to notice thereof, or by electronic transmission by such person, either before or after such meeting, and will be waived by any stockholder by his or her attendance thereat in person, by remote communication, if applicable, or by proxy, except when the stockholder attends a meeting for the express purpose of objecting, at the beginning of the meeting, to the transaction of any business because the meeting is not lawfully called or convened. Any stockholder so waiving notice of such meeting shall be bound by the proceedings of any such meeting in all respects as if due notice thereof had been given.

 

Section 8.           Quorum. At all meetings of stockholders, except where otherwise provided by statute or by the Certificate of Incorporation, or by these Bylaws, the presence, in person, by remote communication, if applicable, or by proxy duly authorized, of the holders of a majority of the voting power of the outstanding shares of stock entitled to vote at such meeting shall constitute a quorum for the transaction of business. Any meeting of stockholders may be adjourned, from time to time, by the chairperson of the meeting (whether or not a quorum is then present). In the absence of a quorum, any meeting of stockholders may, if directed to be voted on by the chairperson of the meeting, be adjourned by vote of the holders of a majority of the voting power of the shares represented thereat and entitled to vote thereon, but no other business shall be transacted at such meeting. The stockholders present at a duly called or convened meeting, at which a quorum is present, may continue to transact business until adjournment, notwithstanding the withdrawal of enough stockholders to leave less than a quorum. Except as otherwise provided by statute or by applicable stock exchange rules, or by the Certificate of Incorporation or these Bylaws, in all matters, other than the election of directors, the affirmative vote of the holders of a majority of the voting power of the shares present in person, by remote communication, if applicable, or represented by proxy duly authorized at the meeting and entitled to vote on the subject matter shall be the act of the stockholders. Except as otherwise provided by statute, the Certificate of Incorporation or these Bylaws, directors shall be elected by a plurality of the votes of the shares present in person, by remote communication, if applicable, or represented by proxy duly authorized at the meeting and entitled to vote generally on the election of directors. Where a separate vote by a class or classes is required, except where otherwise provided by statute or by the Certificate of Incorporation or these Bylaws or by applicable stock exchange rules, a majority of the voting power of the outstanding shares of such class or classes, present in person, by remote communication, if applicable, or represented by proxy duly authorized, shall constitute a quorum entitled to take action with respect to that vote on that matter and the affirmative vote of the holders of a majority (plurality, in the case of the election of directors) of the voting power of the shares of such class or classes present in person, by remote communication, if applicable, or represented by proxy at the meeting and entitled to vote thereon shall be the act of such class or classes.

 

- 8 -

 

 

Section 9.           Adjournment and Notice of Adjourned Meetings. Any meeting of stockholders, whether annual or special, may be adjourned from time to time either by the chairperson of the meeting or, if directed to be voted on by the chairperson of the meeting, by the vote of the holders of a majority of the voting power of the shares present in person, by remote communication, if applicable, or represented by proxy and entitled to vote thereon duly authorized at the meeting. When a meeting is adjourned to another time or place, if any, notice need not be given of the adjourned meeting if the time and place, if any, thereof, and the means of remote communication (if any) by which stockholders and proxyholders may be deemed present in person and vote at such adjourned meeting, are announced at the meeting at which the adjournment is taken. At the adjourned meeting, the corporation may transact any business that might have been transacted at the original meeting. If the adjournment is for more than thirty (30) days, a notice of the adjourned meeting shall be given to each stockholder of record entitled to vote at the meeting. If after the adjournment a new record date for determination of stockholders entitled to vote is fixed for the adjourned meeting, the Board of Directors shall fix as the record date for determining stockholders entitled to notice of such adjourned meeting the same or an earlier date as that fixed for the determination of stockholders entitled to vote at the adjourned meeting, and shall give notice of the adjourned meeting to each stockholder of record as of the record date so fixed for notice of such adjourned meeting.

 

Section 10.           Voting Rights. For the purpose of determining those stockholders entitled to vote at any meeting of the stockholders, except as otherwise provided by law, only persons in whose names shares stand on the stock records of the corporation on the record date, as provided in Section 12, shall be entitled to vote or execute consents at any meeting of stockholders. Every person entitled to vote shall have the right to do so either in person, by remote communication, if applicable, or by an agent or agents authorized by a proxy granted in accordance with Delaware law. An agent so appointed need not be a stockholder. No proxy shall be voted after three (3) years from its date unless the proxy provides for a longer period.

 

Section 11.           Joint Owners of Stock. If shares having voting power stand of record in the names of two (2) or more persons, whether fiduciaries, members of a partnership, joint tenants, tenants in common, tenants by the entirety, or otherwise, or if two (2) or more persons have the same fiduciary relationship respecting the same shares, unless the Secretary is given written notice to the contrary and is furnished with a copy of the instrument or order appointing them or creating the relationship wherein it is so provided, their acts with respect to voting shall have the following effect: (a) if only one (1) votes, his or her act binds all; (b) if more than one (1) votes, the act of the majority so voting binds all; (c) if more than one (1) votes, but the vote is evenly split on any particular matter, each faction may vote the securities in question proportionally, or may apply to the Delaware Court of Chancery for relief as provided in the DGCL, Section 217(b). If the instrument filed with the Secretary shows that any such tenancy is held in unequal interests, a majority or even-split for the purpose of subsection (c) shall be a majority or even-split in interest.

 

Section 12.           List of Stockholders. The corporation shall prepare, at least ten (10) days before every meeting of stockholders, a complete list of the stockholders entitled to vote at said meeting in accordance with Section 219 of the DGCL, as amended from time to time.

 

Section 13.           Action Without Meeting. Subject to the Certificate of Incorporation, no action required or permitted to be taken by the stockholders of the corporation may be effected by any consent in writing or by electronic transmission by such stockholders.

 

- 9 -

 

 

Section 14.           Organization.

 

(a)          At every meeting of stockholders, the Chairperson of the Board of Directors, or, if a Chairperson has not been appointed or is absent, the Chief Executive Officer, or if no Chief Executive Officer is then serving or is absent, the President, or, if the President is absent, a chairperson of the meeting chosen by the Board of Directors, or if no chairperson is so chosen, a chairperson of the meeting chosen by the holders of a majority of the voting power of the shares entitled to vote, present in person or by proxy duly authorized, shall act as chairperson. The Chairperson of the Board of Directors may appoint the Chief Executive Officer as chairperson of the meeting. The Secretary, or, in his or her absence, an Assistant Secretary or other officer or other person directed to do so by the chairperson of the meeting, shall act as secretary of the meeting.

 

(b)         The Board of Directors of the corporation shall have the right to postpone, cancel or reschedule any previously called annual meeting or special meeting of stockholders. The Board of Directors of the corporation shall be entitled to make such rules or regulations for the conduct of meetings of stockholders as it shall deem necessary, appropriate or convenient. Subject to such rules and regulations of the Board of Directors, if any, the chairperson of the meeting shall have the right and authority to prescribe such rules, regulations and procedures and to do all such acts as, in the judgment of such chairperson, are necessary, appropriate or convenient for the proper conduct of the meeting, including, without limitation, convening and (for any or no reason) adjourning, postponing or recessing the meeting, establishing an agenda or order of business for the meeting, rules and procedures for maintaining order at the meeting and the safety of those present, limitations on participation in such meeting to stockholders of record of the corporation and their duly authorized and constituted proxies and such other persons as the chairperson shall permit, restrictions on entry to the meeting after the time fixed for the commencement thereof, limitations on the time allotted to questions or comments by participants and regulation of the opening and closing of the polls for balloting on matters which are to be voted on by ballot. The date and time of the opening and closing of the polls for each matter upon which the stockholders will vote at the meeting shall be announced at the meeting. Unless and to the extent determined by the Board of Directors or the chairperson of the meeting, meetings of stockholders shall not be required to be held in accordance with rules of parliamentary procedure.

 

ARTICLE IV

 

DIRECTORS

 

Section 15.           Number and Term of Office. Except as otherwise provided in the Certificate of Incorporation, the Board of Directors shall consist of no fewer than four nor more than 12 members, the number thereof to be determined from time to time by resolution of the Board of Directors. Directors need not be stockholders unless so required by the Certificate of Incorporation.

 

Section 16.           Powers. The business and affairs of the corporation shall be managed by or under the direction of the Board of Directors, except as may be otherwise provided by statute or by the Certificate of Incorporation.

 

Section 17.           Term of Directors. Each director will be elected at each annual meeting of stockholders, to hold office until the next annual meeting. Notwithstanding the foregoing provisions of this section, each director shall serve until his or her successor is duly elected and qualified or until his or her earlier death, resignation or removal. No decrease in the number of directors constituting the Board of Directors shall shorten the term of any incumbent director.

 

- 10 -

 

 

Section 18.           Vacancies. Unless otherwise provided in the Certificate of Incorporation, any vacancies on the Board of Directors resulting from death, resignation, disqualification, removal or other causes and any newly created directorships resulting from any increase in the number of directors shall, unless the Board of Directors determines by resolution that any such vacancies or newly created directorships shall be filled by stockholders, be filled only by the affirmative vote of a majority of the directors then in office, even though less than a quorum of the Board of Directors, or by a sole remaining director, and not by the stockholders, provided, however, that whenever the holders of any class or classes of stock thereof are entitled to elect one or more directors by the provisions of the Certificate of Incorporation, vacancies and newly created directorships of such class or classes shall, unless the Board of Directors determines by resolution that any such vacancies or newly created directorships shall be filled by stockholders, be filled by a majority of the directors elected by such class or classes thereof then in office, or by a sole remaining director so elected, and not by the stockholders. Any director elected in accordance with the preceding sentence shall hold office for the remainder of the full term of the director for which the vacancy was created or occurred and until such director’s successor shall have been elected and qualified. A vacancy in the Board of Directors shall be deemed to exist under this Bylaw in the case of the death, removal or resignation of any director.

 

Section 19.           Resignation. Any director may resign at any time by delivering his or her notice in writing or by electronic transmission to the Secretary, such resignation to specify whether it will be effective at a particular time. The Board of Directors (without the participation of the Director tending such resignation), giving due consideration to the best interests of the Corporation and its stockholders, shall evaluate the relevant facts and circumstances, and shall make a decision with a reasonable time period thereafter as to whether to accept the tendered resignation. If the Board of Directors rejects such tendered resignation, the Board of Directors will publicly disclose its reasons for doing so. Except as set forth above, any resignation shall take effect at the time therein specified or, if no such specification is made, it shall be deemed effective at the time of delivery to the Secretary. When one or more directors shall resign from the Board of Directors, effective at a future date, a majority of the directors then in office, including those who have so resigned, shall have power to fill such vacancy or vacancies, the vote thereon to take effect when such resignation or resignations shall become effective, and each director so chosen shall hold office for the unexpired portion of the term of the director whose place shall be vacated and until his or her successor shall have been duly elected and qualified.

 

Section 20.           Removal. Any director may be removed only in the manner provided in the Certificate of Incorporation.

 

Section 21.           Meetings.

 

(a)            Regular Meetings. Unless otherwise restricted by the Certificate of Incorporation, regular meetings of the Board of Directors may be held at any time or date and at any place within or without the State of Delaware which has been designated by the Board of Directors and publicized among all directors, either orally or in writing, by telephone, including a voice-messaging system or other system designed to record and communicate messages, facsimile, or by electronic mail or other electronic means. No further notice shall be required for regular meetings of the Board of Directors.

 

(b)         Special Meetings. Unless otherwise restricted by the Certificate of Incorporation, special meetings of the Board of Directors may be held at any time and place within or without the State of Delaware whenever called by the Chairperson of the Board, the Chief Executive Officer or a majority of the total number of authorized directors.

 

- 11 -

 

 

(c)         Meetings by Electronic Communications Equipment. Any member of the Board of Directors, or of any committee thereof, may participate in a meeting by means of conference telephone or other communications equipment by means of which all persons participating in the meeting can hear each other, and participation in a meeting by such means shall constitute presence in person at such meeting.

 

(d)         Notice of Special Meetings. Notice of the time and place, if any, of all special meetings of the Board of Directors shall be in writing, by facsimile, telegraph or telex, or by electronic mail or other means of electronic transmission, during normal business hours, at least twenty-four (24) hours before the time of the meeting. If notice is sent by U.S. mail, it shall be sent by first class mail, postage prepaid, at least three (3) days before the date of the meeting. Notice of any meeting may be waived in writing, or by electronic transmission, at any time before or after the meeting and will be waived by any director by attendance thereat, except when the director attends the meeting for the express purpose of objecting, at the beginning of the meeting, to the transaction of any business because the meeting is not lawfully called or convened.

 

(e)         Waiver of Notice. The transaction of all business at any meeting of the Board of Directors, or any committee thereof, however called or noticed, or wherever held, shall be as valid as though it had been transacted at a meeting duly held after regular call and notice, if a quorum be present and if, either before or after the meeting, each of the directors not present who did not receive notice shall sign a written waiver of notice or shall waive notice by electronic transmission. All such waivers shall be filed with the corporate records or made a part of the minutes of the meeting.

 

Section 22.           Quorum and Voting.

 

(a)          Unless the Certificate of Incorporation requires a greater number, and except with respect to questions related to indemnification arising under Section 44, a quorum of the Board of Directors shall consist of a majority of the total number of directors then in office; provided, however, at any meeting whether a quorum be present or otherwise, a majority of the directors present may adjourn from time to time until the time fixed for the next regular meeting of the Board of Directors, without notice other than by announcement at the meeting.

 

(b)          At each meeting of the Board of Directors at which a quorum is present, all questions and business shall be determined by the affirmative vote of a majority of the directors present, unless a different vote be required by law, the Certificate of Incorporation or these Bylaws.

 

Section 23.           Action Without Meeting. Unless otherwise restricted by the Certificate of Incorporation or these Bylaws, any action required or permitted to be taken at any meeting of the Board of Directors or of any committee thereof may be taken without a meeting, if all members of the Board of Directors or committee, as the case may be, consent thereto in writing or by electronic transmission. After an action is so taken, such writing or writings or transmission or transmissions shall be filed with the minutes of proceedings of the Board of Directors or committee.

 

Section 24.           Fees and Compensation. Directors shall be entitled to such compensation for their services as may be approved by the Board of Directors, including, if so approved, by resolution of the Board of Directors, a fixed sum and expenses of attendance, if any, for attendance at each regular or special meeting of the Board of Directors and at any meeting of a committee of the Board of Directors. Nothing herein contained shall be construed to preclude any director from serving the corporation in any other capacity as an officer, agent, employee, or otherwise and receiving compensation therefor.

 

- 12 -

 

 

Section 25.           Committees.

 

(a)            Other Committees. The Board of Directors may, from time to time, appoint such committees as may be permitted by law. Such committees appointed by the Board of Directors shall consist of one (1) or more members of the Board of Directors and shall have such powers and perform such duties as may be prescribed by the resolution or resolutions creating such committees.

 

(b)            Term. The Board of Directors, subject to the provisions of subsections (a) or (b) of this Section 25, may at any time increase or decrease the number of members of a committee or terminate the existence of a committee. The membership of a committee member shall terminate on the date of his or her death or voluntary resignation from the committee or from the Board of Directors. The Board of Directors may at any time for any reason remove any individual committee member and the Board of Directors may fill any committee vacancy created by death, resignation, removal or increase in the number of members of the committee. The Board of Directors may designate one or more directors as alternate members of any committee, who may replace any absent or disqualified member at any meeting of the committee, and, in addition, in the absence or disqualification of any member of a committee, the member or members thereof present at any meeting and not disqualified from voting, whether or not he or they constitute a quorum, may unanimously appoint another member of the Board of Directors to act at the meeting in the place of any such absent or disqualified member.

 

(c)            Meetings. Unless the Board of Directors shall otherwise provide, regular meetings of any committee appointed pursuant to this Section 25 shall be held at such times and places as are determined by the Board of Directors, or by any such committee, and when notice thereof has been given to each member of such committee, no further notice of such regular meetings need be given thereafter. Special meetings of any such committee may be held at any place which has been determined from time to time by such committee, and may be called by any director who is a member of such committee, upon notice to the members of such committee of the time and place of such special meeting given in the manner provided for the giving of notice to members of the Board of Directors of the time and place of special meetings of the Board of Directors. Notice of any special meeting of any committee may be waived in writing or by electronic transmission at any time before or after the meeting and will be waived by any director by attendance thereat, except when the director attends such special meeting for the express purpose of objecting, at the beginning of the meeting, to the transaction of any business because the meeting is not lawfully called or convened. Unless otherwise provided by the Board of Directors in the resolutions authorizing the creation of the committee, a majority of the authorized number of members of any such committee shall constitute a quorum for the transaction of business, and the affirmative act of a majority of those present at any meeting at which a quorum is present shall be the act of such committee.

 

Section 26.           Duties of Chairperson of the Board of Directors and Lead Independent Director.

 

(a)            The Chairperson of the Board of Directors, if appointed and when present, shall preside at all meetings of the stockholders (subject to Section 14(a) hereof) and the Board of Directors. The Chairperson of the Board of Directors shall perform other duties commonly incident to the office and shall also perform such other duties and have such other powers, as the Board of Directors shall designate from time to time.

 

- 13 -

 

 

(b)            The Chairperson of the Board of Directors, or if the Chairperson is not an independent director, one of the independent directors, may be designated by the Board of Directors as lead independent director to serve until replaced by the Board of Directors (“Lead Independent Director”). The Lead Independent Director will: with the Chairperson of the Board of Directors, establish the agenda for regular Board meetings and serve as chairperson of Board of Directors meetings in the absence of the Chairperson of the Board of Directors; establish the agenda for meetings of the independent directors; coordinate with the committee chairs regarding meeting agendas and informational requirements; preside over meetings of the independent directors; preside over any portions of meetings of the Board of Directors at which the evaluation or compensation of the Chief Executive Officer is presented or discussed; preside over any portions of meetings of the Board of Directors at which the performance of the Board of Directors is presented or discussed; and perform such other duties as may be established or delegated by the Board of Directors.

 

Section 27.           Organization. At every meeting of the directors, the Chairperson of the Board of Directors, or, if a Chairperson has not been appointed or is absent, the Lead Independent Director, or if the Lead Independent Director has not been appointed or is absent, the Chief Executive Officer (if a director), or, if a Chief Executive Officer is absent, the President (if a director), or if the President is absent, the most senior Vice President (if a director), or, in the absence of any such person, a chairperson of the meeting chosen by a majority of the directors present, shall preside over the meeting. The Secretary, or in his or her absence, any Assistant Secretary or other officer, director or other person directed to do so by the person presiding over the meeting, shall act as secretary of the meeting.

 

ARTICLE V

 

OFFICERS

 

Section 28.           Officers Designated. The officers of the corporation shall include, if and when designated by the Board of Directors, the Chief Executive Officer, the President, one or more Vice Presidents, the Secretary, the Chief Financial Officer and the Treasurer. The Board of Directors may also appoint one or more Assistant Secretaries and Assistant Treasurers and such other officers and agents with such powers and duties as it shall deem necessary. The Board of Directors may assign such additional titles to one or more of the officers as it shall deem appropriate. Any one person may hold any number of offices of the corporation at any one time unless specifically prohibited therefrom by law. The salaries and other compensation of the officers of the corporation shall be fixed by or in the manner designated by the Board of Directors or a committee thereof to which the Board of Directors has delegated such responsibility.

 

Section 29.           Tenure and Duties of Officers.

 

(a)            General. All officers shall hold office at the pleasure of the Board of Directors and until their successors shall have been duly elected and qualified, unless sooner removed. Any officer elected or appointed by the Board of Directors may be removed at any time by the Board of Directors. If the office of any officer becomes vacant for any reason, the vacancy may be filled by the Board of Directors.

 

(b)            Duties of Chief Executive Officer. The Chief Executive Officer shall preside at all meetings of the stockholders and at all meetings of the Board of Directors (if a director), unless the Chairperson of the Board of Directors or (in the case of meetings of the Board of Directors) the Lead Independent Director has been appointed and is present. Unless an officer has been appointed Chief Executive Officer of the corporation, the President shall be the chief executive officer of the corporation and shall, subject to the control of the Board of Directors, have general supervision, direction and control of the business and officers of the corporation. To the extent that a Chief Executive Officer has been appointed and no President has been appointed, all references in these Bylaws to the President shall be deemed references to the Chief Executive Officer. The Chief Executive Officer shall perform other duties commonly incident to the office and shall also perform such other duties and have such other powers, as the Board of Directors shall designate from time to time.

 

- 14 -

 

 

(c)            Duties of President. The President shall preside at all meetings of the stockholders and at all meetings of the Board of Directors (if a director), unless the Chairperson of the Board of Directors, the Lead Independent Director (in the case of meetings of the Board of Directors) or the Chief Executive Officer has been appointed and is present. Unless another officer has been appointed Chief Executive Officer of the corporation, the President shall be the chief executive officer of the corporation and shall, subject to the control of the Board of Directors, have general supervision, direction and control of the business and officers of the corporation. The President shall perform other duties commonly incident to the office and shall also perform such other duties and have such other powers, as the Board of Directors (or the Chief Executive Officer, if the Chief Executive Officer and President are not the same person and the Board of Directors has delegated the designation of the President’s duties to the Chief Executive Officer) shall designate from time to time.

 

(d)            Duties of Vice Presidents. A Vice President may assume and perform the duties of the President in the absence or disability of the President or whenever the office of President is vacant (unless the duties of the President are being filled by the Chief Executive Officer). A Vice President shall perform other duties commonly incident to their office and shall also perform such other duties and have such other powers as the Board of Directors or the Chief Executive Officer, or, if the Chief Executive Officer has not been appointed or is absent, the President shall designate from time to time.

 

(e)            Duties of Secretary. The Secretary shall attend all meetings of the stockholders and of the Board of Directors and shall record all acts and proceedings thereof in the minute book of the corporation. The Secretary shall give notice in conformity with these Bylaws of all meetings of the stockholders and of all meetings of the Board of Directors and any committee thereof requiring notice. The Secretary shall perform all other duties provided for in these Bylaws and other duties commonly incident to the office and shall also perform such other duties and have such other powers as the Board of Directors shall designate from time to time. The Chief Executive Officer, or if no Chief Executive Officer is then serving, the President, may direct any Assistant Secretary or other officer to assume and perform the duties of the Secretary in the absence or disability of the Secretary, and each Assistant Secretary shall perform other duties commonly incident to the office and shall also perform such other duties and have such other powers as the Board of Directors or the Chief Executive Officer, or if no Chief Executive Officer is then serving, the President shall designate from time to time.

 

(f)            Duties of Chief Financial Officer. The Chief Financial Officer shall keep or cause to be kept the books of account of the corporation in a thorough and proper manner and shall render statements of the financial affairs of the corporation in such form and as often as required by the Board of Directors or the Chief Executive Officer, or if no Chief Executive Officer is then serving, the President. The Chief Financial Officer, subject to the order of the Board of Directors, shall have the custody of all funds and securities of the corporation. The Chief Financial Officer shall perform other duties commonly incident to the office and shall also perform such other duties and have such other powers as the Board of Directors or the Chief Executive Officer, or if no Chief Executive Officer is then serving, the President shall designate from time to time. To the extent that a Chief Financial Officer has been appointed and no Treasurer has been appointed, all references in these Bylaws to the Treasurer shall be deemed references to the Chief Financial Officer. The President may direct the Treasurer, if any, or any Assistant Treasurer, or the controller or any assistant controller to assume and perform the duties of the Chief Financial Officer in the absence or disability of the Chief Financial Officer, and each Treasurer and Assistant Treasurer and each controller and assistant controller shall perform other duties commonly incident to the office and shall also perform such other duties and have such other powers as the Board of Directors or the Chief Executive Officer, or if no Chief Executive Officer is then serving, the President shall designate from time to time.

 

- 15 -

 

 

(g)            Duties of Treasurer. Unless another officer has been appointed Chief Financial Officer of the corporation, the Treasurer shall be the chief financial officer of the corporation and shall keep or cause to be kept the books of account of the corporation in a thorough and proper manner and shall render statements of the financial affairs of the corporation in such form and as often as required by the Board of Directors or the Chief Executive Officer, or if no Chief Executive Officer is then serving, the President, and, subject to the order of the Board of Directors, shall have the custody of all funds and securities of the corporation. The Treasurer shall perform other duties commonly incident to the office and shall also perform such other duties and have such other powers as the Board of Directors or the Chief Executive Officer, or if no Chief Executive Officer is then serving, the President and Chief Financial Officer (if not Treasurer) shall designate from time to time.

 

Section 30.           Delegation of Authority. The Board of Directors may from time to time delegate the powers or duties of any officer to any other officer or agent, notwithstanding any provision hereof.

 

Section 31.           Resignations. Any officer may resign at any time by giving notice in writing or by electronic transmission to the Board of Directors or to the Chief Executive Officer, or if no Chief Executive Officer is then serving, the President or to the Secretary. Any such resignation shall be effective when received by the person or persons to whom such notice is given, unless a later time is specified therein, in which event the resignation shall become effective at such later time. Unless otherwise specified in such notice, the acceptance of any such resignation shall not be necessary to make it effective. Any resignation shall be without prejudice to the rights, if any, of the corporation under any contract with the resigning officer.

 

Section 32.           Removal. Any officer may be removed from office at any time, either with or without cause, by the affirmative vote of a majority of the directors in office at the time, or by the unanimous written consent of the directors in office at the time, or by any committee or by the Chief Executive Officer or by other superior officers upon whom such power of removal may have been conferred by the Board of Directors.

 

ARTICLE VI

 

EXECUTION OF CORPORATE INSTRUMENTS AND VOTING OF

 

SECURITIES OWNED BY THE CORPORATION

 

Section 33.           Execution of Corporate Instruments. The Board of Directors may, in its discretion, determine the method and designate the signatory officer or officers, or other person or persons, to execute on behalf of the corporation any corporate instrument or document, or to sign on behalf of the corporation the corporate name without limitation, or to enter into contracts on behalf of the corporation, except where otherwise provided by law or these Bylaws, and such execution or signature shall be binding upon the corporation.

 

All checks and drafts drawn on banks or other depositaries on funds to the credit of the corporation or in special accounts of the corporation shall be signed by such person or persons as the Board of Directors shall authorize so to do.

 

Unless authorized or ratified by the Board of Directors or within the agency power of an officer, no officer, agent or employee shall have any power or authority to bind the corporation by any contract or engagement or to pledge its credit or to render it liable for any purpose or for any amount.

 

Section 34.           Voting of Securities Owned by the Corporation. All stock and other securities of other corporations or other entities owned or held by the corporation for itself, or for other parties in any capacity, shall be voted (including by written consent), and all proxies with respect thereto shall be executed, by the person authorized so to do by resolution of the Board of Directors, or, in the absence of such authorization, by the Chairperson of the Board of Directors, the Chief Executive Officer, the President, or any Vice President.

 

- 16 -

 

 

ARTICLE VII

 

SHARES OF STOCK

 

Section 35.           Form and Execution of Certificates. The shares of the corporation shall be represented by certificates, or shall be uncertificated if so provided by resolution or resolutions of the Board of Directors. Certificates for the shares of stock, if any, shall be in such form as is consistent with the Certificate of Incorporation and applicable law. Every holder of stock in the corporation represented by certificate shall be entitled to have a certificate signed by or in the name of the corporation by any two authorized officers of the corporation, certifying the number of shares owned by him in the corporation. Any or all of the signatures on the certificate may be facsimiles. In case any officer, transfer agent, or registrar who has signed or whose facsimile signature has been placed upon a certificate shall have ceased to be such officer, transfer agent, or registrar before such certificate is issued, it may be issued with the same effect as if he were such officer, transfer agent, or registrar at the date of issue.

 

Section 36.           Lost Certificates. A new certificate or certificates or uncertificated shares shall be issued in place of any certificate or certificates theretofore issued by the corporation alleged to have been lost, stolen, or destroyed, upon the making of an affidavit of that fact by the person claiming the certificate of stock to be lost, stolen, or destroyed. The corporation may require, as a condition precedent to the issuance of a new certificate or certificates or uncertificated shares, the owner of such lost, stolen, or destroyed certificate or certificates, or the owner’s legal representative, to agree to indemnify the corporation in such manner as it shall require or to give the corporation a surety bond in such form and amount as it may direct as indemnity against any claim that may be made against the corporation with respect to the certificate alleged to have been lost, stolen, or destroyed.

 

Section 37.           Transfers.

 

(a)            Transfers of record of shares of stock of the corporation shall be made only upon its books by the holders thereof, in person or by attorney duly authorized, and, in the case of stock represented by certificate, upon the surrender of a properly endorsed certificate or certificates for a like number of shares.

 

(b)            The corporation shall have power to enter into and perform any agreement with any number of stockholders of any one or more classes of stock of the corporation to restrict the transfer of shares of stock of the corporation of any one or more classes owned by such stockholders in any manner not prohibited by the DGCL.

 

Section 38.           Fixing Record Dates.

 

(a)            In order that the corporation may determine the stockholders entitled to notice of or to vote at any meeting of stockholders or any adjournment thereof, the Board of Directors may fix a record date, which record date shall not precede the date upon which the resolution fixing the record date is adopted by the Board of Directors, and which record date shall, subject to applicable law, not be more than sixty (60) nor less than ten (10) days before the date of such meeting. If the board of directors so fixes a date, such date shall also be the record date for determining the stockholders entitled to vote at such meeting. If no record date is fixed by the Board of Directors, the record date for determining stockholders entitled to notice of or to vote at a meeting of stockholders shall be at the close of business on the day next preceding the day on which notice is given, or if notice is waived, at the close of business on the day next preceding the day on which the meeting is held. A determination of stockholders of record entitled to notice of or to vote at a meeting of stockholders shall apply to any adjournment of the meeting; provided, however, that the Board of Directors may fix a new record date for the adjourned meeting.

 

- 17 -

 

 

(b)            In order that the corporation may determine the stockholders entitled to receive payment of any dividend or other distribution or allotment of any rights or the stockholders entitled to exercise any rights in respect of any change, conversion or exchange of stock, or for the purpose of any other lawful action, the Board of Directors may fix, in advance, a record date, which record date shall not precede the date upon which the resolution fixing the record date is adopted, and which record date shall be not more than sixty (60) days prior to such action. If no record date is fixed, the record date for determining stockholders for any such purpose shall be at the close of business on the day on which the Board of Directors adopts the resolution relating thereto.

 

Section 39.           Registered Stockholders. The corporation shall be entitled to recognize the exclusive right of a person registered on its books as the owner of shares to receive dividends, and to vote as such owner, and shall not be bound to recognize any equitable or other claim to or interest in such share or shares on the part of any other person whether or not it shall have express or other notice thereof, except as otherwise provided by the laws of Delaware.

 

ARTICLE VIII

 

OTHER SECURITIES OF THE CORPORATION

 

Section 40.           Execution of Other Securities. All bonds, debentures and other corporate securities of the corporation, other than stock certificates (covered in Section 35), may be signed by the Chairperson of the Board of Directors, the Chief Executive Officer, the President or any Vice President, or such other person as may be authorized by the Board of Directors, and the corporate seal impressed thereon or a facsimile of such seal imprinted thereon and attested by the signature of the Secretary or an Assistant Secretary, or the Chief Financial Officer or Treasurer or an Assistant Treasurer; provided, however, that where any such bond, debenture or other corporate security shall be authenticated by the manual signature, or where permissible facsimile signature, of a trustee under an indenture pursuant to which such bond, debenture or other corporate security shall be issued, the signatures of the persons signing and attesting the corporate seal on such bond, debenture or other corporate security may be the imprinted facsimile of the signatures of such persons. Interest coupons appertaining to any such bond, debenture or other corporate security, authenticated by a trustee as aforesaid, shall be signed by the Chief Financial Officer, Treasurer or an Assistant Treasurer of the corporation or such other person as may be authorized by the Board of Directors, or bear imprinted thereon the facsimile signature of such person. In case any officer who shall have signed or attested any bond, debenture or other corporate security, or whose facsimile signature shall appear thereon or on any such interest coupon, shall have ceased to be such officer before the bond, debenture or other corporate security so signed or attested shall have been delivered, such bond, debenture or other corporate security nevertheless may be adopted by the corporation and issued and delivered as though the person who signed the same or whose facsimile signature shall have been used thereon had not ceased to be such officer of the corporation.

 

- 18 -

 

 

ARTICLE IX

 

DIVIDENDS

 

Section 41.           Declaration of Dividends. Dividends upon the capital stock of the corporation, subject to the provisions of the Certificate of Incorporation and applicable law, if any, may be declared by the Board of Directors pursuant to law at any regular or special meeting. Dividends may be paid in cash, in property, or in shares of the capital stock, subject to the provisions of the Certificate of Incorporation and applicable law.

 

Section 42.           Dividend Reserve. Before payment of any dividend, there may be set aside out of any funds of the corporation available for dividends such sum or sums as the Board of Directors from time to time, in their absolute discretion, think proper as a reserve or reserves to meet contingencies, or for equalizing dividends, or for repairing or maintaining any property of the corporation, or for such other purpose as the Board of Directors shall think conducive to the interests of the corporation, and the Board of Directors may modify or abolish any such reserve in the manner in which it was created.

 

ARTICLE X

 

FISCAL YEAR

 

Section 43.           Fiscal Year. The fiscal year of the corporation shall end on December 31 of each year, unless otherwise determined by the Board of Directors.

 

ARTICLE XI

 

INDEMNIFICATION

 

Section 44.           Indemnification of Directors, Executive Officers, Other Officers, Employees and Other Agents.

 

(a)            Directors and Executive Officers. The corporation shall indemnify any person who was or is a party or is threatened to be made a party to any threatened, pending or completed action, suit or proceeding, whether civil, criminal, administrative or investigative, by reason of the fact that such person is or was a director, officer, employee or agent of the corporation or while a director or executive officer of the corporation is or was serving at the request of the corporation as a director, officer, employee or agent of another corporation, partnership, joint venture, trust or other enterprise to the extent not prohibited by the DGCL or any other applicable law; provided, however, that the corporation may modify the extent of such indemnification by individual contracts with its directors and executive officers; and, provided, further, that the corporation shall not be required to indemnify any director or executive officer in connection with any proceeding (or part thereof) initiated by such person unless (i) such indemnification is expressly required to be made by law, (ii) the proceeding (or part thereof) was authorized by the Board of Directors of the corporation, (iii) such indemnification is provided by the corporation, in its sole discretion, pursuant to the powers vested in the corporation under the DGCL or any other applicable law or (iv) such indemnification is required to be made under subsection (d).

 

(b)            Other Officers, Employees and Other Agents. The corporation shall have the power to indemnify (including the power to advance expenses in a manner consistent with subsection (c)) its other officers, employees and other agents as set forth in the DGCL or any other applicable law. Subject to Section 145(d) of the DGCL, the Board of Directors shall have the power to delegate the determination of whether indemnification shall be given to any such person except executive officers to such officers or other persons as the Board of Directors shall determine.

 

- 19 -

 

 

(c)            Expenses. The corporation shall advance to any person who was or is a party or is threatened to be made a party to any threatened, pending or completed action, suit or proceeding, whether civil, criminal, administrative or investigative, by reason of the fact that he or she is or was a director or executive officer, of the corporation, or is or was serving at the request of the corporation as a director or executive officer of another corporation, partnership, joint venture, trust or other enterprise, prior to the final disposition of the proceeding, promptly following request therefor, all expenses actually and reasonably incurred by any director or executive officer in connection with such proceeding provided, however, that if the DGCL requires, an advancement of expenses incurred by a director or executive officer in his or her capacity as a director or executive officer (and not in any other capacity in which service was or is rendered by such indemnitee, including, without limitation, service to an employee benefit plan) shall be made only upon delivery to the corporation of an undertaking (hereinafter an “undertaking”), by or on behalf of such indemnitee, to repay all amounts so advanced if it shall ultimately be determined by final judicial decision from which there is no further right to appeal (hereinafter a “final adjudication”) that such indemnitee is not entitled to be indemnified for such expenses under this section or otherwise.

 

Notwithstanding the foregoing, unless otherwise determined pursuant to subsection (e) of this section, no advance shall be made by the corporation to any person entitled to indemnification in any action, suit or proceeding, whether civil, criminal, administrative or investigative, if a determination is reasonably and promptly made (i) by a majority vote of directors who were not parties to the proceeding, even if not a quorum, or (ii) by a committee of such directors designated by a majority vote of such directors, even though less than a quorum, or (iii) if there are no such directors, or such directors so direct, by independent legal counsel in a written opinion, that the facts known to the decision-making party at the time such determination is made demonstrate clearly and convincingly that such person acted in bad faith or in a manner that such person did not believe to be in or not opposed to the best interests of the corporation or with respect to any criminal action or proceeding that such person acted without reasonable cause to believe that his or her conduct was lawful.

 

(d)            Enforcement. Without the necessity of entering into an express contract, all rights to indemnification and advances to directors and executive officers under this Bylaw shall be deemed to be contractual rights and be effective to the same extent and as if provided for in a contract between the corporation and the director or executive officer. Any right to indemnification or advances granted by this section to a director, officer, employee or other agent of the corporation shall be enforceable by or on behalf of the person holding such right in any court of competent jurisdiction if (i) the claim for indemnification or advances is denied, in whole or in part, or (ii) no disposition of such claim is made within ninety (90) days of request therefor. To the extent permitted by law, the claimant in such enforcement action, if successful in whole or in part, shall be entitled to be paid also the expense of prosecuting the claim. In connection with any claim for indemnification, the corporation shall be entitled to raise as a defense to any such action that the claimant has not met the standards of conduct that make it permissible under the DGCL or any other applicable law for the corporation to indemnify the claimant for the amount claimed. In connection with any claim by any person otherwise entitled to indemnification hereunder for advances, the corporation shall be entitled to raise a defense as to any such action clear and convincing evidence that such person acted in bad faith or in a manner that such person did not believe to be in or not opposed to the best interests of the corporation, or with respect to any criminal action or proceeding that such person acted without reasonable cause to believe that his or her conduct was lawful. Neither the failure of the corporation (including its Board of Directors, independent legal counsel or its stockholders) to have made a determination prior to the commencement of such action that indemnification of the claimant is proper in the circumstances because he or she has met the applicable standard of conduct set forth in the DGCL or any other applicable law, nor an actual determination by the corporation (including its Board of Directors, independent legal counsel or its stockholders) that the claimant has not met such applicable standard of conduct, shall be a defense to the action or create a presumption that claimant has not met the applicable standard of conduct. In any suit brought by a director or executive officer to enforce a right to indemnification or to an advancement of expenses hereunder, the burden of proving that the director or executive officer is not entitled to be indemnified, or to such advancement of expenses, under this section or otherwise shall be on the corporation.

 

- 20 -

 

 

(e)            Non-Exclusivity of Rights. The rights conferred on any person by this Bylaw shall not be exclusive of any other right which such person may have or hereafter acquire under any applicable statute, provision of the Certificate of Incorporation, Bylaws, agreement, vote of stockholders or disinterested directors or otherwise, both as to action in his or her official capacity and as to action in another capacity while holding office. The corporation is specifically authorized to enter into individual contracts with any or all of its directors, officers, employees or agents respecting indemnification and advances, to the fullest extent not prohibited by the DGCL, or by any other applicable law.

 

(f)            Survival of Rights. The rights conferred on any person by this Bylaw shall continue as to a person who has ceased to be a director or executive officer or officer, employee or other agent and shall inure to the benefit of the heirs, executors and administrators of such a person.

 

(g)            Insurance. To the fullest extent permitted by the DGCL or any other applicable law, the corporation may purchase insurance on behalf of any person required or permitted to be indemnified pursuant to this section.

 

(h)            Amendments. Any elimination, impairment, amendment, repeal or modification of this section shall only be prospective and shall not affect the rights under this Bylaw in effect at the time of the alleged occurrence of any action or omission to act that is the cause of any proceeding against any agent of the corporation.

 

(i)            Saving Clause. If this Bylaw or any portion hereof shall be invalidated on any ground by any court of competent jurisdiction, then the corporation shall nevertheless indemnify each director and executive officer to the full extent not prohibited by any applicable portion of this section that shall not have been invalidated, or by any other applicable law. If this section shall be invalid due to the application of the indemnification provisions of another jurisdiction, then the corporation shall indemnify each director and executive officer to the full extent under any other applicable law.

 

(j)            Certain Definitions. For the purposes of this Bylaw, the following definitions shall apply:

 

(i)            The term “proceeding” shall be broadly construed and shall include, without limitation, the investigation, preparation, prosecution, defense, settlement, arbitration and appeal of, and the giving of testimony in, any threatened, pending or completed action, suit or proceeding, whether civil, criminal, administrative or investigative.

 

(ii)            The term “expenses” shall be broadly construed and shall include, without limitation, court costs, attorneys’ fees, witness fees, fines, amounts paid in settlement or judgment and any other costs and expenses of any nature or kind incurred in connection with any proceeding.

 

(iii)            The term the “corporation” shall include, in addition to the resulting corporation, any constituent corporation (including any constituent of a constituent) absorbed in a consolidation or merger which, if its separate existence had continued, would have had power and authority to indemnify its directors, officers, and employees or agents, so that any person who is or was a director, officer, employee or agent of such constituent corporation, or is or was serving at the request of such constituent corporation as a director, officer, employee or agent of another corporation, partnership, joint venture, trust or other enterprise, shall stand in the same position under the provisions of this section with respect to the resulting or surviving corporation as he would have with respect to such constituent corporation if its separate existence had continued.

 

- 21 -

 

 

(iv)            References to a “director,” “executive officer,” “officer,” “employee,” or “agent” of the corporation shall include, without limitation, situations where such person is serving at the request of the corporation as, respectively, a director, executive officer, officer, employee, trustee or agent of another corporation, partnership, joint venture, trust or other enterprise.

 

(v)            References to “other enterprises” shall include employee benefit plans; references to “fines” shall include any excise taxes assessed on a person with respect to an employee benefit plan; and references to “serving at the request of the corporation” shall include any service as a director, officer, employee or agent of the corporation which imposes duties on, or involves services by, such director, officer, employee, or agent with respect to an employee benefit plan, its participants, or beneficiaries; and a person who acted in good faith and in a manner he reasonably believed to be in the interest of the participants and beneficiaries of an employee benefit plan shall be deemed to have acted in a manner “not opposed to the best interests of the corporation” as referred to in this section.

 

ARTICLE XII

 

NOTICES

 

Section 45.           Notices.

 

(a)            Notice to Stockholders. Written notice to stockholders of stockholder meetings shall be given as provided in Section 7 herein. Without limiting the manner by which notice may otherwise be given effectively to stockholders under any agreement or contract with such stockholder, and except as otherwise required by law, written notice to stockholders for purposes other than stockholder meetings may be sent by U.S. mail or nationally recognized overnight courier, or by facsimile or by electronic mail or other electronic means.

 

(b)            Notice to Directors. Any notice required to be given to any director may be given by the method stated in subsection (a) or as otherwise provided in these Bylaws, with notice other than one which is delivered personally to be sent to such address as such director shall have filed in writing with the Secretary, or, in the absence of such filing, to the last known address of such director.

 

(c)            Affidavit of Mailing. An affidavit of mailing, executed by a duly authorized and competent employee of the corporation or its transfer agent appointed with respect to the class of stock affected, or other agent, specifying the name and address or the names and addresses of the stockholder or stockholders, or director or directors, to whom any such notice or notices was or were given, and the time and method of giving the same, shall in the absence of fraud, be prima facie evidence of the facts therein contained.

 

(d)            Methods of Notice. It shall not be necessary that the same method of giving notice be employed in respect of all recipients of notice, but one permissible method may be employed in respect of any one or more, and any other permissible method or methods may be employed in respect of any other or others.

 

(e)            Notice to Person With Whom Communication is Unlawful. Whenever notice is required to be given, under any provision of law or of the Certificate of Incorporation or Bylaws of the corporation, to any person with whom communication is unlawful, the giving of such notice to such person shall not be required and there shall be no duty to apply to any governmental authority or agency for a license or permit to give such notice to such person. Any action or meeting which shall be taken or held without notice to any such person with whom communication is unlawful shall have the same force and effect as if such notice had been duly given. In the event that the action taken by the corporation is such as to require the filing of a certificate under any provision of the DGCL, the certificate shall state, if such is the fact and if notice is required, that notice was given to all persons entitled to receive notice except such persons with whom communication is unlawful.

 

- 22 -

 

 

(f)            Notice to Stockholders Sharing an Address. Except as otherwise prohibited under DGCL, any notice given under the provisions of DGCL, the Certificate of Incorporation or the Bylaws shall be effective if given by a single written notice to stockholders who share an address if consented to by the stockholders at that address to whom such notice is given. Such consent shall have been deemed to have been given if such stockholder fails to object in writing to the corporation within sixty (60) days of having been given notice by the corporation of its intention to send the single notice. Any consent shall be revocable by the stockholder by written notice to the corporation.

 

ARTICLE XIII

 

AMENDMENTS

 

Section 46.           Amendments. Subject to the limitations set forth in Section 44(h) or the provisions of the Certificate of Incorporation, the Board of Directors is expressly empowered to adopt, amend or repeal the Bylaws of the corporation. The stockholders also shall have power to adopt, amend or repeal the Bylaws of the corporation; provided, however, that, in addition to any vote of the holders of any class of stock of the corporation required by law or by the Certificate of Incorporation, such action by stockholders shall require the affirmative vote of the holders of a two-thirds majority of the voting power of all of the then-outstanding shares of the capital stock of the corporation entitled to vote generally in the election of directors, voting together as a single class.

 

- 23 -

 

 

Exhibit 4.1

 

 

NUMBER SHARESDirect Digital HolDings, inc.CLASS A COMMON STOCKINCORPORATED UNDER THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF DELAWARESEE REVERSE FOR CERTAIN DEFINITIONS CUSIP 25461T 10 5his ertifies hatSPECIMEN - NOT NEGOTIABLEFULLY PAID AND NON-ASSESSABLE SHARES OF CLASS A COMMON STOCK, $0.001 PAR VALUE PER SHARE, OF Direct Digital HolDings, inc. transferable on the books of the Corporation by the holder hereof in person or by duly authorized attorney upon surrender of this certificate duly endorsed. This certificate and the shares represented hereby are subject to the laws of the State of Delaware, and to the Certificate of Incorporation and Bylaws of the Corporation, as now in effect or as hereafter amended. This certificate is not valid until countersigned and registered by the Transfer Agent and Registrar. WITNESS the facsimile seal of the Corporation and the facsimile signatures of its duly authorized officers.DateD:SPECIMEN not negotiableCHIEF EXECUTIVE OFFICERCHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER

 

 

 

 

THE CORPORATION WILL FURNISH TO ANY STOCKHOLDER, UPON REQUEST AND WITHOUT CHARGE, A FULL STATEMENT OF THE DESIGNA- TIONS, RELATIVE RIGHTS, PREFERENCES AND LIMITATIONS OF THE SHARES OF EACH CLASS AND SERIES AUTHORIZED TO BE ISSUED, SO FAR AS THE SAME HAVE BEEN DETERMINED, AND OF THE AUTHORITY, IF ANY, OF THE BOARD TO DIVIDE THE SHARES INTO CLASSES OR SERIES AND TO DETERMINE AND CHANGE THE RELATIVE RIGHTS, PREFERENCES AND LIMITATIONS OF ANY CLASS OR SERIES. SUCH REQUEST MAY BE MADE TO THE SECRETARY OF THE CORPORATION OR TO THE TRANSFER AGENT NAMED ON THIS CERTIFICATE. The following abbreviations, when used in the inscription on the face of this certificate, shall be construed as though they were written out in full according to applicable laws or regulations:TEN COM - as tenants in common UNIF GIFT MIN ACT - ....................Custodian.................... TEN ENT - as tenants by the entireties (Cust) (Minor) JT TEN - as joint tenants with right of under Uniform Gifts to Minors survivorship and not as tenants in common Act................... (State)Additional abbreviations may also be used though not in the above list.For Value Received, hereby sell, assign and transfer untoPLEASE INSERT SOCIAL SECURITY OR OTHER IDENTIFYING NUMBER OF ASSIGNEE(PLEASE PRINT OR TYPEWRITE NAME AND ADDRESS, INCLUDING ZIP CODE, OF ASSIGNEE)Shares of the stock represented by the within Certificate, and do hereby irrevocably constitute and appointAttorney to transfer the said stock on the books of the within named Corporation with full power of substitution in the premises.DatedSignature(s) GuaranteedNOTICE: THE SIGNATURE(S) TO THISASSIGNMENT MUST CORRESPOND WITH THE NAME(S) AS WRITTEN UPON THE FACE OF THE CERTIFICATE, IN EVERY PARTICULAR, WITHOUT ALTERATION OR ENLARGEMENT OR ANY CHANGE WHATSOEVER.By The Signature(s) must be guaranteed by an eligible guarantor institution (Banks, Stockbrokers, Savings and Loan Associations and Credit Unions with membership in an approved Signature Guarantee Medallion Program), pursuant to SEC Rule 17Ad-15.COLUMBIA PRINTING SERVICES, LLC - www.stockinformation.com

 

 

 

exhibit 10.2

 

Tax Receivable Agreement

 

between

 

DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, Inc.

 

and

 

THE PERSONS NAMED HEREIN

 

Dated as of [•]

 

 

 

 

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

TAX RECEIVABLE AGREEMENT 1
     
RECITALS 1
     
ARTICLE I Definitions 2
     
1.1 Definitions 2
     
Article II Determination of Certain Realized Tax Benefits 10
     
2.1 Basis Schedule 10
     
2.2 Tax Benefit Schedule 11
     
2.3 Procedures, Amendments 12
     
2.4 Basis Adjustments 13
     
Article III Tax Benefits Payments 13
     
3.1 Payments 13
     
3.2 No Duplicative Payments 14
     
3.3 Pro Rata Payments 14
     
3.4 Payment Ordering 15
     
3.5 Excess Payments 15
     
Article IV Termination 15
     
4.1 Early Termination of Agreement; Breach of Agreement 15
     
4.2 Early Termination Notice 17
     
4.3 Payment upon Early Termination 17
     
Article V Subordination and Late Payments 18
     
5.1 Subordination 18
     
5.2 Late Payments by the Corporate Taxpayer 18
     
Article VI No Disputes; Consistency; Cooperation 18
     
6.1 Participation in the Corporate Taxpayer’s and OpCo’s Tax Matters 18
     
6.2 Consistency 19
     
6.3 Cooperation 19
     
Article VII Miscellaneous 19
     
7.1 Notices 19
     
7.2 Counterparts 20
     
7.3 Entire Agreement; No Third Party Beneficiary 20
     
7.4 Governing Law 20

 

-i-

 

 

7.5 Severability 20
     
7.6 Successors; Assignment; Amendments; Waivers 20
     
7.7 Titles and Subtitles 21
     
7.8 Resolution of Disputes 21
     
7.9 Reconciliation 23
   
7.10 Withholding 23
     
7.11 Admission of the Corporate Taxpayer into a Consolidated Group; Transfers of Corporate Assets 24
     
7.12 Confidentiality 25
     
7.13 Partnership Agreement 26
     
7.14 Change in Law 26
     
7.15 Electronic Signatures 26

 

-ii-

 

 

TAX RECEIVABLE AGREEMENT

 

This TAX RECEIVABLE AGREEMENT (this “Agreement”), is dated as of [•], 2021, and is between Direct Digital Holdings, Inc., a Delaware corporation, each of the undersigned parties, and each of the other persons from time to time that becomes a party hereto (each, excluding the Corporate Taxpayer and OpCo (each as defined below), a “TRA Party” and together the “TRA Parties”).

 

RECITALS

 

WHEREAS, the TRA Parties directly or indirectly hold Class A Common Units (the “Class A Units”) in Direct Digital Holdings, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company (“OpCo”), which is classified as a partnership for U.S. federal income Tax purposes;

 

WHEREAS, after the Pre-IPO Exchanges (as defined in the LLC Agreement), the Corporate Taxpayer will be the sole managing member of OpCo, and will hold, directly and/or indirectly, all of the Class B Voting Units (the “Class B Units,” and together with the Class A Units, the “Units”);

 

WHEREAS, from time to time following the Lock-Up Period (as defined in the LLC Agreement), each holder of Class A Units has the right to require OpCo to redeem (a “Redemption”) all or a portion of such holder’s Class A Units for, at the Corporate Taxpayer’s election, cash or shares of Class A common stock of the Corporate Taxpayer (the “Class A Shares”), in either case contributed to OpCo by the Corporate Taxpayer, provided that, at the election of the Corporate Taxpayer in its sole discretion, the Corporate Taxpayer may effect a direct exchange (a “Direct Exchange”) of such cash or Class A Shares for such Class A Units, all in accordance with and subject to the provisions of the LLC Agreement (as defined below);

 

WHEREAS, OpCo and each of its direct and indirect Subsidiaries (as defined below) treated as a partnership for U.S. federal income Tax purposes currently have and will have in effect an election under Section 754 of the Code, for each Taxable Year (as defined below) that includes the IPO Date and for each Taxable Year in which a taxable acquisition (including a deemed taxable acquisition under Section 707(a) of the Code) of Class A Units by the Corporate Taxpayer or by OpCo from any of the TRA Parties (an “Exchanging Holder”) for Class A Shares and/or other consideration occurs;

 

WHEREAS, the income, gain, loss, expense and other Tax items of the Corporate Taxpayer may be affected by the (i) Basis Adjustments and (ii) Imputed Interest (each as defined below) (collectively, the “Tax Attributes”); and

 

WHEREAS, the parties to this Agreement desire to provide for certain payments and make certain arrangements with respect to the effect of the Tax Attributes on the liability for Taxes (as defined below) of the Corporate Taxpayer.

 

NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the foregoing and the respective covenants and agreements set forth herein, and intending to be legally bound hereby, the parties hereto agree as follows:

 

 

 

 

ARTICLE I
Definitions

 

1.1              Definitions. As used in this Agreement, the terms set forth in this Article I shall have the following meanings (such meanings to be equally applicable to both the singular and plural forms of the terms defined).

 

Actual Tax Liability” means, with respect to any Taxable Year, an amount, not less than zero, equal to the actual liability for Taxes of (i) the Corporate Taxpayer and (ii) without duplication, OpCo (and OpCo’s applicable Subsidiaries), but in the case of this clause (ii), only with respect to Taxes imposed on OpCo (and OpCo’s applicable Subsidiaries) and allocable to the Corporate Taxpayer; provided, that the actual liability for Taxes described in clauses (i) and (ii) shall be calculated (a) using the Assumed Rate, solely for purposes of calculating the U.S. state and local Actual Tax liability of the Corporate Taxpayer, and (b) assuming, solely for purposes of calculating the liability for U.S. federal income Taxes, in order to prevent double counting, that U.S. state and local Taxes are not deductible by the Corporate Taxpayer for U.S. federal income Tax purposes.

 

Affiliate” means, with respect to any Person, any other Person that directly or indirectly, through one or more intermediaries, Controls, is Controlled by, or is under common Control with, such first Person.

 

Agreed Rate” means a per annum rate of the lesser of (i) 6.5% and (ii) LIBOR plus 100 basis points.

 

Agreement” has the meaning set forth in the Preamble to this Agreement.

 

Amended Schedule” has the meaning set forth in Section 2.3(b) of this Agreement.

 

Assumed Rate” means, with respect to any Taxable Year, the tax rate equal to the sum of the product of (x) OpCo’s income and franchise Tax apportionment percentage(s) for each U.S. state and local jurisdiction in which OpCo files income or franchise Tax Returns for the relevant Taxable Year, and (y) the highest corporate income and franchise Tax rate(s) for each such U.S. state and local jurisdiction in which OpCo files income or franchise Tax Returns for each relevant Taxable Year; provided, that the Assumed Rate calculated pursuant to the foregoing shall be reduced by the assumed U.S. federal income Tax benefit received by the Corporate Taxpayer with respect to U.S. state and local jurisdiction income and franchise Taxes (with such benefit calculated as the product of (a) the Corporate Taxpayer’s marginal U.S. federal income Tax rate for such Taxable Year and (b) the Assumed Rate (without regard to this proviso)).

 

Attributable” means the portion of any Tax Attribute of the Corporate Taxpayer that is “Attributable” to any present or former holder of Units, other than the Corporate Taxpayer, and shall be determined by reference to the Tax Attributes, under the following principles:

 

(i)       the Basis Adjustments shall be determined separately with respect to each Exchanging Holder, using reasonable methods for tracking such Basis Adjustments, and are Attributable to each Exchanging Holder in an amount equal to the total Basis Adjustments relating to such Class A Units Exchanged by such Exchanging Holder (determined without regard to any dilutive or antidilutive effect of any contribution to or distribution from OpCo after the date of an applicable Exchange, and taking into account any adjustment under Section 743(b) of the Code); and

 

2

 

 

(ii)       any deduction to the Corporate Taxpayer with respect to a Taxable Year in respect of Imputed Interest is Attributable to the Person that is required to include the Imputed Interest in income (without regard to whether such Person is actually subject to Tax thereon).

 

Basis Adjustment” means the adjustment to the Tax basis of a Reference Asset under Sections 732, 734(b), 754 and/or 1012 of the Code (in situations where, as a result of one or more Exchanges, OpCo becomes an entity that is disregarded as separate from its owner for U.S. federal income Tax purposes) or under Sections 734(b), 743(b), 754 and/or 755 of the Code (in situations where, following an Exchange, OpCo remains in existence as an entity treated as a partnership for U.S. federal income Tax purposes) and, in each case, analogous sections of state, local and foreign Tax laws, as a result of an Exchange and the payments made pursuant to this Agreement in respect of such Exchange. For the avoidance of doubt, the amount of any Basis Adjustment resulting from an Exchange of one or more Class A Units shall be determined without regard to any Pre-Exchange Transfer of such Class A Units and as if any such Pre-Exchange Transfer had not occurred. The amount of any Basis Adjustment shall be determined using the Market Value at the time of the Exchange.

 

Basis Schedule” has the meaning set forth in Section 2.1 of this Agreement.

 

Beneficial Owner” means, with respect to any security, a Person who directly or indirectly, through any contract, arrangement, understanding, relationship or otherwise, has or shares: (i) voting power, which includes the power to vote, or to direct the voting of, such security; and/or (ii) investment power, which includes the power to dispose of, or to direct the disposition of, such security. The term “Beneficial Ownership” shall have a correlative meaning.

 

Board” means the Board of Directors of the Corporate Taxpayer.

 

Business Day” means each day that is not a Saturday, Sunday or other day on which banking institutions in Houston, Texas or New York, New York are authorized or required by law to close.

 

Change of Control” means the occurrence of any of the following events:

 

(i)       any Person or any group of Persons acting together that would constitute a “group” for purposes of Section 13(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended or any successor provisions thereto (excluding (a) a corporation or other entity owned, directly or indirectly, by the stockholders of the Corporate Taxpayer in substantially the same proportions as their ownership of stock of the Corporate Taxpayer or (b) a group of Persons in which one or more Affiliates of the Founder Member, directly or indirectly hold Beneficial Ownership of securities representing more than 50% of the total voting power held by such group) is or becomes the Beneficial Owner, directly or indirectly, of securities of the Corporate Taxpayer representing more than 50% of the combined voting power of the Corporate Taxpayer’s then outstanding voting securities; or

 

3

 

 

(ii)       the following individuals cease for any reason to constitute a majority of the number of directors of the Corporate Taxpayer then serving: individuals who, on the IPO Date, constitute the Board and any new director whose appointment or election by the Board or nomination for election by the Corporate Taxpayer’s stockholders was approved or recommended by a vote of at least two-thirds (2/3) of the directors then still in office who either were directors on the IPO Date or whose appointment, election or nomination for election was previously so approved or recommended by the directors referred to in this clause (ii); or

 

(iii)       there is consummated a merger or consolidation of the Corporate Taxpayer with any other corporation or other entity, and, immediately after the consummation of such merger or consolidation, either (x) the Board immediately prior to the merger or consolidation does not constitute at least a majority of the board of directors of the company surviving the merger or, if the surviving company is a Subsidiary, the ultimate parent thereof, or (y) the voting securities of the Corporate Taxpayer immediately prior to such merger or consolidation do not continue to represent or are not converted into more than 50% of the combined voting power of the then outstanding voting securities of the Person resulting from such merger or consolidation or, if the surviving company is a Subsidiary, the ultimate parent thereof; or

 

(iv)       the stockholders of the Corporate Taxpayer approve a plan of complete liquidation or dissolution of the Corporate Taxpayer or there is consummated an agreement or series of related agreements for the sale, lease or other disposition, directly or indirectly, by the Corporate Taxpayer of all or substantially all of the Corporate Taxpayer’s assets, other than such sale or other disposition by the Corporate Taxpayer of all or substantially all of the Corporate Taxpayer’s assets to an entity at least 50% of the combined voting power of the voting securities of which are owned by stockholders of the Corporate Taxpayer in substantially the same proportions as their ownership of the Corporate Taxpayer immediately prior to such sale.

 

Notwithstanding the foregoing, except with respect to clause (ii) and clause (iii)(x) above, a “Change of Control” shall not be deemed to have occurred by virtue of the consummation of any transaction or series of integrated transactions immediately following which the record holders of the shares of the Corporate Taxpayer immediately prior to such transaction or series of transactions continue to have substantially the same proportionate ownership in, and voting control over, and own substantially all of the shares of, an entity which owns, directly or indirectly, all or substantially all of the assets of the Corporate Taxpayer immediately following such transaction or series of transactions.

 

Class A Shares” has the meaning set forth in the Recitals of this Agreement.

 

Class A Units” has the meaning set forth in the Recitals of this Agreement.

 

Class B Units” has the meaning set forth in the Recitals of this Agreement.

 

Code” means the U.S. Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended.

 

Control” means the possession, direct or indirect, of the power to direct or cause the direction of the management and policies of a Person, whether through ownership of voting securities, by contract or otherwise.

 

4

 

 

Corporate Taxpayer” means Direct Digital Holdings, Inc. and any successor corporation and shall include any Person that is a member of any consolidated Tax Return of which Direct Digital Holdings, Inc. is a member.

 

Corporate Taxpayer Return” means the U.S. federal income Tax Return of the Corporate Taxpayer filed with respect to Taxes of any Taxable Year, including any consolidated Tax Return.

 

Cumulative Net Realized Tax Benefit” for a Taxable Year means the cumulative amount of Realized Tax Benefits for all Taxable Years of the Corporate Taxpayer, up to and including such Taxable Year net of the Realized Tax Detriment for the same period. The Realized Tax Benefit and Realized Tax Detriment for each Taxable Year shall be determined based on the most recent Tax Benefit Schedules or Amended Schedules, if any, in existence at the time of such determination; provided, that, for the avoidance of doubt, the computation of the Cumulative Net Realized Tax Benefit shall be adjusted to reflect any applicable Determination with respect to any Realized Tax Benefits and/or Realized Tax Detriments.

 

DDM” means Direct Digital Management, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company.

 

Default Cap” has the meaning set forth in Section 3.1(c) of this Agreement.

 

Default Rate” means a per annum rate of LIBOR plus 500 basis points.

 

Determination” shall have the meaning ascribed to such term in Section 1313(a) of the Code or any other event (including the execution of IRS Form 870-AD), including a settlement with the applicable Taxing Authority, that establishes the amount of any liability for Tax.

 

Direct Exchange” has the meaning set forth in the Recitals of this Agreement.

 

Dispute” has the meaning set forth in Section 7.8(a) of this Agreement.

 

Early Termination Date” means the date of an Early Termination Notice for purposes of determining the Early Termination Payment.

 

Early Termination Effective Date” means the date on which an Early Termination Schedule becomes binding pursuant to Section 4.2 of this Agreement.

 

Early Termination Notice” has the meaning set forth in Section 4.2 of this Agreement.

 

Early Termination Payment” has the meaning set forth in Section 4.3(b) of this Agreement.

 

Early Termination Rate” means the lesser of (i) 6.5% and (ii) LIBOR plus 100 basis points.

 

Early Termination Schedule” has the meaning set forth in Section 4.2 of this Agreement.

 

5

 

 

Exchange” means any taxable acquisition (including a deemed taxable acquisition under Section 707(a) of the Code) of Class A Units by the Corporate Taxpayer in exchange for Class A Shares and/or other consideration, and any deemed Exchange of Units pursuant to this Agreement.

 

Exchange Date” means the date of any Exchange.

 

Exchanging Holder” has the meaning set forth in the Recitals of this Agreement.

 

Expert” has the meaning set forth in Section 7.9 of this Agreement.

 

Founder Member” means DDM and its permitted transferees.

 

Future TRAs” has the meaning set forth in Section 5.1 of this Agreement.

 

Hypothetical Tax Liability” means, with respect to any Taxable Year, an amount, not less than zero, equal to the liability for Taxes of (i) the Corporate Taxpayer and (ii) without duplication, OpCo (and OpCo’s applicable Subsidiaries), but in the case of this clause (ii) only with respect to Taxes imposed on OpCo (and OpCo’s applicable Subsidiaries) and allocable to the Corporate Taxpayer, in each case using the same methods, elections, conventions, and practices used on the relevant Tax Return of the Corporate Taxpayer, but (a) using the Non-Stepped Up Tax Basis as reflected on the Basis Schedule including amendments thereto for the Taxable Year, (b) excluding any deduction attributable to Imputed Interest attributable to any payment made under this Agreement for the Taxable Year, (c) using the Assumed Rate, solely for purposes of calculating the U.S. state and local Hypothetical Tax Liability of the Corporate Taxpayer, and (d) assuming, solely for purposes of calculating the liability for U.S. federal income Taxes, in order to prevent double counting, that U.S. state and local Taxes are not deductible by the Corporate Taxpayer for U.S. federal income Tax purposes. For the avoidance of doubt, Hypothetical Tax Liability shall be determined without taking into account the carryover or carryback of any Tax item (or portions thereof) that is attributable to a Tax Attribute as applicable.

 

Imputed Interest” in respect of a TRA Party shall mean any interest imputed under Section 1272, 1274, 7872 or 483 or other provision of the Code with respect to the Corporate Taxpayer’s payment obligations in respect of such TRA Party under this Agreement.

 

Interest Amount” has the meaning set forth in Section 3.1(b) of this Agreement.

 

IPO” means the initial public offering of Class A Shares by the Corporate Taxpayer (including any greenshoe related to such initial public offering).

 

IPO Date” means the initial closing date of the IPO.

 

IRS” means the U.S. Internal Revenue Service.

 

Joinder” has the meaning set forth in Section 7.6(a) of this Agreement.

 

6

 

 

LIBOR” means during any period, the rate which appears on the Bloomberg Page BBAM1 (or on such other substitute Bloomberg page that displays rates at which U.S. dollar deposits are offered by leading banks in the London interbank deposit market), or the rate which is quoted by another source selected by the Corporate Taxpayer as an authorized information vendor for the purpose of displaying rates at which U.S. dollar deposits are offered by leading banks in the London interbank deposit market (an “Alternate Source”), at approximately 11:00 a.m., London time, two (2) Business Days prior to the first day of such period as the London interbank offered rate for U.S. dollars having a borrowing date and a maturity comparable to such period or, if such period is longer than one year, the London interbank offered rate for U.S. dollars having a maturity of one year (or if there shall at any time, for any reason, no longer exist a Bloomberg Page BBAM1 (or any substitute page) or any LIBOR Alternate Source, a comparable replacement rate determined by the Corporate Taxpayer at such time, which determination shall be conclusive absent manifest error); provided, that at no time shall LIBOR be less than 0%. If the Corporate Taxpayer has made the determination (such determination to be conclusive absent manifest error) that (i) LIBOR is no longer a widely recognized benchmark rate for newly originated loans in the U.S. loan market in U.S. dollars or (ii) the applicable supervisor or administrator (if any) of LIBOR has made a public statement identifying a specific date after which LIBOR shall no longer be used for determining interest rates for loans in the U.S. loan market in U.S. dollars, then the Corporate Taxpayer shall, subject to the prior written consent of the TRA Party Representative, which consent shall not be unreasonably withheld, conditioned or delayed, establish a replacement interest rate (the “Replacement Rate”), after giving due consideration to any evolving or then prevailing conventions for similar loans in the U.S. loan market in U.S. dollars for such alternative benchmark, and including any mathematical or other adjustments to such benchmark giving due consideration to any evolving or then prevailing convention for similar loans in the U.S. loan market in U.S. dollars for such benchmark, which adjustment, method for calculating such adjustment and benchmark shall be published on an information service as selected from time to time by the Corporate Taxpayer. The Replacement Rate shall, subject to the next two sentences, replace LIBOR for all purposes under this Agreement. In connection with the establishment and application of the Replacement Rate, this Agreement shall be amended solely with the consent of the Corporate Taxpayer and OpCo, as may be necessary or appropriate, in the reasonable judgment of the Corporate Taxpayer, to effect the provisions of this definition. The Replacement Rate shall be applied in a manner consistent with market practice; provided that, in each case, to the extent such market practice is not administratively feasible for the Corporate Taxpayer, such Replacement Rate shall be applied as otherwise reasonably determined by the Corporate Taxpayer.

 

LLC Agreement” means, with respect to OpCo, the Second Amended and Restated Limited Liability Company Agreement of OpCo, dated on or about the date hereof, as such agreement may be further amended, restated, supplemented and/or otherwise modified from time to time.

 

Market Value” shall mean, (i) with respect to an Exchange, the value of the Class A Shares on the applicable Exchange Date determined by the Corporate Taxpayer on a reasonable and consistent basis and used by the Corporate Taxpayer in its U.S. federal income Tax reporting with respect to such Exchange, and (ii) with respect to a deemed Exchange pursuant to Valuation Assumption (6), (A) if the Class A Shares trade on a National Securities Exchange (as defined in the LLC Agreement) or automated or electronic quotation system, the arithmetic average of the high trading price on such date (or if such date is not a Trading Day (as used in this definition, as defined in the LLC Agreement), the immediately preceding Trading Day) and the low trading price on such date (or if such date is not a Trading Day, the immediately preceding Trading Day) or (B) if the Class A Shares are not then traded on a National Securities Exchange or automated or electronic quotation system, as applicable, the Appraiser FMV (as defined in the LLC Agreement) of one (1) Class A Share on such date.

 

7

 

 

Material Objection Notice” has the meaning set forth in Section 4.2 of this Agreement.

 

Net Tax Benefit” has the meaning set forth in Section 3.1(b) of this Agreement.

 

Non-Stepped Up Tax Basis” means, with respect to any Reference Asset at any time, the Tax basis that such asset would have had at such time if no Basis Adjustments had been made.

 

Objection Notice” has the meaning set forth in Section 2.3(a) of this Agreement.

 

OpCo” has the meaning set forth in the Recitals of this Agreement.

 

Opt-Out Notice” has the meaning set forth in Section 4.1(c) of this Agreement.

 

Person” means any individual, corporation, firm, partnership, joint venture, limited liability company, estate, trust, business association, organization, governmental entity or other entity.

 

Pre-Exchange Transfer” means any transfer (including upon death) or distribution in respect of one or more Units (i) that occurs prior to an Exchange of such Units, and (ii) to which Section 734(b) or 743(b) of the Code applies.

 

Realized Tax Benefit” means, for a Taxable Year, the excess, if any, of the Hypothetical Tax Liability over the Actual Tax Liability of (i) the Corporate Taxpayer and (ii) without duplication, OpCo (and OpCo’s applicable Subsidiaries), but only with respect to Taxes imposed on OpCo (and OpCo’s applicable Subsidiaries) that are allocable to the Corporate Taxpayer under Section 704 of the Code. If all or a portion of the Actual Tax Liability for the Taxable Year arises as a result of an audit by a Taxing Authority of any Taxable Year, such liability shall not be included in determining the Realized Tax Benefit unless and until there has been a Determination.

 

Realized Tax Detriment” means, for a Taxable Year, the excess, if any, of the Actual Tax Liability over the Hypothetical Tax Liability of (i) the Corporate Taxpayer and (ii) without duplication, OpCo (and OpCo’s applicable Subsidiaries), but only with respect to Taxes imposed on OpCo (and OpCo’s applicable Subsidiaries) that are allocable to the Corporate Taxpayer under Section 704 of the Code. If all or a portion of the Actual Tax Liability for the Taxable Year arises as a result of an audit by a Taxing Authority of any Taxable Year, such liability shall not be included in determining the Realized Tax Detriment unless and until there has been a Determination.

 

Reconciliation Dispute” has the meaning set forth in Section 7.9 of this Agreement.

 

Reconciliation Procedures” has the meaning set forth in Section 2.3(a) of this Agreement.

 

Redemption” has the meaning set forth in the Recitals of this Agreement.

 

8

 

 

Reference Asset” means any tangible or intangible asset that is held by OpCo, or by any of its direct or indirect Subsidiaries treated as a partnership or disregarded entity (but only to the extent such indirect Subsidiaries are held through Subsidiaries treated as partnerships or disregarded entities) for purposes of the applicable Tax, at the time of an Exchange. A Reference Asset also includes any asset that is “substituted basis property” under Section 7701(a)(42) of the Code with respect to a Reference Asset. For the avoidance of doubt, a Reference Asset does not include an asset held directly or indirectly by a Subsidiary treated as a corporation for U.S. federal income Tax purposes.

 

Schedule” means any of the following: (i) a Basis Schedule; (ii) a Tax Benefit Schedule; or (iii) the Early Termination Schedule.

 

Senior Obligations” has the meaning set forth in Section 5.1 of this Agreement.

 

Subsidiaries” means, with respect to any Person, as of any date of determination, any other Person as to which such Person, owns, directly or indirectly, or otherwise controls more than 50% of the voting power or other similar interests or the sole general partner interest or managing member or similar interest of such Person.

 

Subsidiary Stock” means stock or other equity interest in a Subsidiary of OpCo that is treated as a corporation for U.S. federal income Tax purposes.

 

Tax Attributes” has the meaning set forth in the Recitals of this Agreement.

 

Tax Benefit Payment” has the meaning set forth in Section 3.1(b) of this Agreement.

 

Tax Benefit Schedule” has the meaning set forth in Section 2.2 of this Agreement.

 

Tax Return” means any return, declaration, report or similar statement filed or required to be filed with respect to Taxes (including any attached schedules), including, without limitation, any information return, claim for refund, amended return and declaration of estimated Tax.

 

Taxable Year” means a taxable year of the Corporate Taxpayer as defined in Section 441(b) of the Code or comparable section of state or local Tax law, as applicable (and, therefore, for the avoidance of doubt, may include a period of less than twelve (12) months for which a Tax Return is made), ending after the IPO Date.

 

Taxes” means any and all U.S. federal, state, local and foreign taxes, assessments or similar charges that are based on or measured with respect to net income or profits (including alternative minimum taxes and any franchise taxes that are based on or measured by net income or profits), and any interest related to such Tax.

 

Taxing Authority” means any domestic, federal, national, state, county or municipal or other local government, any subdivision, agency, commission or authority thereof, or any quasi-governmental body exercising any taxing authority or any other authority exercising Tax regulatory authority.

 

TRA Party” has the meaning set forth in the Preamble to this Agreement.

 

9

 

 

TRA Party Representative” means Mark D. Walker.

 

Treasury Regulations” means the final, temporary and proposed regulations under the Code promulgated from time to time (including corresponding provisions and succeeding provisions) as in effect for the relevant taxable period.

 

Units” has the meaning set forth in the Recitals of this Agreement.

 

Valuation Assumptions” shall mean, as of an Early Termination Date, the assumptions that in each Taxable Year ending on or after such Early Termination Date, (1) the Corporate Taxpayer will have taxable income sufficient to fully utilize the Tax items arising from the Tax Attributes (other than any items addressed in clause (2) below) during such Taxable Year or future Taxable Years (including, for the avoidance of doubt, Basis Adjustments and Imputed Interest that would result from future payments made under this Agreement that would be paid in accordance with the Valuation Assumptions) in which such deductions would become available, (2) loss carryovers generated by deductions arising from any Tax Attributes or Imputed Interest that are available as of the date of such Early Termination Date will be used by the Corporate Taxpayer on a pro rata basis from the date of such Early Termination Date through the earlier of (x) the scheduled expiration date under applicable Tax law of such loss carryovers or (y) the fifth (5th) anniversary of the Early Termination Date, (3) the U.S. federal income Tax rates that will be in effect for each such Taxable Year will be those specified for each such Taxable Year by the Code and other law as in effect on the Early Termination Date, the Assumed Rate will be calculated based on such rates and the apportionment factors applicable in the most recently ended Taxable Year (except to the extent any change to such Tax rates has already been enacted into law), and LIBOR or the Replacement Rate, as applicable, that will be in effect for each such Taxable Year will be the rate in effect on the Early Termination Date, (4) any non-amortizable, non-depreciable assets (other than any Subsidiary Stock) will be disposed of on the fifteenth (15th) anniversary of the applicable Exchange and any cash equivalents will be disposed of twelve (12) months following the Early Termination Date, unless such date has passed in which case such assets will be deemed disposed of on the fifth (5th) anniversary of the Early Termination Date; provided, that in the event of a Change of Control, such non-amortizable, non-depreciable assets shall be deemed disposed of at the time of sale (if applicable) of the relevant asset in the Change of Control (if earlier than such fifteenth (15th) anniversary), (5) any Subsidiary Stock will not be deemed to be disposed unless actually disposed, and (6) if, at the Early Termination Date, there are Units that have not been Exchanged, then each such Unit shall be deemed Exchanged for the Market Value (as determined in accordance with clause (ii) of the definition thereof) of the Class A Shares that would be transferred if the Exchange occurred on the Early Termination Date.

 

Article II
Determination of Certain Realized Tax Benefits

 

2.1              Basis Schedule. Within ninety (90) calendar days after the due date (including extensions) of IRS Form 1120 (or any successor form) of the Corporate Taxpayer for each relevant Taxable Year, the Corporate Taxpayer shall deliver to the TRA Party Representative a schedule (the “Basis Schedule”) that shows, in reasonable detail necessary to perform the calculations required by this Agreement, (i) the Non-Stepped Up Tax Basis of the Reference Assets as of each applicable Exchange Date, if any, (ii) the Basis Adjustment with respect to the Reference Assets as a result of the Exchanges effected in such Taxable Year or any prior Taxable Year, if any, calculated (1) in the aggregate and (2) with respect to Exchanges by each TRA Party, and (iii) the period (or periods) over which each such Basis Adjustment is amortizable and/or depreciable. All costs and expenses incurred in connection with the provision and preparation of the Basis Schedules and Tax Benefit Schedules under this Agreement shall be borne by OpCo.

 

10

 

 

2.2              Tax Benefit Schedule.

 

(a)               Tax Benefit Schedule. Within ninety (90) calendar days after the due date (including extensions) of IRS Form 1120 (or any successor form) of the Corporate Taxpayer for any Taxable Year in which there is a Realized Tax Benefit or a Realized Tax Detriment, the Corporate Taxpayer shall provide to the TRA Party Representative a schedule showing, in reasonable detail, the calculation of the Realized Tax Benefit and Tax Benefit Payment, or the Realized Tax Detriment, as applicable, in respect of each TRA Party for such Taxable Year (a “Tax Benefit Schedule”). Each Tax Benefit Schedule will become final as provided in Section 2.3(a) and may be amended as provided in Section 2.3(b) (subject to the procedures set forth in Section 2.3(b)).

 

(b)               Applicable Principles. Subject to Section 3.3, the Realized Tax Benefit (or the Realized Tax Detriment) for each Taxable Year is intended to measure the decrease (or increase) in the actual liability for Taxes of the Corporate Taxpayer for such Taxable Year attributable to the Tax Attributes, determined using a “with and without” methodology. Carryovers or carrybacks of any Tax item attributable to any of the Tax Attributes shall be considered to be subject to the rules of the Code and the Treasury Regulations or the appropriate provisions of U.S. state and local Tax law, as applicable, governing the use, limitation and expiration of carryovers or carrybacks of the relevant type. If a carryover or carryback of any Tax item includes a portion that is attributable to any Tax Attribute (“TRA Portion”) and another portion that is not (“Non-TRA Portion”), such portions shall be considered to be used in accordance with the “with and without” methodology so that the amount of any Non-TRA Portion is deemed utilized, to the extent available, prior to the amount of any TRA Portion, to the extent available (with the TRA Portion being applied on a proportionate basis consistent with the provisions of Section 3.3). For the avoidance of doubt, the Corporate Taxpayer shall be entitled to make reasonable simplifying assumptions in making determinations contemplated by this Agreement, including reasonable assumptions regarding basis recovery periods based on available balance sheet information and including the assumption that the Assumed Rate is to be applied against the amount of taxable income of the Corporate Taxpayer for U.S. federal income Tax purposes that is used in calculating the Actual Tax Liability and the Hypothetical Tax Liability (and the parties hereby agree that that the Corporate Taxpayer’s determination of the Realized Tax Benefit and Realized Tax Detriment with respect to U.S. state and local Taxes will not take into account jurisdiction-specific U.S. state and local adjustments to the U.S. federal taxable income base or to the U.S. federal rules regarding the utilization of Tax attribute carryovers). The parties agree that (A) all Tax Benefit Payments (other than the portion of the Tax Benefit Payments treated as Imputed Interest) attributable to the Basis Adjustments will be treated as subsequent upward purchase price adjustments that have the effect of creating additional Basis Adjustments to Reference Assets for the Corporate Taxpayer in the year of payment, (B) as a result, such additional Basis Adjustments will be incorporated into the current year calculation and into future year calculations, as appropriate, on an iterative basis continuing until any incremental Basis Adjustment is immaterial as reasonably determined by the TRA Party Representative and the Corporate Taxpayer in good faith, (C) the Actual Tax Liability will take into account the deduction of the portion of the Tax Benefit Payment that must be accounted for as Imputed Interest, and (D) the liability for U.S. federal income Taxes of the Corporate Taxpayer and the amount of taxable income of the Corporate Taxpayer for U.S. federal income Tax purposes as determined for purposes of calculating the Actual Tax Liability and the Hypothetical Tax Liability shall include, without duplication, such liability for U.S. federal income Taxes and such U.S. federal taxable income that is economically borne by or allocated to the Corporate Taxpayer as a result of the provisions of Section 4.6(d) of the LLC Agreement; provided, however, that such liability for Taxes and such taxable income shall be included in the Hypothetical Tax Liability and the Actual Tax Liability subject to the adjustments and assumptions set forth in the definitions thereof and, to the extent any such amount is taken into account on an Amended Schedule, such amount shall adjust a Tax Benefit Payment, as applicable, in accordance with Section 2.3(b).

 

11

 

 

2.3              Procedures, Amendments.

 

(a)               Procedures. Every time the Corporate Taxpayer delivers to the TRA Party Representative an applicable Schedule under this Agreement, including any Amended Schedule delivered pursuant to Section 2.3(b), and any Early Termination Schedule or amended Early Termination Schedule, the Corporate Taxpayer shall also (x) deliver to the TRA Party Representative supporting schedules and work papers, as determined by the Corporate Taxpayer or as reasonably requested by the TRA Party Representative, providing reasonable detail regarding data and calculations that were relevant for purposes of preparing the Schedule and (y) allow the TRA Party Representative reasonable access at no cost to the appropriate representatives at the Corporate Taxpayer, as determined by the Corporate Taxpayer or as reasonably requested by the TRA Party Representative, in connection with a review of such Schedule. Without limiting the generality of the preceding sentence, the Corporate Taxpayer shall ensure that any Tax Benefit Schedule that is delivered to the TRA Party Representative, along with any supporting schedules and work papers, provides a reasonably detailed presentation of the calculation of the Actual Tax Liability and the Hypothetical Tax Liability and identifies any material assumptions or operating procedures or principles that were used for purposes of such calculations. An applicable Schedule or amendment thereto shall become final and binding on all parties thirty (30) calendar days from the date on which the TRA Party Representative is treated as having received the applicable Schedule or amendment thereto under Section 7.1 unless the TRA Party Representative (i) within thirty (30) calendar days from such date provides the Corporate Taxpayer with written notice of a material objection to such Schedule (“Objection Notice”) made in good faith or (ii) provides a written waiver of such right of any Objection Notice within the period described in clause (i) above, in which case such Schedule or amendment thereto becomes binding on the date the waiver is received by the Corporate Taxpayer. If the Corporate Taxpayer and the TRA Party Representative, for any reason, are unable to successfully resolve the issues raised in the Objection Notice within thirty (30) calendar days after receipt by the Corporate Taxpayer of an Objection Notice, the Corporate Taxpayer and the TRA Party Representative shall employ the reconciliation procedures as described in Section 7.9 of this Agreement (the “Reconciliation Procedures”).

 

(b)               Amended Schedule. The applicable Schedule for any Taxable Year may be amended from time to time by the Corporate Taxpayer (i) in connection with a Determination affecting such Schedule, (ii) to correct material inaccuracies in the Schedule identified as a result of the receipt of additional factual information relating to a Taxable Year after the date the Schedule was provided to the TRA Party Representative, (iii) to comply with an Expert’s determination under the Reconciliation Procedures, (iv) to reflect a change in the Realized Tax Benefit, or the Realized Tax Detriment for such Taxable Year attributable to a carryback or carryforward of a loss or other Tax item to such Taxable Year, (v) to reflect a change in the Realized Tax Benefit or the Realized Tax Detriment for such Taxable Year attributable to an amended Tax Return filed for such Taxable Year or (vi) to adjust an applicable TRA Party’s Basis Schedule to take into account payments made pursuant to this Agreement (any such Schedule, an “Amended Schedule”). The Corporate Taxpayer shall provide an Amended Schedule to the TRA Party Representative when the Corporate Taxpayer delivers the Basis Schedule for the following taxable year.

 

12

 

 

2.4              Basis Adjustments.

 

(a)               Basis Adjustments. The parties to this Agreement acknowledge and agree to treat (A) to the fullest extent permitted by law each Direct Exchange as giving rise to Basis Adjustments and (B) to the fullest extent permitted by law each Redemption using cash or Class A Shares contributed to OpCo by the Corporate Taxpayer as a direct purchase of Class A Units by the Corporate Taxpayer from the applicable TRA Party pursuant to Section 707(a)(2)(B) of the Code as giving rise to Basis Adjustments.

 

(b)               Section 754 Election. The Corporate Taxpayer shall ensure that, on and after the date hereof for each taxable year in which an Exchange may occur, and each direct and indirect Subsidiary of OpCo that is treated as a partnership for U.S. federal income Tax purposes will have in effect an election under Section 754 of the Code (and under any similar provision of applicable U.S. state or local law).

 

Article III
Tax Benefits Payments

 

3.1              Payments.

 

(a)               Payments. Within five (5) Business Days after a Tax Benefit Schedule delivered to the TRA Party Representative becomes final in accordance with Section 2.3(a) and Section 7.9, if applicable, the Corporate Taxpayer shall pay each TRA Party for the applicable Taxable Year the Tax Benefit Payment determined pursuant to Section 3.1(b) that is Attributable to such TRA Party. Each such Tax Benefit Payment shall be made by wire transfer of immediately available funds to the bank account previously designated by such TRA Party to the Corporate Taxpayer or as otherwise agreed by the Corporate Taxpayer and such TRA Party. For the avoidance of doubt, (x) no Tax Benefit Payment shall be made in respect of estimated Tax payments, including, without limitation, U.S. federal estimated income Tax payments and (y) the payments provided for pursuant to the above sentence shall be computed separately for each TRA Party. A separate Capital Account shall be maintained for each Member, including any Member who shall hereafter acquire an interest in the Company.

 

13

 

 

(b)               A “Tax Benefit Payment” in respect of a TRA Party for a Taxable Year means an amount, not less than zero, equal to the Net Tax Benefit that is Attributable to such TRA Party and the Interest Amount with respect thereto. For the avoidance of doubt, for tax purposes, the Interest Amount shall not be treated as interest, but instead, shall be treated as additional consideration in the applicable transaction, unless otherwise required by law. Subject to Section 3.3, the “Net Tax Benefit” for a Taxable Year shall be an amount equal to the excess, if any, of 85% of the Cumulative Net Realized Tax Benefit as of the end of such Taxable Year, over the total amount of payments previously made under the first sentence of Section 3.1(a) (excluding payments attributable to Interest Amounts); provided, for the avoidance of doubt, that no such recipient shall be required to return any portion of any previously made Tax Benefit Payment. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this Agreement, the parties acknowledge and agree that the determination of the portion of the Tax Benefit Payment to be paid to a TRA Party under this Agreement with respect to U.S. state and local Taxes shall not require separate “with and without” calculations in respect of each applicable U.S. state and local Tax jurisdiction but rather will be based on the U.S. federal taxable income or gain for such taxable year reported on the Corporate Taxpayer’s IRS Form 1120 (or any successor form) and the Assumed Rate. The “Interest Amount” shall equal the interest on the Net Tax Benefit calculated at the Agreed Rate from the due date (without extensions) for filing IRS Form 1120 (or any successor form) of the Corporate Taxpayer with respect to Taxes for such Taxable Year until the payment date under Section 3.1(a). Notwithstanding the foregoing, for each Taxable Year ending on or after the date of a Change of Control that occurs after the IPO Date, all Tax Benefit Payments shall be calculated by utilizing Valuation Assumptions (1), (2), (4) and (5), substituting in each case the terms “date of a Change of Control” for an “Early Termination Date.”

 

(c)               Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, the aggregate payments to a TRA Party under this Agreement in respect of an Exchange shall not exceed 60% of the fair market value of the initial consideration received by a TRA Party on such Exchange (the “Default Cap”), provided that, if a TRA Party delivers written notification before the end of its taxable year that includes the Exchange to the Corporate Taxpayer of a stated maximum selling price (within the meaning of Treasury Regulation 15A.453-1(c)(2)), the amount of the initial consideration received in connection with the applicable Exchange and the aggregate Tax Benefit Payments to such TRA Party in respect of such Exchange (other than amounts accounted for as interest under the Code) shall not exceed such stated maximum selling price, and the Default Cap shall not apply with respect to such TRA Party.

 

3.2              No Duplicative Payments. It is intended that the provisions of this Agreement will not result in duplicative payment of any amount (including interest) required under this Agreement. The provisions of this Agreement shall be construed in the appropriate manner to ensure such intentions are realized.

 

3.3              Pro Rata Payments. Notwithstanding anything in Section 3.1 to the contrary, to the extent that the aggregate Realized Tax Benefit of the Corporate Taxpayer with respect to the Tax Attributes is limited in a particular Taxable Year because the Corporate Taxpayer does not have sufficient taxable income, the Net Tax Benefit of the Corporate Taxpayer shall collectively be allocated among all parties eligible for Tax Benefit Payments under this Agreement in proportion to the amount of Net Tax Benefit, as such term is defined in this Agreement, that would have been Attributable to each such party if the Corporate Taxpayer had sufficient taxable income so that there were no such limitation.

 

14

 

 

3.4              Payment Ordering. If for any reason the Corporate Taxpayer does not fully satisfy its payment obligations to make all Tax Benefit Payments due under this Agreement in respect of a particular Taxable Year, then the Corporate Taxpayer and the TRA Parties agree that (i) Tax Benefit Payments for such Taxable Year shall be allocated to all parties eligible for Tax Benefit Payments under this Agreement in proportion to the amounts of Net Tax Benefit, respectively, that would have been Attributable to each TRA Party if the Corporate Taxpayer had sufficient cash available to make such Tax Benefit Payments and (ii) no Tax Benefit Payments shall be made in respect of any Taxable Year until all Tax Benefit Payments to all TRA Parties in respect of all prior Taxable Years have been made in full.

 

3.5              Excess Payments. To the extent the Corporate Taxpayer makes a payment to a TRA Party in respect of a particular Taxable Year under Section 3.1(a) of this Agreement (taking into account Section 3.3 and Section 3.4) in an amount in excess of the amount of such payment that should have been made to such TRA Party in respect of such Taxable Year, then (i) such TRA Party shall not receive further payments under Section 3.1(a) until such TRA Party has foregone a cumulative amount of payments equal to such excess and (ii) the Corporate Taxpayer will pay the amount of such TRA Party’s foregone payments to the other Persons to whom a payment is due under this Agreement and that have not received any such excess payment in a manner such that each such Person to whom a payment is due under this Agreement, to the maximum extent possible, receives aggregate payments under Section 3.1(a) (taking into account Section 3.3 and Section 3.4) in the amount it would have received if there had been no excess payment to such TRA Party.

 

Article IV
Termination

 

4.1              Early Termination of Agreement; Breach of Agreement.

 

(a)               The Corporate Taxpayer may terminate this Agreement with respect to all amounts payable to the TRA Parties and with respect to all of the Class A Units held by the TRA Parties at any time by paying to each TRA Party the Early Termination Payment in respect of such TRA Party; provided, however, that this Agreement shall only terminate upon the receipt of the Early Termination Payment by all TRA Parties, and provided, further, that the Corporate Taxpayer may withdraw any notice to execute its termination rights under this Section 4.1(a) prior to the time at which any Early Termination Payment has been paid. Upon payment of the Early Termination Payment by the Corporate Taxpayer, none of the TRA Parties or the Corporate Taxpayer shall have any further payment obligations under this Agreement, other than for any (a) Tax Benefit Payments due and payable and that remain unpaid as of the Early Termination Notice and (b) Tax Benefit Payment due for the Taxable Year ending with or including the date of the Early Termination Notice (except to the extent that the amount described in clause (b) is included in the Early Termination Payment). If an Exchange occurs after the Corporate Taxpayer makes all of the required Early Termination Payments, the Corporate Taxpayer shall have no obligations under this Agreement with respect to such Exchange.

 

15

 

 

(b)               In the event that the Corporate Taxpayer (1) materially breaches any of its material obligations under this Agreement, whether as a result of failure to make any payment when due, failure to honor any other material obligation required hereunder or by operation of law as a result of the rejection of this Agreement in a case commenced under the Bankruptcy Code or otherwise or (2)(A) shall commence any case, proceeding or other action (i) under any existing or future law of any jurisdiction, domestic or foreign, relating to bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization or relief of debtors, seeking to have an order for relief entered with respect to it, or seeking to adjudicate a bankruptcy or insolvency, or seeking reorganization, arrangement, adjustment, winding-up, liquidation, dissolution, composition or other relief with respect to it or its debts or (ii) seeking an appointment of a receiver, trustee, custodian, conservator or other similar official for it or for all or any substantial part of its assets, or it shall make a general assignment for the benefit of creditors or (B) there shall be commenced against the Corporate Taxpayer any case, proceeding or other action of the nature referred to in clause (A) above that remains undismissed or undischarged for a period of sixty (60) calendar days, all obligations hereunder shall be automatically accelerated and shall be immediately due and payable, and such obligations shall be calculated as if an Early Termination Notice had been delivered on the date of such breach and shall include, but not be limited to, (1) the Early Termination Payments calculated as if an Early Termination Notice had been delivered on the date of a breach, (2) any Tax Benefit Payment due and payable and that remains unpaid as of the date of a breach, and (3) any Tax Benefit Payment in respect of any TRA Party due for the Taxable Year ending with or including the date of a breach; provided that procedures similar to the procedures of Section 4.2 shall apply with respect to the determination of the amount payable by the Corporate Taxpayer pursuant to this sentence. Notwithstanding the foregoing (other than as set forth in subsection (2) above), in the event that the Corporate Taxpayer breaches this Agreement, each TRA Party shall be entitled to elect to receive the amounts set forth in clauses (1), (2) and (3) above or to seek specific performance of the terms hereof. The parties agree that the failure to make any payment due pursuant to this Agreement within three (3) months of the date such payment is due shall be deemed to be a material breach of a material obligation under this Agreement for all purposes of this Agreement, and that it will not be considered to be a material breach of a material obligation under this Agreement to make a payment due pursuant to this Agreement within three (3) months of the date such payment is due. Notwithstanding anything in this Agreement to the contrary, it shall not be a material breach of a material obligation of this Agreement if the Corporate Taxpayer fails to make any Tax Benefit Payment when due to the extent that the Corporate Taxpayer has insufficient funds to make such payment; provided, (i) the Corporate Taxpayer has used reasonable efforts to obtain such funds and (ii) that the interest provisions of Section 5.2 shall apply to such late payment (unless the Corporate Taxpayer does not have sufficient funds to make such payment as a result of limitations imposed by any Senior Obligations, in which case Section 5.2 shall apply, but the Default Rate shall be replaced by the Agreed Rate); provided further, for the avoidance of doubt, the last sentence of this Section 4.1(b) shall not apply to any payments due pursuant to the acceleration upon a Change of Control contemplated by Section 4.1(c).

 

(c)               The Corporate Taxpayer shall provide written notice to the TRA Party Representative thirty (30) days in advance of the closing of any Change of Control, and the TRA Party Representative shall have the option, upon written notice to the Corporate Taxpayer (“Opt-Out Notice”) within twenty (20) days thereafter, to cause its respective TRA Parties to continue as TRA Parties under this Agreement after such Change of Control, in which case each such TRA Party will not be entitled to receive the amounts set forth in the remainder of this Section 4.1(c), and Valuation Assumptions (1), (2), (4) and (5) shall apply to Tax Benefit Payments to each such TRA Party following the closing of such Change of Control. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in the foregoing sentence in this Section 4.1(c), if an Opt-Out Notice is not timely provided with respect to a TRA Party, all obligations hereunder will be accelerated and such obligations shall be calculated as if an Early Termination Notice had been delivered on the date of such Change of Control and shall include (1) the Early Termination Payments calculated with respect to such TRA Parties as if the Early Termination Date is the date of such Change of Control, (2) any Tax Benefit Payment due and payable and that remains unpaid as of the date of such Change of Control, and (3) any Tax Benefit Payment in respect of any TRA Party due for the Taxable Year ending with or including the date of such Change of Control. If an Opt-Out Notice is not timely provided with respect to a TRA Party, (i) such TRA Party shall be entitled to receive the amounts set forth in clauses (1), (2) and (3) of the preceding sentence, (ii) any Early Termination Payment described in the preceding sentence shall be calculated utilizing Valuation Assumptions (1), (2), (3), (4), (5) and (6), substituting in each case the terms “date of a Change of Control” for an “Early Termination Date,” and (iii) Section 4.2 and Section 4.3 shall apply, mutatis mutandis, with respect to payments to such TRA Party upon the Change of Control.

 

16

 

 

4.2              Early Termination Notice. If the Corporate Taxpayer chooses to exercise its right of early termination under Section 4.1 above, the Corporate Taxpayer shall deliver to each TRA Party notice of such intention to exercise such right (“Early Termination Notice”) and shall deliver to the TRA Party Representative a schedule (the “Early Termination Schedule”) specifying the Corporate Taxpayer’s intention to exercise such right and showing in reasonable detail the calculation of the Early Termination Payment(s) due for each TRA Party. Each Early Termination Schedule shall become final and binding on all parties thirty (30) calendar days from the first date on which all applicable TRA Parties are treated as having received such Schedule or amendment thereto under Section 7.1 unless the TRA Party Representative (i) within thirty (30) calendar days after such date provides the Corporate Taxpayer with notice of a material objection to such Schedule made in good faith (“Material Objection Notice”) or (ii) provides a written waiver of such right of a Material Objection Notice within the period described in clause (i) above, in which case such Schedule becomes binding on the date the waiver is received by the Corporate Taxpayer. If the Corporate Taxpayer and the TRA Party Representative, for any reason, are unable to successfully resolve the issues raised in such notice within thirty (30) calendar days after receipt by the Corporate Taxpayer of the Material Objection Notice, the Corporate Taxpayer and the TRA Party Representative shall employ the Reconciliation Procedures in which case such Schedule becomes binding ten (10) calendar days after the conclusion of the Reconciliation Procedures.

 

4.3              Payment upon Early Termination.

 

(a)               Within three (3) calendar days after an Early Termination Effective Date, the Corporate Taxpayer shall pay to each TRA Party an amount equal to the Early Termination Payment in respect of such TRA Party. Such payment shall be made by wire transfer of immediately available funds to a bank account or accounts designated by such TRA Party or as otherwise agreed by the Corporate Taxpayer and such TRA Party or, in the absence of such designation or agreement, by check mailed to the last mailing address provided by such TRA Party to the Corporate Taxpayer.

 

(b)               Early Termination Payment” in respect of a TRA Party shall equal the present value, discounted at the Early Termination Rate as of the applicable Early Termination Effective Date, of all Tax Benefit Payments in respect of such TRA Party that would be required to be paid by the Corporate Taxpayer beginning from the Early Termination Date and assuming that the Valuation Assumptions in respect of such TRA Party are applied and that each Tax Benefit Payment for the relevant Taxable Year would be satisfied on the due date (without extensions) under applicable law as of the Early Termination Effective Date for filing of IRS Form 1120 (or any successor form) of the Corporate Taxpayer.

 

17

 

 

Article V
Subordination and Late Payments

 

5.1              Subordination. Notwithstanding any other provision of this Agreement to the contrary, any Tax Benefit Payment or payments made with respect to Section 4.1(c) due to events described in paragraph (ii) of the definition of Change of Control required to be made by the Corporate Taxpayer to the TRA Parties under this Agreement shall rank subordinate and junior in right of payment to any principal, interest or other amounts due and payable in respect of any obligations in respect of indebtedness for borrowed money of the Corporate Taxpayer and its Subsidiaries (“Senior Obligations”) and shall rank pari passu in right of payment with all current or future unsecured obligations of the Corporate Taxpayer that are not Senior Obligations. To the extent that any payment under this Agreement is not permitted to be made at the time payment is due as a result of this Section 5.1 and the terms of agreements governing Senior Obligations, such payment obligation nevertheless shall accrue for the benefit of TRA Parties and the Corporate Taxpayer shall make such payments at the first opportunity that such payments are permitted to be made in accordance with the terms of the Senior Obligations. Notwithstanding any other provision of this Agreement to the contrary, to the extent that the Corporate Taxpayer or any of its Affiliates enters into future Tax receivable or other similar agreements (“Future TRAs”), the Corporate Taxpayer shall ensure that the terms of any such Future TRA shall provide that the Tax Attributes subject to this Agreement are considered senior in priority to any Tax attributes subject to any such Future TRA for purposes of calculating the amount and timing of payments under any such Future TRA.

 

5.2              Late Payments by the Corporate Taxpayer. Subject to the proviso in the last sentence of Section 4.1(b), the amount of all or any portion of any Tax Benefit Payment or Early Termination Payment not made to the TRA Parties when due under the terms of this Agreement, whether as a result of Section 5.1 or otherwise, shall be payable together with any interest thereon, computed at the Default Rate and commencing from the date on which such Tax Benefit Payment or Early Termination Payment was first due and payable to the date of actual payment.

 

Article VI
No Disputes; Consistency; Cooperation

 

6.1              Participation in the Corporate Taxpayer’s and OpCo’s Tax Matters. Except as otherwise provided herein, the Corporate Taxpayer shall have full responsibility for, and sole discretion over, all Tax matters concerning the Corporate Taxpayer and OpCo, including without limitation the preparation, filing or amending of any Tax Return and defending, contesting or settling any issue pertaining to Taxes. Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Corporate Taxpayer shall notify the TRA Party Representative of, and keep the TRA Party Representative reasonably informed with respect to, the portion of any audit of the Corporate Taxpayer and OpCo by a Taxing Authority the outcome of which is reasonably expected to materially affect the rights and obligations of the TRA Parties under this Agreement, and shall provide the TRA Party Representative reasonable opportunity to provide information and other input to the Corporate Taxpayer, OpCo and their respective advisors concerning the conduct of any such portion of such audit; provided, however, that the Corporate Taxpayer and OpCo shall not be required to take any action that is inconsistent with any provision of the LLC Agreement.

 

18

 

 

6.2              Consistency. The Corporate Taxpayer and the TRA Parties agree to report and cause to be reported for all purposes, including U.S. federal, state and local Tax purposes and financial reporting purposes, all Tax-related items (including, without limitation, the Tax Attributes and each Tax Benefit Payment) in a manner consistent with that contemplated by this Agreement or specified by the Corporate Taxpayer in any Schedule required to be provided by or on behalf of the Corporate Taxpayer under this Agreement unless otherwise required by law. The Corporate Taxpayer shall (and shall cause OpCo and its other Subsidiaries to) use commercially reasonable efforts (for the avoidance of doubt, taking into account the interests and entitlements of all TRA Parties under this Agreement) to defend the Tax treatment contemplated by this Agreement and any Schedule in any audit, contest or similar proceeding with any Taxing Authority.

 

6.3              Cooperation. Each of the TRA Parties shall (a) furnish to the Corporate Taxpayer in a timely manner such information, documents and other materials in its possession as the Corporate Taxpayer may reasonably request for purposes of making any determination or computation necessary or appropriate under this Agreement, preparing any Tax Return or contesting or defending any audit, examination or controversy with any Taxing Authority, (b) make itself available to the Corporate Taxpayer and its representatives to provide explanations of documents and materials and such other information as the Corporate Taxpayer or its representatives may reasonably request in connection with any of the matters described in clause (a) above, and (c) reasonably cooperate in connection with any such matter, and the Corporate Taxpayer shall reimburse each such TRA Party for any reasonable and documented out-of-pocket costs and expenses incurred pursuant to this Section 6.3. Upon the request of any TRA Party, the Corporate Taxpayer shall cooperate in taking any action reasonably requested by such TRA Party in connection with its tax or financial reporting and/or the consummation of any assignment or transfer of any of its rights and/or obligations under this Agreement, including without limitation, providing any information or executing any documentation.

 

Article VII
Miscellaneous

 

7.1              Notices. All notices, requests, claims, demands and other communications hereunder shall be in writing and shall be deemed duly given and received (a) on the date of delivery if delivered personally, or by facsimile or email with confirmation of transmission by the transmitting equipment or (b) on the first Business Day following the date of dispatch if delivered by a recognized next-day courier service. All notices hereunder shall be delivered as set forth below, or pursuant to such other instructions as may be designated in writing by the party to receive such notice:

 

If to the Corporate Taxpayer, to:

Direct Digital Holdings, Inc.

1233 West Loop South, Suite 1170

Houston, TX 77027

Attention: Mark Walker, Chief Executive Officer

Email: mwalker@directdigitalholdings.com

 

19

 

 

If to the TRA Parties, to the respective addresses, fax numbers and email addresses set forth in the records of OpCo.

 

Any party may change its address or email by giving the other party written notice of its new address or email in the manner set forth above

 

7.2              Counterparts. This Agreement may be executed in one or more counterparts, all of which shall be considered one and the same agreement and shall become effective when one or more counterparts have been signed by each of the parties and delivered to the other parties, it being understood that all parties need not sign the same counterpart. Delivery of an executed signature page to this Agreement by facsimile transmission shall be as effective as delivery of a manually signed counterpart of this Agreement.

 

7.3              Entire Agreement; No Third Party Beneficiary. This Agreement constitutes the entire agreement and supersedes all prior agreements and understandings, both written and oral, among the parties with respect to the subject matter hereof. This Agreement shall be binding upon and inure solely to the benefit of each party hereto and their respective successors and permitted assigns, and nothing in this Agreement, express or implied, is intended to or shall confer upon any other Person any right, benefit or remedy of any nature whatsoever under or by reason of this Agreement.

 

7.4              Governing Law. This Agreement shall be governed by, and construed in accordance with, the law of the State of Delaware.

 

7.5              Severability. If any term or other provision of this Agreement is invalid, illegal or incapable of being enforced by any law or public policy, all other terms and provisions of this Agreement shall nevertheless remain in full force and effect so long as the economic or legal substance of the transactions contemplated hereby is not affected in any manner materially adverse to any party. Upon such determination that any term or other provision is invalid, illegal or incapable of being enforced, the parties hereto shall negotiate in good faith to modify this Agreement so as to effect the original intent of the parties as closely as possible in an acceptable manner in order that the transactions contemplated hereby are consummated as originally contemplated to the greatest extent possible.

 

7.6              Successors; Assignment; Amendments; Waivers.

 

(a)               No TRA Party may, directly or indirectly, assign or otherwise transfer its rights under this Agreement to any Person (other than a permitted transferee) without the express prior written consent of the Corporate Taxpayer, such consent not to be unreasonably withheld, conditioned, or delayed, and without such Person (including a permitted transferee) executing and delivering a joinder to this Agreement, substantially in the form of Exhibit A hereto, agreeing to become a TRA Party for all purposes of this Agreement, except as otherwise provided in such joinder (a “Joinder”). For avoidance of doubt, this Section 7.6(a) shall apply regardless of whether such TRA Party continues to hold any interest in the Corporate Taxpayer or OpCo; provided, however, that if a TRA Party transfers Class A Units in accordance with the terms of the LLC Agreement but does not assign to the transferee of such Units its rights under this Agreement with respect to such transferred Class A Units, such TRA Party shall continue to be entitled to receive the Tax Benefit Payments arising in respect of a subsequent Exchange of such Class A Units. Any assignment, or attempted assignment in violation of this Agreement, including any failure of a purported assignee to enter into a Joinder or to provide any forms or other information to the extent required hereunder, shall be null and void, and shall not bind or be recognized by the Corporate Taxpayer or the TRA Parties. The Corporate Taxpayer shall be entitled to treat the record owner of any rights under this Agreement as the absolute owner thereof and shall incur no liability for payments made in good faith to such owner until such time as a written assignment of such rights is permitted pursuant to the terms and conditions of this Section 7.6(a) and has been recorded on the books of the Corporate Taxpayer.

 

20

 

 

(b)               No provision of this Agreement may be amended unless such amendment is approved in writing by each of the Corporate Taxpayer and by the TRA Party Representative; provided, that no such amendment shall be effective if such amendment will have a disproportionate effect on the payments one or more TRA Parties receive under this Agreement unless such amendment is consented in writing by such TRA Parties disproportionately affected who would be entitled to receive at least two-thirds of the total amount of the Early Termination Payments payable to all TRA Parties disproportionately affected hereunder if the Corporate Taxpayer had exercised its right of early termination on the date of the most recent Exchange prior to such amendment (excluding, for purposes of this sentence, all payments made to any TRA Party pursuant to this Agreement since the date of such most recent Exchange). No provision of this Agreement may be waived unless such waiver is in writing and signed by the party against whom the waiver is to be effective.

 

(c)               All of the terms and provisions of this Agreement shall be binding upon, shall inure to the benefit of and shall be enforceable by the parties hereto and their respective successors, assigns, heirs, executors, administrators and legal representatives. The Corporate Taxpayer shall require and cause any direct or indirect successor (whether by purchase, merger, consolidation or otherwise) to all or substantially all of the business or assets of the Corporate Taxpayer, by written agreement, expressly to assume and agree to perform this Agreement in the same manner and to the same extent that the Corporate Taxpayer would be required to perform if no such succession had taken place.

 

7.7              Titles and Subtitles. The titles of the sections and subsections of this Agreement are for convenience of reference only and are not to be considered in construing this Agreement.

 

7.8              Resolution of Disputes.

 

(a)               Except as provided by Section 7.9, any dispute that is not amicably resolved within thirty (30) days after being notified to the other parties rising out of or relating to this Agreement, including any ancillary claims of any party, arising out of, relating to or in connection with the validity, negotiation, execution, interpretation, performance or non-performance of this Agreement (including the validity, scope and enforceability of this arbitration provision), or the propriety of the commencement of the arbitration (each a “Dispute”) shall be finally settled by arbitration conducted by a single arbitrator in accordance with the then-existing Rules of Arbitration of the International Chamber of Commerce. The seat or legal place of arbitration shall be Houston, Texas. If the parties to the Dispute fail to agree on the selection of an arbitrator within thirty (30) calendar days of the receipt of the request for arbitration, the International Chamber of Commerce shall make the appointment. Performance under this Agreement shall continue if reasonably possible during any arbitration proceedings. The arbitration shall be deemed to meet these qualifications unless a party objects with five (5) days of nomination.

 

21

 

 

(b)               Notwithstanding the provisions of paragraph (a), the Corporate Taxpayer may bring an action or special proceeding in any court of competent jurisdiction for the purpose of compelling a party to arbitrate, seeking temporary or preliminary relief in aid of an arbitration hereunder, enforcing and/or challenging an arbitration award and, for the purposes of this paragraph (b), each TRA Party (i) expressly consents to the application of paragraph (c) of this Section 7.8 to any such action or proceeding, (ii) agrees that proof shall not be required that monetary damages for breach of the provisions of this Agreement would be difficult to calculate and that remedies at law would be inadequate, and (iii) irrevocably appoints the Corporate Taxpayer as agent of such TRA Party for service of process in connection with any such action or proceeding and agrees that service of process upon such agent, who shall promptly advise the TRA Party of any such service of process, shall be deemed in every respect effective service of process upon the TRA Party in any such action or proceeding.

 

(c)               (i) EACH PARTY HEREBY IRREVOCABLY SUBMITS TO THE JURISDICTION OF COURTS LOCATED IN HOUSTON, TEXAS FOR THE PURPOSE OF ANY JUDICIAL PROCEEDING BROUGHT IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE PROVISIONS OF THIS SECTION 7.8, OR ANY JUDICIAL PROCEEDING ANCILLARY TO AN ARBITRATION OR CONTEMPLATED ARBITRATION ARISING OUT OF OR RELATING TO OR CONCERNING THIS AGREEMENT. Such ancillary judicial proceedings include any suit, action or proceeding to compel arbitration, to obtain temporary or preliminary judicial relief in aid of arbitration, or to confirm, enforce or challenge an arbitration award. The parties acknowledge that the fora designated by this paragraph (c) have a reasonable relation to this Agreement, and to the parties’ relationship with one another; and (ii) The parties hereby waive, to the fullest extent permitted by applicable law, any objection which they now or hereafter may have to personal jurisdiction or to the laying of venue of any such ancillary suit, action or proceeding brought in any court referred to in the preceding paragraph of this Section 7.8 and such parties agree not to plead or claim the same.

 

22

 

 

7.9              Reconciliation. In the event that the Corporate Taxpayer and the TRA Party Representative are unable to resolve a disagreement with respect to the matters governed by Sections 2.3 and 4.2 within the relevant period designated in this Agreement (“Reconciliation Dispute”), the Reconciliation Dispute shall be submitted for determination to a nationally recognized expert (the “Expert”) in the particular area of disagreement mutually acceptable to both parties. The Expert shall be a partner or principal in a nationally recognized accounting or law firm, and unless the Corporate Taxpayer and the TRA Party Representative agree otherwise, the Expert shall not, and the firm that employs the Expert shall not, have any material relationship with the Corporate Taxpayer or the TRA Party Representative or other actual or potential conflict of interest. If the Corporate Taxpayer and the TRA Party Representative are unable to agree on an Expert within fifteen (15) calendar days of receipt by the respondent(s) of written notice of a Reconciliation Dispute, then the Expert shall be appointed by the International Chamber of Commerce Centre for Expertise. The Expert shall resolve any matter relating to the TRA Party’s Basis Schedule or an amendment thereto or the Early Termination Schedule or an amendment thereto within thirty (30) calendar days and shall resolve any matter relating to a Tax Benefit Schedule or an amendment thereto within fifteen (15) calendar days or as soon thereafter as is reasonably practicable, in each case after the matter has been submitted to the Expert for resolution. Notwithstanding the preceding sentence, if the matter is not resolved before any payment that is the subject of a disagreement would be due (in the absence of such disagreement) or any Tax Return reflecting the subject of a disagreement is due, the undisputed amount shall be paid on the date prescribed by this Agreement and such Tax Return may be filed as prepared by the Corporate Taxpayer, subject to adjustment or amendment upon resolution. The costs and expenses relating to the engagement of such Expert or amending any Tax Return shall be borne by the Corporate Taxpayer except as provided in the next sentence. The Corporate Taxpayer and the TRA Party Representative shall bear their own costs and expenses of such proceeding, unless (i) the Expert adopts the TRA Party Representative’s position, in which case the Corporate Taxpayer shall reimburse the relevant TRA Party Representative for any reasonable out-of-pocket costs and expenses in such proceeding, or (ii) the Expert adopts the Corporate Taxpayer’s position, in which case the TRA Party Representative shall reimburse the Corporate Taxpayer for any reasonable out-of-pocket costs and expenses in such proceeding. Any dispute as to whether a dispute is a Reconciliation Dispute within the meaning of this Section 7.9 shall be decided by the Expert. The Expert shall finally determine any Reconciliation Dispute and the determinations of the Expert pursuant to this Section 7.9 shall be binding on the Corporate Taxpayer and each of the TRA Parties and may be entered and enforced in any court having jurisdiction.

 

7.10          Withholding. The Corporate Taxpayer shall be entitled to deduct and withhold from any payment payable pursuant to this Agreement such amounts as the Corporate Taxpayer is required to deduct and withhold with respect to the making of such payment under the Code or any provision of state, local or foreign Tax law; provided that, prior to deducting or withholding any such amounts, the Corporate Taxpayer shall notify the TRA Party Representative and shall consult in good faith with such TRA Party Representative regarding the basis for such deduction or withholding. To the extent that amounts are so withheld and paid over to the appropriate Taxing Authority by the Corporate Taxpayer, such withheld amounts shall be treated for all purposes of this Agreement as having been paid to the Person in respect of whom such withholding was made. To the extent that any payment pursuant to this Agreement is not reduced by such deductions or withholdings, such recipient shall indemnify the applicable withholding agent for any amounts imposed by any Taxing Authority together with any costs and expenses related thereto, but not including penalties and interest attributable to the applicable withholding agent’s gross negligence or willful misconduct. Each TRA Party shall promptly provide the Corporate Taxpayer, OpCo or other applicable withholding agent with any applicable Tax forms and certifications (including IRS Form W-9 or the applicable version of IRS Form W-8) reasonably requested, in connection with determining whether any such deductions and withholdings are required under the Code or any provision of state, local or foreign Tax law.

 

23

 

 

7.11          Admission of the Corporate Taxpayer into a Consolidated Group; Transfers of Corporate Assets.

 

(a)               If the Corporate Taxpayer is or becomes a member of an affiliated, consolidated, combined or unitary group of corporations that files a consolidated, combined or unitary income Tax Return pursuant to Sections 1501 et seq. of the Code or any corresponding provisions of state, local or foreign law, then: (i) the provisions of this Agreement shall be applied with respect to the group as a whole; and (ii) Tax Benefit Payments, Early Termination Payments and other applicable items hereunder shall be computed with reference to the consolidated, combined or unitary taxable income, gain, loss, deduction and attributes of the group as a whole.

 

(b)               If the Corporate Taxpayer (or any member of a group described in Section 7.11(a)) transfers or is deemed to transfer any Unit or any Reference Asset to a transferee that is treated as a corporation for U.S. federal income Tax purposes (other than a member of a group described in Section 7.11(a)) in a transaction in which the transferee’s basis in the property acquired is determined in whole or in part by reference to such transferor’s basis in such property, then the Corporate Taxpayer shall cause such transferee to assume the obligation to make payments hereunder with respect to the applicable Tax Attributes associated with any Reference Asset or interest therein acquired (directly or indirectly) in such transfer (taking into account any gain recognized in the transaction) in a manner consistent with the terms of this Agreement as the transferee (or one of its Affiliates) actually realizes Tax benefits from the Tax Attributes.

 

(c)               If OpCo or any applicable Subsidiary transfers (or is deemed to transfer for U.S. federal income Tax purposes) any Reference Asset to a transferee that is treated as a corporation for U.S. federal income Tax purposes (other than a member of a group described in Section 7.11(a)) in a transaction in which the transferee’s basis in the property acquired is determined in whole or in part by reference to such transferor’s basis in such property, OpCo or the applicable Subsidiary shall be treated as having disposed of the Reference Asset in a wholly taxable transaction. The consideration deemed to be received by OpCo or the applicable Subsidiary in the transaction contemplated in the prior sentence shall be equal to the fair market value of the deemed transferred asset, plus (i) the amount of debt to which such asset is subject, in the case of a transfer of an encumbered asset or (ii) the amount of debt allocated to such asset, in the case of a transfer of a partnership interest. The transactions described in this Section 7.11(c) and Section 7.11(e) below shall be taken into account in determining the Realized Tax Benefit or Realized Tax Detriment, as applicable, for such Taxable Year based on the income, gain or loss deemed allocated to the Corporate Taxpayer using the Non-Adjusted Tax Basis of the Reference Assets in calculating its Hypothetical Tax Liability for such Taxable Year and using the actual Tax basis of the Reference Assets in calculating its Actual Tax Liability, determined using the “with and without” methodology. Thus, for example, in determining the Hypothetical Tax Liability of the Corporate Taxpayer, the taxable income of the Corporate Taxpayer shall be determined by treating OpCo as having sold the applicable Reference Asset for its fair market value, recovering any basis applicable to such Reference Asset (using the Non-Adjusted Tax Basis), while the Actual Tax Liability of the Corporate Taxpayer would be determined by recovering the actual Tax basis of the Reference Asset that reflects any Basis Adjustments.

 

(d)               If any member of a group described in Section 7.11(a) that owns any Unit deconsolidates from the group (or the Corporate Taxpayer deconsolidates from the group), then the Corporate Taxpayer shall cause such member (or the parent of the consolidated group in a case where the Corporate Taxpayer deconsolidates from the group) to assume the obligation to make payments hereunder with respect to the applicable Tax Attributes associated with any Reference Asset it owns (directly or indirectly) in a manner consistent with the terms of this Agreement as the member (or one of its Affiliates) actually realizes Tax benefits. If a transferee or a member of a group described in Section 7.11(a) assumes an obligation to make payments pursuant to this Section 7.11(d), then the initial obligor is relieved of the obligation assumed.

 

24

 

 

(e)               If the Corporate Taxpayer (or any member of a group described in Section 7.11(a)) transfers (or is deemed to transfer for U.S. federal income Tax purposes) any Unit in a transaction that is wholly or partially taxable, then for purposes of calculating payments under this Agreement, OpCo shall be treated as having disposed of the portion of any Reference Asset (determined based on a pro rata share of an undivided interest in each Reference Asset) that is indirectly transferred by the Corporate Taxpayer or other entity described above (i.e., taking into account the number of Units transferred) in a wholly or partially taxable transaction, as applicable, in which all income, gain or loss is allocated to the Corporate Taxpayer. The consideration deemed to be received by OpCo shall be equal to the fair market value of the deemed transferred asset, plus (i) the amount of debt to which such asset is subject, in the case of a transfer of an encumbered asset or (ii) the amount of debt allocated to such asset, in the case of a transfer of a partnership interest.

 

7.12          Confidentiality.

 

(a)               Each TRA Party and each of their assignees acknowledge and agree that the information of the Corporate Taxpayer is confidential and, except in the course of performing any duties as necessary for the Corporate Taxpayer and its Affiliates, as required by law or legal process or to enforce the terms of this Agreement, such person shall keep and retain in the strictest confidence and not disclose to any Person any confidential matters, acquired pursuant to this Agreement, of the Corporate Taxpayer and its Affiliates and successors, concerning OpCo, its members and its Affiliates and successors, learned by the TRA Party heretofore or hereafter. This Section 7.12 shall not apply to (i) any information that has been made publicly available by the Corporate Taxpayer or any of its Affiliates, becomes public knowledge (except as a result of an act of the TRA Party in violation of this Agreement) or is generally known to the business community and (ii) the disclosure of information to the extent necessary for the TRA Party to prepare and file its Tax Returns, to respond to any inquiries regarding the same from any Taxing Authority or to prosecute or defend any action, proceeding or audit by any Taxing Authority with respect to such Tax Returns. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein, each TRA Party and each of their assignees (and each employee, representative or other agent of the TRA Party or its assignees, as applicable) may disclose to any and all Persons, without limitation of any kind, the Tax treatment and Tax structure of the Corporate Taxpayer, OpCo and their Affiliates, and any of their transactions, and all materials of any kind (including opinions or other Tax analyses) that are provided to the TRA Party relating to such Tax treatment and Tax structure.

 

(b)               If a TRA Party or an assignee commits a breach, or threatens to commit a breach, of any of the provisions of this Section 7.12, the Corporate Taxpayer shall have the right and remedy to have the provisions of this Section 7.12 specifically enforced by injunctive relief or otherwise by any court of competent jurisdiction without the need to post any bond or other security, it being acknowledged and agreed that any such breach or threatened breach shall cause irreparable injury to the Corporate Taxpayer or any of its Subsidiaries or the TRA Parties and the accounts and funds managed by the Corporate Taxpayer and that money damages alone shall not provide an adequate remedy to such Persons. Such rights and remedies shall be in addition to, and not in lieu of, any other rights and remedies available at law or in equity.

 

25

 

 

7.13          Partnership Agreement. This Agreement shall be treated as part of the LLC Agreement as described in Section 761(c) of the Code and Sections 1.704-1(b)(2)(ii)(h) and 1.761-1(c) of the Treasury Regulations.

 

7.14          Change in Law. Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, if, in connection with an actual or proposed change in law, a TRA Party reasonably believes that the existence of this Agreement could cause income (other than income arising from receipt of a payment under this Agreement) recognized by the TRA Party upon any Exchange by such TRA Party to be treated as ordinary income rather than capital gain (or otherwise taxed at ordinary income rates) for U.S. federal income Tax purposes or would have other material adverse Tax consequences to such TRA Party, then at the election of such TRA Party and to the extent specified by such TRA Party, this Agreement (i) shall cease to have further effect with respect to such TRA Party, (ii) shall not apply to an Exchange by such TRA Party occurring after a date specified by such TRA Party, or (iii) shall otherwise be amended in a manner determined by such TRA Party, provided that such amendment shall not result in an increase in payments under this Agreement at any time as compared to the amounts and times of payments that would have been due in the absence of such amendment.

 

7.15          Electronic Signatures. The words “execution,” “signed,” “signature,” “delivery,” and words of like import in or relating to this Agreement or any document to be signed in connection with this Agreement shall be deemed to include electronic signatures (including pdf or any electronic signature complying with the U.S. federal ESIGN Act of 2000, e.g., www.docusign.com), deliveries or the keeping of records in electronic form, each of which shall be of the same legal effect, validity or enforceability as a manually executed signature, physical delivery thereof or the use of a paper-based recordkeeping system, as the case may be, and the parties hereto consent to conduct the transactions contemplated hereunder by electronic means.

 

[Remainder of page intentionally blank]

 

26

 

 

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Corporate Taxpayer and each TRA Party have duly executed this Agreement as of the date first written above.

 

  Corporate Taxpayer
   
  DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, INC.
   
  By:  
    Name:
    Title:
   
  OpCo:
   
  DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC
   
  By:  
    Name:
    Title:

 

[Signature Page to the Tax Receivable Agreement]

 

 

 

 

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the undersigned have executed this Agreement as of the date first written above.

 

  DIRECT DIGITAL MANAGEMENT, LLC
   
  By:
  By:
  By:  
    Name:
    Title:

 

[Signature Page to the Tax Receivable Agreement]

 

 

 

 

Exhibit A

Form of Joinder

 

This JOINDER (this “Joinder”) to the Tax Receivable Agreement (as defined below), is by and among Direct Digital Holdings, Inc., a Delaware corporation (including any successor corporation the “Corporate Taxpayer”), ______________________ (“Transferor”) and ______________________ (“Permitted Transferee”).

 

WHEREAS, on ______________________, Permitted Transferee shall acquire ______________________ percent of the Transferor’s right to receive payments that may become due and payable under the Tax Receivable Agreement (as defined below) (the “Acquired Interests”) from Transferor (the “Acquisition”); and

 

WHEREAS, Transferor, in connection with the Acquisition, has required Permitted Transferee to execute and deliver this Joinder pursuant to Section 7.6(a) of the Tax Receivable Agreement, dated as of [•], between the Corporate Taxpayer, OpCo and the TRA Parties (as defined therein) (the “Tax Receivable Agreement”).

 

NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the foregoing and the respective covenants and agreements set forth herein, and intending to be legally bound hereby, the parties hereto agree as follows:

 

1.1       Definitions. To the extent capitalized words used in this Joinder are not defined in this Joinder, such words shall have the respective meanings set forth in the Tax Receivable Agreement.

 

1.2       Acquisition. For good and valuable consideration, the sufficiency of which is hereby acknowledged by the Transferor and the Permitted Transferee, the Transferor hereby transfers and assigns absolutely to the Permitted Transferee all of the Acquired Interests.

 

1.3       Joinder. Permitted Transferee hereby acknowledges and agrees (i) that it has received and read the Tax Receivable Agreement, (ii) that the Permitted Transferee is acquiring the Acquired Interests in accordance with and subject to the terms and conditions of the Tax Receivable Agreement and (iii) to become a “TRA Party” (as defined in the Tax Receivable Agreement) for all purposes of the Tax Receivable Agreement.

 

1.4       Notice. Any notice, request, consent, claim, demand, approval, waiver or other communication hereunder to Permitted Transferee shall be delivered or sent to Permitted Transferee at the address set forth on the signature page hereto in accordance with Section 7.1 of the Tax Receivable Agreement.

 

1.5       Governing Law. This Joinder shall be governed by and construed in accordance with the law of the State of Delaware.

 

 

 

 

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, this Joinder has been duly executed and delivered by Permitted Transferee as of the date first above written.

 

  DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, INC.
   
  By:  
    Name:
    Title:
   
  [TRANSFEROR]
   
  By:  
    Name:
    Title:
   
  [PERMITTED TRANSFEREE]
   
  By:  
    Name:
    Title:
    Address for Notices:

 

[Signature Page to Joinder]

 

 

 

 

Exhibit 10.7

 

FIRST AMENDMENT TO CREDIT AGREEMENT

 

This First Amendment to Credit Agreement (“Amendment”), dated as of December 17, 2021 (the “Effective Date”), is entered into by and between Direct Digital Holdings, LLC, a Texas limited liability company (“Direct Digital”), Colossus Media, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company (“Colossus”), Huddled Masses LLC, a Delaware limited liability company (“HM”), Orange142, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company (“Orange”) and Universal Standards for Digital Marketing, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company (“USDM” and together with Direct Digital, Colossus, HM, and Orange, “Borrowers” and each individually a “Borrower”), and East West Bank, a California state bank (“Lender”).

 

RECITALS:

 

WHEREAS, Borrowers and Lender entered into that certain Credit Agreement dated as of September 30, 2020 (as amended, supplemented, or otherwise modified up to the date hereof, the “Existing Credit Agreement”; the Credit Agreement as may be further amended, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time, including by this Amendment, the “Credit Agreement”);

 

WHEREAS, Each Borrower and Lender agree to amend the Existing Credit Agreement as set forth

 

herein;

 

WHEREAS, Lender is willing to amend the Existing Credit Agreement under the terms and conditions set forth herein;

 

NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the premises and for other good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, Borrowers and Lender hereby agree as follows:

 

1.             Same Terms. The terms used in this Amendment shall have the same meanings as provided therefor in the Credit Agreement, unless the context hereof otherwise requires or provides.

 

2. Amendments to Existing Credit Agreement.

 

(a) Exhibit B to the Credit Agreement is amended to read in its entirety as set forth on Exhibit B attached hereto as Annex I.

 

(b) Exhibit C to the Credit Agreement is amended to read in its entirety as set forth on Exhibit C attached hereto as Annex II.

 

(c)           Effective as of the Effective Date, the Existing Credit Agreement is hereby amended by deleting the stricken text (indicated textually in the same manner as the following example: stricken text) and by adding the double-underlined text (indicated textually in the same manner as the following example: double-underlined text) as set forth in Annex III hereto.

 

3.             Ratification. Except as expressly provided herein, each Borrower hereby (a) ratifies the Obligations and each of the Loan Documents to which it is a party, and agrees and acknowledges that the Credit Agreement and each of the other Loan Documents to which it is a party shall continue in full force and effect after giving effect to this Amendment; (b) ratifies and confirms that the security instruments executed by each Borrower, as amended hereby, are not released, diminished, impaired, reduced, or otherwise adversely affected by the Credit Agreement and continue to secure the full payment and performance of the Obligations pursuant to their terms; (c) acknowledges the continuing existence and priority of the Liens granted, conveyed, and assigned to Lender, under the security instruments; and (d) agrees that the Obligations include, without limitation, the Obligations (as amended by this Amendment). Except as expressly provided herein, nothing in this Amendment extinguishes, novates or releases any right, claim, Lien, security interest or entitlement of Lender created by or contained in any of such documents nor is any Borrower released from any covenant, warranty or obligation created by or contained therein.

 

 

 

 

4.             Representations and Warranties. Each Borrower hereby represents and warrants to Lender that (a) this Amendment has been duly authorized, executed, and delivered by each Borrower; (b) no action of, or filing with, any Governmental Authority is required to authorize, or is otherwise required in connection with, the execution, delivery, and performance by each Borrower of this Amendment; (c) the Loan Documents, as amended by this Amendment, are valid and binding upon each Borrower and are enforceable against each such Borrower, in accordance with their respective terms, except as limited by Debtor Relief Laws; (d) the execution, delivery, and performance by each Borrower of this Amendment does not require the consent of any other Person and do not and will not constitute a violation of any laws, agreements, or understandings to which each such Borrower is a party or by which each such Borrower is bound; (e) all representations and warranties in the Loan Documents are true and correct in all material respects except (i) to the extent that such representations and warranties specifically refer to an earlier date, in which case they shall be true and correct in all material respect as of such earlier date or (ii) the facts on which any of them were based have been changed by transactions contemplated or permitted by the Credit Agreement; and (f) no Event of Default exists.

 

5.             Other Agreements. Each Borrower (a) agrees to perform such acts and duly authorize, execute, acknowledge, deliver, file, and record such additional pledges, and other agreements, documents, instruments, and certificates as Lender may reasonably deem necessary or appropriate in order to preserve and protect the Collateral granted by such Borrower pursuant to the security instruments executed by such Borrower; and (b) represents and warrants to Lender that such liability and obligation may reasonably be expected to directly or indirectly benefit each Borrower.

 

6.             Conditions to Effectiveness. The transactions contemplated by this Amendment shall be deemed to be effective as of the Effective Date, when the following have been satisfied in a manner satisfactory to Lender:

 

(a)        all representations and warranties set forth in this Amendment are true and correct in all material respects as set forth in Section 4 above;

 

(b)        Lender receives a fully executed copy of this Amendment;

 

(c)        Lender receives a Revolving Credit Note in the aggregate principal amount of $5,000,000;

 

(d)        Lender receives a copy of authorizing resolutions of the applicable governing body of each Borrower which authorize the execution, delivery, and performance of this Amendment, including, without limitation, the increase in the Commitment;

 

(e)        Keith Smith and Mark Walker will enter into subordination agreements in form and substance reasonably acceptable to the Lender with respect to the management fees payable under and pursuant to the Board Services and Consulting Agreements each dated as of September 30, 2020, by and between Direct Digital, on the one hand, and Keith Smith and Mark Walker on the other hand;

 

(f)        Lender receives payment of (i) a non-refundable amendment fee in an amount equal to $50,000, and (ii) the reasonable and documented out-of-pocket fees and expenses of Lender’s counsel incurred in connection with this Amendment in immediately available funds to the extent invoiced on or prior to the date hereof; and

 

(g)        after giving effect to this Amendment, no Default or Event of Default exists under the Credit Agreement.

 

2

 

 

7.             Counterparts. For the convenience of the parties, this Amendment may be executed in multiple counterparts, each of which for all purposes shall be deemed to be an original, and all such counterparts shall together constitute but one and the same agreement. Delivery of an executed counterpart of a signature page of this Amendment by telecopy, e-mail, facsimile transmission, electronic mail in “portable document format” (“.pdf”) form or other electronic means intended to preserve the original graphic and pictorial appearance of the item being sent shall be effective as a delivery of a manually executed counterpart of this Amendment.

 

8.             References to the Credit Agreement. Upon the effectiveness of this Amendment, (a) each reference in the Credit Agreement to “this Agreement”, “hereunder”, “hereof”, “herein”, or words of like import shall mean and be a reference to the Existing Credit Agreement as amended hereby, and (b) each reference to the Credit Agreement in any other document, instrument or agreement executed and/or delivered in connection with the Credit Agreement shall mean and be a reference to the Existing Credit Agreement as amended hereby.

 

9.             Effect. This Amendment is one of the Loan Documents. The modifications set forth herein are limited precisely as written and shall not be deemed (a) to be a consent under or a waiver of or an amendment to any other term or condition in the Credit Agreement, or (b) to prejudice any right or rights which the Lender now has or may have in the future under or in connection with the Credit Agreement, as amended hereby, or any of the other documents referred to herein or therein.

 

10.           ENTIRE AGREEMENT. THIS AMENDMENT CONSTITUTES THE ENTIRE AGREEMENT BETWEEN THE PARTIES HERETO WITH RESPECT TO THE SUBJECT HEREOF. FURTHERMORE, IN THIS REGARD, THIS AMENDMENT AND THE OTHER WRITTEN LOAN DOCUMENTS REPRESENT, COLLECTIVELY, THE FINAL AGREEMENT AMONG THE PARTIES THERETO AND MAY NOT BE CONTRADICTED BY EVIDENCE OF PRIOR, CONTEMPORANEOUS, OR SUBSEQUENT ORAL AGREEMENTS OF SUCH PARTIES.

 

THERE ARE NO UNWRITTEN ORAL AGREEMENTS AMONG SUCH PARTIES

 

[REMAINDER OF PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK]

 

3

 

 

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, this Amendment is deemed executed effective as of the date first above written.

 

  BORROWERS:
   
  DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC
   
  By: /s/ Keith W. Smith
    Name: Keith W. Smith
    Title: President

 

  COLOSSUS MEDIA, LLC
   
  By: /s/ Keith W. Smith
    Name: Keith W. Smith
    Title: President
   
  HUDDLED MASSES LLC
   
  By: /s/ Keith W. Smith
    Name: Keith W. Smith
    Title: President
   
  ORANGE142, LLC
   
  By: /s/ Keith W. Smith
    Name: Keith W. Smith
    Title: President

 

Signature Page to 

First Amendment to Credit Agreement

 

 

 

 

  UNIVERSAL STANDARDS FOR DIGITAL MARKETING, LLC
   
  By: /s/ Keith W. Smith
    Name: Keith W. Smith
    Title: President

 

Signature Page to 

First Amendment to Credit Agreement

 

 

 

 

  EAST WEST BANK,
  a California state bank
   
  By: /s/ Hamilton LaRoe
    Hamilton LaRoe
    First Vice President

 

Signature Page to 

First Amendment to Credit Agreement

 

 

 

 

ANNEX I

 

EXHIBIT B

 

(See attached)

 

 

 

 

 

  EXHIBIT B

 

COMPLIANCE CERTIFICATE

 

FOR QUARTER ENDED ____________________ (THE “SUBJECT QUARTER”)

BANK: EAST WEST BANK
BORROWERS: Direct  Digital  Holdings,  LLC,  a  Texas  limited  liability  company  (“Direct Digital”),  Colossus  Media,  LLC,  a  Delaware  limited liability company (“Colossus”),  Huddled  Masses  LLC,  a  Delaware  limited liability company (“HM”), Orange142, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company (“Orange”) and Universal Standards for Digital Marketing, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company  (“USDM”  and  together  with  Direct  Digital,  Colossus,  HM,  and Orange, “Borrowers” and each individually a “Borrower”)

 

This Certificate is delivered under the Credit Agreement (the “Agreement”) dated as of September 30, 2020, by and among Borrowers and Bank as such may have been amended, supplemented or replaced. Capitalized terms used in this Certificate shall, unless otherwise indicated, have the meanings set forth in the Agreement. On behalf of Borrowers, the undersigned certifies to Bank on the date hereof that (a) no Default or Event of Default has occurred and is continuing, (b) all representations and warranties of Borrowers contained in the Agreement and in the other Loan Documents are true and correct in all material respects, and (c) the information set forth below hereto is true and correct as of the last day of the Subject Quarter:

 

DESCRIPTION OF COVENANT

 

(1) Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio of not less than 1.25 to 1.0 (Section 9.01 of Agreement)   to 1.0
   
(2) Total Leverage Ratio of not greater than (Section 9.02 of Agreement):     to 1.0

 

       
  December 31, 2020 3.00:1.00  
  March 31, 2021 3.00:1.00  
  June 30, 2021 2.75:1:00  
  September 30, 2021 2.75:1:00  
  December 31, 2021 2.50:1:00  
  and thereafter 3.75:1:00  
  March 31, 2022 2.50:1:00  
  June 30, 2022 2.25:1:00  
  September 30, 2022 2.25:1:00  
  and thereafter    

 

(3) Liquid Assets plus Revolving Credit Availability in the minimum amount of:  

 

  September 30, 2020 – June 29, 2021 $1,000,000  
  June 30, 2021 – December 30, 2021 $1,100,000  
  December 31, 2021 – June 29, 2022 $1,250,000  
  June 30, 2022 and thereafter $1,350,000  

 

4834-9142-1879 v.10 Exhibit A

 

 

(Section 9.03 of the Agreement) $__________________

  

4834- 9142- 1879 v.10 A-6  

 

 

  BORROWERS:
   
  DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC
   
  By:  
    Name:
    Title:

 

  COLOSSUS MEDIA, LLC
   
  By:  
    Name:
    Title:

 

  HUDDLED MASSES LLC
   
  By:  
    Name:
    Title:

 

  ORANGE142, LLC
   
  By:  
    Name:
    Title:

 

  UNIVERSAL STANDARDS FOR DIGITAL MARKETING, LLC
   
  By:  
    Name:
    Title:

 

Exhibit A

 

 

ANNEX II

 

EXHIBIT C

 

(See attached)

 

 

 

Anything herein to the contrary notwithstanding, the Liens and security interests securing the obligations evidenced by this revolving credit note, the exercise of any right or remedy with respect hereto and certain of the rights of the holder hereof are subject to the provisions of the Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of December 3, 2021 (as amended, restated, supplemented, substituted, replaced or otherwise modified from time to time, the "Intercreditor Agreement"), by and between Lafayette Square Loan Servicing, LLC (in its capacity as agent for the LS Facility Lenders and together with its successors and assigns, the "LS Facility Agent"), for and on behalf of the LS Facility Creditors and each other LS Facility Claimholder (each as defined in the Intercreditor Agreement) from time to time, and East West Bank (“EWB”), acting on behalf of each A/R Facility Claimholder (as defined in the Intercreditor Agreement). In the event of any conflict between the terms of the Intercreditor Agreement and this revolving credit note, the terms of the Intercreditor Agreement shall govern and control.

 

REVOLVING CREDIT NOTE

 

$5,000,000 December 17, 2021

 

FOR VALUE RECEIVED, Direct Digital Holdings, LLC, a Texas limited liability company (“Direct Digital”), Colossus Media, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company (“Colossus”), Huddled Masses LLC, a Delaware limited liability company (“HM”), Orange142, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company (“Orange”) and Universal Standards for Digital Marketing, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company (“USDM” and together with Direct Digital, Colossus, HM, and Orange, collectively, “Borrower”), hereby unconditionally, jointly and severally, promise to pay to the order of EAST WEST BANK, a California state bank (“Lender”), in accordance with the provisions of the Credit Agreement (as hereinafter defined), the principal sum of Five Million Dollars ($5,000,000), or such other amount as may from time to time be advanced by Lender as Revolving Credit Advance to or for the benefit or account of Borrower pursuant to the terms of that certain Credit Agreement, dated as of the date hereof (as amended, restated, extended, supplemented or otherwise modified in writing from time to time, the “Credit Agreement;” the terms defined therein being used herein as therein defined), between Borrower and Lender.

 

Borrower promises to pay interest on the unpaid principal amount of this Note from the date hereof until the Revolving Credit Advances made by Lender are paid in full, at such interest rates and at such times as provided in the Credit Agreement. All payments of principal and interest shall be made to Lender in Dollars in immediately available funds at Lender’s Principal Office. If any amount is not paid in full when due hereunder, then such unpaid amount shall bear interest, to be paid upon demand, from the due date thereof until the date of actual payment (and before as well as after judgment) computed at the per annum rate set forth in the Credit Agreement.

 

This Note is the Revolving Credit Note referred to in the Credit Agreement, is entitled to the benefits thereof and may be prepaid in whole or in part subject to the terms and conditions provided therein. This Note is also entitled to the benefits of the Guaranty. Upon the occurrence and continuation of one or more of the Events of Default specified in the Credit Agreement, all amounts then remaining unpaid on this Note shall become, or may be declared to be, immediately due and payable all as provided in the Credit Agreement. Lender may also attach schedules to this Note and endorse thereon the date, amount and maturity of its Revolving Credit Advances and payments with respect thereto.

 

Borrower, for itself, its successors and assigns, hereby waives diligence, presentment, protest and demand and notice of protest, demand, dishonor and non-payment of this Note.

 

Exhibit B

 

 

THIS NOTE, AND ANY CLAIM, CONTROVERSY, OR DISPUTE ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THIS NOTE, SHALL BE GOVERNED BY AND CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF TEXAS.

 

[Remainder of Page Intentionally Left Blank; 

Signature Page Follows.]

 

Exhibit B

 

 

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, Borrower, intending to be legally bound hereby, has duly executed this Note as of the day and year first written above.

 

  BORROWER:
   
  DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC
   
  By:  
    Name:
    Title:

 

  COLOSSUS MEDIA, LLC
   
  By:  
    Name:
    Title:

 

  HUDDLED MASSES LLC
   
  By:  
    Name:
    Title:

 

  ORANGE142, LLC
   
  By:  
    Name:
    Title:

 

  UNIVERSAL STANDARDS FOR DIGITAL MARKETING, LLC
   
  By:  
    Name:
    Title:

 

Exhibit B

 

 

ANNEX III

 

CONFORMED CREDIT AGREEMENT

 

(See attached)

 

Exhibit B

 

 

Conformed Copy

 

 

CREDIT AGREEMENT

 

by and among

 

DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC

 

COLOSSUS MEDIA, LLC

 

HUDDLED MASSES LLC

 

ORANGE142, LLC

 

UNIVERSAL STANDARDS FOR DIGITAL MARKETING, LLC

 

and

 

EAST WEST BANK

 

 

Dated as of September 30, 2020

 

(as amended through the First Amendment to Credit Agreement dated as of December 17, 2021)

 

 

 

 

TABLE OF CONTENTS
    Page
     
ARTICLE I. DEFINITIONS 1
1.01 Definitions 22
1.02 Accounting Matters 23
1.03 Other Definitional Provisions 23
ARTICLE II. ADVANCES 23
2.01 Advances 23
2.02 General Provisions Regarding Interest, Etc. 24
2.03 Unused Facility Fee 25
2.04 Use of Proceeds 26
2.05 Late Charges 27
2.06 Funding Loss 27
ARTICLE III. PAYMENTS 27
3.01 Method of Payment 27
3.02 Prepayments 27
ARTICLE IV. SECURITY 28
4.01 Collateral 28
4.02 Setoff 28
ARTICLE V. CONDITIONS PRECEDENT 28
5.01 Initial Extension of Credit 28
5.02 All Extensions of Credit 30
ARTICLE VI. REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES 31
6.01 Corporate Existence 31
6.02 Financial Statements, Etc. 31
6.03 Action; No Breach 31
6.04 Operation of Business 31
6.05 Litigation and Judgments 32
6.06 Rights in Properties; Liens 32
6.07 Enforceability 32
6.08 Approvals 32
6.09 Taxes 32
6.10 Use of Proceeds; Margin Securities 32
6.11 ERISA 32
6.12 Disclosure 33
6.13 Subsidiaries, Ventures, Etc. 33
6.14 Agreements 33
6.15 Compliance with Laws 33
6.16 Regulated Entities 33
6.17 Environmental Matters 33
6.18 Intellectual Property 34
6.19 Foreign Assets Control Regulations and Anti-Money Laundering 35
6.20 Patriot Act 35
6.21 Solvency 35
6.22 Anti-Corruption Laws 35
6.23 Beneficial Ownership Regulation 35

 

i 

 

 

ARTICLE VII. AFFIRMATIVE COVENANTS 36
7.01 Reporting Requirements 36
7.02 Maintenance of Existence; Conduct of Business 37
7.03 Maintenance of Properties 37
7.04 Taxes and Claims 37
7.05 Insurance 38
7.06 Inspection Rights 38
7.07 Keeping Books and Records 38
7.08 Compliance with Laws 39
7.09 Compliance with Agreements 39
7.10 Further Assurances 39
7.11 ERISA 39
7.12 Depository Relationship 39
7.13 Subsidiaries 39
7.14 Keepwell 39
ARTICLE VIII. NEGATIVE COVENANTS 40
8.01 Debt 40
8.02 Limitation on Liens 40
8.03 Mergers, Etc 40
8.04 Restricted Payments 41
8.05 Loans and Investments 41
8.06 Limitation on Issuance of Equity 41
8.07 Transactions with Affiliates 41
8.08 Disposition of Assets 42
8.09 Sale and Leaseback 42
8.10 Nature of Business 42
8.11 Environmental Protection 42
8.12 Accounting 42
8.13 No Negative Pledge 42
8.14 Subsidiaries 42
8.15 Hedge Agreements 42
8.16 OFAC 43
8.17 Payments under Term Loan Agreement 43
8.18 Payments on Preferred Equity 43
ARTICLE IX. FINANCIAL COVENANTS 43
9.01 Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio 43
9.02 Total Leverage Ratio 43
9.03 43
9.04 Liquid Assets 44
ARTICLE X. DEFAULT 44
10.01 Events of Default 44
10.02 Remedies Upon Default 46
10.03 Performance by Lender 46
10.04 Equity Cure 46

ii 

 

 

ARTICLE XI. MISCELLANEOUS 47
11.01 Expenses 47
11.02 INDEMNIFICATION 47
11.03 Limitation of Liability 48
11.04 No Duty 48
11.05 Lender Not Fiduciary 48
11.06 Equitable Relief 48
11.07 No Waiver; Cumulative Remedies 48
11.08 Successors and Assigns 48
11.09 Survival 48
11.10 ENTIRE AGREEMENT; AMENDMENT 49
11.11 Notices 49
11.12 Governing Law; Venue; Service of Process 49
11.13 Counterparts 50
11.14 Severability 50
11.15 Headings 50
11.16 Participations, Etc. 50
11.17 Construction 50
11.18 Independence of Covenants 50
11.19 WAIVER OF JURY TRIAL 50
11.20 Additional Interest Provision 51
11.21 Ceiling Election 52
11.22 USA Patriot Act Notice 52
11.01 Intercreditor Legend 52

 

SCHEDULES
 
6.13 Subsidiaries, Ventures, Etc.
6.18 Intellectual Property
8.01 Existing Debt
8.02 Existing Liens
8.05 Existing Investments

 

EXHIBITS    
     
A. Borrowing Base Report 1.01
B. Compliance Certificate 1.01
C. Revolving Credit Note 2.01

 

iii 

 

 

CREDIT AGREEMENT

 

THIS CREDIT AGREEMENT (this “Agreement”), dated as of September 30, 2020 is by and among Direct Digital Holdings, LLC, a Texas limited liability company (“Direct Digital”), Colossus Media, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company (“Colossus”), Huddled Masses LLC, a Delaware limited liability company (“HM”), Orange142, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company (“Orange”) and Universal Standards for Digital Marketing, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company (“USDM” and together with Direct Digital, Colossus, HM, and Orange, “Borrowers” and each individually a “Borrower”), and East West Bank, a California state bank (“Lender”).

 

RECITALS:

 

Borrowers have requested that Lender extend credit to Borrowers as described in this Agreement. Lender is willing to make such credit available to Borrowers upon and subject to the provisions, terms and conditions hereinafter set forth.

 

NOW THEREFORE, in consideration of the premises and the mutual covenants herein contained, the parties hereto agree as follows:

 

ARTICLE I.  

DEFINITIONS

 

1.01 Definitions. As used in this Agreement, all exhibits, appendices and schedules hereto and in any note, certificate, report or other Loan Documents made or delivered pursuant to this Agreement, the following terms will have the meanings given such terms in this Article I or in the provision, section or recital referred to below:

 

Acquisition” means the acquisition by any Person of (a) a majority of the Equity Interests of another Person, (b) all or substantially all of the assets of another Person or (c) all or substantially all of a business unit or line of business of another Person, in each case (i) whether or not involving a merger or consolidation with such other Person and (ii) whether in one transaction or a series of related transactions.

 

Advance” means an advance by Lender to Borrowers pursuant to Article II.

 

Advance Request Form” means a certificate, in a form approved by Lender, properly completed and signed by Borrowers requesting a Revolving Credit Advance.

 

Affiliate” means, as to any Person, any other Person (a) that directly or indirectly, through one or more intermediaries, controls or is controlled by, or is under common control with, such Person; (b) that directly or indirectly beneficially owns or holds five percent (5%) or more of any class of voting stock of such Person; or (c) five percent (5%) or more of the voting stock of which is directly or indirectly beneficially owned or held by the Person in question. The term “control” means the possession, directly or indirectly, of the power to direct or cause direction of the management and policies of a Person, whether through the ownership of voting securities, by contract, or otherwise; provided, however, in no event shall Lender be deemed an Affiliate of Borrowers or any of their Affiliates or the Subsidiaries.

 

Agreement” has the meaning set forth in the Introductory Paragraph hereto, as the same may, from time to time, be amended, modified, restated, renewed, waived, supplemented, or otherwise changed, and includes all schedules, exhibits and appendices attached or otherwise identified therewith.

 

 

 

 

“Available Tenor” means, as of any date of determination and with respect to the then-current Benchmark, as applicable, (x) if the then-current Benchmark is a term rate, any tenor for such Benchmark that is or may be used for determining the length of an Interest Period or (y) otherwise, any payment period for interest calculated with reference to such Benchmark, as applicable, pursuant to this Agreement as of such date.

 

“Benchmark” means, initially, USD LIBOR; provided that if a replacement of the Benchmark has occurred pursuant to this Section titled “Benchmark Replacement Setting”, then “Benchmark” means the applicable Benchmark Replacement to the extent that such Benchmark Replacement has replaced such prior benchmark rate. Any reference to “Benchmark” shall include, as applicable, the published component used in the calculation thereof.

 

“Benchmark Replacement” means, for any Available Tenor:

 

(a)                For purposes of clause (a) of this Section, the first alternative set forth below that can be determined by the Lender:

 

(i)                 the sum of: (i) Term SOFR and (ii) 0.11448% (11.448 basis points) for an Available Tenor of one-month’s duration, 0.26161% (26.161 basis points) for an Available Tenor of three-months’ duration, 0.42826% (42.826 basis points) for an Available Tenor of six-months’ duration, and 0.71513% (71.513 basis points) for an Available Tenor of 12-month’s duration; or

 

(ii)               the sum of: (i) SOFR Average and (ii) 0.11448% (11.448 basis points).

 

(b)                For purposes of clause (b) of this Section, the sum of (a) the alternate benchmark rate and (b) an adjustment (which may be a positive or negative value or zero), in each case, that has been selected by the Lender as the replacement for such Available Tenor of such Benchmark giving due consideration to any evolving or then-prevailing market convention, including any applicable recommendations made by the Relevant Governmental Body, for U.S. dollar-denominated syndicated or bilateral credit facilities at such time;

 

provided that, (i) notwithstanding (a)(i) and (b) above, if the Borrower has a Hedge Agreement in place on the USD LIBOR Transition Date with the Lender for the purposes of hedging the Loan, the Benchmark Replacement will be the sum of: (i) Daily Simple SOFR and (ii) the spread adjustment selected or recommended by the Relevant Governmental Body for the replacement of the tenor of USD LIBOR with a SOFR-based rate having approximately the same length as the interest payment period specified in clause (a) of this Section; and (ii) if the Benchmark Replacement would be less than the Floor, the Benchmark Replacement will be deemed to be the Floor for the purposes of this Agreement and the other Loan Documents.

 

“Benchmark Replacement Conforming Changes” means, with respect to any Benchmark Replacement, any technical, administrative or operational changes (including changes to the definition of “ABR,” the definition of “Business Day,” the definition of “Interest Period,” timing and frequency of determining rates and making payments of interest, timing of borrowing requests or prepayment, conversion or continuation notices, the applicability and length of lookback periods, the applicability of breakage provisions, and other technical, administrative or operational matters) that the Lender decides may be appropriate to reflect the adoption and implementation of such Benchmark Replacement and to permit the administration thereof by the Lender in a manner substantially consistent with market practice (or, if the Lender decides that adoption of any portion of such market practice is not administratively feasible or if the Lender determines that no market practice for the administration of such Benchmark Replacement exists, in such other manner of administration as the Lender decides is reasonably necessary in connection with the administration of this Agreement and the other Loan Documents).

 

2 

 

 

“Benchmark Transition Event” means, with respect to any then-current Benchmark other than USD LIBOR, the occurrence of a public statement or publication of information by or on behalf of the administrator of the then-current Benchmark, the regulatory supervisor for the administrator of such Benchmark, the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System, the Federal Reserve Bank of New York, an insolvency official with jurisdiction over the administrator for such Benchmark, a resolution authority with jurisdiction over the administrator for such Benchmark or a court or an entity with similar insolvency or resolution authority over the administrator for such Benchmark, announcing or stating that (a) such administrator has ceased or will cease on a specified date to provide all Available Tenors of such Benchmark, permanently or indefinitely, provided that, at the time of such statement or publication, there is no successor administrator that will continue to provide any Available Tenor of such Benchmark or (b) all Available Tenors of such Benchmark are or will no longer be representative of the underlying market and economic reality that such Benchmark is intended to measure and that representativeness will not be restored.

 

Beneficial Ownership Certification” means a certification regarding beneficial ownership required by the Beneficial Ownership Regulation, which certification shall be substantially in form and substance satisfactory to Lender.

 

Beneficial Ownership Regulation” means 31 C.F.R. §1010.230.

 

Borrowers” means the Persons identified as such in the Introductory Paragraph hereof, and their successors and assigns, and “Borrower” means any one of the Borrowers.

 

Borrowing Base” means, at any time, an amount equal to the lesser of (a) $1,000,0002,500,000 (the “Initial Borrowing Cap”) or (b) the sum of fifty percent (50%) of the value of Eligible Accounts. Notwithstanding the foregoing, if the Lender and the Term Loan Lender expressly consent in writing, the Initial Borrowing Cap may be removed.

 

Borrowing Base Report” means, as of any date of preparation, a certificate setting forth the Borrowing Base (in a form acceptable to Lender in substantially the form of Exhibit A attached hereto) prepared by and certified by a Responsible Officer of Borrower.

 

Business Day” means any day other than a Saturday or a Sunday or any day on which commercial banks in Los Angeles, California, are authorized or required to close, and, if the applicable Business Day relates to a LIBOR Amount, such day also must be a day on which U.S. Dollar deposits are traded by and between banks in the London interbank Eurodollar market.

 

Capital Expenditure” shall mean any expenditure by a Person for (a) an asset which will be used in a year or years subsequent to the year in which the expenditure is made and which asset is properly classified in relevant financial statements of such Person as equipment, real property, a fixed asset or a similar type of capitalized asset in accordance with GAAP or (b) an asset relating to or acquired in connection with an acquired business, and any and all acquisition costs related to (a) or (b) above.

 

Capitalized Lease Obligation” shall mean the amount of Debt under a lease of Property by a Person that would be shown as a liability on a balance sheet of such Person prepared for financial reporting purposes in accordance with GAAP.

 

3 

 

 

Cash and Cash Equivalents” shall mean, with respect to any Person, an unrestricted or unencumbered (A) cash and (B) any of the following: (x) marketable direct obligations issued or unconditionally guaranteed by the United States Government or issued by an agency thereof and backed by the full faith and credit of the United States; (y) marketable direct obligations issued by any state of the United States of America or any political subdivision of any such state or any public instrumentality thereof which, at the time of acquisition, has one of the two highest ratings obtainable from any two of S&P Global Ratings, Moody’s Investors Service, Inc. or Fitch Investors (or, if at any time no two of the foregoing shall be rating such obligations, then from such other nationally recognized rating services as may be acceptable to Lender) and is not listed for possible down-grade in any publication of any of the foregoing rating services; (z) domestic certificates of deposit or domestic time deposits or repurchase agreements issued by any commercial bank organized under the laws of the United States of America or any state thereof or the District of Columbia having combined capital and surplus of not less than $500,000,000.00, which commercial bank has a rating of at least either “AA” or such comparable rating from S&P Global Ratings or Moody’s Investors Service, Inc., respectively; (aa) money market funds having assets under management in excess of $1,000,000,000.00; (bb) any unrestricted stock, shares, certificates, bonds, debentures, notes or other instrument which constitutes a “security” under the Security Act of 1993, which are freely tradable on any nationally recognized securities exchange and are not otherwise encumbered by such transferee; (cc) lines of credit; (dd) unfunded, but unconditionally committed and unencumbered capital commitments of the direct or indirect members or limited partners of such Person (or, to the extent encumbered by a subscription facility (or the like), such capital commitments, less any amounts drawn and outstanding under a subscription facility (or the like)) or such other assets or properties as Lender may (in its sole discretion) deem acceptable as evidenced by Lender’s written confirmation, excluding any and all retirement accounts and deferred profit-sharing accounts. To constitute “Cash and Cash Equivalents” the foregoing items described in (A) and (B) above must be: (i) owned solely in the name of such Person or its wholly owned direct or indirect subsidiaries, as set forth on such Person’s balance sheet (and not jointly with any other person or entity) in a non-margin account identified as being owned by solely in the name of such Person or its wholly owned direct or indirect subsidiaries, as set forth on such Person’s balance sheet; and (ii) free and clear of any lien, security interest, assignment, right of setoff or other encumbrance of any kind except Permitted Liens hereof. For any purpose of determination hereunder, the amount of “Cash and Cash Equivalents” shall be reduced by outstanding unsecured debt (under revolving lines of credit or otherwise) of any one or more of the person/trusts which comprise such Person.

 

Cash Flow Available for Debt Service” means, for Borrowers and the Subsidiaries, on a consolidated basisConsolidated Basis, for any period, (a) EBITDA, minus (b) cash taxes paid or payable or Permitted Tax Distributions made during such period, minus (c) all Capital Expenditures not financed with Debt permitted hereunder during such period, minus (d) distributions.

 

Change in Controlmeansshall mean:

 

(a)                 at any reorganization, recapitalization, consolidation or merger (or similar transaction or series of related transactions) of any Borrower, any sale or exchange of outstanding sharestime prior to the consummation of a Qualified IPO, (i) the occurrence of any event (whether in one or more transactions) which results in a transfer of control of Direct Digital or any other Equity Interests (or similar transaction or series of related transactions) of any Borrower or any other transaction or series ofBorrower to a Person other than the Permitted Holders, or (ii) the occurrence of any event (whether in one or more transactions, as a result of) which (iresults in (A) Mark Walker andor Keith Smith (together with members ofor their immediate families) collectively do not own a majority of the common equity interest in and more than 50% of the voting power of, and control, the surviving entity of such transaction or series of related transactions (or the parent of such surviving entity if such surviving entity is wholly owned by such parent), in each case without regard to whether a Borrower is the surviving entity, and own and controlrespective Related Parties failing to own, directly or indirectly a majority, legally and beneficially (free and clear of all Liens), at least 75% of the Equity Interests in and more than 50% of the voting power of, and control, each Borrower, or (ii) any other Person or group acquires, directly or indirectly, more than 50% of the voting power, or control, of any Borrower, it being understood that any change in composition of the Board of Direct Digital as contemplated by the Operating Agreement of Direct Digital as in effect as of the date hereof shall not constitute a Change in Control(on a fully diluted basis) of Direct Digital or (B) Direct Digital failing to own legally and beneficially (free and clear of Liens), 100% of the Equity Interests (on a fully diluted basis) of each other Borrower;

 

4 

 

 

(b)                at any time after the consummation of a Qualified IPO, (i) any “person” or “group” (as such terms are used in Sections 13(d) and 14(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, but excluding any Permitted Holder) becomes the “beneficial owner” (as defined in Rules 13d-3 and 13d-5 under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, except that a person or group shall be deemed to have “beneficial ownership” of all securities that such person or group has the right to acquire, whether such right is exercisable immediately or only after the passage of time (such right, an “option right”)), directly or indirectly, of 40% or more of the voting power of the total outstanding Equity Interests of DDH Holdings entitled to vote for members of the board of directors or equivalent governing body of DDH Holdings on a fully-diluted basis (and taking into account all such Equity Interests that such “person” or “group” has the right to acquire pursuant to any option right); or (ii) the occurrence of any event (whether in one or more transactions) which results in Direct Digital failing to own legally and beneficially (free and clear of Liens), 100% of the Equity Interests (on a fully diluted basis) of each other Borrower; or

 

(c)                at any time after the consummation of a Qualified IPO, during any period of 12 consecutive months, a majority of the members of the board of directors or other equivalent governing body of DDH Holdings cease to be composed of individuals (i) who were members of that board or equivalent governing body on the first day of such period, (ii) whose election or nomination to that board or equivalent governing body was approved by individuals referred to in clause (i) above constituting at the time of such election or nomination at least a majority of that board or equivalent governing body or (iii)   whose election or nomination to that board or other equivalent governing body was approved by individuals referred to in clauses (i) and (ii) above constituting at the time of such election or nomination at least a majority of that board or equivalent governing body, in each case with respect to clauses (i), (ii) and (iii), as a result of hostile proxy contest.

 

Code” means the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, and the regulations promulgated and rulings issued thereunder.

 

Collateral” means all property and assets granted as collateral security for the Obligations, whether real or personal property, whether granted directly or indirectly, whether granted now or in the future, and whether granted in the form of a security interest, mortgage, collateral mortgage, deed of trust, assignment, pledge, crop pledge, chattel mortgage, collateral chattel mortgage, chattel trust, factor's lien, equipment trust, conditional sale, trust receipt, lien, charge, lien or title retention contract, lease or consignment intended as a security device, or any other security or lien interest or Hedge Agreement whatsoever, whether created by law, contract, or otherwise.

 

5 

 

 

  

Commitment” means the obligation of Lender to make Revolving Credit Advances pursuant to Section 2.01 in an aggregate principal amount up to but not exceeding FourFive Million Five Hundred Thousand Dollars ($4,500,0005,000,000), subject to termination pursuant to Section 10.02.

 

Commitment Fee” means Forty-Five Thousand and No/100 Dollars ($45,000).

 

Commodity Exchange Act” means the Commodity Exchange Act (7 U.S.C. §1 et seq.), and any successor statute.

 

Common Units Redemption” shall mean the contemplated redemption of all of the common units held in Direct Digital by USDM Holdings pursuant to the Redemption Agreement.

 

Compliance Certificate” means a certificate, substantially in the form of Exhibit B attached hereto, prepared by and executed by an officer of Borrowers.

 

Consolidated Basis” shall mean, (a) prior to a Qualified IPO, with respect to Direct Digital and its Subsidiaries, as the context may require, the consolidation in accordance with GAAP of the accounts and other items of Direct Digital and its Subsidiaries, and (b) subsequent to a Qualified IPO, with respect to DDH Holdings and its Subsidiaries as the context may require, the consolidation in accordance with GAAP of the accounts and other items of DDH Holdings and its Subsidiaries, it being understood that any reference to Borrowers and their Subsidiaries in any financial definitions or calculations herein shall be deemed to refer to DDH Holdings and its Subsidiaries.

 

Constituent Documents” means (i) in the case of a corporation, its articles or certificate of incorporation and bylaws; (ii) in the case of a general partnership, its partnership agreement and certificate of formation or other instrument filed in connection with its formation; (iii) in the case of a limited partnership, its certificate of limited partnership and partnership agreement; (iv) in the case of a trust, its trust agreement; (v) in the case of a joint venture, its joint venture agreement; (vi) in the case of a limited liability company, its articles of organization and operating agreement or regulations; and (vii) in the case of any other entity, its organizational and governance documents and agreements.

 

Control” means the possession, directly or indirectly, of the power to direct or cause the direction of the management or policies of a Person, whether through the ability to exercise voting power, by contract or otherwise. “Controlling” and “Controlled” have meanings correlative thereto.

 

“Daily Simple SOFR” means, for any day, SOFR, with the conventions for this rate (which may include a lookback) being established by the Lender in accordance with the conventions for this rate recommended by the Relevant Governmental Body for determining “Daily Simple SOFR” for bilateral business loans; provided, that if the Lender decides that any such convention is not administratively feasible for the Lender, then the Lender may establish another convention in its reasonable discretion.

 

DDH Holdings” means Direct Digital Holdings, Inc., a Delaware corporation, which entity has been incorporated to enter into a Qualified IPO, and shall, upon consummation of the Qualified IPO, be the managing member of Direct Digital at all times while the umbrella partnership corporation structure (“Up-C Structure”) is in effect.

 

6

 

  

Debt” means as to any Person at any time (without duplication): (a) all obligations of such Person for borrowed money, (b) all obligations of such Person evidenced by bonds, notes, debentures, or other similar instruments, (c) all obligations of such Person to pay the deferred purchase price of property or services, except trade accounts payable of such Person arising in the ordinary course of business that are not past due by more than ninety (90) days, (d) all Capitalized Lease Obligations of such Person, (e) all Debt or other obligations of others Guaranteed by such Person, (f) all obligations secured by a Lien existing on property owned by such Person, whether or not the obligations secured thereby have been assumed by such Person or are non-recourse to the credit of such Person, (g) any other obligation for borrowed money or other financial accommodations which in accordance with GAAP would be shown as a liability on the balance sheet of such Person, (h) any repurchase obligation or liability of a Person with respect to accounts, chattel paper or notes receivable sold by such Person, (i) any liability under a sale and leaseback transaction that is not a Capitalized Lease Obligation, (j) any obligation under any so-called “synthetic leases”, (k) any obligation arising with respect to any other transaction that is the functional equivalent of borrowing but which does not constitute a liability on the balance sheets of a Person, (l) all reimbursement obligations of such Person (whether contingent or otherwise) in respect of letters of credit, bankers’ acceptances, surety or other bonds and similar instruments, and (m) all liabilities of such Person in respect of unfunded vested benefits under any Plan. The term “Debt” shall exclude obligations under an operating lease and Preferred Equity.

 

Debt Service” means, for any Person as of any date of determination, the sum of (a) the current portion of long-term Debt of such Person and (b) all regularly scheduled interest payments that are paid in cash with respect of all Debt of such Person for the trailing twelve-month period ending on the date of determination.

 

Default” means an Event of Default or the occurrence of an event or condition which with notice or lapse of time or both would become an Event of Default.

 

Default Interest Rate” means a rate per annum equal to the Loan Rate plus five percent (5%), but in no event in excess of the Maximum Lawful Rate.

 

Delaware LLC” means any limited liability company organized or formed under the laws of the State of Delaware.

 

Delaware LLC Division” means the statutory division of any Delaware LLC into two or more Delaware LLCs pursuant to Section 18-217 of the Delaware Limited Liability Company Act.

 

Designated Jurisdiction” means any country or territory to the extent that such country or territory itself is the subject of any Sanction.

 

Direct Digital Management” means Direct Digital Management, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company.

 

Dollars” and “$” mean lawful money of the United States of America.

 

Domestic Subsidiary” means any Subsidiary that is organized under the laws of any political subdivision of the United States of America.

 

“Early Opt-in Effective Date” means, with respect to any Early Opt-in Election, the sixth (6th) Business Day after the date notice of such Early Opt-in Election is provided to the Borrower so long as the Lender has not received, by 5:00 p.m. (New York City time) on the fifth (5th) Business Day after the date notice of such Early Opt-in Election is provided to the Borrower, written notice of objection to such Early Opt-in Election from the Borrower.

 

“Early Opt-in Election” means the occurrence of the election by the Lender to trigger a fallback from USD LIBOR and the provision by the Lender of written notice of such election to the Borrower.

  

7

 

 

EBITDA” means, for Borrowers and their Subsidiaries on a consolidated basisConsolidated Basis for any period in question, the sum of (a) Net Income for such period plus (b) to the extent deducted in determining such Net Income, the sum, without duplication, of (i) Interest Expense during such period, (ii) all federal, state, local and/or foreign income taxes payable by Borrowers and their Subsidiaries during such period, (iii) depreciation expenses of Borrowers and their Subsidiaries during such period, (iv) amortization expenses of Borrowers and their Subsidiaries during such period, (v) for any portion of the applicable measurement period, occurring prior to a Qualified IPO, management fees payable under and pursuant to the Board Services and Consulting Agreements each dated as of September 30, 2020, by and between DDHDirect Digital, on the one hand, and Keith Smith and Mark Walker, respectively, on the other hand (not to exceed in aggregate amount $900,000 per annum or $225,000 per quarter for purposes of this definition), and (vi) transaction fees and expenses incurred in connection with a Qualified IPO after the First Amendment Effective Date, paid in cash within 30 days of the consummation of such Qualified IPO not to exceed $2,500,000 (or such greater amount approved by Lender) in the aggregate over the life of this Agreement, and (vii) without duplication, non-recurring legal, consulting expenses in an amount up to $250,000500,000 during any 12 month period, and minus (c) any extraordinary, non-recurring and/or non-cash gains or income during such period as reported in the monthly and annual financials of Borrowers and their Subsidiaries, all determined on a consolidated basisConsolidated Basis.

 

Eligible Accounts” means, at any time, all accounts receivable of Borrowers and their Subsidiaries that are Guarantors created in the ordinary course of business that are acceptable to Lender in its Permitted Discretion and satisfy the following conditions:

 

(a)                The account complies with all applicable laws, rules, and regulations, including, without limitation, usury laws, the Federal Truth in Lending Act, and Regulation Z of the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System;

 

(b)               The account has not been outstanding for more than ninety (90) days past the original date of invoice;

 

(c)                The account does not represent a commission and the account was created in connection with (i) the sale of goods by a Borrower or a Subsidiary in the ordinary course of business and such sale has been consummated and such goods have been shipped and delivered and received by the account debtor, or (ii) the performance of services by a Borrower or a Subsidiary in the ordinary course of business and such services have been completed and accepted by the account debtor;

 

(d)               The account arises from an enforceable contract, the performance of which has been completed by a Borrower or a Subsidiary;

 

(e)               The account does not arise from the sale of any good that is on a bill-and-hold, guaranteed sale, sale-or-return, sale on approval, consignment, or any other repurchase or return basis;

 

(f)                A Borrower or a Subsidiary has good and indefeasible title to the account and the account is not subject to any Lien except Liens in favor of Lender and Term Loan Lender;

 

(g)               The account does not arise out of a contract with or order from, an account debtor that, by its terms, prohibits or makes void or unenforceable the grant of a security interest by a Borrower or a Subsidiary to Lender in and to such account;

  

8

 

 

(h)                The account is not subject to any setoff, counterclaim, defense, dispute, recoupment, or adjustment other than normal discounts for prompt payment;

 

(i)                 The account debtor is not insolvent or the subject of any bankruptcy or insolvency proceeding and has not made an assignment for the benefit of creditors, suspended normal business operations, dissolved, liquidated, terminated its existence, ceased to pay its debts as they become due, or suffered a receiver or trustee to be appointed for any of its assets or affairs;

 

(j)                 The account is not evidenced by chattel paper or an instrument;

 

(k)                No default exists under the account by any party thereto beyond any applicable notice and cure period;

 

(l)                 The account debtor has not returned or refused to retain, or otherwise notified a Borrower or a Subsidiary of any dispute concerning, or claimed nonconformity of, any of the goods from the sale of which the account arose;

 

(m)              The account is not owed by an Affiliate, employee, officer, director or shareholder of any Borrower or a Subsidiary;

 

(n)                The account is payable in Dollars by the account debtor;

 

(o)                The account is not owed by an account debtor whose accounts Lender in its Permitted Discretion has chosen to exclude from Eligible Accounts;

 

(p)                The account shall be ineligible if the account debtor is domiciled in any country other than the United States of America and/or Canada;

 

(q)                The account shall be ineligible if more than twenty-five percent (25%) of the aggregate balances then outstanding on accounts owed by such account debtor and its Affiliates to any Borrower or a Subsidiary are more than ninety (90) days past the dates of their original invoices;

 

(r)                 The account shall be ineligible if the account debtor is the United States of America or any department, agency, or instrumentality thereof, and the Federal Assignment of Claims Act of 1940, as amended, shall not have been complied with;

 

(s)                 The account shall be ineligible to the extent the aggregate of all accounts owed by the account debtor and its Affiliates to which the account relates exceeds twenty-five percent (25%) of all accounts owed by all of Borrower’s and its Subsidiaries’ account debtors; and

 

(t)                 The Account is otherwise acceptable in the Permitted Discretion of Lender; provided that Lender shall have the right to create and adjust eligibility standards and related reserves from time to time in its Permitted Discretion.

 

The amount of the Eligible Accounts owed by an account debtor to Borrower or a Subsidiary shall be reduced by the amount of all “contra accounts” and other obligations owed by Borrower or a Subsidiary to such account debtor.

 

Environmental Laws” means any and all federal, state, and local laws, regulations, judicial decisions, orders, decrees, plans, rules, permits, licenses, and other governmental restrictions and requirements pertaining to health, safety, or the environment, including, without limitation, the Comprehensive Environmental Response, Compensation and Liability Act of 1980, 42 U.S.C. §9601 et seq., the Resource Conservation and Recovery Act of 1976, 42 U.S.C. §6901 et seq., the Occupational Safety and Health Act, 29 U.S.C. §651 et seq., the Clean Air Act, 42 U.S.C. §7401 et seq., the Clean Water Act, 33 U.S.C. §1251 et seq., and the Toxic Substances Control Act, 15 U.S.C. §2601 et seq., as the same may be amended or supplemented from time to time.

 

9

 

 

Environmental Liabilities” means, as to any Person, all liabilities, obligations, responsibilities, Remedial Actions, losses, damages, punitive damages, consequential damages, treble damages, costs, and expenses, (including, without limitation, all reasonable fees, disbursements and expenses of counsel, expert and consulting fees and costs of investigation and feasibility studies), fines, penalties, sanctions, and interest incurred as a result of any claim or demand, by any Person, whether based in contract, tort, implied or express warranty, strict liability, criminal or civil statute, including any Environmental Law, permit, order or agreement with any Governmental Authority or other Person, arising from environmental, health or safety conditions or the Release or threatened Release of a Hazardous Material into the environment, resulting from the past, present, or future operations of such Person or its Affiliates.

 

Equity Cure” means the cash contributions made to Direct Digital in immediately available funds by one or more holders of Equity Interests therein as additional common equity contributions to Direct Digital and which are designated an “Equity Cure” by Direct Digital under Section 10.04 at the time contributed.

 

Equity Interests” means, with respect to any Person, all of the shares of capital stock of (or other ownership or profit interests in) such Person, all of the warrants, options or other rights for the purchase or acquisition from such Person of shares of capital stock of (or other ownership or profit interests in) such Person, all of the securities convertible into or exchangeable for shares of capital stock of (or other ownership or profit interests in) such Person or warrants, rights or options for the purchase or acquisition from such Person of such shares (or such other interests), and all of the other ownership or profit interests in such Person (including partnership, member or trust interests therein), whether voting or nonvoting, and whether or not such shares, warrants, options, rights or other interests are outstanding on any date of determination.

 

ERISA” means the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended from time to time, and the regulations and published interpretations thereunder.

 

ERISA Affiliate” means any corporation or trade or business which is a member of the same controlled group of corporations (within the meaning of Section 414(b) of the Code) as any Borrower or is under common control (within the meaning of Section 414(c) of the Code) with any Borrower.

 

Event of Default” has the meaning specified in Section 10.01.

 

Excluded Account” means any deposit account (including, for the avoidance of doubt, any cash, cash equivalents or other property contained therein): (i) solely to the extent, and for so long as, such deposit account is pledged to secure performance of obligations arising under clause (vi) of the defined term “Permitted Liens”, and whether such pledge is by escrow or otherwise, in all cases with a balance no greater than such obligations under clause (vi) of the defined term “Permitted Liens”; (ii) used exclusively for payroll, payroll taxes and other employee wage and benefit payments with a balance no greater than such payroll, payroll taxes and other employee wage and benefit payments obligations that are to be paid within any two-week period; (iii) constituting a “zero balance” deposit account; or (iv) consisting of a disbursement account established with a payment processor to process vendor payments so long as the average monthly balance in such account does not exceed $250,000 at any one time.

 

10

 

 

Excluded Hedge Obligation” means, with respect to any Obligated Party, any Hedge Obligations if, and to the extent that, all or a portion of such Obligated Party’s Guarantee of (whether such Guarantee arises pursuant to a Guaranty, by such Obligated Party’s being jointly and severally liable for such Hedge Obligations, or otherwise (any such Guarantee, an “Applicable Guarantee”)), or the grant by such Obligated Party of a security interest to secure, such Hedge Obligations (or any Applicable Guarantee thereof) is or becomes illegal or unlawful under the Commodity Exchange Act or any rule, regulation or order of the Commodity Futures Trading Commission (or the application or official interpretation of any thereof) by virtue of such Obligated Party’s failure for any reason not to constitute an Eligible Contract Participant (as defined in the Commodity Exchange Act), and any and all Guarantees of such Obligated Parties’ Hedge Obligations by other Obligated Parties at the time the Applicable Guarantee of such Obligated Party or the grant of such security interest becomes effective with respect to such related Hedge Obligations. If any Hedge Obligations arise under a Master Agreement governing more than one Hedge Agreement, then such exclusion shall apply only to the portion of such Hedge Obligations that is attributable to Hedge Agreements for which such Applicable Guarantee or security interest is or becomes illegal.

 

Excluded Taxes” means (a) backup withholding taxes, (b) franchise taxes, (c) taxes imposed on or measured by net income (however denominated), in each case, (i) imposed on (or measured by) Lender’s net income by the jurisdiction under the laws of which Lender is organized or in which its principal office is located or in which its applicable lending office is located or (ii) that are taxes imposed as a result of a present or former connection between Lender and the jurisdiction imposing such tax (other than connections arising from Lender having executed, delivered, become a party to, performed its obligations under, received payments under, received or perfected a security interest under, or engaged in any other transaction pursuant to or enforced any Loan Document or sold or assigned an interest in any Advance, and (d) taxes attributable to Lender’s failure to provide Borrowers with any forms or other documentation required by applicable law or reasonably requested by Borrowers in order for Borrowers to determine whether or not payments pursuant to any Loan Document are subject to withholding or information reporting requirements.

 

Family” means with respect to any Person (a) such Person’s spouse, (b) any immediate family member of such Persons, and (c) any other natural person who has been adopted by such Person.

 

First Amendment Effective Date” means December 17, 2021.

 

Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio” means the ratio of (a) Cash Flow Available for Debt Service for the trailing twelve-month period ending on the date of determination, to (b) Debt Service, in each case for Borrowers and the Subsidiaries on a consolidated basisConsolidated Basis.

 

“Floor” means the benchmark rate floor, if any, provided in this Agreement initially (as of the execution of this Agreement, the modification, amendment or renewal of this Agreement or otherwise) with respect to USD LIBOR.

 

Funding Loss” means the amount (which shall be payable on demand by Lender) necessary to promptly compensate Lender for, and hold it harmless from, any loss, cost or expense incurred by Lender as a result of:

 

(a)       any payment or prepayment of any LIBOR Amount on a day other than the last day of the relevant LIBOR Interest Period (whether voluntary, mandatory, automatic, by reason of acceleration, or otherwise); or

  

11

 

 

(b)       any failure by Borrowers to borrow a LIBOR Amount bearing or selected to bear interest based upon LIBOR on the date or in the amount selected by Borrowers;

 

including any loss of anticipated profits and any loss or expense arising from the liquidation or reemployment of funds obtained by it to maintain such LIBOR Amount or from fees payable to terminate the deposits from which such funds were obtained. Borrowers shall also pay any customary administrative fees charged by Lender in connection with the foregoing. For purposes of calculating amounts payable by Borrowers to Lender hereunder, Lender shall be deemed to have funded the LIBOR Amount based upon the LIBOR Rate by a matching deposit or other borrowing in the London inter-bank market for a comparable amount and for a comparable period, whether or not such LIBOR Amount was in fact so funded.

 

GAAP” means generally accepted accounting principles, applied on a consistent basis, as set forth in Opinions of the Accounting Principles Board of the American Institute of Certified Public Accountants and/or in statements of the Financial Accounting Standards Board and/or their respective successors and which are applicable in the circumstances as of the date in question. Accounting principles are applied on a “consistent basis” when the accounting principles applied in a current period are comparable in all material respects to those accounting principles applied in a preceding period.

 

Governmental Authority” means any nation or government, any state or political subdivision thereof and any entity exercising executive, legislative, judicial, regulatory, or administrative functions of or pertaining to government.

 

Guarantee” by any Person means any obligation, contingent or otherwise, of such Person directly or indirectly guaranteeing any Debt or other obligation of any other Person as well as any obligation or liability, direct or indirect, contingent or otherwise, of such Person (a) to purchase or pay (or advance or supply funds for the purchase or payment of) such Debt or other obligation or liability (whether arising by virtue of partnership arrangements, by agreement to keep-well, to purchase assets, goods, securities or services, to operate Property, to take-or-pay, or to maintain net worth or working capital or other financial statement conditions or otherwise) or (b) entered into for the purpose of indemnifying or assuring in any other manner the obligee of such Debt or other obligation or liability of the payment thereof or to protect the obligee against loss in respect thereof (in whole or in part), provided that the term Guarantee shall not include endorsements for collection or deposit in the ordinary course of business. The term “Guarantee” used as a verb has a corresponding meaning.

 

Guarantor” means any Person who from time to time guarantees all or any part of the Obligations, including, the Subsidiary Guarantors.

 

Guaranty” means a written guaranty of each Guarantor in favor of Lender, in form and substance satisfactory to Lender, as the same may be amended, modified, restated, renewed, replaced, extended, supplemented or otherwise changed from time to time.

 

Hazardous Material” means any substance, product, waste, pollutant, material, chemical, contaminant, constituent, or other material which is or becomes listed, regulated, or addressed under any Environmental Law, including, without limitation, asbestos, petroleum, and polychlorinated biphenyls.

 

12

 

  

Hedge Agreement” means (a) any and all interest rate swap transactions, basis swaps, credit derivative transactions, forward rate transactions, commodity swaps, commodity options, forward commodity contracts, equity or equity index swaps or options, bond or bond price or bond index swaps or options or forward bond or forward bond price or forward bond index transactions, interest rate options, forward foreign exchange transactions, cap transactions, floor transactions, collar transactions, currency swap transactions, cross-currency rate swap transactions, currency options, spot contracts, or any other similar transactions or any combination of any of the foregoing (including any options to enter into any of the foregoing), whether or not any such transaction is governed by or subject to any master agreement, (b) any and all transactions of any kind, and the related confirmations, which are subject to the terms and conditions of, or governed by, any form of master agreement published by the International Swaps and Derivatives Association, Inc., any International Foreign Exchange Master Agreement, or any other master agreement (any such master agreement, together with any related schedules and annexes, a “Master Agreement”) and (c) any and all Master Agreements and any and all related confirmations.

 

Hedge Bank” means any Person that, at the time it enters into an interest rate Hedge Agreement permitted under this Agreement, is Lender or an Affiliate of Lender, in its capacity as a party to such Hedge Agreement.

 

Hedge Obligations” means, for any Person, any and all obligations (whether absolute or contingent and howsoever and whensoever created) of such Person to pay or perform under any agreement, contract or transaction that constitutes a “swap” within the meaning of Section 1a(47) of the Commodity Exchange Act arising, evidenced or acquired under (a) any and all Hedging Agreements, (b) any and all cancellations, buy backs, reversals, terminations or assignments of any Hedging Agreements, and (c) any and all renewals, extensions and modifications of any Hedging Agreements and any and all substitutions of any Hedging Agreements.

 

Huddled Masses Notes” means, collectively (i) that certain Promissory Note dated June 21, 2018, by and between HMC Operations, LLC, a Texas limited liability company and Cantu Holdings, LLC, a Delaware limited liability, in the amount of $250,000.00, with an outstanding balance of $87,500 as of the date hereof, (ii) that certain Promissory Note dated June 21, 2018, by and between HMC Operations, LLC, a Texas limited liability company, Charles Cantu, a New York resident, Kristie MacDonald, Amy Harris, Laura Ottaviano, Lisa Grisanti, Joseph Riggio, in the amount of $141,203.69, (iii) that certain Promissory Note dated June 21, 2018, by and between HMC Operations, LLC, a Texas limited liability company, and Devon White, a New York resident, in the amount of $21,990.74, and (iv) that certain Promissory Note dated June 21, 2018, by and between HMC Operations, LLC, a Texas limited liability company, and MediaMath, Inc., a Delaware corporation, in the amount of $64,814.81.

 

Intercreditor Agreement” means that certain Intercreditor Agreement of even date herewith, by and among Term Loan Lender and Lender, as amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time.

 

Interest Expense” means, for any period, the interest expense of Borrowers and their Subsidiaries for the period in question, determined on a consolidated basisConsolidated Basis and consistent with practices as of the date hereof or otherwise in accordance with GAAP.

 

Interest Payment Date” means (a) with respect to any principal amount bearing interest based upon the Prime Rate, the first day of each and every calendar month during the term of the Notes and (b) with respect to each LIBOR Amount, the last day of each LIBOR Interest Period applicable to such LIBOR Amount.

 

Investment” means any beneficial ownership (including stock, partnership or limited liability company interests) of or in any Person, or any loan, advance or capital contribution to any Person or the acquisition of any material assets of another Person, other than equipment purchases made by the Borrower as part of the operation of its business.

 

 

13

 

 

Liabilities” means, at any particular time, all amounts which, in conformity with GAAP, would be included as liabilities on a balance sheet of a Person.

 

LIBOR Amountmeans each principal amount for which the LIBOR Rate applies for any specified LIBOR Interest Period.

 

LIBOR Interest Periodmeans, for any LIBOR Amount, a period of one month; provided, however, that: (i) the first day of a LIBOR Interest Period must be a Business Day; (ii) no LIBOR Interest Period shall extend beyond the Maturity Date of the Loan under which the LIBOR Amount was made; (iii) no LIBOR Interest Period shall extend beyond the scheduled payment date of any principal payment required by the Loan under which the LIBOR Amount was made; (iv) any LIBOR Interest Period that would otherwise expire on a day that is not a Business Day shall be extended to the next succeeding Business Day, unless the result of such extension would be to extend such LIBOR Interest Period into another calendar month, in which event the LIBOR Interest Period shall end on the immediately preceding Business Day; and (v) any LIBOR Interest Period that begins on the last Business Day of a calendar month (or on a day for which there is no numerically corresponding day in the calendar month at the end of such LIBOR Interest Period) shall end on the last Business Day of a calendar month.

 

LIBOR Rate” means, an interest rate equivalent to Lender’s LIBOR Rate which is that rate determined by Lender’s Treasury Desk to be the Interbank lending rate for a period equal to the applicable LIBOR Interest Period which appears on the Bloomberg Screen B TMM Page under the heading “LIBOR Fix” as of 11:00 am (London Time) on the second Business Day prior to the first day of such period (adjusted for any and all assessments, surcharges and reserve requirements). Notwithstanding anything in this definition to the contrary, if LIBOR Rate shall be less than zero, then such rate shall be deemed to be zero for purposes of this Agreement.

 

Lien” means any lien, mortgage, security interest, tax lien, pledge, charge, hypothecation, assignment, preference, priority, or other encumbrance of any kind or nature whatsoever (including, without limitation, any conditional sale or title retention agreement), whether arising by contract, operation of law, or otherwise.

 

Liquid Assets” shall mean, with respect to any Person, (a) unencumbered Cash and Cash Equivalents (as defined below) and (b) marketable securities, each valued in accordance with GAAP, consistently applied (or other principles acceptable to Lender), as reasonably determined by such Person and reasonably approved by Lender.

 

Loan Documents” means this Agreement, the Intercreditor Agreement, the Preferred Equity Subordination Agreement, and all promissory notes, security agreements, pledge agreements, deeds of trust, assignments, letters of credit, guaranties, Hedge Agreements and other instruments, documents, and agreements executed and delivered pursuant to or in connection with this Agreement, as such instruments, documents, and agreements may be amended, modified, renewed, restated, extended, supplemented, replaced, consolidated, substituted, or otherwise changed from time to time.

 

Loan Rate” means the LIBOR Rate plus 3.50% per annum; provided, that, in no event shall the Loan Rate be less than 0.50% of the Loan Rate effective on the date of this Agreement.

 

Management Fee Subordination Agreement” means each Management Fee Subordination Agreement dated as of December 17, 2021, with respect to the management fees payable under and pursuant to the Board Services and Consulting Agreements each dated as of September 30, 2020, by and between Direct Digital, on the one hand, and Keith Smith and Mark Walker on the other hand, as the same may be amended, restated, supplemented, modified, or changed from time to time.

 

 

14

 

 

 

Master Agreement” has the meaning set forth in the definition of “Hedge Agreement.”

 

Material Adverse Event” means any act, event, condition, or circumstance which could materially and adversely affect: (a) the operations, business, properties, liabilities (actual or contingent), or condition (financial or otherwise) of Borrowers or Borrowers and the Subsidiaries, taken as a whole; (b) the ability of any Obligated Party to perform its obligations under any Loan Document to which it is a party; or (c) the legality, validity, binding effect or enforceability against any Obligated Party of any Loan Document to which it is a party.

 

Maturity Date” means 3:00 P.M. Dallas, Texas time on September 30, 2022, or such earlier date on which the Commitment terminates as provided in this Agreement.

 

Maximum Lawful Rate” means, at any time, the maximum rate of interest which may be charged, contracted for, taken, received or reserved by Lender in accordance with applicable Texas law (or applicable United States federal law to the extent that such law permits Lender to charge, contract for, receive or reserve a greater amount of interest than under Texas law). The Maximum Lawful Rate shall be calculated in a manner that takes into account any and all fees, payments, and other charges in respect of the Loan Documents that constitute interest under applicable law. Each change in any interest rate provided for herein based upon the Maximum Lawful Rate resulting from a change in the Maximum Lawful Rate shall take effect without notice to Borrowers at the time of such change in the Maximum Lawful Rate.

 

Multiemployer Plan” means a multiemployer plan defined as such in Section 3(37) of ERISA to which contributions have been made by any Borrower or any ERISA Affiliate and which is covered by Title IV of ERISA.

 

Net Income” means the net income (or loss) of Borrowers and their Subsidiaries for the period in question, determined on a consolidated basisConsolidated Basis and consistent with practices as of the date hereof or otherwise in accordance with GAAP.

 

Notes” means, collectively, all promissory notes (and “Note” means any of such Notes) executed at any time by Borrowers and payable to the order of Lender, as amended, renewed, replaced, extended, supplemented, consolidated, restated, modified, otherwise changed and/or increased from time to time.

 

Obligated Party” means each Borrower, each Guarantor and any other Person who is or becomes party to any agreement that guarantees or secures payment and performance of the Obligations or any part thereof.

 

Obligations” means all obligations, indebtedness, and liabilities of Borrowers, each Guarantor and any other Obligated Party to Lender or any Affiliate of Lender, or both, now existing or hereafter arising, whether direct, indirect, related, unrelated, fixed, contingent, liquidated, unliquidated, joint, several, or joint and several, including, without limitation, the obligations, indebtedness, and liabilities under this Agreement, all Hedge Obligations under any Secured Hedge Agreements, the other Loan Documents, any cash management or treasury services agreements and all interest accruing thereon (whether a claim for post-filing or post-petition interest is allowed in any bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization or similar proceeding) and all attorneys’ fees and other expenses incurred in the enforcement or collection thereof; provided, however, that any other term or provision of this Agreement or any other Loan Document to the contrary notwithstanding, the “Obligations” of any Obligated Party shall exclude, as to such Obligated Party, Excluded Hedge Obligations of such Obligated Party.

 

15 

 

 

Operating Agreement of Direct Digital” means (a) prior to the Reorganization Transactions, the Amended and Restated Limited Liability Company Agreement of Direct Digital dated September 30, 2020 and (b) concurrently with and following the Reorganization Transactions, the amended and restated limited liability company agreement of Direct Digital executed in connection therewith.

 

Orange 142 Acquisition” means the acquisition by Direct Digital of all or substantially all of the issued and outstanding membership interests of Orange, via sale, transfer, conveyance, assignment, and/or contribution of such interests.

 

Priority Collateral” means the Collateral in which the Lender has a first priority security interest under the Security Agreement, subject to the Intercreditor Agreement.

 

Patriot Act” means the USA PATRIOT Act (Title III of Pub. L. 107-56 (signed into law October 26, 2001)).

 

PBGC” means the Pension Benefit Guaranty Corporation or any entity succeeding to all or any of its functions under ERISA.

 

Permitted Discretion” means a determination in good faith and in the exercise of reasonable (from the perspective of a secured asset-based lender) business judgment.

 

Permitted Holders” shall mean Keith Smith, Mark Walker, Leah Woolford and/or their respective Related Persons.

 

Permitted Indebtedness” means: (i) Debt to Lender arising under this Agreement or any other Loan Document; (ii) Term Loan Debt in accordance with the Intercreditor Agreement; (iii) Debt existing on the date hereof which is disclosed in Schedule 8.01; (iv) Debt of up to $200,000 outstanding at any time secured by a Lien described in clause (viii) of the defined term “Permitted Liens,” provided such Debt does not exceed the cost of the equipment or intellectual property financed with such Debt; (v) amounts billed to a Borrower by its suppliers for goods delivered to or services performed for such Borrower in the ordinary course of business; (vi) reimbursement obligations in connection with trade letters of credit entered into in the ordinary course of business and, to the extent not subject to an Excluded Account, cash management services (including credit cards, debit cards and other similar instruments) that are secured by cash and issued on behalf of any Borrower or a Subsidiary thereof in an amount not to exceed $200,000 at any time outstanding; (vii) Debt secured by a Lien described in clause (xi) of the defined term “Permitted Liens”; (viii) Debt; extensions, refinancings and renewals of any items of Permitted Indebtedness; provided that the principal amount is not increased or the terms modified to impose materially more burdensome terms upon any Borrower or its Subsidiary, as the case may be; and (ix) other unsecured Debt in an amount not to exceed $200,000 in the aggregate; and (x) the Huddled Masses Notes as in effect as of the date hereof.

 

16 

 

 

Permitted Investment” means: (i) Investments existing as of the date hereof which are disclosed on Schedule 8.05; (ii) (a) marketable direct obligations issued or unconditionally guaranteed by the United States of America or any agency or any State thereof maturing within one year from the date of acquisition thereof currently having a rating of at least A-2 or P-2 from either Standard & Poor’s Corporation or Moody’s Investors Services, (b) commercial paper maturing no more than one year from the date of creation thereof and currently having a rating of at least A-2 or P-2 from either Standard & Poor’s Corporation or Moody’s Investors Service, (c) certificates of deposit issued by any bank with assets of at least $250,000,000 maturing no more than one year from the date of investment therein, and (d) money market accounts; (iii) repurchases of stock from current or former employees, directors, or consultants of the Borrower under the terms of applicable repurchase agreements at the original issuance price of such securities in an aggregate amount not to exceed $250,000 in any fiscal year; provided that no Event of Default has occurred, is continuing or could exist after giving effect to the repurchases; (iv) Investments (including debt obligations) received in connection with the bankruptcy or reorganization of customers or suppliers and in settlement of delinquent obligations of, and other disputes with, customers or suppliers arising in the ordinary course of Borrowers’ business; (v) Investments consisting of notes receivable of, or prepaid royalties and other credit extensions to, customers and suppliers who are not Affiliates, in the ordinary course of business; provided that this subparagraph (vi) shall not apply to Investments of any Borrower in any Subsidiary; (vi) Investments consisting of loans not involving the net transfer on a substantially contemporaneous basis of cash proceeds to employees, officers or directors relating to the purchase of capital stock or other Equity Interests of a Borrower pursuant to employee stock purchase plans or other similar agreements approved by such Borrower’s Board of Directors (or, if not a corporation, its equivalent authorizing body); (vii) Investments consisting of travel advances in the ordinary course of business; (viii) Investments in newly-formed Subsidiaries; provided that any such Subsidiary that is or is expected to become an After-Acquired Subsidiary complies with Section 7.13 hereof; and (ix) additional Investments that do not exceed $200,000 in the aggregate in any fiscal year if, at the time of such Investment and after giving effect thereto, the Borrower is in compliance with the Financial Covenants in Article IX (or, for any period prior to December 31, 2020, would be in compliance if the requirement thereunder were in effect as of the date of such Investment).

 

Permitted Liens” means any and all of the following: (i) Liens in favor of the Lender; (ii) Liens in favor of the Term Loan Lender securing the Debt under the Term Loan Documents, subject to the Intercreditor Agreement; (iii) Liens existing as of the date hereof which are disclosed in Schedule 8.02 hereto; (iv) Liens for taxes, fees, assessments or other governmental charges or levies, either not delinquent or being contested in good faith by appropriate proceedings; provided that Borrowers maintain adequate reserves therefor in accordance with GAAP; (v) Liens securing claims or demands of materialmen, artisans, mechanics, carriers, warehousemen, landlords and other like Persons arising in the ordinary course of any Borrower’s business and imposed without action of such parties; (vi) Liens arising from judgments, decrees or attachments in circumstances which do not constitute an Event of Default hereunder; (vii) Liens on deposits held in an Excluded Account; (viii) Liens on equipment or software or other intellectual property constituting purchase money Liens and Liens in connection with capital leases securing Indebtedness permitted in clause (iv) of “Permitted Indebtedness”; (ix) Liens incurred in connection with Subordinated Debt; (x) leasehold interests in leases or subleases and licenses granted in the ordinary course of business and not interfering in any material respect with the business of the licensor; (xi) Liens in favor of customs and revenue authorities arising as a matter of law to secure payment of custom duties that are promptly paid on or before the date they become due; (xii) Liens on insurance proceeds securing the payment of financed insurance premiums that are promptly paid on or before the date they become due (provided that such Liens extend only to such insurance proceeds and not to any other property or assets); (xiii) statutory and common law rights of set-off and other similar rights as to deposits of cash and securities in favor of banks, other depository institutions and brokerage firms; (xiv) easements, zoning restrictions, rights-of-way and similar encumbrances on real property imposed by law or arising in the ordinary course of business so long as they do not materially impair the value or marketability of the related property; (xv) (A) Liens on cash securing obligations permitted under clause (vi) of the definition of Permitted Indebtedness and (B) security deposits in connection with real property leases, the combination of (A) and (B) in an aggregate amount not to exceed $300,000 at any time; (xvi) sales, transfers or other dispositions of assets permitted by Section 8.08 and, in connection therewith, customary rights and restrictions contained in agreements relating to such transactions pending the completion thereof or during the term thereof, and any option or other agreement to sell, transfer, license, sublicense, lease, sublease or dispose of an asset permitted by Section 8.08, in each case, such terms being agreed to and such transactions entered into in the ordinary course of business; and (xvii) Liens incurred in connection with the extension, renewal or refinancing of the Debt secured by Liens of the type described in clauses (i) through (xvi) above; provided that any extension, renewal or replacement Lien shall be limited to the property encumbered by the existing Lien and the principal amount of the Debt being extended, renewed or refinanced (as may have been reduced by any payment thereon) does not increase.

 

17 

 

 

Permitted Tax Distributions” means, quarterly tax distributions by Direct Digital to its direct or indirect constituent members in the amount necessary to satisfy the U.S. federal, state and local income tax obligations allocated toof such members based on the taxable income of Direct Digital and its Subsidiaries on a consolidated basisConsolidated Basis for such taxable year, in an aggregate amount determined in accordance with the terms of the organizational documents of Direct Digital. Direct Digital may make such distributions after the end of the taxable year, or make such distributions on a quarterly basis during the taxable year to reflect estimated tax obligations of the members and their direct or indirect equityholders. For the avoidance of doubt, Permitted Tax Distributions based on estimates shall be made on a “rolling basis” and will be trued-up at least annually.

 

Person” means any individual, corporation, limited liability company, business trust, association, company, partnership, joint venture, Governmental Authority, or other entity, and shall include such Person’s heirs, administrators, personal representatives, executors, successors and assigns.

 

Plan” means any employee benefit or other plan established or maintained by any Borrower or any ERISA Affiliate and which is covered by Title IV of ERISA.

 

Preferred A Redemption means the redemption of the preferred A units held in Direct Digital pursuant to the Redemption Agreement.

 

Preferred B Redemption means the contemplated redemption of the preferred B units held in Direct Digital pursuant to the Redemption Agreement.

 

Preferred Equity” means the Equity Interests issued to USDM Holdings, Inc., a Texas corporation, and other “Preferred Unit Holders” pursuant to the Operating Agreement of Direct Digital.

 

Preferred Equity Subordination Agreement” means that certain Preferred Equity Subordination Agreement of even date herewith, by and among Direct Digital, the holder(s) of the Preferred Equity and Lender, as amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time.

 

Prime Rate” means, for any day, the rate of interest announced from time to time by Lender as its “base” or “prime” rate of interest, which Borrowers hereby acknowledge and agree may not be the lowest interest rate charged by Lender and is set by Lender in its sole discretion, changing when and as said prime rate changes.

 

Principal Office” means the principal office of Lender, presently located at 5001 Spring Valley Road, Suite 825W, Dallas, Texas 75224.

 

Priority Collateral” means the Collateral in which the Lender has a first priority security interest under the Security Agreement, subject to the Intercreditor Agreement.

 

Prohibited Transaction” means any non-exempt transaction set forth in Section 406 of ERISA or Section 4975 of the Code.

 

18 

 

 

Property” of a Person means any and all property, whether real, personal, tangible, intangible or mixed, of such Person, or any other assets owned, operated or leased by such Person.

 

Public Company Costsshall mean actual documented costs relating to compliance with the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, as amended, and other actual documented expenses arising out of or incidental to DDH Holdings’ status as a reporting company, including actual documented costs, fees and expenses (including reasonable legal, accounting and other professional fees) relating to compliance with provisions of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, registration and reporting obligations, the rules of securities exchange companies with listed equity securities, directors’ compensation, fees and expense reimbursement, shareholder meetings and reports to shareholders, indemnification and reimbursement of directors, officers and employees in respect of liabilities relating to their serving in any such capacity, directors’ and officers’ insurance and other executive costs, legal and other professional fees, and listing fees.

 

Qualified IPOshall mean the issuance of Equity Interests by Direct Digital or DDH Holdings in an underwritten primary public offering (other than a public offering pursuant to a registration statement on Form S-8) on or prior to June 30, 2022 pursuant to an effective registration statement filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission in accordance with the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, (whether alone or in connection with a secondary public offering) that generates gross cash proceeds of not less than $34,500,000 (after giving effect to the greenshoe), and (y) net cash proceeds actually received by Borrowers of not less than $15,000,000 and pursuant to which the Reorganization Transactions shall occur.

 

Redemption Agreement means that certain redemption agreement dated as of November 14, 2021 by and between Direct Digital and USDM Holdings.

 

Redemption/Exchange Transactions means at any time following the consummation of a Qualified IPO, the transactions pursuant to which Direct Digital redeems Class A Common Units for either (A)(1) a stock exchange payment or (2) a cash exchange payment, in each case in accordance with the Operating Agreement of Direct Digital or (B) the direct purchase by DDH Holdings of vested Class A Common Units and paired voting stock pursuant to any call right, in accordance with the Operating Agreement of Direct Digital.

 

Related Indebtedness” has the meaning set forth in Section 11.20 of this Agreement.

 

Related Person means, with respect to a particular Person: (a) each other member of such Person’s Family; (b) any Person that is directly or indirectly Controlled by such Person and/or any one or more members of such Person’s Family; (c) any Person with respect to which such Person and/or one or more members of such Person’s Family constitute all of the executors or trustees thereof (or in a similar capacity); and (d) any estate planning trust or limited partnership formed or organized for the benefit of such Person or such Person’s Family so long as during his/her lifetime, such Person remains in Control of the voting rights with respect to any actions to be taken by such trust or limited partnership.

 

Release” means, as to any Person, any release, spill, emission, leaking, pumping, injection, deposit, disposal, disbursement, leaching, or migration of Hazardous Materials into the indoor or outdoor environment or into or out of property owned by such Person, including, without limitation, the movement of Hazardous Materials through or in the air, soil, surface water, ground water, or property.

 

“Relevant Governmental Body” means the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System or the Federal Reserve Bank of New York, or a committee officially endorsed or convened by the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System or the Federal Reserve Bank of New York, or any successor thereto.

 

19 

 

 

Remedial Action” means all actions required to (a) clean up, remove, treat, or otherwise address Hazardous Materials in the indoor or outdoor environment, (b) prevent the Release or threat of Release or minimize the further Release of Hazardous Materials so that they do not migrate or endanger or threaten to endanger public health or welfare or the indoor or outdoor environment, or (c) perform pre-remedial studies and investigations and post-remedial monitoring and care.

 

Reorganization Transactionsmeans the transactions contemplated pursuant to which Direct Digital will effect an initial public offering, including, (i) the preferred equity units held in Direct Digital will be redeemed, including pursuant to the Preferred A Redemption and the Preferred B Redemption, (ii) the Common Units Redemption shall be consummated with proceeds from a Qualified IPO, (iii) the Equity Interests held in Direct Digital will be reclassified into two classes of units, (iv) the holders of Class A common units will contribute all their Class A common units to DDH Holdings in exchange for Class A common stock, (v) immediately after which the holders of Class B voting units will contribute all of their Class B voting units to DDH Holdings in exchange for Class B common stock, (vi) immediately following such exchanges, DDH Holdings will be designated as the managing member of Direct Digital, (vii) DDH Holdings shall use the net proceeds received from an initial public offering to purchase Class A common units from Direct Digital, and (viii) the amendment and restatement of the Direct Digital limited liability company agreement to effect the foregoing.

 

Reportable Event” means any of the events set forth in Section 4043 of ERISA that requires the Borrower or Subsidiary to notify the PBGC of such event, and the reporting of which is not otherwise waived.

 

Responsible Officer” means (a) for any Borrower, the chief executive officer, president, chief financial officer, or treasurer of such Borrower or any Person designated by a Responsible Officer to act on behalf of a Responsible Officer; provided that such designated Person may not designate any other Person to be a Responsible Officer. Any document delivered hereunder that is signed by a Responsible Officer of Borrowers shall be conclusively presumed to have been authorized by all necessary corporate, partnership and/or other action on the part of Borrowers and such Responsible Officer shall be conclusively presumed to have acted on behalf of Borrowers and (b) for each other Person, (i) in the case of a corporation, its chief executive officer, president, chief financial officer, treasurer, assistant treasurer or controller, and a secretary or assistant secretary for the purposes of delivering incumbency certificates, or as a second Responsible Officer in any case where two Responsible Officers are acting on behalf of such corporation; (ii) in the case of a limited partnership, the Responsible Officer of the general partner, acting on behalf of such general partner in its capacity as general partner; or (iii) in the case of a limited liability company, the Responsible Officer of the managing member, acting on behalf of such managing member in its capacity as managing member.

 

Revolving Credit Advance” means any Advance made by Lender to Borrowers pursuant to Section 2.01(a) of this Agreement.

 

Revolving Credit Availability” means on any date of determination the Commitment minus the aggregate amount of all outstanding Revolving Credit Advances.

 

Revolving Credit Note” means the promissory note of Borrowers payable to the order of Lender, in substantially the form of Exhibit C hereto, and all amendments, extensions, renewals, replacements, and modifications thereof.

 

20 

 

 

RICO” means the Racketeer Influenced and Corrupt Organization Act of 1970.

 

Sanction(s)” means any sanction administered or enforced by the United States Government (including without limitation, OFAC), the United Nations Security Council, the European Union, Her Majesty’s Treasury (“HMT”) or other relevant sanctions authority.

 

Secured Hedge Agreement” means any Hedge Agreement permitted under this Agreement entered into by and between any Obligated Party and any Hedge Bank.

 

Security Agreement” means the Security Agreement dated of even date herewith of Borrowers and the other Obligated Parties party thereto in favor of Lender, in form and substance satisfactory to Lender, as the same may be amended, restated, supplemented, modified, or changed from time to time.

 

Security Documents” means the Security Agreement, each Guaranty, and each and every other security agreement, pledge agreement, mortgage or other collateral security agreement required by or delivered to Lender from time to time to secure the Obligations or any portion thereof.

 

“SOFR” means a rate per annum equal to the secured overnight financing rate for such Business Day published by the Federal Reserve Bank of New York (or a successor administrator of the secured overnight financing rate) on the website of the Federal Reserve Bank of New York, currently at http://www.newyorkfed.org (or any successor source for the secured overnight financing rate identified as such by the administrator of the secured overnight financing rate from time to time).

 

“SOFR Average” means the compounded average of SOFR over a rolling calendar day period of thirty (30) days as published by the Federal Reserve Bank of New York (or a successor administrator of the SOFR Average).

 

“Specified Financial Covenants” has the meaning set forth in Section 10.04.

 

Specified Obligated Party” means any Obligated Party that is not an Eligible Contract Participant (determined prior to giving effect to Section 7.14 hereof or any other “keepwell, support or other agreement” (as defined in the Commodity Exchange Act), or any similar provision contained in any Guaranty).

 

Subordinated Debt” means any Debt of Borrowers (other than the Obligations) that has been subordinated to the Obligations by written agreement, in form and content satisfactory to Lender, including without limitation, any payment obligations on the Preferred Equity.

 

Subsidiary” means (a) any corporation of which at least a majority of the outstanding shares of stock having by the terms thereof ordinary voting power to elect a majority of the board of directors of such corporation (irrespective of whether or not at the time stock of any other class or classes of such corporation shall have or might have voting power by reason of the happening of any contingency) is at the time directly or indirectly owned or controlled by any Borrower or one or more of the Subsidiaries or by any Borrower and one or more of the Subsidiaries; and (b) any other entity (i) of which at least a majority of the ownership, equity or voting interest is at the time directly or indirectly owned or controlled by one or more of Borrowers and the Subsidiaries and (ii) which is treated as a subsidiary in accordance with GAAP.

 

Subsidiary Guarantors” means each Domestic Subsidiary of each Borrower formed or acquired after the date hereof who from time to time guarantees all or any part of the Obligations, and “Subsidiary Guarantor” means any one of the Subsidiary Guarantors.

 

21 

 

 

Tax Receivable Agreementmeans that certain tax receivable agreement to be entered into by and among DDH Holdings, Direct Digital and Direct Digital Management.

 

Term Loan Debt” means the secured indebtedness of Borrowers under the Term Loan Agreement in a principal amount not to exceed TwelveThirty-Two Million Eight Hundred Twenty-Five Thousand Dollars ($12,825,00032,000,000).

 

Term Loan Documents” means the Term Loan Agreement and the other LoanOther Documents (as defined in the Term Loan Agreement) executed in connection therewith, in each case, as amended, restated or modified from time to time as permitted by the terms of the Intercreditor Agreement.

 

Term Loan Agreement” means that certain Term Loan and Security Agreement dated as of the date hereofDecember 3, 2021, by and between Term Loan Lender and Borrowers as amended, restated or modified from time to time as permitted by the terms of the Intercreditor Agreement.

 

Term Loan Lender” means Silverpeak Credit Partners, LPLafayette Square Loan Servicing, LLC and the other lenders and financial institutions from time to time party to the Term Loan Agreement and itstheir successors and permitted assigns.

 

Term Loan Priority Collateral” means all Collateral that is not Priority Collateral.

 

“Term SOFR” means, for the applicable corresponding tenor, the forward-looking term rate based on SOFR that has been selected or recommended by the Relevant Governmental Body.

 

Total Debt” means all Debt of Borrowers and the Subsidiaries at such time.

 

Total Leverage Ratio” means the ratio of (a) Total Debt of Borrowers and the Subsidiaries, on a consolidated basisConsolidated Basis, as of such date, to (b) EBITDA for Borrowers and the Subsidiaries, on a consolidated basisConsolidated Basis, for the four (4) fiscal quarters ending on such date.

 

UCC” means the Chapters 1 through 11 of the Texas Business and Commerce Code, as amended from time to time.

 

Up-C Structurehas the meaning given in the definition of DDH Holdings.

 

Unfunded Pension Liability” means the excess, if any, of (a) the funding target as defined under Section 430(d) of the Code without regard to the special at risk rules of Section 430(i) of the Code, over (b) the value of plan assets as defined under Section 430(g)(3)(A) of the Code determined as of the last day of each calendar year, without regard to the averaging which may be allowed under Section 310(g)(3)(B) of the Code and reduced for any prefunding balance or funding standard carryover balance as defined and provided for in Section 430(f) of the Code.

 

“USD LIBOR” means the London interbank offered rate for U.S. dollars.

 

USDM Holdings” means USDM Holdings, Inc., a Texas corporation.

 

1.02         Accounting Matters. Any accounting term used in this Agreement or the other Loan Documents shall have, unless otherwise specifically provided therein, the meaning customarily given such term in accordance with GAAP, and all financial computations thereunder shall be computed, unless otherwise specifically provided therein, in accordance with GAAP consistently applied; provided, that all financial covenants and calculations in the Loan Documents shall be made in accordance with GAAP as in effect on the date of this Agreement unless Borrowers and Lender shall otherwise specifically agree in writing. That certain items or computations are explicitly modified by the phrase “in accordance with GAAP” shall in no way be construed to limit the foregoing.

 

22 

 

 

1.03        Other Definitional Provisions. All definitions contained in this Agreement are equally applicable to the singular and plural forms of the terms defined. The words “hereof”, “herein”, and “hereunder” and words of similar import referring to this Agreement refer to this Agreement as a whole and not to any particular provision of this Agreement. Unless otherwise specified, all Article and Section references pertain to this Agreement. Terms used herein that are defined in the UCC, unless otherwise defined herein, shall have the meanings specified in the UCC.

 

ARTICLE II. 

ADVANCES

 

2.01           Advances.

 

(a)           Revolving Credit Advances. Subject to the terms and conditions of this Agreement, Lender agrees to make one or more Revolving Credit Advances to Borrowers from time to time from the date hereof to and including the Maturity Date in an aggregate principal amount at any time outstanding up to but not exceeding the amount of the Commitment, provided that the aggregate amount of all Revolving Credit Advances at any time outstanding shall not exceed the lesser of (i) the amount of the Commitment or (ii) the Borrowing Base. Subject to the foregoing limitations, and the other terms and provisions of this Agreement, Borrowers may borrow, repay, and reborrow hereunder.

 

(i)                 The Revolving Credit Note. The obligation of Borrowers to repay the Revolving Credit Advances and interest thereon shall be evidenced by the Revolving Credit Note executed by Borrowers payable to the order of Lender, in the principal amount of the Commitment as originally in effect and dated the date hereof.

 

(ii)               Payments on Revolving Credit Advances. All accrued but unpaid interest on the Revolving Credit Advances outstanding from time to time shall be payable in monthly installments on each Interest Payment Date until the Maturity Date when the then outstanding principal balance of the Revolving Credit Note and all accrued but unpaid interest thereon shall be due and payable. Borrowers may from time to time during the term of this Agreement borrow, partially or wholly repay its outstanding borrowings, and reborrow, subject to all of the limitations, terms and conditions of this Agreement and of the Loan Documents; provided, however, that the unpaid principal of the Revolving Credit Note shall not at any time exceed the principal amount stated above.

 

(iii)               Borrowing Procedure. Borrowers shall give Lender notice of each Revolving Credit Advance by means of an Advance Request Form containing the information required therein and delivered (by hand or by mechanically confirmed facsimile) to Lender no later than 1:00 p.m. (Texas time) on the day on which the Revolving Credit Advance is desired to be funded. Advances shall be in a minimum amount of $10,000. Lender at its option may accept telephonic requests for such Advances, provided that such acceptance shall not constitute a waiver of Lender’s right to require delivery of an Advance Request Form in connection with subsequent Advances. Any telephonic request for a Revolving Credit Advance by Borrowers shall be promptly confirmed by submission of a properly completed Advance Request Form to Lender, but failure to deliver an Advance Request Form shall not be a defense to payment of the Advance. Lender shall have no liability to Borrowers for any loss or damage suffered by Borrowers as a result of Lender’s honoring of any requests, execution of any instructions, authorizations or agreements or reliance on any reports communicated to it telephonically, by facsimile or electronically and purporting to have been sent to Lender by Borrowers and Lender shall have no duty to verify the origin of any such communication or the identity or authority of the Person sending it. Subject to the terms and conditions of this Agreement, each Revolving Credit Advance shall be made available to Borrowers by depositing the same, in immediately available funds, in an account of Borrowers designated by Borrowers maintained with Lender at the Principal Office. At no time shall there be more than five (5) LIBOR Amounts outstanding under this Agreement.

 

23 

 

 

 

2.02               General Provisions Regarding Interest, Etc.

 

(a)           Repayment of Advances. Borrowers shall repay the unpaid principal amount of all Advances on the Maturity Date, unless sooner due by reason of acceleration by Lender as provided in this Agreement.

 

(b)           Interest Rate. The unpaid principal balance of the Notes shall bear interest from the date hereof through the Maturity Date at a per annum rate which shall be, except as otherwise provided in this Agreement, the lesser of (A) the Loan Rate in effect from day to day, or (B) the Maximum Lawful Rate. The determination by Lender of the Loan Rate shall, in the absence of manifest error, be conclusive and binding in all respects. Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, in the event that (i) LIBOR is permanently or indefinitely unavailable or unascertainable, or ceases to be published by the LIBOR administrator or its successor, (ii) the LIBOR administrator or its successor invokes its insufficient admissions policy, (iii) LIBOR is determined to be no longer representative by the regulatory supervisor of the administrator of LIBOR, (iv) LIBOR can no longer be lawfully relied upon in contracts of this nature by one or both of the parties, or (v) LIBOR does not accurately and fairly reflect the cost of making or maintaining the type of loans or advances under this Agreement and in any such case, such circumstances are unlikely to be temporary, then all references to the Loan Rate herein will instead be to a replacement rate determined by Lender in its reasonable judgment, including any adjustment to the replacement rate to reflect a different credit spread, term or other mathematical adjustment deemed necessary by the Lender in its reasonable judgment. Lender will provide reasonable notice to Borrowers of such replacement rate, which will be effective on the date of the earliest event set forth in clauses (i)-(v) of this paragraph. If there is any ambiguity as to the date of occurrence of any such event, Lender’s judgment will be dispositive.

 

(c)            Default Interest Rate. Any outstanding principal of any Advance and (to the fullest extent permitted by law) any other amount payable by Borrowers under this Agreement or any other Loan Document that is not paid in full when due (whether at stated maturity, by acceleration, or otherwise) shall bear interest at the Default Interest Rate for the period from and including the due date thereof to but excluding the date the same is paid in full. Additionally, upon the occurrence and during the continuance of an Event of Default all outstanding and unpaid principal amounts of all of the Obligations shall, to the extent permitted by law, bear interest at the Default Interest Rate until such time as Lender shall waive in writing the application of the Default Interest Rate to such Event of Default situation. Interest payable at the Default Interest Rate shall be payable from time to time on demand.

 

24

 

  

(d)           Computation of Interest. Interest on the Advances and all other amounts payable by Borrowers hereunder is computed on a 365/360 basis; that is, by applying the ratio of the interest rate over a year of 360 days, multiplied by the outstanding principal balance, multiplied by the actual number of days the principal balance is outstanding.

 

(e)           Application of Payments. Except as expressly provided this Agreement to the contrary, all payments on the Notes shall be applied in the following order of priority: (a) the payment or reimbursement of any Funding Loss, expenses, costs or obligations (other than the outstanding principal balance hereof and interest hereon) for which Borrowers shall be obligated or Lender shall be entitled pursuant to the provisions of this Agreement or the other Loan Documents; (b) the payment of accrued but unpaid interest hereon; and (c) the payment of all or any portion of the principal balance of the Advances then outstanding hereunder. If an Event of Default exists, then Lender may, at the sole option of Lender, apply any such payments, at any time and from time to time, to any of the items specified in clauses (a), (b) or (c) above without regard to the order of priority otherwise specified in this Section 2.02(e) and any application to the outstanding principal balance hereof may be made in either direct or inverse order of maturity. Payments by check or draft shall not constitute payment in immediately available funds until the required amount is actually received by Lender. Payments in immediately available funds received by Lender in the place designated for payment on a Business Day prior to 3:00 p.m. Dallas, Texas time at said place of payment shall be credited prior to the close of business on the Business Day received, while payments received by Lender on a day other than a Business Day or after 3:00 p.m. Dallas, Texas time on a Business Day shall not be credited until the next succeeding Business Day. If any payment of principal or interest on the Notes shall become due and payable on a day other than a Business Day, such payment shall be made on the next succeeding Business Day. Acceptance by Lender of any payment in an amount less than the full amount then due shall be deemed an acceptance on account only, and the failure to pay the entire amount then due may become an Event of Default. Borrowers agree that all payments of any Obligation due hereunder shall be final, and if any such payment is recovered in any bankruptcy, insolvency or similar proceedings instituted by or against Borrowers, all obligations due hereunder shall be automatically reinstated in respect of the obligation as to which payment is so recovered.

 

2.03         Benchmark Replacement Setting. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein or in any other Loan Document (and any Hedge Agreement shall be deemed not to be a “Loan Document” for purposes of this Section):

 

(a)               Replacing USD LIBOR. On March 5, 2021 the Financial Conduct Authority (“FCA”), the regulatory supervisor of USD LIBOR’s administrator (“IBA”), announced in a public statement the future cessation or loss of representativeness of overnight/Spot Next, 1-month, 3-month, 6-month and 12-month USD LIBOR tenor settings. On the earlier of (i) the date that all Available Tenors of USD LIBOR have either permanently or indefinitely ceased to be provided by IBA or have been announced by the FCA pursuant to public statement or publication of information to be no longer representative and (ii) the Early Opt-in Effective Date (the “USD LIBOR Transition Date”), if the then-current Benchmark is USD LIBOR, the Benchmark Replacement will replace such Benchmark for all purposes hereunder and under any Loan Document in respect of any setting of such Benchmark on such day and all subsequent settings without any amendment to, or further action or consent of any other party to this Agreement or any other Loan Document. If the Benchmark Replacement is Daily Simple SOFR, all interest payments will be payable on a monthly basis.

 

25

 

 

(b)            Replacing Future Benchmarks. Upon the occurrence of a Benchmark Transition Event, the Benchmark Replacement will replace the then-current Benchmark for all purposes hereunder and under any Loan Document in respect of any Benchmark setting at or after 5:00 p.m. on the fifth (5th) Business Day after the date notice of such Benchmark Replacement is provided to the Borrower without any amendment to this Agreement or any other Loan Document, or further action or consent of the Borrower. At any time that the administrator of the then-current Benchmark has permanently or indefinitely ceased to provide such Benchmark or such Benchmark has been announced by the regulatory supervisor for the administrator of such Benchmark pursuant to public statement or publication of information to be no longer representative of the underlying market and economic reality that such Benchmark is intended to measure and that representativeness will not be restored, the Borrower may revoke any request for a borrowing of, conversion to or continuation of Loans to be made, converted or continued that would bear interest by reference to such Benchmark until the Borrower’s receipt of notice from the Lender that a Benchmark Replacement has replaced such Benchmark, and, failing that, the Borrower will be deemed to have converted any such request into a request for a borrowing of or conversion to ABR Loans. During the period referenced in the foregoing sentence, the component of ABR based upon the Benchmark will not be used in any determination of ABR.

  

(c)            Benchmark Replacement Conforming Changes. In connection with the implementation and administration of a Benchmark Replacement, the Lender will have the right to make Benchmark Replacement Conforming Changes from time to time and, notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein or in any other Loan Document, any amendments implementing such Benchmark Replacement Conforming Changes will become effective without any further action or consent of any other party to this Agreement.

 

(d)           Notices; Standards for Decisions and Determinations. The Lender will promptly notify the Borrower of (i) the implementation of any Benchmark Replacement and (ii) the effectiveness of any Benchmark Replacement Conforming Changes. Any determination, decision or election that may be made by the Lender pursuant to this Section, including any determination with respect to a tenor, rate or adjustment or of the occurrence or non-occurrence of an event, circumstance or date and any decision to take or refrain from taking any action, will be conclusive and binding absent manifest error and may be made in its sole discretion and without consent from any other party hereto, except, in each case, as expressly required pursuant to this Section.

 

(e)          Unavailability of Tenor of Benchmark. At any time (including in connection with the implementation of a Benchmark Replacement), (i) if the then-current Benchmark is a term rate (including Term SOFR or USD LIBOR), then the Lender may remove any tenor of such Benchmark that is unavailable or non-representative for Benchmark (including Benchmark Replacement) settings and (ii) the Lender may reinstate any such previously removed tenor for Benchmark (including Benchmark Replacement) settings.

 

2.04        2.03 Unused Facility Fee. Borrowers agree to pay to Lender an unused facility fee on the daily unused amount of the Commitment for the period from and including the date of this Agreement to and including the Maturity Date, at the rate of 0.50% per annum based on a 360-day year and the actual number of days elapsed. For the purpose of calculating the unused facility fee hereunder, the Commitment shall be deemed utilized by the amount of all outstanding Revolving Credit Advances. Accrued unused facility fees shall be payable quarterly in arrears on the first (1st) Business Day of each April, July, October, and January during the term of this Agreement and on the Maturity Date.

 

26

 

 

2.05        2.04 Use of Proceeds. The proceeds of the Revolving Credit Advances shall be used by Borrowers to repay Debt, for working capital in the ordinary course of business and other general corporate purposes.

 

2.06        2.05 Late Charges. If a payment required by this Agreement is more than ten (10) days late, Borrowers will be charged 6.000% of the unpaid portion of the regularly scheduled payment or $5.00, whichever is greater.

 

2.07        2.06 Funding Loss. Borrowers shall pay to Lender any amounts required to compensate Lender for any Funding Loss.

 

ARTICLE III. 

PAYMENTS

 

3.01        Method of Payment. All payments of principal, interest, and other amounts to be made by Borrowers under this Agreement and the other Loan Documents shall be made in immediately available funds in Dollars at the Principal Office (or at such other place as Lender, in Lender’s sole discretion, may have established by delivery of written notice thereof to Borrowers from time to time), without offset, in lawful money of the United States of America, which shall at the time of payment be legal tender in payment of all debts and dues, public and private. Payments by check or draft shall not constitute payment in immediately available funds until the required amount is actually received by Lender in full. Payments in immediately available funds received by Lender in the place designated for payment on a Business Day prior to 11:00 a.m. (Dallas, Texas time) at such place of payment shall be credited prior to the close of business on the Business Day received, while payments received by Lender on a day other than a Business Day or after 11:00 a.m. (Dallas, Texas time) on a Business Day shall not be credited until the next succeeding Business Day. If any payment of principal or interest on the Notes shall become due and payable on a day other than a Business Day, then such payment shall be made on the next succeeding Business Day. Any such extension of time for payment shall be included in computing interest which has accrued and shall be payable in connection with such payment.

 

3.02 Prepayments.

 

(a)            Voluntary Prepayments. Borrowers may prepay all or any portion of the Notes at any time without fee, premium or penalty, all or any portion of the outstanding principal balance hereof; provided, that, (i) such prepayment shall also include any and all accrued but unpaid interest on the amount of principal being so prepaid through and including the date of prepayment, plus any other sums which have become due to Lender under the other Loan Documents on or before the date of prepayment, but which have not been fully paid and (ii) such prepayment shall also include any Funding Loss. Prepayments shall be in a minimum of $10,000. Notwithstanding the provisions of this paragraph, Borrowers must consult with Lender prior to making any prepayments when a Hedge Agreement has been executed between Borrowers and Lender in connection with the Notes. Borrowers acknowledge that partial prepayments of the Notes may require the Hedge Agreement to be amended, and full prepayment will terminate the Hedge Agreement. Full and partial prepayments will trigger an early termination valuation under the Hedge Agreement. Thus, an early termination fee may occur under the Hedge Agreement upon partial and full prepayment of the Notes. Notwithstanding the provisions of this paragraph, Borrowers shall remain obligated to pay any fee due and owing under the Hedge Agreement, including but not limited to any fee owed upon early termination of the Hedge Agreement.

 

27

 

 

(b)            Mandatory Prepayment of Revolving Credit Advances. Borrowers must pay on DEMAND the amount by which at any time the unpaid principal balance of the Revolving Credit Note exceeds the Borrowing Base.

 

ARTICLE IV. 

SECURITY

 

4.01        Collateral. To secure full and complete payment and performance of the Obligations, Borrowers and each Guarantor shall execute and deliver or cause to be executed and delivered all of the Security Documents required by Lender covering the Property and Collateral described in such Security Documents. Each Obligated Party shall execute and cause to be executed such further documents and instruments, including without limitation, Uniform Commercial Code financing statements, as Lender, in its sole discretion, deems necessary or desirable to create, evidence, preserve, and perfect its liens and security interests in the Collateral.

 

4.02        Setoff. If an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, Lender shall have the right to set off and apply against the Obligations in such manner as Lender may determine, at any time and without notice to Borrowers, any and all deposits (general or special, time or demand, provisional or final) or other sums at any time credited by or owing from Lender to Borrowers whether or not the Obligations are then due. As further security for the Obligations, Borrowers hereby grant to Lender a security interest in all money, instruments, and other property of Borrowers now or hereafter held by Lender, including, without limitation, property held in safekeeping. In addition to Lender’s right of setoff and as further security for the Obligations, Borrowers hereby grant to Lender a security interest in all deposits (general or special, time or demand, provisional or final) and other accounts of Borrowers now or hereafter on deposit with or held by Lender and all other sums at any time credited by or owing from Lender to Borrowers. The rights and remedies of Lender hereunder are in addition to other rights and remedies (including, without limitation, other rights of setoff) which Lender may have.

 

ARTICLE V. 

CONDITIONS PRECEDENT

 

5.01        Initial Extension of Credit. The obligation of Lender to make the initial Advance under any Note is subject to the condition precedent that Lender shall have received on or before the day of such Advance all of the following, each dated (unless otherwise indicated) the date hereof, in form and substance satisfactory to Lender:

 

(a)           Resolutions. Resolutions of the applicable governing body of each Borrower and each other Obligated Party which authorize the execution, delivery, and performance by such Person of this Agreement and the other Loan Documents to which such Person is or is to be a party;

 

(b)           Incumbency Certificate. A certificate of incumbency certified by a Responsible Officer certifying the names of the individuals or other Persons authorized to sign this Agreement and each of the other Loan Documents to which each Borrower and each other Obligated Party is or is to be a party (including the certificates contemplated herein) on behalf of such Person together with specimen signatures of such individual Persons;

 

(c)           Constituent Documents. The Constituent Documents for each Borrower and each other Obligated Party certified as of a date acceptable to Lender by the appropriate government officials of the state of incorporation or organization of each such party;

 

28

 

 

(d)           Governmental Certificates. Certificates of the appropriate government officials of the state of incorporation or organization of each Borrower, each other Obligated Party and each Pledgor as to the existence and good standing of each such party, each dated within fifteen (15) days (or such longer period acceptable to Lender) prior to the date of the initial Advance;

 

(e)            Notes. The Notes executed by Borrowers;

 

(f)            Intercreditor Agreement. A fully executed copy of the Intercreditor Agreement;

 

(g)           Term Loan Documents. Executed copies of the Term Loan Documents in form reasonably acceptable to Lender;

 

(h)           Preferred Equity Subordination Agreement. A fully executed copy of the Preferred Equity Subordination Agreement;

 

(i)            Security Documents. The Security Documents executed by Borrowers, the other Obligated Parties and the Pledgors;

 

(j)            Financing Statements. UCC financing statements reflecting each of the Obligated Parties, as debtors, and Lender, as secured party, which are required to grant a Lien which secures the Obligations and covering such Collateral as Lender may request;

 

(k)           Insurance Matters. Copies of insurance certificates describing all insurance policies required by Section 7.05 together with loss payable and lender endorsements in favor of Lender with respect to all insurance policies covering Collateral;

 

(l)            UCC Search. The results of a Uniform Commercial Code search showing all financing statements and other documents or instruments on file against each Borrower, and each other Obligated Party in the appropriate filing offices, such search to be as of a date no more than fifteen (15) days (or such longer period acceptable to Lender) prior to the date of the initial Advance;

 

(m)           Attorneys’ Fees and Expenses. Evidence that the costs and expenses (including reasonable attorneys’ fees) referred to in Section 11.01, to the extent incurred, shall have been paid in full by Borrowers;

 

(n)             KYC Information.

 

(i)                 Upon the reasonable request of Lender made at least five (5) days prior to the date hereof, Borrowers shall have provided to Lender, and Lender shall be reasonably satisfied with, the documentation and other information so requested in connection with applicable “know your customer” and anti-money-laundering rules and regulations, including, without limitation, the Patriot Act; and

 

(ii)               At least five (5) days prior to the date hereof, if any Borrower qualifies as a “legal entity customer” under the Beneficial Ownership Regulation, such Borrower shall deliver, to Lender, a Beneficial Ownership Certification in relation to such Borrower;

 

29

 

 

(o)           Existing Debt of Obligated Parties. All of the existing Debt of each Obligated Party (other than Debt permitted to exist pursuant to Section 8.01) will be repaid in full and all security interests related thereto shall be terminated on or prior to the date hereof;

 

(p)           Opinions of Counsel. Customary opinions of legal counsel to Borrowers, each Obligated Party and each Pledgor as to such other matters as Lender may reasonably request;

 

(q)            Closing Fees. Evidence that the Commitment Fee and any other fees due at closing have been paid;

 

(r)             Quality of Earnings. Receipt, review and approval of a quality of earnings report on Borrowers, evidencing a minimum EBITDA of not less than $6,000,000 for the trailing twelve-month period ending June 30, 2020, in form and substance acceptable to Lender; and

 

(s)             Orange 142 Acquisition. Copies of all fully executed material documents evidencing the Orange 142 Acquisition and evidence that the Orange 142 Acquisition has been consummated in accordance with the terms thereof and the requirements of any Governmental Authority.

 

(t)                 Huddled Masses Notes. An executed copy of the Huddled Masses Notes executed by the parties thereto.

 

5.02             All Extensions of Credit. The obligation of Lender to make any Advance or issue any Letter of Credit (including the initial Advance and the initial Letter of Credit) is subject to the following additional conditions precedent:

 

(a)           Request for Advance or Letter of Credit. Lender shall have received in accordance with this Agreement, as the case may be, an Advance Request Form or Letter of Credit Request Form pursuant to Lender’s requirements dated the date of such Advance or Letter of Credit and executed by a Responsible Officer of Borrowers;

 

(b)           No Default. No Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, or would result from or after giving effect to such Advance or Letter of Credit as evidenced by a Compliance Certificate;

 

(c)           No Material Adverse Event. No Material Adverse Event has occurred, and no circumstance exists that could be a Material Adverse Event;

 

(d)           Representations and Warranties. All of the representations and warranties contained in Article VI hereof and in the other Loan Documents shall be true and correct in all material respects on and as of the date of such Advance with the same force and effect as if such representations and warranties had been made on and as of such date, except that for purposes of this Section 5.02(d), the representations and warranties contained in Section 6.02 shall be deemed to refer to (i) Borrowers and the Subsidiaries and (ii) the most recent financial statements furnished pursuant to clauses (a) and (b) of Section 7.01 and any representations and warranties made as of an earlier date shall be true and correct in all material respects as of such earlier date; and

 

(e)           Additional Documentation. Lender shall have received such additional approvals, or documents as Lender or its legal counsel may reasonably request consistent with the transaction contemplated in this Agreement.

 

30

 

 

ARTICLE VI. 

REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES

 

To induce Lender to enter into this Agreement, and except as set forth on the Schedules, Borrowers represents and warrants to Lender that:

 

6.01        Corporate Existence. Each Borrower and each Subsidiary (a) is duly incorporated or organized, as the case may be, validly existing, and in good standing under the laws of the jurisdiction of its incorporation or organization; (b) has all requisite power and authority to own its assets and carry on its business as now being or as proposed to be conducted; and (c) is qualified to do business in all jurisdictions in which the nature of its business makes such qualification necessary and where failure to so qualify could result in a Material Adverse Event. Each Borrower and each of the other Obligated Parties has the power and authority to execute, deliver, and perform its obligations under this Agreement and the other Loan Documents to which it is or may become a party.

 

6.02        Financial Statements, Etc. Borrowers have delivered to Lender audited financial statements of Borrowers as at and for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2019 and unaudited financial statements of Borrowers as of July 31, 2020. Such financial statements are true and correct, have been prepared in accordance with GAAP, and fairly and accurately present, on a consolidated basisConsolidated Basis, the financial condition of Borrowers as of the respective dates indicated therein and the results of operations for the respective periods indicated therein. No Borrower nor any Subsidiary nor any other Obligated Party has any material contingent liabilities, liabilities for taxes, unusual forward or long-term commitments, or unrealized or anticipated losses from any unfavorable commitments except as referred to or reflected in such financial statements. No Material Adverse Event has occurred since the effective date of the financial statements referred to in this Section 6.02. All projections delivered by Borrowers to Lender have been prepared in good faith, with care and diligence and use assumptions that are reasonable under the circumstances at the time such projections were prepared and delivered to Lender and all such assumptions are disclosed in the projections (it being understood for purposes that such projections are subject to significant uncertainties and contingencies, many of which are beyond the control of the Borrowers, that no assurance is given that any particular projections will be realized, and that actual results may differ from the projected results). No Borrower nor any Subsidiary has any material Guarantees, contingent liabilities, liabilities for taxes, or any long-term leases or unusual forward or long-term commitments, or any Hedge Agreement or other transaction or obligation in respect of derivatives, that are not reflected in the most-recent financial statements referred to in this Section 6.02. Other than the Debt listed on Schedule 8.01, Debt reflected on the financial statements delivered pursuant to Sections 5.01(j), 7.01(a) and 7.01(b), and Debt otherwise permitted by Section 8.01, each Borrower and each Subsidiary has no Debt.

 

6.03        Action; No Breach. The execution, delivery, and performance by each Borrower and each other Obligated Party of this Agreement and the other Loan Documents to which such Person is or may become a party and compliance with the terms and provisions hereof and thereof have been duly authorized by all requisite action on the part of such Person and do not and will not (a) violate or conflict with, or result in a breach of, or require any consent under (i) the Constituent Documents of such Person, (ii)   any applicable law, rule, or regulation or any order, writ, injunction, or decree of any Governmental Authority or arbitrator, or (iii) any agreement or instrument to which such Person is a party or by which it or any of its Properties is bound or subject, or (b) constitute a default under any such agreement or instrument, or result in the creation or imposition of any Lien upon any of the revenues or assets of such Person.

 

6.04        Operation of Business. Borrowers and each of the Subsidiaries possess all licenses, permits, franchises, patents, copyrights, trademarks, and tradenames, or rights thereto, necessary to conduct their respective businesses substantially as now conducted and as presently proposed to be conducted, and Borrowers and each of the Subsidiaries are not in violation of any valid rights of others with respect to any of the foregoing.

 

31

 

 

6.05        Litigation and Judgments. There is no action, suit, investigation, or proceeding before or by any Governmental Authority or arbitrator pending, or to the knowledge of Borrowers, threatened against or affecting any Borrower or any of the Subsidiaries, that would, if adversely determined, would constitute a Material Adverse Event on the business, condition (financial or otherwise), operations, or properties of any Borrower or any of the Subsidiaries or the ability of any Borrower to pay and perform the Obligations. There are no outstanding judgments against any Borrower or any Subsidiary.

 

6.06        Rights in Properties; Liens. Borrowers and each of the Subsidiaries have good and indefeasible title to or valid leasehold interests in their respective Properties, including the Properties reflected in the financial statements described in Section 6.02, and none of the Properties of Borrowers or any Subsidiary is subject to any Lien, except Permitted Liens.

 

6.07        Enforceability. This Agreement constitutes, and the other Loan Documents to which Borrowers or any other Obligated Party is a party, when delivered, shall constitute legal, valid, and binding obligations of such Person, enforceable against such Person in accordance with their respective terms, except as limited by bankruptcy, insolvency, or other laws of general application relating to the enforcement of creditors’ rights.

 

6.08        Approvals. No authorization, approval, or consent of, and no filing or registration with, any Governmental Authority or third party is or will be necessary for the execution, delivery, or performance by Borrowers of this Agreement and the other Loan Documents to which each Borrower is or may become a party or the validity or enforceability thereof.

 

6.09         Taxes. Each Borrower and each Subsidiary have filed all tax returns (federal, state, and local) required to be filed, including all income, franchise, employment, Property, and sales tax returns, and have paid all of their respective liabilities for taxes, assessments, governmental charges, and other levies that are due and payable, except where the failure to file such tax returns or to pay such taxes would not reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Event. No Borrower knows of any pending investigation of any Borrower or any of the Subsidiaries by any taxing authority or of any pending but unassessed tax liability of Borrowers or any of the Subsidiaries.

 

6.10       Use of Proceeds; Margin Securities. No Borrower nor any Subsidiary is engaged principally, or as one of its important activities, in the business of extending credit for the purpose of purchasing or carrying margin stock (within the meaning of Regulations G, T, U, or X of the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System), and no part of the proceeds of any Advance will be used to purchase or carry any margin stock or to extend credit to others for the purpose of purchasing or carrying margin stock.

 

6.11        ERISA. Each Plan that is intended to qualify under Section 401(a) of the Code has received a favorable determination letter from the IRS or an application for such a letter is currently being processed by the IRS with respect thereto and, to the knowledge of Borrowers, nothing has occurred which would prevent, or cause the loss of, such qualification. No application for a funding waiver or an extension of any amortization period pursuant to Section 412 of the Code has been made with respect to any Plan. There are no pending or, to the knowledge of Borrowers, threatened claims, actions or lawsuits, or action by any Governmental Authority, with respect to any Plan. There has been no Prohibited Transaction or violation of the fiduciary responsibility rules with respect to any Plan. No ERISA Event has occurred or is reasonably expected to occur. No Plan has any Unfunded Pension Liability. No Obligated Party or ERISA Affiliate has incurred, or reasonably expects to incur, any liability under Title IV of ERISA with respect to any Plan (other than premiums due and not delinquent under Section 4007 of ERISA). No Obligated Party or ERISA Affiliate has incurred, or reasonably expects to incur, any liability (and no event has occurred which, with the giving of notice under Section 4219 of ERISA, would result in such liability) under Section 4201 or 4243 of ERISA with respect to a Multiemployer Plan. No Obligated Party or ERISA Affiliate has engaged in a transaction that could be subject to Section 4069 or 4212(c) of ERISA.

 

32

 

 

6.12        Disclosure. No written statement, information, report, representation, or warranty made by any Borrower or any other Obligated Party in this Agreement or in any other Loan Document or furnished to Lender in connection with this Agreement or any of the transactions contemplated hereby contains any untrue statement of a material fact or omits to state any material fact necessary to make the statements herein or therein not misleading. There is no fact known to any Borrower which is a Material Adverse Event, or which might in the future be a Material Adverse Event that has not been disclosed in writing to Lender.

 

6.13        Subsidiaries, Ventures, Etc. Borrowers have no Subsidiaries, or joint ventures or partnerships other than those listed on Schedule 6.13 and Schedule 6.13 sets forth the jurisdiction of incorporation or organization of each such Person and the percentage of Borrowers’ ownership interest in such Person. All of the outstanding capital stock or other ownership interest of each Person described in Schedule 6.13 has been validly issued, is fully paid, and is non-assessable (except with respect to limited liability company interests). There are no outstanding subscriptions, options, warrants, calls, rights or other agreements or commitments (other than stock or similar options granted to employees or directors and directors’ qualifying shares) of any nature relating to any Equity Interests of Borrowers or any Subsidiary, except as created by the Loan Documents. Each Subsidiary of Borrowers is a Subsidiary Guarantor (other than Orange 142 Advertising Canada, Inc.).

 

6.14        Agreements. No Borrower nor any Subsidiary is a party to any indenture, loan, or credit agreement, or to any lease or other agreement or instrument, or subject to any charter or corporate or other organizational restriction which could create or cause a Material Adverse Event on the business, condition (financial or otherwise), operations, or properties of Borrowers or any Subsidiary, or the ability of Borrowers to pay and perform its obligations under the Loan Documents to which it is a party. No Borrower nor any Subsidiary is in default in any material respect in the performance, observance, or fulfillment of any of the obligations, covenants, or conditions contained in any agreement or instrument material to its business to which it is a party.

 

6.15        Compliance with Laws. No Borrower nor any Subsidiary is in violation in any material respect of any law, rule, regulation, order, or decree of any Governmental Authority or arbitrator.

 

6.16        Regulated Entities. No Borrower nor any Subsidiary is (a) an “investment company” or a company “controlled” by an “investment company” within the meaning of the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended, or (b) subject to regulation under the Federal Power Act, the Interstate Commerce Act, any state public utilities code, or any other federal or state statute, rule or regulation limiting its ability to incur Debt, pledge its assets or perform its obligations under the Loan Documents.

 

6.17 Environmental Matters.

 

(a)           Each Borrower, each Subsidiary, and all of their respective properties, assets, and operations are in compliance in all material respects with all Environmental Laws. No Borrower is aware of, nor has Borrower received notice of, any past, present, or future conditions, events, activities, practices, or incidents which may interfere with or prevent the compliance or continued compliance of Borrowers and the Subsidiaries with all Environmental Laws;

 

33

 

 

 

(b)                Each Borrower and each Subsidiary have obtained all permits, licenses, and authorizations that are required under applicable Environmental Laws, and all such permits are in good standing and each Borrower and the Subsidiaries are in compliance with all of the terms and conditions of such permits except to the extent that it would not cause a Material Adverse Event;

  

(c)                No Hazardous Materials exist on, about, or within or have been used, generated, stored, transported, disposed of on, or Released from any of the properties or assets of any Borrower or any Subsidiary except in accordance with Environmental Laws. The use which Borrowers and the Subsidiaries make and intend to make of their respective properties and assets will not result in the use, generation, storage, transportation, accumulation, disposal, or Release of any Hazardous Material on, in, or from any of their properties or assets except in accordance with Environmental Laws;

 

(d)                No Borrower nor any Subsidiary nor any of their respective currently or previously owned or, to any Borrower’s knowledge, leased properties or operations is subject to any outstanding or threatened order from or agreement with any Governmental Authority or other Person or subject to any judicial or docketed administrative proceeding with respect to (i) failure to comply with Environmental Laws, (ii) Remedial Action, or (iii) any Environmental Liabilities arising from a Release or threatened Release;

 

(e)                There are no conditions or circumstances associated with the currently or previously owned or, to any Borrower’s knowledge, leased properties or operations of any Borrower or any Subsidiary that could reasonably be expected to give rise to any Environmental Liabilities;

 

(f)                 No Borrower nor any of the Subsidiaries is a treatment, storage, or disposal facility requiring a permit under the Resource Conservation and Recovery Act, 42 U.S.C. §6901 et seq., regulations thereunder or any comparable provision of state law. Borrowers and the Subsidiaries are in compliance in all material respects with all applicable financial responsibility requirements of all Environmental Laws;

 

(g)                No Borrower nor any Subsidiary has filed or failed to file any notice required under applicable Environmental Law reporting a Release except to the extent that it would not cause a Material Adverse Event; and

 

(h)                No Lien arising under any Environmental Law has attached to any property or revenues of any Borrower or the Subsidiaries except to the extent that it would not cause a Material Adverse Event.

 

6.18        Intellectual Property. All material copyrights, trademarks and patents owned or used by Borrowers and the Subsidiaries is listed, together with application or registration numbers, where applicable, in Schedule 6.18. Each Person identified on Schedule 6.18 owns, or is licensed to use, all intellectual property necessary to conduct its business as currently conducted except for such Intellectual Property the failure of which to own or license could be a Material Adverse Event. Each Person identified on Schedule 6.18 will maintain the patenting and registration of all copyrights, trademarks and patents with the United States Patent and Trademark Office, the United States Copyright Office, or other appropriate Governmental Authority, and each Person identified on Schedule 6.18 will promptly patent or register, as the case may be, all new copyrights, trademarks and patents and notify Lender in writing five (5) Business Days prior to filing any such new patent or registration.

 

34  

 

 

6.19        Foreign Assets Control Regulations and Anti-Money Laundering. Each Obligated Party and each Subsidiary of each Obligated Party is and will remain in compliance in all material respects with all United States economic sanctions laws, Executive Orders and implementing regulations as promulgated by the United States Treasury Department’s Office of Foreign Assets Control (“OFAC”), and all applicable anti-money laundering and counter-terrorism financing provisions of the Bank Secrecy Act and all regulations issued pursuant to it. No Obligated Party and no Subsidiary, and to Borrowers’ knowledge, no Affiliate, or any director, officer, employee, agent, affiliate or representative of any Obligated Party, is an individual or entity that is, or is owned or controlled by any individual or entity that is (a) currently the subject or target of any Sanctions, (b) a Person designated by the United States government on the list of the Specially Designated Nationals and Blocked Persons (the “SDN List”) with which a United States Person cannot deal with or otherwise engage in business transactions, or included on HMT’s Consolidated List of Financial Sanctions Targets and the Investment Ban List or any similar list enforced by any other relevant sanctions authority, (c) a Person who is otherwise the target of United States economic sanction laws such that a United States Person cannot deal or otherwise engage in business transactions with such Person, or (d) located, organized or resident in a Designated Jurisdiction.

 

6.20        Patriot Act. The Obligated Parties, each of their Subsidiaries, and, to Borrowers’ knowledge, each of their Affiliates are in compliance with (a) the Trading with the Enemy Act, and each of the foreign assets control regulations of the United States Treasury Department (31 CFR, Subtitle B Chapter V, as amended), and all other enabling legislation or executive order relating thereto, (b) the Patriot Act, and (c) all other federal or state laws relating to “know your customer” and anti-money laundering rules and regulations. No part of the proceeds of any Revolving Loan will be used directly or indirectly for any payments to any government official or employee, political party, official of a political party, candidate for political office, or anyone else acting in an official capacity, in order to obtain, retain or direct business or obtain any improper advantage, in violation of the United States Foreign Corrupt Practices Act of 1977.

 

6.21        Solvency. Direct Digital and its Subsidiaries, on a consolidated basisConsolidated Basis, are solvent and have not entered into any transaction with the intent to hinder, delay or defraud a creditor.

 

6.22        Anti-Corruption Laws. Each Obligated Party and each Subsidiary of each Obligated Party has conducted their businesses in compliance with the United States Foreign Corrupt Practices Act of 1977, the UK Bribery Act 2010, and other similar anti-corruption legislation in other jurisdictions, and has instituted and maintained policies and procedures designed to promote and achieve compliance with such laws.

 

6.23        Beneficial Ownership Regulation. The information included in the Beneficial Ownership Certification is true and correct in all respects.

 

35  

 

 

ARTICLE VII. 

AFFIRMATIVE COVENANTS

 

Each Borrower covenants and agrees that, as long as the Obligations or any part thereof are outstanding, or Lender has any Commitment hereunder, such Borrower will perform and observe the following positive covenants, unless Lender shall otherwise consent in writing:

 

7.01 Reporting Requirements. Borrowers will furnish to Lender:

 

(a)                Annual Financial Statements. As soon as available, and in any event (i) prior to a Qualified IPO,within one hundred twenty (120) days after the fiscal year of Borrowers, and (ii) following a Qualified IPO, within ninety (90) days after the fiscal year of Borrowers, a copy of the annual audit report of Borrowers and the Subsidiaries for such fiscal year containing, on a consolidatedConsolidated and consolidating basisConsolidating Basis, balance sheets and statements of income, retained earnings, and cash flow as at the end of such fiscal year and for the twelve-month period then ended, in each case setting forth in comparative form the figures for the preceding fiscal year, all in reasonable detail and audited and certified by independent certified public accountants of recognized standing acceptable to Lender, to the effect that such report has been prepared in accordance with GAAP and containing no material qualifications or limitations on scope;

 

(b)                Monthly Financial Statements; Quarterly Financial Statements. As soon as available, and in any event (i) prior to a Qualified IPO, within thirty (30) days after the end of each calendar month, and (ii) following a Qualified IPO, within forty-five (45) days after the fiscal quarters of Borrowers, a copy of an unaudited financial report of Borrowers and the Subsidiaries as of the end of such monthperiod and for the portion of the fiscal year then ended, containing, on a consolidatedConsolidated and consolidatingConsolidating basis, balance sheets and statements of income, retained earnings, and cash flow, all in reasonable detail certified by a Responsible Officer of Borrowers to have been prepared in accordance with GAAP and to fairly and accurately present (subject to year-end audit adjustments) the financial condition and results of operations of Borrowers and the Subsidiaries, on a consolidated and consolidating basis, at the date and for the periods indicated therein;

 

(c)                Borrowing Base Report. As soon as available, and in any event within thirty (30) days after the end of each calendar month, a Borrowing Base Report, in substantially the form of Exhibit A attached hereto, certified by a Responsible Officer of Borrowers;

 

(d)                Compliance Certificate. As soon as available, and in any event within thirty (30) days after the end of each fiscal quarter of Borrowers thereafter, and together with the delivery of the financial statements required pursuant to Section 7.01(a) above, a Compliance Certificate executed by a Responsible Officer of Borrowers;

 

(e)                Management Letters. Promptly upon receipt thereof, a copy of any management letter or written report submitted to Borrowers or any Subsidiary by independent certified public accountants with respect to the business, condition (financial or otherwise), operations, or properties of Borrowers or any Subsidiary; provided, that the foregoing shall not apply with respect to any such letters or reports relating solely to procedural or filing requirements with respect to a Qualified IPO;

 

(f)                 Notice of Litigation. Promptly after the commencement thereof, notice of all actions, suits, and proceedings before any Governmental Authority or arbitrator affecting any Borrower or any Subsidiary which, if determined adversely to such Borrower or such Subsidiary, could cause or create a Material Adverse Event on the business, condition (financial or otherwise), operations, or properties of such Borrower or such Subsidiary;

 

36  

 

 

(g)                Notice of Material Adverse Event. As soon as possible and in any event within five (5) Business Days after the occurrence thereof, written notice of any event or circumstance that could reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Event;

 

(h)                ERISA Reports. Promptly after the filing or receipt thereof, copies of all reports, including annual reports, and notices which any Borrower or any Subsidiary files with or receives from the PBGC or the U.S. Department of Labor under ERISA; and as soon as possible and in any event within ten (10) days after any Borrower or any Subsidiary knows or has reason to know that any Reportable Event or Prohibited Transaction has occurred with respect to any Plan or that the PBGC or any Borrower or any Subsidiary has instituted or will institute proceedings under Title IV of ERISA to terminate any Plan, a certificate of a Responsible Officer of such Borrower setting forth the details as to such Reportable Event or Prohibited Transaction or Plan termination and the action that such Borrower proposes to take with respect thereto;

 

(i)                 Annual Projections. As soon as available, but in any event not more than forty-five (45) days after the end of each fiscal year of Borrowers, forecasts prepared by management of Borrowers and approved by the members of Borrowers, in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to Lender, of financial projections of Borrowers and the Subsidiaries on a monthly basis for the current fiscal year; provided, that following a Qualified IPO, to the extent the foregoing constitutes material non-public information, no Borrower shall be required to deliver any such financial projections until such time as Lender delivers to the Borrowers a non-disclosure agreement that is in form and substance satisfactory to the Borrowers in their reasonable discretion containing, among other things, standstill provisions preventing transactions in the stock of DDH Holdings and Borrowers;

 

(j)                 KYC. Promptly following any request therefor, Borrowers shall provide information and documentation reasonably requested by Lender for purposes of compliance with applicable “know your customer” requirements under the Patriot Act, the Beneficial Ownership Regulation or other applicable anti-money laundering laws, including but not limited to a Beneficial Ownership Certification form acceptable to Lender; and

 

(k)                General Information. Promptly, such other information concerning Borrowers, or any Subsidiary or Obligated Party as Lender may from time to time reasonably request.

 

7.02          Maintenance of Existence; Conduct of Business. Borrowers will preserve and maintain, and will cause each Subsidiary to preserve and maintain, its existence and all of its leases, privileges, licenses, permits, franchises, qualifications, and rights the failure of which to maintain would result in a Material Adverse Event. Borrowers will conduct, and will cause each Subsidiary to conduct, its business in an orderly and efficient manner in accordance with good business practices. Without limitation, Borrowers will not make (and will not permit any of the Subsidiaries to make) any material change in its credit collection policies if such change would materially impair the collectability of any account, nor will it rescind, cancel or modify any account except in the ordinary course of business.

 

7.03        Maintenance of Properties. Borrowers will maintain, keep, and preserve, and cause each Subsidiary to maintain, keep, and preserve, all of its Properties (tangible and intangible) necessary or useful in the proper conduct of its business in good working order and condition.

 

7.04       Taxes and Claims. Borrowers will pay or discharge, and will cause each Subsidiary to pay or discharge, at or before maturity or before becoming delinquent (a) all taxes, levies, assessments, and governmental charges imposed on it or its income or profits or any of its property, and (b) all lawful claims for labor, material, and supplies, which, if unpaid, might become a Lien upon any of its property; provided, however, that no Borrower nor any Subsidiary shall be required to pay or discharge (i) any tax, levy, assessment, or governmental charge or (ii) such Lien for labor, material or supplies, which is (y) being contested in good faith by appropriate proceedings diligently pursued, and for which adequate reserves have been established or (z) where such failure to pay or discharge would not reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Event.

 

37  

 

 

7.05          Insurance.

 

(a)                Borrowers shall, and shall cause each of the Subsidiaries to, maintain insurance with financially sound and reputable insurance companies in such amounts and covering such risks as is usually carried by corporations engaged in similar businesses and owning similar Properties in the same general areas in which Borrowers and the Subsidiaries operate, provided that in any event Borrowers will maintain and cause each of the Subsidiaries to maintain workmen’s compensation insurance, property insurance, comprehensive general liability insurance, reasonably satisfactory to Lender. Each insurance policy covering Collateral shall name Lender as loss payee and each insurance policy covering liabilities shall name Lender as additional insured, and each such insurance policy shall provide that such policy will not be cancelled or reduced without thirty (30) days prior written notice to Lender.

 

(b)                During the continuance of an Event of Default, all proceeds of insurance shall be paid over to Lender for application to the Obligations. So long as no Event of Default is continuing, subject to Section 7.05(c), all proceeds of insurance in excess of $50,000 shall be paid over to Lender for application to the Obligations.

 

(c)                Borrowers may apply the net proceeds of a casualty or condemnation (each a “Loss”) to the repair, restoration, or replacement of the assets suffering such Loss, so long as (i) such repair, restoration, or replacement is completed within two hundred seventy (270) days after the date of such Loss (or such longer period of time agreed to in writing by Lender), (ii) while such repair, restoration, or replacement is underway, all of such net proceeds are on deposit with Lender in a separate deposit account over which Lender has exclusive control, and (iii) such Loss did not cause an Event of Default. If an Event of Default occurs pursuant to which Lender exercises its rights to accelerate the Obligations as provided in Section 10.02 or such repair, restoration, or replacement is not completed within two hundred seventy (270) days of the date of such Loss (or such longer period of time agreed to in writing by Lender), then Lender may immediately and without notice to any Person apply all of such net proceeds to the Obligations, regardless of any other prior agreement regarding the disposition of such net proceeds.

 

7.06        Inspection Rights. Upon reasonable prior notice to Borrowers from Lender, and at any reasonable time and from time to time, Borrowers shall, and shall cause each of the Subsidiaries to, (a) permit representatives of Lender to examine, inspect, review, evaluate and make physical verifications and appraisals of the inventory and other Collateral in any manner and through any medium that Lender considers advisable, (b) to examine, copy, and make extracts from its books and records, (c) to visit and inspect its Properties, and (d) to discuss its business, operations, and financial condition with its officers, employees, and independent certified public accountants, in each instance, at Borrowers’ expense; provided, that so long as no Default or Event of Default has occurred and is continuing such inspection rights shall be limited to no more than twice per calendar year.

 

7.07        Keeping Books and Records. Borrowers will maintain, and will cause each Subsidiary to maintain, proper books of record and account in which full, true, and correct entries in conformity with GAAP shall be made of all dealings and transactions in relation to its business and activities.

 

38  

 

 

7.08        Compliance with Laws. Borrowers will comply, and will cause each Subsidiary to comply, in all material respects with all applicable laws, rules, regulations, orders, and decrees of any Governmental Authority or arbitrator.

 

7.09          Compliance with Agreements. Borrowers will comply, and will cause each Subsidiary to comply, in all material respects with all agreements, contracts, and instruments binding on it or affecting its properties or business.

 

7.10        Further Assurances. Borrowers will, and will cause each Subsidiary to, execute and deliver such further agreements and instruments and take such further action (including promptly completing any registration or stamping of documents as may be applicable) as may be requested by Lender to carry out the provisions and purposes of this Agreement and the other Loan Documents and to create, preserve, and perfect the Liens of Lender in the Collateral.

 

7.11        ERISA. Borrowers will comply, and will cause each Subsidiary to comply, with all minimum funding requirements, and all other material requirements, of ERISA, if applicable, so as not to give rise to any liability thereunder.

 

7.12        Depository Relationship. To induce Lender to establish the interest rates provided for in the Notes, Borrowers shall, and shall cause each of the Subsidiaries to, within ninety (90) days after the date of this Agreement, use Lender as its principal depository bank and Borrowers shall, and shall cause each of the Subsidiaries to, maintain Lender as its principal depository bank, including for the maintenance of business, cash management, operating and administrative deposit accounts.

 

7.13        Subsidiaries. Concurrently upon the formation or acquisition of any Subsidiary after the date hereof (an “After-Acquired Subsidiary”), Borrowers shall cause the After-Acquired Subsidiary to deliver all of its Constituent Documents to Lender and (a) if such Subsidiary is a Domestic Subsidiary, execute a Guaranty in favor of Lender and such Loan Documents as shall be required by Lender to create first priority Liens in the Priority Collateral and second priority Liens in the Term Loan Priority Collateral (in each case, subject to Liens permitted under Section 8.02) in favor of Lender in such After-Acquired Subsidiary’s assets and such other documents as Lender deems reasonably necessary in connection with such actions and execute any other amendment to this Agreement as deemed necessary by Lender and (b) execute and deliver or cause to be delivered to Lender all Security Documents, stock certificates, stock powers and other agreements and instruments as may be requested by Lender to ensure that Lender has a perfected Lien on all Priority Collateral held by Borrowers or any other Obligated Party with respect to such Subsidiary.

 

7.14        Keepwell. Borrowers hereby absolutely, unconditionally and irrevocably undertake to provide such funds or other support to each Specified Obligated Party with respect to such Hedge Obligations as may be needed by such Specified Obligated Party from time to time to honor all of its obligations under its Guaranty and the other Loan Documents in respect of such Hedge Obligations and to cause such Specified Obligated Party to be an Eligible Contract Participant (as defined in the Commodity Exchange Act) with respect to all Hedge Obligations (but, in each case, only up to the maximum amount of such liability that can be hereby incurred without rendering Borrowers’ obligations and undertakings under this Section 7.14 voidable under applicable law relating to fraudulent conveyance or fraudulent transfer, and not for any greater amount). The obligations and undertakings of Borrowers under this Section 7.14 shall remain in full force and effect until the Obligations have been indefeasibly paid and performed in full. Borrowers intend this Section 7.14 to constitute, and this Section 7.14 shall be deemed to constitute, a Guarantee of the obligations of, and a “keepwell, support, or other agreement” (as defined in the Commodity Exchange Act) for the benefit of, each Specified Obligated Party for all purposes of the Commodity Exchange Act.

 

39  

 

 

7.15        Deposit Account Control Agreements. No Borrower shall maintain any deposit accounts, except with respect to which the Lender has notice, setting forth the information included for Accounts on Schedule 3.10 to the Security Agreement. Each deposit account maintained by any Borrower shall be subject to an account control agreement satisfactory in form and substance satisfactory to the Lender, provided that no account control agreement shall be required during the first 30 days after the date hereof with respect to deposit accounts identified on Schedule 3.10 to the Security Agreement with Silicon Valley Bank, Investar Bank or JPMorgan Chase (the “Transition Deposit Accounts”). Within 30 days after the date hereof, the applicable Borrower maintaining any Transition Deposit Account shall either (i) transfer all funds in such Transition Deposit Account to another deposit account then subject to an account control agreement satisfactory in form and substance to the Lender and close such Transition Deposit Account or (ii) enter into an account control agreement satisfactory in form and substance to the Lender with respect to such Transition Deposit Account.

 

7.16 Management Fee Subordination Agreement Within fifteen (15) days of the date hereof, Direct Digital, Keith Smith and Mark Walker will enter into subordination agreements in form and substance reasonably acceptable to the Lender with respect to the management fees payable under and pursuant to the Board Services and Consulting Agreements each dated as of September 30, 2020, by and between Direct Digital, on the one hand, and Keith Smith and Mark Walker on the other hand.

 

ARTICLE VIII. 

NEGATIVE COVENANTS

 

Each Borrower covenants and agrees that, as long as the Obligations or any part thereof are outstanding, or Lender has any Commitment hereunder, Borrower will perform and observe the following negative covenants, unless Lender shall otherwise consent in writing:

 

8.01       Debt. No Borrower will incur, create, assume, or permit to exist, and will not permit any Subsidiary to incur, create, assume, or permit to exist, any Debt (other than Permitted Indebtedness), unless

 

(a) There is not then an Event of Default or Default that has occurred and is continuing;

 

(b) Such Debt constitutes Subordinated Debt and matures after the Maturity Date; and

 

(c)                After giving effect to such additional Debt, such Borrower’s Debt is less than 2.5 times its EBITDA over the preceding 12 month period as reported in its most recent quarterly or annual financial statements.

 

8.02          Limitation on Liens. No Borrower will incur, create, assume, or permit to exist, and will not permit any Subsidiary to incur, create, assume, or permit to exist, any Lien upon any of its property, assets, or revenues, whether now owned or hereafter acquired, other than Permitted Liens.

 

8.03       Mergers, Etc. No Borrower will, nor will it permit any Subsidiary to, become a party to a merger or consolidation, or any Acquisition, or wind-up, dissolve, or liquidate, including, in each case, pursuant to a Delaware LLC Division, other than (i)the Orange 142 Acquisition, (ii) or a Qualified IPO, (iii) in order to effect the Reorganization Transactions, or (iv) in order to effect the Redemption/Exchange Transactions.

 

40  

 

 

8.04         Restricted Payments. No Borrower shall, and nor shall it allow any Subsidiary to, (a) repurchase or redeem any class of stock or other Equity Interest other than (i) pursuant to employee, director or consultant repurchase plans or other similar agreements; provided, however, in each case (other than any such repurchase or redemption in the ordinary course of business in connection with an employee incentive plan or other transaction permitted by Section 8.07) the repurchase or redemption price does not exceed the original consideration paid for such stock or Equity Interest, (ii) the conversion of any of its convertible securities into other securities of such Borrower pursuant to the terms of such convertible securities or, (iii) the payment of cash in lieu of fractional shares upon the conversion of any such convertible securities, not to exceed $500,000 in the aggregate, or (iv) pursuant to the Reorganization Transactions, a Qualified IPO or the Redemption/Exchange Transactions; (b) declare or pay any cash dividend or make a cash distribution on any class of stock or other Equity Interest, except (i)   that a Subsidiary may pay dividends or make distributions to any Borrower and such Borrower may make Permitted Tax Distributions to its direct and indirect equity holders and, (ii) as expressly permitted under the terms of the Preferred Equity Subordination Agreement and Section 8.18 hereof, (iii) subsequent to a Qualified IPO and to the extent made with cash proceeds of a Qualified IPO, cash payments to any holders of Direct Digital’s preferred Equity Interests, and (iv) with respect to the payment of Public Company Costs to the extent reasonably acceptable to Lender; (c) lend money to any employees, officers or directors or guarantee the payment of any such loans granted by a third party in excess of $250,000 in the aggregate at any one time outstanding; (d) waive, release or forgive any Indebtedness owed by any employees, officers or directors in excess of $250,000 in the aggregate, or (e) make any payments on Subordinated Debt (collectively, “Restricted Payments”) unless:

 

(a)               There shall not than be an Event of Default or Default that has occurred and is continuing, and

 

(b)               Both before and after giving effect to such Restricted Payment, (i) each of the Financial Covenants in Article IX shall be satisfied and (ii) the Borrowers’ Total Debt shall be less than 2.5 times their EBITDA over the preceding 12 month period reported in its most recent quarterly or annual financial statements.

 

8.05          Loans and Investments. No Borrower will make, and will not permit any Subsidiary to make, any advance, loan, extension of credit, or capital contribution to or investment in, or purchase, or permit any Subsidiary to purchase, any stock, bonds, notes, debentures, or other securities of, any Person, other than (i) Permitted Investments, (ii) pursuant to the Reorganization Transactions and a Qualified IPO, or (iii) Investments required to finance the buyout of the SSP licensing agreement by a Borrower in an amount not to exceed $750,000 in the aggregate; provided that no Event of Default has occurred and is continuing or would occur after giving effect to such Investments.

 

8.06        Limitation on Issuance of Equity. Except as permitted by Sections 8.07, 8.08 and 8.18, or pursuant to the Reorganization Transactions, the Redemption/Exchange Transactions or a Qualified IPO, no Borrower will, nor will it permit any Subsidiary to, at any time issue, sell, assign, or otherwise dispose of (a) any of its Equity Interests, (b) any securities exchangeable for or convertible into or carrying any rights to acquire any of its Equity Interests, or (c) any option, warrant, or other right to acquire any of its Equity Interests.

 

8.07        Transactions with Affiliates. No Borrower will enter into, nor will it permit any Subsidiary to enter into, any transaction, including, without limitation, the purchase, sale, or exchange of property or the rendering of any service, with any Affiliate of such Borrower or such Subsidiary, except (a) in the ordinary course of and pursuant to the reasonable requirements of such Borrower’s or such Subsidiary’s business and upon fair and reasonable terms no less favorable to such Borrower or such Subsidiary than would be obtained in a comparable arm’s-length transaction with a Person not an Affiliate of Borrowers or such Subsidiary, (b) the payment of management fees as permitted pursuant to Section 8.19, (c) compensation and employee benefit, incentive and severance arrangements paid to, and indemnities provided for the benefit of, directors, officers or employees any Borrower or their respective Subsidiaries in the ordinary course of business, (d) any issuances of securities or other payments, awards or grants in cash, securities or otherwise pursuant to, or the funding of, employment agreements, stock options and stock ownership plans approved by the governing body of Direct Digital or DDH Holdings, as applicable, (e) transactions pursuant to the Tax Receivable Agreement, and (f) transactions pursuant to the Redemption/Exchange Transactions.

 

41  

 

 

8.08        Disposition of Assets. No Borrower will sell, lease, assign, transfer, or otherwise dispose of any of its assets, or permit any Subsidiary to do so with any of its assets, except (a) dispositions of inventory in the ordinary course of business or, (b) dispositions, for fair value, of worn-out and obsolete equipment not necessary or useful to the conduct of business, or (c) pursuant to the Reorganization Transactions, the Redemption/Exchange Transactions or a Qualified IPO.

 

8.09          Sale and Leaseback. No Borrower will enter into, nor will it permit any Subsidiary to enter into, any arrangement with any Person pursuant to which it leases from such Person real or personal property that has been or is to be sold or transferred, directly or indirectly, by it to such Person.

 

8.10        Nature of Business. No Borrower will, nor will it permit any Subsidiary to, engage in any business other than the businesses in which they are engaged as of the date hereof and businesses reasonably related thereto and logical extensions thereof.

 

8.11        Environmental Protection. No Borrower will, nor will it permit any Subsidiary to, (a) use (or permit any tenant to use) any of their respective properties or assets for the handling, processing, storage, transportation, or disposal of any Hazardous Material, (b) generate any Hazardous Material, (c) conduct any activity that is likely to cause a Release or threatened Release of any Hazardous Material, or (d)  otherwise conduct any activity or use any of their respective properties or assets in any manner that is likely to violate any Environmental Law or create any Environmental Liabilities for which Borrowers or any Subsidiary would be responsible.

 

8.12        Accounting. No Borrower will, nor will it permit any Subsidiary to, change its fiscal year or make any change (a) in accounting treatment or reporting practices, except as required by GAAP and disclosed to Lender, or (b) in tax reporting treatment, except as required by law and disclosed to Lender.

 

8.13        No Negative Pledge. No Borrower will, nor will it permit any Subsidiary to, enter into or permit to exist any arrangement or agreement, other than pursuant to this Agreement, any Loan Document, or the Term Loan Documents, which directly or indirectly prohibits any Borrower or any Subsidiary from creating or incurring a Lien on any of its assets.

 

8.14        Subsidiaries. No Borrower will, directly or indirectly, form or acquire any Subsidiary unless such Subsidiary complies with the requirements of Section 7.13.

 

8.15        Hedge Agreements. No Borrower will, nor shall it permit any Subsidiary to, enter into any Hedge Agreement, except (a) Hedge Agreements entered into to hedge or mitigate risks to which Borrowers or any Subsidiary have actual exposure (other than those in respect of Equity Interests or any Term Loan Debt) which have terms and conditions reasonably acceptable to Lender, and (b) other Hedge Agreements entered into in order to effectively cap, collar or exchange interest rates (from fixed to floating rates, from one floating rate to another floating rate or otherwise) with respect to any Debt of Borrowers or any Subsidiary which have terms and conditions reasonably acceptable to Lender.

 

42  

 

 

8.16        OFAC. No Borrower will, nor shall it permit any Subsidiary to, fail to comply with the laws, regulations and executive orders referred to in Sections 6.19 and 6.20. No Borrower shall, directly or indirectly, use the proceeds of any Loan, or lend, contribute or otherwise make available such proceeds to any Subsidiary, joint venture partner or other individual or entity, to fund any activities of or business with any individual or entity, or in any Designated Jurisdiction, that, at the time of such funding, is the subject of Sanctions, or in any other manner that will result in a violation by any individual or entity of Sanctions.

 

8.17        Payments under Term Loan Agreement. No Borrower will, nor will it permit any Subsidiary to, directly or indirectly, make any optional or voluntary payment, prepayment, repurchase or redemption of any Term Loan Debt not otherwise permitted under the terms of the Intercreditor Agreement.

 

8.18        Payments on Preferred Equity. No Borrower will, nor will it permit any Subsidiary to, directly or indirectly, make any optional or voluntary payment, prepayment, repurchase or redemption on any Preferred Equity not otherwise permitted under the terms of the Preferred Equity Subordination Agreement, other than in connection with the Reorganization Transactions and a Qualified IPO.

 

8.19        Payment of Management Fees. Prior to a Qualified IPO, no Borrower will, nor will it permit any Subsidiary to, directly or indirectly, make any payment of management fees, provided that, so long as no Default exists or would result therefrom and the Borrower and its Subsidiaries are in compliance with the covenants set forth in Article IX before and after giving pro forma effect thereto, a Borrower may pay the fees described in the Board Services and Consulting Agreements each dated as of September 30, 2020, by and between Direct Digital, on the one hand, and Keith Smith and Mark Walker on the other hand to the extent permitted under the terms of the Management Fee Subordination Agreement.

 

ARTICLE IX. 

FINANCIAL COVENANTS

 

Each Borrower covenants and agrees that, as long as the Obligations or any part thereof are outstanding, or Lender has any Commitment hereunder, such Borrower will, at all times, observe and perform the following financial covenants, unless Lender shall otherwise consent in writing.

 

9.01        Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio. Borrowers will maintain a Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio of not less than 1.25 to 1.0, beginning with the fiscal quarter of Borrowers ending September 30, 2020. Beginning with the fiscal quarter of Borrowers ending December 31, 2021 and thereafter, Borrowers will maintain a Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio of not less than 1.50 to 1.00. This ratio shall be calculated at the end of each fiscal quarter of Borrowers using the results of the twelve-month period ending with such fiscal quarter end.

 

9.02        Total Leverage Ratio. Borrowers will maintain a Total Leverage Ratio not to exceed the ratio set forth in the following table:    

 

December 31, 2020 3.00:1.00
March 31, 2021 3.00:1.00
June 30, 2021 2.75:1:00
September 30, 2021 2.75:1:00
December 31, 2021 2.50:1:00
and thereafter 3.75:1:00
March 31, 2022 2.50:1:00
June 30, 2022 2.25:1:00
September 30, 2022 2.25:1:00
and thereafter  

 

43  

 

 

This ratio shall be calculated at the end of each fiscal quarter of Borrowers using the results of the twelve-month period ending with such fiscal quarter end.

 

9.04        Liquid Assets. Borrowers and the Subsidiaries, on a consolidated basisConsolidated Basis, shall maintain minimum Liquid Assets at all times, in one or more accounts held with Lender plus Revolving Credit Availability in the amounts set forth in the following table:amount of $1,250,000.

 

September 30, 2020 – June 29, 2021 $1,000,000
June 30, 2021 – December 30, 2021 $1,100,000
December 31, 2021 – June 29, 2022 $1,250,000
June 30, 2022 and thereafter $1,350,000

 

ARTICLE X. 

DEFAULT

 

10.01         Events of Default. Each of the following shall be deemed an “Event of Default”:

 

(a)                Borrowers shall fail to pay the Obligations, or any part thereof shall not be paid when due or declared due and, other than with respect to payments of principal, such failure shall continue unremedied for three (3) days after such payment became due.

 

(b)                Borrowers shall breach any provision of Section 7.01, Article VIII or Article IX of this Agreement.

 

(c)                Any representation or warranty made or deemed made by any Borrower, any other Obligated Party or any Pledgor (or any of their respective officers) in any Loan Document or in any certificate, report, notice, or financial statement furnished at any time in connection with this Agreement shall be false, misleading, or erroneous in any material respect (without duplication of any materiality qualifier contained therein) when made or deemed to have been made.

 

(d)                Any Borrower or any Obligated Party shall fail to perform, observe, or comply with any covenant, agreement, or term contained in this Agreement or any other Loan Document (other than as covered by Section 10.01(a) and (b) above), and such failure continues for more than thirty (30) days following the date such failure first began.

 

(e)                Any Borrower, any Subsidiary, any Obligated Party or any Pledgor shall commence a voluntary proceeding seeking liquidation, reorganization, or other relief with respect to itself or its debts under any bankruptcy, insolvency, or other similar law now or hereafter in effect or seeking the appointment of a trustee, receiver, liquidator, custodian, or other similar official of it or a substantial part of its property or shall consent to any such relief or to the appointment of or taking possession by any such official in an involuntary case or other proceeding commenced against it or shall make a general assignment for the benefit of creditors or shall generally fail to pay its debts as they become due or shall take any corporate action to authorize any of the foregoing.

 

44 

 

 

(f)                 Any Borrower, any Subsidiary, or any Obligated Party shall fail to pay when due any principal of or interest on any Debt in excess of $250,000 (other than the Obligations), or the maturity of any such Debt shall have been accelerated, or any such Debt shall have been required to be prepaid prior to the stated maturity thereof, or any event shall have occurred that permits (or, with the giving of notice or lapse of time or both, would permit) any holder or holders of such Debt or any Person acting on behalf of such holder or holders to accelerate the maturity thereof or require any such prepayment.

 

(g)                This Agreement or any other Loan Document shall cease to be in full force and effect or shall be declared null and void or the validity or enforceability thereof shall be contested or challenged by Borrowers, any Subsidiary, any Obligated Party, any Pledgor or any of their respective shareholders, or Borrowers, any Obligated Party or any Pledgor shall deny that it has any further liability or obligation under any of the Loan Documents, or any lien or security interest created by the Loan Documents shall for any reason cease to be a valid, first priority perfected security interest in and lien upon any Priority Collateral or a valid, a second priority perfected security interest in and lien upon the Term Loan Priority Collateral or any other Collateral purported to be covered thereby; provided that, Borrowers shall have fifteen (15) days to have this Agreement or any other Loan Document reinstated, or to have any such security interest perfected.

 

(h)                Any of the following events shall occur or exist with respect to Borrowers: (i) any Prohibited Transaction involving any Plan; (ii) any Reportable Event with respect to any Plan; (iii) the filing under Section 4041 of ERISA of a notice of intent to terminate any Plan or the termination of any Plan; (iv) any event or circumstance that might constitute grounds entitling the PBGC to institute proceedings under Section 4042 of ERISA for the termination of, or for the appointment of a trustee to administer, any Plan, or the institution by the PBGC of any such proceedings; or (v) complete or partial withdrawal under Section 4201 or 4204 of ERISA from a Multiemployer Plan or the reorganization, insolvency, or termination of any Multiemployer Plan; and in each case above, such event or condition, together with all other events or conditions, if any, have subjected or could in the reasonable opinion of Lender subject Borrowers to any tax, penalty, or other liability to a Plan, a Multiemployer Plan, the PBGC, or otherwise (or any combination thereof) which in the aggregate could reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Event.

 

(i)                 If a Guarantor or any other Obligated Party is a corporation, partnership or other entity, such Person shall be the subject of a bankruptcy or receivership proceeding or shall have dissolved, liquidated or otherwise ceased doing business.

 

(j)                 Any Borrower, any of the Subsidiaries, or any Obligated Party, or any of their material properties, revenues, or assets, shall become subject to an order of forfeiture, seizure, or divestiture (whether under RICO or otherwise) and the same shall not have been discharged within sixty (60) days from the date of entry thereof.

 

(k)                A Change in Control shall occur.

 

45 

 

 

(l)                 An involuntary proceeding shall be commenced against any Borrower, any Subsidiary, any Obligated Party or any Pledgor seeking liquidation, reorganization, or other relief with respect to it or its debts under any bankruptcy, insolvency, or other similar law now or hereafter in effect or seeking the appointment of a trustee, receiver, liquidator, custodian, or other similar official for it or a substantial part of its property, and such involuntary proceeding shall remain undismissed and unstayed for a period of sixty (60) days.

 

(m)              Any Borrower, any Subsidiary or any Obligated Party shall fail to discharge within a period of thirty (30) days after the commencement thereof any attachment, sequestration, or similar proceeding or proceedings involving an aggregate amount in excess of Two Hundred Fifty Thousand Dollars ($250,000) against any of its assets or properties.

 

(n)                A final judgment or judgments for the payment of money in excess of Two Hundred Fifty Thousand Dollars ($250,000) in the aggregate shall be rendered by a court or courts against any Borrower, any of the Subsidiaries, or any Obligated Party and the same shall not be discharged (or provision shall not be made for such discharge), or a stay of execution thereof shall not be procured, within thirty (30) days from the date of entry thereof and such Borrower or the relevant Subsidiary or Obligated Party shall not, within said period of thirty (30) days, or such longer period during which execution of the same shall have been stayed, appeal therefrom and cause the execution thereof to be stayed during such appeal.

 

(o)                An Event of Default (as defined in the Term Loan Agreement) under the Term Loan Documents shall occur and be continuing.

 

10.02         Remedies Upon Default. If any Event of Default shall occur and be continuing, Lender may without notice terminate the Commitment and declare the Obligations or any part thereof to be immediately due and payable, and the same shall thereupon become immediately due and payable, without notice, demand, presentment, notice of dishonor, notice of acceleration, notice of intent to accelerate, notice of intent to demand, protest, or other formalities of any kind, all of which are, to the maximum extent permitted by law, hereby expressly waived by Borrowers; provided, however, that upon the occurrence of an Event of Default under Section 10.01(e) or Section 10.01(l), and so long as continuing, the Commitment shall automatically terminate, and the Obligations shall become immediately due and payable without notice, demand, presentment, notice of dishonor, notice of acceleration, notice of intent to accelerate, notice of intent to demand, protest, or other formalities of any kind, all of which are, to the maximum extent permitted by law, hereby expressly waived by Borrowers. If any Event of Default shall occur and be continuing, Lender may exercise all rights and remedies available to it in law or in equity, under the Loan Documents, or otherwise.

 

10.03      Performance by Lender. If Borrowers shall fail to perform any covenant or agreement contained in any of the Loan Documents, Lender may perform or attempt to perform such covenant or agreement on behalf of Borrowers. In such event, Borrowers shall, at the request of Lender, promptly pay any amount reasonably expended by Lender in connection with such performance or attempted performance to Lender, together with interest thereon at the Default Interest Rate from and including the date of such expenditure to but excluding the date such expenditure is paid in full. Notwithstanding the foregoing, it is expressly agreed that Lender shall not have any liability or responsibility for the performance of any obligation of Borrowers under this Agreement or any other Loan Document.

 

10.04      Equity Cure. Notwithstanding the foregoing, and subject to the last sentence of this Section 10.04, the Borrowers may cure (and shall be deemed to have cured) (any such cure, an “Equity Cure”) an Event of Default arising out of a breach of any of the financial covenants set forth in Sections 9.01, 9.02 or 9.03 (the “Specified Financial Covenants”) if (i) the Borrowers receive, within 10 Business Days after the date on which the Specified Financial Covenants are first required to be tested pursuant to the terms hereof, cash proceeds in an amount which, if treated as income for the preceding fiscal quarter, would result in compliance with such Specified Financial Covenants, and (ii) Lender receives written notice from the Borrowers that such payment has been made and that it is to be deemed an Equity Cure hereunder. Upon any Equity Cure of a Specified Financial Covenant, any Event of Default that occurred and is continuing from a breach of such Specified Financial Covenant shall be deemed cured with no further action required by Lender. An Equity Cure may not be used to cure an Event of Default more than twice in any calendar year (or be in an aggregate amount of such cash proceeds in any calendar year of more than $2,000,000), or more than four times during the term of this Agreement (including any extension thereof), or be in an amount greater than necessary to cure the Specified Financial Covenants.

 

46 

 

 

ARTICLE XI. 

MISCELLANEOUS

 

11.01         Expenses. Each Borrower hereby agrees, jointly and severally, to pay on demand: (a) all reasonable and documented costs and out-of-pocket expenses of Lender in connection with the preparation, negotiation, execution, and delivery of this Agreement and the other Loan Documents and any and all amendments, modifications, renewals, extensions, and supplements thereof and thereto, including, without limitation, the reasonable fees and expenses of outside legal counsel, advisors, consultants, and auditors for Lender; (b) all costs and expenses of Lender in connection with any Default and the enforcement of this Agreement or any other Loan Document, including, without limitation, the reasonable and documented fees and out-of-pocket expenses of legal counsel, advisors, consultants, and auditors for Lender; (c) all transfer, stamp, documentary, or other similar taxes, assessments, or charges levied by any Governmental Authority in respect of this Agreement or any of the other Loan Documents; (d)  all reasonable and documented costs, expenses, assessments, and other charges incurred in connection with any filing, registration, recording, or perfection of any Lien contemplated by this Agreement or any other Loan Document; and (e) all other reasonable and documented costs and expenses incurred by Lender in connection with (i) this Agreement or any other Loan Document, (ii) the servicing and administration of the Obligations, (iii) any litigation, dispute, suit, proceeding or action arising from or related to the Obligations or any Loan Document, or (iv) the enforcement of its rights and remedies, and the protection of its interests in bankruptcy, insolvency or other legal proceedings, including, without limitation, all costs, expenses, and other charges incurred in connection with evaluating, observing, collecting, examining, auditing, appraising, selling, liquidating, or otherwise disposing of the Collateral or other assets of Borrowers. Each Borrower authorizes Lender, at its sole option, to (i) cause a Revolving Credit Advance on or after the date of this Agreement, (ii) debit any other Borrower account with Lender, or (iii) make demand upon Borrowers, for payment of all reasonable attorneys’ fees and out-of-pocket expenses incurred by Lender in connection with the negotiation and documentation of this Agreement and the other Loan Documents by counsel retained by Lender, which attorney’s fees and expenses become due through the date of this Agreement and/or after the date of this Agreement.

 

11.02        INDEMNIFICATION. EACH BORROWER SHALL INDEMNIFY LENDER AND EACH AFFILIATE THEREOF AND THEIR RESPECTIVE OFFICERS, DIRECTORS, EMPLOYEES, ATTORNEYS, AND AGENTS (COLLECTIVELY, THE “INDEMNIFIED PARTIES” AND INDIVIDUALLY AN “INDEMNIFIED PARTY”) FROM, AND HOLD EACH OF THEM HARMLESS AGAINST, ANY AND ALL LOSSES, LIABILITIES, CLAIMS, DAMAGES, PENALTIES, JUDGMENTS, DISBURSEMENTS, COSTS, AND EXPENSES (INCLUDING ATTORNEYS’ FEES) TO WHICH ANY OF THEM MAY BECOME SUBJECT WHICH DIRECTLY OR INDIRECTLY ARISE FROM OR RELATE TO (a) ANY OF THE LOAN DOCUMENTS INCLUDING THE NEGOTIATION, EXECUTION, DELIVERY, PERFORMANCE, ADMINISTRATION, OR ENFORCEMENT OF ANY OF THE LOAN DOCUMENTS, (b) ANY OF THE TRANSACTIONS CONTEMPLATED BY THE LOAN DOCUMENTS, (c) ANY BREACH BY ANY BORROWER OF ANY REPRESENTATION, WARRANTY, COVENANT, OR OTHER AGREEMENT CONTAINED IN ANY OF THE LOAN DOCUMENTS, (d) ANY ACTION TAKEN OR NOT TAKEN BY LENDER (OR ANY TRUSTEE UNDER ANY SECURITY INSTRUMENT) THAT IS ALLOWED OR PERMITTED UNDER ANY OF THE LOAN DOCUMENTS, INCLUDING THE PROTECTION OR ENFORCEMENT OF ANY LIEN, SECURITY INTEREST, OR OTHER RIGHT, REMEDY, OR RECOURSE CREATED OR AFFORDED BY THE LOAN DOCUMENTS OR AT LAW OR IN EQUITY, (e) ANY DISPUTE AMONG OR BETWEEN ANY OF THE OBLIGATED PARTIES OR BETWEEN OR AMONG ANY PARTNERS, VENTURERS, EMPLOYEES, OFFICERS, DIRECTORS, SHAREHOLDERS, MEMBERS, MANAGERS, TRUSTEES, OR OTHER RESPONSIBLE PARTIES OF BORROWERS, (f) THE PRESENCE, RELEASE, THREATENED RELEASE, DISPOSAL, REMOVAL, OR CLEANUP OF ANY HAZARDOUS MATERIAL LOCATED ON, ABOUT, WITHIN, OR AFFECTING ANY OF THE PROPERTIES OR ASSETS OF BORROWERS OR ANY OF THE SUBSIDIARIES OR ANY OTHER OBLIGATED PARTY, (g) THE USE OR PROPOSED USE OF ANY LETTER OF CREDIT, (h) ANY AND ALL TAXES (OTHER THAN EXCLUDED TAXES), LEVIES, DEDUCTIONS, OR CHARGES IMPOSED ON LENDER OR ANY OF LENDER’S CORRESPONDENTS IN RESPECT OF ANY LETTER OF CREDIT, OR (i) ANY INVESTIGATION, LITIGATION, OR OTHER PROCEEDING, INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, ANY THREATENED INVESTIGATION, LITIGATION, OR OTHER PROCEEDING, RELATING TO ANY OF THE FOREGOING INCLUDING THOSE BROUGHT OR INITIATED BY. WITHOUT LIMITING ANY PROVISION OF THIS AGREEMENT OR OF ANY OTHER LOAN DOCUMENT, IT IS THE EXPRESS INTENTION OF THE PARTIES HERETO THAT THE INDEMNIFIED PARTIES BE INDEMNIFIED FROM AND HELD HARMLESS AGAINST ANY AND ALL LOSSES, LIABILITIES, CLAIMS, DAMAGES, PENALTIES, JUDGMENTS, DISBURSEMENTS, COSTS, AND EXPENSES (INCLUDING REASONABLE ATTORNEYS’ FEES) ARISING OUT OF OR RESULTING FROM THE STRICT LIABILITY, SOLE CONTRIBUTORY OR ORDINARY NEGLIGENCE OF ANY OF THE INDEMNIFIED PARTIES; PROVIDED, HOWEVER, THAT THE INDEMNITY SET FORTH IN THIS SECTION 11.02 WILL NOT APPLY TO CLAIMS CAUSED BY THE GROSS NEGLIGENCE OR WILLFUL MISCONDUCT OF LENDER OR ANY OF ITS OFFICERS, EMPLOYEES, AGENTS, ADVISORS, OR REPRESENTATIVES, AS DETERMINED BY A COURT OF COMPETENT JURISDICTION IN FINAL AND NON APPEALABLE JUDGMENT.

 

47 

 

 

LENDER MAY EMPLOY AN ATTORNEY OR ATTORNEYS OF ITS OWN CHOOSING TO PROTECT OR ENFORCE ITS RIGHTS, REMEDIES, AND RECOURSES, AND TO ADVISE AND DEFEND THE INDEMNIFIED PARTIES WITH RESPECT TO THOSE ACTIONS AND OTHER MATTERS. EACH BORROWER SHALL REIMBURSE LENDER FOR THE ATTORNEYS’ REASONABLE FEES AND OUT-OF-POCKET EXPENSES (INCLUDING EXPENSES AND COSTS FOR EXPERTS AND/OR CONSULTANTS) OF THE INDEMNIFIED PARTIES IMMEDIATELY ON RECEIPT OF WRITTEN DEMAND FROM LENDER, WHETHER ON A MONTHLY OR OTHER TIME INTERVAL, AND WHETHER OR NOT AN ACTION IS ACTUALLY COMMENCED OR CONCLUDED. ALL OTHER REIMBURSEMENT AND INDEMNITY OBLIGATIONS UNDER THIS AGREEMENT SHALL BECOME DUE AND PAYABLE WHEN ACTUALLY INCURRED BY LENDER OR ANY OF THE OTHER THE INDEMNIFIED PARTIES. ANY PAYMENTS NOT MADE WITHIN TEN (10) DAYS AFTER WRITTEN DEMAND FROM LENDER SHALL BEAR INTEREST AT THE DEFAULT INTEREST RATE FROM THE DATE OF THAT DEMAND UNTIL FULLY PAID. THE PROVISIONS OF THIS SECTION 11.02 SHALL SURVIVE REPAYMENT AND PERFORMANCE OF THE OBLIGATIONS, THE RELEASE OF ANY LIENS SECURING THE OBLIGATIONS, ANY FORECLOSURE (OR ACTION IN LIEU OF FORECLOSURE), THE TRANSFER BY ANY BORROWER OF ANY OF ITS RIGHTS, TITLE, AND INTERESTS IN OR TO ANY COLLATERAL SECURING THE OBLIGATIONS, AND THE EXERCISE BY LENDER OF ANY OR ALL REMEDIES SET FORTH IN ANY LOAN DOCUMENT. NOTWITHSTANDING THE FOREGOING THIS SECTION 11.02 SHALL NOT APPLY WITH RESPECT TO EXCLUDED TAXES OR TO ANY OTHER TAXES (OTHER THAN ANY TAXES THAT REPRESENT LOSSES, CLAIMS, DAMAGES, ETC. ARISING FROM ANY NON-TAX CLAIM.

 

11.03       Limitation of Liability. Neither Lender nor any Affiliate, officer, director, employee, attorney, or agent of Lender shall have any liability with respect to, and, to the maximum extent permitted by law, each Borrower hereby waives, releases, and agrees not to sue any of them upon, any claim for any special, indirect, incidental, or consequential damages suffered or incurred by such Borrower in connection with, arising out of, or in any way related to, this Agreement or any of the other Loan Documents, or any of the transactions contemplated by this Agreement or any of the other Loan Documents. To the maximum extent permitted by law, each Borrower hereby waives, releases, and agrees not to sue Lender or any of Lender’s Affiliates, officers, directors, employees, attorneys, or agents for punitive damages in respect of any claim in connection with, arising out of, or in any way related to, this Agreement or any of the other Loan Documents, or any of the transactions contemplated by this Agreement or any of the other Loan Documents.

 

11.04      No Duty. All attorneys, accountants, appraisers, and other professional Persons and consultants retained by Lender shall have the right to act exclusively in the interest of Lender and shall have no duty of disclosure, duty of loyalty, duty of care, or other duty or obligation of any type or nature whatsoever to Borrowers or any of Borrowers’ shareholders or any other Person.

 

11.05      Lender Not Fiduciary. The relationship between Borrowers and Lender is solely that of debtor and creditor, and Lender has no fiduciary or other special relationship with Borrowers, and no term or condition of any of the Loan Documents shall be construed so as to deem the relationship between Borrowers and Lender to be other than that of debtor and creditor.

 

11.06      Equitable Relief. Borrowers recognizes that in the event Borrowers fail to pay, perform, observe, or discharge any or all of the Obligations, any remedy at law may prove to be inadequate relief to Lender. Borrowers therefore agree that Lender, if Lender so requests, shall be entitled to temporary and permanent injunctive relief in any such case without the necessity of proving actual damages.

 

11.07      No Waiver; Cumulative Remedies. No failure on the part of Lender to exercise and no delay in exercising, and no course of dealing with respect to, any right, power, or privilege under this Agreement shall operate as a waiver thereof, nor shall any single or partial exercise of any right, power, or privilege under this Agreement preclude any other or further exercise thereof or the exercise of any other right, power, or privilege. The rights and remedies provided for in this Agreement and the other Loan Documents are cumulative and not exclusive of any rights and remedies provided by law.

 

11.08      Successors and Assigns. This Agreement is binding upon and shall inure to the benefit of Lender and Borrowers and their respective successors and assigns, except that Borrowers may not assign or transfer any of its rights or obligations under this Agreement without the prior written consent of Lender.

 

11.09      Survival. All representations and warranties made in this Agreement or any other Loan Document or in any document, statement, or certificate furnished in connection with this Agreement shall survive the execution and delivery of this Agreement and the other Loan Documents, and no investigation by Lender or any closing shall affect the representations and warranties or the right of Lender to rely upon them. Without prejudice to the survival of any other obligation of Borrowers hereunder, the obligations of Borrowers under Sections 11.01 and 11.02 shall survive repayment of the Notes and termination of the Commitment.

 

48 

 

 

11.10      ENTIRE AGREEMENT; AMENDMENT. THIS AGREEMENT, THE NOTES, AND THE OTHER LOAN DOCUMENTS REFERRED TO HEREIN EMBODY THE FINAL, ENTIRE AGREEMENT AMONG THE PARTIES HERETO AND SUPERSEDE ANY AND ALL PRIOR COMMITMENTS, AGREEMENTS, REPRESENTATIONS, AND UNDERSTANDINGS, WHETHER WRITTEN OR ORAL, RELATING TO THE SUBJECT MATTER HEREOF AND MAY NOT BE CONTRADICTED OR VARIED BY EVIDENCE OF PRIOR, CONTEMPORANEOUS, OR SUBSEQUENT ORAL AGREEMENTS OR DISCUSSIONS OF THE PARTIES HERETO. THERE ARE NO ORAL AGREEMENTS AMONG THE PARTIES HERETO. The provisions of this Agreement and the other Loan Documents to which Borrowers are parties may be amended or waived only by an instrument in writing signed by the parties hereto.

 

11.11      Notices. Unless otherwise expressly provided herein, all notices and other communications provided for hereunder shall be in writing (including by facsimile transmission) and mailed, faxed or delivered, to the address, facsimile number or subject to the last sentence hereof electronic mail address specified for notices below the signatures hereon or to such other address as shall be designated by such party in a notice to the other parties. All such other notices and other communications shall be deemed to have been given or made upon the earliest to occur of (i) actual receipt by the intended recipient or (ii) (A) if delivered by hand or courier, when signed for by the designated recipient; (B) if delivered by mail, four (4) Business Days after deposit in the mail, postage prepaid; (C) if delivered by facsimile when sent and receipt has been confirmed by telephone; and (D) if delivered by electronic mail (which form of delivery is subject to the provisions of the last sentence below) when delivered; provided, however, that notices and other communications pursuant to Article II shall not be effective until actually received by Lender. Electronic mail and intranet websites may be used only to distribute only routine communications, such as financial statements and other information, and to distribute Loan Documents for execution by the parties thereto and may not be used for any other purpose.

 

11.12      Governing Law; Venue; Service of Process. THIS AGREEMENT AND ANY CONTROVERSY, DISPUTE, CLAIM OR CAUSE OF ACTION ARISING OUT OF OR RELATING TO THIS AGREEMENT, THE OTHER LOAN DOCUMENTS, ANY BREACH THEREOF, THE TRANSACTIONS CONTEMPLATED THEREBY, OR ANY OTHER DISPUTE BETWEEN OR AMONG LENDER AND ANY OF THE OBLIGATED PARTIES (WHETHER IN CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE) SHALL BE GOVERNED BY AND CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF TEXAS; PROVIDED THAT LENDER SHALL RETAIN ALL RIGHTS UNDER FEDERAL LAW. IF, FOR ANY REASON, A COURT OF COMPETENT JURISDICTION DETERMINES THAT TEXAS LAW SHOULD NOT APPLY TO THE PROVISIONS OF THE LOAN DOCUMENTS PERTAINING TO THE CREATION, PERFECTION, ENFORCEMENT, OR VALIDITY OF THE LIENS AND SECURITY INTERESTS CREATED PURSUANT TO THE APPLICABLE LOAN DOCUMENTS, THEN SUCH PROVISIONS (BUT ONLY THOSE PROVISIONS) SHALL BE GOVERNED BY, CONSTRUED, AND INTERPRETED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE LAWS OF THE STATE WHERE THE APPLICABLE COLLATERAL IS LOCATED. THIS AGREEMENT HAS BEEN ENTERED INTO IN DALLAS COUNTY, TEXAS, AND IS PERFORMABLE FOR ALL PURPOSES IN DALLAS COUNTY, TEXAS. THE PARTIES HEREBY AGREE THAT ANY LAWSUIT, ACTION, OR PROCEEDING THAT IS BROUGHT (WHETHER IN CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE) ARISING OUT OF OR RELATING TO ANY OF THE LOAN DOCUMENTS, THE TRANSACTIONS CONTEMPLATED THEREBY, OR THE ACTS, CONDUCT, OR OMISSIONS OF LENDER OR ANY OF ITS AGENTS, SUCCESSORS OR ASSIGNS OR OF ANY OF THE OBLIGATED PARTIES IN THE NEGOTIATION, ADMINISTRATION OR ENFORCEMENT OF ANY OF THE LOAN DOCUMENTS SHALL BE BROUGHT IN A STATE OR FEDERAL COURT OF COMPETENT JURISDICTION LOCATED IN DALLAS COUNTY, TEXAS. EACH BORROWER HEREBY IRREVOCABLY AND UNCONDITIONALLY (A) SUBMITS TO THE EXCLUSIVE JURISDICTION OF SUCH COURTS, (B) WAIVES ANY OBJECTION IT MAY NOW OR HEREAFTER HAVE AS TO THE VENUE OF ANY SUCH LAWSUIT, ACTION, OR PROCEEDING BROUGHT IN ANY SUCH COURT, AND (C) FURTHER WAIVES ANY CLAIM THAT IT MAY NOW OR HEREAFTER HAVE THAT ANY SUCH COURT IS AN INCONVENIENT FORUM. EACH OF THE PARTIES HERETO AGREE THAT SERVICE OF PROCESS UPON IT MAY BE MADE BY CERTIFIED OR REGISTERED MAIL, RETURN RECEIPT REQUESTED AT THE ADDRESS FOR NOTICES REFERENCED IN SECTION 11.11 HEREOF.

 

49 

 

 

11.13       Counterparts. This Agreement may be executed in any number of counterparts and by different parties on separate counterparts, each of which, when executed and delivered, shall be deemed to be an original, and all of which, when taken together, shall constitute but one and the same agreement. Delivery of an executed signature page of this Agreement and all other documents executed in connection with the Loan by facsimile or other electronic mail transmission shall be effective as delivery of a manually executed counterpart hereof.

 

11.14       Severability. Any provision of this Agreement held by a court of competent jurisdiction to be invalid or unenforceable shall not impair or invalidate the remainder of this Agreement and the effect thereof shall be confined to the provision held to be invalid or illegal.

 

11.15       Headings. The headings, captions, and arrangements used in this Agreement are for convenience only and shall not affect the interpretation of this Agreement.

 

11.16       Participations, Etc. Lender shall have the right at any time and from time to time to grant participations in, and sell and transfer, the Obligations and any Loan Documents; provided, that so long as no Default or Event of Default has occurred and is continuing, the Borrowers shall have the right to consent to any such sale or transfer of the Obligations. Each actual or proposed participant or assignee, as the case may be, shall be entitled to receive all information received by Lender regarding Borrowers and the Subsidiaries, including, without limitation, information required to be disclosed to a participant or assignee pursuant to Banking Circular 181 (Rev., August 2, 1984), issued by the Comptroller of the Currency (whether the actual or proposed participant or assignee is subject to the circular or not).

 

11.17       Construction. Borrowers and Lender acknowledge that each of them has had the benefit of legal counsel of its own choice and has been afforded an opportunity to review this Agreement and the other Loan Documents with its legal counsel and that this Agreement and the other Loan Documents shall be construed as if jointly drafted by Borrowers and Lender.

 

11.18       Independence of Covenants. All covenants hereunder shall be given independent effect so that if a particular action or condition is not permitted by any of such covenants, the fact that it would be permitted by an exception to, or be otherwise within the limitations of, another covenant shall not avoid the occurrence of a Default if such action is taken or such condition exists.

 

11.19      WAIVER OF JURY TRIAL. TO THE FULLEST EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, EACH BORROWER HEREBY IRREVOCABLY AND EXPRESSLY WAIVES ALL RIGHT TO A TRIAL BY JURY IN ANY ACTION, PROCEEDING, OR COUNTERCLAIM (WHETHER BASED UPON CONTRACT, TORT, OR OTHERWISE) ARISING OUT OF OR RELATING TO ANY OF THE LOAN DOCUMENTS OR THE TRANSACTIONS CONTEMPLATED THEREBY OR THE ACTIONS OF LENDER IN THE NEGOTIATION, ADMINISTRATION, OR ENFORCEMENT THEREOF. EACH PARTY HERETO (A) CERTIFIES THAT NO REPRESENTATIVE, AGENT OR ATTORNEY OF ANY OTHER PERSON HAS REPRESENTED, EXPRESSLY OR OTHERWISE, THAT SUCH OTHER PERSON WOULD NOT, IN THE EVENT OF LITIGATION, SEEK TO ENFORCE THE FOREGOING WAIVER AND (B) ACKNOWLEDGES THAT IT AND THE OTHER PARTIES HERETO HAVE BEEN INDUCED TO ENTER INTO THIS AGREEMENT AND THE OTHER LOAN DOCUMENTS BY, AMONG OTHER THINGS, THE MUTUAL WAIVERS AND CERTIFICATIONS IN THIS SECTION 11.19.

 

50 

 

 

11.20       Additional Interest Provision. It is expressly stipulated and agreed to be the intent of Borrowers and Lender at all times to comply strictly with the applicable Texas law governing the maximum rate or amount of interest payable on the indebtedness evidenced by any Note, any Loan Document, and the Related Indebtedness (or applicable United States federal law to the extent that it permits Lender to contract for, charge, take, reserve or receive a greater amount of interest than under Texas law). If the applicable law is ever judicially interpreted so as to render usurious any amount (i) contracted for, charged, taken, reserved or received pursuant to any Note, any of the other Loan Documents or any other communication or writing by or between Borrowers and Lender related to the transaction or transactions that are the subject matter of the Loan Documents, (ii) contracted for, charged, taken, reserved or received by reason of Lender’s exercise of the option to accelerate the maturity of any Note and/or any and all indebtedness paid or payable by Borrowers to Lender pursuant to any Loan Document other than any Note (such other indebtedness being referred to in this Section as the “Related Indebtedness”), or (iii) Borrowers will have paid or Lender will have received by reason of any voluntary prepayment by Borrowers of any Note and/or the Related Indebtedness, then it is Borrowers’ and Lender’s express intent that all amounts charged in excess of the Maximum Lawful Rate shall be automatically canceled, ab initio, and all amounts in excess of the Maximum Lawful Rate theretofore collected by Lender shall be credited on the principal balance of any Note and/or the Related Indebtedness (or, if any Note and all Related Indebtedness have been or would thereby be paid in full, refunded to Borrowers), and the provisions of any Note and the other Loan Documents shall immediately be deemed reformed and the amounts thereafter collectible hereunder and thereunder reduced, without the necessity of the execution of any new document, so as to comply with the applicable law, but so as to permit the recovery of the fullest amount otherwise called for hereunder and thereunder; provided, however, if any Note has been paid in full before the end of the stated term of any such Note, then Borrowers and Lender agree that Lender shall, with reasonable promptness after Lender discovers or is advised by Borrowers that interest was received in an amount in excess of the Maximum Lawful Rate, either refund such excess interest to Borrowers and/or credit such excess interest against such Note and/or any Related Indebtedness then owing by Borrowers to Lender. Borrowers hereby agree that as a condition precedent to any claim seeking usury penalties against Lender, Borrowers will provide written notice to Lender, advising Lender in reasonable detail of the nature and amount of the violation, and Lender shall have sixty (60) days after receipt of such notice in which to correct such usury violation, if any, by either refunding such excess interest to Borrowers or crediting such excess interest against the Note to which the alleged violation relates and/or the Related Indebtedness then owing by Borrowers to Lender. All sums contracted for, charged, taken, reserved or received by Lender for the use, forbearance or detention of any debt evidenced by any Note and/or the Related Indebtedness shall, to the extent permitted by applicable law, be amortized or spread, using the actuarial method, throughout the stated term of such Note and/or the Related Indebtedness (including any and all renewal and extension periods) until payment in full so that the rate or amount of interest on account of any Note and/or the Related Indebtedness does not exceed the Maximum Lawful Rate from time to time in effect and applicable to such Note and/or the Related Indebtedness for so long as debt is outstanding. In no event shall the provisions of Chapter 346 of the Texas Finance Code (which regulates certain revolving credit loan accounts and revolving triparty accounts) apply to this Note and/or any of the Related Indebtedness. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained herein or in any of the other Loan Documents, it is not the intention of Lender to accelerate the maturity of any interest that has not accrued at the time of such acceleration or to collect unearned interest at the time of such acceleration.

 

51 

 

 

 

11.21        Ceiling Election. To the extent that Lender is relying on Chapter 303 of the Texas Finance Code to determine the Maximum Lawful Rate payable on any such Note and/or any other portion of the Obligations, Lender will utilize the weekly ceiling from time to time in effect as provided in such Chapter 303, as amended. To the extent United States federal law permits Lender to contract for, charge, take, receive or reserve a greater amount of interest than under Texas law, Lender will rely on United States federal law instead of such Chapter 303 for the purpose of determining the Maximum Lawful Rate. Additionally, to the extent permitted by applicable law now or hereafter in effect, Lender may, at its option and from time to time, utilize any other method of establishing the Maximum Lawful Rate under such Chapter 303 or under other applicable law by giving notice, if required, to Borrowers as provided by applicable law now or hereafter in effect.

 

11.22        USA Patriot Act Notice. Lender hereby notifies Borrowers that pursuant to the requirements of the Patriot Act, it is required to obtain, verify and record information that identifies Borrowers, which information includes the names and addresses of Borrowers and other information that will allow Lender to identify Borrowers in accordance with the Patriot Act. Borrowers shall, promptly following a request by Lender, provide all documentation and other information that Lender requests in order to comply with its ongoing obligations under applicable “know your customer” and anti-money laundering rules and regulations, including the Patriot Act. Lender will require the legal entity to provide identifying information about each beneficial owner and/or individuals who have significant responsibility to control, manage or direct the legal entity.

 

11.23 Confidentiality. LENDER ACKNOWLEDGES THAT INFORMATION RECEIVED FROM ANY BORROWER RELATING TO SUCH BORROWER OR ANY SUBSIDIARY OR THEIR BUSINESSES OR THE COLLATERAL FURNISHED TO SUCH PERSON PURSUANT TO THIS AGREEMENT MAY INCLUDE MATERIAL NON-PUBLIC INFORMATION CONCERNING SUCH BORROWER, ITS SUBSIDIARIES AND ITS OTHER AFFILIATES AND THEIR RESPECTIVE SECURITIES, AND CONFIRMS THAT IT HAS DEVELOPED COMPLIANCE PROCEDURES REGARDING THE USE OF MATERIAL NON-PUBLIC INFORMATION AND THAT IT WILL HANDLE SUCH MATERIAL NON-PUBLIC INFORMATION IN ACCORDANCE WITH THOSE PROCEDURES AND APPLICABLE LAW, INCLUDING FEDERAL AND STATE SECURITIES LAWS. ALL INFORMATION, INCLUDING REQUESTS FOR WAIVERS AND AMENDMENTS, FURNISHED BY ANY BORROWER PURSUANT TO, OR IN THE COURSE OF ADMINISTERING, THIS AGREEMENT MAY CONTAIN MATERIAL NON-PUBLIC INFORMATION CONCERNING THE BORROWERS, THEIR SUBSIDIARIES AND THEIR OTHER AFFILIATES AND THEIR RESPECTIVE SECURITIES. ACCORDINGLY, LENDER REPRESENTS TO THE BORROWER THAT SUCH PERSON HAS IDENTIFIED A CREDIT CONTACT WHO MAY RECEIVE INFORMATION THAT MAY CONTAIN SUCH MATERIAL NON-PUBLIC INFORMATION IN ACCORDANCE WITH ITS COMPLIANCE PROCEDURES AND APPLICABLE LAW, INCLUDING FEDERAL AND STATE SECURITIES LAWS.

 

11.24 11.01 Intercreditor Legend.11.02 Anything herein to the contrary notwithstanding, the Liens and security interests securing the obligations evidenced by this agreement, the exercise of any right or remedy with respect hereto and certain of the rights of the holder hereof are subject to the provisions of the Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of the date hereofDecember 3, 2021 (as amended, restated, supplemented, substituted, replaced or otherwise modified from time to time, the "Intercreditor Agreement"), by and between Silverpeak Credit PartnersLafayette Square Loan Servicing, LPLLC (in its capacity as agent for the SilverpeakLS Facility Lenders and together with its successors and assigns, the "SilverpeakLS Facility Agent"), for and on behalf of the SilverpeakLS Facility Creditors and each other SilverpeakLS Facility Claimholder (each as defined in the Intercreditor Agreement) from time to time, and East West Bank, acting on behalf of each A/R Facility Claimholder (each as defined in the Intercreditor Agreement). In the event of any conflict between the terms of the Intercreditor Agreement and this agreement, the terms of the Intercreditor Agreement shall govern and control."

 

[Remainder of Page Intentionally Left Blank;

Signature Page Follows.]

 

52

 

  

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have duly executed this Agreement as of the day and year first above written.

 

  BORROWERS:
   
  DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC
   
  By:  
    Name:
    Title:
   
  COLOSSUS MEDIA, LLC
   
  By:  
    Name:
    Title:
   
  HUDDLED MASSES LLC
   
  By:  
    Name:
    Title:
   
  ORANGE142, LLC
   
  By:  
    Name:
    Title:

 

Signature Page to

Credit Agreement

 

 

 

 

 

  UNIVERSAL STANDARDS FOR DIGITAL MARKETING, LLC
   
  By:  
    Name:
    Title:
   
  Address for Notices:
   
  c/o Direct Digital Holdings, LLC
1233 West Loop South
  Suite 1170
  Houston, Texas 77027   
  Email:  
  Phone:  

 

Signature Page to

Credit Agreement

 

 

 

 

  LENDER:
   
  EAST WEST BANK,
a California state bank
   
   
  By:  
    Hamilton LaRoe
    First Vice President
   
  Address for Notices:
   
  5001 Spring Valley Road; Suite 825W
  Dallas, Texas 75244
  Attention: Hamilton LaRoe
  Email: Hamilton.LaRoe@EastWestBank.com

 

Signature Page to

Credit Agreement

 

 

 

 

Exhibit 10.14

Execution Version

 

REDEMPTION AGREEMENT

 

THIS REDEMPTION AGREEMENT (“Agreement”) is made and entered into as of November 14, 2021 (the “Effective Date”) by and between Direct Digital Holdings, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company (the “Company”), and USDM Holdings, Inc., a Texas corporation (“Seller”). The Company and Seller are referred to herein each as a “Party” and collectively as the “Parties.” Capitalized terms used but not defined herein shall have the meanings assigned to such terms in the Amended and Restated Limited Liability Company Agreement of the Company, dated as of September 30, 2020 (as amended, the “LLC Agreement”).

 

WITNESSETH:

 

WHEREAS, as of the Effective Date, Seller owns 3,500 Class A Units (the “Class A Redemption Units”), 7,046 Class B Preferred Units (the “Class B Redemption Units”), and 5,637 Common Units (the “Common Redemption Units” and collectively with the Class A Redemption Units and the Class B Redemption Units, the “Redemption Units”); and

 

WHEREAS, the Company is (a) restructuring its senior indebtedness (the “Refinancing”), and (b) in the process of undergoing a proposed initial public offering (the “IPO”) using a holding company, Direct Digital Holdings, Inc., a Delaware corporation; and

 

WHEREAS, the Parties desire that (a) at the Initial Closing (as defined below), the Company shall redeem all of the Class A Redemption Units in consideration of the Class A Redemption Price (as defined below), and (b) at the Second Closing (as defined below), the Company shall redeem all of the Class B Redemption Units in consideration of the Class B Redemption Price (as defined below) and shall redeem all of the Common Redemption Units in consideration of the Common Units Redemption Price (as defined below); and

 

WHEREAS, after giving effect to all such redemptions as described in the immediately preceding recital, including the payment of all of the consideration therefor as described in this Agreement, Seller shall immediately cease to hold any Redemption Units or other interests in the Company;

 

NOW THEREFORE, in consideration of the mutual covenants and agreements herein contained, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the parties hereto agree as follows:

 

Section 1. Redemption by the Company.

 

(a)           Class A Redemption. Effective as of the Initial Closing, Seller shall sell to the Company, and the Company shall redeem from Seller, all of the Class A Redemption Units, in each case free and clear of all liens and encumbrances of any kind. In exchange for the Class A Redemption Units, the Company shall pay Seller a total purchase price equal to Three Million Five Hundred Thousand Dollars ($3,500,000.00), plus the Preferred Return Distribution Deficits in respect of the Class A Preferred Units calculated in accordance with Section 4(a)(iii), in immediately available funds (the “Class A Redemption Price”). Seller agrees that as of the Initial Closing, Seller shall not have any further rights with respect to the Class A Redemption Units. For the avoidance of doubt, Seller shall have all rights entitled to it under the LLC Agreement as an owner of Class B Preferred Units, including but not limited to the right to elect and appoint a Manager of the Company (and Leah Woolford shall continue to serve as such Manager), until the redemption of the Class B Preferred Units pursuant to this Agreement, or if this Agreement is terminated, the LLC Agreement.

 

 

 

(b)           Class B Redemption and Common Units Redemption. Effective as of the Second Closing, Seller shall sell to the Company, and the Company shall redeem from Seller, all of the Class B Redemption Units and the Common Redemption Units, in each case free and clear of all liens and encumbrances of any kind. In exchange for the Class B Redemption Units, the Company shall pay Seller a total purchase price equal to Seven Million Forty-Six Thousand Two Hundred Fifty-One Dollars ($7,046,251.00), plus the Preferred Return Distribution Deficits in respect of the Class B Preferred Units calculated in accordance with Section 4(b)(iii), in immediately available funds (the “Class B Redemption Price”). In exchange for the Common Redemption Units, the Company shall pay Seller a total purchase price equal to Seven Million Dollars ($7,000,000.00) (the “Common Units Redemption Price” and collectively with the Class A Redemption Price, and the Class B Redemption Price, the “Redemption Price”). Notwithstanding the foregoing, if payment of the Class B Redemption Price and the Common Units Redemption Price occurs after December 31, 2021, the Parties will in good faith recalculate the Common Units Redemption Price using solely the calculation in Section 8.10(b) of the LLC Agreement, with the “Enterprise Value” factoring in 2020 audited EBITDA, 2021 audited EBITDA and projected 2022 EBITDA as the Company’s trailing two (2) years of audited EBITDA together with a year of the Company’s projected EBITDA as provided in the definition of “Enterprise Value”; provided that if 2021 audited financials are not available as of such Second Closing, the Second Closing will proceed based on estimated information and the Parties will agree to a true-up mechanism for 2021 EBITDA resulting from the completion of the 2021 audit. As of the Second Closing, Seller shall not have any further rights with respect to the Class B Redemption Units or the Common Redemption Units.

 

(c)           Prior to the Second Closing, the LLC Agreement and all rights and responsibilities of the parties thereunder shall remain in full force and effect. After the Second Closing, all covenants and obligations to which the Parties are subject under the LLC Agreement that are contemplated to survive the termination of Seller’s ownership of Units shall survive for the periods set forth in the LLC Agreement (collectively, the “Surviving Covenants and Obligations”).

 

Section 2. Agreement on Redemption Price. The Parties hereby acknowledge and agree that at the (a) Initial Closing, Seller shall receive the Class A Redemption Price at the direction of the Company as full payment for the Class A Redemption Units, and (b) Second Closing, Seller shall receive the Class B Redemption Price and the Common Units Redemption Price at the direction of the Company as full payment for the Class B Redemption Units and the Common Redemption Units, respectively. Seller hereby acknowledges and agrees that it has had an opportunity to ask questions of and receive answers from the Company or a person or persons acting on the Company’s behalf, and all of Seller’s questions have been answered to its full satisfaction. Without limiting the right to recalculate in good faith the Common Units Redemption Price after December 31, 2021 as set forth in Section 1(b), Seller acknowledges and agrees that it waives any and all rights to contest the determination of the Redemption Price under the LLC Agreement or otherwise.

 

Section 3. Closings.

 

(a)           Initial Closing. The closing of the sale and redemption of the Class A Redemption Units under this Agreement (the “Initial Closing”) shall take place by the electronic or physical exchange of documents and other deliverables and the Class A Redemption Price, on the date of consummation of the Refinancing. The date upon which the Initial Closing occurs is referred to herein as the “Initial Closing Date.” The Initial Closing need not be in person. The Company shall cause its new lender involved in the Refinancing to directly deliver to Seller an amount equal to the Class A Redemption Purchase Price by wire transfer in immediately available funds from the Refinancing, to an account or accounts designated by Seller to the Company.

 

-2-

 

 

(b)           Second Closing. The closing of the sale and redemption of the Class B Redemption Units and the Common Redemption Units under this Agreement (the “Second Closing”) shall take place by the electronic or physical exchange of documents and other deliverables and the Class B Redemption Price and the Common Units Redemption Price, within (2) business days after the date of consummation of the IPO. The date upon which the Second Closing occurs is referred to herein as the “Second Closing Date.” The Second Closing need not be in person. The Company shall cause the Class B Redemption Price and the Common Units Redemption Price to be directly delivered to Seller via wire transfer in immediately available funds from the IPO, to an account or accounts designated by Seller to the Company. For the avoidance of doubt, the Class B Redemption Price and the Common Units Redemption Price must be received by Seller on or before December 31, 2021 to avoid the Parties’ good faith recalculation of the Common Units Redemption Price pursuant to Section 1(b) of this Agreement.

 

Section 4. Conditions to the Closings; Closing Deliveries.

 

(a)            Initial Closing.

 

(i)            The Company’s obligation to close at the Initial Closing is contingent upon the following: (A) the representations and warranties of the Seller contained in Section 5 shall be true and correct in all respects as of the Initial Closing Date with the same effect as though made at and as of the Initial Closing Date; (B) the Seller shall have duly performed and complied in all material respects with all agreements, covenants, and conditions required by this Agreement to be performed or complied with by it prior to or on the Initial Closing Date; and (C) the Company shall have received a certificate, dated the Initial Closing Date and signed by the manager or a duly authorized officer of the Seller, that each of the conditions set forth in Section 4(a)(i)(A) and Section 4(a)(i)(B) has been satisfied.

 

(ii)           Seller’s obligation to close at the Initial Closing is contingent upon the following: (A) the representations and warranties of the Company contained in Section 6 shall be true and correct in all respects as of the Initial Closing Date with the same effect as though made at and as of the Initial Closing Date; (B) the Company shall have duly performed and complied in all material respects with all agreements, covenants, and conditions required by this Agreement to be performed or complied with by it prior to or on the Initial Closing Date; and (iii) Seller shall have received a certificate, dated the Initial Closing Date and signed by the manager or a duly authorized officer of the Company, that each of the conditions set forth in Section 4(a)(ii)(A) and Section 4(a)(ii)(B) has been satisfied.

 

(iii)          One (1) business day prior to the Initial Closing, the Company shall deliver to Seller the calculation of the Class A Redemption Purchase Price which will include the amount of Preferred Return Distribution Deficits in respect of the Class A Preferred Units. At the Initial Closing, the Company shall cause its new lender involved in the Refinancing to directly deliver to Seller an amount equal to the Class A Redemption Purchase Price by wire transfer in immediately available funds from the Refinancing, to an account or accounts designated by Seller to the Company. For purposes of this Agreement and the Preferred Return Distribution Deficits in respect of the Class A Preferred Units, the “Preferred Return Distribution Deficits” means the excess of Seller’s Preferred Return (determined immediately prior to the Initial Closing) over the aggregate amount of the distributions made to Seller by the Company pursuant to Section 3.1(a) of the LLC Agreement from inception of the Company to the Initial Closing.

 

(iv)          Seller agrees to execute and deliver such assignment or other instrument of transfer as the Company may reasonably require to effect the transactions contemplated by this Agreement.

 

-3-

 

 

(b)           Second Closing.

 

(i)            The Company’s obligation to close at the Second Closing is contingent upon the following: (A) the representations and warranties of the Seller contained in Section 5 shall be true and correct in all respects as of the Second Closing Date with the same effect as though made at and as of the Second Closing Date, modified, mutatis mutandis, to reflect the redemption of the Class A Redemption Units pursuant to the Initial Closing; (B) the Seller shall have duly performed and complied in all material respects with all agreements, covenants, and conditions required by this Agreement to be performed or complied with by it prior to or on the Second Closing Date; and (C) the Company shall have received a certificate, dated the Second Closing Date and signed by the manager or a duly authorized officer of the Seller, that each of the conditions set forth in Section 4(b)(i)(A) and Section 4(b)(i)(B) has been satisfied.

 

(ii)           Seller’s obligation to close at the Second Closing is contingent upon the following: (A) the representations and warranties of the Company contained in Section 6 shall be true and correct in all respects as of the Second Closing Date with the same effect as though made at and as of the Second Closing Date, modified, mutatis mutandis, to reflect the redemption of the Class A Redemption Units pursuant to the Initial Closing; (B) the Company shall have duly performed and complied in all material respects with all agreements, covenants, and conditions required by this Agreement to be performed or complied with by it prior to or on the Second Closing Date; and (iii) Seller shall have received a certificate, dated the Second Closing Date and signed by the manager or a duly authorized officer of the Company, that each of the conditions set forth in Section 4(b)(ii)(A) and Section 4(b)(ii)(B) has been satisfied.

 

(iii)          One (1) business day prior to the Second Closing, the Company shall deliver to Seller the calculation of the Class B Redemption Purchase Price which will include the amount of Preferred Return Distribution Deficits in respect of the Class B Preferred Units. At the Second Closing, the Company shall cause the Class B Redemption Price and the Common Units Redemption Price to be directly delivered to Seller via wire transfer in immediately available funds from the IPO, to an account or accounts designated by Seller to the Company. For purposes of this Agreement and the Preferred Return Distribution Deficits in respect of the Class B Preferred Units, the “Preferred Return Distribution Deficits” means the excess of Seller’s Preferred Return (determined immediately prior to the Second Closing) over the aggregate amount of the distributions made to Seller by the Company pursuant to Section 3.1(b) of the LLC Agreement from inception of the Company to the Second Closing.

 

(iv)          Seller agrees to execute and deliver such assignment or other instrument of transfer as the Company may reasonably require to effect the transactions contemplated by this Agreement.

 

Section 5. Seller Representations and Warranties. Seller hereby represents and warrants to the Company, as of the date of this Agreement and as of each Closing Date, as follows:

 

(a)           Existence and Power. Seller is a corporation duly organized, validly existing and in good standing under the Laws of the State of Texas.

 

(b)           Organizational Authorization. The execution, delivery and performance by Seller of this Agreement and the consummation of the transactions contemplated hereby are within Seller’s organizational powers as a corporation and have been duly authorized by all necessary actions on the part of the shareholders and directors of Seller, as applicable. This Agreement constitutes a valid and binding agreement of Seller, enforceable against Seller in accordance with its terms, subject to applicable bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization, moratorium and similar laws affecting creditors’ rights generally, and subject, as to enforceability, to general principles of equity (regardless of whether enforcement is sought in a proceeding at law or in equity).

 

(c)           Noncontravention. The execution, delivery and performance by Seller of this Agreement do not and will not (i) violate the certificate of incorporation, bylaws or other equivalent governing documents of Seller, (ii) violate any law, judgment, injunction, order or decree, or (iii) require any consent or other action by any person or entity under, result in a breach of, constitute a default under, accelerate any obligation under, or give rise to a right of termination, cancellation or acceleration of any right or obligation of Seller under any provisions of any agreement, contract, instrument, permit, authorization, order, writ, judgment, injunction, decree or arbitration award, whether written or oral, to which Seller is a party.

 

-4-

 

 

(d)           Ownership of Units. As of the date hereof, Seller is the record and beneficial owner of all of the Redemption Units, free and clear of any liens and encumbrances of any kind, other than restrictions on transfer under applicable securities laws and under the LLC Agreement, and Seller does not own any other equity or debt interests in the Company.

 

(e)           Actions and Proceedings. There are no (i) outstanding judgments, orders, writs, injunctions or decrees of any court, governmental authority or arbitration tribunal against Seller which have or would reasonably be expected to have an adverse effect on the ability of Seller to consummate the transactions contemplated hereby or (ii) actions, suits, claims or legal, administrative or arbitration proceedings pending or, to the knowledge of Seller, threatened against Seller, which have or would reasonably be expected to have an adverse effect on the ability of Seller to consummate the transactions contemplated hereby.

 

(f)            Reliance. In making its decision to sell the Redemption Units hereunder, Seller has not relied in any way upon any representation, warranty, statement, act, or omission of the Company or any of its affiliates, agents, representatives, or other personnel, other than those expressly set forth in this Agreement.

 

(g)           No Other Representations and Warranties. EXCEPT FOR THE REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES CONTAINED IN THIS SECTION 5, SELLER MAKES NO EXPRESS OR IMPLIED REPRESENTATION OR WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, AND SELLER HEREBY DISCLAIMS ANY SUCH REPRESENTATION OR WARRANTY IN CONNECTION WITH THE EXECUTION AND DELIVERY OF THIS AGREEMENT AND THE CONSUMMATION OF THE TRANSACTIONS CONTEMPLATED BY THIS AGREEMENT.

 

Section 6. Company Representations and Warranties. The Company hereby represents and warrants to Seller, as of the date of this Agreement and as of each Closing Date, as follows:

 

(a)           Existence and Power. The Company is a limited liability company duly organized, validly existing and in good standing under the Laws of the State of Texas.

 

(b)           Organizational Authorization. The Company has the full right and limited liability company power and authority to enter into this Agreement and to carry out the transactions contemplated hereby and thereby. The execution and delivery of this Agreement and the performance of the Company’s obligations hereunder have been duly authorized by all necessary actions on the part of the members and managers of the Company, as applicable. This Agreement constitutes, or will when executed and delivered constitute, a valid and binding obligation of the Company, enforceable in accordance with its terms, subject to applicable bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization, moratorium and similar laws affecting creditors’ rights generally, and subject, as to enforceability, to general principles of equity (regardless of whether enforcement is sought in a proceeding at law or in equity).

 

(c)           Noncontravention. The execution, delivery and performance by the Company of this Agreement and each agreement, document and instrument to be executed and delivered by it pursuant to or as contemplated by this Agreement and the consummation of the transactions contemplated hereby and thereby do not and will not (i) violate the certificate of formation, limited liability company agreement or other equivalent governing documents of the Company, (ii) violate any law, judgment, injunction, order or decree, or (iii) require any consent or other action by any person or entity under, result in a breach of, constitute a default under, accelerate any obligation under, or give rise to a right of termination, cancellation or acceleration of any right or obligation of the Company under any provisions of any agreement, contract, instrument, permit, authorization, order, writ, judgment, injunction, decree or arbitration award, whether written or oral, to which the Company is a party.

 

-5-

 

 

(d)           Actions and Proceedings. There are no (i) outstanding judgments, orders, writs, injunctions or decrees of any court, governmental authority or arbitration tribunal against the Company which have or would reasonably be expected to have an adverse effect on the ability of the Company to consummate the transactions contemplated hereby or (ii) actions, suits, claims or legal, administrative or arbitration proceedings pending or, to the knowledge of the Company, threatened against the Company, which have or would reasonably be expected to have an adverse effect on the ability of the Company to consummate the transactions contemplated hereby.

 

(e)           Reliance. In making its decision to purchase the Redemption Units hereunder, the Company has not relied in any way upon any representation, warranty, statement, act, or omission of the Seller or any of its affiliates, agents, representatives, or other personnel, other than those expressly set forth in this Agreement.

 

(f)            No Other Representations and Warranties. EXCEPT FOR THE REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES CONTAINED IN THIS SECTION 6, THE COMPANY MAKES NO EXPRESS OR IMPLIED REPRESENTATION OR WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, AND THE COMPANY HEREBY DISCLAIMS ANY SUCH REPRESENTATION OR WARRANTY IN CONNECTION WITH THE EXECUTION AND DELIVERY OF THIS AGREEMENT AND THE CONSUMMATION OF THE TRANSACTIONS CONTEMPLATED BY THIS AGREEMENT.

 

Section 7. Release by Seller. Subject to Seller’s rights under this Agreement, effective as of the Second Closing Date, Seller, to the fullest extent legally possible, hereby completely and forever releases, waives and discharges, and shall be forever precluded from asserting, any and all claims, obligations (other than contractual, statutory, or other obligations to indemnify Seller, Leah Woolford, Jeff Woolford, or their respective affiliates, which are not hereby released, waived or discharged), suits, judgments, damages, demands, debts, rights, causes of action and liabilities, of any kind or nature, whether liquidated or unliquidated, fixed or contingent, matured or unmatured, known or unknown, foreseen or unforeseen, whether or not hidden or concealed, then existing in law, equity or otherwise, that Seller, including without limitation derivatively, to the fullest extent legally possible, has, had or may have against the Company or any of its subsidiaries, if applicable, and its respective present or former managers, officers, employees, predecessors, successors and members acting in such capacity, that are based in whole or in part on any act, omission, transaction or other occurrence taking place on or prior to the Second Closing Date, other than any claims, obligations, suits, judgments, damages, demands, debts, rights, causes of action and liabilities arising from or relating to the Surviving Covenants and Obligations (collectively, “Seller Claims”), and other than, as applicable, any rights under this Agreement to which Seller is entitled. In making this waiver, Seller acknowledges that it may hereafter discover facts in addition to or different from those which Seller now believes to be true with respect to the subject matter released herein, but agree that it has taken that possibility into account in reaching this Agreement and as to which Seller expressly assumes the risk. THE PROVISIONS IN THIS SECTION 7 SHALL BE ENFORCEABLE REGARDLESS OF WHETHER THE LIABILITY IS BASED UPON PAST, PRESENT, OR FUTURE ACTS, CLAIMS, OR LAWS (INCLUDING ANY PAST, PRESENT, OR FUTURE ENVIRONMENTAL LAW (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO CERCLA), OCCUPATIONAL SAFETY AND HEALTH LAW, OR PRODUCTS LIABILITY, SECURITIES, OR OTHER LAW).

 

-6-

 

 

Section 8. Release by the Company. Subject to the Company’s rights under this Agreement, effective as of the Second Closing Date, the Company, to the fullest extent legally possible, hereby completely and forever releases, waives and discharges, and shall be forever precluded from asserting, any and all claims, obligations, suits, judgments, damages, demands, debts, rights, causes of action and liabilities, of any kind or nature, whether liquidated or unliquidated, fixed or contingent, matured or unmatured, known or unknown, foreseen or unforeseen, whether or not hidden or concealed, then existing in law, equity or otherwise, that the Company, including without limitation derivatively, to the fullest extent legally possible, has, had or may have against Seller, and Seller’s respective present or former shareholders, directors, managers, officers, employees, predecessors, successors and members acting in such capacity, that are based in whole or in part on any act, omission, transaction or other occurrence taking place on or prior to the Second Closing Date, other than any claims, obligations, suits, judgments, damages, demands, debts, rights, causes of action and liabilities arising from or relating to the Surviving Covenants and Obligations (collectively, “Company Claims”), and other than, as applicable, any rights under this Agreement to which the Company is entitled. In making this waiver, the Company acknowledges that it may hereafter discover facts in addition to or different from those which the Company now believes to be true with respect to the subject matter released herein, but agree that it has taken that possibility into account in reaching this Agreement and as to which the Company expressly assumes the risk. THE PROVISIONS IN THIS SECTION 8 SHALL BE ENFORCEABLE REGARDLESS OF WHETHER THE LIABILITY IS BASED UPON PAST, PRESENT, OR FUTURE ACTS, CLAIMS, OR LAWS (INCLUDING ANY PAST, PRESENT, OR FUTURE ENVIRONMENTAL LAW (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO CERCLA), OCCUPATIONAL SAFETY AND HEALTH LAW, OR PRODUCTS LIABILITY, SECURITIES, OR OTHER LAW).

 

Section 9. Confidentiality. Seller acknowledges that it has or may have access to Confidential Information (as defined below) and that such Confidential Information does and will constitute valuable, special and unique property of the Company. Seller agrees that, from and after the date hereof, Seller will not, directly or indirectly, disclose, reveal, divulge or communicate to any person or entity, or use or otherwise exploit for Seller’s own benefit, or to the Company’s detriment, any Confidential Information. Seller shall not have any obligation to keep confidential any Confidential Information if and to the extent disclosure thereof is specifically required by law; provided, however, that in the event disclosure is required by applicable law, Seller shall, to the extent reasonably possible, provide the Company with prompt notice of such requirement prior to making any disclosure so that the Company may seek an appropriate protective order. For purposes of this Section 9, “Confidential Information” shall mean any confidential information with respect to the business of the Company and its subsidiaries, including, without limitation, methods of operation, customers, and customer lists, products, proposed products, former products, proposed, pending or completed acquisitions of any company, division, product line or other business unit, prices, fees, costs, plans, designs, technology, inventions, trade secrets, know-how, software, marketing methods, policies, plans, personnel, suppliers, competitors, markets or other specialized information or proprietary matters. The term “Confidential Information” does not include, and there shall be no obligation hereunder with respect to, information that (i) is generally available to the public on the date of this Agreement, or (ii) becomes generally available to the public other than as a result of a disclosure by Seller not otherwise permissible thereunder. Seller acknowledges that the Company or its parent company may disclose the terms of this Agreement in order to comply with applicable legal or regulatory requirements, including those imposed by federal securities laws and regulations.

 

Section 10. Termination. This Agreement may be terminated and the transactions contemplated hereby may be abandoned at any time prior to the Initial Closing Date (with respect to the redemption of the Class A Redemption Units) or Second Closing Date (with respect to the redemption of the Class B Redemption Units and Common Redemption Units), as applicable:

 

(a)           by mutual written consent of the Company and Seller;

 

-7-

 

 

(b)           by the Company, if at any time there has been a material misrepresentation, breach of warranty or breach of covenant on the part of Seller in any of the representations, warranties or covenants under this Agreement which breach is not curable, or, if curable, is not cured within ten (10) days after written notice of such breach is given to the Company;

 

(c)           by Seller, if there has been a material misrepresentation, material breach of warranty or material breach of covenant on the part of the Company in any of the representations, warranties or covenants under this Agreement which breach is not curable, or if curable, is not cured within ten (10) days after written notice of such breach is given to Seller; or

 

(d)           by Seller, if the Second Closing does not occur prior to June 30, 2022;

 

provided, however, that the right of the Company under Section 10(b) and the right of Seller under Section 10(c) shall not be available to such Party if such Party’s breach of any obligation under this Agreement has been the cause of, or resulted in, the failure of such transaction to occur on or before such date. The Party desiring to terminate this Agreement pursuant to this Section 10 shall give written notice of such termination to the other Party in accordance with the relevant provisions of this Agreement.

 

Section 11. Miscellaneous.

 

(a)           Entire Agreement; Amendment. Except as provided below, this Agreement constitutes the entire agreement between the Parties, and contains all of the agreements and understandings between the Parties, with respect to the subject matter hereof. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein, until the Second Closing this Agreement does not (in any respect) amend, change, modify, or supersede the LLC Agreement, which remains in full force and effect according to it terms. No change, modification or amendment to this Agreement shall be valid unless the same be in writing and signed by each of the Parties. No waiver of any provision of this Agreement shall be valid unless in writing and signed by the Party to be charged. This Agreement and the rights and obligations hereunder shall be binding upon and inure solely to the benefit of the Parties, their respective successors and permitted assigns, but this Agreement shall not be assignable by either Party hereto without the express written consent of the other Party, and any attempted assignment without consent shall be void, except that the Company may (i) assign any or all of its rights and obligations under this Agreement to any affiliate of the Company or any buyer of all or substantially all of the assets of the Company, and (ii) assign any or all of its rights under this Agreement to any lender to the Company for indebtedness to any such lender.

 

(b)           Governing Law and Jurisdiction. This Agreement shall be governed by and construed in accordance with the laws of the State of Texas without giving effect to conflicts of law principles. Each Party irrevocably agrees that any proceeding against it arising out of or in connection with this Agreement or the transactions contemplated by this Agreement or disputes relating hereto (whether for breach of contract, tortious conduct or otherwise) shall be brought exclusively in the state courts of Texas, and hereby irrevocably accepts and submits to the exclusive jurisdiction and venue of the aforesaid courts in personam with respect to any such proceeding and waives to the fullest extent permitted by law any objection that it may now or hereafter have that any such proceeding has been brought in an inconvenient forum.

 

(c)           Waiver of Jury Trial. Each Party hereby waives, to the fullest extent permitted by law, any right it may have to a trial by jury in respect to any litigation directly or indirectly arising out of, under or in connection with this Agreement or the transactions contemplated hereby or thereby or disputes relating hereto or thereto. Each Party (a) certifies that no representative, agent or attorney of any other Party has represented, expressly or otherwise, that such other Party would not, in the event of litigation, seek to enforce the foregoing waiver and (b) acknowledges that it and the other Party have been induced to enter into this Agreement by, among other things, the mutual waivers and certifications in this Section 11(c).

 

-8-

 

 

(d)           Specific Performance. The Parties agree that irreparable damage for which monetary damages, even if available, would not be an adequate remedy, would occur in the event that the Parties do not perform their obligations under the provisions of this Agreement (including failing to take such actions as are required of them hereunder to consummate this Agreement) in accordance with its specified terms or otherwise breach such provisions. The Parties acknowledge and agree that (a) the Parties shall be entitled to an injunction or injunctions, specific performance or other equitable relief to prevent breaches of this Agreement and to enforce specifically the terms and provisions hereof in any court of competent jurisdiction without proof of damages or otherwise, this being in addition to any other remedy to which they are entitled under this Agreement and (b) the right of specific enforcement is an integral part of the transactions contemplated by this Agreement and without that right, the Parties would not have entered into this Agreement. The Parties agree not to assert that a remedy of specific enforcement is unenforceable, invalid, contrary to law or inequitable for any reason, and not to assert that a remedy of monetary damages would provide an adequate remedy or that the Parties otherwise have an adequate remedy at law.

 

(e)           Prevailing Party. If any litigation or other court action, arbitration, or similar adjudicatory proceeding is commenced by any Party to enforce its rights under this Agreement against any other Party, all fees, costs, and expenses, including, without limitation, reasonable attorneys’ fees and court costs, incurred by the prevailing party in such litigation, action, arbitration, or proceeding will be reimbursed by the losing party; provided, that if, a Party to such litigation, action, arbitration, or proceeding prevails in part, and loses in part, then the court, arbitrator, or other adjudicator presiding over such litigation, action, arbitration, or proceeding will award a reimbursement of the fees, costs and expenses incurred by such Party on an equitable basis.

 

(f)            Expenses. All costs and expenses incurred by the Parties in connection with the negotiation, preparation and execution of this Agreement and the consummation of the transactions contemplated hereby shall be paid by the Party incurring such expenses.

 

(g)            Notices. Any notice, request, instruction or other communication to be given hereunder by either Party to the other Party shall be in writing and delivered personally, or sent by postpaid registered or certified mail, or sent by electronic mail, pursuant to the information below:

 

if to Seller, addressed to:

 

5729 Krause Lane, Unit #13

Austin, Texas 78738

Attention: Leah Woolford and Jeff Woolford

Email:    leah@usdmholdings.com

jeff@usdmholdings.com

 

with a copy (not constituting notice) to:

 

Fredrikson & Byron, P.A.

200 South Sixth Street, Suite 4000

Attention: Jessica D. Manivasager

Email: jmanivasager@fredlaw.com

 

-9-

 

 

and, if to the Company, addressed to:

 

c/o Direct Digital Management, LLC
10219 Piping Rock Lane

Houston, TX 77042

Attention: Keith Smith and Mark Walker

Email:     ksmith@directdigitalholdings.com

mwalker@directdigitalholdings.com

 

with a copy (not constituting notice) to:

 

McGuireWoods LLP

2000 McKinney Avenue, Suite 1400

Dallas, Texas 75201

Attention: Phyllis Y. Young

Email: pyoung@mcguirewoods.com

 

or to such other address for either Party as such Party shall hereafter designate by like notice. Each notice, request, instruction, consent and other communication under this Agreement shall be deemed to have been given, (i) on the date of delivery, if personally delivered, (ii) on the earlier of the date of the receipt or three (3) days after deposit in the US mail, if delivered by postpaid registered or certified mail, and (iii) on the earlier of the date of the electronic email transmission or the date of acknowledged receipt, if sent by email.

 

(h)           Severability. All agreements and covenants contained herein are severable, and in the event that any of them shall be held to be invalid by any competent court, this Agreement shall be interpreted as though such invalid agreements were not contained herein.

 

(i)            Counterparts. This Agreement may be executed in two or more counterparts, each of which shall be deemed an original but together shall constitute one and the same instrument.

 

(j)            Headings. The Article and Section headings contained in this Agreement are for reference purposes only and shall not affect in any way the meaning and interpretation of this Agreement.

 

SIGNATURE PAGE TO FOLLOW

 

-10-

 

 

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, this Agreement has been executed by the Parties on the date and year first above written.

 

    COMPANY:
     
    DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC
     
     
    By: /s/ Mark Walker       
    Name: Mark Walker
    Title: CEO
     
    SELLER:
     
    USDM HOLDINGS, INC.
     
     
    By: /s/ Leah Woolford
    Name: Leah Woolford
    Title: Chairwoman

 

[Signature page to Redemption Agreement]

 

 

Exhibit 10.17

 

Execution Version

 

 

 

TERM LOAN AND SECURITY AGREEMENT

 

Lafayette Square Loan Servicing, LLC
(AS AGENT)

 

THE LENDERS PARTY HERETO
(AS LENDERS)

 

WITH

 

DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC
(AS A BORROWER),

 

ANY PERSON JOINED HERETO AS A BORROWER FROM TIME TO TIME

 

AND

 

CERTAIN SUBSIDIARIES OF BORROWERS PARTY HERETO
(AS GUARANTORS)

 

December 3, 2021

 

 

 

 

 

 

Table of Contents

 

Page

 

I. DEFINITIONS 1

 

1.1 Accounting Terms 1
1.2 Defined Terms 2
1.3 Uniform Commercial Code Terms 42
1.4 Certain Matters of Construction 42

 

II. ADVANCES, PAYMENTS 43

 

2.1 Term Loans 43
2.2 Repayment of Advances 44
2.3 [Reserved] 45
2.4 Statement of Account 45
2.5 Additional Payments 45
2.6 Manner of Borrowing and Payment 45
2.7 Mandatory Prepayments 46
2.8 Use of Proceeds 47
2.9 Defaulting Lender 47
2.10 Joint and Several Liability, Waivers, etc. 48

 

III. INTEREST AND FEES 50

 

3.1 Interest 50
3.2 [Reserved] 50
3.3 [Reserved] 50
3.4 Fee Letter 50
3.5 Computation of Interest and Fees 51
3.6 Maximum Charges 51
3.7 Increased Costs 51
3.8 Benchmark Replacement Setting 52
3.9 Capital Adequacy 55
3.10 Taxes 56
3.11 Replacement of Lenders 60

 

IV. COLLATERAL: GENERAL TERMS 60

 

4.1 Security Interest in the Collateral 60
4.2 Creation and Perfection of Security Interest 61
4.3 [Reserved] 62
4.4 Preservation of Collateral 62
4.5 Ownership of Collateral 62
4.6 Defense of Agent’s and Lenders’ Interests 63
4.7 Books and Records 64
4.8 Financial Disclosure 64
4.9 Compliance with Laws 64

 

i 

 

 

Table of Contents

(continued)

 

Page

 

4.10 Inspection of Premises 64
4.11 Insurance 65
4.12 Failure to Pay Insurance 65
4.13 Payment of Taxes 65
4.14 Payment of Leasehold Obligations 66
4.15 Receivables 66
4.16 Pledge of Personal Property Assets 68
4.17 Maintenance of Equipment 69
4.18 Exculpation of Liability 69
4.19 Environmental Matters 69
4.20 Financing Statements 70
4.21 Key Executive Policy 71

 

V. REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES 71

 

5.1 Organization; Requisite Power and Authority; Qualification 71
5.2 Equity Interests and Ownership 71
5.3 Due Authorization 72
5.4 No Conflict 72
5.5 Governmental Consents 72
5.6 Binding Obligations 72
5.7 No Material Adverse Effect; No Default 72
5.8 Tax Returns 73
5.9 Financial Statements 73
5.10 Information Regarding the Credit Parties and their Subsidiaries 74
5.11 Environmental Matters; O.S.H.A. 74
5.12 Solvency; No Litigation, Violation, Indebtedness or Default 75
5.13 Patents, Trademarks, Copyrights and Licenses 76
5.14 Licenses, Permits and Other Approvals 76
5.15 Default of Indebtedness 76
5.16 No Default 76
5.17 No Burdensome Restrictions 76
5.18 No Labor Disputes 76
5.19 Margin Regulations 77
5.20 Investment Company Act 77
5.21 Disclosure 77
5.22 Delivery of Certain Documents 77
5.23 Swaps 78
5.24 [Reserved] 78
5.25 [Reserved] 78
5.26 Business and Property of Credit Parties 78
5.27 Insurance 78
5.28 [Reserved] 78
5.29 Anti-Terrorism Laws; Anti-Corruption Laws 78

 

ii 

 

 

Table of Contents

(continued)

 

Page

 

5.30 Trading with the Enemy 79
5.31 [Reserved] 79
5.32 [Reserved] 79
5.33 Eligible Impact Service 79
5.34 Data Privacy and Security 80
5.35 Small Business Administration Documents 80
5.36 Small Business Concern 81
5.37 Canadian Subsidiary 81
5.38 Survival of Representations and Warranties 81

 

VI. AFFIRMATIVE COVENANTS 81

 

6.1 Lender Meetings 81
6.2 Conduct of Business and Maintenance of Existence and Assets 81
6.3 Violations 81
6.4 Government Receivables 82
6.5 Financial Covenants 82
6.6 Execution of Supplemental Instruments 82
6.7 Payment of Indebtedness 82
6.8 Real Property Collateral 83
6.9 Federal Securities Laws 84
6.10 Exercise of Rights 84
6.11 [Reserved] 84
6.12 Additional Subsidiaries 84
6.13 [Reserved] 85
6.14 Sanctions and Anti-Corruption Matters 85
6.15 Impact Subscription to or Impact Services 85
6.16 Post-Closing Deliveries 86

 

VII. NEGATIVE COVENANTS 87

 

7.1 Merger, Consolidation, Acquisition and Sale of Assets 87
7.2 Creation of Liens 88
7.3 No Further Negative Pledges 90
7.4 Investments 90
7.5 Sale and Lease-Backs 91
7.6 [Reserved] 91
7.7 Restricted Payments 91
7.8 Indebtedness 92
7.9 Nature of Business 92
7.10 Transactions with Affiliates 92
7.11 Burdensome Agreements 93
7.12 [Reserved] 93
7.13 Fiscal Year and Accounting Changes 93

 

iii 

 

 

Table of Contents

(continued)

 

Page

 

7.14 [Reserved] 93
7.15 Amendment of Governing Documents 93
7.16 Compliance with ERISA 94
7.17 Prepayment of Indebtedness 94
7.18 Anti-Terrorism Laws 94
7.19 Membership/Partnership Interests 94
7.20 Trading with the Enemy Act 95
7.21 Management Agreement; Management Fees 95
7.22 Other Agreements 95
7.23 Canadian Subsidiary 95
7.24 ABL Obligations 95

 

VIII. CONDITIONS PRECEDENT 96

 

8.1 Conditions to Initial Advances 96
8.2 Conditions to Delayed Draw Term Loans 99

 

IX. INFORMATION AS TO CREDIT PARTIES 100

 

9.1 Information Regarding Credit Parties 100
9.2 [Reserved] 100
9.3 [Reserved] 100
9.4 Litigation, etc. 100
9.5 Material Occurrences 100
9.6 Management Discussion and Analysis 101
9.7 Annual Financial Statements 101
9.8 Quarterly Financial Statements 101
9.9 Monthly Financial Statements 102
9.10 Acquired Intellectual Property 102
9.11 Additional Information 102
9.12 Projections 103
9.13 Small Business Administration 103
9.14 Notice of Suits, Adverse Events 103
9.15 ERISA Notices and Requests 103
9.16 [Reserved] 104
9.17 Board Observation Rights 104

 

X. EVENTS OF DEFAULT 104

 

10.1 Nonpayment 104
10.2 Breach of Representation 104
10.3 Noncompliance 105
10.4 Reserved 105
10.5 Judgments and Attachments 105
10.6 Criminal Proceeding 105

 

iv 

 

 

Table of Contents

(continued)

 

Page

 

10.7 Bankruptcy 105
10.8 Inability to Pay 106
10.9 Government Settlement 106
10.10 Material Adverse Change 106
10.11 Cross Default to other Indebtedness 106
10.12 Breach of Guarantee 106
10.13 Change of Control 107
10.14 Invalidity 107
10.15 Seizures 107
10.16 Operations 107
10.17 Pension Benefit Plans 107
10.18 Anti-Terrorism Laws 107
10.19 Invalidity of Intercreditor Agreement or Subordination Provisions 108

 

XI. LENDERS’ RIGHTS AND REMEDIES AFTER DEFAULT, ETC. 108

 

11.1 Rights and Remedies 108
11.2 Agent’s Discretion 110
11.3 Setoff 110
11.4 Rights and Remedies not Exclusive 111
11.5 Allocation of Payments After Event of Default 111

 

XII. WAIVERS AND JUDICIAL PROCEEDINGS 111

 

12.1 Waiver of Notice 111
12.2 Delay 112
12.3 Jury Waiver 112

 

XIII. EFFECTIVE DATE AND TERMINATION 112

 

13.1 Term 112
13.2 Termination 112
13.3 Revival and Reinstatement of Obligations 113

 

XIV. REGARDING AGENT 113

 

14.1 Appointment 113
14.2 Nature of Duties 114
14.3 Lack of Reliance on Agent and Resignation 114
14.4 Certain Rights of Agent 115
14.5 Reliance 115
14.6 Notice of Default 115
14.7 Indemnification 116
14.8 Agent in its Individual Capacity 116
14.9 Delivery of Documents 116
14.10 Borrowers’ Undertaking to Agent 116

 

v 

 

 

Table of Contents

(continued)

 

Page

 

14.11 No Reliance on Agent’s Customer Identification Program 116
14.12 Other Agreements 117
14.13 Erroneous Payment 117

 

XV. MISCELLANEOUS 118

 

15.1 Governing Law 118
15.2 Entire Understanding 119
15.3 Successors and Assigns; Participations; New Lenders 121
15.4 Application of Payments 123
15.5 Indemnity 124
15.6 Notice 124
15.7 Survival 126
15.8 Severability 126
15.9 Expenses 126
15.10 Injunctive Relief 127
15.11 Damages 127
15.12 Captions 127
15.13 Counterparts, etc. 127
15.14 Construction 127
15.15 Confidentiality; Sharing Information 128
15.16 PUBLICITY 129
15.17 Certifications From Banks and Participants; USA PATRIOT Act 129
15.18 Borrowing Agency Provisions 130

 

XVI. Guaranty and Suretyship Agreement 130

 

16.1 Guaranty and Suretyship Agreement 130
16.2 Guaranty of Payment and Not Merely Collection 131
16.3 Guarantor and Suretyship Waivers 131
16.4 Repayments or Recovery from Agent or Lenders 132
16.5 Enforceability of Obligations 132
16.6 Guaranty Payable upon Event of Default; Remedies 133
16.7 Waiver of Subrogation 133
16.8 Continuing Guaranty and Suretyship Agreement 133
16.9 General Limitation on Guarantee Obligations 134
16.10 Right of Contribution 134
16.11 Intercreditor Agreement 134

 

vi 

 

 

TERM LOAN AND SECURITY AGREEMENT

 

Term Loan and Security Agreement dated as of December 3, 2021 among DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC, a Texas limited liability company (“DDH”, together with any Person joined as a party to this Agreement as a “Borrower” in accordance with Section 6.12 hereof, and all of their respective permitted successors and assigns, the “Borrowers”), the Guarantors party hereto (together with the Borrowers, the “Credit Parties” and each a “Credit Party”), the financial institutions which are now or which hereafter become a party hereto (collectively, the “Lenders” and each individually, a “Lender”) and Lafayette Square Loan Servicing, LLC (“Lafayette Square”), as agent for Lenders (Lafayette Square, in such capacity, “Agent”).

 

IN CONSIDERATION of the mutual covenants and undertakings herein contained, the Credit Parties, Lenders and Agent hereby agree as follows:

 

I. DEFINITIONS.

 

1.1            Accounting Terms.

 

(a)            Except as otherwise expressly provided herein, all accounting terms used in this Agreement, the Other Documents or any certificate, report or other document made or delivered pursuant to this Agreement not otherwise defined herein shall have the meanings assigned to them in conformity with GAAP. Financial statements and other information required to be delivered by Borrower to Agent and Lenders pursuant to Sections 9.7, 9.8 and 9.9 shall be prepared in accordance with GAAP as in effect at the time of such preparation. If at any time any change in GAAP or in the consistent application thereof would affect the computation of any financial covenant or requirement set forth in this Agreement or any Other Document, and Borrowing Agent shall object in writing to determining compliance based on such change or Agent shall otherwise require, then Agent and Borrowing Agent shall negotiate in good faith to amend such financial covenant, requirement or applicable defined terms to preserve the original intent thereof in light of such change to GAAP, provided that, until so amended such computations shall continue to be made on a basis consistent with the most recent financial statements delivered pursuant to Sections 9.7, 9.8 and 9.9 as to which no such objection has been made and the Credit Parties shall provide additional financial statements or supplements thereto, attachments to Compliance Certificates and/or calculations regarding financial covenants as Agent may reasonably require in order to provide the appropriate financial information required hereunder with respect to the Credit Parties both reflecting any applicable changes in GAAP and as necessary to demonstrate compliance with the financial covenants before giving effect to the applicable changes in GAAP.

 

(b)            Notwithstanding the above, the parties hereto acknowledge and agree that all calculations of the financial covenants in Section 6.5 shall be made on a Pro Forma Basis.

 

(c)            Notwithstanding the above, for purposes of determining compliance with any covenant (including the computation of any financial covenant) contained herein, Indebtedness of DDH and its Subsidiaries (or DDH Holdings and its Subsidiaries if applicable) shall be deemed to be carried at 100% of the outstanding principal amount thereof, and the effects of FASB ASC 825 and FASB ASC 470-20 on financial liabilities shall be disregarded.

 

 

 

 

(d)            [Reserved].

  

(e)            To the extent a Fiscal Year or Fiscal Quarter of DDH (or DDH Holdings if applicable) ends on a date that is not a calendar year or calendar quarter end, references herein to a Fiscal Year or Fiscal Quarter ending on March 31, June 30, September 30 or December 31 shall be deemed to refer to the Fiscal Year or Fiscal Quarter most recently ending on or about such date.

 

1.2            Defined Terms. For purposes of this Agreement the following terms shall have the following meanings:

 

ABL Amendment” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 6.16(e) hereof.

 

ABL Credit Agreement” shall mean (a) that certain Credit Agreement dated as of September 30, 2020 among DDH, certain Subsidiaries thereof, and ABL Lender, as such agreement has been amended and may hereafter be amended, restated or otherwise modified in accordance with the Intercreditor Agreement, and (b) any Replacement ABL Credit Agreement entered into subsequent to the Closing Date.

 

ABL Lender” shall mean (a) East West Bank, a California bank, and any successors and assigns to the extent permitted pursuant to the Intercreditor Agreement, or (b) any lender under a Replacement ABL Credit Agreement.

 

ABL Loan Documents” shall mean any and all notes, agreements, documents, instruments now or at anytime evidencing, securing, guarantying or otherwise executed and delivered in connection with the ABL Credit Agreement, as the same may be amended, restated, supplemented or modified in accordance with the Intercreditor Agreement, including all “Loan Documents” as defined in the ABL Credit Agreement.

 

ABL Obligations” shall mean the liabilities and Indebtedness of the Credit Parties outstanding under the ABL Credit Agreement from time to time, including the “Obligations” under and as defined in the ABL Credit Agreement in effect on the date hereof.

 

Acquisition” shall mean, with respect to any Person, the acquisition by such Person, in a single transaction or in a series of related transactions, of (a) all or any substantial portion of the property of another Person, or any division, line of business or other business unit of another Person or (b) at least a majority of the Voting Stock of another Person, in each case whether or not involving a merger or consolidation with such other Person and whether for cash, property, services, assumption of Indebtedness, securities or otherwise.

 

Acquisition Documentsshall mean, with respect to any Acquisition, the purchase agreement and all material other agreements related to such Acquisition, in each case as amended in conformity with the terms of this Agreement.

 

Advances” shall mean and include each advance of the Term Loans.

 

Adverse Proceeding shall mean any action, suit, proceeding (whether administrative, judicial or otherwise), governmental investigation or arbitration (whether or not purportedly on behalf of any Credit Party or any of its Subsidiaries) at law or in equity, or before or by any Governmental Body, whether pending, threatened in writing against any Credit Party or any of its Subsidiaries or any material property of any Credit Party or any of its Subsidiaries.

 

2 

 

 

Affiliate” of any Person shall mean any other Person that directly, or indirectly through one or more intermediaries, Controls, is Controlled by, or is under common Control with such the Person specified.

 

Agent” shall have the meaning set forth in the preamble to this Agreement and shall include its successors and permitted assigns.

 

Agreement” shall mean this Term Loan and Security Agreement, as the same may be amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time.

 

ALTA” shall mean American Land Title Association.

 

Anti-Corruption Laws” shall mean the Foreign Corrupt Practices Act, 15 U.S.C. §§ 78dd-1, et seq, the UK Bribery Act of 2010 and all other laws, rules, and regulations of any jurisdiction applicable to any Credit Party or any of its Affiliates from time to time concerning or relating to bribery or corruption.

 

Anti-Terrorism Laws” shall mean any Applicable Laws relating to terrorism, trade sanctions programs and embargoes, import/export licensing, money laundering or bribery and any regulation, order or directive promulgated, issued or enforced pursuant to such Applicable Laws, including Executive Order No. 13224, the USA PATRIOT Act, the Applicable Laws comprising or implementing the Bank Secrecy Act, and the Applicable Laws administered by OFAC (as any of the foregoing Applicable Laws may from time to time be amended, modified, supplemented, renewed, extended, or replaced).

 

Applicable Impact Discount” shall mean (a) as of the Closing Date and through and including the date immediately prior to the first Applicable Impact Discount Reset Date, a rate per annum equal to 0.00 % and (b) on and after each Applicable Impact Discount Reset Date, (i) a rate per annum as set forth in the table below based upon the Impact Subscription to each of the Eligible Impact Services by Borrowers:

 

No Eligible Impact Services     0.00 %
One or more Eligible Impact Services     0.05 %

 

plus (ii) solely to the extent Borrowers received a B Corp Certification by Standards Analysts at the non-profit B Lab (or any successor certification or administrator identified by Agent in its sole discretion), as listed in https://bcorporation.net/directory (or any successor directory identified by Agent in its sole discretion) or such other comparable certification from a nationally recognized and reputable third party assessment and validation of social and environmental performance identified to and approved by Agent in writing, a rate per annum equal to 0.05% so long as Borrowers maintain such certification.

 

3 

 

 

The component of the Applicable Impact Discount set forth in clause (b)(i) above shall (i) remain in effect for the period of the applicable Impact Subscription to any applicable Eligible Impact Service(s) notwithstanding removal of such provider, program or service from Exhibit A (unless Agent has notified Borrowers in writing that such provider, program or service is removed or to be removed from Exhibit A prior to the commencement of the period of any such Impact Subscription) and (ii) be adjusted, to the extent applicable, (x) as of each Applicable Impact Discount Reset Date based upon and to the extent that Borrowers have certified in the applicable Impact Certificate as to the Impact Subscription to any such applicable Eligible Impact Service or (y) otherwise at such time agreed by Agent and Borrowers as a result of a mutual determination to (1) cease or otherwise terminate any applicable Eligible Impact Service (thereby reducing the Applicable Impact Discount) or (2) Impact Subscribe to an Eligible Impact Service which had not been the subject of an Impact Subscription immediately prior to such determination (thereby increasing the Applicable Impact Discount to the extent applicable).

  

If Agent determines that Borrowers did not successfully make an Impact Subscription to any such Eligible Impact Service during an earlier period in which the Applicable Impact Discount applied (or were otherwise not certified as a B Corporation under clause (b)(ii) above during any such earlier period), without limiting any other rights or remedies arising as a result of any certification in an Impact Certificate which may prove to have been false or misleading, Borrowers shall automatically and retroactively be obligated to pay to Agent, for the benefit of the applicable Lenders, promptly on demand by Agent, an amount equal to the excess of the amount of interest that should have been paid for such period without the Applicable Impact Discount over the amount of interest actually paid for such period.

 

Applicable Impact Discount Reset Date” shall mean the first day of the month following the date on which financial statements, Compliance Certificate and Impact Certificate are required to be delivered pursuant to Section 9.8 after the end of each related Fiscal Quarter.

 

Applicable Laws” shall mean all applicable laws, including all applicable provisions of constitutions, statutes, rules, ordinances, regulations and orders of all Governmental Bodies and all orders, rulings, writs and decrees of all courts, tribunals and arbitrators.

 

4 

 

 

Applicable Margin” shall mean (a) as of the Closing Date and through and including the date on which the quarterly financial statements of the Credit Parties on a Consolidated Basis required under Section 9.8 hereof for the fiscal quarter ending December 31, 2021 are delivered, the margin corresponding to Level III below (the date of such delivery, the “Initial Adjustment Date”), and (b) effective on the first day of the month following receipt by Agent of the quarterly financial statements of the Credit Parties on a Consolidated Basis and related Compliance Certificate required under Section 9.8 hereof for the fiscal quarter ending subsequent to the Initial Adjustment Date (such first day of the applicable month, an “Adjustment Date”), the Applicable Margin for the Term Loans shall be adjusted, if necessary, to the applicable percent per annum set forth in the pricing table below corresponding to the Consolidated Total Net Leverage Ratio for the trailing four quarter period ending on the last day of the most recently completed fiscal quarter prior to the applicable Adjustment Date:

 

Level     Consolidated Total Net
Leverage Ratio
  Applicable Margin  
  I     Less than or equal to 2.00 to 1.00
    6.50 %
  II     Greater than 2.00 to 1.00 and less than or equal to 2.50 to 1.00     7.00 %
  III     Greater than 2.50 to 1.00 and less than or equal to 3.00 to 1.00
    7.50 %
  IV     Greater than 3.00 to 1.00 and less than or equal to 3.50 to 1.00     8.00 %
  V     Greater than 3.50 to 1.00 and less than or equal to 4.00 to 1.00     8.50 %
  VI     Greater than 4.00 to 1.00     9.00 %

  

If the Credit Parties shall fail to deliver the financial statements, certificates and/or other information required under Sections 9.7 or 9.8 hereof by the dates required pursuant to such sections, each Applicable Margin shall be conclusively presumed to equal the highest Applicable Margin specified in the pricing table set forth above until the date of delivery of such financial statements, certificates and/or other information, at which time the rate will be adjusted based upon the Consolidated Total Net Leverage Ratio reflected in such statements. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary set forth herein, immediately and automatically upon the occurrence and continuation of any Event of Default, each Applicable Margin shall increase to and equal the highest Applicable Margin specified in the pricing table set forth above and shall continue at such highest Applicable Margin until the date (if any) on which such Event of Default shall be waived in accordance with the provisions of this Agreement, at which time the rate will be adjusted based upon the Consolidated Total Net Leverage Ratio reflected on the most recently delivered financial statements and Compliance Certificate delivered by the Credit Parties to Agent pursuant to Section 9.7 or 9.8 hereof (as applicable). Any increase in interest rates payable by the Credit Parties under this Agreement and the Other Documents pursuant to the provisions of the foregoing sentence shall be in addition to and independent of any increase in such interest rates resulting from the occurrence of any Event of Default (including, if applicable, any Event of Default arising from a breach of Sections 9.7 or 9.8 hereof) and/or the effectiveness of the Default Rate provisions of Section 3.1 hereof.

 

If, as a result of any restatement of, or other adjustment to, the financial statements of the Credit Parties or for any other reason, Agent determines in its Permitted Discretion that (a) the Consolidated Total Net Leverage Ratio as previously calculated as of any applicable date for any applicable period was inaccurate, and (b) a proper calculation of the Consolidated Total Net Leverage Ratio for any such period would have resulted in different pricing for such period, then (i) if the proper calculation of the Consolidated Total Net Leverage Ratio would have resulted in a higher interest rate for such period, automatically and immediately without the necessity of any demand or notice by Agent or any other affirmative act of any party, the interest accrued on the applicable outstanding Advances for such period under the provisions of this Agreement and the Other Documents shall be deemed to be retroactively increased by, and the Credit Parties shall be obligated to immediately pay to Agent for the ratable benefit of Lenders an amount equal to the excess of the amount of interest that should have been paid for such period over the amount of interest actually paid for such period; and (ii) if the proper calculation of the Consolidated Total Net Leverage Ratio would have resulted in a lower interest rate for such period, then Agent shall, upon such determination, notify DDH of the amount of interest over-paid and the Borrowers shall be entitled to a credit (which shall be applied to future accrued interest) from the Lenders who were Lenders that held the Loans during the relevant period and continue to hold Loans on the date Agent made such determination in an amount equal to any such excess interest paid to such Lender; provided, that, if as a result of any restatement or other event or other determination by Agent a proper calculation of the Consolidated Total Net Leverage Ratio would have resulted in a higher interest rate for one or more periods and a lower interest rate for one or more other periods (due to the shifting of income or expenses from one period to another period or any other reason), then the amount payable by the Credit Parties pursuant to clause (i) above shall be based upon the excess, if any, of the amount of interest that should have been paid for all applicable periods over the amounts of interest actually paid for such periods.

 

5 

 

 

Asset Sale shall mean a sale, lease, Sale and Leaseback Transaction, assignment, conveyance, exclusive license (as licensor), Securitization Transaction, transfer or other disposition to, or any exchange of property with, any non-Credit Party Person, in one transaction or a series of transactions, of all or any part of any Credit Party or any of its Subsidiaries’ businesses, assets or properties of any kind, whether real, personal, or mixed and whether tangible or intangible, whether now owned or hereafter acquired, created, leased or licensed, including the Equity Interests of DDH or any Subsidiary of DDH, provided that “Asset Sales” shall not include any (a) dispositions of surplus, obsolete or worn out property or property in the ordinary course of business; (b) dispositions of inventory sold, and Intellectual Property licensed, in the ordinary course of business; (c) dispositions of accounts or payment intangibles (each as defined in the UCC) resulting from the compromise or settlement thereof in the ordinary course of business for less than the full amount thereof; (d) dispositions of Cash Equivalents in the ordinary course of business; (e) licenses, sublicenses, leases or subleases granted to any third parties in the ordinary course of business that do not interfere in any material respect with the business of Borrower or any of its Subsidiaries; and (f) any Redemption/Exchange Transactions.

 

Attributable Principal Amount” shall mean (a) in the case of Capital Leases, the amount of Capital Lease obligations determined in accordance with GAAP, (b) in the case of Synthetic Leases, an amount determined by capitalization of the remaining lease payments thereunder as if it were a Capital Lease determined in accordance with GAAP, (c) in the case of Securitization Transactions, the outstanding principal amount of such financing, after taking into account reserve amounts and making appropriate adjustments, determined by Agent in its reasonable judgment and (d) in the case of Sale and Leaseback Transactions, the present value (discounted in accordance with GAAP at the debt rate implied in the applicable lease) of the obligations of the lessee for rental payments during the term of such lease.

 

Authority” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 4.19(c).

 

Authorized Officer shall mean, as applied to any Person, any individual holding the position of chairman of the board (if an officer), chief executive officer, president or one of its vice presidents (or the equivalent thereof), chief financial officer or treasurer and, solely for purposes of making the certifications required under Sections 8.1(c) and (d), any secretary or assistant secretary.

 

6 

 

  

Bankruptcy Code” shall mean Title 11 of the United States Code entitled “Bankruptcy,” as now and hereafter in effect, or any successor statute.

 

Borrower” and “Borrowers” shall mean DDH and each other Person joined as a party to this Agreement as a “Borrower” in accordance with Sections 6.12 hereof, and all of their respective permitted successors and assigns.

 

Borrowers’ Account” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 2.4.

 

Borrowing Agent” shall mean DDH.

 

Business Day” shall mean any day other than Saturday or Sunday, a legal holiday on which commercial banks are authorized or required by law to be closed for business in New York, New York or legal holiday on which Agent is not open for business in its main office in New York.

 

Capital Expenditures” shall mean, for any period of determination, expenditures made or liabilities incurred during such period for the acquisition of any fixed assets or improvements, replacements, substitutions or additions thereto which have a useful life of more than one year (including, for the purpose of clarity, the total principal portion of Capitalized Lease Obligations paid in such period), which, in accordance with GAAP, would be classified as capital expenditures, but excluding (a) any such expenditures made with proceeds of any Involuntary Disposition to the extent such expenditures are used to purchase property that is the same as or similar to the property subject to such Involuntary Disposition or (b) Permitted Acquisitions; provided that, for purposes hereof, Capital Expenditures shall be calculated net of the value of any property traded-in or exchanged in connection with any such expenditure.

 

Capital Lease” shall mean, with respect to any Person, any lease of (or other agreement conveying the right to use) any property by such Person as a lessee that, in conformity with GAAP (subject to Section 1.1), is or should be accounted for as a capital lease on the balance sheet of such Person.

 

Capitalized Lease Obligation” shall mean any obligation under a Capital Lease.

 

Cash Equivalents” shall mean, as of any date of determination, any of the following: (a) marketable securities (i) issued or directly and unconditionally guaranteed as to interest and principal by the United States government, or (ii) issued by any agency of the United States the obligations of which are backed by the full faith and credit of the United States, in each case maturing within one (1) year after such date; (b) marketable direct obligations issued by any state of the United States or any political subdivision of any such state or any public instrumentality thereof, in each case maturing within one (1) year after such date and having, at the time of the acquisition thereof, a rating of at least A-1 from S&P or at least P-1 from Moody’s; (c) commercial paper maturing no more than one (1) year from the date of creation thereof and having, at the time of the acquisition thereof, a rating of at least A-1 from S&P or at least P-1 from Moody’s; (d) certificates of deposit or bankers’ acceptances maturing within one (1) year after such date and issued or accepted by any commercial bank that is organized under the laws of the United States or any state thereof or the District of Columbia that (i) is at least “adequately capitalized” (as defined in the regulations of its primary federal banking regulator), and (ii) has Tier 1 capital (as defined in such regulations) of not less than $100,000,000; and (e) shares of any money market mutual fund that (i) has substantially all of its assets invested continuously in the types of investments referred to in clauses (a) and (b) above, (ii) has net assets of not less than $500,000,000, and (iii) has the highest rating obtainable from either S&P or Moody’s.

 

7 

 

 

CERCLA” shall mean the Comprehensive Environmental Response, Compensation and Liability Act of 1980, as amended, 42 U.S.C. §§9601 et seq.

 

Change of Control” shall mean:

 

(a)            at any time prior to the consummation of a Qualified IPO, (i) the occurrence of any event (whether in one or more transactions) which results in a transfer of control of DDH or any other Credit Party to a Person other than the Permitted Holders, or (ii) the occurrence of any event (whether in one or more transactions) which results in (A) Mark Walker or Keith Smith or their respective Related Parties failing to own, directly or indirectly, legally and beneficially (free and clear of all Liens), at least 75% of the Equity Interests (on a fully diluted basis) of DDH or (B) DDH failing to own legally and beneficially (free and clear of Liens), 100% of the Equity Interests (on a fully diluted basis) of each other Credit Party;

 

(b)             at any time after the consummation of a Qualified IPO, (i)     any “person” or “group” (as such terms are used in Sections 13(d) and 14(d) of the Exchange Act) excluding any Permitted Holder) becomes the “beneficial owner” (as defined in Rules 13d-3 and 13d-5 under the Exchange Act, except that a person or group shall be deemed to have “beneficial ownership” of all securities that such person or group has the right to acquire, whether such right is exercisable immediately or only after the passage of time (such right, an “option right”)), directly or indirectly, of 40% or more of the voting power of the total outstanding Equity Interests of DDH Holdings entitled to vote for members of the board of directors or equivalent governing body of DDH on a fully-diluted basis (and taking into account all such Equity Interests that such “person” or “group” has the right to acquire pursuant to any option right); or (ii) the occurrence of any event (whether in one or more transactions) which results in (A) DDH Holdings, Keith Smith, Mark Walker and their respective Related Parties collectively, failing to own, directly or indirectly, legally and beneficially (free and clear of all Liens), 100% of the Equity Interests (on a fully diluted basis) of DDH, or (B) DDH failing to own legally and beneficially (free and clear of Liens), 100% of the Equity Interests (on a fully diluted basis) of each other Credit Party; or

 

(c)            at any time after the consummation of a Qualified IPO, during any period of 12 consecutive months, a majority of the members of the board of directors or other equivalent governing body of DDH Holdings cease to be composed of individuals (i) who were members of that board or equivalent governing body on the first day of such period, (ii) whose election or nomination to that board or equivalent governing body was approved by individuals referred to in clause (i) above constituting at the time of such election or nomination at least a majority of that board or equivalent governing body or (iii) whose election or nomination to that board or other equivalent governing body was approved by individuals referred to in clauses (i) and (ii) above constituting at the time of such election or nomination at least a majority of that board or equivalent governing body’, in each case with respect to clauses (i), (ii) and (iii), as a result of hostile proxy contest.

 

8 

 

 

Closing Date” shall mean December 3, 2021.

 

Closing Date Term Loan” shall mean the Advances made pursuant to Section 2.1(a) hereof.

 

Closing Date Term Loan Amount” shall mean $22,000,000.

 

Closing Date Term Note” shall mean, collectively, the promissory notes described in Section 2.1(a) hereof.

 

Closing Date Transactions” shall mean, collectively, (a) the consummation of the transactions contemplated by and this Agreement, (b) the Preferred A Redemption, (c) the repayment of Indebtedness of the Borrowers with the proceeds of the Closing Date Term Loan, in each case, which have been, or are contemplated to be, consummated on or prior to the Closing Date and (d) the payment of fees and expenses in connection therewith.

 

Code” shall mean the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as the same may be amended or supplemented from time to time, and any successor statute of similar import, and the rules and regulations thereunder, as from time to time in effect.

 

Collateral” shall mean and include, all right, title and interest of each Credit Party in all of the following property and assets of such Credit Party, in each case, whether now existing or hereafter arising or created and whether now owned or hereafter acquired and wherever located:

 

(a)            all Receivables;

 

(b)            all cash and currency;

 

(c)            all Certificates of Title;

 

(d)            all Chattel Paper;

 

(e)            those certain Commercial Tort Claims set forth on Schedule 1.2(c) hereto;

 

(f)             all Intellectual Property (other than any United States intent to use applications prior to the filing of a “Statement of Use” or “Amendment to Allege Use”);

 

(g)            all Deposit Accounts;

 

(h)            all Documents;

 

(i)            all Equipment;

 

(j)             all Fixtures;

 

(k)            all General Intangibles (including, without limitation, the Key Executive Policy);

 

9 

 

 

(l)             all Goods;

 

(m)            all Instruments;

 

(n)            all Inventory;

 

(o)            all Investment Property;

 

(p)            all Letter-of-Credit Rights;

 

(q)            all Payment Intangibles;

 

(r)            all Subsidiary Stock;

 

(s)            all Software;

 

(t)             all Supporting Obligations;

 

(u)            all books and records pertaining to any of the foregoing; and

 

(v)            all Accessions and Proceeds of any and all of the foregoing.

 

Notwithstanding the foregoing, Collateral shall not include, and no Credit Party shall be deemed to have granted a security interest in the following (each of the following, “Excluded Property”): (i)  any disbursement deposit account the funds in which are used solely for the payment of salaries and wages, employee benefits, workers’ compensation and similar expenses, (ii) any owned or leased real or personal property which is located outside of the United States, (iii) any owned real property having a fair market value not in excess of $500,000; provided that the aggregate fair market value of all such real property constituting “Excluded Property” does not exceed $500,000, in which case Borrowing Agent shall designate certain of such real property as not constituting “Excluded Property” so that the foregoing aggregate threshold is not exceeded, (iv) any leased real property, (v) motor vehicles subject to certificate of title statutes having an original cost not in excess of $500,000 in the aggregate, (vi) any property which, subject to the terms of Section 7.3, is subject to a Lien of the type described in Section 7.2(n) pursuant to documents which prohibit the applicable Credit Party from granting any other Liens in such property, (vii) any property to the extent that the grant of a security interest therein would violate Applicable Laws, require a consent not obtained of any Governmental Body, or constitute a breach of or default under, or result in the termination of or require a consent not obtained under, any contract, lease, license or other agreement evidencing or giving rise to such property, or result in the invalidation thereof or provide any party thereto with a right of termination (other than to the extent that any such term would be rendered ineffective pursuant to Section 9-406, 9-407, 9-408 or 9-409 of the applicable Uniform Commercial Code or any other Applicable Law or principles of equity), (viii) any certificates, licenses and other authorizations issued by any Governmental Body to the extent that Applicable Laws prohibit the granting of a security interest therein, (ix) Equity Interests of 142 Canada, (x) proceeds and products of any and all of the foregoing excluded property described in clauses (i) through (ix) above only to the extent such proceeds and products would constitute Excluded Property, and (x) any other assets of such Credit Party with respect to which Agent and Borrowers agree in writing that the costs or other consequences of obtaining or perfecting a security interest in such property are excessive in view of the benefits to be obtained therefrom; provided, however, that the security interest granted to Agent hereunder or any Other Document shall attach immediately to any asset of any Credit Party at such time as such asset ceases to meet any of the criteria for “Excluded Property” described in any of the foregoing clauses (i) through (ix) above.

 

10 

 

 

Commitment Percentage” of any Lender shall mean, as applicable, its Term Loan Commitment Percentage and/or its Delayed Draw Term Loan Commitment Percentage, as applicable.

 

Common Units Redemption” shall mean the contemplated redemption of all of the common units held in DDH by USDM Holdings, Inc. pursuant to the Redemption Agreement.

 

Company Agreement” shall mean the amended and restated limited liability company agreement of DDH entered into in connection with a Qualified IPO.

 

Compliance Certificate” shall mean a compliance certificate in substantially the form attached hereto as Exhibit C to be signed by an Authorized Officer of DDH.

 

Consents” shall mean all filings and all licenses, permits, consents, approvals, authorizations, qualifications and orders of Governmental Bodies and other third parties, domestic or foreign, necessary to carry on the Credit Parties’ business or necessary (including to avoid a conflict or breach under any agreement, instrument, other document, license, permit or other authorization) for the execution, delivery or performance of this Agreement, the Other Documents, the Acquisition Documents and all related documents and agreements, including any Consents required under the ABL Loan Documents and all applicable federal, state or other Applicable Law.

 

Consolidated Basis” shall mean, (a) prior to a Qualified IPO, with respect to DDH and its Subsidiaries, as the context may require, the consolidation in accordance with GAAP of the accounts and other items of DDH and its Subsidiaries, and (b) subsequent to a Qualified IOP, with respect to DDH Holdings and its Subsidiaries as the context may require, the consolidation in accordance with GAAP of the accounts and other items of DDH Holdings and its Subsidiaries.

 

Consolidated Capital Expenditures” shall mean, for any period, for DDH (or DDH Holdings if applicable) and its Subsidiaries on a Consolidated Basis, the sum of all Capital Expenditures of such entity for such period.

 

Consolidated Current Assets” shall mean, as of any date of determination, the total assets of DDH (or DDH Holdings if applicable) and its Subsidiaries on a Consolidated Basis that may properly be classified as current assets in accordance with GAAP, excluding cash and Cash Equivalents.

 

Consolidated Current Liabilities” shall mean, as of any date of determination, the total liabilities of DDH (or DDH Holdings if applicable) and its Subsidiaries on a Consolidated Basis that may properly be classified as current liabilities in accordance with GAAP and shall be calculated by excluding the current portion of the Obligations.

 

11 

 

 

Consolidated EBITDA” shall mean, for any period, for DDH and its Subsidiaries (or DDH Holdings and its Subsidiaries if applicable) on a Consolidated Basis, an amount equal to (a) Consolidated Net Income for such period plus, (b) to the extent deducted in determining such Consolidated Net Income, the sum, without duplication, of (i) Consolidated Interest Charges during such period, (ii) all federal, state, local and/or foreign income taxes payable by DDH and its Subsidiaries (or DDH Holdings and its Subsidiaries if applicable) during such period, (iii) depreciation expenses of DDH and its Subsidiaries (or DDH Holdings and its Subsidiaries if applicable) during such period, (iv) amortization expenses of DDH and its Subsidiaries (or DDH Holdings and its Subsidiaries if applicable) during such period, (v) for any portion of the applicable measurement period occurring prior to a Qualified IPO, Management Fees paid in cash prior to a Qualified IPO during such period in an amount not to exceed in aggregate amount $900,000 per annum or $225,000 per quarter for purposes of this definition, (vi) [reserved], (vii) without duplication, non-recurring actual, documented legal, consulting expenses in an amount up to $500,000 during any 12 month period, and (ix) any cash payments (including all premiums) made with respect to the Key Executive Policies required pursuant to Section 4.21, and minus (c) any extraordinary, non-recurring and/or non-cash gains or income during such period as reported in the monthly and annual financials of DDH and its Subsidiaries (or DDH Holdings and its Subsidiaries if applicable). Notwithstanding the forgoing, Consolidated EBITDA for the calendar months set forth below shall be the amount corresponding to such calendar month set forth below:

 

Calendar Month Ended   Consolidated EBITDA  
September 30, 2020   $ 672,790.00  
October 31, 2020   $ 330,910.00  
November 30, 2020   $ 284,005.00  
December 31, 2020   $ 505,656.00  
January 31, 2021   $ (18,458.00 )
February 28, 2021   $ 144,508.00  
March 31, 2021   $ 644,059.00  
April 30, 2021   $ 928,598.00  
May 31, 2021   $ 1,163,805.00  
June 30, 2021   $ 1,322,474.00  
July 31, 2021   $ 445,733.00  
August 30, 2021   $ 496,366.00  

 

12 

 

 

Consolidated Excess Cash Flow” shall mean, for any period for DDH and its Subsidiaries (or DDH Holdings and its Subsidiaries if applicable) on a Consolidated Basis, an amount equal to the sum, without duplication, of (a) Consolidated EBITDA, minus (b) Unfinanced Capital Expenditures, minus (c) the cash portion of Consolidated Interest Charges, minus (d) Consolidated Taxes paid in cash minus (e) Consolidated Scheduled Funded Debt Payments, minus (f) the Consolidated Working Capital Adjustment, minus (g) the aggregate amount of all voluntary prepayments of any Indebtedness permitted hereunder of DDH and its Subsidiaries (or DDH Holdings and its Subsidiaries if applicable) made during such Fiscal Year (other than in respect of any revolving credit facility to the extent there is not an equivalent permanent reduction in commitments thereunder), minus (h) all cash expenses added back in computing Consolidated EBITDA.

 

Consolidated Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio” shall mean for DDH and its Subsidiaries (or DDH Holdings and its Subsidiaries if applicable) on a Consolidated Basis, as of any date of determination, the ratio of (a) Consolidated EBITDA for the period of the four (4) Fiscal Quarters most recently ended, minus Taxes paid in cash or permitted Tax Distributions during such period, minus without duplication, Unfinanced Capital Expenditures made during such period, minus Restricted Payments (other than the Preferred A Redemption) for such period paid in cash (without limiting any restrictions in respect thereof under Section 7.7) to (b) the sum of (i) Consolidated Fixed Charges for such period.

 

Consolidated Fixed Charges” shall mean, for any period, for DDH (or DDH Holdings if applicable) and its Subsidiaries on a Consolidated Basis, an amount equal to the sum of (a) the cash portion of Consolidated Interest Charges for such period plus (b) Consolidated Scheduled Funded Debt Payments for such period, all as determined in accordance with GAAP.

 

Consolidated Funded Debt” shall mean Funded Debt of DDH (or DDH Holdings if applicable) and its Subsidiaries on a Consolidated Basis determined in accordance with GAAP excluding any obligations under an operating lease.

 

Consolidated Interest Charges” shall mean, for any period, the interest expense of DDH (or DDH Holdings if applicable) and its Subsidiaries on a Consolidated Basis for the period in question, determined on a consolidated basis and in accordance with GAAP.

 

Consolidated Net Income” shall mean, for any period, for DDH (or DDH Holdings if applicable) and its Subsidiaries on a Consolidated Basis, the net income (or loss) of DDH (or DDH Holdings if applicable) and its Subsidiaries for that period, as determined in accordance with GAAP.

 

Consolidated Scheduled Funded Debt Payments” shall mean for any period for DDH (or DDH Holdings if applicable) and its Subsidiaries on a Consolidated Basis, the sum of all scheduled payments of principal on Consolidated Funded Debt, as determined in accordance with GAAP. For purposes of this definition, “scheduled payments of principal” (a) shall be deemed to include, without duplication, scheduled principal payments with respect to the Attributable Principal Amount of Capital Leases (other than in respect of any Securitization Transactions, Sale and Leaseback Transactions and Synthetic Leases) and (b) shall not include any voluntary prepayments or mandatory prepayments required pursuant to the ABL Credit Agreement except to the extent such prepayments are accompanied by a permanent reduction of the commitments thereunder.

 

13 

 

 

Consolidated Senior Net Leverage Ratio” shall mean, as of any date of determination, the ratio of (a) the result of (i) the Funded Debt of DDH (or DDH Holdings if applicable) and its Subsidiaries on a Consolidated Basis, but excluding any Subordinated Debt and any obligations under an operating lease, minus (ii) the Unrestricted Cash of DDH and the Credit Parties in excess of $1,000,000; provided that the amount of Unrestricted Cash included in the calculation pursuant to this clause (ii) shall not exceed $15,000,000 to (b) Consolidated EBITDA for the period of the four (4) Fiscal Quarters most recently ended.

 

Consolidated Taxes” shall mean, for any period, for DDH and its Subsidiaries (or DDH Holdings and its Subsidiaries if applicable) on a Consolidated Basis, the aggregate of all taxes, as determined in accordance with GAAP.

 

Consolidated Total Net Leverage Ratio” shall mean, as of any date of determination, the ratio of (a) the result of (i) the Funded Debt of DDH (or DDH Holdings if applicable) and its Subsidiaries on a Consolidated Basis, excluding any obligations under an operating lease, minus (ii) the Unrestricted Cash of DDH and the Credit Parties in excess of $1,000,000; provided that the amount of Unrestricted Cash included in the calculation pursuant to this clause (ii) shall not exceed $15,000,000 to (b) Consolidated EBITDA for the period of the four (4) Fiscal Quarters most recently ended.

 

Consolidated Working Capital” shall mean, as of any date of determination, the excess of Consolidated Current Assets less Consolidated Current Liabilities.

 

Consolidated Working Capital Adjustment” shall mean, for any period on a Consolidated Basis, the amount (which may be a negative number) by which Consolidated Working Capital as of the end of such period exceeds (or is less than) Consolidated Working Capital as of the beginning of such period.

 

Contractual Obligation shall mean, as applied to any Person, any provision of any Security issued by that Person or of any indenture, mortgage, deed of trust, contract, undertaking, agreement or other instrument to which that Person is a party or by which it or any of its properties is bound or to which it or any of its properties is subject.

 

Control” shall mean the possession, directly or indirectly, of the power to direct or cause the direction of the management or policies of a Person, whether through the ability to exercise voting power, by contract or otherwise. “Controlling” and “Controlled” have meanings correlative thereto.

 

Control Agreement(s)” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 6.16(c) hereof.

 

Covered Entity” shall mean (a) each Credit Party, each Subsidiary of each Credit Party, and all pledgors of Collateral and (b) each Person that, directly or indirectly, is in control of a Person described in clause (a) above. For purposes of this definition, control of a Person shall mean the direct or indirect (x) ownership of, or power to vote, twenty-five percent (25%) or more of the issued and outstanding equity interests having ordinary voting power for the election of directors of such Person or other Persons performing similar functions for such Person, or (y) power to direct or cause the direction of the management and policies of such Person whether by ownership of equity interests, contract or otherwise.

 

14 

 

 

Credit Parties” shall mean the Borrowers and the Guarantors, and “Credit Party” shall mean any of them.

 

Customer” shall mean and include the account debtor with respect to any Receivable of a Person and/or the prospective purchaser of goods, services or both with respect to any contract or contract right, and/or any party who enters into or proposes to enter into any contract or other arrangement with such Person, pursuant to which such Person is to deliver any personal property or perform any services.

 

DDH” shall have the meaning ascribed to such term in the preamble to this Agreement.

 

DDH Holdings” shall mean Direct Digital Holdings, Inc., a Delaware corporation, which entity has been incorporated to enter into a Qualified IPO and shall, upon consummation of the Qualified IPO, be the managing member of DDH at all times while the umbrella partnership corporation structure is in effect.

 

Debt Transaction” shall mean, with respect to DDH or any of its Subsidiaries, any sale, issuance, placement, assumption or guaranty of Funded Debt, whether or not evidenced by a promissory note or other written evidence of Indebtedness, except for Funded Debt permitted to be incurred pursuant to Section 7.8.

 

Debtor Relief Laws” shall mean the Bankruptcy Code, and all other liquidation, conservatorship, bankruptcy, assignment for the benefit of creditors, moratorium, rearrangement, receivership, insolvency, reorganization, or similar debtor relief laws of the United States or other applicable jurisdictions from time to time in effect.

 

Default” shall mean an event, circumstance or condition which, with the giving of notice or passage of time or both, would constitute an Event of Default.

 

Default Rate” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 3.1 hereof.

 

Defaulting Lender” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 2.9(a) hereof.

 

Delayed Draw Term Loan” shall mean the Advances made pursuant to Section 2.1(b).

 

Delayed Draw Term Loan Amount” shall mean the amount requested by Borrowing Agent to be funded as the Delayed Draw Term Loan, up to the Delayed Draw Term Loan Maximum Amount.

 

Delayed Draw Term Loan Commitment Percentage” of any Lender shall mean the percentage set forth on Schedule 1.2(b) as its “Delayed Draw Term Loan Commitment Percentage,” as the same may be adjusted upon any assignment by a Lender pursuant to Section 15.3(c) or 15.3(d).

 

15 

 

 

Delayed Draw Term Loan Funding Date” shall mean, with respect to an Advance of the Delayed Draw Term Loan, the date no later than thirty six (36) months after the Closing Date on which each of the following conditions have been satisfied: (a) Agent has received, no less than ten (10) days prior to the date such Advance is requested to be funded, a written request duly executed by Borrowing Agent, specifying the amount of such Advance requested and the date on which such Advance is requested to be funded and (b) the conditions set forth in Section 8.2 have been satisfied.

 

Delayed Draw Term Loan Maximum Amount” means $10,000,000 less the original principal amount of each Delayed Draw Term Loan made subsequent to the Closing Date.

 

Delayed Draw Term Loan Note” shall mean, collectively, the promissory notes described in Section 2.1(b).

 

Depository Accounts” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 4.15(h)(i) hereof.

 

Disqualified Assignee” shall mean any Person with respect to which (a) a voluntary or involuntary case (or comparable proceeding) has been commenced under any applicable state or federal bankruptcy, insolvency, receivership, reorganization or other debtor relief laws, (b) a custodian, conservator, receiver or similar official has been appointed for such Person or for any substantial part of such Person’s assets (or any motion or request therefor has been filed with any Governmental Body), (c) such Person has made or agreed to make a general assignment for the benefit of creditors or is otherwise adjudicated as, or determined by any Governmental Body having regulatory authority over such Person or its assets to be, insolvent, bankrupt, or deficient in meeting any capital adequacy or liquidity standard of such Governmental Body, (d) such Person is a Defaulting Lender, or otherwise is unable to fulfill its obligations as a lender, under any credit facility to which it is a party (or has publicly announced that it believes that it will be any of the foregoing), or (e) which is a competitor of any Credit Party or its Subsidiaries.

 

Dollar” and the sign “$” shall mean lawful money of the United States of America.

 

Domestic Subsidiary” shall mean each Subsidiary of DDH that is not a Foreign Subsidiary.

 

Eligible Assignee” shall mean (a)(i) a commercial bank, commercial lender, financial institution, or Affiliate of such entity that represents and warrants that it is not a Disqualified Assignee; provided that so long as no Event of Default has occurred and is continuing, such Person shall be approved by Borrowing Agent (which approval of Borrowing Agent shall not be unreasonably withheld, conditioned or delayed), or (ii) any other Person approved by Borrowing Agent (which approval of Borrowing Agent shall not be unreasonably withheld, conditioned or delayed) provided that, in each case, Borrowing Agent will be deemed to have consented to any such assignment in this clause (a) unless it objects thereto by written notice to Agent within ten (10) days after having received notice thereof, (b) any Lender or Affiliate (other than a natural Person) of a Lender or a Related Fund (other than a natural Person) of a Lender and (c) during the continuation of an Event of Default under Sections 10.1, 10.3 (solely as a result of a failure to comply with Section 6.5) or 10.7, any other Person (other than a natural person).

 

16 

 

 

Eligible Impact Services” shall mean Impact Services and/or Impact Providers, as applicable, acceptable to Agent in its Permitted Discretion as part of its mission and identified on Exhibit A attached hereto and incorporated herein, as such Exhibit may be amended or supplemented in writing from time to time by written notice from Agent to Borrowers or otherwise as requested by Borrowers and approved by Agent in Agent’s sole discretion.

 

Enterprise Value” shall mean (i) with respect to any Acquisition of Property or any Acquisition of 100% of the Equity Interests of a Person, the aggregate cash and non-cash consideration (including any assumption of Indebtedness, deferred purchase price and any equity consideration) paid for such Property or Equity Interests, and (ii) with respect to any Acquisition of less than 100% of the Equity Interests of a Person, the total enterprise value of the Person acquired, calculated based upon the aggregate cash and non-cash consideration (including any assumption of Indebtedness, deferred purchase price and any equity consideration) paid for the percentage of Equity Interests that were acquired in such Acquisition, as reasonably determined in good faith by Borrower and mutually agreed to by Agent.

 

Environmental Claim shall mean any known investigation, written notice of violation, written claim, action, suit, proceeding, written demand, abatement order or other written order or directive (conditional or otherwise), by any Person arising (a) pursuant to or in connection with any actual or alleged violation of any Environmental Law; (b) in connection with any Hazardous Material or any actual or alleged Hazardous Materials Activity; or (c) in connection with any actual or alleged damage, injury, threat or harm to human health, safety, natural resources or the environment.

 

Environmental Complaint” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 4.19(c) hereof.

 

Environmental Laws shall mean any and all current or future federal or state (or any subdivision of either of them), statutes, ordinances, orders, rules, regulations, judgments, Governmental Authorizations, or any other written requirements of Governmental Bodies relating to (a) any Hazardous Materials Activity; (b) the generation, use, storage, transportation or disposal of Hazardous Materials; or (c) protection of human health and the environment from pollution, in each case, in any manner applicable to any Credit Party or any of its Subsidiaries or their respective Real Property.

 

Environmental Liability” shall mean any liability, contingent or otherwise (including any liability for damages, costs of environmental remediation, fines, penalties or indemnities), of DDH, any other Credit Party or any of their respective Subsidiaries directly or indirectly resulting from or based upon (a) violation of any Environmental Law, (b) the generation, use, handling, transportation, storage, treatment or disposal of any Hazardous Materials, (c) exposure to any Hazardous Materials, (d) the Release or threatened Release of any Hazardous Materials into the environment or (e) any contract, agreement or other consensual arrangement pursuant to which DDH or any Subsidiary of DDH assumed liability with respect to any of the foregoing.

 

Equipment” shall mean and include, with respect to any Person, all of such Person’s goods (other than Inventory) whether now owned or hereafter acquired and wherever located including all equipment, machinery, apparatus, motor vehicles, fittings, furniture, furnishings, fixtures, parts, accessories and all replacements and substitutions therefor or accessions thereto.

 

17 

 

 

Equity Interests” of any Person shall mean any and all shares, rights to purchase, options, warrants, general, limited or limited liability partnership interests, member interests, participation or other equivalents of or interest in (regardless of how designated) equity of such Person, whether voting or nonvoting, including common stock, preferred stock, convertible securities or any other “equity security” (as such term is defined in Rule 3a11-1 of the General Rules and Regulations promulgated by the SEC under the Exchange Act), including in each case all of the following rights relating to such Equity Interests, whether arising under the Governing Documents of the Person issuing such Equity Interests (the “Equity Issuer”) or under the Applicable Laws of such Equity Issuer’s jurisdiction of organization relating to the formation, existence and governance of corporations, limited liability companies or partnerships or business trusts or other legal entities, as the case may be: (i) all economic rights (including all rights to receive dividends and distributions) relating to such Equity Interests; (ii) all voting rights and rights to consent to any particular actions by the applicable Equity Issuer; (iii) all management rights with respect to such Equity Issuer; (iv) in the case of any Equity Interests consisting of a general partner interest in a partnership, all powers and rights as a general partner with respect to the management, operations and control of the business and affairs of the applicable Equity Issuer; (v) in the case of any Equity Interests consisting of the membership/limited liability company interests of a managing member in a limited liability company, all powers and rights as a managing member with respect to the management, operations and control of the business and affairs of the applicable Equity Issuer; (vi) all rights to designate or appoint or vote for or remove any officers, directors, managers, general partners or managing members of such Equity Issuer and/or any members of any board of members/managers/partners/directors that may at any time have any rights to manage and direct the business and affairs of the applicable Equity Issuer under its Governing Documents as in effect from time to time or under Applicable Law; (vii) all rights to amend the Governing Documents of such Equity Issuer, (viii) in the case of any Equity Interests in a partnership or limited liability company, the status of the holder of such Equity Interests as a “partner”, general or limited, or “member” (as applicable) under the applicable Governing Documents and/or Applicable Law; and (ix) all certificates evidencing such Equity Interests.

 

Equity Transaction” shall mean, with respect to DDH or any of its Subsidiaries, any issuance or sale by DDH or any such Subsidiary of shares of its Equity Interests, to include, without limitation, any capital contribution by such Person’s existing members, partners or shareholders, as applicable, other than an issuance (a) to DDH Holdings or Permitted Holders, (b) in connection with a conversion of debt securities to equity, (c) in connection with the exercise by a present or former employee, officer or director under a stock incentive plan, stock option plan or other equity-based compensation plan or arrangement, (d) which occurred on or prior to the Closing Date, (e) as consideration for an Acquisition permitted by Section 7.1(a), or (f) the proceeds of which are used to fund the purchase price consideration for a contemporaneous Acquisition permitted by Section 7.1(a) or capital expenditure permitted hereunder.

 

ERISA” shall mean the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended from time to time, any successor statute, and the rules and regulations promulgated thereunder.

 

18 

 

 

ERISA Affiliate” shall mean, as applied to any Person, (a) any corporation which is a member of a controlled group of corporations within the meaning of Section 414(b) of the Code of which that Person is a member; (b) any trade or business (whether or not incorporated) which is a member of a group of trades or businesses under common control within the meaning of Section 414(c) of the Code of which that Person is a member; and (c) any member of an affiliated service group within the meaning of Section 414(m) or (o) of the Code for purposes of provisions relating to Section 412 of the Code of which that Person, any corporation described in clause (a) above or any trade or business described in clause (b) above is a member.

  

ERISA Event” shall mean (a) a “reportable event” within the meaning of Section 4043 of ERISA and the regulations issued thereunder with respect to any Pension Plan (excluding those for which notice to the PBGC has been waived by regulation) that is reasonably likely to result in material liability to any Credit Party; (b) the failure to meet the minimum funding standard of Section 412 of the Code with respect to any Pension Plan (whether or not waived in accordance with Section 412(c) of the Code), the failure to make by its due date any minimum required contribution or any required installment under Section 430(j) of the Code with respect to any Pension Plan or the failure to make by its due date any required contribution to a Multiemployer Plan in either case if such failure is reasonably likely to result in liability to any Credit Party in excess of $250,000 (net of third party indemnification); (c) the provision by the administrator of any Pension Plan pursuant to Section 4041(a)(2) of ERISA of a notice of intent to terminate such plan in a distress termination described in Section 4041(c) of ERISA; (d) the withdrawal from any Pension Plan with two (2) or more contributing sponsors or the termination of any such Pension Plan, in either case resulting in material liability pursuant to Section 4063 or 4064 of ERISA; (e) the institution by the PBGC of proceedings to terminate any Pension Plan, or the occurrence of any event or condition reasonably likely to constitute grounds under ERISA for the termination of, or the appointment of a trustee to administer, any Pension Plan; (f) the imposition of liability pursuant to Section 4062(e) or 4069 of ERISA or by reason of the application of Section 4212(c) of ERISA, in each case, that is reasonably likely to result in material liability to any Credit Party; (g) the withdrawal of any Credit Party, any of its Subsidiaries or any of their respective ERISA Affiliates in a complete or partial withdrawal (within the meaning of Sections 4203 and 4205 of ERISA) from any Multiemployer Plan if such withdrawal is reasonably likely to result in liability in excess of $250,000 (net of third party indemnification), or the receipt by any Credit Party, any of its Subsidiaries or any of their respective ERISA Affiliates of notice from any Multiemployer Plan that it is in critical status or insolvency pursuant to Section 4241 or 4245 of ERISA, or that it is in “critical” or “endangered” status within the meaning of Section 103(f)(2)(G) of ERISA, or that it intends to terminate or has terminated under Section 4041A or 4042 of ERISA, if such critical status, insolvency or termination is reasonably likely to result in liability to any Credit Party in excess of $250,000 (net of third party indemnification); (h) the imposition of fines, penalties, taxes or related charges under Chapter 43 of the Code or under Section 409, Section 502(c), (i) or (l), or Section 4071 of ERISA in respect of any Pension Plan if such fines, penalties, taxes or related charges are reasonably likely to result in material liability to any Credit Party; (i) the assertion of a claim (other than routine claims for benefits and funding obligations in the ordinary course) against any Pension Plan other than a Multiemployer Plan or the assets thereof, or against any Person in connection with any Pension Plan such Person sponsors or maintains which is reasonably likely to result in material liability to any Credit Party; (j) receipt from the Internal Revenue Service of a final written determination of the failure of any Pension Plan intended to be qualified under Section 401(a) of the Code to qualify under Section 401(a) of the Code, or the failure of any trust forming part of any such plan to qualify for exemption from taxation under Section 501(a) of the Code; or (k) the imposition of a lien pursuant to Section 430(k) of the Code or pursuant to Section 303(k) or 4068 of ERISA in each case that is reasonably likely to result in material liability to any Credit Party.

 

19 

 

 

Erroneous Payment” shall have the meaning given to such term in Section 14.13(a) hereof.

 

Erroneous Payment Notice” shall have the meaning given to such term in Section 14.13(b) hereof.

 

Event of Default” shall have the meaning set forth in Article X hereof.

 

Exchange Act” shall mean the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended from time to time, and any successor statute.

 

Excluded Deposit Accounts” means any deposit account (including, for the avoidance of doubt, any cash, cash equivalents or other property contained therein): (i) solely to the extent, and for so long as, such deposit account is pledged to secure obligations arising under Section 7.02(o) of the defined term “Permitted Encumbrances”, and whether such pledge is by escrow or otherwise, in all cases with a balance no greater than such obligations under Section 7.02(o) of the defined term “Permitted Encumbrances”; (ii) used exclusively for payroll, payroll taxes and other employee wage and benefit payments with a balance no greater than such payroll, payroll taxes and other employee wage and benefit payments obligations that are to be paid within any two-week period; (iii) constituting a “zero balance” deposit account; or (iv) consisting of a disbursement account established with a payment processor to process vendor payments so long as the average monthly balance in such account (and in all such accounts in the aggregate) does not exceed $250,000 at any one time.

 

Excluded Perfection Action” shall mean any action with respect to assets otherwise constituting Collateral with respect to which Agent and Borrowing Agent shall have determined in their reasonable discretion and agree in writing that the costs or other consequences of such perfection action are excessive in relation to the benefit to the Lenders of the security intended to be afforded thereby.

 

Excluded Property” shall have the meaning set forth in the definition of “Collateral” above.

 

Excluded Taxes” shall mean any of the following Taxes on or with respect to a Payee, (a) Taxes imposed on or measured by net income (however denominated), franchise Taxes, and branch profits Taxes, in each case, imposed as a result of such recipient being organized under the laws of, or having its principal office or, in the case of any Payee, its applicable lending office located in, the jurisdiction imposing such Tax (or any political subdivision thereof), (b) in the case of a Payee, U.S. federal withholding Taxes imposed on amounts payable to or for the account of such Payee with respect to an applicable interest in an Advance or commitment pursuant to any Applicable Law in effect on the date on which (i) such Lender acquired such interest in the Advance or commitment (other than an assignee pursuant to a request by Borrowing Agent under Section 3.11) or (ii) such Lender changes its lending office, except in each case to the extent that, pursuant to Section 3.10, amounts with respect to such Taxes were payable either to such Lender’s assignor immediately before such Lender became a party hereto or to such Lender immediately before it changed its lending office, (c) Taxes attributable to such Lender’s failure to comply with Section 3.10(g)(i), or (d) any withholding Taxes imposed under FATCA.

 

20 

 

 

 

 

Executive Order No. 13224” shall mean the Executive Order No. 13224 on Terrorist Financing, effective September 24, 2001, as the same has been, or shall hereafter be, renewed, extended, amended or replaced.

 

Extraordinary Receipts” shall mean any cash in excess of $250,000 received by or paid to or for the account of DDH or any of its Subsidiaries not in the ordinary course of business (net of taxes paid or payable in connection with such receipts, including any applicable permitted Tax Distributions, if applicable), including, without limitation, under any indemnification provisions, all proceeds from releases of any escrowed amounts, any proceeds from insurance policies, all payments received in respect of any indemnification obligation and any applicable purchase price adjustments and in connection with income Tax refunds.

 

Family” shall mean, with respect to any Person (a) such Person’s spouse, (b) any immediate family member of such Persons, and (c) any other natural person who has been adopted by such Person.

 

FATCA” shall mean Sections 1471 through 1474 of the Code, as of the date of this Agreement (or any amended or successor version that is substantively comparable and not materially more onerous to comply with), any current or future regulations thereunder or official interpretations thereof and any agreements entered into pursuant to Section 1471(b)(1) of the Code.

 

Fee Letter” shall mean the fee letter dated the date hereof among the Borrowers and Agent, as the same may be amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time.

 

Financial Officer Certification shall mean, with respect to the financial statements for which such certification is required, the certification of the chief financial officer of DDH that such financial statements fairly present, in all material respects, the financial condition of DDH and its Subsidiaries as of the dates indicated on a Consolidated Basis and the results of their operations and their cash flows for the periods indicated on a Consolidated Basis, subject to changes resulting from audit and normal year-end adjustments.

 

Fiscal Quarter” shall mean a fiscal quarter of any Fiscal Year.

 

Fiscal Year shall mean the fiscal year of DDH and its Subsidiaries, as such end date may be adjusted in accordance with Section 7.13.

 

Flood Hazard Property shall mean any Real Property Collateral located in an area designated by the Federal Emergency Management Agency (and any successor Governmental Body performing a similar function) as having special flood or mud slide hazards.

 

Foreign Subsidiary” shall mean any Subsidiary of DDH that is not organized or incorporated in the United States, any State thereof or the District of Columbia.

 

21

 

 

Funded Debt” shall mean, as to any Person at a particular time, without duplication, all of the following, whether or not included as indebtedness or liabilities in accordance with GAAP:

 

(a)           all obligations for borrowed money, whether current or long-term (including the Obligations hereunder, the ABL Obligations, any Subordinated Debt (other than the Preferred Equity) and all Capitalized Lease Obligations), all obligations evidenced by bonds, debentures, notes, loan agreements or other similar instruments;

 

(b)           all obligations in respect of the deferred purchase price of property or services (other than trade accounts payable in the ordinary course of business and, in each case, not past due for more than sixty (60) days after the date on which such trade account payable is due), including, without limitation, any earn-out obligations recognized as a liability on the balance sheet of such Person and its Subsidiaries in accordance with GAAP;

 

(c)           all non-contingent obligations under letters of credit (including standby and commercial), bankers’ acceptances and similar instruments (including bank guaranties);

 

(d)           the Attributable Principal Amount of Capital Leases, Synthetic Leases, Securitization Transactions and Sale and Leaseback Transactions;

 

(e)           [reserved];

 

(f)           all Funded Debt of others secured by (or for which the holder of such Funded Debt has an existing right, contingent or otherwise, to be secured by) any Lien on, or payable out of the proceeds of production from, property owned or acquired by such Person, whether or not the obligations secured thereby have been assumed;

 

(g)           all Guarantees in respect of Funded Debt of another Person; and

 

(h)           Funded Debt of any partnership or joint venture or other similar entity in which such Person is a general partner or joint venturer, and, as such, has personal liability for such obligations, but only to the extent there is recourse to such Person for payment thereof.

 

For purposes hereof, the amount of Funded Debt shall (I) be determined (x) based on the outstanding principal amount in the case of borrowed money indebtedness under clause (a) and purchase money indebtedness and the deferred purchase obligations under clause (b), (y) without duplication for any letter of credit sublimit within a loan facility commitment amount, based on the maximum amount available to be drawn in the case of letter of credit obligations and the other obligations under clause (c), and (z) based on the amount of Funded Debt that is the subject of the Guarantees and for which there is recourse to such Person in the case of Guarantees under clause (g) and (II) not be reduced by any origination fees related thereto.

 

Funding Account” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 4.15(h)(iii).

 

Funds Flow Statement” shall mean the funds flow statement delivered to Agent as of the Closing Date with respect to the Closing Date Transactions.

 

22

 

 

GAAP” shall mean, subject to the limitations on the application thereof set forth in Section 1.1, generally accepted accounting principles in the United States of America in effect from time to time.

 

General Intangibles” shall mean and include, with respect to any Person, all of such Person’s general intangibles, whether now owned or hereafter acquired, including all payment intangibles, all choses in action, causes of action, corporate or other business records, inventions, designs, patents, patent applications, equipment formulations, manufacturing procedures, quality control procedures, trademarks, trademark applications, service marks, trade secrets, goodwill, copyrights, design rights, software, computer information, source codes, codes, records and updates, registrations, licenses, franchises, customer lists, tax refunds, tax refund claims, computer programs, all claims under guaranties, security interests or other security held by or granted to such Person to secure payment of any of the Receivables (other than to the extent covered by Receivables), all rights of indemnification and all other intangible property of every kind and nature (other than Receivables).

 

Governing Documents” shall mean, for a corporation, its articles of incorporation or certificate of incorporation and its bylaws, for a limited liability company, its articles of organization or certificate of formation and its operating agreement, and for a partnership, its certificate of formation and its partnership agreement.

 

Governmental Authorization shall mean any permit, license, authorization, plan, directive, consent order or consent decree of or from any Governmental Body.

 

Governmental Body” shall mean any nation or government, any state or other political subdivision thereof or any entity, authority, agency, division or department exercising executive, legislative, judicial, taxing, regulatory or administrative powers or functions of or pertaining to a government (including any supra-national bodies such as the European Union or the European Central Bank) and any group or body charged with setting financial accounting or regulatory capital rules or standards (including, without limitation, the Financial Accounting Standards Board, the Bank for International Settlements or the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision or any successor or similar authority to any of the foregoing).

 

Guarantee” shall mean, as to any Person, (a) any obligation, contingent or otherwise, of such Person guaranteeing or having the economic effect of guaranteeing any Indebtedness or other obligation payable or performable by another Person (the “primary obligor”) in any manner (including as a result of joint and several liability with such primary obligor), whether directly or indirectly, and including any obligation of such Person, direct or indirect, (i) to purchase or pay (or advance or supply funds for the purchase or payment of) such Indebtedness or other obligation, (ii) to purchase or lease property, securities or services for the purpose of assuring the obligee in respect of such Indebtedness or other obligation of the payment or performance of such Indebtedness or other obligation, (iii) to maintain working capital, equity capital or any other financial statement condition or liquidity or level of income or cash flow of the primary obligor so as to enable the primary obligor to pay such Indebtedness or other obligation, or (iv) entered into for the purpose of assuring in any other manner the obligee in respect of such Indebtedness or other obligation of the payment or performance thereof or to protect such obligee against loss in respect thereof (in whole or in part), or (b) any Lien on any assets of such Person securing any Indebtedness or other obligation of any other Person, whether or not such Indebtedness or other obligation is assumed by such Person (or any right, contingent or otherwise, of any holder of such Indebtedness to obtain any such Lien). The amount of any Guarantee shall be deemed to be an amount equal to the stated or determinable amount of the related primary obligation, or portion thereof, in respect of which such Guarantee is made or, if not stated or determinable, the maximum reasonably anticipated liability in respect thereof as determined by the guaranteeing Person in good faith. The term “Guarantee” as a verb has a corresponding meaning.

 

23

 

 

Guaranteed Obligations” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 16.1 hereof.

 

Guarantor” shall mean (i) Orange142, LLC, (ii) Huddled Masses LLC, (iii) Colossus Media, LLC, (iv) Universal Standards for Digital Marketing, LLC, (v) subject to Section 6.16 hereof, DDH Holdings, (vi) each Person who subsequent to the Closing Date becomes a party to this Agreement as a Guarantor and (vii) each other Person who may hereafter guarantee payment or performance of the whole or any part of the Obligations and “Guarantors” shall mean collectively all such Persons.

 

Guarantor Security Agreement” shall mean, individually and collectively, any Security Agreement, or joinder thereto, executed by any Guarantor in favor of Agent securing the Guarantee of such Guarantor or otherwise securing the Obligations, in form and substance satisfactory to Agent.

 

Hazardous Discharge” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 4.19(c) hereof.

 

Hazardous Materials” shall mean any hazardous substances defined by CERCLA, including any hazardous waste as defined under 40 C.F.R. Parts 260-270, gasoline or petroleum (including crude oil or any fraction thereof), asbestos or polychlorinated biphenyls.

 

Hazardous Materials Activity” shall mean any past, current, proposed or threatened activity, event or occurrence involving any Hazardous Materials, including the use, manufacture, possession, storage, holding, presence, existence, location, Release, threatened Release, discharge, placement, generation, transportation, processing, construction, treatment, abatement, removal, remediation, disposal, disposition or handling of any Hazardous Materials, and any corrective action or response action with respect to any of the foregoing.

 

Impact Certificate” shall mean a certificate in substantially the form attached hereto as Exhibit D to be signed by an Authorized Officer of Borrowers.

 

Impact Provider” shall mean any third-party provider or other third party vendor providing Impact Services.

 

Impact Services” shall mean programs or services intended to provide to companies and their employees, as applicable, long-term, sustainable impact in financial inclusion and empowerment, housing, jobs, wellness, diversity and inclusion or such other core values acceptable to Agent in its sole discretion.

 

Impact Subscription” shall mean the subscription to, participation in or other purchase or acquisition of one or more (as applicable) Impact Services by Borrowers (or any of them, as applicable) for any period identified and offered by an Impact Provider to Borrowers. “Impact Subscribe” and “Impact Subscribed” shall have the corollary meaning thereto.

 

24

 

 

Inchoate Obligations” shall mean contingent indemnification or expense reimbursement Obligations other than those related to claims, causes of action, or liabilities that have been asserted or threatened in writing or that otherwise can be reasonably identified by Agent or any Lender based on the then-known facts and circumstances.

 

Indebtedness” shall mean, as to any Person, at any time, any and all indebtedness, obligations or liabilities (whether matured or unmatured, liquidated or unliquidated, direct or indirect, absolute or contingent, or joint or several) of such Person for or in respect of all of the following, whether or not included as indebtedness or liabilities in accordance with GAAP (without duplication):

 

(a)           all Funded Debt;

 

(b)           net obligations under any Swap Agreement;

 

(c)           all Guarantees in respect of Indebtedness of another Person; and

 

(d)           all Indebtedness of the types referred to in clauses (a) through (c) above of any partnership or joint venture (other than a joint venture that is itself a corporation or limited liability company) in which any Borrower or a Subsidiary is a general partner or joint venturer, unless such Indebtedness is non-recourse to such Borrower or Subsidiary and excluded as Indebtedness of such Borrower or Subsidiary for purposes of GAAP.

 

For purposes hereof, the amount of Indebtedness shall be determined based on Swap Termination Value in the case of net obligations under any Swap Agreement under clause (b).

 

Indemnified Taxes” shall mean (a) Taxes other than Excluded Taxes, imposed on or with respect to any payment made by or on account of any obligations of any Credit Party under this Agreement or any Other Document, and (b) to the extent not otherwise described in (a), Other Taxes.

 

Intellectual Property” shall mean property constituting under any Applicable Law a patent, patent application, copyright, trademark, service mark, trade name, mask work, trade secret or license or other right to use any of the foregoing.

 

Intercreditor Agreement” shall mean that certain Intercreditor Agreement dated as of the date hereof by and between Agent and ABL Agent, as the same may be amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time.

 

Interest Period” shall mean, with respect to any Term Loan, (a) initially, the period commencing on the date such Term Loan is made and ending on the last day of the fiscal quarter immediately succeeding the date such Term Loan is made, and (b) thereafter, the period commencing on the date immediately after the end of the previous Interest Period and ending on the earlier of (i) the last day of the fiscal quarter then ending and (ii) the day before the last day of the Term, provided, that if any Interest Period would end on a day other than a Business Day, such Interest Period shall be extended to the next succeeding Business Day unless such next succeeding Business Day would fall in the next calendar month, in which case such Interest Period shall end on the immediately preceding Business Day.

 

25

 

 

Intermediate Holdco” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 6.12 hereof.

 

Inventory” shall mean and include, with respect to any Person, all of such Person’s now owned or hereafter acquired inventory, goods, merchandise and other personal property, wherever located, to be furnished under any consignment arrangement, contract of service or held for sale or lease, all raw materials, work in process, finished goods and materials and supplies of any kind, nature or description which are or might be used or consumed in such Person’s business or used in selling or furnishing such goods, merchandise and other personal property, and all documents of title or other documents representing them.

 

Investment” shall mean, as to any Person, any direct or indirect acquisition or investment by such Person, whether by means of (a) the purchase or other acquisition of Equity Interests of another Person, (b) a loan, advance or capital contribution to, Guarantee or assumption of debt of, or purchase or other acquisition of any other debt or equity participation or interest in, another Person, including any partnership or joint venture interest in such other Person and any arrangement pursuant to which the investor Guarantees Indebtedness of such other Person, or (c) an Acquisition. For purposes of covenant compliance, the amount of any Investment shall be the amount actually invested, without adjustment for subsequent increases or decreases in the value of such Investment.

 

Investment Property” shall mean and include, with respect to any Person, all of such Person’s now owned or hereafter acquired securities (whether certificated or uncertificated), securities entitlements, securities accounts, commodities contracts and commodities accounts.

 

Involuntary Disposition” shall mean the receipt by DDH or any of its Subsidiaries of any cash insurance proceeds or condemnation awards payable by reason of theft, loss, physical destruction or damage, taking or similar event with respect to any of its Property in excess of $100,000.

 

Key Executive Policy” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 4.21.

 

Key Performance Indicatorsshall mean the key performance indicators set forth on Exhibit E attached hereto and such other key performance indicators as Borrowers and Agent shall agree from time to time in replacement of (provided that such replacement shall provide a reasonably similar metric) or in addition to any of the foregoing; provided, however, that any foregoing key performance indicators may be removed or modified by Borrowers with the consent of Agent (such approval not to be unreasonably withheld, delayed or conditioned); provided, further, that all foregoing key performance indicators shall be developed and disclosed to Agent within three months of the Closing Date.

 

Lafayette Square” shall have the meaning set forth in the preamble to this Agreement and shall extend to all of its successors and permitted assigns.

 

26

 

 

Leasehold Interests” shall mean each Credit Party’s right, title and interest in and to the leased Real Property.

 

Lender” and “Lenders” shall have the meaning ascribed to such term in the preamble to this Agreement and shall include each Person which becomes a permitted transferee, successor or permitted assign of any Lender.

 

LIBOR Rate” shall mean, for any Interest Period, the greater of (i) the rate per annum determined by Agent by dividing (a) the Published Rate as of 11:00 a.m. (London time) two (2) Business Days prior to the first day of the applicable Interest Period by (b) a number equal to 1.00 minus the percentage prescribed by the Federal Reserve for determining the maximum reserve requirements with respect to any eurocurrency funding by banks on the date of determination and (ii) one percent (1.00%).

 

Lien” shall mean (a) any mortgage, deed of trust, pledge, hypothecation, collateral assignment, security interest, lien (whether statutory or otherwise), charge, claim or encumbrance, or preference, priority or other security agreement or preferential arrangement held or asserted in respect of any asset of any kind or nature whatsoever including any conditional sale or other title retention agreement, any lease having substantially the same economic effect as any of the foregoing, and the filing of, or agreement to give, any financing statement under the Uniform Commercial Code or comparable law of any jurisdiction and (b) in the case of Securities, any purchase option, call or similar right of a third party with respect to such Securities.

 

Lien Waiver Agreement” shall mean an agreement which is executed in favor of Agent, in form and content satisfactory to Agent in its Permitted Discretion, by a Person who owns or occupies premises at which any Collateral may be located from time to time and by which such Person shall waive or subordinate any Lien that such Person may ever have with respect to any of the Collateral and shall authorize Agent from time to time to enter upon the premises to inspect or remove the Collateral from such premises or to use such premises to store or dispose of such Collateral.

 

Liquidity” shall mean, as of any date of determination, the sum of (a) Unrestricted Cash plus (b) Revolving Credit Availability (as defined in the ABL Credit Agreement as in effect on the date hereof).

 

LLC Division” shall mean, in the event a Credit Party is a limited liability company, (a) the division of any such Borrower or Guarantor into two or more newly formed limited liability companies (whether or not such Borrower or Guarantor is a surviving entity following any such division) pursuant to Section 18-217 of the Delaware Limited Liability Company Act or any similar provision under any similar act governing limited liability companies organized under the laws of any other State or Commonwealth or of the District of Columbia, or (b) the adoption of a plan contemplating, or the filing of any certificate with any applicable Governmental Body that results or may result in, any such division.

 

Management Fee Subordination Agreement” shall mean that certain Management Fee Subordination Agreement, dated as of the date hereof, by and among Mark Walker, Keith Smith, the Credit Parties, and Agent, as the same may be amended, restated, amended and restated, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time, which agreement shall terminate upon the occurrence of a Qualified IPO.

 

27

 

 

Management Fees” shall mean management fees or advisory fees required to be paid to the Keith Smith or Mark Walker pursuant to those certain Board Services and Consulting Agreements each dated as of September 30, 2020, by and between DDH, on the one hand, and Keith Smith and Mark Walker on the other hand, together with any other similar fees pursuant to any management agreement or management services agreement entered into now or hereafter by and between Keith Smith or Mark Walker and a Credit Party.

 

Margin Stock” shall have the meaning as defined in Regulation U of the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System as in effect from time to time.

 

Material Adverse Effect” shall mean any effect, event, condition, action, omission, change or state of facts that, individually or in the aggregate, has resulted in, or could reasonably be expected to result in, a material adverse effect with respect to (a) the business operations, properties, assets, or financial condition of DDH and its Subsidiaries; (b) the ability of the Credit Parties to fully and timely perform the Obligations; (c) the legality, validity, binding effect, or enforceability against an Credit Party of this Agreement or any Other Document to which it is a party; (d) the priority of Liens in the whole of the Collateral in favor of Agent; or (e) the material rights, remedies and benefits available to, or conferred upon Agent under this Agreement or any Other Document.

 

Material Contract” shall mean any contract or other arrangement (other than the Other Documents) to which any Credit Party or any Subsidiary of any Credit Party is a party as to which the breach, nonperformance, cancellation or failure to renew by any party thereto could reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.

 

Modified Transfer Supplement” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 15.3(d).

 

Moody’s shall mean Moody’s Investor Services, Inc., together with its successors.

 

Mortgage” shall mean, with respect to any Real Property Collateral, any mortgage, deed of trust or deed to secure debt that purports to grant to Agent a Lien on such Real Property or any interest (including with respect to any improvements and fixtures) of any Credit Party in such Real Property.

 

Multiemployer Plan” shall mean a “multiemployer plan” as defined in Sections 3(37) of ERISA which is sponsored, maintained or contributed to by, or required to be contributed to by, any Credit Party or any of its ERISA Affiliates or with respect to which any Credit Party or any of its ERISA Affiliates previously sponsored, maintained or contributed to or was required to contribute to, and still has liability.

 

Net Cash Proceeds” shall mean the aggregate proceeds paid in cash or Cash Equivalents received by DDH or any of its Subsidiaries in connection with any Asset Sale, Debt Transaction, Involuntary Disposition, Equity Transaction or Extraordinary Receipts, net of (a) direct costs incurred or estimated costs for which reserves are maintained, in connection therewith (including reasonable legal, accounting and investment banking fees and expenses, sales commissions and underwriting discounts); (b) estimated taxes paid or payable (including sales, use or other transactional taxes and any net marginal increase in income taxes) directly, or indirectly, by DDH or any of its Subsidiaries, including any such estimated taxes paid or payable by any holder of the Equity Interest issued by DDH (including, DDH Holdings), in each case as a result thereof; and (c) the amount required to retire any Indebtedness secured by a Permitted Encumbrance (excluding any Permitted Encumbrance that is pari passu or junior to the Agent’s Lien on or security interest in the Collateral) on the related property (in all cases paid to Persons other than Affiliates of a Credit Party). For purposes hereof, “Net Cash Proceeds” includes any cash or Cash Equivalents received upon the disposition of any non-cash consideration received by DDH or any of its Subsidiaries in any Asset Sale, Debt Transaction, Involuntary Disposition, Equity Transaction or Extraordinary Receipts.

 

28

 

 

Notes” shall mean Term Notes.

 

Obligations” shall mean and include, in each case to the extent arising under or in connection with this Agreement and/or the Other Documents: any and all loans, advances, debts, liabilities, obligations, covenants and duties owing by the Credit Parties (or any of them) to Lenders or Agent of any kind or nature, present or future (including any interest or other amounts accruing thereon after maturity, or after the filing of any petition in bankruptcy, or the commencement of any insolvency, reorganization or like proceeding relating to any Credit Party, whether or not a claim for post-filing or post-petition interest or other amounts is allowed in such proceeding), whether or not evidenced by any note, guaranty or other instrument, whether arising under any agreement, instrument or document (including this Agreement and the Other Documents) whether or not for the payment of money, whether arising by reason of an extension of credit, opening of a letter of credit, loan, equipment lease or guarantee, under any interest or currency swap, future, option or other similar agreement, or in any other manner, whether arising out of overdrafts or deposit or other accounts or electronic funds transfers (whether through automated clearing houses or otherwise) or out of Agent’s or any Lenders non-receipt of or inability to collect funds or otherwise not being made whole in connection with depository transfer check or other similar arrangements, whether direct or indirect (including those acquired by assignment or participation), absolute or contingent, joint or several, due or to become due, now existing or hereafter arising, contractual or tortious, liquidated or unliquidated, regardless of how such indebtedness or liabilities arise or by what agreement or instrument they may be evidenced or whether evidenced by any agreement or instrument, including, but not limited to, any and all of any Credit Parties’ Indebtedness and/or liabilities under this Agreement, the Other Documents or under any other agreement between Agent or Lenders and any Credit Party and any amendments, extensions, renewals or increases and all costs and expenses of Agent and any Lender incurred in the documentation, negotiation, modification, enforcement, collection or otherwise in connection with any of the foregoing, including but not limited to reasonable, documented (to the extent readily available) attorneys’ fees, allocated costs of internal counsel and out-of-pocket expenses and all obligations of the Credit Parties (or any of them) to Agent or Lenders to perform acts or refrain from taking any action.

 

OFAC” shall mean the U.S. Department of the Treasury’s Office of Foreign Assets Control.

 

Orange142 Canada” shall mean Orange142 Advertising Canada, Inc., a corporation organized under the laws of British Columbia.

 

29

 

 

Other Connection Taxes” shall mean, with respect to any Payee, Taxes imposed as a result of a present or former connection between such Payee and the jurisdiction imposing such Tax (other than connections arising from such Payee having executed, delivered, become a party to, performed its obligations under, received payments under, received or perfected a security interest under, engaged in any other transaction pursuant to or enforced this Agreement or any Other Document, or sold or assigned an interest in any Obligation or Other Document).

 

Other Documents” shall mean the Notes, the Fee Letter, all related Guarantees, all Security Agreements, all Guarantor Security Agreements, all Pledge Agreements, the Intercreditor Agreement, the Management Fee Subordination Agreement, any subordination agreement relating to Subordinated Debt, if applicable, any Swap Agreement with any Lender or Affiliate thereof, any Lien Waiver Agreements, Mortgages (if any), environmental indemnities with respect to Real Property, and any and all other agreements, instruments and documents, including guaranties, pledges, powers of attorney, consents, interest or currency swap agreements or other similar agreements and all other writings heretofore, now or hereafter executed by any Credit Party and/or delivered to Agent or any Lender in respect of the transactions contemplated by this Agreement; provided that “Other Documents” shall not include any document evidencing any rights of any Lender as a holder of Equity Interests of DDH or DDH Holdings.

 

Other Taxes” shall mean all present or future stamp, court or documentary, intangible, recording, filing, other excise or property Taxes or similar Taxes, charges or similar levies that arise from any payment made under, from the execution, delivery, performance, enforcement or registration of, from the receipt or perfection of a security interest under, or otherwise with respect to, this Agreement or any Other Document, except any such Taxes that are Other Connection Taxes imposed with respect to an assignment (other than an assignment made pursuant to Section 3.11).

 

Participant” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 15.3(b) hereof.

 

Payee” shall mean Agent, any Lender, assignee of any Lender or Participant.

 

Payment Conditions” shall mean that prior to and after giving effect to the relevant dividend, distribution, acquisition, investment or applicable transaction as to which the satisfaction of the Payment Conditions is being determined, each of the following conditions is satisfied: (i) no Default or Event of Default is continuing or would occur after giving Pro Forma effect to such action, (ii) DDH and its Subsidiaries shall, on a Pro Forma Basis, have a Consolidated Senior Net Leverage Ratio of not greater than 1.5 to 1.00, and (iii) DDH and its Subsidiaries shall, on a Pro Forma Basis, have Liquidity of not less than $15,000,000.

 

PBGC” shall mean the Pension Benefit Guaranty Corporation established pursuant to Subtitle A of Title IV of ERISA or any successor thereto.

 

Pension Plan” shall mean any “employee pension benefit plan” as defined in Section 3(2) of ERISA other than a Multiemployer Plan, which is subject to Section 412 of the Code or Section 302 of ERISA and which is sponsored, maintained or contributed to by, or required to be contributed to by, any Credit Party or any of its ERISA Affiliates or with respect to which any Credit Party or any of its ERISA Affiliates previously sponsored, maintained or contributed to, or was required to contribute to, and still has liability.

 

30

 

 

Permitted Acquisition” shall mean any Acquisition by a Credit Party that satisfies the following conditions:

 

(a)            the Property acquired (or the Property of the Person acquired) in such Acquisition is a business or is used or useful in a business permitted under Section 7.9 and constitutes all or substantially all of the assets (or all or substantially all of the assets constituting a business unit, division, product line, or line of business of any Person);

 

(b)            with respect to the acquisition of Equity Interests, the target shall have a positive EBITDA, calculated in accordance with GAAP for the trailing twelve month period immediately prior to such acquisition,

 

(c)            in the case of an Acquisition of Equity Interests, (i) the board of directors (or other comparable governing body) of such other Person shall have approved the Acquisition, (ii) such Person shall be organized and existing under the laws of any state of the United States or the District of Columbia and (iii) all of the Equity Interests of such Person are being acquired;

 

(d)            the total costs and liabilities (including without limitation, all assumed liabilities, all earn-out payments, deferred payments and the value of any other stock or assets transferred, assigned or encumbered with respect to such acquisitions) each such acquisition consummated during the Term do not exceed, as of the date of determination, 40% of the Credit Parties’ Consolidated EBITDA calculated on a Pro Forma Basis;

 

(e)            after giving effect to such Acquisition (including the incurrence of any Indebtedness and Delayed Draw Term Loans incurred in connection therewith), DDH and its Subsidiaries (or DDH Holdings and its Subsidiaries after a Qualified IPO) shall, on a Pro Forma Basis, have a Consolidated Senior Net Leverage Ratio of not greater than 1.5 to 1.00;

 

(f)             (i) no Default or Event of Default shall exist and be continuing immediately before or immediately after giving effect thereto, (ii) the representations and warranties made by each of the Credit Parties in this Agreement and each Other Document shall be true and correct in all material respects as if made on the date of such Acquisition (after giving effect thereto) except to the extent such representations and warranties expressly relate to an earlier date, in which case they shall be true and correct in all material respects as of such earlier date (or, in each case, in all respects with respect to any representation or warranty which, by its terms is expressly qualified by materiality, Material Adverse Effect or dollar amount thresholds), and (iii) the Borrowers shall have given Agent written notice of such Acquisition with reasonable detail thereof, and all business, financial/accounting and legal due diligence and documentation with respect thereto (including any quality of earnings reports obtained by the Credit Parties with respect thereto), in each case, no later than thirty (30) days prior to the consummation thereof (or such shorter notice as may be acceptable to Agent in its sole discretion); and

 

(g)            the Property acquired in such Acquisition shall constitute Collateral, and the Person acquired in such Acquisition shall be a Credit Party.

 

31

 

 

Permitted Discretion” shall mean a determination made in the exercise of reasonable (from the perspective of a secured creditor) business judgment.

 

Permitted Dividends” shall mean (a) dividends and/or distributions required to be paid to the holders of the Preferred Equity (as set forth in the Governing Documents of DDH in effect on the date hereof) so long as (i) the Consolidated Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio, calculated on a Pro Forma Basis, would not be less than 1.5 to 1.00 after giving effect thereto, (ii) no Default or Event of Default is continuing or would occur after giving Pro Forma effect to such dividend, and (iii) expressly permitted under the terms of the Preferred Equity Subordination Agreement and (b) after consummation of a Qualified IPO, dividends and distributions to DDH Holdings and any shareholders of DDH Holdings so long as the Payment Conditions are satisfied.

 

Permitted Encumbrances” shall mean each of the Liens permitted pursuant to Section 7.2.

 

Permitted Holders” shall mean Keith Smith, Mark Walker, Leah Woolford and/or their respective Related Persons.

 

Permitted Lines of Business” shall mean any business engaged in by any Credit Party or its Subsidiaries as of the Closing Date and businesses that are substantially similar, related or incidental thereto, and, the offering of products and services that are complementary or ancillary thereto, as may be adjusted from time to time.

 

Permitted Management Fee Payments” shall mean at any time prior to the consummation of a Qualified IPO, the payment of regularly scheduled Management Fees in accordance with the Board Services and Consulting Agreements each dated as of September 30, 2020 (as in effect on the date hereof) so long as at the time of and after giving pro forma effect thereto (calculated with respect to the financial covenants set forth in Section 6.5 as of the last day of the fiscal quarter for which Borrowers were required to deliver financial statements pursuant to Section 9.8 hereof as if such payment was made on the last day of such fiscal quarter and without giving effect to the addback set forth in clause (v) of the definition Consolidated EBITDA) no Default or Event of Default has occurred or would occur.

 

“Person” shall mean any individual, sole proprietorship, partnership, corporation, business trust, joint stock company, trust, unincorporated organization, association, limited liability company, limited liability partnership, institution, public benefit corporation, joint venture, entity or Governmental Body (whether federal, state, county, city, municipal or otherwise, including any instrumentality, division, agency, body or department thereof).

 

Personal Information” shall mean, in addition to any definition for any similar term (e.g., “personal data,” “personally identifiable information,” or “PII”) provided by applicable law or by a Credit Party or Subsidiary in any of its privacy policies, notices or contracts, all information that identifies, relates to, describes, is reasonably capable of being associated with, or could reasonably be linked, directly or indirectly, with a particular individual or household, including (a) name, physical address, telephone number, email address, financial information, financial account number or government-issued identifier (including Social Security number and driver’s license number), medical, health or insurance information, gender, date of birth, educational or employment information, religious or political views or affiliations, marital or other status, and any other data used or intended to be used to identify, contact or precisely locate an individual (e.g., geolocation data), (b) any data regarding an individual’s activities online or on a mobile device or application, and (c) Internet Protocol addresses and unique device identifiers. Personal Information may relate to any individual, including a current, prospective or former customer, end user or employee of any Person and includes information in any form or media, whether paper, electronic, or otherwise.

 

32

 

 

Pledge Agreements” shall mean that certain Pledge Agreement, dated as of the Closing Date, by DDH pursuant to which DDH pledges all of the Equity Interests owned by DDH in its Subsidiaries and any other pledge agreement executed and delivered by any other Person subsequent to the Closing Date to secure the Obligations.

 

Preferred A Redemption” shall mean the redemption of the preferred A units held in DDH pursuant to the Redemption Agreement.

 

Preferred B Redemption” shall mean the contemplated redemption of the preferred B units held in DDH pursuant to the Redemption Agreement.

 

Preferred Equity” shall mean the preferred B units issued to USDM Holdings, Inc., a Texas corporation and other “Preferred Unit Holders” pursuant to the Amended and Restated Limited Liability Company Agreement of DDH dated September 30, 2020.

 

Preferred Equity Subordination Agreement” shall mean that certain Preferred Equity Subordination Agreement of even date herewith, by and among DDH, the holder(s) of the Preferred Equity and Agent, as amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time, which agreement shall terminate upon the occurrence of a Qualified IPO and shall expressly permit the transactions contemplated by a Qualified IPO.

 

Privacy and Security Laws” shall mean any and all applicable laws, legal requirements, executive orders, regulations and self-regulatory guidelines (including of any applicable foreign jurisdiction) relating to the receipt, collection, compilation, use, storage, processing, sharing, safeguarding, security (technical, physical and administrative), disposal, destruction, disclosure or transfer (including cross-border) of any Personal Information, including the Federal Trade Commission Act, the California Consumer Privacy Act (CCPA), the California Privacy Rights Act (CPRA), Virginia’s Consumer Data Protection Act (CDPA), the Colorado Privacy Act (CPA), Massachusetts General Law Chapter 93H and its implementing regulations 201 CMR 17.00, New York’s Stop Hacks and Improve Electronic Data Security Act (SHIELD Act), the Payment Card Industry Data Security Standard (PCI-DSS), the CAN-SPAM Act, the Telephone Consumer Protection Act (TCPA), the EU General Data Protection Regulation, Regulation 2016/679/EU (GDPR), and any and all applicable federal, state or global laws relating to the privacy and security of Personal Information, and any laws relating to the use of biometric identifiers.

 

Privacy Laws” shall have the meaning ascribed to such term in the definition of HIPAA.

 

Pro Forma Balance Sheet” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 5.9(c) hereof.

 

33

 

 

Pro Forma Basis” shall mean, for purposes of calculating any financial covenants set forth in Section 6.5 or set forth in any other provision hereof (including for purposes of calculating compliance with clause (d) of the definition of Permitted Acquisition), that any Asset Sale, Involuntary Disposition, Acquisition, incurrence of Indebtedness (including the incurrence of any Delayed Draw Term Loan) or Restricted Payment shall be deemed to have occurred as of the first day of the most recent four (4) Fiscal Quarter period ended prior to the date of such transaction for which Borrowers were required to deliver financial statements pursuant to Sections 9.7 or 9.8. In connection with the foregoing, (a) (i) with respect to any Asset Sale or Involuntary Disposition, income statement and cash flow statement items (whether positive or negative) attributable to the property disposed of shall be excluded to the extent relating to any period occurring prior to the date of such transaction and (ii) with respect to any Acquisition, income statement items attributable to the Person or property that is the subject of such transaction shall be included to the extent relating to any period applicable in such calculations to the extent (A) such items are not otherwise included in such income statement items for DDH (or DDH Holdings, if applicable) and its Subsidiaries in accordance with GAAP or in accordance with any defined terms set forth in Section 1.2 and (B) such items are supported by financial statements or other information reasonably satisfactory to Agent, (b) any Indebtedness (including any Delayed Draw Term Loan) incurred or assumed by any Credit Party or any Subsidiary of a Credit Party (including the Person or property acquired) in connection with such transaction (i) shall be deemed to have been incurred as of the first day of the applicable period and (ii) if such Indebtedness has a floating or formula rate, shall have an implied rate of interest for the applicable period for purposes of this definition determined by utilizing the rate which is or would be in effect with respect to such Indebtedness as of the relevant date of determination, and (c) any Restricted Payment shall be deemed to have been paid as of the first day of the applicable period.

 

Pro Forma Financial Statements” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 5.9(d) hereof.

 

Projections” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 5.9(d) hereof.

 

Property” shall mean an interest of any kind in any property or asset, whether real, personal or mixed, and whether tangible or intangible.

 

Public Company Costs” shall mean actual documented costs relating to compliance with the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, as amended, and other actual documented expenses arising out of or incidental to DDH Holdings’ status as a reporting company, including actual documented costs, fees and expenses (including reasonable legal, accounting and other professional fees) relating to compliance with provisions of the Securities Act and the Exchange Act, registration and reporting obligations, the rules of securities exchange companies with listed equity securities, directors’ compensation, fees and expense reimbursement, shareholder meetings and reports to shareholders, indemnification and reimbursement of directors, officers and employees in respect of liabilities relating to their serving in any such capacity, directors’ and officers’ insurance and other executive costs, legal and other professional fees, and listing fees.

 

Published Rate” shall mean the rate of interest published each Business Day in The Wall Street Journal “Money Rates” listing under the caption “London Interbank Offered Rates” for a three month period (or, if no such rate is published therein for any reason, then the Published Rate shall be the Eurodollar rate for a three month period as published in another publication determined by Agent).

 

34

 

 

Purchasing CLO” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 15.3(d) hereof.

 

Purchasing Lender” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 15.3(c) hereof.

 

Qualified IPO” shall mean the issuance of Equity Interests by DDH or DDH Holdings in an underwritten primary public offering (other than a public offering pursuant to a registration statement on Form S-8) on or prior to June 30, 2022 pursuant to an effective registration statement filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission in accordance with the Securities Act (whether alone or in connection with a secondary public offering) that generates gross cash proceeds of not less than $34,500,000 (after giving effect to the greenshoe), and (y) Net Cash Proceeds actually received by Borrowers of not less than $15,000,000 and pursuant to which the Reorganization Transactions shall occur.

 

Quality of Earnings Report” shall mean that certain Quality of Earnings Report prepared by DoerenMayhew dated November 15, 2021 (with quality of earnings diligence analysis through August 31, 2021).

 

Real Property” shall mean all of each Credit Party’s right, title and interest in and to owned and leased premises now owned or hereafter acquired by any Credit Party.

 

Real Property Collateral” shall mean all Real Property (including any Leasehold Interests) subject to the Liens of Agent.

 

Receivables” shall mean and include, as to any Person, all of such Person’s accounts, contract rights, instruments (including those evidencing indebtedness owed to such Person by its Affiliates), documents, chattel paper (including electronic chattel paper), general intangibles relating to accounts, drafts and acceptances, credit card receivables and all other forms of obligations owing to such Person arising out of or in connection with the sale or lease of Inventory or the rendition of services, all supporting obligations, guarantees and other security therefor, whether secured or unsecured, now existing or hereafter created, and whether or not specifically sold or assigned to Agent hereunder.

 

Redemption Agreement” shall mean that certain redemption agreement dated as of November 14, 2021, by and between DDH and USDM Holdings, Inc.

 

Redemption/Exchange Transactions” shall mean at any time following the consummation of a Qualified IPO, the transactions pursuant to which DDH redeems Class A Common Units for either (A)(1) a stock exchange payment or (2) a cash exchange payment, in each case in accordance with the Company Agreement or (B) the direct purchase by DDH Holdings of vested Class A Common Units and paired voting stock pursuant any call right, in accordance with the Company Agreement.

 

Register” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 15.3(e) hereof.

 

Related Fund” shall mean, with respect to any Person that is an investment fund, any other investment fund that is managed or advised by the same investment advisor as such Person or by an Affiliate of such investment advisor.

 

35

 

 

Related Parties” shall mean, with respect to a particular Person: (a) each other member of such Person’s Family; (b) any Person that is directly or indirectly Controlled by such Person and/or any one or more members of such Person’s Family; (c) any Person with respect to which such Person and/or one or more members of such Person’s Family constitute all of the executors or trustees thereof (or in a similar capacity); and (d) any estate planning trust or limited partnership formed or organized for the benefit of such Person or such Person’s Family so long as during his/her lifetime, such Person remains in Control of the voting rights with respect to any actions to be taken by such trust or limited partnership.

 

Release” shall mean any release, spill, emission, leaking, pumping, pouring, injection, escaping, deposit, disposal, discharge, dispersal, dumping, leaching or migration of any Hazardous Material into the indoor or outdoor environment (including the abandonment or disposal of any barrels, containers or other closed receptacles containing any Hazardous Material), including the movement of any Hazardous Material through the air, soil, surface water or groundwater.

 

Reorganization Transactions” shall mean the transactions contemplated pursuant to which DDH will effect an initial public offering, including, (i) the preferred equity units held in DDH will be redeemed, including pursuant to the Preferred A Redemption and the Preferred B Redemption, (ii) the Common Units Redemption shall be consummated with proceeds from a Qualified IPO, (iii) the Equity Interests held in DDH will be reclassified into two classes of units, (iv) the holders of Class A common units will contribute all of their Class A common units to DDH Holdings in exchange for Class A common stock, (v) immediately after which the holders of Class B voting units will contribute all of their Class B voting units to DDH Holdings in exchange for Class B common stock, (vi) immediately following such exchanges, DDH Holdings will be designated as the managing member of DDH, and (vii) DDH Holdings shall use the net proceeds received from an initial public offering to purchase Class A common units from DDH.

 

Replacement ABL Credit Agreement” shall mean any loan or credit agreement entered into subsequent to the date hereof which (a) makes available to Borrower a revolving credit facility in an amount equal to $5,000,000 (or such other amount reasonably acceptable to Agent and the Required Lenders), (b) has terms which are not in any material respect less favorable to the Borrower than the terms in effect under the ABL Credit Agreement in effect on the Closing Date, (c) is subject to an intercreditor agreement granting Agent the same priority collateral and substantially the same rights with respect to the Collateral as those set forth in the Intercreditor Agreement, and (d) is otherwise satisfactory to Agent and the Required Lenders in its reasonable discretion exercised in good faith.

 

Required Lenders” shall mean Lenders holding more than fifty percent (50%) of the sum of (a) the aggregate unused Term Loan Commitment Percentages and Delayed Draw Term Loan Commitment Percentages, and (b) the aggregate outstanding principal amount of the Closing Date Term Loan and Delayed Draw Term Loans; provided, however, that (x) so long as Agent is also a Lender hereunder, Required Lenders shall include Agent, and (y) any portion of unused Term Loan Commitment Percentages and Delayed Draw Term Loan Commitment Percentages (or portion of outstanding Closing Date Term Loans or Delayed Draw Term Loans) held, or deemed held by, a Defaulting Lender shall be excluded for purposes of making a determination of Required Lenders.

 

36

 

 

Restricted Payment” shall mean any dividend or other distribution (whether in cash, securities or other property) with respect to any Equity Interests of DDH Holdings, DDH or any Subsidiary thereof, or any payment (whether in cash, securities or other property and including, any cash payments to any holders of DDH’s Preferred Equity), including any sinking fund or similar deposit, on account of the purchase, redemption, retirement, acquisition, cancellation or termination of any such Equity Interests or on account of any return of capital to any such Person’s stockholders, partners or members (or the equivalent Person thereof), or any setting apart of funds or property for any of the foregoing.

 

S&P shall mean Standard & Poor’s Financial Services LLC, a subsidiary of The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc., together with its successors.

 

Sale and Leaseback Transaction” shall mean, with respect to DDH or any Subsidiary of DDH, any arrangement, directly or indirectly, with any Person (other than a Credit Party) whereby DDH or such Subsidiary shall sell or transfer to a third party any property, real or personal, used or useful in its business, whether now owned or hereafter acquired, and thereafter rent or lease such property or other property that it intends to use for substantially the same purpose or purposes as the property being sold or transferred.

 

Sanctioned Country” shall mean (a) a country, region, territory or a government of a country or territory, (b) an agency of the government of a country, region or territory, or (c) an organization directly or indirectly owned or controlled by a country, region, territory or its government, that is subject to Sanctions.

 

Sanctioned Person” shall mean (a) a Person named on the list of “Specially Designated Nationals” or any other Sanctions related list of designated Persons maintained by OFAC, the U.S. Department of State, the United Nations Security Council, the European Union or any European Union member state, (b) any Person operating, organized or resident in a Sanctioned Country or (c) any Person owned or controlled by any such Person or Persons described in the foregoing clauses (a) or (b).

 

Sanctions” shall mean economic or financial sanctions or trade embargoes imposed, administered or enforced from time to time by (a) the U.S. government, including those administered by OFAC or the U.S. Department of State, (b) the United Nations Security Council, (c) the European Union, (d) any European Union member state, (e) Her Majesty’s Treasury of the United Kingdom or (f) any other relevant sanctions authority.

 

SBA Forms” shall mean, collectively, (i) Portfolio Financing Report (SBA Form 1031), (ii) Size Status Declaration (SBA Form 480), (iii) Assurance of Compliance for Nondiscrimination (SBA Form 652), and (iv) the SBIC Regulatory Side Letter.

 

SBICshall mean a small business investment company licensed under the SBIC Act.

 

SBIC Act” shall mean the Small Business Investment Act of 1958, as amended.

 

SBIC Lender” shall mean a Lender that is an SBIC and is subject to the SBIC Act and the regulations promulgated thereunder by the SBA relating to the small business investment company program.

 

SBIC Regulatory Side Letter” shall mean a letter agreement, dated on or after the Closing Date, made by certain of the Credit Parties in favor of the SBIC Lender.

 

37

 

 

SEC” shall mean the Securities and Exchange Commission or any successor thereto.

 

Securities shall mean any stock, shares, partnership interests, limited liability company interests, voting trust certificates, certificates of interest or participation in any profit-sharing agreement or arrangement (e.g., stock appreciation rights), options, warrants, bonds, debentures, notes, or other evidences of indebtedness, secured or unsecured, convertible, subordinated or otherwise, or in general any instruments commonly known as “securities” or any certificates of interest, shares or participations in temporary or interim certificates for the purchase or acquisition of, or any right to subscribe to, purchase or acquire, any of the foregoing.

 

Securities Act” shall mean the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.

 

Securitization Transaction” shall mean any financing or factoring or similar transaction (or series of such transactions) entered by DDH or any of its Subsidiaries pursuant to which DDH or such Subsidiary may sell, convey or otherwise transfer, or grant a security interest in, accounts, payments, receivables, rights to future lease payments or residuals or similar rights to payment (the “Securitization Receivables”) to a special purpose subsidiary or affiliate (a “Securitization Subsidiary”) or any other Person.

 

Security Agreement” shall mean any security agreement or pledge agreement executed and delivered in favor of Agent pursuant to this Agreement or any Other Document, including, without limitation, the Pledge Agreements and any other security agreement or pledge agreement delivered in connection with the Other Documents, including any intellectual property assignments or security agreements required to be delivered by this Agreement or any Other Document, in each case, as amended, amended and restated, modified and supplemented from time to time.

 

Security Incident” shall mean any unauthorized access, acquisition, use, disclosure, modification, deletion or destruction of Personal Information or interference with the operation of computer systems, including software, hardware, servers, networks and interfaces used by any Credit Party or Subsidiary, both for internal purposes and for the customers of any Credit Party or Subsidiary.

 

Senior Officer” shall mean, with respect to any Person, any individual holding the position of chairman of the board (if an officer), chief executive officer, president, vice president, chief financial officer or treasurer of such Person.

 

Solvent” or “Solvency” shall mean, with respect to any Person as of a particular date, that on such date (a) such Person is able to pay its debts and other liabilities, contingent obligations and other commitments as they mature in the ordinary course of business, (b) such Person does not intend to, and does not believe that it will, incur debts or liabilities beyond such Person’s ability to pay as such debts and liabilities mature in their ordinary course, (c) such Person is not engaged in a business or a transaction, and is not about to engage in a business or a transaction, for which such Person’s property would constitute unreasonably small capital after giving due consideration to the prevailing practice in the industry in which such Person is engaged or is to engage, (d) the fair value of the property of such Person is greater than the total amount of liabilities, including, without limitation, contingent liabilities, of such Person and (e) the present fair salable value of the assets of such Person is not less than the amount that will be required to pay the probable liability of such Person on its debts as they become absolute and matured. In computing the amount of contingent liabilities at any time, it is intended that such liabilities will be computed at the amount which, in light of all the facts and circumstances existing at such time, represents the amount that can reasonably be expected to become an actual or matured liability.

 

38

 

 

Subordinated Debt” shall mean any Indebtedness of any Credit Party to any Person (including any shareholder, officer, director, employee, consultant, or Affiliate of any Borrower) which Indebtedness shall be subordinated to any Term Loan on terms and conditions satisfactory to Agent in its Permitted Discretion, including but not limited to the Preferred Equity.

 

Subordination Agreement” shall mean, collectively, those certain subordination agreements with respect to Subordinated Debt, including but not limited to the Preferred Equity Subordination Agreement, which shall be executed and delivered in connection therewith and as a condition thereto, each of which must be acceptable to Agent in its sole and absolute discretion.

 

Subsidiary” shall mean, with respect to any Person, any corporation, partnership, limited liability company, association, joint venture or other business entity of which more than fifty percent (50%) of the Voting Stock is at the time owned or controlled, directly or indirectly, by that Person, or the accounts of which would be consolidated with those of such Person in its consolidated financial statements in accordance with GAAP, if such statements were prepared as of such date, or one or more of the other Subsidiaries of that Person or a combination thereof; provided, in determining the percentage of ownership interests of any Person controlled by another Person, no ownership interest in the nature of a “qualifying share” of the former Person shall be deemed to be outstanding. Unless otherwise provided, “Subsidiary” shall refer to a Subsidiary of a Credit Party; provided, that so long as Orange142 Canada does not conduct any business operations, have any material assets (other than holding a bank account with a de minimis account balance), incur any material liabilities or engage in any transactions with the Credit Parties, such entity shall not constitute a Subsidiary.

 

Subsidiary Stock” shall mean all of the issued and outstanding Equity Interests of any Subsidiary owned by a Credit Party.

 

Swap Agreement” shall mean (a) any and all rate swap transactions, basis swaps, credit derivative transactions, forward rate transactions, commodity swaps, commodity options, forward commodity contracts, equity or equity index swaps or options, bond or bond price or bond index swaps or options or forward bond or forward bond price or forward bond index transactions, interest rate options, forward foreign exchange transactions, currency swap transactions, cross-currency rate swap transactions, currency options, cap transactions, floor transactions, collar transactions, spot contracts, or any other similar transactions or any combination of any of the foregoing (including any options or warrants to enter into any of the foregoing), whether or not any such transaction is governed by, or otherwise subject to, any master agreement or any netting agreement, and (b) any and all transactions or arrangements of any kind, and the related confirmations, which are subject to the terms and conditions of, or governed by, any form of master agreement (or similar documentation) published from time to time by the International Swaps and Derivatives Association, Inc., any International Foreign Exchange Master Agreement, or any other master agreement (any such agreement or documentation, together with any related schedules, a “Master Agreement”), including any such obligations or liabilities under any Master Agreement.

 

39

 

 

Swap Termination Value” shall mean, in respect of any one or more Swap Agreements, after taking into account the effect of any legally enforceable netting agreement relating to such Swap Agreements, (a) for any date on or after the date such Swap Agreements have been closed out and termination value(s) determined in accordance therewith, such termination value(s) and (b) for any date prior to the date referenced in clause (a), the amount(s) determined as the mark-to-market value(s) for such Swap Agreements, as determined based upon one or more mid-market or other readily available quotations provided by any recognized dealer in such Swap Agreements (which may include Agent, any Lender or any Affiliate of Agent or any Lender).

 

Synthetic Lease” shall mean a lease transaction under which the parties intend that (a) the lease will be treated as an “operating lease” by the lessee pursuant to Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 13, as amended and (b) the lessee will be entitled to various tax and other benefits ordinarily available to owners (as opposed to lessees) of like property.

 

Tax” or “Taxes” (and, with correlative meaning, “Taxable” or “Taxing”) shall mean all present or future taxes, levies, imposts, duties, deductions, withholdings (including backup withholdings), assessments, fees or other charges imposed by any Governmental Body, including any interest, additions to tax or penalties applicable thereto.

 

Tax Distribution” shall mean the Taxes assumed to be payable by a direct or indirect shareholder or member of any Credit Party as a result of the allocation of income of such Credit Party to such shareholder or member due to such Credit Party’s status for federal, state or local Tax purposes as a partnership, subchapter S corporation or any other entity that is a pass-through entity or disregarded entity for federal, state and local Tax purposes (as applicable) but only for so long as such Credit Party continues to be so treated as a pass-through entity or disregarded entity for federal, state and local tax purposes, as evidenced and substantiated by the tax returns filed by such Credit Party (as applicable), with such Taxes assumed to be payable by such shareholder or member of any Credit Party being calculated for all members or shareholders, as applicable, at the highest combined marginal federal, state and local Tax rate applicable to any Credit Party that is allocated to such member or shareholder of the Credit Party, taking into consideration (A) the character and nature of such income or gain (i.e., whether such income is subject to Tax at capital gains rates, ordinary income rates or any special rates), (B) losses previously allocated to each such member or shareholder, as applicable, by such Credit Party to the extent such losses have not previously been applied to reduce the Tax Distribution hereunder, provided that capital losses and capital loss carry forwards shall be taken into account only to the extent they are currently usable to offset income or gain allocated by such Credit Party to a member or shareholder, as applicable; and provided, further, that to the extent that any losses allocated by such Credit Party result in a payback by a member to such Credit Party of previous Tax Distributions pursuant to Section 7.7 hereof, then such losses shall not be taken into account for purposes of determining the Tax Distribution hereunder, and (C) the deduction under Section 199A of the Internal Revenue Code in respect of the taxable income of the Credit Parties, to the extent such deduction may be currently utilized by such shareholder or member.

 

40

 

 

Tax Receivable Agreement” shall mean that certain tax receivable agreement to be entered into by and among DDH Holdings, DDH, and Direct Digital Management, LLC.

 

Term” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 13.1 hereof.

 

Term Loan Commitment Percentage” of any Lender shall mean the percentage set forth on Schedule 1.2(b) as its “Term Loan Commitment Percentage,” as the same may be adjusted upon any assignment by a Lender pursuant to Section 15.3(c) or 15.3(d).

 

Term Loan Rate” shall mean an interest rate per annum equal to the LIBOR Rate plus the Applicable Margin less any Applicable Impact Discount.

 

Term Loans” shall mean, collectively, the Closing Date Term Loan and the Delayed Draw Term Loan.

 

Term Notes” shall mean, collectively, the Closing Date Term Note and the Delayed Draw Term Loan Notes.

 

Title Policy” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 6.8(b)(iii) hereof.

 

Trading with the Enemy Act” shall mean the foreign assets control regulations of the United States Treasury Department (31 CFR, Subtitle B, Chapter V, as amended) and any enabling legislation or executive order relating thereto.

 

Transfer Supplement” shall mean a document in the form of Exhibit B hereto, properly completed and otherwise in form and substance satisfactory to Agent by which the Purchasing Lender purchases and assumes a portion of (i) the obligation of Lenders to make Advances under this Agreement or (ii) the right and option of Lenders to make Delayed Draw Term Loans under this Agreement.

 

Transferee” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 15.3(d) hereof.

 

Unfinanced Capital Expenditures” shall mean, for any specified Persons, all Consolidated Capital Expenditures of such Persons other than those made utilizing financing provided by the applicable seller or third party lenders (including (x) by any Lender to the extent that the Indebtedness arising with respect to such financing does not constitute Advances or Obligations, and (y) expenditures made with advance under the ABL Credit Agreement).

 

Uniform Commercial Code” or “UCC” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 1.3 hereof.

 

United States” and “U.S.” shall mean the United States of America.

 

Unrestricted Cash” shall mean that portion of the Credit Parties’ cash that is (a) free and clear of all Liens, other than Liens in favor of Agent and ABL Lender pursuant to the ABL Credit Agreement, (b) maintained by the Credit Parties in one or more deposit accounts that are located in the United States and are subject to Control Agreements and (c) not listed as “restricted” on the Credit Parties’ balance sheet.

 

41

 

 

 

USA PATRIOT Act” shall mean the Uniting and Strengthening America by Providing Appropriate Tools Required to Intercept and Obstruct Terrorism Act of 2001, Public Law 107-56, as the same has been, or shall hereafter be, renewed, extended, amended or replaced.

 

Voting Stock” shall mean, with respect to any Person, Equity Interests issued by such Person the holders of which are ordinarily, in the absence of contingencies, entitled to vote for the election of directors (or persons performing similar functions) of such Person, even though the right so to vote has been suspended by the happening of such a contingency.

 

1.3            Uniform Commercial Code Terms. All terms used herein and defined in the Uniform Commercial Code as adopted in the State of New York from time to time (the “Uniform Commercial Code”) shall have the meaning given therein unless otherwise defined herein. Without limiting the foregoing, the terms “accessions”, “accounts”, “certificates of title”, “chattel paper”, “commercial tort claims”, “commodities accounts”, “commodities contracts”, “documents”, “deposit accounts”, “electronic chattel paper”, “equipment”, “fixtures”, “general intangibles”, “goods”, “instruments”, “inventory”, “investment property”, “letter-of-credit rights”, “payment intangibles”, “proceeds”, “securities”, “securities accounts”, “securities entitlements”, “supporting obligations” and “software”, as and when used in the description of Collateral (and related underlying definitions) have the meanings given to such terms in Articles 8 or 9 of the Uniform Commercial Code. To the extent the definition of any category or type of collateral is expanded by any amendment, modification or revision to the Uniform Commercial Code, such expanded definition will apply automatically as of the date of such amendment, modification or revision.

 

1.4            Certain Matters of Construction.

 

(a)            The terms “herein”, “hereof” and “hereunder” and other words of similar import refer to this Agreement as a whole and not to any particular section, paragraph or subdivision. All references herein to Articles, Sections, Exhibits and Schedules shall be construed to refer to Articles and Sections of, and Exhibits and Schedules to, this Agreement. Any pronoun used shall be deemed to cover all genders. Wherever appropriate in the context, terms used herein in the singular also include the plural and vice versa. All references to statutes and related regulations shall include any amendments of same and any successor statutes and regulations. Unless otherwise provided, all references to any instruments or agreements to which Agent is a party, including references to any of the Other Documents, shall include any and all modifications or amendments thereto and any and all extensions, renewals or restatements thereof. All references herein to the time of day shall mean the time in New York, New York. Unless otherwise provided, all financial calculations shall be determined on a first-in-first-out basis. Whenever the words “including” or “include” shall be used, such words shall be understood to mean “including, without limitation” or “include, without limitation”. A Default or Event of Default shall be deemed to exist at all times during the period commencing on the date that such Default or Event of Default occurs to the date on which such Default or Event of Default is waived in writing pursuant to this Agreement or, in the case of a Default, is remedied within any grace period expressly provided for in this Agreement; and an Event of Default shall “continue” or be “continuing” until such Event of Default has been waived in writing by the Required Lenders. Any Lien referred to in this Agreement or any of the Other Documents as having been created in favor of Agent, any agreement entered into by Agent pursuant to this Agreement or any of the Other Documents, any payment made by or to or funds received by Agent pursuant to or as contemplated by this Agreement or any of the Other Documents, or any act taken or omitted to be taken by Agent, shall, unless otherwise expressly provided, be created, entered into, made or received, or taken or omitted, for the benefit or account of Agent and Lenders. Wherever the phrase “to the best of each Credit Party’s knowledge” or words of similar import relating to the knowledge or the awareness of a Credit Party are used in this Agreement or Other Documents, such phrase shall mean and refer to (i) the actual knowledge of a Senior Officer of a Credit Party or (ii) the knowledge that a Senior Officer would have obtained if he or she had engaged in good faith and diligent performance of his or her duties, including the making of such reasonably specific inquiries as may be necessary of the employees or agents of a Credit Party and a good faith attempt to ascertain the existence or accuracy of the matter to which such phrase relates. All covenants hereunder shall be given independent effect so that if a particular action or condition is not permitted by any of such covenants, the fact that it would be permitted by an exception to, or otherwise within the limitations of, another covenant shall not avoid the occurrence of a default if such action is taken or condition exists. In addition, all representations and warranties hereunder shall be given independent effect so that if a particular representation or warranty proves to be incorrect or is breached, the fact that another representation or warranty concerning the same or similar subject matter is correct or is not breached will not affect the incorrectness of a breach of a representation or warranty hereunder.

 

42 

 

 

II. ADVANCES, PAYMENTS.

 

2.1            Term Loans.

 

(a)            Closing Date Term Loan.

 

(i)            Subject to the terms and conditions of this Agreement, each Lender, severally and not jointly, will make a term loan to Borrowers in the amount equal to such Lender’s Term Loan Commitment Percentage of the Closing Date Term Loan Amount (collectively, the “Closing Date Term Loan”). Subject to acceleration upon the occurrence and during the continuance of an Event of Default under this Agreement or termination of this Agreement, and subject to the application of any prepayments in accordance with the terms hereof, the Closing Date Term Loan shall be, with respect to principal, due and payable in quarterly installments on the last Business Day of each fiscal quarter: (x) commencing January 1, 2022 (with the first payment due March 31, 2022) through and including December 31, 2023, in an amount equal to $137,500.00 each, and (y) at all times thereafter, in an amount equal to $275,000.00 each, with a final installment due at the end of the Term in an amount equal to the entire unpaid principal balance thereof. The Closing Date Term Loan shall be evidenced by one or more secured promissory notes (collectively, the “Closing Date Term Note”) in substantially the form attached hereto as Exhibit F-1.

 

(ii)            Borrowing Agent may, from time to time, prepay the principal amount owing under the Closing Date Term Loan, so long as: (A) Borrowing Agent shall have provided at least three (3) Business Days prior written notice not later than 1:00 p.m. (New York City time) to Agent of such prepayment, specifying the amount of such prepayment (which notice, once given, shall be irrevocable); (B) each such prepayment is in a minimum amount of $500,000, or an increment of $250,000 in excess thereof and (C) such prepayment shall be accompanied by the payment of any prepayment fee set forth in the Fee Letter. Such prepayments shall be applied to the principal installments due on the Closing Date Term Loan on a pro rata basis; provided that any such prepayments shall be applied on a pro rata basis to the Closing Date Term Loan and the then outstanding portion of the Delayed Draw Term Loans.

 

(b)            Delayed Draw Term Loans.

 

(i)            During the period commencing on the Closing Date and ending on the third anniversary of the Closing Date (such period the “Delayed Draw Term Loan Availability Period”), Borrowing Agent may, from time to time, request additional term loans under this Agreement (each an “Delayed Draw Term Loan”), provided that the aggregate maximum amount of all Delayed Draw Term Loans made under this Agreement shall not exceed the Delayed Draw Term Loan Maximum Amount.

 

(ii)            Requests for Delayed Draw Term Loans shall be made in writing, duly executed by Borrowing Agent to Agent (each such request an “Delayed Draw Term Loan Request”), no less than ten (10) Business Days prior to the date such Delayed Draw Term Loan is requested to be funded, specifying (x) the amount of such Delayed Draw Term Loan requested, (y) the date on which such Delayed Draw Term Loan is requested to be funded and (z) the proposed use of proceeds of such Delayed Draw Term Loan, which must be a Permitted Acquisition, including a reasonably detailed description of such Permitted Acquisitions and such documents and information regarding such Permitted Acquisition as Lenders may request.

 

(iii)            Subject to the terms and conditions of this Agreement, including satisfaction of the conditions set forth in Section 8.2 hereof, each Lender severally and not jointly, shall make a Delayed Draw Term Loan to Borrowers in the sum equal to such Lender’s Delayed Draw Term Loan Commitment Percentage of the Delayed Draw Term Loan Amount, each such Delayed Draw Term Loan to be in an aggregate amount not less than $250,000 (or, if less, the remaining available on the unfunded Delayed Draw Term Loan Maximum Amount) on the applicable Delayed Draw Term Loan Funding Date. Without limiting the discretion of each Lender under this Section 2.1(b)(iii), each Delayed Draw Term Loan shall be advanced on the applicable Delayed Draw Term Loan Funding Date.

 

43 

 

 

(iv)            Subject to acceleration upon the occurrence and during the continuance of an Event of Default under this Agreement or termination of this Agreement, and subject to the application of any prepayments in accordance with the terms hereof, each Delayed Draw Term Loan shall be, with respect to principal, payable in quarterly installments in an amount equal to (x) commencing January 1, 2022 through and including December 31, 2023, six hundred twenty-five thousandths of one percent (0.625%), and (y) at all times thereafter, one and one quarter of one percent (1.25%) of the amounts of the applicable Delayed Draw Term Loan, commencing on the last day of the first full Fiscal Quarter ending after the applicable Delayed Draw Term Loan Funding Date of such Delayed Draw Term Loan, with a final installment due at the end of the Term in an amount equal to the entire unpaid principal balance thereof. Each Delayed Draw Term Loan shall be evidenced by one or more secured promissory notes (collectively, the “Delayed Draw Term Loan Note”) in substantially the form attached hereto as Exhibit F-2.

 

(v)            Borrowing Agent may, from time to time, prepay the principal amount owing under each Delayed Draw Term Loan, so long as: (A) Borrowing Agent shall have provided at least three (3) Business Days prior written notice not later than 11:00 a.m. (New York City time) to Agent of such prepayment, specifying the amount of such prepayment (which notice, once given, shall be irrevocable); (B) each such prepayment is in a minimum amount of $500,000, or an increment of $250,000 in excess thereof and (C) such prepayment shall be accompanied by the payment of any prepayment fee set forth in the Fee Letter. Such prepayments shall be applied to the principal installments due on such Delayed Draw Term Loan on a pro rata basis; provided that any such prepayments shall be applied on a pro rata basis to the Closing Date Term Loan and the then outstanding portion of the Delayed Draw Term Loans.

 

2.2            Repayment of Advances.

 

(a)            The Term Loans shall be due and payable as provided in Section 2.1 and in the Term Notes, subject to mandatory prepayments as herein provided. Notwithstanding the foregoing, all Advances shall be subject to earlier repayment upon (i) acceleration upon the occurrence and during the continuance of an Event of Default under this Agreement or (ii) termination of this Agreement.

 

(b)            Each Borrower recognizes that the amounts evidenced by checks, notes, drafts or any other items of payment relating to and/or proceeds of Collateral may not be collectible by Agent on the date received. In consideration of Agent’s agreement to conditionally credit Borrowers’ Account as of the next Business Day following Agent’s receipt of those items of payment, each Borrower agrees that, in computing the charges under this Agreement, all items of payment shall be deemed applied by Agent on account of the Obligations (i) on the Business Day following Agent’s receipt of such payments via wire transfer or electronic depository check or (ii) in the case of payments received by Agent in any other form, the Business Day such payment constitutes good funds in Agent’s account. Agent is not, however, required to credit Borrowers’ Account for the amount of any item of payment which is unsatisfactory to Agent in its Permitted Discretion and Agent may charge Borrowers’ Account for the amount of any item of payment which is returned to Agent unpaid.

 

(c)            All payments of principal, interest and other amounts payable hereunder, or under any of the Other Documents shall be made to Agent via wire transfer or electronic depository check not later than 1:00 p.m. (New York City time) on the due date therefor in lawful money of the United States of America in federal funds or other funds immediately available to Agent.

 

(d)            Borrowers shall, jointly and severally, pay principal, interest, and all other amounts payable hereunder, or under any related agreement, without any deduction whatsoever, including, but not limited to, any deduction for any setoff or counterclaim.

 

(e)            Any amount prepaid or repaid in respect of Term Loans may not be reborrowed.

 

44 

 

 

2.3            [Reserved].

 

2.4            Statement of Account. Agent shall maintain, in accordance with its customary procedures, a loan account (“Borrowers’ Account”) in the name of the Borrowers in which shall be recorded the date and amount of each Advance made by Lenders, the Lender(s) making such Advance and the date and amount of each payment in respect thereof; provided, however, the failure by Agent to record the date and amount of any Advance shall not adversely affect Agent or any Lender. The records of Agent with respect to the loan account shall be prima facie evidence absent manifest error of the amounts of Advances and other charges thereto and of payments applicable thereto.

 

2.5            Additional Payments. Any sums expended by Agent or any Lender due to any Borrower’s failure to perform or comply with its obligations under this Agreement or any Other Document including the Borrowers’ obligations under Sections 4.2, 4.4, 4.12, 4.13 and 4.14 hereof, may be charged to Borrowers’ Account and added to the Obligations.

 

2.6            Manner of Borrowing and Payment.

 

(a)            Each payment (including each prepayment) by Borrowers on account of the principal of and interest on the Term Loans shall be applied to the Term Loans pro rata according to the Term Loan Commitment Percentages of Lenders. Except as expressly provided herein, all payments (including prepayments) to be made by Borrowers on account of principal, interest and fees shall be made without set off or counterclaim and shall be made to Agent on behalf of the Lenders, in each case, via wire transfer or electronic depository check on or prior to 1:00 p.m. (New York City time) in Dollars and in immediately available funds.

 

(b)            Except as otherwise expressly provided in this Agreement with respect to any such specified payment required to be made by Borrowers hereunder or with respect to any payment obtained by a Lender as consideration for the assignment of or sale of a participation in any of its Advances to any assignee or participant as contemplated under Section 15.3 of this Agreement, if any Lender or Participant (a “benefited Lender”) shall at any time receive any payment of all or part of its Advances, or interest thereon, or receive any Collateral in respect thereof (whether voluntarily or involuntarily or, if consented to by Agent, by set-off) in a greater proportion than any such payment to and Collateral received by any other Lender, if any, in respect of such other Lender’s Advances, or interest thereon, and such greater proportionate payment or receipt of Collateral is not expressly permitted hereunder, such benefited Lender shall purchase for cash from the other Lenders a participation in such portion of each such other Lender’s Advances, or shall provide such other Lender with the benefits of any such Collateral, or the proceeds thereof, as shall be necessary to cause such benefited Lender to share the excess payment or benefits of such Collateral or proceeds ratably with each of the other Lenders; provided, however, that if all or any portion of such excess payment or benefits is thereafter recovered from such benefited Lender, such purchase shall be rescinded, and the purchase price and benefits returned, to the extent of such recovery, but without interest. Each Lender so purchasing a portion of another Lender’s Advances may exercise all rights of payment (including, if consented to by Agent, rights of set-off) with respect to such portion as fully as if such Lender were the direct holder of such portion.

 

45 

 

 

2.7            Mandatory Prepayments.

 

(a)            Asset Dispositions and Involuntary Dispositions. The Credit Parties shall prepay the Obligations in an amount equal to one hundred percent (100%) of the Net Cash Proceeds received from any Asset Sale (other than Asset Sales permitted pursuant to Section 7.1(b)) or Involuntary Disposition by DDH or any of its Subsidiaries on the Business Day following receipt of Net Cash Proceeds required to be prepaid pursuant to the provisions hereof; provided that such prepayment shall not be required to be made to the extent Borrowing Agent delivers to Agent a certificate stating that the applicable Credit Party intends to reinvest such Net Cash Proceeds in replacement assets (excluding Consolidated Current Assets) that are useful in the business of DDH or any of its Subsidiaries within 180 days after the date of such Asset Sale or Involuntary Disposition and such Net Cash Proceeds are so reinvested during such period, provided, further that in the case of an Involuntary Disposition, if a definitive agreement to so reinvest has been executed within such 180-day period, then such reinvestment shall have been consummated within 180 days after the date such definitive agreement was executed; it being understood that any such Net Cash Proceeds not so reinvested during such periods, shall be used to prepay the Obligations immediately following the expiration of such respective period. Until the date of payment, such Net Cash Proceeds required to be prepaid shall be held in trust for Agent and, upon such prepayment, shall be applied to the Term Loans in the inverse order of maturities thereof (x) in respect of the Closing Date Term Loan and the Delayed Draw Term Loans, and (y) to all remaining principal installments thereof until paid in full. The foregoing shall not be deemed to be implied consent to any such sale otherwise prohibited by the terms and conditions hereof.

 

(b)            [Reserved].

 

(c)            Equity Proceeds. The Credit Parties shall prepay the Obligations in an amount equal to one hundred percent (100%) of the Net Cash Proceeds from any Equity Transactions (other than a Qualified IPO and Equity Transactions used solely to consummate Permitted Acquisitions and completed substantially contemporaneously therewith) on the Business Day following receipt thereof unless waived by Agent in its sole and absolute discretion. Until the date of payment, such Net Cash Proceeds required to be prepaid shall be held in trust for Agent. The foregoing shall not be deemed to be implied consent to any such issuance otherwise prohibited by the terms and conditions hereof. Such repayments shall be applied to the outstanding principal installments of the Term Loans in the inverse order of maturities thereof (x) in respect of the Closing Date Term Loan and the Delayed Draw Term Loans, and (y) to all remaining principal installments thereof until paid in full.

 

(d)            Indebtedness Proceeds. The Credit Parties shall prepay the Obligations in an amount equal to one hundred percent (100%) of the Net Cash Proceeds from any Debt Transactions on the Business Day following receipt thereof. Until the date of payment, such proceeds shall be held in trust for Agent. The foregoing shall not be deemed to be implied consent to any such incurrence otherwise prohibited by the terms and conditions hereof. Such repayments shall be applied to the outstanding principal installments of the Term Loans in the inverse order of maturities thereof (x) in respect of the Closing Date Term Loan and the Delayed Draw Term Loans, and (y) to all remaining principal installments thereof until paid in full.

 

(e)            Consolidated Excess Cash Flow. The Credit Parties shall prepay the Obligations, within thirty (30) days of delivery of each annual Compliance Certificate delivered under Section 9.7, commencing with the Compliance Certificate delivered for the Fiscal Year ending December 31, 2022, in an amount equal to (i) so long as no Event of Default has occurred and is continuing, 50% of Consolidated Excess Cash Flow and (ii) following the occurrence and during the continuance of an Event of Default, 100% of Consolidated Excess Cash Flow for the immediately preceding Fiscal Year unless waived in writing by Agent. The prepayments specified in this Section 2.7(e) shall be applied to the outstanding principal installments of the Term Loans in the inverse order of maturities thereof (x) in respect of the Closing Date Term Loan and the Delayed Draw Term Loans, and (y) to all remaining principal installments thereof until paid in full. In the event that the Compliance Certificate required by Section 9.7 is not delivered on or before the due date, then a calculation based upon estimated amounts shall be made by Agent upon which calculation Borrowers shall make the prepayments required by this Section 2.7(e), subject to adjustment when the applicable financial statements and Compliance Certificate are delivered to Agent as required hereby. Such calculations made by Agent and/or acceptance of any related estimated prepayments shall not be deemed a waiver of any rights Agent or Lenders may have, whether as a result of the failure by Borrowers to timely deliver such financial statements or otherwise.

 

46 

 

 

 

(f)            Extraordinary Receipts. When any Credit Party or Subsidiary thereof receives the cash proceeds of any Extraordinary Receipt, unless such Credit Party or Subsidiary reinvests such proceeds in the same manner that it would be entitled to under Section 2.7(a), the Credit Parties shall repay the Term Loans in an amount equal to 100% of the Net Cash Proceeds of such Extraordinary Receipts, such prepayments to be made promptly but in no event more than five (5) Business Days following receipt of such Net Cash Proceeds, and until the date of payment, such proceeds shall be held in trust for Agent. Such repayments shall be applied to the outstanding principal installments of the Term Loans in the inverse order of maturities thereof (x) in respect of the Closing Date Term Loan and the Delayed Draw Term Loans, and (y) to all remaining principal installments thereof until paid in full.

 

(g)            ABL Loan Documents. The terms of this Section 2.7 are subject to the terms and conditions of the Intercreditor Agreement. To the extent that any mandatory prepayment pursuant to the ABL Loan Documents is, contemporaneously with the event giving rise to such prepayment, required and permitted to be paid to the ABL Obligations pursuant to the Intercreditor Agreement, then the amount of such payment required pursuant to the ABL Loan Documents at such time shall reduce the amount of any mandatory prepayment owing pursuant to this Section 2.7 on a dollar for dollar basis or as otherwise required pursuant to the Intercreditor Agreement.

 

2.8            Use of Proceeds.

 

(a)            Borrowers shall use the proceeds of (i) the Closing Date Term Loans to (A) fund the Preferred A Redemption, (B) refinance certain Indebtedness of the Borrowers existing immediately prior to the Closing Date, (C) pay fees and expenses associated with the Closing Date Transactions and (D) provide for their general corporate needs and working capital requirements, including, funding for creation and retention of direct and indirect jobs and/or opening of new revenue-generating locations, and (ii) the Delayed Draw Term Loans (if any) to (A) fund Permitted Acquisitions and (B) pay fees and expenses associated with the Delayed Draw Term Loans and such Permitted Acquisitions.

 

(b)            Without limiting the generality of Section 2.8(a) above, neither any Borrower, any other Credit Party, nor any other Person which may in the future become a Credit Party, intends to use nor shall they use any portion of the proceeds of the Advances, directly or indirectly, for any purpose in violation of the Trading with the Enemy Act or to purchase or carry, or to reduce or refinance any Indebtedness incurred to purchase or carry, any margin stock (as defined in Regulation U of the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System) or for any related purpose governed by Regulations T, U or X of the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System.

 

2.9            Defaulting Lender.

 

(a)            Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained herein, in the event any Lender (i) has refused (which refusal constitutes a breach by such Lender of its obligations under this Agreement) to make available its portion of any Advance or (ii) notifies either Agent or Borrowing Agent that it does not intend to make available its portion of any Advance and such actual refusal would constitute a breach by such Lender of its obligations under this Agreement (each, a “Lender Default”), all rights and obligations hereunder of such Lender (a “Defaulting Lender”) as to which a Lender Default is in effect and of the other parties hereto shall be modified to the extent of the express provisions of this Section 2.9 while such Lender Default remains in effect.

 

(b)            Advances shall be incurred pro rata from Lenders (the “Non-Defaulting Lenders”) which are not Defaulting Lenders based on their respective applicable Commitment Percentages, and no Commitment Percentage of any Lender or any pro rata share of any Advances required to be advanced by any Lender shall be increased as a result of such Lender Default. Amounts received in respect of principal of any type of Advances shall be applied to reduce the applicable Advances of each Lender (other than any Defaulting Lender) pro rata based on the aggregate of the outstanding Advances of that type of all Lenders at the time of such application; provided, that, Agent shall not be obligated to transfer to a Defaulting Lender any payments received by Agent for the Defaulting Lender’s benefit, nor shall a Defaulting Lender be entitled to the sharing of any payments hereunder (including any principal, interest or fees). Amounts payable to a Defaulting Lender shall instead be paid to or retained by Agent and, if so paid or retained, shall be deemed to have been paid by Borrowers for all purposes hereunder. Agent may hold and, in its discretion, re-lend to Borrowers the amount of such payments received or retained by it for the account of such Defaulting Lender.

 

47 

 

 

(c)            A Defaulting Lender shall not be entitled to give instructions to Agent or to approve, disapprove, consent to or vote on any matters relating to this Agreement and the Other Documents. All amendments, waivers and other modifications of this Agreement and the Other Documents may be made without regard to a Defaulting Lender and, solely for purposes of any determination of “Required Lenders” in accordance with the definition thereof, a Defaulting Lender shall be deemed not to be a Lender and not to have either Advances outstanding or a Commitment Percentage.

 

(d)            Other than as expressly set forth in this Section 2.9, the rights and obligations of a Defaulting Lender (including the obligation to indemnify Agent) and the other parties hereto shall remain unchanged. Nothing in this Section 2.9 shall be deemed to release any Defaulting Lender from its obligations under this Agreement and the Other Documents, shall alter such obligations, shall operate as a waiver of any default by such Defaulting Lender hereunder, or shall prejudice any rights which any Borrower, Agent or any Lender may have against any Defaulting Lender as a result of any default by such Defaulting Lender hereunder.

 

(e)            In the event a Defaulting Lender retroactively cures to the satisfaction of Agent the breach which caused a Lender to become a Defaulting Lender, such Defaulting Lender shall no longer be a Defaulting Lender and shall be treated as a Lender under this Agreement.

 

2.10            Joint and Several Liability, Waivers, etc. Each Borrower hereby agrees as follows.

 

(a)            Each Borrower is accepting joint and several liability hereunder and under the Other Documents in consideration of the financial accommodations to be provided by Agent and the Lenders under this Agreement, for the mutual benefit, directly and indirectly, of each Borrower and in consideration of the undertakings of the other Borrowers to accept joint and several liability for the Obligations.

 

(b)            Each Borrower, jointly and severally, hereby irrevocably and unconditionally accepts, not merely as a surety but also as a co-debtor, joint and several liability with the other Borrowers, with respect to the payment and performance of all of the Obligations (including any Obligations arising under this Section 2.10), it being the intention of each Borrower and the parties hereto that all the Obligations shall be the joint and several obligations of each Borrower without preferences or distinction among them.

 

(c)            If and to the extent that any Borrower shall fail to make any payment with respect to any of the Obligations as and when due or to perform any of the Obligations in accordance with the terms thereof, then in each such event the other Borrowers will make such payment with respect to, or perform, such Obligation.

 

(d)            The Obligations of each Borrower under the provisions of this Section 2.10 constitute the absolute and unconditional, full recourse Obligations of each Borrower enforceable against each Borrower to the full extent of its properties and assets, irrespective of the validity, regularity or enforceability of this Agreement or any other circumstances whatsoever.

 

48 

 

 

(e)            Except as otherwise expressly provided in this Agreement, to the fullest extent permitted by Applicable Law, each Borrower hereby waives notice of acceptance of its joint and several liability, notice of any Advances issued under or pursuant to this Agreement, notice of the occurrence of any Default, Event of Default, or of any demand for any payment under this Agreement, notice of any action at any time taken or omitted by Agent or Lenders under or in respect of any of the Obligations, any requirement of diligence or to mitigate damages and, generally, to the extent permitted by Applicable Law, all demands, notices and other formalities of every kind in connection with this Agreement (except as otherwise provided in this Agreement). Each Borrower hereby assents to, and waives, to the fullest extent permitted by Applicable Law, notice of, any extension or postponement of the time for the payment of any of the Obligations, the acceptance of any payment of any of the Obligations, the acceptance of any partial payment thereon, any waiver, consent or other action or acquiescence by Agent or Lenders at any time or times in respect of any default by any Borrower in the performance or satisfaction of any term, covenant, condition or provision of this Agreement, any and all other indulgences whatsoever by Agent or Lenders in respect of any of the Obligations, and the taking, addition, substitution or release, in whole or in part, at any time or times, of any security for any of the Obligations or the addition, substitution or release, in whole or in part, of any Borrower. Without limiting the generality of the foregoing, each Borrower assents to any other action or delay in acting or failure to act on the part of Agent or any Lender with respect to the failure by any Borrower to comply with any of its respective Obligations, including, without limitation, any failure strictly or diligently to assert any right or to pursue any remedy or to comply fully with Applicable Laws or regulations thereunder, which might, but for the provisions of this Section 2.10 afford grounds for terminating, discharging or relieving any Borrower, in whole or in part, from any of its Obligations under this Section 2.10, it being the intention of each Borrower that, so long as any of the Obligations hereunder remain unsatisfied, the Obligations of each Borrower under this Section 2.10 shall not be discharged except by performance and then only to the extent of such performance. The Obligations of each Borrower under this Section 2.10 shall not be diminished or rendered unenforceable by any winding up, reorganization, arrangement, liquidation, reconstruction or similar proceeding with respect to any Borrower or Agent or any Lender.

 

(f)            Each Borrower represents and warrants to Agent and Lenders that such Borrower is currently informed of the financial condition of the other Borrowers and of all other circumstances which a diligent inquiry would reveal and which bear upon the risk of nonpayment of the Obligations. Each Borrower further represents and warrants to Agent and Lenders that such Borrower has read and understands the terms and conditions of this Agreement and the Other Documents. Each Borrower hereby covenants that such Borrower will continue to keep informed of the other Borrowers’ financial condition, the financial condition of other guarantors, if any, and of all other circumstances which bear upon the risk of nonpayment or nonperformance of the Obligations.

 

(g)            Each Borrower waives, to the maximum extent permitted by law, all rights and defenses arising out of an election of remedies by Agent or any Lender, even though that election of remedies, such as a nonjudicial foreclosure with respect to security for a guaranteed obligation, has destroyed Agent’s or such Lender’s rights of subrogation and reimbursement against any Borrower by the operation of Section 580(d) of the California Code of Civil Procedure, any comparable statute, or otherwise.

 

(h)            [Reserved].

 

(i)            The provisions of this Section 2.10 are made for the benefit of Agent, Lenders and their respective successors and assigns, and may be enforced by it or them from time to time against any Borrower as often as occasion therefor may arise and without requirement on the part of Agent, any Lender, any of their respective successors or assigns first to marshal any of its or their claims or to exercise any of its or their rights against any Borrower or to exhaust any remedies available to it or them against any Borrower or to resort to any other source or means of obtaining payment of any of the Obligations hereunder or to elect any other remedy. The provisions of this Section 2.10 shall remain in effect until all of the Obligations shall have been paid in full in accordance with the terms of this Agreement. If at any time, any payment, or any part thereof, made in respect of any of the Obligations, is rescinded or must otherwise be restored or returned by Agent or any Lender upon the insolvency, bankruptcy or reorganization of any Borrower, or otherwise, the provisions of this Section 2.10 will forthwith be reinstated in effect, as though such payment had not been made.

 

49 

 

 

(j)            Until the Obligations (other than Inchoate Obligations) have been paid in full in cash in accordance with the terms hereof, all of the commitments of the Lenders hereunder have been terminated and this Agreement has been terminated, each Borrower hereby agrees that it will not enforce any of its rights of contribution or subrogation against any other Borrower with respect to any liability incurred by it hereunder or under any of the Other Documents, any payments made by it to Agent or any Lender with respect to any of the Obligations or any collateral security therefor until such time as all of the Obligations (other than Inchoate Obligations) have been paid in full in cash. Any claim which any Borrower may have against any other Borrower with respect to any payments to Agent or any Lender hereunder or under any Other Documents are hereby expressly made subordinate and junior in right of payment, without limitation as to any increases in the Obligations arising hereunder or thereunder, to the prior payment in full in cash of the Obligations (other than Inchoate Obligations) and, in the event of any insolvency, bankruptcy, receivership, liquidation, reorganization or other similar proceeding under the laws of any jurisdiction relating to any Borrower, its debts or its assets, whether voluntary or involuntary, all such Obligations shall be paid in full in cash before any payment or distribution of any character, whether in cash, securities or other property, shall be made to any other Borrower therefor.

 

(k)            Each Borrower hereby agrees that, after the occurrence and during the continuance of any Event of Default, the payment of any amounts due with respect to the indebtedness or other obligations owing by any Borrower to any other Borrower is hereby subordinated to the prior payment in full in cash of the Obligations (other than Inchoate Obligations) in accordance with the terms of this Agreement. Each Borrower hereby agrees that after the occurrence and during the continuance of any Event of Default, such Borrower will not demand, sue for or otherwise attempt to collect any indebtedness of any other Borrower owing to such Borrower until the Obligations (other than Inchoate Obligations) shall have been paid in full in cash. If, notwithstanding the foregoing sentence, any Borrower shall collect, enforce or receive any amounts in respect of such indebtedness, such amounts shall be collected, enforced and received by such Borrower as trustee for Agent, and such Borrower shall deliver any such amounts to Agent for application to the Obligations in accordance with the terms of this Agreement.

 

III. INTEREST AND FEES.

 

3.1            Interest. Interest on Advances shall be payable in arrears on the last Business Day of each month. Interest charges shall be computed on the actual principal amount of Advances outstanding during the monthly period, at a rate per annum equal to the applicable Term Loan Rate. Whenever, subsequent to the date of this Agreement, the LIBOR Rate is increased or decreased, the Term Loan Rate shall be similarly changed without notice or demand of any kind by an amount equal to the amount of such change in the LIBOR Rate during the time such change or changes remain in effect. Upon and after the occurrence of an Event of Default, and during the continuation thereof, at the option of Agent or at the direction of Required Lenders, the Obligations shall bear interest at the Term Loan Rate plus two (2%) percent per annum (the “Default Rate”).

 

3.2            [Reserved].

 

3.3            [Reserved].

 

3.4            Fee Letter. Borrowers shall pay the amounts required to be paid in the Fee Letter in the manner and at the times required by the Fee Letter.

 

50 

 

 

3.5            Computation of Interest and Fees. Interest hereunder shall be computed on the basis of a 360 day year and for the actual number of days elapsed. If any payment to be made hereunder becomes due and payable on a day other than a Business Day, the due date thereof shall be extended to the next succeeding Business Day and interest thereon shall be payable at the applicable Term Loan Rate during such extension, unless such next succeeding Business Day would fall in the next calendar month, in which case the due date shall be on the immediately preceding Business Day.

 

3.6            Maximum Charges. In no event whatsoever shall interest and other charges charged hereunder exceed the highest rate permissible under law. In the event interest and other charges as computed hereunder would otherwise exceed the highest rate permitted under law, such excess amount shall be first applied to any unpaid principal balance owed by Borrowers, and if the then remaining excess amount is greater than the previously unpaid principal balance, Lenders shall promptly refund such excess amount to Borrowing Agent and the provisions hereof shall be deemed amended to provide for such permissible rate.

 

3.7            Increased Costs. In the event that any Applicable Law or any change therein or in the interpretation or application thereof, or compliance by any Lender (for purposes of this Section 3.7, the term “Lender” shall include Agent or any Lender and any corporation or bank controlling Agent or any Lender) and the office or branch where Agent or any Lender (as so defined) makes or maintains any Advances with any request or directive (whether or not having the force of law) from any central bank or other financial, monetary or other authority, shall:

 

(a)            subject Agent or any Lender to any Tax of any kind whatsoever (other than (A) Indemnified Taxes and (B) Excluded Taxes) on the Advances, this Agreement, any Other Document, any commitments or other obligations or participations therein, or its deposits, reserves, other liabilities or capital attributable thereto;

 

(b)            impose, modify or deem applicable any reserve, special deposit, compulsory loan, insurance charge, assessment or similar requirement against assets held by, or deposits in or for the account of, advances or loans by, or other credit extended by, any office of Agent or any Lender, including pursuant to Regulation D of the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System; or

 

(c)            impose on Agent or any Lender or the London interbank market any other condition, loss or expense (other than Taxes) affecting this Agreement or any Other Document or any Advance made by any Lender or participation therein;

 

and the result of any of the foregoing is to increase the cost to Agent or any Lender of making, renewing or maintaining its Advances hereunder by an amount that Agent or such Lender deems to be material or to reduce the amount of any payment (whether of principal, interest or otherwise) in respect of any of the Advances by an amount that Agent or such Lender deems to be material, then, in any case Borrowers shall within 30 days of the events or conditions giving rise thereto pay Agent or such Lender, upon its demand, such additional amount as will compensate Agent or such Lender for such additional cost or such reduction, as the case may be, provided that the foregoing shall not apply to increased costs which are reflected in the LIBOR Rate, as the case may be. Agent or such Lender shall certify the amount of such additional cost or reduced amount to Borrowing Agent (in writing and providing in reasonable detail the reasons for and calculations of such amounts), and such certification shall be conclusive evidence absent manifest error.

 

51 

 

 

Failure or delay on the part of Agent or any Lender to demand compensation pursuant to the foregoing provisions of this Section 3.7 shall not constitute a waiver of Agent’s or such Lender’s right to demand such compensation, provided that no Credit Party shall be required to compensate Agent or any Lender pursuant to the foregoing provisions of this Section 3.7 for any increased costs incurred or reductions suffered more than nine (9) months prior to the date that Agent or such Lender notifies Borrowing Agent of the circumstance giving rise to such increased costs or reductions and of Agent’s or such Lender’s intention to claim compensation therefor (except that, if the circumstance giving rise to such increased costs or reductions involves a change in law that is retroactive, then the nine-month period referred to above shall be extended to include the period of retroactive effect thereof).

 

3.8            Benchmark Replacement Setting.

 

(a)            Replacing USD LIBOR. On March 5, 2021 the Financial Conduct Authority (“FCA”), the regulatory supervisor of USD LIBOR’s administrator (“IBA”), announced in a public statement the future cessation or loss of representativeness of overnight/Spot Next, 1-month, 3-month, 6-month and 12- month USD LIBOR tenor settings. On the earlier of (i) the date that all Available Tenors of USD LIBOR have either permanently or indefinitely ceased to be provided by IBA or have been announced by the FCA pursuant to public statement or publication of information to be no longer representative and (ii) the Early Opt-in Effective Date, if the then-current Benchmark is USD LIBOR, the Benchmark Replacement will replace such Benchmark for all purposes hereunder and under this Agreement or any Other Document in respect of any setting of such Benchmark on such day and all subsequent settings without any amendment to, or further action or consent of any other party to this Agreement or any Other Document. If the Benchmark Replacement is based on Daily Simple SOFR pursuant to clause (ii) of the definition of “Benchmark Replacement”, all interest payments will be payable on a monthly basis.

 

(b)            Replacing Future Benchmarks. Upon the occurrence of a Benchmark Transition Event, the Benchmark Replacement will replace the then-current Benchmark for all purposes hereunder and under this Agreement or any Other Document in respect of any Benchmark setting at or after 5:00 p.m. on the fifth (5th) Business Day after the date notice of such Benchmark Replacement is provided to the Lenders without any amendment to, or further action or consent of any other party to, this Agreement or any Other Document so long as Agent has not received, by such time, written notice of objection to such Benchmark Replacement from Lenders comprising the Required Lenders.

 

(c)            Benchmark Replacement Conforming Changes. In connection with the implementation and administration of a Benchmark Replacement, Agent will have the right to make Benchmark Replacement Conforming Changes from time to time and, notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein or in any Other Document, any amendments implementing such Benchmark Replacement Conforming Changes will become effective without any further action or consent of any other party to this Agreement.

 

52 

 

 

(d)            Notices; Standards for Decisions and Determinations. Agent will promptly notify the Borrowers and the Lenders of (i) the implementation of any Benchmark Replacement and (ii) the effectiveness of any Benchmark Replacement Conforming Changes. Any determination, decision or election that may be made by Agent or, if applicable, any Lender (or group of Lenders) pursuant to this Section 3.8, including any determination with respect to a tenor, rate or adjustment or of the occurrence or non-occurrence of an event, circumstance or date and any decision to take or refrain from taking any action, will be conclusive and binding absent manifest error and may be made in its or their sole discretion and without consent from any other party hereto, except, in each case, as expressly required pursuant to this Section 3.8.

 

(e)            Unavailability of Tenor of Benchmark. At any time (including in connection with the implementation of a Benchmark Replacement), (i) if the then-current Benchmark is a term rate (including Term SOFR or USD LIBOR), then Agent may remove any tenor of such Benchmark that is unavailable or non-representative for Benchmark (including Benchmark Replacement) settings and (ii) Agent may reinstate any such previously removed tenor for Benchmark (including Benchmark Replacement) settings.

 

(f)            Definitions Applicable to this Section 3.8.

 

Available Tenor” means, as of any date of determination and with respect to the then-current Benchmark, as applicable, (x) if the then-current Benchmark is a term rate, any tenor for such Benchmark that is or may be used for determining the length of the three month period or (y) otherwise, any payment period for interest calculated with reference to such Benchmark, as applicable, pursuant to this Agreement as of such date.

 

Benchmark” means, initially, USD LIBOR; provided that if a replacement of the Benchmark has occurred pursuant to this Section 3.8, then “Benchmark” means the applicable Benchmark Replacement to the extent that such Benchmark Replacement has replaced such prior benchmark rate. Any reference to “Benchmark” shall include, as applicable, the published component used in the calculation thereof.

 

Benchmark Replacement” means, for any Available Tenor, the alternative set forth below that that has been selected by the Agent and can be determined by the Agent:

 

(i)            the sum of: (x) Term SOFR and (y) 0.11448% (11.448 basis points) for an Available Tenor of one-month’s duration, 0.26161% (26.161 basis points) for an Available Tenor of three-months’ duration, and 0.42826% (42.826 basis points) for an Available Tenor of six-months’ duration,

 

(ii)            the sum of: (x) Daily Simple SOFR and (y) the spread adjustment selected or recommended by the Relevant Governmental Body for the replacement of the tenor of USD LIBOR with a SOFR-based rate having approximately the same length as the interest payment period specified in clause (a) of this Section 3.8, or

 

53 

 

 

(iii)            the sum of: (x) the alternate benchmark rate that has been selected by the Agent as the replacement for the then-current Benchmark for the applicable corresponding tenor giving due consideration to (i) any selection or recommendation of a replacement benchmark rate or the mechanism for determining such a rate by the Relevant Governmental Body or (ii) any evolving or then-prevailing market convention for determining a benchmark rate as a replacement for the then-current Benchmark for U.S. dollar-denominated syndicated credit facilities at such time and (y) an adjustment (which may be a positive or negative value or zero), in each case, that has been selected by Agent as the replacement for such Available Tenor of such Benchmark giving due consideration to any evolving or then-prevailing market convention, including any applicable recommendations made by the Relevant Governmental Body, for U.S. dollar-denominated syndicated credit facilities at such time;

 

provided that, if the Benchmark Replacement as determined pursuant to this definition of “Benchmark Replacement” would be less than the Floor, the Benchmark Replacement will be deemed to be the Floor for the purposes of this Agreement and the Other Documents.

 

Any Benchmark Replacement shall be applied in a manner consistent with market practice.

 

Benchmark Replacement Conforming Changes” means, with respect to any Benchmark Replacement, any technical, administrative or operational changes (including, without limitation, changes to timing and frequency of determining rates and making payments of interest, timing of borrowing requests or prepayment, conversion or continuation notices, the applicability and length of lookback periods, the applicability of breakage provisions, and other technical, administrative or operational matters) that Agent decides may be appropriate to reflect the adoption and implementation of such Benchmark Replacement and to permit the administration thereof by Agent in a manner substantially consistent with market practice (or, if Agent decides that adoption of any portion of such market practice is not administratively feasible or if Agent determines that no market practice for the administration of such Benchmark Replacement exists, in such other manner of administration as Agent decides is reasonably necessary in connection with the administration of this Agreement and the Other Documents).

 

Benchmark Transition Event” means, with respect to any then-current Benchmark other than USD LIBOR, the occurrence of a public statement or publication of information by or on behalf of the administrator of the then-current Benchmark, the regulatory supervisor for the administrator of such Benchmark, the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System, the Federal Reserve Bank of New York, an insolvency official with jurisdiction over the administrator for such Benchmark, a resolution authority with jurisdiction over the administrator for such Benchmark or a court or an entity with similar insolvency or resolution authority over the administrator for such Benchmark, announcing or stating that (a) such administrator has ceased or will cease on a specified date to provide all Available Tenors of such Benchmark, permanently or indefinitely, provided that, at the time of such statement or publication, there is no successor administrator that will continue to provide any Available Tenor of such Benchmark or (b) all Available Tenors of such Benchmark are or will no longer be representative of the underlying market and economic reality that such Benchmark is intended to measure and that representativeness will not be restored.

 

Daily Simple SOFRmeans, for any day, SOFR, with the conventions for this rate (which will include a lookback) being established by Agent in a manner consistent with market practice in accordance with the conventions for this rate recommended by the Relevant Governmental Body for determining “Daily Simple SOFR” for syndicated business loans; provided, that if Agent decides that any such convention is not administratively feasible for Agent, then Agent may establish another convention consistent with market practice in its reasonable discretion.

 

Early Opt-in Effective Datemeans, with respect to any Early Opt-in Election, the sixth (6th) Business Day after the date notice of such Early Opt-in Election is provided to the Lenders, so long as Agent has not received, by 5:00 p.m. (New York City time) on the fifth (5th) Business Day after the date notice of such Early Opt-in Election is provided to the Lenders, written notice of objection to such Early Opt-in Election from Lenders comprising the Required Lenders.

 

54 

 

 

Early Opt-in Electionmeans the occurrence of:

 

(a)            a notification by Agent to (or the request by the Borrowers to Agent to notify) each of the other parties hereto that at least five currently outstanding U.S. dollar-denominated syndicated credit facilities at such time contain (as a result of amendment or as originally executed) a SOFR-based rate (including SOFR, a term SOFR or any other rate based upon SOFR) as a benchmark rate (and such syndicated credit facilities are identified in such notice and are publicly available for review), and

 

(b)            the joint election by Agent and the Borrowers to trigger a fallback from USD LIBOR and the provision by Agent of written notice of such election to the Lenders.

 

Floormeans the benchmark rate floor, if any, provided in this Agreement initially (as of the execution of this Agreement, the modification, amendment or renewal of this Agreement or otherwise) with respect to USD LIBOR.

 

Relevant Governmental Bodymeans the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System or the Federal Reserve Bank of New York, or a committee officially endorsed or convened by the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System or the Federal Reserve Bank of New York, or any successor thereto.

 

SOFRmeans a rate per annum equal to the secured overnight financing rate for such Business Day published by the Federal Reserve Bank of New York (or a successor administrator of the secured overnight financing rate) on the website of the Federal Reserve Bank of New York, currently at http://www.newyorkfed.org (or any successor source for the secured overnight financing rate identified as such by the administrator of the secured overnight financing rate from time to time).

 

Term SOFRmeans, for the applicable corresponding tenor, the forward-looking term rate based on SOFR that has been selected or recommended by the Relevant Governmental Body.

 

USD LIBORmeans the London interbank offered rate for U.S. dollars.

 

3.9            Capital Adequacy.

 

(a)            In the event that Agent or any Lender shall have determined that any Applicable Law or guideline regarding capital adequacy, or any change therein, or any change in the interpretation or administration thereof by any Governmental Body, central bank or comparable agency charged with the interpretation or administration thereof, or compliance by Agent or any Lender (for purposes of this Section 3.9, the term “Lender” shall include Agent or any Lender and any corporation or bank controlling Agent or any Lender) and the office or branch where Agent or any Lender (as so defined) makes or maintains any Advances with any request or directive regarding capital adequacy (whether or not having the force of law) of any such authority, central bank or comparable agency, has or would have the effect of reducing the rate of return on Agent or any Lender’s capital as a consequence of its obligations hereunder to a level below that which Agent or such Lender could have achieved but for such adoption, change or compliance (taking into consideration Agent’s and each Lender’s policies with respect to capital adequacy) by an amount deemed by Agent or any Lender to be material, then, from time to time, Borrowers shall pay upon demand to Agent or such Lender such additional amount or amounts as will compensate Agent or such Lender for such reduction. In determining such amount or amounts, Agent or such Lender may use any reasonable averaging or attribution methods. The protection of this Section 3.9 shall be available to Agent and each Lender regardless of any possible contention of invalidity or inapplicability with respect to the Applicable Law or condition.

 

55 

 

 

(b)            A certificate of Agent or such Lender setting forth such amount or amounts as shall be necessary to compensate Agent or such Lender with respect to Section 3.9(a) hereof when delivered to Borrowing Agent shall be conclusive evidence absent manifest error.

 

(c)            Failure or delay on the part of Agent or any Lender to demand compensation pursuant to the foregoing provisions of this Section 3.9 shall not constitute a waiver of Agent’s or such Lender’s right to demand such compensation, provided that no Credit Party shall be required to compensate Agent or any Lender pursuant to the foregoing provisions of this Section 3.9 for any reductions suffered more than six months prior to the date that Agent or such Lender notifies Borrowing Agent of the circumstance giving rise to such reductions and of such Lender’s intention to claim compensation therefor (except that, if the circumstance giving rise to such increased costs or reductions involves a change in law that is retroactive, then the six-month period referred to above shall be extended to include the period of retroactive effect thereof).

 

3.10            Taxes.

 

(a)            [Reserved].

 

(b)            Payment Free of Taxes. Any and all payments by or on account of any Obligations of any Credit Party under this Agreement or any Other Document shall be made without deduction or withholding for any Taxes, except as required by Applicable Law. If any Applicable Law (as determined in the good faith discretion of Borrowing Agent or a Payee) requires the deduction or withholding of any Tax from any such payment by a Payee, then Borrowing Agent or such Payee, as applicable, shall be entitled to make such deduction or withholding and shall timely pay the full amount deducted or withheld to the relevant Governmental Body in accordance with Applicable Law and, if such Tax is an Indemnified Tax, then the sum payable by the applicable Credit Party shall be increased as necessary so that after such deduction or withholding has been made (including such deductions and withholdings applicable to additional sums payable under this Section) the Payee, as the case may be, receives an amount equal to the sum it would have received had no such deduction or withholding been made. For clarity, notwithstanding the submission of documentation by a Payee under Section 3.10(g)(i) claiming a reduced rate of or exemption from U.S. withholding Tax, Agent shall be entitled to withhold United States federal income Taxes at the full 30% withholding rate if in its reasonable judgment it is required to do so under the due diligence requirements imposed upon Agent under § 1.1441-7(b) of the United States Income Tax Regulations or other Applicable Law.

 

(c)            Payment of Other Taxes by the Credit Parties. The Credit Parties shall timely pay to the relevant Governmental Body in accordance with Applicable Law, or at the option of Agent timely reimburse it for the payment of, any Other Taxes.

 

(d)            Indemnification by the Credit Parties. Each Credit Party shall jointly and severally indemnify Agent and each Payee, within ten (10) days after demand therefor, for the full amount of any Indemnified Taxes (including Indemnified Taxes imposed or asserted on or attributable to amounts payable under this Section) payable or paid by Agent or any Payee or required to be withheld or deducted from a payment to such Agent or Payee, as the case may be, and any penalties, interest and out-of-pocket expenses arising therefrom or with respect thereto, whether or not such Indemnified Taxes were correctly or legally imposed or asserted by the relevant Governmental Body. A certificate as to the amount of such payment or liability delivered to Borrowers by any Payee (with a copy to Agent), or by Agent on its own behalf or on behalf of a Payee shall be conclusive absent demonstrable error.

 

56 

 

 

(e)            Indemnification by the Payees. Each Payee shall severally indemnify Agent, within ten (10) days after demand therefor, for (i) any Indemnified Taxes attributable to such Payee (but only to the extent that any Credit Party has not already indemnified Agent for such Indemnified Taxes and without limiting the obligation of the Credit Parties to do so), and (ii) any Excluded Taxes attributable to such Payee, in each case, that are payable or paid by Agent in connection with this Agreement or any Other Document, and any reasonable expenses arising therefrom or with respect thereto, whether or not such Taxes were correctly or legally imposed or asserted by the relevant Governmental Body. In addition, and for clarity, Agent is hereby indemnified severally by the Lenders under § 1.1461-1(e) of the United States Income Tax Regulations against any claims and demands of any Payee for the amount of any Tax it deducts and withholds in accordance with regulations under § 1441 of the Code. A certificate as to the amount of such payment or liability delivered to any Payee by Agent shall be conclusive absent manifest error. Each Payee hereby authorizes Agent to set off and apply any and all amounts at any time owing to such Payee under any Other Document or otherwise payable by Agent to the Payee from any other source against any amount due to Agent under this clause (e).

 

(f)            Evidence of Payments. As soon as practicable after any payment of Taxes by any Credit Party to a Governmental Body pursuant to this Section 3.10, such Credit Party shall deliver to Agent the original or a certified copy of a receipt issued by such Governmental Body evidencing such payment, a copy of the return reporting such payment or other evidence of such payment reasonably satisfactory to Agent.

 

(g)            Status of Payees. (i) Any Payee that is entitled to an exemption from or reduction of withholding Tax with respect to payments hereunder or under any Other Document shall deliver to Borrowers and Agent, at the time or times reasonably requested by Borrowing Agent or Agent, such properly completed and executed documentation prescribed by Applicable Law as will permit such payments to be made without withholding or at a reduced rate of withholding. In addition, any Payee, if reasonably requested by Borrowing Agent or Agent, shall deliver such other documentation prescribed by Applicable Law or reasonably requested by Borrowing Agent or Agent as will enable Borrowing Agent or Agent to determine whether or not such Payee is subject to backup withholding or information reporting requirements. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in the preceding two sentences, the completion, execution and submission of such documentation (other than such documentation set forth in Sections 3.10(g)(ii)(A), 3.10(g)(ii)(B) and 3.10(g)(ii)(D) below) shall not be required if in Payee’s reasonable judgment such completion, execution or submission would subject such Payee to any material unreimbursed cost or expense or would materially prejudice the legal or commercial position of such Payee, and Payee hereby acknowledges and agrees that in such circumstance Borrowers and Agent shall withhold against all payments to be made by Borrowers or Agent to such Payee in accordance with Applicable Law.

 

(ii)            Without limiting the generality of the foregoing, in the event that any Borrower is a “United States Person” as defined in Section 7701(a)(30) of the Code (a “U.S. Person”),

 

(A)            any Payee that is a U.S. Person shall deliver to Borrowing Agent and Agent on or prior to the date on which such Payee becomes a Payee under this Agreement (and from time to time thereafter upon the reasonable request of the Borrower or Agent), two (2) duly completed and executed copies of IRS Form W-9 certifying that such Payee is exempt from U.S. federal backup withholding Tax;

 

(B)            any Payee that is organized under the laws of a jurisdiction other than that in which the Credit Parties are resident for income Tax purposes (a “Foreign Lender”) shall, to the extent it is legally entitled to do so, deliver to Borrowing Agent and Agent (in such number of copies as shall be requested by the recipient) on or prior to the date on which such Foreign Lender becomes a Payee under this Agreement (and from time to time thereafter upon the reasonable request of any Borrower or Agent), whichever of the following is applicable:

 

57 

 

 

a.            in the case of a Foreign Lender claiming the benefits of an income tax treaty to which the United States is a party (x) with respect to payments of interest under this Agreement or any Other Document, two (2) duly completed and executed copies of IRS Form W-8BEN or W-8BEN-E (as applicable) establishing an exemption from, or reduction of, U.S. federal withholding Tax pursuant to the “interest” article of such tax treaty and (y) with respect to any other applicable payments under this Agreement or any Other Document, two (2) duly completed and executed copies of IRS Form W-8BEN or W-8BEN-E (as applicable) establishing an exemption from, or reduction of, U.S. federal withholding Tax pursuant to the “business profits” or “other income” article of such tax treaty;

 

b.            two (2) duly completed and executed copies of IRS Form W-8ECI;

 

c.            in the case of a Foreign Lender claiming the benefits of the exemption for portfolio interest under Section 881(c) of the Code, (x) two (2) duly completed and executed copies of a certificate in form and substance satisfactory to Agent to the effect that such Foreign Lender is not a “bank” within the meaning of Section 881(c)(3)(A) of the Code, a “10 percent shareholder” of the Borrowers within the meaning of Section 881(c)(3)(B) of the Code, or a “controlled foreign corporation” described in Section 881(c)(3)(C) of the Code (a “U.S. Tax Compliance Certificate”) and (y) two (2) duly completed and executed copies of IRS Form W-8BEN or IRS Form W-8BEN-E, as applicable; or

 

d.            to the extent a Foreign Lender is not the beneficial owner, two (2) duly completed and executed copies of IRS Form W-8IMY, accompanied by two (2) duly completed and executed copies of IRS Form W-8ECI, IRS Form W-8BEN or W-8BEN-E (as applicable), two (2) duly completed and executed copies of a U.S. Tax Compliance Certificate in form and substance satisfactory to Agent, two (2) duly completed and executed copies of IRS Form W-9, and/or other certification documents from each beneficial owner, as applicable; provided that if the Foreign Lender is a partnership and one or more direct or indirect partners of such Foreign Lender are claiming the portfolio interest exemption, such Foreign Lender may provide two (2) duly completed and executed copies of a U.S. Tax Compliance Certificate in form and substance satisfactory to Agent on behalf of each such direct and indirect partner;

 

(C)            any Foreign Lender shall, to the extent it is legally entitled to do so, deliver to Borrowing Agent and Agent (in such number of copies as shall be requested by the recipient) on or prior to the date on which such Foreign Lender becomes a Payee under this Agreement (and from time to time thereafter upon the reasonable request of Borrowing Agent or Agent), executed copies of any other form prescribed by Applicable Law as a basis for claiming exemption from or a reduction in U.S. federal withholding Tax, duly completed, together with such supplementary documentation as may be prescribed by applicable law to permit Borrowing Agent or Agent to determine the withholding or deduction required to be made;

 

(D)            if a payment to a Payee under this Agreement or any Other Document would be subject to U.S. Federal withholding Taxes imposed by FATCA if such Payee were to fail to comply with the applicable reporting requirements of FATCA (including those contained in Section 1471(b) or 1472(b) of the Code, as applicable), such Payee shall deliver to Borrowing Agent and Agent at the time or times prescribed by law and at such time or times reasonably requested by Borrowing Agent or Agent such documentation prescribed by applicable law (including as prescribed by Section 1471(b)(3)(C)(i) of the Code) and such additional documentation reasonably requested by Borrowing Agent or Agent as may be necessary for Credit Parties and Agent to comply with their obligations under FATCA and to determine that such Payee has complied with such Payee’s obligations under FATCA or to determine the amount to deduct and withhold from such payment. Solely for purposes of this clause (D), “FATCA” shall include any amendments made to FATCA after the date of this Agreement; and

 

58 

 

 

(E)            Any Agent that is not a U.S. Person shall, at the time such Agent becomes a party to this Agreement, provide to the Borrowing Agent two duly-signed properly completed copies of (1) IRS Form W-8ECI, or any successor thereto with respect to payments, if any, received by the Agent for its own account, and (2) with respect to payments received on account of any Payee, executed copies of IRS Form W-8IMY (or any successor form) certifying that the Agent is either (a) a “qualified intermediary” and that it assumes primary withholding responsibility under Chapters 3 and 4 of the Code and primary Form 1099 reporting and backup withholding responsibility for payments it receives for the account of others or (b) a “U.S. branch” and that payment it receives for others are not effectively connected with the conduct of a trade or business in the United States and that is using the form as evidence of its agreement to be treated as a U.S. Person with respect to payments associated with the IRS Form W-8IMY.

 

Each Payee agrees that if any form or certification it previously delivered expires or becomes obsolete or inaccurate in any respect, it shall update such form or certification or promptly notify Borrowing Agent and Agent in writing of its legal inability to do so.

 

(h)            Treatment of Certain Refunds. If any party determines, in its sole discretion exercised in good faith, that it has received a refund of any Taxes as to which it has been indemnified pursuant to this Section 3.10 (including by the payment of additional amounts pursuant to this Section 3.10), it shall pay to the indemnifying party an amount equal to such refund (but only to the extent of indemnity payments made under this Section with respect to the Taxes giving rise to such refund), net of all out-of-pocket expenses (including Taxes) of such indemnified party and without interest (other than any interest paid by the relevant Governmental Body with respect to such refund). Such indemnifying party, upon the request of such indemnified party, shall repay to such indemnified party the amount paid over pursuant to this clause (h) (plus any penalties, interest or other charges imposed by the relevant Governmental Body) in the event that such indemnified party is required to repay such refund to such Governmental Body. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this clause (h), in no event will the indemnified party be required to pay any amount to an indemnifying party pursuant to this clause (h) the payment of which would place the indemnified party in a less favorable net after-Tax position than the indemnified party would have been in if the Tax subject to indemnification and giving rise to such refund had not been deducted, withheld or otherwise imposed and the indemnification payments or additional amounts with respect to such Tax had never been paid. This clause shall not be construed to require any indemnified party to make available its Tax returns (or any other information relating to its Taxes that it deems confidential) to the indemnifying party or any other Person.

 

59 

 

 

 

(i)            Survival. Each party’s obligations under this Section 3.10 shall survive the resignation or replacement of Agent or any assignment of rights by, or the replacement of, a Payee, the termination of the commitments and the repayment, satisfaction or discharge of all obligations under this Agreement or any Other Document.

 

3.11            Replacement of Lenders. If any Lender (an “Affected Lender”) (a) makes demand upon any Credit Party for (or if any Credit Party is otherwise required to pay) amounts pursuant to Sections 3.7, 3.9 or 3.10 or (b) is a Defaulting Lender, then such Lender shall use reasonable efforts to mitigate such losses, including in the case of clause (a), by designating a different lending office or Affiliate of such Lender for the funding or booking the Loans hereunder and Borrowing Agent may, within ninety (90) days of receipt of such demand (or the occurrence of such other event causing any Credit Party to be required to pay such compensation) or Lender Default, as the case may be, by notice (a “Replacement Notice”) in writing to Agent and such Affected Lender (i) request the Affected Lender to cooperate with Borrowing Agent in obtaining a replacement Lender who is an Eligible Assignee and is satisfactory to Agent and Borrowing Agent in their sole discretion (the “Replacement Lender”); (ii) request the non-Affected Lenders to acquire and assume all of the Affected Lender’s Advances and Commitment Percentage as provided herein, but none of such Lenders shall be under an obligation to do so; or (iii) designate a Replacement Lender who is an Eligible Assignee and is satisfactory to Agent and Borrowing Agent in their sole discretion. If any satisfactory Replacement Lender shall be obtained, and/or if any one or more of the non-Affected Lenders shall agree to acquire and assume all of the Affected Lender’s Advances and Commitment Percentage, then such Affected Lender shall assign, in accordance with Section 15.3, all of its Advances and Commitment Percentage and other rights and obligations under this Agreement and the Other Documents to such Replacement Lender or non-Affected Lenders, as the case may be, in exchange for payment of the principal amount so assigned and all interest and fees accrued on the amount so assigned, plus all other Obligations then due and payable to the Affected Lender; provided, however, that (A) such assignment shall be without recourse, representation or warranty and shall be on terms and conditions reasonably satisfactory to such Affected Lender and such Replacement Lender and/or non-Affected Lenders, as the case may be, and (B) prior to any such assignment, the Borrowers shall have paid to such Affected Lender all amounts properly demanded and unreimbursed under Sections 3.7 and 3.9. Upon the effective date of such assignment, the Borrowers shall, if requested, issue replacement Notes to such Replacement Lender and/or non-Affected Lenders, as the case may be, and such institution(s) shall become a “Lender” for all purposes under this Agreement and the other Documents.

 

IV. COLLATERAL: GENERAL TERMS.

 

4.1            Security Interest in the Collateral. To secure the prompt payment and performance to Agent and each Lender (and each other holder of any Obligations) of the Obligations, each Credit Party hereby collaterally assigns, pledges and grants to Agent for its benefit and for the ratable benefit of each Lender a continuing security interest in and to and Lien on all of its Collateral, whether now owned or existing or hereafter created, acquired or arising and wherever located. Each Credit Party shall mark its books and records as may be necessary or appropriate to evidence and perfect Agent’s security interest and shall cause its financial statements to reflect such security interest. Each Credit Party shall promptly provide Agent with written notice of all commercial tort claims, such notice to contain the case title together with the applicable court and a brief description of the claim(s). Upon delivery of each such notice, such Credit Party shall be deemed to hereby grant to Agent a security interest and lien in and to such commercial tort claims and all proceeds thereof.

 

60

 

 

4.2            Creation and Perfection of Security Interest.

 

(a)            This Agreement and the Other Documents are effective to create in favor of Agent, for the ratable benefit of Lenders and the other holders of the Obligations, a legal, valid and enforceable security interest in the Collateral identified therein, except to the extent the enforceability thereof may be limited by applicable Debtor Relief Laws affecting creditors’ rights generally and by equitable principles of law (regardless of whether enforcement is sought in equity or at law), and this Agreement and the Other Documents shall create a fully perfected Lien on, and security interest in, all right, title and interest of the obligors thereunder in such Collateral, in each case prior and superior in right to any other Lien (other than Permitted Encumbrances) (i) with respect to any such Collateral that is a “security” (as such term is defined in the Uniform Commercial Code) and is evidenced by a certificate, when such Collateral is delivered to Agent with duly executed stock powers with respect thereto, (ii) with respect to any such Collateral that is a “security” (as such term is defined in the Uniform Commercial Code) but is not evidenced by a certificate, when UCC financing statements in appropriate form are filed in the appropriate filing offices in the jurisdiction of organization of the pledgor or when “control” (as such term is defined in the Uniform Commercial Code) is established by Agent over such interests in accordance with the provision of Section 8-106 of the Uniform Commercial Code, or any successor provision, (iii) with respect to any such Collateral that is not a “security” (as such term is defined in the Uniform Commercial Code), when UCC financing statements in appropriate form are filed in the appropriate filing offices in the jurisdiction of organization of the pledgor (to the extent such security interest can be perfected by filing under the Uniform Commercial Code) and (iv) with respect to any such Collateral that is Intellectual Property, when intellectual property security agreements are recorded with the United States Patent and Trademark Office and the United States Copyright Office, together with the financing statements set forth in clause (iii).

 

(b)            Each Credit Party shall take all action that may be necessary or that Agent may request in its Permitted Discretion, so as at all times to maintain the validity, perfection, enforceability and priority of Agent’s security interest in and Lien on the Collateral or to enable Agent to protect, exercise or enforce its rights hereunder and in the Collateral including, but not limited to, (i) promptly discharging all Liens other than Permitted Encumbrances, (ii) using commercially reasonable efforts to obtain Lien Waiver Agreements to the extent required under Section 4.5(c), (iii) delivering to Agent, endorsed or accompanied by such instruments of assignment as Agent may specify, and stamping or marking, in such manner as Agent may specify, any and all chattel paper, instruments (other than those deposited for collection), letters of credit and advices thereof and documents evidencing or forming a part of the Collateral, in each case with a face value in excess of $250,000, individually and in the aggregate, (iv) reserved, and (v) executing and delivering financing statements, Control Agreements, instruments of pledge, mortgages, notices and assignments, in each case in form and substance satisfactory to Agent in its Permitted Discretion, relating to the creation, validity, perfection, maintenance or continuation of Agent’s security interest and Lien under the Uniform Commercial Code or other Applicable Law. By its signature hereto, each Credit Party hereby authorizes Agent to file against such Credit Party, one or more financing, continuation or amendment statements pursuant to the Uniform Commercial Code in form and substance satisfactory to Agent (which statements may have a description of collateral which is broader than that set forth herein, including without limitation a description of Collateral as “all assets” and/or “all personal property” of any Credit Party). All charges, expenses and fees Agent may incur in doing any of the foregoing, and any local filing, recording, documentary or similar taxes relating thereto, shall be charged to Borrowers’ Account as an Advance and added to the Obligations, or, at Agent’s option, shall be paid to Agent for its benefit and for the ratable benefit of Lenders immediately upon demand. Notwithstanding the foregoing, no Credit Party shall be required to undertake any Excluded Perfection Action.

 

61

 

 

4.3            [Reserved].

 

4.4            Preservation of Collateral. Following the occurrence and during the continuance of an Event of Default, in addition to the rights and remedies set forth in Section 11.1 hereof, Agent: (a) may at any time take such steps as Agent deems reasonably necessary to protect Agent’s interest in and to preserve the Collateral and (b) shall have, and is hereby granted, a right of ingress and egress to the places where the Collateral is located to take possession of all or any part of the Collateral and to remove all or any part of the Collateral. Each Credit Party shall cooperate all of Agent’s reasonable efforts to preserve the Collateral and will take such actions to preserve the Collateral as Agent may reasonably direct. All of Agent’s expenses of preserving the Collateral shall be charged to Borrowers’ Account as an Advance and added to the Obligations.

 

4.5            Ownership of Collateral.

 

(a)            Each of the Credit Parties and its Subsidiaries has (i) good, sufficient and legal title to (in the case of fee interests in Real Property), (ii) valid leasehold interests in (in the case of leasehold interests in real or personal property), and (iii) good title to (in the case of all other personal property), all of their respective properties and assets reflected in their financial statements and other information referred to in Section 5.9 and in the most recent financial statements delivered pursuant to Sections 9.7, 9.8 and 9.9, in each case except for assets disposed of since the date of such financial statements as permitted under Section 7.1(b). All such properties and assets are free and clear of Liens other than Permitted Encumbrances. With respect to the Collateral, at the time the Collateral becomes subject to Agent’s security interest: (i) a Credit Party shall have rights in or be the sole owner of and fully authorized and able to sell, transfer, pledge and/or grant a first priority (subject only to Permitted Encumbrances) security interest in each and every item of its Collateral to Agent; (ii) each document and agreement executed by each Credit Party or delivered to Agent or any Lender in connection with this Agreement shall be true and correct in all material respects; (iii) all signatures and endorsements of each Credit Party that appear on such documents and agreements shall be genuine and such Credit Party shall have full capacity to execute same; and (iv) each Credit Party’s Equipment with a value in excess of $100,000 shall be located as of the Closing Date (and as updated pursuant to Sections 4.5 and 9.11(b)) as set forth on Schedule 4.5 and shall not be removed from such location(s) without the prior written consent of Agent; except (A) with respect to the sale of Inventory in the ordinary course of business and Equipment to the extent permitted in Section 7.1 hereof; and (B) for items in transit between Credit Parties’ locations, items out for repair, items provided to employees in the ordinary course of business and samples for customers.

 

62

 

 

(b)            [Reserved].

 

(c)            Notwithstanding anything contained herein to the contrary and without limiting anything contained herein, Borrowers shall use commercially reasonable efforts to deliver or cause to be delivered to Agent duly executed Lien Waiver Agreements in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to Agent with respect to (w) 1233 West Loop South, Suite 1170, Houston, Texas 77027, (x) 716 Congress Avenue. Suite 100, Austin, Texas 78701, (y) each other Real Property that has Collateral with a book or fair market value (whichever is greater) in excess of $250,000 stored or located therein and (z) upon the reasonable request of Agent, any other leased locations where corporate records are maintained.

 

4.6            Defense of Agent’s and Lenders’ Interests. Until (a) payment and performance in full of all of the Obligations (other than Inchoate Obligations) and (b) termination of all obligations of Agent and the Lenders to make any Advances hereunder and termination of this Agreement, Agent’s interests in the Collateral shall continue in full force and effect. During such period no Credit Party shall, without Agent’s prior written consent, pledge, sell (except Inventory in the ordinary course of business and other Collateral to the extent not constituting an Asset Sale), assign, transfer, create or suffer to exist a Lien upon or encumber or allow or suffer to be encumbered in any way except for Permitted Encumbrances and except as permitted by Section 7.1, any part of the Collateral. Each Borrower shall use commercially reasonable efforts to defend Agent’s interests in any material portion of the Collateral against any and all Persons whatsoever. At any time following demand by Agent for payment of all Obligations after the occurrence and during the continuance of an Event of Default, Agent shall have the right to take possession of the indicia of the Collateral and the Collateral in whatever physical form contained, including: labels, stationery, documents, instruments and advertising materials. If Agent exercises this right to take possession of the Collateral, each Borrower shall, upon demand, assemble it in the manner requested by Agent, to the extent commercially reasonable, and make it available to Agent at a place reasonably convenient to Agent. In addition, with respect to all Collateral, at all times following the occurrence and during the continuance of an Event of Default, Agent and Lenders shall be entitled to all of the rights and remedies set forth herein and further provided by the Uniform Commercial Code or other Applicable Law. Following the occurrence and during the continuance of an Event of Default, Agent may, at its option, instruct all suppliers, carriers, forwarders, warehousers or others receiving or holding cash, checks, documents or instruments in which Agent holds a security interest to deliver same to Agent and/or subject to Agent’s order and if they shall come into such Credit Party’s possession, they, and each of them, shall be held by such Credit Party in trust as Agent’s trustee, and such Credit Party will promptly deliver them to Agent in their original form together with any necessary endorsement.

 

63

 

 

4.7            Books and Records. Each Credit Party shall keep proper books of record and account in which full, true and correct entries shall be made of all dealings or transactions in relation to its business and activities to the extent necessary to prepare the financial statements of DDH and its Subsidiaries, on a Consolidated Basis, in conformity with GAAP consistently applied in the opinion of such independent public accountant as shall then be regularly engaged by DDH.

 

4.8            Financial Disclosure. Subject to applicable federal and state securities laws, each Credit Party hereby irrevocably authorizes and directs all accountants and auditors employed by such Credit Party at any time during the Term to deliver to Agent copies of any Credit Party’s financial statements, trial balances or other accounting records of any sort in the accountant’s or auditor’s possession, and to disclose to Agent any information such accountants may have concerning any Credit Party’s financial status and business operations; provided however, Agent will attempt to obtain such information or materials directly from Credit Parties prior to obtaining such information or materials from such accountants. Subject to applicable federal and state securities laws, each Credit Party hereby authorizes all Governmental Bodies to furnish to Agent copies of reports or examinations relating to any Credit Party, whether made by such Credit Party or otherwise; provided however, Agent will attempt to obtain such information or materials directly from Credit Parties prior to obtaining such information or materials from such Governmental Bodies.

 

4.9            Compliance with Laws. Each Credit Party shall comply, and shall cause each of its Subsidiaries to comply, with (a) all Anti-Terrorism Laws, and (b) all other Applicable Laws which noncompliance with, with respect to this clause (b) only, could reasonably be expected to have, individually or in the aggregate, a Material Adverse Effect.

 

4.10            Inspection of Premises. Each Credit Party will, and will cause each of its Subsidiaries to, permit Agent and each Lender and their respective representatives and independent contractors to visit and inspect any of its properties, to conduct field audits and examinations, to examine its corporate, financial and operating records, and make copies thereof or abstracts therefrom, and to discuss its affairs, finances and accounts with its directors, officers, and independent public accountants, all at the expense of Borrowers and at such reasonable times during normal business hours and as often as may be reasonably desired, upon reasonable advance notice to Borrowing Agent (and such Persons shall use commercially reasonable efforts to conduct such visits and inspections in a manner as to minimize interference in the applicable Credit Parties normal operations), provided, however, that so long as no Event of Default exists, without limiting the number of any such visits and/or inspections, Borrowers shall not be obligated to pay for more than two (2) such inspections per year.

 

64

 

 

4.11            Insurance. Subject to Section 6.16(f), the Credit Parties will maintain or cause to be maintained, with financially sound and licensed insurers, property insurance, public liability insurance, cybersecurity insurance, and third party property damage insurance with respect to liabilities, losses or damage in respect of the assets, properties and businesses of each Credit Party and its Subsidiaries as may customarily be carried or maintained under similar circumstances by Persons of established reputation engaged in similar businesses, in each case, in such amounts, with such deductibles, covering such risks and otherwise on such terms and conditions as shall be customary for such Persons. Without limiting the generality of the foregoing, each of Borrower and its Subsidiaries will maintain or cause to be maintained (a) flood insurance with respect to each Flood Hazard Property that is a part of the Collateral, if any, and that is located in a community that participates in the National Flood Insurance Program, in each case (to the extent required) in compliance with any applicable regulations of the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System, and (b) replacement value casualty insurance on the Collateral under such policies of insurance, with such insurance companies, in such amounts, with such deductibles, and covering such risks as are at all times carried or maintained under similar circumstances by Persons of established reputation engaged in similar businesses. Each such policy of insurance shall (i) with respect to liability insurance and cybersecurity insurance, name Agent, on behalf of the holders of the Obligations, as an additional insured thereunder as its interests may appear, and (ii) in the case of each property insurance policy, contain a loss payable clause or endorsement with respect to the Collateral, reasonably satisfactory in form and substance to Agent, that names Agent, on behalf of the holders of the Obligations, as the lender’s loss payee thereunder and provides for at least thirty (30) days’ (or ten (10) days’ in the case of non-payment of premium) prior written notice to Agent of any modification or cancellation of such policy; and which, for the avoidance of doubt, in the case of being added as an additional insured with respect to such liability insurance, shall not limit the ability of the applicable insurance carrier to satisfy any claims that may be payable to a third party on behalf of any Credit Party. Credit Parties shall furnish Agent with copies of all policies and evidence of the maintenance of such policies by the renewal thereof as soon as practicable prior to the expiration date thereof. If any insurance losses are paid by check, draft or other instrument payable to any Credit Party and Agent jointly, Agent may endorse such Credit Party’s name thereon and do such other things as Agent may deem advisable to reduce the same to cash. Following the occurrence and during the continuance of an Event of Default with respect to all claims for insurance proceeds in excess of $250,000, Agent is hereby authorized to adjust and compromise claims under insurance coverage referred to in clause (b) above. All loss recoveries received by Agent upon any such insurance may be applied to the Obligations, in such order as Agent in its Permitted Discretion shall determine during the continuance of an Event of Default and, at all other times as set forth in Section 2.7(a). Any surplus shall be paid by Agent to Borrowing Agent or applied as may be otherwise required by law.

 

4.12            Failure to Pay Insurance. If Credit Parties fail to obtain insurance as hereinabove provided, or to keep the same in force, Agent, if Agent so elects, may obtain such insurance and pay the premium therefor on behalf of Credit Parties, and charge Borrowers’ Account therefor as an Advance and such expenses so paid shall be part of the Obligations.

 

4.13            Payment of Taxes. Each Credit Party will, and will cause each of its Subsidiaries to, pay (a) all federal, state and other material Taxes imposed upon it or any of its properties or assets or in respect of any of its income, businesses or franchises before any penalty or fine accrues thereon and (b) all claims (including claims for labor, services, materials and supplies) for sums that have become due and payable and that by law have or may become a Lien upon any of its properties or assets, prior to the time when any penalty or fine shall be incurred with respect thereto; provided, no such Tax or claim need be paid if it is being contested in good faith by appropriate proceedings promptly instituted and diligently conducted, so long as (i) adequate reserve or other appropriate provision, as shall be required in conformity with GAAP shall have been made therefor, and (ii) in the case of a Tax or claim which has or may become a Lien against any of the Collateral, such contest proceedings conclusively operate to stay the sale of any portion of the Collateral to satisfy such Tax or claim. No Credit Party will, nor will any Credit Party permit any of its Subsidiaries to, file or consent to the filing of any consolidated income tax return with any Person (other than DDH or any Subsidiary of DDH). Subject to the limitations of Section 3.10, if any Tax by any Governmental Body is or may be imposed on or as a result of any transaction between any Credit Party and Agent or any Lender which Agent or any Lender may be required to withhold or pay or if any Taxes, assessments, or other charges remain unpaid after the date fixed for their payment, or if any claim shall be made which, in Agent’s or any Lender’s Permitted Discretion, may possibly create a valid Lien on the Collateral, Agent may without notice to any Credit Party pay the Taxes, assessments or other claims and each Borrower hereby indemnifies and holds Agent and each Lender harmless in respect thereof. Agent will not pay any Taxes, assessments or claims to the extent being contested as set forth in the proviso in the first sentence in this Section 4.13. The amount of any payment by Agent under this Section 4.13 shall be charged to Borrowers’ Account and added to the Obligations and, until Borrowers shall furnish Agent with an indemnity therefor (or supply Agent with evidence satisfactory to Agent that due provision for the payment thereof has been made), Agent may hold without interest any balance standing to Borrowers’ credit and Agent shall retain its security interest in and Lien on any and all Collateral held by Agent.

 

65

 

 

4.14            Payment of Leasehold Obligations. Credit Parties shall at all times pay, when and as due, to the extent failure to pay such amount could result in the termination of such lease, its rental obligations under all leases under which it is a tenant, and shall otherwise comply, in all material respects, with all other terms of such leases and keep them in full force and effect (except for termination of a lease at its scheduled termination date or otherwise in accordance with the terms thereof), to the extent termination of such lease would reasonably result in a Material Adverse Effect.

 

4.15            Receivables.

 

(a)            Nature of Receivables. Each of the Receivables shall be a bona fide and valid account representing a bona fide indebtedness incurred by the Customer therein named, for a fixed sum as set forth in the invoice relating thereto (provided that immaterial or unintentional invoice errors shall not be deemed to be a breach hereof) with respect to the sale or lease and delivery of goods upon stated terms of a Credit Party, or work, labor or services theretofore rendered by a Credit Party as of the date each Receivable is created. Same shall be due and owing in accordance with Credit Party’s standard terms of sale without known dispute, setoff or counterclaim except to the extent that such disputes, setoffs, or counterclaims have been disclosed to Agent to the extent involving an amount in excess of $250,000 individually or in the aggregate.

 

(b)            Solvency of Customers. Each Customer (other than Customers having Receivables not in excess of $250,000 in the aggregate at any time outstanding), to each Credit Party’s actual knowledge, as of the date each Receivable is created, is and will be solvent and able to pay all Receivables on which the Customer is obligated in full when due or with respect to such Customers of Credit Parties who are not, to any Credit Party’s actual knowledge, solvent, the applicable Borrower has set up on its books and in its financial records bad debt reserves adequate to cover such Receivables.

 

(c)            Location of Credit Party. Credit Parties’ chief executive office is set forth on Schedule 4.5; provided, that, Credit Parties may change the location of their chief executive office upon 10 days prior written notice to Agent. Until written notice is given to Agent by Credit Parties of any other office at which any Credit Party keeps its records pertaining to Receivables, all such records shall be kept at such executive office.

 

(d)            Collection of Receivables. Credit Parties shall deposit in a Depository Account or, upon request by Agent, deliver to Agent, in original form and within three (3) Business Days of receipt thereof, all checks, drafts, notes, money orders, acceptances, cash and other evidences of Indebtedness paid in respect of Receivables.

 

66

 

 

(e)            Notification of Assignment of Receivables. At any time during the continuance of an Event of Default, Agent shall have the right to send notice of the assignment of, and Agent’s security interest in and Lien on, the Receivables to any and all Customers or any third party holding or otherwise concerned with any of the Collateral. Agent shall use reasonable efforts to provide notice to Borrowing Agent of the sending of any such notice of assignment, but failure to do so shall not result in any liability to Agent. Thereafter, Agent shall have the sole right to collect the Receivables, take possession of the Collateral, or both. Agent’s actual collection expenses, including, but not limited to, stationery and postage, telephone and telegraph, secretarial and clerical expenses and the salaries of any collection personnel used for collection, may be charged to Borrowers’ Account and added to the Obligations.

 

(f)            Power of Agent to Act on Credit Parties’ Behalf. Agent shall have the right to receive, endorse, assign and/or deliver in the name of Agent or any Credit Party any and all checks, drafts and other instruments for the payment of money relating to the Receivables, and each Credit Party hereby waives notice of presentment, protest and non-payment of any instrument so endorsed. Each Credit Party hereby constitutes Agent or Agent’s designee as such Credit Party’s attorney with power: (i) to endorse such Credit Party’s name upon any notes, acceptances, checks, drafts, money orders or other evidences of payment or Collateral; (ii) to sign such Credit Party’s name on any invoice or bill of lading relating to any of the Receivables, drafts against Customers, assignments and verifications of Receivables; (iii) to send verifications of Receivables to any Customer; (iv) to sign such Credit Party’s name on all financing statements or any other documents or instruments deemed necessary or appropriate by Agent to preserve, protect, or perfect Agent’s interest in the Collateral and to file same; (v) to demand payment of the Receivables; (vi) to enforce payment of the Receivables by legal proceedings or otherwise; (vii) to exercise all of such Credit Party’s rights and remedies with respect to the collection of the Receivables and any other Collateral; (viii) to settle, adjust, compromise, extend or renew the Receivables; (ix) to settle, adjust or compromise any legal proceedings brought to collect Receivables; (x) to prepare, file and sign such Credit Party’s name on a proof of claim in bankruptcy or similar document against any Customer; (xi) to prepare, file and sign such Credit Party’s name on any notice of Lien, assignment or satisfaction of Lien or similar document in connection with the Receivables; and (xii) to do all other acts and things necessary to carry out this Agreement; provided, however, Agent shall only exercise the rights described in clauses (i), (ii), (v), (vi), (vii), (viii), (ix) and (xi) upon the occurrence and during the continuance of an Event of Default. All acts of said attorney or designee are hereby ratified and approved, and said attorney or designee shall not be liable for any acts of omission or commission nor for any error of judgment or mistake of fact or of law, unless done maliciously or with gross (not mere) negligence (as determined by a court of competent jurisdiction in a final non-appealable judgment); this power being coupled with an interest is irrevocable while any of the Obligations (other than Inchoate Obligations) remain unpaid. Agent shall have the right at any time following the occurrence and during the continuance of an Event of Default, to change the address for delivery of mail addressed to any Credit Party to such address as Agent may designate and to receive, open and dispose of all mail addressed to any Credit Party.

 

67

 

 

(g)            No Liability. Neither Agent nor any Lender shall, under any circumstances or in any event whatsoever, have any liability for any error or omission or delay of any kind occurring in the settlement, collection or payment of any of the Receivables or any instrument received in payment thereof, or for any damage resulting therefrom. Following the occurrence and during the continuance of an Event of Default, Agent may, without notice or consent from any Credit Party, sue upon or otherwise collect, extend the time of payment of, compromise or settle for cash, credit or upon any terms any of the Receivables or any other securities, instruments or insurance applicable thereto and/or release any obligor thereof. Following the occurrence and during the continuance of an Event of Default, Agent is authorized and empowered to accept the return of the goods represented by any of the Receivables, all without discharging or in any way affecting any Credit Party’s liability hereunder. Agent shall use reasonable efforts to notify the applicable Credit Party of any such acceptance of returned goods, but shall have no liability for any failure to do so.

 

(h)            Cash Management; Payment Mechanics.

 

(i)            The Credit Parties shall direct each of their Customers to remit all payments on Receivables to, and Credit Parties shall deposit all cash, checks, notes instruments and other funds or items of payment received by such Credit Party from time to time to, depository accounts (“Depository Accounts”) established at ABL Lender or such other depository approved by Agent in its reasonable discretion for the deposit of such amounts.

 

(ii)            As of the Closing Date, all deposit accounts and investment accounts of DDH and its Subsidiaries are set forth on Schedule 4.15(h). Each Credit Party will notify Agent in writing at least five (5) Business Days prior to the establishment of any deposit accounts or investment accounts not set forth on Schedule 4.15(h). Subject to Section 6.16 hereof, the Credit Parties shall deliver to Agent Control Agreements with respect to all deposit accounts of the Credit Parties (including without limitation, the Depository Accounts, but excluding any Excluded Deposit Accounts).

 

(iii)            On or before the Closing Date, Borrowing Agent shall have established a deposit account at a depository approved by Agent in its reasonable discretion for the purpose of receiving proceeds of the Advances (the “Funding Account”).

 

(i)            Adjustments. No Borrower will, without Agent’s consent, compromise or adjust any Receivables (or extend the time for payment thereof) or accept any returns of merchandise or grant any additional discounts, allowances or credits thereon except for compromises, adjustments, returns, discounts, credits and allowances in the ordinary course of business of Borrowers.

 

4.16            Pledge of Personal Property Assets.

 

(a)            Each Credit Party shall cause one hundred percent (100%) of the issued and outstanding Equity Interests of each Subsidiary of DDH to be subject at all times to a first priority lien (subject to any Permitted Encumbrance) in favor of Agent pursuant to the terms and conditions of this Agreement and the Other Documents, together with opinions of counsel and any filings and deliveries or other items reasonably requested by Agent necessary in connection therewith (to the extent not delivered on the Closing Date) to perfect the security interests therein, all in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to Agent.

 

68

 

 

(b)            Each Credit Party shall (i) cause all of its owned personal property (other than Excluded Property) to be subject at all times to first priority (subject to any Permitted Encumbrances), perfected Liens in favor of Agent to secure the Obligations pursuant to the terms and conditions of this Agreement and the Other Documents or, with respect to any such property acquired subsequent to the Closing Date, such other additional security documents as Agent shall reasonably request, subject in any case to Permitted Encumbrances and (ii) deliver such other documentation as Agent may reasonably request in connection with the foregoing, including, without limitation, appropriate Control Agreements, UCC-1 financing statements, certified resolutions and other organizational and authorizing documents of such Person, opinions of counsel to such Person (which shall cover, among other things, the legality, validity, binding effect and enforceability of the documentation referred to above and the perfection of Agent’s Liens thereunder) and other items reasonably requested by Agent necessary in connection therewith to perfect the security interests therein, all in form, content and scope reasonably satisfactory to Agent.

 

4.17            Maintenance of Equipment. Each Credit Party shall, and shall cause each of its Subsidiaries to, maintain or cause to be maintained in good repair, working order and condition, ordinary wear and tear excepted, all material properties used or useful in the business of any Credit Party and its Subsidiaries and from time to time will make or cause to be made all appropriate repairs, renewals and replacements thereof substantially in accordance with such Credit Party’s past business practices.

 

4.18            Exculpation of Liability. Nothing herein contained shall be construed to constitute Agent, any Lender or any of their respective officers, directors, Affiliates, attorneys, employees or agents as any Borrower’s agent for any purpose whatsoever, nor shall Agent, any Lender or any of their respective officers, directors, Affiliates, attorneys, employees or agents be responsible or liable for any shortage, discrepancy, damage, loss or destruction of any part of the Collateral wherever the same may be located and regardless of the cause thereof, except to the extent arising out of the gross negligence or willful misconduct of Agent or any Lender. Neither Agent nor any Lender, whether by anything herein or in any assignment or otherwise, assume any of any Borrower’s obligations under any contract or agreement assigned to Agent or such Lender, and neither Agent nor any Lender shall be responsible in any way for the performance by any Borrower of any of the terms and conditions thereof.

 

4.19            Environmental Matters.

 

(a)            Each Credit Party will deliver to Agent with reasonable promptness, such documents and information with respect to any material Environmental Claim as from time to time may be reasonably requested by Agent.

 

(b)            Each Credit Party shall promptly take, and shall cause each of its Subsidiaries promptly to take, any and all actions necessary to (i) cure any violation of applicable Environmental Laws by such Credit Party or its Subsidiaries that would reasonably be expected to have, individually or in the aggregate, a Material Adverse Effect, and (ii) respond to any Environmental Claim against such Credit Party or any of its Subsidiaries and discharge any obligations it may have to any Person thereunder where failure to do so would reasonably be expected to have, individually or in the aggregate, a Material Adverse Effect.

 

69

 

 

(c)            In the event any Borrower obtains, gives or receives notice of any Release or threat of Release of a reportable quantity of any Hazardous Materials at the Real Property (any such event being hereinafter referred to as a “Hazardous Discharge”) or receives any request for information or notification that it is potentially responsible for investigation or cleanup of environmental conditions at the Real Property or other written notice with regard to any Hazardous Discharge or any other Environmental Claim (any of the foregoing is referred to herein as an “Environmental Complaint”) from any Person, including any state agency responsible in whole or in part for environmental matters in the state in which the Real Property is located or the United States Environmental Protection Agency (any such Person hereinafter the “Authority”), then Borrowers shall, within ten (10) Business Days, give written notice of same to Agent detailing facts and circumstances of which any Borrower is aware giving rise to the Hazardous Discharge or Environmental Complaint. Such information is to be provided to allow Agent to protect its security interest in and Lien on the Real Property and the Collateral and is not intended to create nor shall it create any obligation upon Agent or any Lender with respect thereto.

 

(d)            Borrowers shall respond promptly to any Hazardous Discharge or Environmental Complaint, except where failure to do so could not reasonably be expected to result in material liability to any Borrower, and take all commercially reasonable action in order to safeguard the health of any Person and to avoid subjecting the Collateral or Real Property to any Lien (other than Permitted Encumbrances). If Borrowers shall fail to respond promptly to any Hazardous Discharge or Environmental Complaint or Borrowers shall fail to comply with any of the requirements of any Environmental Laws, Agent on behalf of Lenders may, but without the obligation to do so, for the sole purpose of protecting Agent’s interest in the Collateral: (i) give such notices or (ii) enter onto the Real Property (or authorize third parties to enter onto the Real Property) and take such actions as Agent (or such third parties as directed by Agent) deem reasonably necessary, to clean up, remove, mitigate or otherwise deal with any such Hazardous Discharge or Environmental Complaint. All reasonable, documented out-of-pocket costs and expenses incurred by Agent and Lenders (or such third parties) in the exercise of any such rights, including any sums paid in connection with any judicial or administrative investigation or proceedings, fines and penalties shall be paid upon demand by Borrowers, and until paid shall be added to and become a part of the Obligations secured by the Liens created by the terms of this Agreement or any other agreement between Agent, any Lender and any Borrower.

 

(e)            [Reserved].

 

(f)            For purposes of Sections 4.19 and 5.7, all references to Real Property shall be deemed to include all of each Borrower’s right, title and interest in and to its owned and leased premises.

 

4.20            Financing Statements. To the knowledge of the Credit Parties, except for the financing statements filed by Agent and the financing statements evidencing Permitted Encumbrances, no financing statement covering any of the Collateral or any proceeds thereof is on file in any public office.

 

70

 

 

4.21            Key Executive Policy. Promptly, but in any event within one hundred twenty (120) days of the Closing Date, as further security for the payment of the Obligations and the satisfaction by Borrowers of all covenants and undertakings contained in this Agreement and the Other Documents, the Borrows shall use commercially reasonable efforts to deliver, for the benefit of Agent and Lenders, a collateral assignment of a key executive life insurance policy owned by Borrowers insuring the life of Keith Smith and Mark Walker in the amount of not less than $5,000,000 for each such Person (and an aggregate amount of not less than $10,000,000) issued by an insurer acceptable to Agent in its sole discretion (such policy, the “Key Executive Policy”), and in connection therewith, within such period, Borrowers shall deliver to Agent all forms and agreements required by the insurer issuing the Key Executive Policy in order to have such assignment of the Key Executive Policy in favor of Agent, for itself and for the benefit of Lenders, acknowledged and reflected on the records of such insurer (all of which such forms shall have been executed by Borrowers and any other party necessary thereto); provided, that no Default or Event of Default shall occur if the Borrowers are unable to obtain coverage in the amounts or on the terms described herein or if premiums on any such policy exceed a commercially reasonable amount. Nothing contained in the foregoing or in any such forms and agreements required by the insurer shall be construed in any way to contradict or limit (but only to expand and extend) the grant of a security interest and Lien by Borrowers in all now existing and hereafter arising General Intangibles and insurance policies provided for in Section 4.1 above.

 

V. REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES.

 

Each Credit Party represents and warrants as follows:

 

5.1            Organization; Requisite Power and Authority; Qualification. Each Credit Party and its Subsidiaries (a) is duly organized, validly existing and in good standing under the laws of its jurisdiction of organization as identified in Schedule 5.1, (b) has all requisite power and authority to own and operate its properties, to carry on its business as now conducted and as proposed to be conducted, to enter into this Agreement and the Other Documents to which it is a party and to carry out the transactions contemplated thereby, and (c) is qualified to do business and in good standing in every jurisdiction where necessary to carry out its business and operations, except in jurisdictions where the failure to be so qualified or in good standing has not had, and could not be reasonably expected to have, a Material Adverse Effect.

 

5.2            Equity Interests and Ownership.

 

(a)            Schedule 5.2(a) correctly sets forth the ownership interest of each Credit Party and each Credit Party’s Subsidiaries, in each case as of the Closing Date. The Equity Interests of each Credit Party and its Subsidiaries have been duly authorized and validly issued and are fully paid and non-assessable (except with respect to limited liability company interests). Except as set forth on Schedule 5.2(a) as of the Closing Date, there is no existing option, warrant, call, right, commitment, buy-sell, voting trust, contribution agreement or other shareholder agreement or other agreement with respect to any Credit Party or any Subsidiary, and there is no membership interest or other Equity Interests of any Credit Party or any Subsidiary outstanding which upon conversion or exchange would require, the issuance by any Credit Party, or any Subsidiary of any additional membership interests or other Equity Interests of any Credit Party or any Subsidiary or other Securities convertible into, exchangeable for or evidencing the right to subscribe for or purchase, a membership interest or other Equity Interests of any Credit Party or any Subsidiary.

 

71

 

 

(b)            The only Subsidiaries of each Credit Party are listed on Schedule 5.2(b).

 

5.3            Due Authorization. The execution, delivery and performance of this Agreement and the Other Documents have been duly authorized by all necessary action on the part of each Credit Party that is a party hereto or thereto.

 

5.4            No Conflict. The execution, delivery and performance by Credit Parties of this Agreement and the Other Documents to which they are parties and the consummation of the transactions contemplated by this Agreement and the Other Documents do not and will not (a) violate in any material respect any provision of any Applicable Laws relating to any Credit Party, any of the Governing Documents of any Credit Party, or any order, judgment or decree of any court or other agency of government binding on any Credit Party; (b) conflict with, result in a breach of or constitute (with due notice or lapse of time or both) a default under any material Contractual Obligations of any Credit Party (including the ABL Loan Documents); (c) result in or require the creation or imposition of any Lien upon any of the properties or assets of any Credit Party (other than any Liens created under this Agreement or any of the Other Documents in favor of Agent) whether now owned or hereafter acquired; or (d) require any approval of stockholders, members or partners or any approval or consent of any Person under any Governing Document or any other material Contractual Obligation of any Credit Party, in each case except for any such approval or consent that has been duly obtained.

 

5.5            Governmental Consents. The execution, delivery and performance by the Credit Parties of this Agreement and the Other Documents to which they are parties and the consummation of the transactions contemplated by this Agreement and the Other Documents do not and will not require, as a condition to the effectiveness thereof, any registration with, consent or approval of, or notice to, or other action to, with or by, any Governmental Body except for filings and recordings with respect to the Collateral to be made, or otherwise delivered to Agent for filing and/or recordation, as of the Closing Date and other filings, recordings or consents which have been obtained or made, as applicable.

 

5.6            Binding Obligations. Each of this Agreement and each Other Document has been duly executed and delivered by each Credit Party that is a party thereto and is the legally valid and binding obligation of such Credit Party enforceable against such Credit Party in accordance with its respective terms, except as may be limited by Debtor Relief Laws or by equitable principles relating to enforceability.

 

5.7            No Material Adverse Effect; No Default.

 

(a)            Since December 31, 2020, no event, circumstance or change has occurred that has caused or evidences, either in any case or in the aggregate, a Material Adverse Effect.

 

(b)            No Default or Event of Default has occurred and is continuing.

 

72

 

 

5.8            Tax Returns. Each Credit Party and its Subsidiaries have filed all federal, state and other material Tax returns and reports required to be filed or have obtained a valid extension of the deadline for any such returns or reports such that there are no delinquencies for filing, and have paid all federal, state and other material Taxes, assessments, fees and other governmental charges levied or imposed upon them or their respective properties, assets, income, businesses and franchises otherwise due and payable, except those being actively contested in good faith and by appropriate proceedings and for which adequate reserves have been provided in accordance with GAAP. There is no proposed Tax assessment against any Credit Party or any of its Subsidiaries that would, if made, have a Material Adverse Effect. 

 

5.9            Financial Statements.

 

(a)            The balance sheet of DDH and its Subsidiaries prepared on a Consolidated Basis for the most recent Fiscal Year ended and the related statements of income, equity and cash flows prepared on a Consolidated Basis for such Fiscal Year, including the notes thereto (i) were prepared in accordance with GAAP consistently applied throughout the period covered thereby (except as otherwise noticed in the Quality of Earnings Report); (ii) fairly present the financial condition of DDH and its Subsidiaries in all material respects as of the date thereof and their results of operations for the period covered thereby, in each case, on a Consolidated Basis, in accordance with GAAP consistently applied throughout the period covered thereby (except as otherwise noticed in the Quality of Earnings Report); and (iii) show all material indebtedness and other liabilities, direct or contingent, of DDH and its Subsidiaries as of the date thereof, including liabilities for taxes, material commitments and Indebtedness, to the extent required to be included thereon in accordance with GAAP.

 

(b)            The audited balance sheet of DDH and its Subsidiaries prepared on a Consolidated Basis as of December 31, 2020, and the related statements of income, equity and cash flows prepared on a Consolidated Basis for such Fiscal Quarter (i) were prepared in accordance with GAAP consistently applied throughout the period covered thereby, except as otherwise expressly noted therein, (ii) fairly present the financial condition of DDH and its Subsidiaries in all material respects as of the date thereof and their results of operations for the period covered thereby, in each case, on a Consolidated Basis, subject, in the case of clauses (i) and (ii), to the absence of footnotes and to normal year-end audit adjustments, except as otherwise expressly noted therein and (iii) show all material indebtedness and other liabilities, direct or contingent, of DDH and its Subsidiaries as of the date of such financial statements, including liabilities for taxes, material commitments and Indebtedness to the extent required to be included thereon in accordance with GAAP.

 

(c)            The pro forma consolidated balance sheet of DDH and its Subsidiaries (the “Pro Forma Balance Sheet”) furnished to Agent on the date hereof reflects the consummation of the Closing Date Transactions and fairly presents in all material respects the financial condition of DDH and its Subsidiaries as of October 31, 2021, after giving pro forma effect to the Closing Date Transactions as if the Closing Date Transactions occurred on such date.

 

(d)            The four quarter consolidated cash flow projections of DDH and its Subsidiaries delivered by DDH as of the Closing Date (the “Projections”) were prepared by DDH based upon estimates and assumptions that DDH believes to be reasonable and fair on the Closing Date in light of present circumstances and, as of the Closing Date, reflected DDH’s good faith estimates of the future financial performance of DDH and its Subsidiaries on a consolidated basis and of the other information projected therein for the periods set forth therein. Notwithstanding the foregoing, it is understood that such Projections were and remain subject to uncertainties and contingencies, many of which are beyond the control of DDH or any of its Subsidiaries, and that no assurance can be given that such Projections will actually be realized. The Projections together with the Pro Forma Balance Sheet, are referred to as the “Pro Forma Financial Statements”.

 

73

 

 

(e)            The forecasted balance sheet and statements of income and cash flows of DDH and its Subsidiaries delivered pursuant to Section 9.12 were prepared in good faith on the basis of the assumptions stated therein, which assumptions were fair in light of the conditions existing at the time of delivery of such forecasts, and represented, at the time of delivery, DDH’s best estimate of its future financial condition and performance.

 

5.10            Information Regarding the Credit Parties and their Subsidiaries. Set forth on Schedule 5.10, is the jurisdiction of organization, the exact legal name (and for the prior five (5) years or since the date of its formation has been) and the true and correct U.S. taxpayer identification number (or foreign equivalent, if any) of each Credit Party and each of its Subsidiaries as of the Closing Date.

 

5.11            Environmental Matters; O.S.H.A..

 

(a)            Each Credit Party is in compliance with, and its facilities, business, assets, property, leaseholds, Real Property and Equipment are in compliance with, the Federal Occupational Safety and Health Act in all material respects and Environmental Laws, and there are no material outstanding citations, notices or orders of non-compliance issued to any Credit Party or relating to its business, assets, property, leaseholds or Equipment under any such laws, rules or regulations.

 

(b)            No Credit Party nor any of its Subsidiaries nor any of their respective current Real Property (solely during and with respect to such Person’s ownership thereof) or operations, and to their knowledge, no former Real Property (solely during and with respect to any Credit Party’s or its Subsidiary’s ownership thereof), are subject to any outstanding order, consent decree or settlement agreement with any Person relating to any Environmental Law, any Environmental Claim, or any Hazardous Materials Activity that, individually or in the aggregate, could reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.

 

(c)            No Credit Party nor any of its Subsidiaries has received any letter or request for information under Section 104 of CERCLA or any comparable state law.

 

(d)            There are and, to each Credit Party’s and its Subsidiaries’ knowledge, have been, no Hazardous Materials Activities which could reasonably be expected to form the basis of an Environmental Claim against such Credit Party or any of its Subsidiaries that, individually or in the aggregate, could reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.

 

(e)            No Credit Party nor any of its Subsidiaries has filed any notice under any Environmental Law indicating past or present treatment of Hazardous Materials at any Real Property owned or leased by such Person (solely during and with respect to such Credit Party’s or its Subsidiary’s ownership thereof), and no Credit Party’s nor any of its Subsidiaries’ operations involves the generation, transportation, treatment, storage or disposal of hazardous waste, as defined under 40 C.F.R. Parts 260-270 or any equivalent state rule defining hazardous waste, in each case, except in material compliance with Environmental Law. Compliance with all current requirements pursuant to or under Environmental Laws could not be reasonably expected to have, individually or in the aggregate, a Material Adverse Effect.

 

74

 

 

5.12            Solvency; No Litigation, Violation, Indebtedness or Default.

 

(a)            After giving effect to the Closing Date Transactions, DDH and its Subsidiaries taken as a whole on a Consolidated Basis are, and, upon the incurrence of any Advance on any date on which this representation and warranty is made or deemed made, will be, Solvent.

 

(b)            There are no Adverse Proceedings that (i) as of the date hereof purport to affect or pertain to this Agreement or any Other Document, or any of the transactions contemplated hereby or (ii) could reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect. No Credit Party nor any of its Subsidiaries is subject to or in default with respect to any final judgments, writs, injunctions, decrees, rules or regulations of any Governmental Body that, individually or in the aggregate, could reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.

 

(c)            Each Credit Party and its Subsidiaries is in compliance with (i) the USA PATRIOT Act and OFAC rules and regulations as provided in Sections 5.29 and 5.30 and (ii) except such non-compliance with such other Applicable Laws that, individually or in the aggregate, could not reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect, all other Applicable Laws.

 

(d)            (i) Except as could not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect, each of the Credit Parties and their Subsidiaries are in compliance with all applicable provisions and requirements of ERISA and the Code and the regulations and published interpretations thereunder with respect to each Pension Plan, and have performed all their obligations under each Pension Plan in all material respects, (ii) each Pension Plan which is intended to qualify under Section 401(a) of the Code has received a favorable determination letter or is the subject of a favorable opinion letter from the Internal Revenue Service indicating that such Pension Plan is so qualified and, to the best knowledge of the Credit Parties, nothing has occurred subsequent to the issuance of such determination letter which would cause such Pension Plan to lose its qualified status except where such event could not reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect, (iii) except as could not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect, no liability to the PBGC (other than required premium payments), the Internal Revenue Service, any Pension Plan (other than for routine claims and required funding obligations in the ordinary course) or any trust established under Title IV of ERISA has been incurred by any Credit Party, any of its Subsidiaries or any of their ERISA Affiliates, (iv) except as would not reasonably be expected to result in liability to any Credit Party or any of its Subsidiaries in excess of $500,000, no ERISA Event has occurred, and (v) except to the extent required under Section 4980B of the Code and Section 601 et seq. of ERISA or similar state laws and except as could not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect, no Pension Plan provides health or welfare benefits (through the purchase of insurance or otherwise) for any retired or former employee of any Credit Party or any of its Subsidiaries.

 

75

 

 

5.13            Patents, Trademarks, Copyrights and Licenses. As of the Closing Date, all registered or material patents, patent applications, trademarks, trademark applications, service marks, service mark applications, copyrights, copyright applications, design rights, tradenames and material licenses therefor owned or utilized by any Credit Party are set forth on Schedule 5.13. Each Credit Party and its Subsidiaries owns or is validly licensed to use all Intellectual Property that is necessary for the present conduct of its business, free and clear of Liens (other than Permitted Encumbrances), without conflict with the rights of any other Person unless the failure to own or benefit from such valid license could not, individually or in the aggregate, reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect. To the knowledge of each Credit Party, no Credit Party nor any of its Subsidiaries is infringing, misappropriating, diluting, or otherwise violating the Intellectual Property rights of any other Person unless such infringement, misappropriation, dilution or violation could not, individually or in the aggregate, reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.

 

5.14            Licenses, Permits and Other Approvals. Each Credit Party (a) is in compliance with and (b) has procured and is now in possession of, all material licenses or permits required by any applicable federal, state, provincial or local law, rule or regulation for the operation of its business in each jurisdiction wherein it is now conducting or proposes to conduct business, except where the failure to so comply or procure such licenses or permits could not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.

 

5.15            Default of Indebtedness. No Credit Party or Subsidiary thereof is in default in the payment of the principal of or interest on any Indebtedness of $250,000 or more in principal amount (in the aggregate for all Credit Parties and Subsidiaries) and no such Indebtedness has been accelerated.

 

5.16            No Default. No Credit Party nor any of its Subsidiaries is in default in the performance, observance or fulfillment of any of the obligations, covenants or conditions contained in any of its Contractual Obligations (other than Contractual Obligations relating to Indebtedness) where the consequences, direct or indirect, of such default or defaults, if any, could reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.

 

5.17            No Burdensome Restrictions. As of the Closing Date, each Credit Party has heretofore delivered to Agent or provided Agent access to true and complete copies of all Material Contracts to which it is a party or to which it or any of its properties is subject. No Credit Party or Subsidiary thereof has agreed or consented to cause or permit in the future (upon the happening of a contingency or otherwise) any of its property, whether now owned or hereafter acquired, to be subject to a Lien which is not a Permitted Encumbrance.

 

5.18            No Labor Disputes. No Credit Party or any of its Subsidiaries is engaged in any unfair labor practice that could reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect. There is (a) no unfair labor practice complaint pending against any Credit Party or any of its Subsidiaries, or to the best knowledge of each Credit Party, threatened against any of them before the National Labor Relations Board and no grievance or arbitration proceeding arising out of or under any collective bargaining agreement that is so pending against any Credit Party or any of its Subsidiaries or to the best knowledge of each Credit Party, threatened against any of them, (b) no strike or work stoppage in existence or to the knowledge of each Credit Party, threatened that involves any Credit Party or any of its Subsidiaries, and (c) to the best knowledge of each Credit Party, no union representation question existing with respect to the employees of any Credit Party or any of its Subsidiaries and, to the best knowledge of each Credit Party, no union organization activity that is taking place, except (with respect to any matter specified in clause (a), (b) or (c) above, either individually or in the aggregate) such as could not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.

 

76

 

 

5.19            Margin Regulations. Neither any Credit Party nor any of its Subsidiaries is engaged principally, or as one of its important activities, in the business of extending credit for the purpose of purchasing or carrying any Margin Stock. No part of the proceeds of any Term Loan made to such Credit Party will be used (i) to purchase or carry any such Margin Stock or to extend credit to others for the purpose of purchasing or carrying any such Margin Stock or for any purpose that violates, or is inconsistent with, the provisions of Regulation T, U or X of the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System as in effect from time to time or (ii) to finance or refinance any (A) commercial paper issued by such Credit Party or (B) any other Indebtedness, except for Indebtedness that such Credit Party incurred for general corporate or working capital purposes.

 

5.20            Investment Company Act. No Credit Party or any of its Subsidiaries is subject to regulation under the Investment Company Act of 1940. No Credit Party or any of its Subsidiaries is an “investment company” or a company “controlled” by a “registered investment company” or a “principal underwriter” of a “registered investment company” as such terms are defined in the Investment Company Act of 1940.

 

5.21            Disclosure. No representation or warranty of any Credit Party contained in this Agreement or any Other Document or in any other documents, certificates or written statements furnished to Agent or any Lender by or on Behalf of any Credit Party or any of its Subsidiaries for use in connection with the transactions contemplated hereby (other than projections and pro forma financial information contained in such materials) contains any untrue statement of a material fact or omits to state a material fact (known to any Credit Party, in the case of any document not furnished by any of them) necessary in order to make the statements contained herein or therein not misleading in any material manner in light of the circumstances in which the same were made. Any projections and pro forma financial information contained in such materials are based upon good faith estimates and assumptions believed by the Credit Parties to be reasonable at the time made, it being recognized by Agent and Lenders that such projections as to future events are not to be viewed as facts and that actual results during the period or periods covered by any such projections may differ from the projected results and that such differences may be material. There are no facts known to any Credit Party (other than matters of a general economic nature) that, individually or in the aggregate, could reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect and that have not been disclosed herein or in such other documents, certificates and statements furnished to Agent or any Lender.

 

5.22            Delivery of Certain Documents. Agent has received true, correct and complete copies of (a) the material ABL Loan Documents, and (b) any material documents governing or giving rise to any Subordinated Debt (including all exhibits, schedules and disclosure letters referred to in any of the foregoing or delivered pursuant thereto), if any and, in each case, all amendments thereto, waivers relating thereto and other side letters or agreements affecting the terms thereof. None of such documents and agreements has been amended or supplemented, nor have any of the provisions thereof been waived, except, in each case to the extent material to the interests of the Lenders, pursuant to a written agreement or instrument which has heretofore been delivered to Agent.

 

77

 

 

5.23            Swaps. No Credit Party or Subsidiary thereof is a party to, nor will it be a party to, any swap agreement whereby such Credit Party has agreed or will agree to swap interest rates or currencies unless same provides that damages upon termination following an event of default thereunder are payable on an unlimited “two-way basis” without regard to fault on the part of either party.

 

5.24            [Reserved].

 

5.25            [Reserved].

 

5.26            Business and Property of Credit Parties. (i) No Credit Party nor Subsidiary thereof engages in or proposes to engage in any business other than as described on Schedule 5.26, and other activities reasonably related thereto and extensions thereof; (ii) none of DDH, Intermediate Holdco or DDH Holdings (subsequent to a Qualified IPO) has engaged in, and does not engage in, any business activities, own any assets or have any liabilities other than (a) acting as a holding company and transactions incidental thereto, including maintaining policies of insurance with respect to directors and officers liability and other insurable risks customary for similarly situated companies, (b) receiving and distributing Restricted Payments permitted pursuant to the terms hereof, (c) liabilities arising under this Agreement, any Other Document and the ABL Loan Documents to which it is a party, (d) owning the Equity Interests of its Subsidiary, (e) activities, ownership of immaterial assets and contractual rights, in each case, incidental to the foregoing and to the maintenance of its corporate existence, (f) activities required to comply with federal and state securities laws, (g) any obligations under any Acquisition Documents in respect of Permitted Acquisitions, (h) liabilities in respect of the Tax Receivable Agreement, and (i) liabilities in respect of Public Company Costs.

 

5.27            Insurance. The properties of the Credit Parties and their Subsidiaries are insured with financially sound and licensed insurance companies not Affiliates of such Persons to the extent required under Section 4.11. The insurance coverage of the Credit Parties and their Subsidiaries as in effect on the Closing Date is outlined as to carrier, policy number, expiration date, type, amount and deductibles on Schedule 5.27.

 

5.28            [Reserved].

 

5.29            Anti-Terrorism Laws; Anti-Corruption Laws.

 

(a)            Each Credit Party, its Subsidiaries and their respective officers and employees and, to the knowledge of such Credit Party, its directors and agents, are in compliance with applicable Sanctions and are not engaged in any activity that would reasonably be expected to result in any Credit Party being designated as a Sanctioned Person. None of the Credit Parties, their Subsidiaries nor their respective Affiliates is in violation of any of the country or list based economic and trade sanctions administered and enforced by OFAC that are described or referenced at http://www.ustreas.gov/offices/enforcement/ofac/ or as otherwise published from time to time.

 

78

 

 

(b)            None of the Credit Parties or their Subsidiaries or, to the knowledge of each Credit Party or its Subsidiaries, any of their respective directors, officers, employees or Affiliates (i) is a Sanctioned Person, (ii) has any of its assets located in a Sanctioned Country (unless approved by Agent), or (iii) derives any of its operating income from investments in, or transactions with Sanctioned Persons (unless approved by Agent). The proceeds of any Term Loan or other transaction contemplated by this Agreement or any Other Document have not been used (x) in violation of any Sanctions, (y) to fund any operations in, finance any investments or activities in or make any payments to, a Sanctioned Person or a Sanctioned Country or (z) in any other manner that would result in a violation of Sanctions by any Person (including Agent, any Lender and any other Person participation in any Term Loan, whether as an underwriter, advisor, investor or otherwise).

 

(c)            Each of the Credit Parties and each of its Subsidiaries and, to the knowledge of each Credit Party and its Subsidiaries, each of their respective directors, officers, employees and Affiliates, is in compliance with Anti-Corruption Laws. None of the Credit Parties nor their respective Subsidiaries has made a payment, offering, or promise to pay, or authorized the payment of, money or anything of value (i) in order to assist in obtaining or retaining business for or with, or directing business to, any foreign official, foreign political party, party official or candidate for foreign political office, (ii) to a foreign official, foreign political party or party official or any candidate for foreign political office, and (iii) with the intent to induce the recipient to misuse his or her official position to direct business wrongfully to such Credit Party or any of its Subsidiaries or to any other Person, in violation of any Anti-Corruption Law. No part of the proceeds of any Advance or other transaction contemplated by this Agreement or any Other Document will violate Anti-Corruption Laws.

 

(d)            To the extent applicable, each Credit Party and its Subsidiaries are in compliance with the USA PATRIOT Act.

 

5.30            Trading with the Enemy. No Credit Party nor any of its Subsidiaries is an “enemy” or an “ally of the enemy” within the meaning of Section 2 of the Trading with the Enemy Act of the United States of America (50 U.S.C. App. §§ 1 et seq.), as amended. To its knowledge, no Credit Party nor any of its Subsidiaries is in violation of (a) the Trading with the Enemy Act, as amended, (b) any of the foreign assets control regulations of the United States Treasury Department (31 CFR, Subtitle B, Chapter V, as amended) or any enabling legislation or executive order relating thereto or (c) the USA PATRIOT Act. No Credit Party or any of its Subsidiaries (i) is a blocked person described in Section 1 of the Anti-Terrorism Order or (ii) to the best of its knowledge, engages in any dealings or transactions, or is otherwise associated, with any such blocked person.

 

5.31            [Reserved].

 

5.32            [Reserved].

 

5.33            Eligible Impact Service. Each Credit Party agrees that (i) it is not, and shall not be deemed to be, a representation or warranty of Agent or any Lender as to the adequacy of any “Eligible Impact Service”, the provider thereof or any impact thereof and neither Agent nor any Lender has made any such representation or warranty as to such program or service, (ii) it has, independently and without reliance upon Agent or any Lender and based on such documents and information as it has deemed appropriate, made its own appraisal of, and investigation into, each of the Eligible Impact Services and made its own decision as to the Impact Subscription to such Eligible Impact Services (and continue to make each such decision) and (iii) Agent shall have no responsibility to ascertain, inquire into, monitor or enforce any such program or service, any provider thereof or any impact thereof.

 

79

 

 

5.34            Data Privacy and Security. Each Credit Party and its Subsidiaries has at all times complied in all material respects with (i) all of its policies and notices regarding Personal Information, privacy and data security, including all privacy policies and similar disclosures published on its websites or otherwise communicated to third parties (“Privacy Policies”), (ii) all Privacy and Security Laws, and (iii) all contractual commitments that each Credit Party and its Subsidiaries has entered into with respect to Personal Information. Except as, individually or in the aggregate, could not reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect, each Credit Party and its Subsidiaries has not been a party to or the subject of any action, claim, complaint or investigation that alleges that the Credit Party or Subsidiary has violated any Privacy and Security Laws, Privacy Policies or contractual commitments with respect to any Personal Information collected or possessed by or on behalf of, or otherwise subject to the possession or control of, the Credit Party or Subsidiary. To the Credit Party’s or Subsidiary’s knowledge, there are no facts or circumstances which could form the basis for any such claim or violation that, individually or in the aggregate, could reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect. Each Credit Party and its Subsidiaries has at all times taken all steps required (by applicable Privacy and Security Laws and Privacy Policies) and reasonably necessary to protect the security, availability, confidentiality and integrity of Personal Information against loss and against a Security Incident, including by implementing and at all times maintaining reasonable safeguards that are at least consistent with best practices in the industry in which the Credit Party and Subsidiary operates and contractually obligating all third parties who process, store, access, use or otherwise handle any Personal Information for or on behalf of the Credit Party or Subsidiary to comply with applicable Privacy and Security Laws and Privacy Policies and take all commercially reasonable steps to protect Personal Information. Each Credit Party and its Subsidiaries has not experienced (nor have any third parties acting on a Credit Party’s or Subsidiary’s behalf) any actual or suspected Security Incident that could reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect. Each Credit Party and its Subsidiaries has not (nor, to such Credit Party’s knowledge, have any third parties acting on such Credit Party’s or Subsidiary’s behalf) notified, or been required to notify, any Person or Governmental Body of any Security Incident that could reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect, including any loss or unauthorized access, use or disclosure, of Personal Information.

 

5.35            Small Business Administration Documents. If applicable, each Credit Party hereby acknowledges that the SBIC Lender is an SBIC and is subject to the SBIC Act and the regulations promulgated thereunder by the SBA relating to the small business investment company program. Although such regulations are not incorporated into this Agreement, each Credit Party acknowledges that it has been provided with an opportunity to review such regulations. The information set forth in the SBA Forms (if any) regarding each Credit Party shall be accurate and complete in all material respects.

 

80

 

 

 

5.36            Small Business Concern. The Credit Parties, together with their “affiliates” (as that term is defined in Title 13, Code of Federal Regulations, § 121.103), do not presently engage in, and do not intend to engage in, any activities, nor does any Credit Party intend to use, directly or indirectly, the proceeds of any Advance for any purpose violative of the SBIC Regulatory Side Letter (if any).

 

5.37            Canadian Subsidiary. Orange142 Canada does not (i) conduct any business operations or own, hold or lease any assets other than holding a bank account with a de minimis account balance or (ii) have any material liabilities.

 

5.38            Survival of Representations and Warranties. All representations and warranties of the Credit Parties contained in this Agreement and the Other Documents shall be true at the time of the Credit Parties’ execution of this Agreement and the Other Documents, and shall survive the execution, delivery and acceptance thereof by the parties thereto and the closing of the transactions described therein or related thereto.

 

VI. AFFIRMATIVE COVENANTS.

 

Each Credit Party shall, and shall cause each of its Subsidiaries to, until payment in full of the Obligations (other than Inchoate Obligations) and termination of all obligations of Agent, the Lenders to make Advances hereunder and termination of this Agreement:

 

6.1            Lender Meetings. Upon reasonable advance notice and at the request of Agent, participate in a meeting with Agent and Lenders one time each Fiscal Year (or such additional meetings as Borrower may agree to in its sole discretion) to be held at Borrowers’ corporate offices (or at such other location as may be agreed to by Borrowers and Agent) at such time as may be agreed to by Borrowers, Agent and Lenders; provided, that prior to receiving any material, non-public information at any such meetings, Agent and Lenders shall execute a non-disclosure agreement with respect to such material, non-public information that is in form and substance satisfactory to the Credit Parties in their reasonable discretion, containing, among other things, standstill provisions preventing transactions in the Credit Parties’ stock.

 

6.2            Conduct of Business and Maintenance of Existence and Assets. At all times preserve and keep in full force and effect its existence and good standing, hold itself out to the public as a legal entity separate and distinct from all other Persons, and preserve and keep all assets, rights, franchises, licenses and permits material to its business, except (i) to the extent permitted by Section 7.1, (ii) to the extent not constituting an Asset Sale hereunder, or (iii) to the extent the failure to maintain such assets, rights, franchises, licenses, or permits could not reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect.

 

6.3            Violations. Promptly notify Agent in writing after learning of any violation of any law, statute, regulation or ordinance of any Governmental Body, or of any agency thereof, applicable to any Credit Party which could reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.

 

81

 

 

6.4            Government Receivables. Upon Agent’s reasonable request, take all steps necessary to protect Agent’s interest in the Collateral under the Federal Assignment of Claims Act, the Uniform Commercial Code and all other applicable state or local statutes or ordinances and deliver to Agent (or ABL Lender) appropriately endorsed, any instrument or chattel paper connected with any Receivable arising out of contracts between any Credit Party and the United States, any state or any department, agency or instrumentality of any of them, except that no Credit Party shall be required to take such actions with respect to Receivables not exceeding $250,000 in the aggregate for all Credit Parties unless otherwise requested in writing by Agent during the continuance of an Event of Default.

 

6.5            Financial Covenants.

 

(a)            Consolidated Total Net Leverage Ratio. Cause to be maintained, when measured as of each date set forth below, a Consolidated Total Net Leverage Ratio of not more than the amount set forth opposite thereto:

 

Measurement Dates Maximum Consolidated Total Net
Leverage
December 31, 2021, March 31, 2022, June 30, 2022 and September 30, 2022 3.50 to 1.00
December 31, 2022 and March 31, 2023 3.25 to 1.00
June 30, 2023 and September 30, 2023 3.00 to 1.00
December 31, 2023, March 31, 2024 2.75 to 1.00
June 30, 2024 and the last day of each fiscal quarter thereafter 2.50 to 1.00

 

(b)            Consolidated Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio. Cause to be maintained a Consolidated Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio as of the end of each Fiscal Quarter, beginning with the Fiscal Quarter ending December 31, 2021, of not less than 1.5 to 1.00.

 

6.6            Execution of Supplemental Instruments. Execute and deliver to Agent from time to time, upon demand, such supplemental agreements, statements, assignments and transfers, or instructions or documents relating to the Collateral, and such other instruments as Agent may reasonably request in its Permitted Discretion, in order that the full intent of this Agreement may be carried into effect.

 

6.7            Payment of Indebtedness. Pay, discharge or otherwise satisfy at or before maturity (subject, where applicable, to specified grace periods and, in the case of the trade payables, to normal payment practices) all its obligations and liabilities of whatever nature, except when the failure to do so could not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect or when the amount or validity thereof is currently being properly contested in good faith by appropriate proceedings promptly instituted and diligently conducted and in respect of which reserves have been established as required in conformity with GAAP, subject at all times to any applicable subordination arrangement in favor of Lenders.

 

82

 

 

6.8            Real Property Collateral.

 

(a)            In the event that any Credit Party owns or acquires Real Property (other than any Real Property constituting Excluded Property), then such Credit Party, no later than ninety (90) days (or such longer period as may be agreed in writing by Agent in its sole discretion) after acquiring such Real Property shall take all such actions and execute and deliver, or cause to be executed and delivered, all such Mortgages, documents, instruments, agreements, opinions and certificates similar to those described in clause (b) immediately below that Agent shall reasonably request to create in favor of Agent a valid and, subject to any filing and/or recording referred to herein, enforceable Lien on, and security interest in such Real Property. Agent may, in its reasonable judgment, grant extensions of time for compliance or exceptions with respect to the provisions of this Section 6.8 by any Credit Party. In addition to the foregoing, the applicable Credit Party shall, at the reasonable request of Agent, deliver, from time to time, to Agent such appraisals as are required by law or regulation of Real Property with respect to which Agent has been granted a Lien.

 

(b)            In order to create in favor of Agent, a valid and, subject to any filing and/or recording referred to herein, enforceable Lien on, and security interest in, any Real Property Collateral that is prior and superior in right to any other Lien (other than Permitted Encumbrances), Agent shall have received from Borrowers with respect to such Real Property Collateral:

 

(i)            a fully executed and notarized Mortgage, in proper form for recording in all appropriate places in all applicable jurisdictions, encumbering such Real Property Collateral;

 

(ii)           an opinion of counsel (which counsel shall be reasonably satisfactory to Agent) in each state in which such Real Property is located with respect to the enforceability of the form of Mortgage to be recorded in such state and such other matters as Agent may reasonably request, in each case in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to Agent;

 

(iii)          (A) ALTA mortgagee title insurance policies or unconditional commitments therefor issued by one or more title companies reasonably satisfactory to Agent (each, a “Title Policy”) with respect to such Real Property, in amounts not less than the fair market value of such Real Property, together with a title report issued by a title company with respect thereto and copies of all recorded documents listed as exceptions to title or otherwise referred to therein, each in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to Agent and (B) evidence reasonably satisfactory to Agent that Borrower has paid to the title company or to the appropriate Governmental Bodies all expenses and premiums of the title company and all other sums required in connection with the issuance of each Title Policy and all applicable recording and stamp taxes (including mortgage recording and intangible taxes) payable in connection with recording the Mortgage for such Real Property Collateral in the appropriate real estate records;

 

(iv)          a recently issued flood zone determination certificate;

 

(v)           evidence of flood insurance with respect to each Flood Hazard Property that is located in a community that participates in the National Flood Insurance Program, in each case in compliance with any applicable regulations of the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System, in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to Agent;

 

83

 

 

(vi)           if an exception to the Title Policy with respect to any Real Property subject to a Mortgage would arise without such ALTA surveys, ALTA surveys of such Real Property; and

 

(vii)         reports and other reasonable information, in form, scope and substance reasonably satisfactory to Agent, regarding environmental matters relating to such Real Property Collateral.

 

6.9            Federal Securities Laws. All documents, financial statements, notices and other information required to be delivered pursuant to this Agreement may be delivered to Agent electronically and, if so delivered to Agent, shall be deemed to have been delivered on the date (i) on which such materials are publicly available as posted on the Electronic Data Gathering, Analysis and Retrieval system (EDGAR); provided Borrower will, within three (3 Business Days, provide notice to Agent of such material being available on EDGAR; or (ii) on which such documents are posted on a Credit Party’s behalf on an Internet or intranet website, if any, to which the Lenders and the Agent have access and approve in writing (whether a commercial or third-party website or whether made available by the Agent.

 

6.10          Exercise of Rights. Enforce all of its rights under any Acquisition Documents including, but not limited to, all indemnification rights and pursue its available remedies in respect thereof in the exercise of its reasonable business judgment with diligence and in good faith; provided, however, that, unless an Event of Default has occurred and is continuing, if in any particular instance the probable amount of any indemnity payment which would be payable on account of the pursuit of any rights or remedies under any Acquisition Documents would be less than $250,000 and the applicable Credit Party in the exercise of its reasonable business judgment determines that in such instance the pursuit of such rights and remedies is not in the best interests of such Credit Party, then the failure of such Credit Party in such instance to pursue any such rights and remedies shall not be a violation of this Section 6.10.

 

6.11          [Reserved].

 

6.12         Additional Subsidiaries. Prior to the acquisition or formation of any Subsidiary of DDH after the Closing Date, (i) DDH shall (a) form a wholly owned Subsidiary holding company (such wholly owned Subsidiary, an “Intermediate Holdco”), (b) transfer, sell and assign all Equity Interests owned by DDH in its existing Subsidiaries to Intermediate Holdco, (c) cause Intermediate Holdco to execute and deliver (I) a joinder agreement to this Agreement fully executed by Intermediate Holdco, the Credit Parties and the Agent pursuant to which Intermediate Holdco shall become a Guarantor hereunder and become jointly and severally liable for the Obligations of the Guarantors hereunder and grant a lien and security interest in its property (to the extent such property would be included in the definition of Collateral), together with amended and restated and schedules to this Agreement, (II) a fully executed Pledge Agreement by Intermediate Holdco pursuant to which Intermediate Holdco shall pledge all of the Equity Interests owned by Intermediate Holdco, (III) such other documents (including without limitation, Control Agreements) as Agent deems necessary to grant to Agent a security interest in any property of Intermediate Holdco (to the extent such property would be included in the definition of Collateral), and (IV) any other documents Agent may reasonably require in connection with the forgoing, including without limitation, legal opinions, certificates, and any documentation and other information requested in connection with applicable “know your customer” and anti-money laundering rules and regulations, including the USA Patriot Act, and (d) DDH shall deliver a fully executed Pledge Agreement pursuant to which DDH shall pledge all of the Equity Interests of Intermediate Holdco, and (ii) upon satisfaction of the conditions set forth in clause (i) above, within thirty (30) days after the acquisition or formation of any Subsidiary of DDH or Intermediate Holdco, the Credit Parties shall:

 

84

 

 

(a)            notify Agent thereof in writing, together with the (i) jurisdiction of formation, (ii) number of shares of each class of Equity Interests outstanding, (iii) number and percentage of outstanding shares of each class owned (directly or indirectly) by any Credit Party or any Subsidiary and (iv) number and effect, if exercised, of all outstanding options, warrants, rights of conversion or purchase and all other similar rights with respect thereto;

 

(b)            cause such Person to at the election of Agent, either (x) become a Borrower hereunder and under the Other Documents by executing and delivering to Agent such assumption agreements, joinder documentation (including in the form of Exhibit G hereto) or such other documents as Agent shall deem appropriate for such purpose, or (y) executes and delivers a Guarantee, Guarantor Security Agreement and joinders to such Other Documents as Agent may request; and

 

(c)            deliver to Agent (i) documents of the types referred to in Sections 8.1(b), (c), (d), (e), (f) and (u), and favorable opinions of counsel to such Person (which shall cover, among other things, the legality, validity, binding effect and enforceability of the documentation referred to in the immediately foregoing clause (b)), all in form, content and scope satisfactory to Agent and (ii) all documents (including Pledge Agreements with respect to the Equity Interests of such Subsidiary), including original certificates evidencing the Equity Interests of such Subsidiary and transfer powers with respect thereto executed in blank, required by Agent in its Permitted Discretion to perfect its Lien on the Equity Interests of such Subsidiary.

 

6.13            [Reserved].

 

6.14            Sanctions and Anti-Corruption Matters. Each Credit Party will, and will cause each of its Subsidiaries to, conduct its businesses in compliance with Sanctions and the United States Foreign Corrupt Practices Act of 1977, the UK Bribery Act 2010 and other similar anti-corruption legislation in other jurisdictions and maintain policies and procedures designed to promote and achieve compliance with such laws.

 

6.15            Impact Subscription to or Impact Services.

 

(a)            Use commercially reasonable and good faith efforts, subject to applicable Federal and state securities laws, to (i) in connection with any Impact Subscription to or Impact Services otherwise obtained by, and made generally available to the employees of, each such Credit Party and Subsidiary, educate such employees of each Credit Party and each Subsidiary of a Credit Party as to the offerings in each such Impact Services and the impact and benefits thereof, and (ii) maintain corporate citizenship and utilize best standards of social responsibility, including, without limitation, with respect to human capital management (it being agreed and acknowledged that the job quality standards promulgated by the Good Jobs Institute (https://goodjobsinstitute.org) and the good faith utilization of the “Good Jobs Scoreboard” promulgated thereby shall be deemed to be maintaining corporate citizenship and utilizing best standards of social responsibility). Without limiting the foregoing, (x) Agent agrees to provide resources, consultation and managerial assistance to (including, without limitation, guidance and counsel concerning the management, operations or business objectives and policies of) the Credit Parties and their Subsidiaries with respect to such efforts to the extent reasonably requested by each such Credit Party and Subsidiary and (y) the Credit Parties shall identify and certify as to any and all efforts to educate employees under clause (i) of this Section 6.15(a), including, without limitation, as to any workshops, intranet postings, literature distribution, employee e-mails or otherwise, in each Impact Certificate delivered pursuant to Section 9.8.

 

85

 

 

(b)            Deliver to any Impact Provider all reasonable documentation such Impact Provider may require in order to provide Agent with information from or regarding the Credit Parties.

 

6.16            Post-Closing Deliveries.

 

(a)            Promptly, but in any event, within thirty (30) days after the Qualified IPO (or such later date consented to by Agent, such consent not to be unreasonably withheld, conditioned or delayed) deliver or cause to be delivered to Agent (i) a joinder agreement to this Agreement fully executed by DDH Holdings, the Credit Parties and the Agent pursuant to which DDH Holdings shall become a Guarantor hereunder and become jointly and severally liable for the Obligations of the Guarantors hereunder and grant a lien and security interest in its property (to the extent such property would be included in the definition of Collateral), together with amended and restated and schedules to this Agreement, (ii) a fully executed Pledge Agreement by DDH Holdings and any Permitted Holders (other than Leah Woolford or any Person owned by Leah Woolford) owning Equity Interests of DDH, pursuant to which DDH Holdings and such Permitted Holders shall pledge all of the Equity Interests owned by such Person in DDH, (iii) such other documents (including without limitation, Control Agreements) as Agent deems necessary to grant to Agent a security interest in any property of DDH Holdings (to the extent such property would be included in the definition of Collateral), and (iv) any other documents Agent may reasonably require in connection with the forgoing, including without limitation, legal opinions, certificates, and any documentation and other information requested in connection with applicable “know your customer” and anti-money laundering rules and regulations, including the USA Patriot Act.

 

(b)            Deliver to Agent the Key Executive Policy as required under and in accordance with Section 4.21.

 

(c)            Promptly, but in any event, within thirty (30) days after the Closing Date (or such later date consented to by Agent, such consent not to be unreasonably withheld, conditioned or delayed), deliver or cause to be delivered to Agent fully executed deposit account control agreements (“Control Agreements”) in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to Agent, among Agent, ABL Lender, the financial institutions or other Person at which all applicable deposit accounts are maintained and the Credit Party maintaining such account(s), with respect to all deposit accounts of Credit Parties (other than those utilized solely for making payroll or employee benefit related payments), including, without limitation, the Depository Accounts and the Funding Accounts, which agreements shall be effective for Agent to obtain “control” (as defined in the Uniform Commercial Code) of all such accounts and all monies on deposit in, or credited to, such deposit accounts and all certificates and instruments, if any, representing or evidencing such deposit accounts.

 

86

 

 

(d)            Deliver to Agent the Landlord Waiver Agreements as required under and in accordance with Section 4.5(c)(i).

 

(e)            Within fourteen days after the Closing Date (or such later date agreed to by Agent and the Required Lenders in their reasonable discretion), Borrowers shall deliver to Agent an amendment to the existing ABL Credit Agreement (an “ABL Amendment”) in effect on the date hereof, in form and substance satisfactory to Agent and the Required Lenders, pursuant to which ABL Lender agrees to increase the commitments under the existing ABL Credit Agreement to $5,000,000 and agrees to such other amendments which are satisfactory to Agent and the Required Lenders in their reasonable discretion; provided however that if such ABL Amendment is not executed and delivered on or prior to the due date set forth above, it shall not be an Event of Default hereunder if Borrowers terminate the existing ABL Credit Agreement and repay all obligations owing thereunder no later than the fourteenth day after the Closing Date (or such later date agreed to by Agent and the Required Lenders in their reasonable discretion).

 

(f)            Within ten (10) days of the Closing Date, Borrowers shall deliver evidence that their insurance policies are in compliance with Section 4.11 hereof (or otherwise acceptable to Agent and Required Lenders in their sole discretion) and deliver certificates of insurance evidencing such compliance and the endorsements required to be delivered pursuant to Section 4.11 hereof.

 

VII. NEGATIVE COVENANTS.

 

The Credit Parties shall not, and shall not permit their respective Subsidiaries, until satisfaction in full of the Obligations (other than Inchoate Obligations), termination of all obligations of Agent and the Lenders to make any Advances hereunder and termination of this Agreement, to:

 

7.1            Merger, Consolidation, Acquisition and Sale of Assets. Enter into any Acquisition or transaction of merger or consolidation, or liquidate, wind-up or dissolve itself (or suffer any liquidation or dissolution), or consummate an LLC Division, or make any Asset Sale (including by way of an LLC Division), or acquire by purchase or otherwise (other than purchases or other acquisitions of inventory and materials and the acquisition of equipment and Capital Expenditures in the ordinary course of business) the business, property or fixed assets of, or Equity Interests or other evidence of beneficial ownership of, any Person or any division or line of business or other business unit of any Person, except: (a) any Subsidiary of DDH may be merged with or into DDH or any Subsidiary of DDH, or be liquidated, wound up or dissolved, or all or any part of its business, property or assets may be conveyed, sold, leased, transferred or otherwise disposed of, in one transaction or a series of transactions, to DDH or any other Subsidiary of DDH; provided, in the case of such a merger, if a Borrower is party to the merger, a Borrower shall be the continuing or surviving Person; (b) Asset Sales, the proceeds of which when aggregated with the proceeds of all other Asset Sales made within the same Fiscal Year, do not exceed $100,000; provided the consideration received for such assets shall be in an amount at least equal to the fair market value thereof (determined in good faith by the board of directors of the applicable Credit Party (or similar governing body)); (c) Investments made in accordance with Section 7.4; (d) sales or dispositions of Equity Interests in connection with a Qualified IPO to consummate the Reorganization Transactions or to effect a Qualified IPO; and (e) dispositions or redemptions of Equity Interests in connection with the Redemption/Exchange Transactions.

 

87

 

 

7.2            Creation of Liens. Directly or indirectly, create, incur, assume or permit to exist any Lien on or with respect to any property or asset of any kind (including any document or instrument in respect of goods or accounts receivable) of any Credit Party or any of its Subsidiaries, whether now owned or hereafter acquired, created or licensed or any income, profits or royalties therefrom, or file or permit the filing of, or permit to remain in effect, any financing statement or other similar notice of any Lien with respect to any such property, asset, income, profits or royalties under the Uniform Commercial Code of any State or under any similar recording or notice statute or under any Applicable Laws related to intellectual property, except:

 

(a)            Liens in favor of Agent granted pursuant to this Agreement or any Other Document;

 

(b)            Liens in favor of ABL Lender pursuant to the ABL Loan Documents to the extent subject to the Intercreditor Agreement;

 

(c)            Liens for Taxes not yet due and payable or for Taxes if obligations with respect to such Taxes are being contested in good faith by appropriate proceedings promptly instituted and diligently conducted;

 

(d)            statutory Liens of landlords, banks, carriers, warehousemen, mechanics, repairmen, workmen and materialmen, and other Liens imposed by law (other than any such Lien imposed pursuant to Section 430(k) of the Code or Section 303(k) or 4068 of ERISA that would constitute an Event of Default under Section 10.17), in each case incurred in the ordinary course of business (i) for amounts not yet overdue, or (ii) for amounts that are overdue and that are being contested in good faith by appropriate proceedings, so long as such reserves or other appropriate provisions, if any, as shall be required by GAAP shall have been made for any such contested amounts;

 

(e)            Liens incurred in the ordinary course of business in connection with workers’ compensation, unemployment insurance and other types of social security, or to secure the performance of tenders, statutory obligations, surety and appeal bonds, bids, leases, government contracts, trade contracts, performance and return-of-money bonds and other similar obligations (exclusive of obligations for the payment of borrowed money or other Indebtedness), so long as no foreclosure, sale or similar proceedings have been commenced with respect to any portion of the Collateral on account thereof;

 

88

 

 

(f)            easements, rights-of-way, restrictions, encroachments, and other minor defects or irregularities in title, in each case which do not and will not interfere in any material respect with the ordinary conduct of the business of any Credit Party or any of its Subsidiaries, including, without limitation, all encumbrances shown on any policy of title insurance in favor of Agent with respect to any Real Property Collateral;

 

(g)           any interest or title of a lessor or sublessor under any lease of real estate permitted hereunder;

 

(h)            Liens solely on any cash earnest money deposits made by any Credit Party or any of its Subsidiaries in connection with any letter of intent, or purchase agreement permitted hereunder;

 

(i)            purported Liens evidenced by the filing of precautionary UCC financing statements relating solely to operating leases of personal property entered into in the ordinary course of business;

 

(j)            Liens in favor of customs and revenue authorities arising as a matter of law to secure payment of customs duties in connection with the importation of goods;

 

(k)            any zoning or similar law or right reserved to or vested in any governmental office or agency to control or regulate the use of any real property;

 

(l)            licenses of patents, trademarks and other intellectual property rights granted by any Credit Party or any of its Subsidiaries in the ordinary course of business and not interfering in any respect with the ordinary conduct of the business of such Credit Party or such Subsidiary;

 

(m)          Liens existing as of the Closing Date and described in Schedule 7.2;

 

(n)            Liens securing purchase money Indebtedness and Capitalized Lease Obligations to the extent permitted pursuant to Section 7.8(g); provided, any such Lien shall encumber only the asset acquired with the proceeds of such purchase money Indebtedness or the assets subject to the applicable Capital Lease, respectively;

 

(o)           Liens consisting of judgment or judicial attachment liens relating to judgments which do not constitute an Event of Default hereunder;

 

(p)           licenses (including licenses of Intellectual Property), sublicenses, leases or subleases granted to third parties in the ordinary course of business;

 

(q)           Liens in favor of collecting banks under Section 4-210 of the Uniform Commercial Code;

 

(r)           Liens (including the right of set-off) in favor of a bank or other depository institution arising as a matter of law encumbering deposits;

 

(s)            Liens arising out of conditional sale, title retention, consignment or similar arrangements for the sale of goods in the ordinary course of business; and

 

89

 

 

(t)            Liens not otherwise permitted hereunder securing Indebtedness or other obligations not in excess of $250,000 in the aggregate at any one time outstanding.

 

7.3            No Further Negative Pledges. Enter into any Contractual Obligation (other than this Agreement and the Other Documents and the ABL Loan Documents) that limits the ability of any Credit Party or any such Subsidiary to create, incur, assume or suffer to exist Liens on property of such Person; provided, however, that this Section 7.3 shall not prohibit (i) any negative pledge incurred or provided in favor of any holder of Indebtedness permitted under Section 7.8(g), solely to the extent any such negative pledge relates to the property financed by or subject to Permitted Encumbrances securing such Indebtedness, (ii) any Permitted Encumbrance or any document or instrument governing any Permitted Encumbrance; provided that any such restriction contained therein relates only to the asset or assets subject to such Permitted Encumbrance, (iii) customary restrictions and conditions contained in any agreement relating to the disposition of any property or assets permitted under Section 7.1 pending the consummation of such disposition, and (iv) customary provisions restricting assignments, subletting or other transfers contained in leases, licenses, joint venture agreements and similar agreements entered into in the ordinary course of business.

 

7.4            Investments. Directly or indirectly, make or own any Investment in any Person, including any joint venture, or create or form any Subsidiary, except: (a) Investments in cash and Cash Equivalents and deposit accounts or securities accounts in connection therewith; (b) (i) equity Investments owned as of the Closing Date in any Subsidiary and (ii) equity Investments made after the Closing Date by the Credit Parties or any Subsidiaries of a Credit Party in any Credit Party; (c) intercompany loans to the extent permitted under Section 7.8(d) and guarantees to the extent permitted under Section 7.8(e); (d) Investments existing on the Closing Date and described on Schedule 7.4; (e) Investments constituting Swap Agreements permitted by Section 7.8(h); (f) Permitted Acquisitions; (g) Investments constituting accounts receivable, trade debt and deposits for the purchase of goods, in each case, made in the ordinary course of business; (h) repurchases of stock from current or former employees, directors, or consultants of the Credit Parties under the terms of applicable repurchase agreements: (i) prior to the consummation of a Qualified IPO, at the original issuance price of such securities in an aggregate amount not to exceed $250,000 in any fiscal year; provided that no Event of Default has occurred, is continuing or could exist after giving effect to the repurchases and (ii) following a Qualified IPO, subject to satisfaction of the Payment Conditions; (i) Investments consisting of travel advances in the ordinary course of business; (j) Investments consisting of loans not involving the net transfer on a substantially contemporaneous basis of cash proceeds to employees, officers or directors relating to the purchase of capital stock or other Equity Interests of the Credit Parties pursuant to employee stock purchase plans or other similar agreements approved by such Credit Party’s Board of Directors (or, if not a corporation, its equivalent authorizing body); (k) Investments (including debt obligations) received in connection with the bankruptcy or reorganization of customers or suppliers and in settlement of delinquent obligations of, and other disputes with, customers or suppliers arising in the ordinary course of Borrowers’ business; (l) Investments consisting of notes receivable of, or prepaid royalties and other credit extensions to, customers and suppliers who are not Affiliates, in the ordinary course of business; provided that this subparagraph (l) shall not apply to Investments of any Borrower in any Subsidiary; (m) formation of, and Investments in, newly-formed Subsidiaries of DDH or any Subsidiary of DDH so long as DDH and such Subsidiary comply with Section 6.12 hereof; (n) Investments made to consummate the Reorganization Transactions in connection with a Qualified IPO; (o) Investments required to finance the buyout of the SSP licensing agreement by a Credit Party in an amount not to exceed $750,000 in the aggregate; provided that no Event of Default has occurred and is continuing or would occur after giving effect to such Investments; and (p) other Investments not listed above and not otherwise prohibited by this Agreement (i) prior to the consummation of a Qualified IPO, in an aggregate amount not to exceed $250,000 in the aggregate in any fiscal year and (ii) following a Qualified IPO, in an aggregate amount not to exceed $500,000 in the aggregate in any fiscal year; provided that to the extent such Investments exceed $200,000 in the aggregate in any fiscal year such Investments shall be subject to satisfaction of the Payment Conditions.

 

90

 

 

7.5            Sale and Lease-Backs. Directly or indirectly, become or remain liable as lessee or as a guarantor or other surety with respect to any lease of any property (whether real, personal or mixed), whether now owned or hereafter acquired, which the Credit Party or any Subsidiary (a) has sold or transferred or is to sell or to transfer to any other Person (other than a Credit Party), or (b) intends to use for substantially the same purpose as any other property which has been or is to be sold or transferred by a Credit Party to any Person (other than a Credit Party) in connection with such lease.

 

7.6            [Reserved].

 

7.7            Restricted Payments. Declare or make, directly or indirectly, any Restricted Payment, or incur any obligation (contingent or otherwise) to do so, except: (a) each Subsidiary of a Borrower may make Restricted Payments to a Borrower, (b) the Preferred A Redemption on the Closing Date, (c) Permitted Dividends, (d) redemptions of Equity Interests pursuant to employee, director or consultant repurchase plans or other similar agreements in an aggregate amount not to exceed $250,000 in any fiscal year; provided, however, in each case (other than any such repurchase or redemption in the ordinary course of business in connection with an employee incentive plan) the repurchase or redemption price does not exceed the original consideration paid for such stock or Equity Interest, (e) the conversion of any of its convertible securities into other securities of such Credit Party pursuant to the terms of such convertible securities, (f) the payment of cash in lieu of fractional shares upon the conversion of any such convertible securities, not to exceed $500,000 in the aggregate during the Term, (g) Permitted Management Fee Payments or (h) any Credit Party and any Subsidiary may make Tax Distributions to its members or shareholders when the applicable Tax giving rise to such Tax Distribution is due, including in respect of estimated Tax payments, so long as: (i) no Event of Default or Default shall be continuing at the time of and after giving pro forma effect to such Tax Distribution; and (ii) the purpose and calculation of such Tax Distribution shall be set forth in writing and submitted to Agent at least ten (10) days prior to such Tax Distribution, which shall be conclusive absent manifest error, and such Tax Distribution shall in fact be used for such purpose, unless an alternative use is approved by the Agent, (i) subsequent to a Qualified IPO and to the extent made with cash proceeds of a Qualified IPO, cash payments to any holders of DDH’s Preferred Equity, (j) cash payments to any holders of DDH’s Preferred Equity subsequent to a Qualified IPO to the extent the Payment Conditions are satisfied with respect to such payments after giving Pro Forma effect thereto, (k) the transactions contemplated pursuant to a Qualified IPO, (l) with respect to the payment of Public Company Costs; and (m) in order to effect the Redemption/Exchange Transactions.

 

91

 

 

7.8            Indebtedness. Directly or indirectly, create, incur, assume or guaranty, or otherwise become or remain directly or indirectly liable with respect to any Indebtedness other than (a) the Obligations; (b) the ABL Obligations in an amount not to exceed the maximum permitted amount set forth in the Intercreditor Agreement; (c) the Subordinated Debt; provided that such Indebtedness shall at all times be subject to a Subordination Agreement and have an earliest maturity date or call or redemption date, as applicable, no earlier than at least six (6) months after the last day of the Term; (d) Indebtedness of the Credit Parties to any other Credit Party; (e) Guarantees with respect to Indebtedness permitted under this Section 7.8; (f) Indebtedness existing on the Closing Date and described in Schedule 7.8; (g) (x) Capitalized Lease Obligations and (y) purchase money Indebtedness; provided, in the case of clause (x), that any such Indebtedness shall be secured only by the asset subject to the applicable Capital Lease, and, in the case of clause (y), that any such Indebtedness shall be secured only by the asset acquired in connection with the incurrence of such Indebtedness; provided further that the sum of the aggregate principal amount of any Indebtedness under this clause (g) shall not exceed at any time $250,000; (h) Indebtedness in respect of any Swap Agreement that is entered into in the ordinary course of business to hedge or mitigate risks to which any Credit Party or any of its Subsidiaries is exposed in the conduct of its business or the management of its liabilities (it being acknowledged by the Credit Parties that a Swap Agreement entered into for speculative purposes or of a speculative nature is not a Swap Agreement entered into in the ordinary course of business to hedge or mitigate risks); (i) Indebtedness in connection with the financing of insurance premiums in the ordinary course of business; (j) Indebtedness representing deferred compensation to officers, directors, employees of DDH and its Subsidiaries; (k) to the extent constituting Indebtedness, accrued Taxes not yet due and payable or that are being contested in good faith by appropriate proceedings promptly instituted and diligently conducted; and (l) other unsecured Indebtedness of the Credit Parties not otherwise permitted hereunder in an aggregate amount not to exceed at any time $250,000.

 

7.9            Nature of Business. From and after the Closing Date, engage in any business other than the Permitted Lines of Business. Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, none of DDH, Intermediate Holdco or, subsequent to a Qualified IPO, DDH Holdings shall (i) incur any liabilities (other than liabilities arising (a) under this Agreement and the Other Documents and the ABL Loan Documents to which it is a party, (b) tax liabilities arising in the ordinary course of business, (c) obligations under any Acquisition documents in respect of a Permitted Acquisition, under any Acquisition Document with respect to a Permitted Acquisition to which it is a party, (d) liabilities in connection with the Tax Receivables Agreement, (e) liabilities for Public Company Costs, and (f) liabilities in connection with the Redemption/Exchange Transactions), (ii) own or acquire any assets (other than the Equity Interests of its Subsidiaries, immaterial assets and contractual rights) or (iii) engage itself in any operations or business, except for those expressly set forth in Section 5.26.

 

7.10            Transactions with Affiliates. Directly or indirectly, enter into or permit to exist any transaction (including the purchase, sale, lease or exchange of any property or the rendering of any service) with any officer, director or Affiliate of DDH or any of its Subsidiaries on terms that are less favorable to DDH or such Subsidiary, as the case may be, than those that might be obtained at the time from a Person who is not an officer, director or Affiliate of DDH or any of its Subsidiaries; provided, the foregoing restriction shall not apply to (a) any transaction between or among the Credit Parties; (b) normal and reasonable compensation and reimbursement of expenses of officers and directors in the ordinary course of business; (c) transactions otherwise permitted under this Agreement; (d) Permitted Management Fee Payments; (d) transactions pursuant to the Tax Receivable Agreement; (e) transactions pursuant to the Redemption/Exchange Transactions; and (f) the transactions described in Schedule 7.10.

 

92

 

 

7.11            Burdensome Agreements. Enter into, or permit to exist, any Contractual Obligation that encumbers or restricts the ability of any such Person to (i) pay dividends or make any other distributions to a Borrower or other Credit Party on its Equity Interests or with respect to any other interest or participation in, or measured by, its profits, (ii) pay any Indebtedness or other obligation owed to a Borrower or any other Credit Party, (iii) make loans or advances to a Borrower or any other Credit Party, (iv) sell, lease or transfer any of its property to any Borrower or any other Credit Party, (v) pledge its property pursuant to this Agreement or any Other Document or any renewals, refinancings, exchanges, refundings or extension thereof, or (vi) act as a Credit Party pursuant to this Agreement and the Other Documents or any renewals, refinancings, exchanges, refundings or extension thereof, except, in each case, for (w) the ABL Loan Documents, this Agreement and the Other Documents, (x) any document or instrument governing Indebtedness incurred pursuant to Section 7.8(g); provided that any such restriction contained therein relates only to the asset or assets constructed or acquired in connection therewith, (y) any Permitted Encumbrance or any document or instrument governing any Permitted Encumbrance, provided that any such restriction contained therein relates only to the asset or assets subject to such Permitted Encumbrance or (z) customary restrictions and conditions contained in any agreement relating to the sale of any property permitted under Section 7.1(b) pending the consummation of such sale.

 

7.12            [Reserved].

 

7.13            Fiscal Year and Accounting Changes. (a) Change its Fiscal Year-end employed by the Credit Parties as of the Closing Date other than in the case of any Subsidiary, to cause such Subsidiary’s Fiscal Year to end in the same date as the Fiscal Year of DDH or (b) make any significant change in accounting treatment and reporting practices except as required or permitted by GAAP.

 

7.14            [Reserved].

 

7.15            Amendment of Governing Documents. Amend or permit any amendments to its Governing Documents (x) to amend or change its legal name without providing not less than twenty (20) days prior written notice to Agent, or (y) if such amendment could reasonably be expected to be materially adverse to Agent or Lenders, it being understood and agreed that (i) the Reorganization Transactions contemplated by a Qualified IPO shall not be deemed to be materially adverse to the Agent or Lenders, and (ii) any amendment to a Credit Party’s Governing Documents that would affect the a pledge of the Equity Interests of such Credit Party (or the rights granted to Agent and Lenders in connection with such pledge) shall be deemed materially adverse.

 

93

 

 

7.16            Compliance with ERISA. (i) (x) Maintain or (y) become obligated to contribute to, any Pension Plan, other than those Pension Plans disclosed on Schedule 5.8(d) as of the Closing Date or any other Pension Plan for which Agent has provided its prior written consent, (ii) engage in any non-exempt “prohibited transaction”, as that term is defined in Section 406 of ERISA and Section 4975 of the Code, with respect to any “plan” as defined in Section 3(3) of ERISA or Section 4975 of the Code which could reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect, (iii) fail to satisfy, or permit any ERISA Affiliate to fail to satisfy, the minimum funding standards of the pension funding rules with respect to any Pension Plan, which could reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect, (iv) terminate, or permit any ERISA Affiliate to terminate, any Pension Plan where such event could result in any material liability of any Credit Party or the imposition of a lien on the property of any Credit Party pursuant to Section 4068 of ERISA, (v) assume, or permit any ERISA Affiliate to assume, any obligation to contribute to any Multiemployer Plan for which Agent has not provided its prior written consent, (vi) incur, or permit any ERISA Affiliate to incur, any withdrawal liability to any Multiemployer Plan in excess of $500,000 or (vii) fail to comply with the requirements of ERISA or the Code or other Applicable Laws in respect of any “plan” as defined in Section 3(3) of ERISA or Section 4975 of the Code which could reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.

 

7.17            Prepayment of Indebtedness. Make any payment, redemption, defeasance or acquisition for value of, or refund, refinance or exchange of, any Subordinated Debt in a manner prohibited by the applicable Subordination Agreement; provided that for the avoidance of doubt, any payment of Subordinated Debt that would also constitute a Restricted Payment is also subject to Section 7.7 hereof.

 

7.18           Anti-Terrorism Laws.

 

(a)          Use the proceeds of any Advance except as permitted by Section 2.8. No Credit Party shall use, and each Credit Party shall ensure that its Subsidiaries and its or their respective directors, officers, employees and agents shall not use, the proceeds of any Advance (i) to refinance any commercial paper, (ii) in any manner that causes or may reasonably be expected to cause any Advance or the application of such proceeds to violate any applicable Sanctions, Regulation T, Regulation U or Regulation X of the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System as in effect from time to time or any other regulation thereof or to violate the Exchange Act, (iii) in furtherance of an offer, payment, promise to pay, or authorization of the payment or giving of money, or anything else of value, to any Person in violation of any Anti-Corruption Laws, or (iv) for the purpose of funding, financing or facilitating any activities, business or transaction of or with any Sanctioned Person, or in any Sanctioned Country; and

 

(b)            No Covered Entity, either in its own right or through any third party, will (i) have any of its assets in a Sanctioned Country or in the possession, custody or control of a Sanctioned Person in violation of any Anti-Terrorism Law; (ii) do business in or with, or derive any of its income from investments in or transactions with, any Sanctioned Country or Sanctioned Person in violation of any Anti-Terrorism Law; (iii) engage in any dealings or transactions prohibited by any Anti-Terrorism Law or (iv) use the Advances to fund any operations in, finance any investments or activities in, or, make any payments to, a Sanctioned Country or Sanctioned Person in violation of any Anti-Terrorism Law.

 

The Credit Parties shall deliver to Agent and/or Lenders, as applicable, any certification or other evidence requested from time to time by Agent and/or any Lender, as applicable in their sole discretion, confirming the Credit Parties’ compliance with this Section 7.18.

 

94

 

 

7.19            Membership/Partnership Interests. Unless consented to by Agent (and all actions, filings and deliveries necessary and desirable in the Permitted Discretion of Agent to perfect Agent’s first priority security interest (subject to any Permitted Encumbrances) have been completed to Agent’s reasonable satisfaction) and except with respect to Subsidiaries existing on the Closing Date with respect to which Agent has received all original certificates evidencing the Equity Interests of such Subsidiaries, elect to treat or permit any of its Domestic Subsidiaries to (a) treat its limited liability company Equity Interests or partnership interests, as the case may be, as securities as contemplated by the definition of “security” in Section 8-102(15) and by Section 8-103 of Article 8 of Uniform Commercial Code or (b) certificate its limited liability company Equity Interests or partnership interests, as the case may be. To the extent that any of the operating agreements, limited partnership agreements or other agreements governing any Equity Interests of any Credit Party’s Subsidiaries, or any law applicable thereto, contains any restrictions on the transfer of such Equity Interests, each Credit Party who owns such Equity Interests and each Credit Party who has issued such Equity Interests hereby (x) consents to the transfer of such Equity Interests by Agent to any Person in connection with any exercise of Agent’s remedies pursuant to the terms of this Agreement or any Other Document and (y) consents to any such transferee being admitted as a member or limited partner of such limited liability company or limited partnership (as applicable) with all of the rights of the Credit Party originally owning such Equity Interests.

 

7.20            Trading with the Enemy Act. Engage in any business or activity in violation of the Trading with the Enemy Act.

 

7.21            Management Agreement; Management Fees. At any time prior to a Qualified IPO, except in connection with the consummation of a Qualified IPO, (i) enter into any other management agreement, consulting agreement, or similar arrangement (other than the Management Agreement) without the prior written consent of Agent; or (ii) pay any Management Fees other than Permitted Management Fee Payments.

 

7.22            Other Agreements. Enter into any amendment, waiver or modification of (a) any documents governing or giving rise to any Subordinated Debt (except to the extent permitted in the subordination agreement with respect thereto) or, in each case, any related agreements, in each case that could reasonably be expected to be material and adverse to the interests of Agent or Lenders in respect of this Agreement, the Other Documents or the transactions contemplated hereby or thereby, (b) the ABL Loan Documents to the extent prohibited by the Intercreditor Agreement, or (c) any Material Contract or Acquisition Documents in a manner which could reasonably be expected to have any material adverse effect on the interests of Agent or Lenders in respect of this Agreement, the Other Documents or the transactions contemplated hereby and thereby, unless required by law.

 

7.23            Canadian Subsidiary. Permit Orange142 Canada to (1) conduct any business operations or own, hold or lease any assets other than holding a bank account with a de minimis account balance or (ii) have any material liabilities.

 

7.24            ABL Obligations. Until an ABL Amendment or an ABL Replacement is in effect, request any loans or advances under the ABL Credit Agreement or permit the outstanding principal balance under the ABL Credit Agreement to exceed $0 (other than ordinary course fees due thereunder which may be charged as loans under such facility to the extent any such fees are paid within one (1) Business Day).

 

95

 

 

VIII. CONDITIONS PRECEDENT.

 

8.1            Conditions to Initial Advances. The agreement of Lenders to make the initial Advances requested to be made on the Closing Date is subject to the satisfaction, or waiver by Agent and the Lenders, immediately prior to or concurrently with the making of such Advances, of the following conditions precedent:

 

(a)            Notes. Agent shall have received the Notes duly executed and delivered by an authorized officer of Borrower, other than the Delayed Draw Term Note;

 

(b)            Filings, Registrations and Recordings. Each document (including any Uniform Commercial Code financing statement, including fixture filings) required by this Agreement, any related agreement or under law or reasonably requested by Agent to be filed, registered or recorded in order to create, in favor of Agent, a perfected security interest in or lien upon the Collateral shall have been properly filed, registered or recorded in each jurisdiction in which the filing, registration or recordation thereof is so required or requested by Agent, and Agent shall have received evidence satisfactory to it (i) of each such filing, registration or recordation and satisfactory evidence of the payment of any necessary fee, tax or expense relating thereto and (ii) that no Liens exist with respect to the Collateral other than Permitted Encumbrances;

 

(c)            Company Proceedings of Credit Parties. Agent shall have received a certificate from the Secretary or Assistant Secretary of each Credit Party, in form and substance satisfactory to Agent: (i) attesting to the resolutions of such Credit Party’s Board of Directors or similar governing body authorizing its execution, delivery, and performance of this Agreement and the Other Documents to which it is a party, (ii) authorizing specific officers of such Credit Party to execute the same and (iii) attesting to the incumbency and signatures of such specific officers of such Credit Party;

 

(d)            Certificates. Agent shall have received, with respect to each Credit Party, a copy of the Certificate of Incorporation or Certificate of Formation, as applicable, of such Credit Party, and all amendments thereto, certified by the Secretary of State or other appropriate official of its jurisdiction of incorporation or formation together with copies of the bylaws or operating agreement of such Credit Party and all agreements of such Credit Party’s Equity Interest holders certified as accurate and complete by the Secretary or Assistant Secretary of such Credit Party;

 

(e)            Good Standing Certificates. Agent shall have received good standing certificates for each Credit Party, dated a recent date, issued by the Secretary of State or other appropriate official of such Credit Party’s jurisdiction of incorporation and each jurisdiction where the conduct of such Credit Party’s business activities or the ownership of its properties necessitates qualification;

 

(f)            Legal Opinion. Agent shall have received the executed legal opinions of (i) counsel to the Borrowers in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to Agent, which shall cover such matters incident to the transactions contemplated by this Agreement, and certain material Other Documents and related agreements as Agent may reasonably require;

 

96

 

 

(g)            No Litigation. (i) No litigation, investigation or proceeding before or by any arbitrator or Governmental Body shall be continuing or threatened against any Credit Party or against the officers or directors of any Credit Party (A) in connection with this Agreement, the Other Documents or any of the transactions contemplated thereby and which, in the reasonable opinion of Agent, is deemed material or (B) which could, as determined by Agent in its Permitted Discretion, reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect; and (ii) no injunction, writ, restraining order or other order of any nature which could, as determined by Agent in its Permitted Discretion, reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect, or inconsistent with the due consummation of the Closing Date Transactions shall have been issued by any Governmental Body;

 

(h)            Financial Condition Certificates. Agent shall have received an executed Financial Condition Certificate in the form of Exhibit H and related financial statements of DDH and its Subsidiaries evidencing that the Consolidated Total Net Leverage Ratio of DDH and its Subsidiaries, calculated on a Pro Forma Basis after giving effect to the Closing Date Transactions is not greater than 2.70 to 1.00;

 

(i)            Fees and Expenses. Agent shall have received all fees payable to Agent and Lenders on or prior to the Closing Date hereunder, including under the Fee Letter and pursuant to Article III, and all costs and expenses required to be paid on the Closing Date pursuant to Section 15.9;

 

(j)            Minimum Cash. Borrower shall, calculated on a pro forma basis after giving effect to the making of the Closing Date Term Loan and the transactions contemplated herein, have unrestricted cash on the balance sheet of not less than $4,000,000;

 

(k)            Structure. The ownership, capital, corporate, tax, organizational and legal structure of DDH and its Subsidiaries (after giving effect to the Closing Date Transactions) shall be satisfactory to Agent in its reasonable discretion;

 

(l)            Insurance. Agent shall have received in form and substance satisfactory to Agent, certified copies of the Credit Parties’ casualty insurance policies, together with lender loss payable endorsements naming Agent as lender loss payee, and certified copies of the Credit Parties’ liability insurance and cybersecurity insurance policies, together with endorsements naming Agent as a co-insured;

 

(m)            Payment Instructions. Agent shall have received written instructions from Borrowing Agent directing the application of proceeds of the initial Advances made pursuant to this Agreement, including the Funds Flow Statement;

 

(n)            Certain Deposit Accounts. Subject to Section 6.17(b), Agent shall have received, in form and substance satisfactory to Agent, duly executed agreements establishing the Funding Account and the Depository Accounts, together with Control Agreements acceptable to Agent;

 

(o)            Consents. Agent shall have received evidence of receipt of any necessary governmental Consents for the Closing Date Transactions and any other Consents where the failure to obtain such consents could reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect, as reasonably required by Agent;

 

97

 

 

(p)            Other Documents. Agent shall have received (i) the executed Fee Letter, (ii) the executed Pledge Agreement, (iii) the Intercreditor Agreement, (iv) the Preferred Equity Subordination Agreement, and (v) the other executed Other Documents;

 

(q)            Closing Certificate. Agent shall have received a closing certificate signed by the a Senior Officer of each Credit Party dated as of the Closing Date (which certifications may be included in the Financial Condition Certificate), stating that (i) all representations and warranties set forth in this Agreement and each of the Other Documents are true and correct in all material respects (without duplication of any materiality qualifier contained therein) on and as of the Closing Date as if made on the Closing Date (except to the extent that such representation or warranty expressly relates to an earlier date (in which event such representations and warranties are true and correct in all material respects (without duplication of any materiality qualifier contained therein) as of such earlier date)), (ii) each Credit Party is in compliance in all material respects with all of the terms and provisions set forth in this Agreement and the Other Documents required to be complied with or performed by such Credit Party on or before the Closing Date, (iii) on such date no Event of Default or Default has occurred and is continuing, and (iv) the other conditions set forth in Section 8.1 have been met as of the Closing Date;

 

(r)            Compliance with Laws. Agent shall be reasonably satisfied that the Credit Parties are in compliance in all material respects with all pertinent federal, state, local or territorial regulations, including those with respect to the Federal Occupational Safety and Health Act, the Environmental Protection Act, ERISA and the Trading with the Enemy Act;

 

(s)            [Reserved].

 

(t)            [Reserved].

 

(u)            Confirmation of Lien Releases. Agent shall have received a fully executed letter agreement from Silverpeak Credit Partners, LP reasonably satisfactory to it confirming that all Liens upon any of the assets of the Credit Parties or any of their Subsidiaries in favor of Silverpeak Credit Partners, LP have been released prior to or as of the Closing Date;

 

(v)            Closing Date Transactions. (i) Substantially concurrently with the funding of the Closing Date Term Loans, Borrower shall have completed the Closing Date Transactions in accordance with the terms of this Agreement and the Other Documents and (ii) Agent shall have received evidence that all necessary consents, permits and approvals (governmental or otherwise) required for the execution, delivery and performance by each Credit Party of the Other Documents have been duly obtained and are in full force and effect;

 

(w)            ABL Obligations. The outstanding principal balance of the ABL Obligations, calculated on a pro forma basis after giving effect to the making of the Closing Date Term Loan and application of the proceeds thereof, shall be $0.

 

(x)            Background Checks. Agent and each Lender shall have received, in form and substance acceptable to Agent, all documentation and other information requested in connection with applicable “know your customer” and anti-money laundering rules and regulations, including the USA Patriot Act;

 

98

 

 

(y)            Quality of Earnings. Agent shall have received and approved the Quality of Earnings Report, in form and substance reasonably acceptable to Agent, evidencing trailing twelve month adjusted EBITDA (as defined therein) of DDH and its Subsidiaries of not less than $6,920,000 for the trailing twelve month period ended October 31, 2021; and

 

(z)            Other. All corporate and other proceedings, and all documents, instruments and other legal matters in connection with the Closing Date Transactions shall be in form and substance satisfactory to Agent (and its counsel) in Agent’s Permitted Discretion.

 

8.2            Conditions to Delayed Draw Term Loans. The making of any Delayed Draw Term Loan is subject to the satisfaction, or waiver by Agent, immediately prior to or concurrently with the making of such Delayed Draw Term Loan, of the following conditions precedent:

 

(a)            No Event of Default or Default shall have occurred and be continuing on such date, or would exist after giving effect to the Advances requested to be made, on such date;

 

(b)            After giving effect to the making of any Delayed Draw Term Loan, DDH and its Subsidiaries (or DDH Holdings and its Subsidiaries after a Qualified IPO) shall, on a Pro Forma Basis, have a Consolidated Total Net Leverage Ratio of not greater than 2.70 to 1.00;

 

(c)            Each of the representations and warranties made by the Credit Parties in or pursuant to this Agreement, the Other Documents and any related agreements to which it is a party, and each of the representations and warranties contained in any certificate, document or financial or other statement furnished at any time under or in connection with this Agreement, the Other Documents or any related agreement shall be true and correct in all material respects (or in all respects with respect to any representation or warranty which, by its terms is limited as to materiality) on and as of such date as if made on and as of such date, except to the extent such representation or warranty was expressly made as of an earlier date, in which case, such representation and warranty was true and correct in all material respects (or in all respects with respect to any representation or warranty which, by its terms is limited as to materiality) on and as of such earlier date;

 

(d)            Agent shall have received a Delayed Draw Term Loan Note duly executed and delivered by an authorized officer of each Borrower;

 

(e)            Since the Closing Date, no Material Adverse Effect shall have occurred;

 

(f)            Agent and Lenders funding such Delayed Draw Term Loan shall have received all fees payable to Agent and Lenders on or prior to the applicable Delayed Draw Term Loan Funding Date hereunder, including under the Fee Letter, and all costs and expenses required to be paid pursuant to Section 15.9;

 

(g)            Agent shall have received a closing certificate signed by the a Senior Officer of each Credit Party dated as of the applicable Delayed Draw Term Loan Funding Date, stating that (i) all representations and warranties set forth in this Agreement and the Other Documents are true and correct in all material respects (without duplication of any materiality qualifier contained therein) on and as of such date, except to the extent such representation or warranty was expressly made as of an earlier date, in which case, such representation and warranty was true and correct in all material respects on and as of such earlier date, (ii) each Credit Party is on such date in compliance in all material respects (without duplication of any materiality qualifier contained therein) with all the terms and provisions set forth in this Agreement and the Other Documents, (iii) after giving effect to such Delayed Draw Term Loan (and any acquisition, investment or other transaction consummated in connection therewith) on a Pro Forma Basis (but without “netting” the cash proceeds of such Delayed Draw Term Loans funded on such date), the Credit Parties shall be in compliance with the financial covenants set forth in Section 6.5, and (iv) on such date no Default or Event of Default has occurred or is continuing; and

 

99

 

 

(h)            Borrowers shall have entered into an ABL Amendment or a Replacement ABL Credit Agreement prior to requesting such Delayed Draw Term Loan.

 

IX. INFORMATION AS TO CREDIT PARTIES.

 

The Credit Parties shall, until satisfaction in full of the Obligations (other than Inchoate Obligations), the termination of all obligations of Agent and the Lenders to make any Advances hereunder and termination of this Agreement:

 

9.1            Information Regarding Credit Parties. Promptly upon learning thereof, report to Agent (a) all matters materially and adversely affecting the value, enforceability or collectability of the Collateral, taken as a whole, and (b) any investigation, hearing, proceeding or other inquest by any Governmental Body into any Credit Party or any Affiliate of any Credit Party with respect to Anti-Terrorism Laws; provided, that, to the extent such investigation, hearing, proceeding or other inquest constitutes, as determined by Borrower, material non-public information, no Credit Party shall be required to report any such information to Agent until such time as Agent delivers to the Credit Parties a non-disclosure agreement that is in form and substance satisfactory to the Credit Parties in their reasonable discretion; provided further that the Credit Parties shall provide Agent prompt notice that such investigation, hearing, proceeding or inquest exists.

 

9.2            [Reserved].

 

9.3            [Reserved].

 

9.4            Litigation, etc. Notify Agent promptly in writing of any claim, litigation, suit or administrative proceeding affecting a Credit Party, whether or not the claim is covered by insurance, and of any litigation, suit or administrative proceeding, which in any such case affects a material portion of Collateral, which involves claims for money damages in excess of $250,000 or which could reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.

 

9.5            Material Occurrences. Deliver, or cause to be delivered, to Agent, promptly upon any Authorized Officer of any Credit Party obtaining knowledge (a) of any condition or event that constitutes a Default or an Event of Default or that notice has been given to any Credit Party with respect there, (b) that any Person has given notice to any Credit Party or any of its Subsidiaries or taken any other action with respect to any event or condition set forth in Section 10.11, (c) of the occurrence of any material violation of, or material non-compliance with, any material requirement of Applicable Laws by any Credit Party, or any of its Subsidiaries, including a description of such violation or non-compliance, or (d) of the occurrence of any Material Adverse Effect (or any other development in the business or affairs of any Credit Party which could reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect), a certificate of its Authorized Officers specifying the nature and period of existence of such condition, event or change, or specifying the notice given and action taken by any such Person and the nature of such claimed Event of Default, Default, event or condition or change (including, without limitation, with particularity any and all provisions of this Agreement and any Other Document that have been breached, as applicable), and what action the Credit Parties have taken, are taking and propose to take with respect thereto.

 

100

 

 

 

9.6            Management Discussion and Analysis. Deliver, or cause to be delivered, to Agent within forty-five (45) days following the end of each Fiscal Quarter of DDH, written discussion and analysis of the prior Fiscal Quarter prepared by the management of DDH in connection with financial statements delivered pursuant to Section 9.8.

 

9.7            Annual Financial Statements. Deliver, or cause to be delivered, to Agent within ninety (90) days after the end of each Fiscal Year of DDH, the balance sheets of DDH and its Subsidiaries (or DDH Holdings and its Subsidiaries after a Qualified IPO), prepared on a Consolidated Basis, as of the end of such Fiscal Year and the related statements of income, equity and cash flows of DDH and its Subsidiaries (or DDH Holdings and its Subsidiaries after a Qualified IPO), prepared on a Consolidated Basis, for such Fiscal Year, setting forth in each case after the first anniversary of the Closing Date in comparative form the corresponding figures for the previous Fiscal Year, in reasonable detail and consistent in all material respects with the manner of presentation as of the Closing Date, together with a Financial Officer Certification with respect thereto; and with respect to such financial statements beginning with Borrower’s Fiscal Year ending on or about December 31, 2021, be audited by an independent certified public accountants of recognized national or regional standing selected by DDH and reasonably acceptable to Agent (the “Accountants”), which report shall be unqualified as to going concern and scope of audit (other as to qualifications pertaining to periods not audited by said auditor); and, in each case, shall state that such financial statements fairly present, in all material respects, the financial position, on a Consolidated Basis, of DDH and its Subsidiaries (or DDH Holdings and its Subsidiaries after a Qualified IPO) as of the dates indicated and the results of their operations and their cash flows for the periods indicated in conformity with GAAP applied on a basis consistent with prior years (except as otherwise disclosed in such financial statements) and that the examination by such accountants in connection with such financial statements has been made in accordance with generally accepted auditing standards.

 

9.8            Quarterly Financial Statements. Deliver, or cause to be delivered, to Agent within forty-five (45) days after the end of each Fiscal Quarter of each Fiscal Year, the balance sheets of DDH and its Subsidiaries (or DDH Holdings and its Subsidiaries after a Qualified IPO), prepared on a Consolidated Basis, as of the end of such Fiscal Quarter and the related statements of income, equity and cash flows of DDH and its Subsidiaries (or DDH Holdings and its Subsidiaries after a Qualified IPO), prepared on a Consolidated Basis, for such Fiscal Quarter and for the prior three Fiscal Quarters during the trailing twelve-month calendar period, setting forth in each case after the first anniversary of the Closing Date in comparative form the corresponding figures for the corresponding periods of the previous Fiscal Year, all in reasonable detail and consistent in all material respects with the manner of presentation as of the Closing Date and complete and correct in all material respects, subject to normal and recurring year-end adjustments that individually and in the aggregate are not material to the Credit Parties’ business operations, together with a Financial Officer Certification with respect thereto. The reports delivered pursuant to this Section 9.8 shall be accompanied by a Compliance Certificate, an Impact Certificate, and a report setting forth the Key Performance Indicators for such period; provided, that to the extent that any Key Performance Indicators constitute material non-public information, the Credit Parties shall be under no obligation to deliver such information to Agent or any Lender until Agent and Lenders deliver to the Credit Parties a non-disclosure agreement that is in form and substance satisfactory to the Credit Parties in their reasonable discretion, containing, among other things, standstill provisions preventing transactions in the Credit Parties’ stock.

 

101 

 

 

9.9            Monthly Financial Statements. Deliver, or cause to be delivered, to Agent within thirty (30) days after the end of each calendar month of each Fiscal Year, the balance sheets of DDH and its Subsidiaries (or DDH Holdings and its Subsidiaries after a Qualified IPO), prepared on a Consolidated Basis, as of the end of such calendar month and the related statements of income, equity and cash flows of DDH and its Subsidiaries (or DDH Holdings and its Subsidiaries after a Qualified IPO), prepared on a Consolidated Basis, for such calendar month and for the period from the beginning of the then current Fiscal Year to the end of such calendar month, setting forth in each case (in the case of any such reporting after the first anniversary of the Closing Date) in comparative form the corresponding figures for the corresponding periods of the previous Fiscal Year, all in reasonable detail and consistent in all material respects with the manner of presentation as of the Closing Date and complete and correct in all material respects, subject to normal and recurring year-end adjustments that individually and in the aggregate are not material to the Credit Parties’ business operations and the absence of footnotes, together with a Financial Officer Certification with respect thereto. Notwithstanding the foregoing, to the extent any of the foregoing constitutes material non-public information, no Credit Party shall be required to deliver any such financial statements until such time as Agent delivers to the Credit Parties a non-disclosure agreement that is in form and substance satisfactory to the Credit Parties in their reasonable discretion containing, among other things, standstill provisions preventing transactions in the Credit Parties’ stock.

 

9.10            Acquired Intellectual Property. At any time upon request by Agent, furnish to Agent a report listing all registered copyrights, patents and trademarks (or applications therefor) acquired by any Credit Party during the period specified by Agent.

 

9.11            Additional Information. Deliver, or cause to be delivered, to Agent (a) such additional information as Agent shall reasonably request in order to enable Agent to determine whether the terms, covenants, provisions and conditions of this Agreement and the Notes have been complied with by the Credit Parties including, without the necessity of any request by Agent, prior written notice of any change (i) in any Credit Party’s legal name, (ii) in any Credit Party’s type of legal entity, (iii) in any Credit Party’s Federal Taxpayer Identification Number or (iv) in any Credit Party’s jurisdiction of incorporation, formation or organization, as applicable, (b) at least thirty (30) days prior thereto, notice of any Credit Party’s opening of any new office or place of business or any Credit Party’s closing of any existing office or place of business (which notice, if any, shall be deemed to amend Schedule 4.5), (c) promptly (but in no event later than five days after entry into the same) copies of all amendments, waivers and supplements to any of the Governing Document or ABL Loan Documents, and (d) such information regarding the operation, business affairs and financial conditions of DDH and its Subsidiaries which Agent may reasonably request.

 

102 

 

 

9.12            Projections. Deliver, or cause to be delivered, to Agent within thirty (30) days after the beginning of each Fiscal Year of DDH, forecasts prepared by management of DDH, on a Consolidated Basis (or for DDH Holdings on a Consolidated Basis subsequent to a Qualified IPO), in form reasonably satisfactory to Agent, of balance sheets and statements of income or operations and cash flows of DDH and its Subsidiaries (or DDH Holdings and its Subsidiaries after a Qualified IPO) on a quarterly basis for the immediately following Fiscal Year (including the Fiscal Year(s) in which the end of the Term occurs).; provided, that to the extent the foregoing constitutes material non-public information, no Credit Party shall be required to deliver any such financial statements until such time as Agent delivers to the Credit Parties a non-disclosure agreement that is in form and substance satisfactory to the Credit Parties in their reasonable discretion containing, among other things, standstill provisions preventing transactions in the Credit Parties’ stock.

 

9.13            Small Business Administration. So long as any Lender is an SBIC Lender, the Credit Parties shall, and shall cause their Subsidiaries to, within ten (10) days of receipt of request from any SBIC Lender, deliver to such SBIC Lender any information requested by the SBA.

 

9.14            Notice of Suits, Adverse Events. Furnish Agent with prompt written notice of (i) any lapse or other termination of any Consent issued to any Credit Party by any Governmental Body or any other Person that is material to the operation of the Credit Parties’ business, (ii) any refusal by any Governmental Body or any other Person to renew or extend any such Consent; and (iii) copies of any periodic or special reports filed by any Credit Party with any Governmental Body or Person, if such reports indicate any material change in the business, operations, affairs or condition of any Credit Party, or if copies thereof are requested by Lender, and (iv) copies of any material notices and other communications from any Governmental Body or Person which specifically relate to any Credit Party to the extent any such notices or communications relate to a Material Adverse Effect; provided, that, at any time prior to a Qualified IPO while the Credit Parties are contemplating a Qualified IPO, the foregoing shall not apply to notices and communications with any Governmental Body relating solely to procedural or filing requirements for such Qualified IPO .

 

9.15            ERISA Notices and Requests. Deliver, or cause to be delivered, to Agent, (i) promptly upon becoming aware of the occurrence of or forthcoming occurrence of any ERISA Event, a written notice specifying the nature thereof, what action any Credit Party, any of its Subsidiaries or any of their respective ERISA Affiliates has taken, is taking or proposes to take with respect thereto and, when known, any action taken or threatened by the Internal Revenue Service, the Department of Labor, the PBGC, or any other party with respect thereto; (ii) (1) promptly upon reasonable request of Agent, copies of each Schedule B (Actuarial Information) to the annual report (Form 5500 Series) filed by any Credit Party, any of its Subsidiaries or any of their respective ERISA Affiliates with respect to each Pension Plan; and (2) promptly after their receipt, copies of all notices received by any Credit Party, any of its Subsidiaries or any of their respective ERISA Affiliates from a Multiemployer Plan sponsor concerning an ERISA Event; and (iii) such additional information relating to the ERISA Event as Agent may reasonably request. Each notice pursuant to this Section 9.15 shall be accompanied by a statement of an Authorized Officer of DDH setting forth details of the occurrence referred to therein and stating what action DDH and/or the other applicable Credit Party has taken and proposes to take with respect thereto.

 

103 

 

 

9.16            [Reserved].

 

9.17            Board Observation Rights. DH shall notify Agent in writing of the date and time for each meeting of the board of managers or directors, as applicable, which such meetings shall be no less often than quarterly, of each Borrower in accordance with the Governing Documents of such Borrower, and shall deliver to Agent all reports and other materials that are provided to the board of directors; provided that to the extent such reports or materials constitute, as determined by Borrower, material non-public information, no Credit Party shall be required to deliver any such reports or materials until such time as Agent delivers to the Credit Parties a non-disclosure agreement that is in form and substance satisfactory to the Credit Parties in their reasonable discretion containing, among other things, standstill provisions preventing transactions in the Credit Parties’ stock. Subject to the execution by Agent of a board observer agreement in form and substance reasonably acceptable to the Borrowers, Agent shall have the right to have up to two (2) designated representatives, at the Borrowers’ expense (including, reimbursement of his or her reasonable out-of-pocket expenses incurred in connection with such designation), and subject to reasonable and customary confidentiality obligations, attend such meetings of the board of directors as an observer. Notwithstanding the foregoing, any such observer may be excluded from any such meeting, and such observer and Agent shall not be required to be delivered or receive any such information and materials (or the relevant portions thereof), if DDH or the applicable Borrower reasonably determines that such exclusion or reservation of delivery is necessary, based on advice of counsel, to avoid an actual conflict of interest, including with respect to any indebtedness of DDH or any of its Subsidiaries held by the applicable Agent or any other Lender, or to protect attorney-client privilege.

 

X. EVENTS OF DEFAULT.

 

The occurrence of any one or more of the following events shall constitute an “Event of Default”:

 

10.1            Nonpayment. Failure by any Credit Party to pay (i) any principal Obligations when due; or (ii) within three (3) Business Days of when due, any interest on the Obligations or any fee or any other amount due hereunder or in any Other Document, in each case, whether at maturity, by reason of acceleration pursuant to the terms of this Agreement, by notice of intention to prepay, or by required prepayment;

 

10.2            Breach of Representation. Any representation, warranty, certification or other statement made or deemed made by any Credit Party in this Agreement, any Other Document or in any statement or certificate at any time given by any Credit Party or any of its Subsidiaries in writing pursuant hereto or thereto or in connection herewith or therewith shall be false in any material respect (or in any respect with respect to any representation or warranty which, by its terms is limited as to materiality) as of the date made or deemed made;

 

104 

 

 

10.3            Noncompliance. Except as otherwise provided for in Section 10.1, failure or neglect of any Credit Party, or any other applicable Person, to perform, keep or observe any term, provision, condition, covenant contained in:

 

(a)            Sections 2.8, 4.9, 4.10, 4.11, 4.19(c), 6.2, 6.5, 6.12(b), 6.14, 6.15, 6.16 (other than 6.16(b)), Article VII, 9.5, 9.6, 9.7, 9.8, 9.9, 9.12 and 9.17, hereof;

 

(b)            Sections 6.3, 6.6, 9.1, 9.11, 9.14, and 9.15 hereof which is not cured within ten (10) from the occurrence of such failure or neglect; or

 

(c)            this Agreement or any of the Other Documents, other than any such term referred to in any other clause of this Section 10.3 and except as provided in Section 4.21, and such default shall not have been remedied or waived within thirty (30) days after the earlier of (i) an Authorized Officer of any Credit Party becoming aware of such default, or (ii) receipt by the Credit Parties of written notice from Agent or any Lender of such default;

 

10.4            Reserved.

 

10.5            Judgments and Attachments. (i) Any one or more non-appealable money judgments, writs or warrants of attachment or similar process involving an aggregate amount at any time in excess of $250,000 (to the extent not adequately covered by insurance as to which a solvent and unaffiliated insurance company has acknowledged coverage) shall be entered or filed against any Credit Party or any of its Subsidiaries or any of their respective assets and shall remain undischarged, unvacated, unbonded or unstayed for a period of sixty (60) days or enforcement proceedings shall have been commenced by a creditor upon such judgment, writ, warrant or process; or (ii) any non-appealable non-monetary judgment or order shall be rendered against any Credit Party or any of its Subsidiaries that could reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect, and shall remain undischarged, unvacated, unbonded or unstayed for a period of sixty (60) days or enforcement proceedings shall have been commenced by a creditor upon such judgment, writ, warrant or process;

 

10.6            Criminal Proceeding. The institution in any court of a criminal proceeding against any Credit Party or officer or director of any Credit Party which would have a Material Adverse Effect, or the indictment of any Credit Party for any misdemeanors resulting from fraudulent conduct or any felony, and in any such case the proceeding is not stayed or dismissed, or the indictment is not withdrawn, within thirty (30) days of such institution or indictment;

 

10.7            Bankruptcy. (a) (i) A court of competent jurisdiction shall enter a decree or order for relief in respect of any Credit Party or any Subsidiary of a Credit Party in an involuntary case under the Bankruptcy Code or Debtor Relief Laws now or hereafter in effect, which decree or order is not stayed; or any other similar relief shall be granted under any applicable federal or state law; or (ii) (w) an involuntary case shall be commenced against any Credit Party or any Subsidiary of a Credit Party under the Bankruptcy Code or other Debtor Relief Laws now or hereafter in effect; or (x) a decree or order of a court having jurisdiction in the premises for the appointment of a receiver, liquidator, sequestrator, trustee, custodian or other officer having similar powers over any Credit Party or any Subsidiary of a Credit Party, or over all or a substantial part of its property, shall have been entered; or (y) there shall have occurred the involuntary appointment of an interim receiver, trustee or other custodian of any Credit Party or any Subsidiary of a Credit Party for all or a substantial part of its property; or (z) a warrant of attachment, execution or similar process shall have been issued against any substantial part of the property of any Credit Party or any Subsidiary of a Credit Party, and any such event described in this clause (ii) shall continue for ninety (90) days without having been dismissed, bonded or discharged; or (b) (i) any Credit Party or any Subsidiary of a Credit Party shall have an order for relief entered with respect to it or shall commence a voluntary case under the Bankruptcy Code or other Debtor Relief Laws now or hereafter in effect, or shall consent to the entry of an order for relief in an involuntary case, or to the conversion of an involuntary case to a voluntary case, under any such law, or shall consent to the appointment of or taking possession by a receiver, trustee or other custodian for all or a substantial part of its property; (ii) or any Credit Party or any Subsidiary of a Credit Party shall make any assignment for the benefit of creditors; or (iii) or the board of directors (or similar governing body) of any Credit Party or any Subsidiary of a Credit Party or any committee thereof shall adopt any resolution or otherwise authorize any action to approve any of the actions referred to in this Section 10.7 or in Section 10.8;

 

105 

 

 

10.8            Inability to Pay. (i) Any Credit Party or any Subsidiary of a Credit Party shall be unable, or shall fail generally, or shall admit in writing its inability, to pay its debts as such debts become due; or (ii) any order, judgment or decree shall be entered against any Credit Party or any Subsidiary of a Credit Party decreeing the dissolution or split up of such Credit Party or such Subsidiary and such order shall remain undischarged or unstayed for a period in excess of thirty (30) days;

 

10.9            Government Settlement. Any Credit Party enters into a settlement agreement with any Governmental Body that (a) results in aggregate liability as to any single or related services of transactions, incidents or conditions of $250,000 or more, or (ii) would reasonably be expected to have, individually or in the aggregate, a Material Adverse Effect;

 

10.10            Material Adverse Change. The occurrence of any event or development which could reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect;

 

10.11            Cross Default to other Indebtedness. (i) Failure of any Credit Party or any of its Subsidiaries to pay when due any principal of or interest on or any other amount payable in respect of one or more items of Indebtedness (other than Indebtedness referred to in Section 7.8(a)) in an aggregate principal amount of $250,000 or more (including, without limitation, an Event of Default under the ABL Loan Documents), in each case beyond the grace or cure period, if any, provided therefor; or (ii) breach or default by any Credit Party with respect to any other term of (1) one or more items of Indebtedness in the aggregate principal amounts referred to in clause (i) above, or (2) any loan agreement, mortgage, indenture or other agreement relating to such item(s) of Indebtedness, in each case beyond the grace or cure period, if any, provided therefor, if the effect of such breach or default is to cause, or to permit the holder or holders of that Indebtedness (or a trustee on behalf of such holder or holders), to cause, that Indebtedness to become or be declared due and payable (or subject to a compulsory repurchase or redeemable) prior to its stated maturity or the stated maturity of any underlying obligation, as the case may be (regardless of whether the holder of such Indebtedness shall actually accelerate, terminate or otherwise exercise any rights and remedies with respect to such Indebtedness);

 

10.12            Breach of Guarantee. Termination or breach of any Guarantee or Guarantor Security Agreement or similar agreement executed and delivered to Agent in connection with the Obligations of Borrowers, or if any Guarantor attempts, in writing or by legal action, to terminate, challenges the validity of, or its liability under, any such Guarantee or Guarantor Security Agreement or similar agreement;

 

106 

 

 

10.13            Change of Control. Any Change of Control shall occur;

 

10.14            Invalidity. At any time after the execution and delivery thereof, (i) this Agreement or any Other Document ceases to be in full force and effect (other than by reason of a release of Collateral in accordance with the terms hereof or thereof or the satisfaction in full of the Obligations (other than Inchoate Obligations) in accordance with the terms hereof) or shall be declared null and void, or Agent shall not have or shall cease to have a valid and perfected Lien in any Collateral with the priority required by this Agreement and the Other Documents, or (ii) any Credit Party shall contest the validity or enforceability of this Agreement or any Other Document in writing or deny in writing that it has any further liability, including with respect to future advances by Agent or any Lender under this Agreement or under any Other Document to which it is a party;

 

10.15            Seizures. Any material portion of the Collateral shall be seized, subject to garnishment or taken by a Governmental Body, or any Credit Party, or the title and rights of any Credit Party, shall have become the subject matter of claim, litigation, suit, garnishment or other proceeding which might, as determined by Agent in its Permitted Discretion, upon final determination, result in impairment or loss of the security provided by this Agreement or the Other Documents;

 

10.16            Operations. Other than those business interruptions which are customary in Credit Party’s industry, the operations of any Credit Party’s manufacturing facility are interrupted at any time for more than fifteen (15) consecutive days, unless such Credit Party shall (i) be entitled to receive for such period of interruption, proceeds of business interruption or similar insurance in an amount sufficient to assure that its per diem cash needs during such period is at least equal to its average per diem cash needs for the consecutive three month period immediately preceding the initial date of interruption and (ii) receive such proceeds in the amount described in clause (i) not later than thirty (30) days following the initial date of any such interruption; provided, however, that notwithstanding the provisions of clauses (i) and (ii) of this Section, an Event of Default shall be deemed to have occurred if such Credit Party shall be receiving such proceeds for a period of thirty (30) consecutive days;

 

10.17            Pension Benefit Plans. There shall occur one or more ERISA Events which individually or in the aggregate results in liability of any Credit Party, any of its Subsidiaries or any of their respective ERISA Affiliates in excess of $250,000 during the term hereof and which is not paid by the applicable due date;

 

10.18            Anti-Terrorism Laws. If (a) any representation or warranty contained in (i) Section 5.29 hereof or (ii) any corresponding section of any Guarantee is or becomes false or misleading at any time, (b) any Borrower shall fail to comply with its obligations under Section 7.18 hereof, or (c) any Guarantor shall fail to comply with its obligations under any section of any Guarantee containing provisions comparable to those set forth in Sections 5.29 and 7.18 hereof;

 

107 

 

 

10.19            Invalidity of Intercreditor Agreement or Subordination Provisions. The Intercreditor Agreement or any subordination agreement with respect to any Subordinated Debt shall cease to be in full force and effect, or any Person party to the Intercreditor Agreement or any such subordination agreement, other than Agent or any Lender party to this Agreement, shall breach the provisions thereof or shall contest in any manner the validity, binding nature or enforceability of any such provision or a proceeding shall be commenced by any such Person or any Governmental Body having jurisdiction over such Person, seeking to establish the invalidity or unenforceability thereof.

 

XI. LENDERS’ RIGHTS AND REMEDIES AFTER DEFAULT, ETC.

 

11.1            Rights and Remedies.

 

(a)            Upon the occurrence of (i) an Event of Default pursuant to Section 10.7 or 10.8, all Obligations shall be immediately due and payable and this Agreement and the obligation of Lenders to make Advances shall be deemed terminated; and (ii) any of the other Events of Default and at any time during the continuance thereafter, at the option of Agent or at the direction of Required Lenders all Obligations shall be immediately due and payable and Agent or Required Lenders shall have the right to terminate this Agreement and to terminate the obligation of Lenders to make Advances. Upon the occurrence of any Event of Default, Agent shall have the right to exercise any and all rights and remedies provided for herein, under the Other Documents, under the Uniform Commercial Code and at law or equity generally, including the right to foreclose the security interests granted herein and to realize upon any Collateral by any available judicial procedure and/or to take possession of and sell any or all of the Collateral with or without judicial process. Agent may enter any of any Credit Party’s premises or other premises without legal process and without incurring liability to any Credit Party therefor, and Agent may thereupon, or at any time thereafter, in its discretion without notice or demand, take the Collateral and remove the same to such place as Agent may deem advisable and Agent may require the Credit Parties to make the Collateral available to Agent at a convenient place. With or without having the Collateral at the time or place of sale, Agent may sell the Collateral, or any part thereof, at public or private sale, at any time or place, in one or more sales, at such price or prices, and upon such terms, either for cash, credit or future delivery, as Agent may elect. Except as to that part of the Collateral which is perishable or threatens to decline speedily in value or is of a type customarily sold on a recognized market, Agent shall give Borrowing Agent reasonable notification of such sale or sales, it being agreed that in all events written notice mailed to Borrowing Agent at least ten (10) days prior to such sale or sales is reasonable notification. At any public sale Agent or any Lender may bid (including credit bid) for and become the purchaser, and Agent, any Lender or any other purchaser at any such sale thereafter shall hold the Collateral sold absolutely free from any claim or right of whatsoever kind, including any equity of redemption and all such claims, rights and equities are hereby expressly waived and released by each Credit Party. In connection with the exercise of the foregoing remedies, including the sale of Inventory, Agent is granted a perpetual nonrevocable, royalty free, nonexclusive license and Agent is granted permission to use all of each Credit Party’s (y) trademarks, trade styles, trade names, patents, patent applications, copyrights, service marks, licenses, franchises and other proprietary rights which are used or useful in connection with Inventory for the purpose of marketing, advertising for sale and selling or otherwise disposing of such Inventory and (z) Equipment for the purpose of completing the manufacture of unfinished goods. The cash proceeds realized from the sale of any Collateral shall be applied to the Obligations in the order set forth in Section 11.5 hereof. Noncash proceeds will only be applied to the Obligations as they are converted into cash. If any deficiency shall arise, the Credit Parties shall remain liable to Agent and Lenders therefor.

 

108 

 

 

(b)            To the extent that Applicable Law imposes duties on Agent to exercise remedies in a commercially reasonable manner, each Credit Party acknowledges and agrees that it is not commercially unreasonable for Agent (i) to fail to incur expenses reasonably deemed significant by Agent to prepare Collateral for disposition or otherwise to complete raw material or work in process into finished goods or other finished products for disposition, (ii) to fail to obtain third party consents for access to Collateral to be disposed of, or to obtain or, if not required by other law, to fail to obtain governmental or third party consents for the collection or disposition of Collateral to be collected or disposed of, (iii) to fail to exercise collection remedies against Customers or other Persons obligated on Collateral or to remove Liens on or any adverse claims against Collateral, (iv) to exercise collection remedies against Customers and other Persons obligated on Collateral directly or through the use of collection agencies and other collection specialists, (v) to advertise dispositions of Collateral through publications or media of general circulation, whether or not the Collateral is of a specialized nature, (vi) to contact other Persons, whether or not in the same business as the Credit Parties (or any of them), for expressions of interest in acquiring all or any portion of such Collateral, (vii) to hire one or more professional auctioneers to assist in the disposition of Collateral, whether or not the Collateral is of a specialized nature, (viii) to dispose of Collateral by utilizing internet sites that provide for the auction of assets of the types included in the Collateral or that have the reasonable capacity of doing so, or that match buyers and sellers of assets, (ix) to dispose of assets in wholesale rather than retail markets, (x) to disclaim disposition warranties, such as title, possession or quiet enjoyment, (xi) to purchase insurance or credit enhancements to insure Agent against risks of loss, collection or disposition of Collateral or to provide to Agent a guaranteed return from the collection or disposition of Collateral, or (xii) to the extent deemed appropriate by Agent, to obtain the services of other brokers, investment bankers, consultants and other professionals to assist Agent in the collection or disposition of any of the Collateral. Each Credit Party acknowledges that the purpose of this Section 11.1(b) is to provide non-exhaustive indications of what actions or omissions by Agent would not be commercially unreasonable in Agent’s exercise of remedies against the Collateral and that other actions or omissions by Agent shall not be deemed commercially unreasonable solely on account of not being indicated in this Section 11.1(b). Without limitation upon the foregoing, nothing contained in this Section 11.1(b) shall be construed to grant any rights to any Credit Party or to impose any duties on Agent that would not have been granted or imposed by this Agreement or by Applicable Law in the absence of this Section 11.1(b).

 

(c)            Without limiting any other provisions hereof:

 

(i)            At any bona fide public sale, and to the extent permitted by Applicable Law, at any private sale, Agent shall be free to purchase all or any part of the Investment Property. Any such sale may be on cash or credit. Agent shall be authorized at any such sale (if it deems it advisable to do so) to restrict the prospective bidders or purchasers to persons who will represent and agree that they are purchasing the Investment Property for their own account in compliance with Regulation D of the Securities Act or any other applicable exemption available under the Securities Act. Agent will not be obligated to make any sale if it determines not to do so, regardless of the fact that notice of the sale may have been given. Agent may adjourn any sale and sell at the time and place to which the sale is adjourned. If the Investment Property is customarily sold on a recognized market or threatens to decline speedily in value, Agent may sell such Investment Property at any time without giving prior notice to any Credit Party or other Person.

 

109 

 

 

(ii)            Each Credit Party recognizes that Agent may be unable to effect or cause to be effected a public sale of the Investment Property by reason of certain prohibitions of the Securities Act, so that Agent may be compelled to resort to one or more private sales to a restricted group of purchasers who will be obligated to agree, among other things, to acquire the Investment Property for their own account, for investment and without a view to the distribution or resale thereof. Each Credit Party understands that private sales so made may be at prices and on other terms less favorable to the seller than if the Investment Property were sold at public sales, and agrees that Agent has no obligation to delay or agree to delay the sale of any of the Investment Property for the period of time necessary to permit the issuer of the securities which are part of the Investment Property (even if the issuer would agree), to register such securities for sale under the Securities Act. Each Credit Party agrees that private sales made under the foregoing circumstances shall be deemed to have been made in a commercially reasonable manner.

 

(iii)            The net cash proceeds arising from the disposition of the Investment Property after deducting expenses incurred by Agent will be applied to the Obligations pursuant to Section 11.5 hereof. If any excess remains after the discharge of all of the Obligations, the same will be paid to the applicable Credit Party or to any other Person that may be legally entitled thereto.

 

(iv)            At any time after the occurrence and during the continuance of an Event of Default (A) Agent may transfer any or all of the Investment Property into its name or that of its nominee and, after providing the Borrowers with one (1) Business Days prior written notice, may exercise all voting rights with respect to the Investment Property, but no such transfer shall constitute a taking of such Investment Property in satisfaction of any or all of the Obligations, and (B) Agent shall be entitled to receive, for application to the Obligations, all cash or stock dividends and distributions, interest and premiums declared or paid on the Investment Property.

 

11.2            Agent’s Discretion. Agent shall have the right in its sole discretion to determine which rights, Liens, security interests or remedies Agent may at any time pursue, relinquish, subordinate, or modify, which procedures, timing and methodologies to employ, and what any other action to take with respect to any or all of the Collateral and in what order, thereto and such determination will not in any way modify or affect any of Agent’s or Lenders’ rights hereunder as against the Credit Parties or each other.

 

11.3            Setoff. Subject to Section 14.12, in addition to any other rights which Agent or any Lender may have under Applicable Law, upon the occurrence of an Event of Default hereunder, Agent and such Lender shall have a right, immediately and without notice of any kind, to apply any Credit Party’s property held by Agent and such Lender or any of their Affiliates to reduce the Obligations and to exercise any and all rights of setoff which may be available to Agent and such Lender with respect to any deposits held by Agent or such Lender.

 

110 

 

 

11.4            Rights and Remedies not Exclusive. The enumeration of the foregoing rights and remedies is not intended to be exhaustive and the exercise of any rights or remedy shall not preclude the exercise of any other right or remedies provided for herein or otherwise provided by law, all of which shall be cumulative and not alternative.

 

11.5            Allocation of Payments After Event of Default. Notwithstanding any other provisions of this Agreement to the contrary, after the occurrence and during the continuance of an Event of Default, all amounts collected or received by Agent on account of the Obligations or any other amounts outstanding under any of the Other Documents or in respect of the Collateral may, at Agent’s discretion, and shall, at the direction of the Required Lenders, be paid over or delivered as follows:

 

FIRST, to the payment of all reasonable costs and expenses (including reasonable attorneys’ fees and allocated costs of internal counsel) of Agent in connection with enforcing its rights and the rights of the Lenders under this Agreement and the Other Documents and any protective advances made by Agent with respect to the Collateral under or pursuant to the terms of this Agreement;

 

SECOND, to payment of any fees owed to Agent;

 

THIRD, to the payment of all reasonable out-of-pocket costs and expenses (including reasonable documented (to the extent readily available) attorneys’ fees and allocated costs of internal counsel) of each of the Lenders to the extent owing to such Lender pursuant to the terms of this Agreement;

 

FOURTH, to the payment of all of the Obligations consisting of accrued fees and interest;

 

FIFTH, to the payment of the outstanding principal amounts of Term Loans, on a pro rata basis;

 

SIXTH, to all other Obligations and other obligations which shall have become due and payable under the Other Documents or otherwise and not repaid pursuant to clauses “FIRST” through “FIFTH” above; and

 

SEVENTH, to the payment of the surplus, if any, to whoever may be lawfully entitled to receive such surplus.

 

In carrying out the foregoing, (i) amounts received shall be applied in the numerical order provided until exhausted prior to application to the next succeeding category; and (ii) each of the Lenders shall receive (so long as it is not a Defaulting Lender) an amount equal to its pro rata share (based on the proportion that the then outstanding Advances held by such Lender bears to the aggregate then outstanding Advances) of amounts available to be applied pursuant to clauses “FOURTH”, “FIFTH,” “SIXTH”, and “SEVENTH” above.

 

XII. WAIVERS AND JUDICIAL PROCEEDINGS.

 

12.1            Waiver of Notice. Each Credit Party hereby waives notice of non-payment of any of the Receivables, demand, presentment, protest and notice thereof with respect to any and all instruments, notice of acceptance hereof, notice of loans or advances made, credit extended, Collateral received or delivered, or any other action taken in reliance hereon, and all other demands and notices of any description, except such as are expressly provided for herein.

 

111 

 

 

12.2            Delay. No delay or omission on Agent’s or any Lender’s part in exercising any right, remedy or option shall operate as a waiver of such or any other right, remedy or option or of any Default or Event of Default.

 

12.3            Jury Waiver. TO THE MAXIMUM EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, EACH PARTY TO THIS AGREEMENT HEREBY EXPRESSLY WAIVES ANY RIGHT TO TRIAL BY JURY OF ANY CLAIM, COUNTERCLAIM, DEMAND, ACTION OR CAUSE OF ACTION (a) ARISING UNDER THIS AGREEMENT, ANY OTHER DOCUMENT OR ANY OTHER INSTRUMENT, DOCUMENT OR AGREEMENT EXECUTED OR DELIVERED IN CONNECTION HEREWITH, OR (b) IN ANY WAY CONNECTED WITH OR RELATED OR INCIDENTAL TO THE DEALINGS OF THE PARTIES HERETO OR ANY OF THEM WITH RESPECT TO THIS AGREEMENT, ANY OTHER DOCUMENT OR ANY OTHER INSTRUMENT, DOCUMENT OR AGREEMENT EXECUTED OR DELIVERED IN CONNECTION HEREWITH, OR THE TRANSACTIONS RELATED HERETO OR THERETO IN EACH CASE WHETHER NOW EXISTING OR HEREAFTER ARISING, AND WHETHER SOUNDING IN CONTRACT OR TORT OR OTHERWISE AND EACH PARTY HEREBY CONSENTS THAT ANY SUCH CLAIM, COUNTERCLAIM, DEMAND, ACTION OR CAUSE OF ACTION SHALL BE DECIDED BY COURT TRIAL WITHOUT A JURY, AND THAT ANY PARTY TO THIS AGREEMENT MAY FILE AN ORIGINAL COUNTERPART OR A COPY OF THIS SECTION WITH ANY COURT AS WRITTEN EVIDENCE OF THE CONSENTS OF THE PARTIES HERETO TO THE WAIVER OF THEIR RIGHT TO TRIAL BY JURY.

 

XIII. EFFECTIVE DATE AND TERMINATION.

 

13.1            Term. This Agreement, which shall inure to the benefit of and shall be binding upon the respective successors and permitted assigns of the Credit Parties, Agent and each Lender, shall become effective on the date hereof and shall continue in full force and effect until December 3, 2026 (the “Term”), unless sooner terminated as herein provided. Borrowers may terminate this Agreement at any time upon fifteen (15) Business Days’ prior written notice upon payment in full of the Obligations (other than Inchoate Obligations).

 

13.2            Termination. The termination of this Agreement shall not affect any Credit Party’s, Agent’s or any Lender’s rights, or any of the Obligations having their inception prior to the effective date of such termination or any Inchoate Obligations, and the provisions hereof shall continue to be fully operative until (a) all transactions entered into, rights or interests created or Obligations (other than Inchoate Obligations) have been fully paid in immediately available funds and (b) each of the Credit Parties have released Agent and Lenders from and against any and all claims of any nature whatsoever that any Credit Party may have against Agent and Lenders (or any of them). The security interests, Liens and rights granted to Agent and Lenders hereunder and the financing statements filed in connection herewith shall continue in full force and effect, notwithstanding the termination of this Agreement or the fact that Borrowers’ Account may from time to time be temporarily in a zero or credit position, until all of the Obligations (other than Inchoate Obligations) have been paid and performed in full in immediately available funds after the termination of all obligations of Agent and Lenders to make any Advances hereunder or Borrowers have furnished Agent and Lenders with an indemnification satisfactory to Agent and Lenders with respect thereto. Accordingly, each Credit Party waives any rights which it may have under the Uniform Commercial Code to demand the filing of termination statements with respect to the Collateral unless and until all of the Obligations (other than Inchoate Obligations) have been paid and performed in full in immediately available funds after the termination of all obligations of Agent and Lenders to make any Advances hereunder, and Agent shall not be required to send such termination statements to any Credit Party, or to file them with any filing office, until such time. When all of the Obligations (other than Inchoate Obligations) have been paid and performed in full in immediately available funds after the termination of all obligations of Agent and Lenders to make any Advances hereunder, Agent will, at Borrowers’ sole expense, execute and deliver any termination statements, lien releases, mortgage releases, re-assignments of trademarks, discharges of security interests, and other similar discharge or release documents (and, if applicable, in recordable form) as are reasonably necessary to release, as of record, Agent’s Liens and all notices of security interests and liens previously filed by Agent with respect to the Obligations. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary set forth herein, all representations, warranties, waivers and indemnities of the Credit Parties contained herein or in any Other Document shall survive the payment in full of the Obligations and termination of this Agreement and/or such Other Documents.

 

112 

 

 

13.3            Revival and Reinstatement of Obligations. If the incurrence or payment of the Obligations by any Credit Party or the transfer to Agent or any Lender of any property should for any reason subsequently be declared to be void or voidable under any state or federal law relating to creditors’ rights, including provisions of the Bankruptcy Code or any other Debtor Relief Laws relating to fraudulent conveyances, preferences, or other voidable or recoverable payments of money or transfers of property (each, a “Voidable Transfer”), and if Agent or any Lender is required to repay or restore, in whole or in part, any such Voidable Transfer, or elects to do so upon the reasonable advice of its counsel, then, as to any such Voidable Transfer, or the amount thereof that Agent or such Lender is required or elects to repay or restore, and as to all reasonable costs, expenses, and attorneys’ fees of Agent and such Lender related thereto, the liability of each Credit Party automatically shall be revived, reinstated, and restored and shall exist as though such Voidable Transfer had never been made and any Liens held by Agent previously released or terminated with respect to any Collateral shall be reinstated as of the date on which Agent or Lenders (as applicable) repays or restores such Voidable Transfer.

 

XIV. REGARDING AGENT.

 

14.1            Appointment. Each Lender hereby designates Lafayette Square to act as Agent for such Lender under this Agreement and the Other Documents. Each Lender hereby irrevocably authorizes Agent to take such action on its behalf under the provisions of this Agreement and the Other Documents and to exercise such powers and to perform such duties hereunder and thereunder as are specifically delegated to or required of Agent by the terms hereof and thereof and such other powers as are reasonably incidental thereto and Agent shall hold all Collateral, payments of principal and interest, fees (except the fees set forth in the Fee Letter), charges and collections received pursuant to this Agreement, for the ratable benefit of Lenders. Agent may perform any of its duties hereunder by or through its agents or employees. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in this Agreement, Agent shall act or refrain from acting or exercise any discretion (and shall be fully protected in so acting or refraining from acting) only with the consent of the Required Lenders; provided, however, that Agent shall not be required to take any action which exposes Agent to liability or which is contrary to this Agreement or the Other Documents or Applicable Law unless Agent is furnished with an indemnification reasonably satisfactory to Agent with respect thereto.

 

113 

 

 

14.2            Nature of Duties. Agent shall have no duties or responsibilities except those expressly set forth in this Agreement and the Other Documents. Neither Agent nor any of its officers, directors, employees or agents shall be (i) liable for any action taken or omitted by them as such hereunder or in connection herewith, unless caused by their gross (not mere) negligence or willful misconduct (as determined by a court of competent jurisdiction in a final non-appealable judgment), or (ii) responsible in any manner for any recitals, statements, representations or warranties made by any Credit Party or any of their respective officers contained in this Agreement, or in any of the Other Documents or in any certificate, report, statement or other document referred to or provided for in, or received by Agent under or in connection with, this Agreement or any of the Other Documents or for the value, validity, effectiveness, genuineness, due execution, enforceability or sufficiency of this Agreement, or any of the Other Documents or for any failure of any Credit Party to perform its obligations hereunder or under any Other Document. Agent shall not be under any obligation to any Lender to ascertain or to inquire as to the observance or performance of any of the agreements contained in, or conditions of, this Agreement or any of the Other Documents, or to inspect the properties, books or records of any of the Credit Parties. The duties of Agent as respects the Advances to Borrowers shall be mechanical and administrative in nature; Agent shall not have by reason of this Agreement a fiduciary relationship in respect of any Lender; and nothing in this Agreement, expressed or implied, is intended to or shall be so construed as to impose upon Agent any obligations in respect of this Agreement or the transactions described herein except as expressly set forth herein.

 

14.3            Lack of Reliance on Agent and Resignation. Independently and without reliance upon Agent or any other Lender, each Lender has made and shall continue to make (a) its own independent investigation of the financial condition and affairs of each Credit Party in connection with the making and the continuance of the Advances hereunder and the taking or not taking of any action in connection herewith, and (b) its own appraisal of the creditworthiness of each Credit Party. Agent shall have no duty or responsibility, either initially or on a continuing basis, to provide any Lender with any credit or other information with respect thereto, whether coming into its possession before making of the Advances or at any time or times thereafter except as shall be provided by the Credit Parties pursuant to the terms hereof. Agent shall not be responsible to any Lender for any recitals, statements, information, representations or warranties herein or in any agreement, document, certificate or a statement delivered in connection with or for the execution, effectiveness, genuineness, validity, enforceability, collectability or sufficiency of this Agreement or any Other Document, or of the financial condition of any Credit Party, or be required to make any inquiry concerning either the performance or observance of any of the terms, provisions or conditions of this Agreement, the Note, the Other Documents or the financial condition of any Credit Party, or the existence of any Event of Default or any Default.

 

114 

 

 

Required Lenders may remove Agent on sixty (60) days’ written notice to each of Agent, Lenders and Borrowing Agent and Agent may resign on sixty (60) days’ written notice to each of Lenders and Borrowing Agent, and upon such removal or resignation, the Required Lenders will promptly designate a successor Agent reasonably satisfactory to Borrowing Agent (provided that no such approval by Borrowing Agent shall be required (i) in any case where the successor Agent is one of the Lenders or (ii) after the occurrence and during the continuance of any Event of Default). Any such successor Agent shall succeed to the rights, powers and duties of Agent, and shall in particular succeed to all of Agent’s right, title and interest in and to all of the Liens in the Collateral securing the Obligations created hereunder or any Other Document, and the term “Agent” shall mean such successor agent effective upon its appointment, and the former Agent’s rights, powers and duties as Agent shall be terminated, without any other or further act or deed on the part of such former Agent. However, notwithstanding the foregoing, if at the time of the effectiveness of the new Agent’s appointment, any further actions need to be taken in order to provide for the legally binding and valid transfer of any Liens in the Collateral from former Agent to new Agent and/or for the perfection of any Liens in the Collateral as held by new Agent or it is otherwise not then possible for new Agent to become the holder of a fully valid, enforceable and perfected Lien as to any of the Collateral, former Agent shall continue to hold such Liens solely as agent for perfection of such Liens on Behalf of new Agent until such time as new Agent can obtain a fully valid, enforceable and perfected Lien on all Collateral, provided that Agent shall not be required to or have any liability or responsibility to take any further actions after such date as such agent for perfection to continue the perfection of any such Liens (other than to forego from taking any affirmative action to release any such Liens). After Agent’s resignation as Agent, the provisions of this Article XIV, and any indemnification rights under this Agreement, including without limitation, rights arising under Section 15.5 hereof, shall inure to its benefit as to any actions taken or omitted to be taken by it while it was Agent under this Agreement (and in the event resigning Agent continues to hold any Liens pursuant to the provisions of the immediately preceding sentence, the provisions of this Article XIV and any indemnification rights under this Agreement, including without limitation, rights arising under Section 15.5 hereof, shall inure to its benefit as to any actions taken or omitted to be taken by it in connection with such Liens).

 

14.4            Certain Rights of Agent. If Agent shall request instructions from Lenders with respect to any act or action (including failure to act) in connection with this Agreement or any Other Document, Agent shall be entitled to refrain from such act or taking such action unless and until Agent shall have received instructions from the Required Lenders; and Agent shall not incur liability to any Person by reason of so refraining. Without limiting the foregoing, Lenders shall not have any right of action whatsoever against Agent as a result of its acting or refraining from acting hereunder in accordance with the instructions of the Required Lenders.

 

14.5            Reliance. Agent shall be entitled to rely, and shall be fully protected in relying, upon any note, writing, resolution, notice, statement, certificate, e-mail, telecopier or facsimile message, order or other document or telephone message believed by it to be genuine and correct and to have been signed, sent or made by the proper Person, and, with respect to all legal matters pertaining to this Agreement and the Other Documents and its duties hereunder, upon advice of counsel selected by it. Agent may employ agents and attorneys-in-fact and shall not be liable for the default or misconduct of any such agents or attorneys-in-fact selected by Agent with reasonable care.

 

14.6            Notice of Default. Agent shall not be deemed to have knowledge or notice of the occurrence of any Default or Event of Default hereunder or under the Other Documents, unless Agent has received notice from a Lender or Borrowing Agent referring to this Agreement or the Other Documents, describing such Default or Event of Default and stating that such notice is a “notice of default”. In the event that Agent receives such a notice, Agent shall give notice thereof to Lenders. Agent shall take such action with respect to such Default or Event of Default as shall be reasonably directed by the Required Lenders; provided, that, unless and until Agent shall have received such directions, Agent may (but shall not be obligated to) take such action, or refrain from taking such action, with respect to such Default or Event of Default as it shall deem advisable in the best interests of Lenders.

 

115 

 

 

14.7            Indemnification. To the extent Agent is not reimbursed and indemnified by Borrowers, each Lender will reimburse and indemnify Agent in proportion to its respective portion of the Advances (or, if no Advances are outstanding, according to its applicable Commitment Percentage), from and against any and all liabilities, obligations, losses, damages, penalties, actions, judgments, suits, costs, expenses or disbursements of any kind or nature whatsoever which may be imposed on, incurred by or asserted against Agent in performing its duties hereunder, or in any way relating to or arising out of this Agreement or any Other Document; provided that, Lenders shall not be liable for any portion of such liabilities, obligations, losses, damages, penalties, actions, judgments, suits, costs, expenses or disbursements resulting from Agent’s gross (not mere) negligence or willful misconduct (as determined by a court of competent jurisdiction in a final non-appealable judgment).

 

14.8            Agent in its Individual Capacity. With respect to the obligation of Agent to lend under this Agreement, the Advances made by it shall have the same rights and powers hereunder as any other Lender and as if it were not performing the duties as Agent specified herein; and the term “Lender” or any similar term shall, unless the context clearly otherwise indicates, include Agent in its individual capacity as a Lender. Agent may engage in business with any Credit Party as if it were not performing the duties specified herein, and may accept fees and other consideration from any Credit Party for services in connection with this Agreement or otherwise without having to account for the same to Lenders.

 

14.9            Delivery of Documents. To the extent Agent receives financial statements or notifications required under Sections 9.7, 9.8, 9.9 and 9.12 pursuant to the terms of this Agreement which the applicable Credit Party is not obligated to deliver to each Lender, Agent will promptly furnish such documents and information to Lenders.

 

14.10            Borrowers’ Undertaking to Agent. Without prejudice to its obligations to Lenders under the other provisions of this Agreement, Borrowers hereby undertake with Agent to pay to Agent from time to time on demand all amounts from time to time due and payable by it for the account of Agent or Lenders or any of them pursuant to this Agreement to the extent not already paid. Any payment made pursuant to any such demand shall pro tanto satisfy the relevant Borrower’s obligations to make payments for the account of Lenders or the relevant one or more of them pursuant to this Agreement.

 

14.11            No Reliance on Agent’s Customer Identification Program. Each Lender acknowledges and agrees that neither such Lender, nor any of its Affiliates, participants or assignees, may rely on Agent to carry out such Lender’s, Affiliate’s, participant’s or assignee’s customer identification program, or other obligations required or imposed under or pursuant to the USA PATRIOT Act or the regulations thereunder, including the regulations contained in 31 CFR 103.121 (as hereafter amended, modified, supplemented or replaced, the “CIP Regulations”), or any other Anti-Terrorism Law, including any programs involving any of the following items relating to or in connection with any Credit Party, their Affiliates or agents, this Agreement, the Other Documents or the transactions hereunder or contemplated hereby: (1) any identity verification procedures, (2) any record-keeping, (3) comparisons with government lists, (4) customer notices or (5) other procedures required under the CIP Regulations or such other laws.

 

116 

 

 

14.12            Other Agreements. Each of the Lenders agrees that it shall not, without the prior written consent of Agent, and that it shall, to the extent it is lawfully entitled to do so, upon the request of Agent, set off against the Obligations, any amounts owing by such Lender to any Credit Party or any deposit accounts of any Credit Party now or hereafter maintained with such Lender. Anything in this Agreement to the contrary notwithstanding, each of the Lenders further agrees that it shall not, unless specifically requested to do so by Agent, take any action to protect or enforce its rights arising out of this Agreement or the Other Documents, it being the intent of Lenders that any such action to protect or enforce rights under this Agreement and the Other Documents shall be taken in concert and at the direction or with the consent of Agent or Required Lenders.

 

14.13            Erroneous Payment.

 

(a)            Each Lender hereby agrees that (i) if Agent (x) notifies a Lender or any Person who has received funds on behalf of a Lender (any such Lender or other recipient, a “Payment Recipient”) that Agent has determined in its sole discretion (whether or not after receipt of any notice under immediately succeeding clause (b)) that any funds (as set forth in such notice from Agent) received by such Payment Recipient from Agent or any of its Affiliates were erroneously or mistakenly transmitted to, or otherwise erroneously or mistakenly received by, such Payment Recipient (whether or not known to such Lender or other such Payment Recipient on its behalf) (any such funds, whether transmitted or received as a payment, prepayment or repayment of principal, interest, fees or otherwise, individually and collectively, an “Erroneous Payment”) and (y) demands in writing the return of such Erroneous Payment (or a portion thereof), such Payment Recipient shall promptly, but in no event later than one (1) Business Day thereafter (or such later date as Agent may, in its sole discretion, specify in writing), return to Agent the amount of any such Erroneous Payment (or portion thereof) as to which such a demand was made, in same day funds (in the currency so received), together with interest thereon (except to the extent waived in writing by Agent) in respect of each day from and including the date such Erroneous Payment (or portion thereof) was received by such Lender to the date such amount is repaid to Agent in same day funds at the greater of the overnight bank funding rate and a rate determined by Agent in accordance with banking industry rules on interbank compensation from time to time in effect, and (ii) such Lender shall not assert any right or claim to the Erroneous Payment, and hereby waives any claim, counterclaim, defense or right of set-off or recoupment with respect to any demand, claim or counterclaim by Agent for the return of any Erroneous Payments received, including without limitation waiver of any defense based on “discharge for value” or any similar doctrine. A notice of Agent to any Lender under this subsection (a) shall be conclusive, absent manifest error.

 

117 

 

 

(b)            Without limiting subsection (a) above, each Lender or other Payment Recipient hereby further agrees that if it receives an Erroneous Payment from Agent (or any of its Affiliates) (i) that is in an amount different than (other than a de minimis difference), or on a different date from, that specified in this Agreement or in a notice of payment sent by Agent (or any of its Affiliates) with respect to such Erroneous Payment (an “Erroneous Payment Notice”), or (ii) that was not preceded or accompanied by an Erroneous Payment Notice, it shall be on notice that, in each such case, an error has been made with respect to such Erroneous Payment. Each Lender or other Payment Recipient further agrees that, in each such case, or if it otherwise becomes aware an Erroneous Payment (or portion thereof) may have been sent in error, such Lender or other such Payment Recipient shall promptly notify Agent of such occurrence and, upon demand from Agent, it shall promptly, but in no event later than one (1) Business Day thereafter, return to Agent the amount of any such Erroneous Payment (or portion thereof) that was received by such Lender or other such Payment Recipient to the date such amount is repaid to Agent in same day funds at the greater of the overnight bank funding rate and a rate determined by Agent in accordance with banking industry rules on interbank compensation from time to time in effect.

 

(c)            Each Credit Party hereby agrees that (i) in the event an Erroneous Payment (or portion thereof) is not recovered from any Lender or other such Payment Recipient that has received such Erroneous Payment (or portion thereof) for any reason, Agent shall be subrogated to all the rights of such Lender with respect to such amount and (ii) an Erroneous Payment shall not pay, prepay, repay, discharge or otherwise satisfy any Obligations owed any Credit Party hereunder or under any of the Other Documents.

 

(d)            Each party’s obligations under this Section 14.13 shall survive the resignation or replacement of Agent or any transfer of rights or obligations by, or the replacement of, a Lender, the termination of this Agreement, the termination of the commitments of the Lenders hereunder and the indefeasible payment in full in cash of the Obligations.

 

XV. MISCELLANEOUS.

 

15.1            Governing Law. This Agreement and each Other Document (unless and except to the extent expressly provided otherwise in any such Other Document), and all matters relating hereto or thereto or arising herefrom or therefrom (whether arising under contract law, tort law or otherwise) shall, in accordance with Section 5-1401 of the General Obligations Law of the State of New York, be governed by and construed in accordance with the laws of the State of New York. Any judicial proceeding brought by or against any Credit Party with respect to any of the Obligations, this Agreement, the Other Documents or any related agreement may be brought in any court of competent jurisdiction in the State of New York, United States of America, and, by execution and delivery of this Agreement, each Credit Party accepts for itself and in connection with its properties, generally and unconditionally, the non-exclusive jurisdiction of the aforesaid courts, and irrevocably agrees to be bound by any judgment rendered thereby in connection with this Agreement. Each Credit Party hereby waives personal service of any and all process upon it and consents that all such service of process may be made by registered mail (return receipt requested) directed to such Credit Party at its address set forth in Section 15.6 and service so made shall be deemed completed five (5) days after the same shall have been so deposited in the mails of the United States of America, or, at Agent’s option, by service upon Borrowing Agent which each Borrower irrevocably appoints as such Borrower’s agent for the purposes of accepting service within the State of New York. Nothing herein shall affect the right to serve process in any manner permitted by law or shall limit the right of Agent or any Lender to bring proceedings against any Credit Party in the courts of any other jurisdiction. Each Credit Party waives any objection to jurisdiction and venue of any action instituted hereunder and shall not assert any defense based on lack of jurisdiction or venue or based upon forum non conveniens. Each Credit Party waives the right to remove any judicial proceeding brought against such Credit Party in any state court to any federal court. Any judicial proceeding by any Credit Party against Agent or any Lender involving, directly or indirectly, any matter or claim in any way arising out of, related to or connected with this Agreement or any related agreement, shall be brought only in a federal or state court located in the Borough of Manhattan, County of New York, State of New York.

 

118 

 

 

15.2            Entire Understanding.

 

(a)            This Agreement and the Other Documents contain the entire understanding between the Credit Parties, Agent and each Lender and supersedes all prior agreements and understandings, if any, relating to the subject matter hereof. Any promises, representations, warranties or guarantees not herein contained and hereinafter made shall have no force and effect unless in writing, signed by each Borrower’s, Agent’s and the applicable Lender’s respective officers. Neither this Agreement nor any portion or provisions hereof may be changed, modified, amended, waived, supplemented, discharged, cancelled or terminated orally or by any course of dealing, or in any manner other than by an agreement in writing, signed by the party to be charged. Each Credit Party acknowledges that it has been advised by counsel in connection with the execution of this Agreement and Other Documents and is not relying upon oral representations or statements inconsistent with the terms and provisions of this Agreement.

 

(b)            The Required Lenders, Agent with the consent in writing of the Required Lenders, and the Credit Parties signatory hereto may, subject to the provisions of this Section 15.2(b), from time to time enter into written supplemental agreements to this Agreement or the Other Documents executed by such Credit Parties, for the purpose of adding or deleting any provisions or otherwise changing, varying or waiving in any manner the rights of Lenders, Agent or such Credit Parties thereunder or the conditions, provisions or terms thereof or waiving any Event of Default thereunder, but only to the extent specified in such written agreements; provided, however, that no such supplemental agreement shall without the consent of all Lenders:

 

(i)            increase the Commitment Percentages or the maximum dollar commitment of any Lender or the Delayed Draw Term Loan Amount;

 

(ii)            whether or not any Advances are outstanding, extend the Term or the time for payment of principal or interest of any Advance (excluding the due date of any mandatory prepayment of an Advance), or any fee payable to any Lender, or reduce the principal amount of or the rate of interest borne by any Advances or reduce any fee payable to any Lender, without the consent of each Lender directly affected thereby (except that Required Lenders may elect to waive or rescind any imposition of the Default Rate under Section 3.1 hereof (unless imposed by Agent));

 

(iii)            alter the definition of the term Required Lenders or alter, amend or modify this Section 15.2(b);

 

119 

 

 

(iv)            release any Collateral during any calendar year (other than in accordance with the provisions of this Agreement) having an aggregate value in excess of $1,000,000;

 

(v)            alter, amend or modify the provisions of Section 11.5 hereof;

 

(vi)            change the rights and duties of Agent; or

 

(vii)            release any Guarantor.

 

(c)            Any such supplemental agreement shall apply equally to each Lender and shall be binding upon the Credit Parties, Lenders and Agent and all future holders of the Obligations. In the case of any waiver, the Credit Parties, Agent and Lenders shall be restored to their former positions and rights, and any Event of Default waived shall be deemed to be cured and not continuing, but no waiver of a specific Event of Default shall extend to any subsequent Event of Default (whether or not the subsequent Event of Default is the same as the Event of Default which was waived), or impair any right consequent thereon.

 

(d)            In the event that Agent or Borrowers request the consent of a Lender (other than Lafayette Square or any of its Affiliates) pursuant to this Section 15.2 and such consent is denied, then Agent or Borrowers may, at their respective option and upon five (5) Business Days prior written notice to Agent (if given by Borrowers) and such Lender (a “Non-Consenting Lender”), require such Non-Consenting Lender to assign its interest in the Advances to Lafayette Square, or if Lafayette Square shall decline to purchase such interest, to another Lender or to any other Person eligible to become a Purchasing Lender in accordance with the terms of Section 15.3(c), for a price equal to the then outstanding principal amount thereof plus accrued and unpaid interest and fees due such Non-Consenting Lender, which interest and fees shall be paid when collected from Borrowers. In the event any Non-Consenting Lender is required to assign its interests hereunder, such Non-Consenting Lender will assign its interest, pursuant to a Transfer Supplement, on the date specified in the notice given to such Non-Consenting Lender, which shall be no later than fifteen (15) Business Days after the date of such notice.

 

(e)            Agent is hereby authorized by each Borrower and the Lenders, from time to time in Agent’s sole discretion, (i) after the occurrence and during the continuation of a Default or an Event of Default, or (ii) at any time that any of the other applicable conditions precedent set forth in Section 8.2 hereof have not been satisfied, to make advances to Borrowers on behalf of the Lenders which Agent, in its reasonable business judgment, deems necessary or desirable (x) to preserve or protect the Collateral, or any portion thereof, (y) to enhance the likelihood of, or maximize the amount of, repayment of the Advances and other Obligations, or (z) to pay any other amount chargeable to Borrowers pursuant to the terms of this Agreement.

 

120 

 

 

15.3            Successors and Assigns; Participations; New Lenders.

 

(a)            This Agreement shall be binding upon and inure to the benefit of the Credit Parties signatory hereto, Agent, each Lender, all future holders of the Obligations and their respective successors and permitted assigns, except that no Credit Party may assign or transfer any of its rights or obligations under this Agreement without the prior written consent of Agent and each Lender.

 

(b)            Each Credit Party acknowledges that in the regular course of commercial banking business one or more Lenders may at any time and from time to time sell participating interests in the Advances to other financial institutions (each such transferee or purchaser of a participating interest, a “Participant”). Upon the occurrence and during the continuance of an Event of Default, each Participant may, with the prior consent of Agent, exercise all rights of payment (including rights of set-off) with respect to the portion of such Advances held by it or other Obligations payable hereunder as fully as if such Participant were the direct holder thereof and the Obligations shall be reduced by the amount of any such setoff, provided that Borrowers shall not be required to pay to any Participant more than the amount which it would have been required to pay to Lender which granted an interest in its Advances or other Obligations payable hereunder to such Participant had such Lender retained such interest in the Advances hereunder or other Obligations payable hereunder and in no event shall Borrowers be required to pay any such amount arising from the same circumstances and with respect to the same Advances or other Obligations payable hereunder to both such Lender and such Participant. Each Borrower hereby grants to any Participant a continuing security interest in any deposits, moneys or other property actually or constructively held by such Participant as security for the Participant’s interest in the Advances. Each Lender that sells a participation shall, acting solely for this purpose as an agent of the Borrowers, maintain a register on which it enters the name and address of each Participant and the principal amounts (and stated interest) of each Participant’s interest in the Advances and Obligations (the “Participant Register”); provided that no Lender shall have any obligation to disclose all or any portion of the Participant Register (including the identity of any Participant or any information relating to a Participant’s interest in any commitments, loans, letters of credit or its other obligations under this Agreement or any Other Document) to any Person except to the extent that such disclosure is necessary to establish that such commitment, loan, letter of credit or other obligation is in registered form under Section 5f.103-1(c) of the United States Treasury Regulations. The entries in the Participant Register shall be conclusive absent manifest error, and such Lender shall treat each Person whose name is recorded in the Participant Register as the owner of such participation for all purposes of this Agreement notwithstanding any notice to the contrary. For the avoidance of doubt, Agent (in its capacity as Agent) shall have no responsibility for maintaining a Participant Register.

 

(c)            Any Lender, with the consent of Agent which shall not be unreasonably withheld or delayed, may sell, assign or transfer all or any part of its rights and obligations under or relating to the Term Loans under this Agreement and the Other Documents to one or more Eligible Assignees and one or more Eligible Assignees may commit to make Advances hereunder (each a “Purchasing Lender”), in minimum amounts of not less than $1,000,000 in the case of any transfer to any Purchasing Lender which is not a Lender or an Affiliate of Lender prior to such transfer, pursuant to a Transfer Supplement, executed by a Purchasing Lender, the transferor Lender, and Agent and delivered to Agent for recording. Upon such execution, delivery, acceptance and recording, from and after the transfer effective date determined pursuant to such Transfer Supplement, (i) Purchasing Lender thereunder shall be a party hereto and, to the extent provided in such Transfer Supplement, have the rights and obligations of a Lender thereunder with the Commitment Percentages as set forth therein, and (ii) the transferor Lender thereunder shall, to the extent provided in such Transfer Supplement, be released from its obligations under this Agreement, the Transfer Supplement creating a novation for that purpose. Such Transfer Supplement shall be deemed to amend this Agreement to the extent, and only to the extent, necessary to reflect the addition of such Purchasing Lender and the resulting adjustment of the Commitment Percentages arising from the purchase by such Purchasing Lender of all or a portion of the rights and obligations of such transferor Lender under this Agreement and the Other Documents. Each Borrower hereby consents to the addition of such Purchasing Lender and the resulting adjustment of the Commitment Percentages arising from the purchase by such Purchasing Lender of all or a portion of the rights and obligations of such transferor Lender under this Agreement and the Other Documents. Borrowers shall execute and deliver such further documents and do such further acts and things in order to effectuate the foregoing. Notwithstanding the foregoing or anything to the contrary set forth herein, no assignment or transfer shall be made to a Defaulting Lender unless an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing.

 

121 

 

 

 

(d)            Any Lender, with the consent of Agent which shall not be unreasonably withheld or delayed, may directly or indirectly sell, assign or transfer all or any portion of its rights and obligations under or relating to the Term Loans under this Agreement and the Other Documents to an entity, whether a corporation, partnership, trust, limited liability company or other entity that (i) is engaged in making, purchasing, holding or otherwise investing in bank loans and similar extensions of credit in the ordinary course of its business and (ii) is administered, serviced or managed by the assigning Lender or an Affiliate of such Lender (a “Purchasing CLO” and together with each Participant and Purchasing Lender, each a “Transferee” and collectively the “Transferees”), pursuant to a Transfer Supplement modified as appropriate to reflect the interest being assigned (“Modified Transfer Supplement”), executed by any intermediate purchaser, the Purchasing CLO, the transferor Lender, and Agent as appropriate and delivered to Agent for recording. Upon such execution and delivery, from and after the transfer effective date determined pursuant to such Modified Transfer Supplement, (i) Purchasing CLO thereunder shall be a party hereto and, to the extent provided in such Modified Transfer Supplement, have the rights and obligations of a Lender thereunder and (ii) the transferor Lender thereunder shall, to the extent provided in such Modified Transfer Supplement, be released from its obligations under this Agreement, the Modified Transfer Supplement creating a novation for that purpose. Such Modified Transfer Supplement shall be deemed to amend this Agreement to the extent, and only to the extent, necessary to reflect the addition of such Purchasing CLO. Each Borrower hereby consents to the addition of such Purchasing CLO. Borrowers shall execute and deliver such further documents and do such further acts and things in order to effectuate the foregoing. Notwithstanding the foregoing or anything to the contrary set forth herein, no assignment or transfer shall be made to a Defaulting Lender unless an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing.

 

(e)            Each Borrower hereby acknowledges and makes the Obligations registered Obligations for United States withholding tax purposes. Agent shall maintain at its address a copy of each Transfer Supplement and Modified Transfer Supplement delivered to it and a register (the “Register”) for the recordation of the names and addresses of each Lender and the outstanding principal, accrued and unpaid interest and other fees due hereunder and Agent shall record the assignment of the Advances in the Register. Any assignment of the Advances, whether or not evidenced by a note, shall be effective as to Borrowers only upon appropriate entries with respect thereto being made in the Register. The entries in the Register shall be prima facie evidence, in the absence of manifest error, and Borrowers, Agent and Lenders may treat each Person whose name is recorded in the Register as the owner of the Advances recorded therein for the purposes of this Agreement notwithstanding notice to the contrary. The Lenders, by their acceptance of this Agreement or any Transfer Supplement, agree to be bound by the provisions of this paragraph and to indemnify and hold harmless Agent against any loss or liability arising from the assignment by a holder of the Advances in violation of this subsection (e). The Register shall be available for inspection by Borrowers or any Lender at any reasonable time and from time to time upon reasonable prior notice. Agent shall receive a fee in the amount of $3,500 payable by the applicable Purchasing Lender and/or Purchasing CLO upon the effective date of each transfer or assignment (other than to an intermediate purchaser) to such Purchasing Lender and/or Purchasing CLO.

 

122 

 

 

(f)            Each Credit Party authorizes each Lender to disclose to any Transferee and any prospective Transferee any and all financial information in such Lender’s possession concerning any Credit Party which has been delivered to such Lender by or on behalf of any Credit Party pursuant to this Agreement or in connection with such Lender’s credit evaluation of any Credit Party.

 

(g)            Any Lender may at any time pledge or assign a security interest in all or any portion of its rights under this Agreement to secure obligations of such Lender, including any pledge or assignment to secure obligations to a Federal Reserve Bank; provided that no such pledge or assignment shall release such Lender from any of its obligations hereunder or substitute any such pledgee or assignee for such Lender as a party hereto.

 

15.4            Application of Payments. Agent shall have the continuing and exclusive right, in its Permitted Discretion, to apply or reverse and re-apply any payment and any and all proceeds of Collateral to any portion of the Obligations. To the extent that any Credit Party makes a payment or Agent or any Lender receives any payment or proceeds of the Collateral for any Credit Party’s benefit, which are subsequently invalidated, declared to be fraudulent or preferential, set aside or required to be repaid to a trustee, debtor in possession, receiver, custodian or any other party under any bankruptcy law, common law or equitable cause, then, to such extent, the Obligations or part thereof intended to be satisfied shall be revived and continue as if such payment or proceeds had not been received by Agent or such Lender.

 

123 

 

 

15.5            Indemnity. Each Credit Party shall defend, protect, indemnify, pay and save harmless Agent, each Lender and each of their respective officers, directors, Affiliates, attorneys, employees and agents (each an “Indemnified Party”) for and from and against any and all claims, demands, liabilities, obligations, losses, damages, penalties, fines, actions, judgments, suits, costs, charges, expenses and disbursements of any kind or nature whatsoever (including reasonable fees and disbursements of counsel (including allocated costs of internal counsel)) (collectively, “Claims”) which may be imposed on, incurred by, or asserted against any Indemnified Party arising out of or in any way relating to or as a consequence, direct or indirect, of: (a) this Agreement, the Other Documents, the Advances and other Obligations, the Eligible Impact Services, and/or the transactions contemplated hereby including the Closing Date Transactions, (b) any action or failure to act or action taken only after delay or the satisfaction of any conditions by any Indemnified Party in connection with and/or relating to the negotiation, execution, delivery or administration of the Agreement and the Other Documents, the credit facilities established hereunder and thereunder and/or the transactions contemplated hereby including the Closing Date Transactions, (c) any Credit Party’s failure to observe, perform or discharge any of its covenants, obligations, agreements or duties under or breach of any of the representations or warranties made in this Agreement and the Other Documents, (d) the enforcement of any of the rights and remedies of Agent or any Lender under the Agreement and the Other Documents, (e) any threatened or actual imposition of fines or penalties, or disgorgement of benefits, for violation of any Anti-Terrorism Law by any Credit Party, any Affiliate or Subsidiary of any of the Credit Parties, and (f) any claim, litigation, proceeding or investigation instituted or conducted by any Governmental Body or instrumentality, any Borrower, any Affiliate or Subsidiary of any Borrowers, or any Guarantor, or any other Person with respect to any aspect of, or any transaction contemplated by, or referred to in, or any matter related to, this Agreement or the Other Documents, whether or not Agent or any Lender is a party thereto. Without limiting the generality of any of the foregoing, each Credit Party shall defend, protect, indemnify, pay and save harmless each Indemnified Party from any Claims which may be imposed on, incurred by, or asserted against any Indemnified Party under any Environmental Laws with respect to or in connection with any Real Property owned or leased by any Credit Party, any Environmental Liability, the presence of any Hazardous Materials affecting any Real Property owned or leased by any Credit Party (whether or not the same originates or emerges from such Real Property or any contiguous real estate), including any Claims consisting of or relating to the imposition or assertion of any Lien on any Real Property owned or leased by any Credit Party under any Environmental Laws and any loss of value of such Real Property as a result of the foregoing except to the extent such loss, liability, damage and expense is attributable to any Hazardous Materials Activity resulting from actions on the part of Agent or any Lender. The Credit Parties’ obligations under this Section 15.5 shall arise upon the discovery of the presence of any Hazardous Materials at any Real Property owned or leased by any Credit Party, whether or not any federal, state, or local environmental agency has taken or threatened any action in connection with the presence of any Hazardous Materials, in each such case except to the extent that any of the foregoing arises out of the gross negligence or willful misconduct of the Indemnified Party (as determined by a court of competent jurisdiction in a final and non-appealable judgment). Without limiting the generality of the foregoing, this indemnity shall extend to any liabilities, obligations, losses, damages, penalties, actions, judgments, suits, costs, expenses and disbursements of any kind or nature whatsoever (including fees and disbursements of counsel) asserted against or incurred by any of the Indemnified Parties by any Person under any Environmental Laws or similar laws by reason of any Credit Party’s or any other Person’s failure to comply with laws applicable to solid or hazardous waste materials, including Hazardous Materials. This Section 15.5 shall not apply with respect to Taxes other than Taxes that represent losses, claims, damages, etc. arising from any non-Tax claim.

 

15.6            Notice. Any notice or request hereunder may be given to any Credit Party or to Agent or any Lender at their respective addresses set forth below or at such other address as may hereafter be specified in a notice designated as a notice of change of address under this Section. Any notice, request, demand, direction or other communication (for purposes of this Section 15.6 only, a “Notice”) to be given to or made upon any party hereto under any provision of this Agreement shall be given or made by telephone or in writing (which includes by means of electronic transmission (i.e., e-mail) or facsimile transmission or by setting forth such Notice on a website (an “Internet Posting”) if Notice of such Internet Posting (including the information necessary to access such site) has previously been delivered to the applicable parties hereto by another means set forth in this Section 15.6) in accordance with this Section 15.6. Any such Notice must be delivered to the applicable parties hereto at the addresses and numbers set forth under their respective names on Section 15.6 hereof or in accordance with any subsequent unrevoked Notice from any such party that is given in accordance with this Section 15.6. Any Notice shall be effective:

 

(a)            In the case of hand-delivery, when delivered;

 

124 

 

 

(b)            If given by mail, five days after such Notice is deposited with the United States Postal Service, with first-class postage prepaid, return receipt requested;

 

(c)            In the case of a telephonic Notice, when a party is contacted by telephone, if delivery of such telephonic Notice is confirmed no later than the next Business Day by hand delivery, a facsimile or electronic transmission, an Internet Posting or an overnight courier delivery of a confirmatory Notice (received at or before noon on such next Business Day);

 

(d)            In the case of a facsimile transmission, when sent to the applicable party’s facsimile machine’s telephone number, if the party sending such Notice receives confirmation of the delivery thereof from its own facsimile machine;

 

(e)            In the case of electronic transmission, when actually received;

 

(f)            In the case of an Internet Posting, upon delivery of a Notice of such posting (including the information necessary to access such site) by another means set forth in this Section 15.6; and

 

(g)            If given by any other means (including by overnight courier), when actually received.

 

Any Lender giving a Notice to any Credit Party shall concurrently send a copy thereof to Agent, and Agent shall promptly notify the other Lenders of its receipt of such Notice.

 

(A)            If to Agent at:

 

Lafayette Square Loan Servicing, LLC
PO Box 25250 

PMB 13941 

Miami, Florida 33102-5250 

  Attention: Susan Golden
  Email: legal@lafayettesquare.com;

lsloanops@lafayettesquare.com

 

with a copy to (which shall not constitute notice) to:

 

Blank Rome LLP
One Logan Square
Philadelphia, Pennsylvania 19103

  Attention: Shlomo B. Troodler, Esq.
  Telephone: (215) 569-5338
  Facsimile: (215) 832-5338
  E-mail: troodler@blankrome.com

 

125 

 

 

(B)            If to a Lender other than Agent, as specified on the signature pages hereof;

 

(C)            If to any Credit Party:

 

Direct Digital Holdings, LLC 

1233 West Loop South, Suite 1170 

Huston, TX 77042 

Attention: Mark Walker 

E-mail: mwalker@directdigitalholdings.com

 

with a copy (which shall not constitute notice) to:

 

McGuireWoods LLP
2000 McKinney Avenue
Suite 1400
Dallas, TX 75201 

Attention: Phyllis Y. Young 

Telephone: (214) 932-6420 

E-mail: pyoung@mcguirewoods.com

 

15.7            Survival. The obligations of the Credit Parties under Sections 3.7, 3.9, 3.10, 4.19(e), 15.5 and 15.9 and the obligations of Lenders under Section 14.7, shall survive termination of this Agreement and the Other Documents and payment in full of the Obligations.

 

15.8            Severability. If any part of this Agreement is contrary to, prohibited by, or deemed invalid under Applicable Laws, such provision shall be inapplicable and deemed omitted to the extent so contrary, prohibited or invalid, but the remainder hereof shall not be invalidated thereby and shall be given effect so far as possible.

 

15.9            Expenses. The Credit Parties shall pay all reasonable costs and expenses including reasonable attorneys’ fees (including the allocated costs of in house counsel) and disbursements incurred by Agent on its Behalf or on Behalf of Lenders: (a) in all efforts made to enforce payment of any Obligation or effect collection of any Collateral, (b) in connection with the entering into, preparation, negotiation, execution, delivery, modification, amendment, administration (including costs and expense with respect to electronic distribution services for distribution of documents and information to the Lenders) and enforcement of this Agreement, the Other Documents or any consents or waivers hereunder or thereunder and all related agreements, documents and instruments (whether or not the transactions contemplated hereby or thereby shall be consummated), (c) in instituting, maintaining, preserving, enforcing and foreclosing on Agent’s security interest in or Lien on any of the Collateral, or maintaining, preserving or enforcing any of Agent’s or any Lender’s rights hereunder, under the Other Documents and under all related agreements, documents and instruments, whether through judicial proceedings or otherwise, (d) in defending or prosecuting any actions or proceedings arising out of or relating to Agent’s or any Lender’s transactions with the Credit Parties or Seller or (e) in connection with any advice given to Agent or any Lender with respect to its rights and obligations under this Agreement, the Other Documents and all related agreements, documents and instruments; provided, however, notwithstanding the foregoing, the Borrowers shall not be required to reimburse the costs of (x) more than one (1) field examinations in any consecutive period of 365 days unless an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing and (y) more than one (1) appraisal of machinery and equipment and of Inventory in any consecutive period of 365 days unless an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing.

 

126 

 

 

15.10            Injunctive Relief. Each Credit Party recognizes that, in the event such Credit Party fails to perform, observe or discharge any of its obligations or liabilities under this Agreement, or threatens to fail to perform, observe or discharge such obligations or liabilities, any remedy at law may prove to be inadequate relief to Lenders; therefore, Agent, if Agent so requests, shall be entitled to temporary and permanent injunctive relief in any such case without the necessity of proving that actual damages are not an adequate remedy.

 

15.11            Damages. Neither Agent nor any Lender, nor any agent or attorney for any of them, shall be liable to any Credit Party (or any Affiliate of any such Person) for indirect, punitive, exemplary or consequential damages arising from any breach of contract, tort or other wrong relating to the establishment, administration or collection of the Obligations or as a result of any transaction contemplated under this Agreement or any Other Document.

 

15.12            Captions. The captions at various places in this Agreement are intended for convenience only and do not constitute and shall not be interpreted as part of this Agreement.

 

15.13            Counterparts, etc. This Agreement may be executed in any number of and by different parties hereto on separate counterparts, all of which, when so executed, shall be deemed an original, but all such counterparts shall constitute one and the same agreement. Any signature delivered by a party by facsimile or other similar method of electronic transmission (including email transmission of a PDF image) shall be deemed to be an original signature hereto.

 

15.14            Construction. The parties acknowledge that each party and its counsel have reviewed this Agreement and that the normal rule of construction to the effect that any ambiguities are to be resolved against the drafting party shall not be employed in the interpretation of this Agreement or any amendments, schedules or exhibits thereto.

 

127 

 

 

15.15            Confidentiality; Sharing Information. Agent, each Lender and each Transferee shall hold all non-public information obtained by Agent, such Lender or such Transferee (and designated as non-public information by Borrower in writing) pursuant to the requirements of this Agreement in accordance with Agent’s, such Lender’s and such Transferee’s customary procedures for handling confidential information of this nature; provided, however, Agent, each Lender and each Transferee may disclose such confidential information (a)(i) to its examiners, Affiliates, outside auditors, counsel and other professional advisors, (ii) to Agent, any Lender or to any prospective Transferees, (iii) to any investor or prospective investor in Agent, any Lender, or any of their respective affiliates, in each case, subject to a non disclosure agreement containing provisions substantially the same as those of this Section 15.15 and among other things, standstill provision preventing transactions in the Credit Parties’ stock and in compliance with applicable Federal and state securities laws, (b) as required by any Governmental Body or representative thereof or pursuant to legal process or in public filings to the extent customary, (c) subject to an agreement (i) in connection with the exercise of any secured creditor remedy under this Agreement or under any of the Other Documents, and (ii) subject to a non disclosure agreement containing provisions substantially the same as those of this Section 15.15 and in compliance with applicable Federal and state securities laws, in connection with a bona fide initial public offering of Equity Interests of Agent, any Lender or any Transferee, to the extent disclosure is required or advisable (in the determination of Agent, such Lender or such Transferee, as applicable, and their respective counsel) under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended; provided, further, that (I) unless specifically prohibited by Applicable Law, Agent, each Lender and each Transferee shall use its reasonable best efforts prior to disclosure thereof, to notify Borrowing Agent of the applicable request for disclosure of such non-public information (A) by a Governmental Body or representative thereof (other than any such request in connection with an examination of the financial condition of a Lender or a Transferee by such Governmental Body) or (B) pursuant to legal process; provided, that notwithstanding anything to the contrary above in this sub-clause (I), the foregoing notice obligation shall not apply with respect to disclosures of non-public information that are requested or required pursuant to routine regulatory examinations or inquiries that do not reference any Credit Party, this Agreement or any Other Document, to which Agent, Lender or a Transferee is subject in the ordinary course of business, and (II) in no event shall Agent, any Lender or any Transferee be obligated to return any materials furnished by any Credit Party other than those documents and instruments in possession of Agent or any Lender in order to perfect its Lien on the Collateral once the Obligations have been paid in full (other than Inchoate Obligations) and the termination of all obligations of Agent and the Lenders to make any Advances hereunder.   Each Credit Party acknowledges that from time to time financial advisory, investment banking and other services may be offered or provided to such Credit Party or one or more of its Affiliates (in connection with this Agreement or otherwise) by any Lender or by one or more Subsidiaries or Affiliates of such Lender and each Credit Party hereby authorizes each Lender to share any information delivered to such Lender by any Credit Party and/or their respective Subsidiaries pursuant to this Agreement or any Other Document, or in connection with the decision of such Lender to enter into this Agreement, to any such Subsidiary or Affiliate of such Lender, it being understood that any such Subsidiary or Affiliate of any Lender receiving such information shall be bound by the provisions of this Section 15.15 as if it were a Lender hereunder.  Such authorization shall survive the repayment of the other Obligations and the termination of this Agreement.

 

AGENT AND EACH LENDER ACKNOWLEDGE THAT INFORMATION received from any Credit Party relating to such Credit Party or any Subsidiary or their businesses or the Collateral FURNISHED TO SUCH PERSON PURSUANT TO THIS AGREEMENT MAY INCLUDE INFORMATION IDENTIFIED BY THE CREDIT PARTIES AS MATERIAL NON-PUBLIC INFORMATION CONCERNING SUCH CREDIT PARTY, ITS SUBSIDIARIES AND ITS OTHER AFFILIATES AND THEIR RESPECTIVE SECURITIES, AND CONFIRMS THAT IT HAS DEVELOPED COMPLIANCE PROCEDURES REGARDING THE USE OF SUCH MATERIAL NON-PUBLIC INFORMATION AND THAT IT WILL HANDLE SUCH MATERIAL NON-PUBLIC INFORMATION IN ACCORDANCE WITH THOSE PROCEDURES AND APPLICABLE LAW, INCLUDING FEDERAL AND STATE SECURITIES LAWS.

 

128 

 

 

ALL INFORMATION, INCLUDING REQUESTS FOR WAIVERS AND AMENDMENTS, FURNISHED BY ANY CREDIT PARTY OR THE AGENT PURSUANT TO, OR IN THE COURSE OF ADMINISTERING, THIS AGREEMENT WILL BE SYNDICATE-LEVEL INFORMATION, WHICH MAY CONTAIN INFORMATION IDENTIFIED BY THE CREDIT PARTIES AS MATERIAL NON-PUBLIC INFORMATION CONCERNING THE CREDIT PARTIES, THEIR SUBSIDIARIES AND THEIR OTHER AFFILIATES AND THEIR RESPECTIVE SECURITIES. ACCORDINGLY, EACH OF AGENT AND EACH LENDER REPRESENTS TO THE CREDIT PARTIES THAT SUCH PERSON HAS IDENTIFIED A CREDIT CONTACT (WHICH SUCH PERSON MAY CHANGE FROM TIME TO TIME UPON NOTICE FROM SUCH PERSON TO THE CREDIT PARTIES) WHO MAY RECEIVE INFORMATION THAT MAY CONTAIN SUCH MATERIAL NON-PUBLIC INFORMATION AND SHARE SUCH INFORMATION IN ACCORDANCE WITH ITS COMPLIANCE PROCEDURES AND APPLICABLE LAW, INCLUDING FEDERAL AND STATE SECURITIES LAWS.

  

15.16            PUBLICITY. EACH CREDIT PARTY AND EACH LENDER HEREBY AUTHORIZES AGENT, AT ITS OWN EXPENSE, AND WITH THE PRIOR WRITTEN CONSENT OF DDH (SUCH CONSENT NOT TO BE UNREASONABLY WITHHELD), TO MAKE APPROPRIATE ANNOUNCEMENTS OF THE FINANCIAL ARRANGEMENT ENTERED INTO AMONG THE CREDIT PARTIES, AGENT AND LENDERS and related services, and hereby grants permission for agent to use the logo of any Credit Party and lender, INCLUDING in marketing materials and other ANNOUNCEMENTS WHICH ARE COMMONLY KNOWN AS TOMBSTONES, IN SUCH PUBLICATIONS, media, or forum AND TO SUCH SELECTED PARTIES AS AGENT SHALL IN ITS SOLE AND ABSOLUTE DISCRETION DEEM APPROPRIATE; provided, that no announcements pursuant to this section 15.16 shall be made prior to the consummation of a qualified Ipo or while any Credit Party is contemplating a qualified IPO and all such announcements pursuant to this section 15.16 shall be in conformance with applicable FEDERAL AND STATE securities laws.

 

15.17            Certifications From Banks and Participants; USA PATRIOT Act.

 

(a)            Each Lender or assignee or participant of a Lender that is not incorporated under the Applicable Laws of the United States of America or a state thereof (and is not excepted from the certification requirement contained in Section 313 of the USA PATRIOT Act and the applicable regulations because it is both (i) an affiliate of a depository institution or foreign bank that maintains a physical presence in the United States or foreign country, and (ii) subject to supervision by a banking authority regulating such affiliated depository institution or foreign bank) shall deliver to Agent the certification, or, if applicable, recertification, certifying that such Lender is not a “shell” and certifying to other matters as required by Section 313 of the USA PATRIOT Act and the applicable regulations: (1) within 10 days after the Closing Date, and (2) as such other times as are required under the USA PATRIOT Act.

 

(b)            The USA PATRIOT Act requires all financial institutions to obtain, verify and record certain information that identifies individuals or business entities which open an “account” with such financial institution. Consequently, any Lender may from time to time request, and each Credit Party shall provide to such Lender, such Credit Party’s name, address, tax identification number and/or such other identifying information as shall be necessary for such Lender to comply with the USA PATRIOT Act and any other Anti-Terrorism Law.

 

129 

 

 

15.18            Borrowing Agency Provisions.

 

(a)            Each Borrower hereby irrevocably designates Borrowing Agent to be its attorney and agent and in such capacity to borrow, sign and endorse notes, and execute and deliver all instruments, documents, writings and further assurances now or hereafter required hereunder, on Behalf of such Borrower, and hereby authorizes Agent to pay over or credit all loan proceeds hereunder in accordance with the request of Borrowing Agent.

 

(b)            The handling of this credit facility as a co-borrowing facility with a borrowing agent in the manner set forth in this Agreement is solely as an accommodation to Borrowers and at their request. Neither Agent nor any Lender shall incur liability to any Borrower as a result thereof. To induce Agent and Lenders to do so and in consideration thereof, each Borrower hereby indemnifies Agent and each Lender and holds Agent and each Lender harmless from and against any and all liabilities, expenses, losses, damages and claims of damage or injury asserted against Agent or any Lender by any Borrower arising from or incurred by reason of the handling of the financing arrangements of Borrowers as provided herein, reliance by Agent or any Lender on any request or instruction from Borrowing Agent or any other action taken by Agent or any Lender with respect to this Section 15.18 except due to willful misconduct or gross (not mere) negligence by the indemnified party (as determined by a court of competent jurisdiction in a final and non-appealable judgment).

 

(c)            All Obligations shall be joint and several, and each Borrower shall make payment upon the maturity of the Obligations by acceleration or otherwise, and such obligation and liability on the part of each Borrower shall in no way be affected by any extensions, renewals and forbearance granted to Agent or any Lender to any Borrower, failure of Agent or any Lender to give Borrowing Agent or any Borrower notice of borrowing or any other notice, any failure of Agent or any Lender to pursue or preserve its rights against any Borrower, the release by Agent or any Lender of any Collateral now or thereafter acquired from any Borrower, and such agreement by each Borrower to pay upon any notice issued pursuant thereto is unconditional and unaffected by prior recourse by Agent or any Lender to the other Borrowers or any Collateral for any Borrower’s Obligations or the lack thereof. Each Borrower waives all suretyship defenses.

 

XVI. Guaranty and Suretyship Agreement.

 

16.1            Guaranty and Suretyship Agreement. Each Guarantor hereby guarantees, and becomes surety for the prompt payment and performance when due (whether at stated maturity, by required prepayment, declaration, demand, by acceleration or otherwise) of all of the Obligations owing by the Credit Parties to Agent and Lenders (the “Guaranteed Obligations”). The obligations and liabilities of the Guarantors under this Article XVI are joint and several, and each Guarantor hereby acknowledges and accepts such joint and several liability and further acknowledges and agrees that the joint and several liabilities of Guarantors under the provisions of this Article XVI shall be primary and direct liabilities and not secondary liabilities.

 

130 

 

 

16.2            Guaranty of Payment and Not Merely Collection. The provisions of this Article XVI constitute a guaranty of payment and not of collection and neither Agent nor any Lender shall be required, as a condition of any Guarantor’s liability hereunder, to make any demand upon or to pursue any of their rights against any Credit Parties and/or any of the Collateral, or to pursue any rights which may be available to Agent and Lenders with respect to any other person who may be liable for the payment of the Guaranteed Obligations and/or any other collateral or security available to Agent and Lenders therefor.

 

16.3            Guarantor and Suretyship Waivers.

 

(a)            The provisions of this Article XVI constitute an absolute, unconditional, irrevocable and continuing guaranty and will remain in full force and effect until all of the Guaranteed Obligations have been paid in full. The provisions of this Article XVI will remain in full force and effect even if there are no Guaranteed Obligations outstanding at a particular time or from time to time. The provisions of this Article XVI will not be affected (i) by any surrender, exchange, acceptance, compromise or release by Agent and Lenders of any other party, or any other guaranty or any Collateral or other collateral or security held by it for any of the Guaranteed Obligations, (ii) by any failure of Agent and Lenders to take any steps to perfect or maintain their Liens or security interest in or to preserve their rights in or to any Collateral or any other security or other collateral for the Guaranteed Obligations or any guaranty, or (iii) by any irregularity, unenforceability or invalidity of the Guaranteed Obligations or any part thereof or any security therefor or other guaranty thereof, and the provisions of this Article XVI will not be affected by any other facts, events, occurrences or circumstances (except payment in full of the Guaranteed Obligations) that might otherwise give rise to any “guarantor” or “suretyship” defenses to which any Guarantor might otherwise be entitled, all of which such “guarantor” or “suretyship” defenses are hereby waived by each Guarantor. The obligations of each Guarantor hereunder shall not be affected, modified or impaired by any counterclaim, set-off, deduction or defense of any kind, including any such counterclaim, set-off, deduction or defense based upon any claim such Guarantor may have against any Borrower, Agent or any Lender, or based upon any claim any Borrower or any other guarantor or surety may have against Agent and Lenders, except payment in full of the Guaranteed Obligations.

 

(b)            Notice of acceptance of the agreement to guaranty provided for under the provisions of this Article XVI, notice of extensions of credit to Borrowers from time to time, notice of default, diligence, presentment, notice of dishonor, protest, demand for payment, and any defense based upon Agent’s or any Lender’s failure to comply with the notice requirements of §§ 9-611, 9-612 and 9-613 of the Uniform Commercial Code are hereby waived to the fullest extent permitted by law. Each Guarantor hereby waives all defenses based on suretyship or impairment of collateral to the fullest extent permitted by law.

 

131 

 

 

(c)            Agent may at any time and from time to time, in accordance with the terms of this Agreement, without impairing or releasing, discharging or modifying any Guarantor’s liabilities hereunder and (for purposes of this Article XVI only) without notice to or the consent of any Guarantor: (i) change the manner, place, time or terms of payment or performance of or interest rates or other fees on, or other terms relating to (including the maturity thereof), any of the Guaranteed Obligations; (ii) renew, extend, substitute, modify, amend or alter or refinance, or grant consents or waivers relating to any of the terms and provisions of this Agreement or any of the Other Documents or of the Guaranteed Obligations, or of any other guaranties, or any security for the Obligations or guaranties, (iii) increase (without limit of any kind) or decrease the Guaranteed Obligations (including all loans and extensions of credit thereunder) or modify the terms on which loans and extensions of credit may be made to Borrower (including without limitation by making available to Borrowers under this Agreement and/or any Other Document and as part of the Guaranteed Obligations any new loans, advances or other extensions of credit of any kind, including any such new loans, advances or extension of credit of a new or different type or nature as compared to the loans, advances and extensions of credit available to Borrowers under this Agreement as of the date hereof); (iv) apply any and all payments by whomever paid or however realized including any proceeds of the Collateral or any other collateral or security, to any Guaranteed Obligations in such order, manner and amount as Agent may determine in its sole discretion, but in accordance with the terms of this Agreement; (v) settle, compromise or deal with any other Person, including any Borrower or any other guarantor, with respect to the Guaranteed Obligations in such manner as Agent deems appropriate in its sole discretion; (vi) substitute, exchange, subordinate, sell, compromise or release any security or guaranty for the Guaranteed Obligations; or (vii) take such actions and exercise such remedies hereunder as provided herein.

  

16.4            Repayments or Recovery from Agent or Lenders. If any demand or claim is made at any time upon Agent or any Lender for the repayment or recovery of any amount received by it in payment or on account of the Guaranteed Obligations (including any such demand or claim made in respect of or arising out of any laws relating to fraudulent transfers, fraudulent conveyances or preferences) and if Agent or any Lender repays all or any part of such amount by reason of any judgment, decree or order of any court or administrative body in respect of such demand or claim, or by reason of any settlement or compromise of any such demand or claim, the joint and several liability of Guarantors with respect to such portion of the Guaranteed Obligations previously satisfied by the payment of the amount so repaid or recovered shall be reinstated and revived and Guarantors will be and remain jointly and severally liable hereunder for the amount so repaid or recovered to the same extent as if such amount had never been received originally by Agent and/or such Lender, as the case may be. The provisions of this Section 16.4 shall survive any release and/or termination of this Agreement (and/or of any Guarantor’s liability under this Article XVI) and will be and remain effective notwithstanding any contrary action which may have been taken by Guarantor in reliance upon such payment, and any such contrary action so taken will be without prejudice to Agent’s or any Lender’s rights hereunder and any such release and/or termination will be deemed to have been conditioned upon such payment having become final and irrevocable.

 

16.5            Enforceability of Obligations. No modification, limitation or discharge of the Guaranteed Obligations arising out of or by virtue of any bankruptcy, reorganization or similar proceeding for relief of debtors under federal or state law with respect to any Borrower or any other guarantor or surety for the Guaranteed Obligations (each, an “Other Obligor”) will affect, modify, limit or discharge, other than any Other Obligor, any Guarantors’ liability in any manner whatsoever and the provisions of this Article XVI will remain and continue in full force and effect and will be enforceable against each Guarantor to the same extent and with the same force and effect as if any such proceeding had not been instituted.

 

132 

 

 

16.6            Guaranty Payable upon Event of Default; Remedies.

 

(a)            Upon the occurrence of any Event of Default under this Agreement, (i) all Guaranteed Obligations may, at the option of Agent, and without demand, notice or legal process of any kind, be declared, and immediately shall become, due and payable, (ii) Agent in its discretion may exercise with respect to any Collateral of any Guarantor or any other collateral or security for the Guaranteed Obligations any one or more of the rights and remedies provided a secured party under the Uniform Commercial Code or any other applicable law or at equity (all of which such rights and remedies are hereby deemed incorporated herein and confirmed and ratified by Guarantors as if expressly set forth and granted and agreed to by Guarantors herein); and/or (iii) Agent in its discretion may exercise from time to time any other rights and remedies available to it or any other Lender at law, in equity or otherwise, provided, however, that upon the occurrence of an Event of Default described in Section 10.7 or Section 10.8 hereof, all of the Guaranteed Obligations shall immediately and automatically become due and payable, without notice of any kind.

 

(b)            The Guarantors jointly and severally agree that, as between the Guarantors and the Agent and Lenders, the obligations of the Credit Parties under this Agreement and the Other Documents may be declared to be forthwith due and payable as provided in Section 11.1 (and shall be deemed to have become automatically due and payable in the circumstances provided in Section 11.1) for purposes of this Article XVI (specifically including Section 16.1 hereof), notwithstanding any stay, injunction or other prohibition preventing such declaration (or such obligations from becoming automatically due and payable) as against the Credit Parties and that, in the event of such declaration (or such obligations being deemed to have become automatically due and payable), such obligations (whether or not due and payable by the Credit Parties) shall forthwith become due and payable by the Guarantors for purposes of this Article XVI (specifically including Section 16.1 hereof).

 

16.7            Waiver of Subrogation. Until the Guaranteed Obligations are paid in full, each Guarantor waives in favor of Agent and Lenders any and all rights which such Guarantor may have to (a) assert any claim against any Borrower or any other Guarantor based on subrogation, restitution, reimbursement or contribution rights with respect to payments made under the provisions of this Article XVI, and (b) any realization on any property of any Borrower or any other Guarantor, including participation in any marshalling of any Borrower’s or any other Guarantor’s assets.

 

16.8            Continuing Guaranty and Suretyship Agreement. The provisions of this Article XVI shall constitute a continuing guaranty and suretyship obligation of each Guarantor with respect to all Guaranteed Obligations from time to time outstanding, arising or incurred, and shall continue in effect, and Agent and Lenders may continue to act in reliance hereon, until all of the Guaranteed Obligations have been paid in full, and until such time, no Guarantor shall have any right to terminate or revoke the provisions of this Article XVI nor any of the guarantee and surety agreements and other covenants and undertakings provided for herein.

 

133 

 

 

16.9            General Limitation on Guarantee Obligations. If, in the course of any legal action or proceeding under any applicable law, including any insolvency, bankruptcy, receivership, liquidation, reorganization or other similar proceeding under the laws of any jurisdiction with respect to any Guarantor(s), the obligations of any Guarantor under the provisions of this Article XVI would otherwise be held or determined to be void, voidable, invalid or unenforceable, or subordinated to the claims of any other creditors, on account of the amount of its liability under the provisions of this Article XVI, then, notwithstanding any other provision to the contrary, the amount of such liabilities of such Guarantor under the provisions of this Article XVI shall, without any further action by such Guarantor, Agent or any Lender or any other person, be automatically limited and reduced to the highest amount (after giving effect to the right of contribution established in Section 16.10 hereof) that is valid and enforceable and not subordinated to the claims of other creditors as determined in such action or proceeding.

 

16.10            Right of Contribution. Each Guarantor hereby agrees that to the extent that any Guarantor shall have paid more than its proportionate share of any payment made hereunder, such Guarantor shall be entitled to seek and receive contribution from and against any other Guarantor hereunder which has not paid its proportionate share of such payment. Each Guarantor’s right of contribution shall be subject to the terms and conditions of Section 16.7 hereof. The provisions of this Section 16.10 shall in no respect limit the obligations and liabilities of any Guarantor to the Agent or any Lender, and each Guarantor shall remain liable to Agent and each Lender for the full amount guaranteed by such Guarantor hereunder.

 

16.11            Intercreditor Agreement. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in this Agreement, the Liens, security interests and rights granted pursuant to this Agreement shall be subject to the terms, provisions and conditions of (and the exercise of any right or remedy by the administrative agent hereunder or thereunder shall be subject to the terms and conditions of), the Intercreditor Agreement. In the event of any conflict between this Agreement and the Intercreditor Agreement, the Intercreditor Agreement shall control, and no right, power, or remedy granted to the Agent hereunder shall be exercised by the Agent, nor shall any direction be given by the Agent in contravention of, the Intercreditor Agreement. With respect to any requirements herein for any Credit Party to deliver originals of certificated Securities, Instruments or similar documents constituting pledged Collateral, such requirements shall be deemed satisfied to the extent the requirements to deliver the same to the ABL Lender in accordance with the Intercreditor Agreement and the ABL Loan Documents are in effect and are satisfied by such Credit Party. To the extent that any covenants, representations or warranties set forth in this Agreement are untrue or incorrect solely as a result of the delivery to, or grant of possession or control to, the ABL Lender in accordance with this Section 16.11, such representation or warranty shall not be deemed to be untrue or incorrect for purposes of this Agreement.

 

[signature pages follow]

 

134 

 

 

 

Each of the parties has signed this Agreement as of the day and year first above written.

 

BORROWERS:  
direct digital holdings, llc
     
  By: /s/ Keith W. Smith
    Name: Keith W. Smith
    Title:   President
   
GUARANTORS  
  orange142, llc
     
By: /s/ Keith W. Smith
    Name: Keith W. Smith
    Title:   President
   
  huddled masses llc
     
  By: /s/ Keith W. Smith
    Name: Keith W. Smith
    Title:   President
   
   
  colossus media, llc
     
  By: /s/ Keith W. Smith
    Name: Keith W. Smith
    Title:   President
   
  UNIVERSAL STANDARDS FOR DIGITAL MARKETING, llc
     
  By: /s/ Keith W. Smith
    Name: Keith W. Smith
    Title:   President

 

[Signature Page to Term Loan and Security Agreement]

 

 

 

 

AGENT:  
Lafayette Square Loan Servicing, LLC
     
  By: /s/ Damien Dwin
    Name: Damien Dwin
    Title:   Chief Executive Officer

 

[Signature Page to Term Loan and Security Agreement]

 

 

 

 

LENDER:  
   
  MIDCAP FINANCIAL TRUST
Addresses for Notices:  
  By: Apollo Capital Management, L.P.,
its investment manager
MidCap Financial Trust  
c/o MidCap Financial Services, LLC, as Servicer
7255 Woodmont Ave., Suite 300
By: Apollo Capital Management, GP, LLC,
its general partner
Bethesda, MD 20814  
Attention: Account Manager for DDH By: /s/ Maurice Amsellem
Telephone: (301) 941-1450   Name: Maurice Amsellem
Email: notices@midcapfinancial.com   Title: Authorized Signatory
     

 

[Signature Page to Term Loan and Security Agreement]

 

 

 

LENDER:  
   
Addresses for Notices: MIDCAP FUNDING XI TRUST, as a Lender
   
MidCap Funding IX Trust
c/o MidCap Financial Services, LLC, as Servicer
By: Apollo Capital Management, L.P.,
its investment manager
7255 Woodmont Ave., Suite 300  
Bethesda, MD 20814
Attention: Account Manager for DDH
By: Apollo Capital Management GP, LLC,
its general partner
Telephone: (301) 941-1450  
Email: notices@midcapfinancial.com By: /s/ Maurice Amsellem
    Name: Maurice Amsellem
    Title: Authorized Signatory
 

[Signature Page to Term Loan and Security Agreement]

 

 

 

 

List of Exhibits and Schedules

 

Exhibits
Exhibit A Eligible Impact Services
Exhibit B Form of Transfer Supplement
Exhibit C Form of Compliance Certificate
Exhibit D Impact Certificate
Exhibit E Key Performance Indicators
Exhibit F-1 Form of Closing Date Term Note
Exhibit F-2 Form of Delayed Draw Term Loan Note
Exhibit G Form of Joinder
Exhibit H Form of Financial Condition Certificate
   
Schedules
Schedule 1.2(b) Term Loan Commitment Percentages
Schedule 1.2(c) Commercial Tort Claims
Schedule 4.5 Chief Executive Office; Equipment and Inventory Locations
Schedule 4.15(h) Deposit and Investment Accounts
Schedule 5.1 Jurisdictions of Organization and Good Standing
Schedule 5.2(a) Equity Interests and Ownership
Schedule 5.2(b) Subsidiaries
Schedule 5.8(d) Pension Benefit Plan
Schedule 5.10 Information Regarding the Credit Parties and their Subsidiaries
Schedule 5.13 Intellectual Property
Schedule 5.26 Liabilities, Assets and Activities
Schedule 5.27 Insurance
Schedule 7.2 Existing Liens
Schedule 7.4 Existing Investments
Schedule 7.8 Existing Indebtedness
Schedule 7.10 Transactions with Affiliates

 

 

 

 

Exhibit A

 

Eligible Impact Services

 

 

 

 

Exhibit B

 

Form of Transfer Supplement

 

 

 

 

Exhibit C

 

Form of Compliance Certificate

 

 

 

 

Exhibit D

 

Impact Certificate

 

 

 

 

Exhibit E

 

Key Performance Indicators

 

 

 

 

Exhibit F-1

 

Form of Closing Date Term Note

 

 

 

Exhibit F-2

 

Form of Delayed Draw Term Loan Note

 

 

 

 

Exhibit G

 

Form of Joinder

 

 

 

 

Exhibit H

 

Form of Financial Condition Certificate

 

 

 

 

Schedule 1.2(b)

 

Term Loan Commitment Percentages

 

 

 

 

Schedule 1.2(c)

 

Commercial Tort Claims

 

 

 

 

Schedule 4.5

 

Chief Executive Office; Equipment and Inventory Locations

 

 

 

 

Schedule 4.15(h)

 

Deposit and Investment Accounts

 

 

 

 

Schedule 5.1

 

Jurisdictions of Organization and Good Standing

 

 

 

 

Schedule 5.2(a)

 

Equity Interests and Ownership

 

 

 

Schedule 5.2(b)

 

Subsidiaries

 

 

 

 

Schedule 5.8(d)

 

Pension Benefit Plan

 

 

 

 

Schedule 5.10

 

Information Regarding the Credit Parties and their Subsidiaries

 

 

 

 

Schedule 5.13

 

Intellectual Property

 

 

 

 

Schedule 5.26

 

Liabilities, Assets and Activities

 

 

 

 

Schedule 5.27

 

Insurance

 

 

 

 

Schedule 7.2

 

Existing Liens

 

 

 

 

Schedule 7.4

 

Existing Investments

 

 

 

 

Schedule 7.8

 

Existing Indebtedness

 

 

 

 

 

Schedule 7.10

 

Transactions with Affiliates

 

 

 

 

Exhibit 10.18 

 

Execution Version

 

Intercreditor Agreement

 

This Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of December 3, 2021 (as amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time, this "Agreement"), is entered into by and between:

 

(a) LAFAYETTE SQUARE LOAN SERVICING, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company ("LS"), acting in its capacity as the "Agent" (together with its successors and assigns, in such capacity, the "LS Facility Agent") for the "Lenders" (collectively, the "LS Facility Lenders," and, together with the LS Facility Agent, the "LS Facility Creditors") from time to time party to the LS Facility Agreement (as defined in paragraph 1 under Preliminary Statements below); and

 

(b) East West Bank, a California state bank ("EWB"), acting in its capacity as lender (the "A/R Facility Lender”) pursuant to the A/R Facility Agreement (as defined in paragraph 3 under Preliminary Statements below).

 

The LS Facility Creditors and the A/R Facility Lender are referred to herein, collectively, as the "Parties," and any of the foregoing, individually, as a "Party." This is the "Intercreditor Agreement" referred to in the LS Facility Agreement and the A/R Facility Agreement.

 

Preliminary Statements

 

1. Pursuant to the Term Loan and Security Agreement, dated as of the date hereof (as amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time (the "LS Facility Agreement"), among Direct Digital Holdings, LLC, a Texas limited liability company ("DDH"), the other "Borrowers" from time to time party thereto (such Borrowers, collectively, and together with DDH, the "LS Borrowers," and each, an "LS Borrower"), the Credit Parties (as defined therein) party thereto, the LS Facility Lenders and the LS Facility Agent, the LS Facility Lenders have agreed to provide certain closing date term loans and delayed draw term loans (the "LS Facility Loan") to the Borrowers, subject to the terms and conditions set forth therein.

 

2. The obligations of the Obligors under the LS Facility Agreement and the other LS Facility Documents (as defined in Section 1.1 (Definitions) below) are secured by a Lien on all assets of the Obligors pursuant to the terms of the LS Facility Documents.

 

3. DDH, the other “Borrower Entities” from time to time party thereto (such Borrower Entities, collectively and together with DDH, the “EWB Borrowers” and each an “EWB Borrower) and EWB, as A/R Facility Lender, have entered into the Credit Agreement, dated as of September 30, 2020 (as has been and may hereafter be amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time, the "A/R Facility Agreement"), pursuant to which the A/R Facility Lender has provided a revolving credit facility (the "A/R Facility") under which it has agreed to make loans (the "A/R Facility Loans") from time to time to the EWB Borrowers, based upon the A/R Facility Receivables (as defined in Section 1.1 (Definitions) below).

 

4. Pursuant to the Security Agreement, dated as of September 30, 2020 (the "A/R Facility Security Agreement"), between the EWB Borrowers and the A/R Facility Lender, the EWB Borrowers have granted to the A/R Facility Lender a security interest in all of its personal property and assets to secure the A/R Facility Loans and its other obligations under the A/R Facility Agreement.

 

 

 

 

5. In order to induce the LS Facility Creditors to enter into the LS Facility Agreement, EWB has agreed that, as and in the manner set forth in this Agreement, (i) the payment of the LS Facility Obligations and A/R Facility Obligations shall be subject to the terms and conditions of this Agreement, and (ii) the priority of the LS Facility Creditors' security interests in and Liens, as in effect from time to time, on the property and assets of the Obligors, other than the A/R Facility Receivables Collateral (as defined in Section 1.1 (Definitions) below), shall be senior and prior to any security interests or Liens securing the A/R Facility Obligations as more fully set forth herein.

 

6. In order to induce EWB to continue to make loans and advances pursuant to the A/R Facility Agreement, the LS Facility Creditors have agreed that, as and in the manner set forth in this Agreement, (i) the payment of the LS Facility Obligations and A/R Facility Obligations shall be subject to the terms and conditions of this Agreement and (ii) the priority of EWB's security interest in and Lien, as in effect from time to time, on the A/R Facility Receivables Collateral shall be senior and prior to any security interests or Liens securing the LS Facility Obligations as more fully set forth herein.

 

7. (i) Under the LS Facility Agreement, it is a condition precedent to the obligation of the LS Facility Lenders to make the LS Facility Loan that EWB has entered into this Agreement, and (ii) under the A/R Facility Agreement, it is a condition precedent to the consent of the A/R Facility Lenders with respect to the LS Facility Loan that LS has entered into this Agreement.

 

Now, therefore, each of the LS Facility Claimholders and each of the A/R Facility Claimholders hereby agrees as follows:

 

Article 1
Definitions and Usage

 

Section 1.1     Definitions. As used in this Agreement, the following terms shall have the following meanings:

 

"Agreement" has the meaning specified in the preamble hereto.

 

"A/R Facility" has the meaning specified in paragraph 3 under Preliminary Statements above.

 

"A/R Facility Agreement" has the meaning specified in paragraph 1 under Preliminary Statements above.

 

"A/R Facility Claimholders" means, at any relevant time, individually and collectively, the A/R Facility Lender and any other holders of the A/R Facility Obligations from time to time.

 

"A/R Facility Documents" means, collectively, (a) the A/R Facility Agreement; (b) the A/R Facility Security Agreement; (c) the “Preferred Equity Subordination Agreement” (as defined in the A/R Facility Agreement); (d) the other "Security Documents" (as defined in the A/R Facility Agreement); (e) any other security agreement, pledge agreement, collateral agreement or other agreement, document, or instrument pursuant to which a Lien is granted securing any A/R Facility Obligation or under which rights or remedies with respect to such Liens are governed and (f) any and all other documents or agreements delivered pursuant to, or in connection with, the A/R Facility Obligations, in each case, as the same may be amended, amended and restated, supplemented, modified, replaced, substituted or renewed from time to time.

 

  2 Intercreditor Agreement

 

 

"A/R Facility Lender" has the meaning specified in the preamble to this Agreement.

 

"A/R Facility Loans" has the meaning specified in paragraph 1 under Preliminary Statements above.

 

"A/R Facility Obligations" means, collectively, all “Obligations” as defined in the A/R Facility Agreement, whether for principal, interest (including interest accruing after the filing of any Insolvency Proceeding in respect of any of the Obligors, whether or not a claim for post-filing or post-petition interest is allowed in such proceeding), default interest, exit fees, premiums, if any, thereon, fees on account of loan servicing and other fees, costs and expenses payable to the A/R Facility Claimholders pursuant to the A/R Facility Documents (including reasonable attorneys' fees and disbursements, including any such fees, costs and expenses incurred after the filing of any Insolvency Proceeding in respect of any of the Obligors, whether or not a claim for post-filing or post-petition payments of such amounts is allowed or allowable in such proceeding), all amounts payable to the A/R Facility Claimholders in respect of any breach of a representation or warranty made in the A/R Facility Documents and other amounts payable in respect thereof or in connection therewith, including any reimbursement obligations or indemnities.

 

"A/R Facility Permitted Payments" means any payment of A/R Facility Obligations that is made solely from A/R Facility Receivables Collateral.

 

A/R Facility Priority Obligations” has the meaning specified in Section 7.1 hereof.

 

"A/R Facility Receivables" means the accounts (as defined in the UCC) constituting the "Eligible Accounts" (as defined in the A/R Facility Agreement) from time to time subject to the A/R Facility.

 

"A/R Facility Receivables Collateral" means any portion of the Collateral that consists of (a) A/R Facility Receivables or (b) any amounts received thereon, or Proceeds thereof, (i) from time to time received following acceleration of the A/R Facility Loans or (ii) realized by the LS Facility Agent on behalf of the A/R Facility Lender from the Disposition of the A/R Facility Receivables.

 

"A/R Facility Recovery" has the meaning specified in Section 4.8 (Avoidance Issues) below.

 

"A/R Facility Security Agreement" has the meaning specified in paragraph 2 under Preliminary Statements above.

 

"A/R Lender Account Control Agreement" means, collectively, any deposit account control agreements with respect to each deposit account and a securities account control agreement with respect to each securities account of any Obligor with EWB or any other depository institution, providing exclusive control thereof to the A/R Facility Lender (or the LC Facility Agent with respect to any Term Loan Priority Account) upon a notice of exclusive control delivered following the occurrence of an Event of Default until such time as Discharge of the A/R Facility Obligations (or until such time as the Discharge of the LS Facility Obligations with respect to any Term Loan Priority Account) has occurred and thereafter providing exclusive control thereof to the LS Facility Agent (or A/R Facility Lender with respect to the Term Loan Priority Accounts) upon a notice of exclusive control delivered following the occurrence of an Event of Default. For the avoidance of doubt, with respect to any Term Loan Priority Account, the applicable deposit account control agreement shall provide that LF Facility Agent shall be the first secured party with respect to (or have exclusive control of) such Term Loan Priority Account until such time as the Discharge of the LS Facility Obligations has ocurred.

 

  3 Intercreditor Agreement

 

 

"Bankruptcy Code" means the United States Bankruptcy Code, 11 U.S.C. §101, et seq.

 

"Business Day" means any day other than Saturday, Sunday and any other day on which banking institutions in the State of New York are authorized to be closed for business.

 

"Cash Collateral" has the meaning specified in Section 4.2 (Financing) below.

 

"Claimholders" means the A/R Facility Claimholders and the LS Facility Claimholders, collectively, and "Claimholder" means any one of them.

 

"Collateral" means all of the assets and property (whether real, personal or mixed (including Equity Interests)) now owned or hereafter acquired by any Obligor in or upon which Liens are granted or purported to be granted pursuant to any of the LS Facility Documents or any of the A/R Facility Documents and all products and Proceeds of any of the foregoing.

 

"Collection Action" means (i)(a) any demand or request for any payment or Distribution, or (b) any commencement of (or participation with others in the commencement or prosecution of) any litigation or other similar proceeding or the commencement of any other attempt to enforce any other right or exercise any remedy, in each case in connection with the A/R Facility Obligations, including any acceleration of any A/R Facility Obligations, (ii) any commencement of, or joinder with any creditor in commencing, any Insolvency Proceeding or the Exercise of Secured Creditor Remedies or the exercise of rights or remedies under any Insolvency Laws against any Obligor or any of its Subsidiaries or any assets of any Obligor or any of its Subsidiaries, in each case by any A/R Facility Claimholder.

 

"Combined Facility Disposition" means any private or public Disposition of all or any Collateral by one or more Obligors with the consent of the LS Facility Agent, on behalf of the requisite LS Facility Claimholders, and by the A/R Facility Lender, on behalf of the requisite A/R Facility Claimholders, after the occurrence and during the continuance of an Event of Default.

 

"Control Collateral" means any Collateral consisting of a certificated security (as defined in the UCC), investment property (as defined in the UCC), a deposit account (as defined in the UCC), or any other Collateral as to which a Lien may be perfected through physical possession or control by the secured party or any agent therefor.

 

"DDH" has the meaning specified in paragraph 1 under Preliminary Statements above.

 

"DIP Financing" has the meaning specified in Section 4.2 (Financing) below.

 

"Discharge of the A/R Facility Obligations" means (a) the payment in full in cash of the A/R Facility Obligations (other than contingent indemnification or reimbursement obligations for which no claim has been made) and (b) the termination or expiration of all commitments to extend credit that would constitute A/R Facility Obligations, in each case, in accordance with the terms of the A/R Facility Documents; provided, however, that no amount shall be deemed to have been paid for purposes of clause (a) of this definition for so long as such amount is, or is reasonably likely to become, subject to an A/R Facility Recovery.

 

  4 Intercreditor Agreement

 

 

"Discharge of the LS Facility Obligations" means (a) the payment in full in cash of the LS Facility Obligations (other than contingent indemnification or reimbursement obligations for which no claim has been made) and (b) the termination or expiration of all commitments to extend credit that would constitute LS Facility Obligations, in each case, in accordance with the terms of the LS Facility Documents; provided, however, that no amount shall be deemed to have been paid for purposes of clause (a) of this definition for so long as such amount is, or is reasonably likely to become, subject to a LS Recovery.

 

"Disposition" or "Dispose" means the conveyance, sale, foreclosure, lease (as lessor), license (as licensor), exchange, assignment, transfer or other disposition of any property by any Person (or the granting of any option or other right to do any of the foregoing).

 

"Distribution" means any payment or distribution by any Person in respect of the LS Facility Obligations or the A/R Facility Obligations, as the case may be, of assets of any kind or character (whether in cash, securities, assets, by set-off, recoupment or otherwise and including by purchase redemption or other acquisition of such LS Facility Obligations or A/R Facility Obligations).

 

"Equity Interests" means, with respect to any Person, the capital stock, partnership or limited liability company interest or other equity securities or equity ownership interests of such Person.

 

"EWB" has the meaning specified in the preamble to this Agreement.

 

EWB Borrowershas the meaning specified in paragraph 3 under Preliminary Statements above.

 

"Exercise any Secured Creditor Remedies" or "Exercise of Secured Creditor Remedies" means (a) the taking of any action to enforce any Lien in respect of all or any portion of the Collateral, including the institution of any foreclosure proceedings or the noticing of any public or private sale or other Disposition pursuant to Article 9 of the UCC; (b) the exercise of any right or remedy provided to a secured creditor under the LS Facility Documents or the A/R Facility Documents (including, in either case, any delivery of any notice to seek to obtain payment directly from any account debtor of any Obligor or the taking of any action or the exercise of any right or remedy in respect of the setoff or recoupment against all or any portion of the Collateral or Proceeds of all or any portion of the Collateral), under applicable law, at equity, in an Insolvency Proceeding or otherwise, including the acceptance of all or any portion of the Collateral in full or partial satisfaction of a Lien; (c) the sale, assignment, transfer, lease, license or other Disposition of all or any portion of the Collateral, by private or public sale or any other means; (d) the exercise of any other enforcement right relating to all or any portion of the Collateral (including the exercise of any voting rights relating to any Equity Interests composing a portion of the Collateral and the gathering of Collateral) whether under the LS Facility Documents, the A/R Facility Documents, under applicable law of any jurisdiction, in equity, in an Insolvency Proceeding (other than a request for adequate protection permitted by this Agreement), or otherwise; (e) the pursuit of LS Facility Dispositions or (f) the setoff or recoupment against or foreclosure on all or any portion of the Collateral or the Proceeds of all or any portion of the Collateral.

 

  5 Intercreditor Agreement

 

 

"Exercise Period " has the meaning specified in Section 7.4 (Exercise Period) below.

 

"Governmental Authority" means the government of the United States or any other nation, or of any political subdivision thereof, whether State or local, and any agency, authority, instrumentality, regulatory body, court, central bank or other entity exercising executive, legislative, judicial, taxing, regulatory or administrative powers or functions of or pertaining to government (including any supra-national bodies such as the European Union or the European Central Bank).

 

"Insolvency Laws" means the Bankruptcy Code and all other liquidation, conservatorship, bankruptcy, assignment for the benefit of creditors, moratorium, rearrangement, receivership, insolvency, reorganization or similar debtor relief laws of the U.S., any State or any other applicable jurisdictions.

 

"Insolvency Proceeding" means any proceeding by or against any Person under the Bankruptcy Code, or under any other Insolvency Law, including assignments for the benefit of creditors, compositions, extensions generally with its creditors or proceedings seeking reorganization, arrangement or other similar relief.

 

"Lien" means any mortgage, deed of trust, pledge, hypothecation, assignment for security, security interest, encumbrance, levy, lien or charge of any kind, whether voluntarily incurred or arising by operation of law or otherwise, against any property, any conditional sale or other title retention agreement and any lease in the nature of a security interest.

 

"LS" has the meaning specified in the preamble to this Agreement.

 

LS Borrowershas the meaning specified in paragraph 1 under Preliminary Statements above.

 

"LS Facility Agent" has the meaning specified in the preamble to this Agreement.

 

"LS Facility Agreement" has the meaning specified in paragraph 1 under Preliminary Statements above.

 

"LS Facility Claimholders" means, at any relevant time, individually and collectively, the LS Facility Creditors, the LS Facility Lenders or any other holders of the LS Facility Obligations at that time.

 

"LS Facility Creditors" has the meaning specified in the preamble to this Agreement.

 

"LS Facility Documents" means, collectively, (a) the LS Facility Agreement, (b) the “Preferred Equity Subordination Agreement” (as defined in the LS Facility Agreement), (c) the “Other Documents" (as defined in the LS Facility Agreement), (d) any other security agreement, pledge agreement, collateral agreement or other agreement, document, or instrument pursuant to which a Lien is granted securing any LS Facility Obligation or under which rights or remedies with respect to such Liens are governed and (f) any and all other documents or agreements delivered pursuant to, or in connection with, the LS Facility Obligations (including in connection with any DIP Financing provided by an LS Facility Claimholder), in each case, as the same may be amended, amended and restated, supplemented, modified, replaced, substituted or renewed from time to time or Refinanced.

 

"LS Facility Lenders" has the meaning specified in the preamble to this Agreement.

 

  6 Intercreditor Agreement

 

 

"LS Facility Loan " has the meaning specified in paragraph 1 under Preliminary Statements above.

 

"LS Facility Obligations" means, collectively, all "Obligations" as defined in the LS Facility Agreement (and all Advances), together with all obligations of the Obligors now or hereafter arising under the LS Facility Documents, whether for principal, interest, default interest (including interest accruing after the filing of any Insolvency Proceeding in respect of any of the Obligors, whether or not a claim for post-filing or post-petition interest is allowed in such proceeding), exit fees, premiums, if any, thereon, and other fees, costs and expenses payable to the LS Facility Claimholders pursuant to the LS Facility Documents (including reasonable attorneys' fees and disbursements, including any such fees, costs and expenses incurred after the filing of any Insolvency Proceeding in respect of any of the Obligors, whether or not a claim for post-filing or post-petition payments of such amounts is allowed or allowable in such proceeding), all amounts payable to the LS Facility Claimholders in respect of any breach of a representation or warranty made in the LS Facility Documents and other amounts payable in respect thereof or in connection therewith, including any reimbursement obligations or indemnities.

 

"LS Recovery" has the meaning specified in Section 4.8 (Avoidance Issues) below.

 

"Obligors" means the LS Borrowers, the EWB Borrowers and each other Person that may from time to time execute and deliver a LS Facility Document or a A/R Facility Document as a "debtor," "borrower," "guarantor," "obligor," "grantor" or "pledgor" (or the equivalent thereof), and "Obligor" means any one of them.

 

"Party" and "Parties" have the respective meanings specified in the preamble to this Agreement.

 

"Person" means any natural person, sole proprietorship, partnership, joint venture, trust, estate, unincorporated organization, association, corporation, limited liability company, institution or other legal entity or organization or any government.

 

"Proceeds" means (a) all "proceeds" as defined in Article 9 of the UCC with respect to the Collateral and (b) whatever is recoverable or recovered when Collateral is sold, exchanged, collected or Disposed of, whether voluntarily or involuntarily.

 

"Purchase Notice" has the meaning specified in Section 7.3(a) (Purchase Notice) below.

 

"Purchase Price" has the meaning specified in Section 7.2(a) (Purchase Price) below.

 

"Refinance" means, in respect of any indebtedness, to refinance, extend, exchange, renew, defease, supplement, restructure, replace, refund or repay, or to issue other indebtedness in exchange or replacement for such indebtedness, in whole or in part, whether with the same or different lenders, arrangers or agents. "Refinanced" and "Refinancing" shall have correlative meanings.

 

"State" means (a) any state or commonwealth of the United States and (b) the District of Columbia.

 

"Subsidiary" means, with respect to any Person, any corporation, partnership, limited liability company, company, association, joint venture or other business entity (a) the accounts of which would be consolidated with those of such Person in such Person's consolidated financial statements if such financial statements were prepared in accordance with GAAP or (b) of which more than 50.00% of the total voting power of shares of stock or other ownership interests entitled (without regard to the occurrence of any contingency) to vote in the election of the Person or Persons (whether directors, managers, trustees or other Persons performing similar functions) having the power to direct or cause the direction of the management and policies thereof is at the time owned or controlled, directly or indirectly, by that Person or one or more of the other Subsidiaries of that Person or a combination thereof; provided, that in determining the percentage of ownership interests of any Person controlled by another Person, no ownership interest in the nature of a "qualifying share" of the former Person shall be deemed to be outstanding.

 

  7 Intercreditor Agreement

 

 

Term Loan Priority Account” shall mean a deposit account or deposit accounts established by the Obligors or any Obligor that solely contains Collateral (other than A/R Facility Receivables Collateral) or Proceeds of Collateral (other than the A/R Facility Receivables Collateral).

 

"UCC" means the Uniform Commercial Code or any successor provision thereof as the same may from time to time be in effect in the State of New York or the Uniform Commercial Code or any successor provision thereof (or similar code or statute) of another jurisdiction, to the extent it may be required to apply to the perfection or priority of any Lien on or otherwise with regard to any item or items of Collateral.

 

"United States" or "U.S." means the United States of America.

 

Section 1.2     Other Defined Terms. Any other capitalized terms used but not defined in this Agreement (including, without limitation, the term "GAAP") have the meanings assigned to such terms under the LS Facility Agreement; provided, that the terms "Default" and "Event of Default" shall mean a “Default” or “Event of Default” as defined under either the LS Facility Agreement or the A/R Facility Agreement.

 

Section 1.3     Usage. The following rules of construction and usage are applicable to this Agreement unless a contrary intention appears:

 

(a)            UCC Terms. All terms used but not defined herein shall, if defined in the UCC and used in Article 8 or 9 thereof, have the meanings assigned to such terms under the UCC for the purposes of Article 8 or 9, as applicable, thereof.

 

(b)            Section References, Etc. References to an "Article," "Section," "Annex," "Exhibit" or "Schedule," or to another subdivision or attachment, shall be deemed to refer to an article, section, annex, exhibit, schedule or other subdivision of, or attachment to, this Agreement.

 

(c)            Inclusion. The word "including" means "including without limitation," and the rule of ejusdem generis shall not be applicable to limit any provision.

 

(d)            Non-Exclusive Disjunction. The word "or" is not exclusive (meaning that "X or Y" should be understood to mean "X or Y (or both X and Y)").

 

(e)            Hereof, Herein and Hereunder. The words "herein," "hereof" and "hereunder," or a word of similar import, shall be construed to refer to the entirety of this Agreement, and not to any particular provision of this Agreement, and includes all annexes, exhibits, schedules and other attachments to this Agreement.

 

(f)            Asset and Property. The words "asset" and "property" shall be construed to have the same meaning and effect and to refer to any and all tangible and intangible assets and properties, including cash, securities, accounts and contract rights.

 

  8 Intercreditor Agreement

 

 

(g)            Word Forms. The definitions contained in this Agreement shall apply equally to the singular and plural forms of the terms defined, and, whenever the context may require, any pronoun shall include the corresponding masculine, feminine and neuter forms.

 

(h)            Agreements and Statutes. Any reference to an agreement, statute, rule or regulation shall be deemed to refer to such agreement, statute, rule or regulation as from time to time amended, modified, supplemented or replaced, including (in the case of agreements) by waiver or consent and (in the case of statutes) by succession of comparable successor statutes and includes (in the case of agreements) references to all annexes, exhibits, schedules and other attachments thereto and documents expressly incorporated by reference therein and (in the case of statutes) any rules and regulations promulgated thereunder and any judicial and administrative interpretations thereof.

 

(i)            Successors and Assigns. References to a Person are also to its permitted successors and assigns.

 

(j)            Immediately-Available Funds. References to deposits, transfers and payments of any amounts refer to deposits, transfers or payments of such amounts in immediately-available funds.

 

(k)            Writing. References to "writing" include printing, typing, lithography, electronic transmission and other means of reproducing words in a visible form.

 

(l)            Time. All references to a time shall mean New York City time in effect on the date of the action unless otherwise expressly stated. In the computation of a period of time from a specified date to a later specified date, the word "from" means "from and including" and the words "to" and "until" each mean "to but excluding." Time is of the essence under this Agreement.

 

(m)            Headings. Headings are included for convenience only and shall not affect the interpretation of this Agreement. Unless the contrary is compelled by the context, everything contained in each Section applies equally to this entire Agreement.

 

Article 2
Lien Subordination

 

Section 2.1     Acknowledgement; Consent; and Subordination.

 

(a)            The A/R Facility Lender and each of the other A/R Facility Claimholders hereby (i) acknowledge that the Obligors, either prior to the date hereof or concurrently herewith, have granted or are granting Liens on the Collateral in favor of the LS Facility Creditors to secure the LS Facility Obligations and (ii) consent, anything to the contrary contained in any A/R Facility Document or any other agreement to which any A/R Facility Claimholder may now or hereafter be a party notwithstanding, to the grant by the Obligors of such Liens on the Collateral to secure the LS Facility Obligations.

 

  9 Intercreditor Agreement

 

 

(b)            Each LS Facility Creditor and each of the other LS Facility Claimholders hereby (i) acknowledge that the Obligors, either prior to the date hereof or concurrently herewith, have granted or are granting Liens on the Collateral in favor of the A/R Facility Lender to secure the A/R Facility Obligations and (ii) consent, anything to the contrary contained in any LS Facility Document or any other agreement to which any LS Facility Claimholder may now or hereafter be a party notwithstanding, to the grant by the Obligors of such Liens on the Collateral to secure the A/R Facility Obligations.

 

(c)            Notwithstanding (A) the date, time, method, manner or order of grant, attachment or perfection of any Liens granted to the LS Facility Creditors (or any LS Facility Lender or other LS Facility Claimholder) or any A/R Facility Claimholder in respect of all or any portion of the Collateral; (B) the order or time of filing or recordation of any document or instrument for perfecting the Liens in favor of the LS Facility Creditors (or any LS Facility Lender or other LS Facility Claimholder) or any A/R Facility Claimholder in any Collateral; (C) any provision of the UCC, any other applicable law, any of the LS Facility Documents or any of the A/R Facility Documents; (D) whether the Liens securing the LS Facility Obligations or the A/R Facility Obligations are valid, enforceable, void, avoidable, subordinated, disputed or allowed; (E) whether or not any such Liens securing any LS Facility Obligations or any A/R Facility Obligations are perfected, unperfected, avoided, set aside or subordinated to any Lien securing any other obligation or debt of any Obligor or any other Person; (F) any defect or deficiency or alleged defect or deficiency in any of the foregoing or (G) any other circumstance whatsoever, each of the LS Facility Agent, on behalf of itself and the LS Facility Lenders, and each of the A/R Facility Claimholders hereby agree that:

 

(i) any Lien with respect to all or any portion of the Collateral (other than A/R Facility Receivables Collateral) securing any LS Facility Obligations now or hereafter held by or on behalf of, or created for the benefit of, any LS Facility Claimholder or any agent or trustee therefor, regardless of how acquired, whether by grant, possession, statute, operation of law, subrogation or otherwise, shall be senior and prior in all respects to all Liens with respect to all or any portion of the Collateral securing any A/R Facility Obligations;

 

(ii) any Lien with respect to all or any portion of the Collateral (other than A/R Facility Receivables Collateral) securing any A/R Facility Obligations now or hereafter held by or on behalf of, or created for the benefit of, any A/R Facility Claimholder or any agent or trustee therefor, regardless of how acquired, whether by grant, possession, statute, operation of law, subrogation or otherwise, shall be junior and subordinate in all respects to all Liens with respect to all or any portion of the Collateral securing any LS Facility Obligations;

 

(iii) any Lien with respect to all or any portion of the A/R Facility Receivables Collateral securing any A/R Facility Obligations now or hereafter held by or on behalf of, or created for the benefit of, any A/R Facility Claimholder or any agent or trustee therefor, regardless of how acquired, whether by grant, possession, statute, operation of law, subrogation or otherwise, shall be senior and prior in all respects to all Liens with respect to all or any portion of the A/R Facility Receivables Collateral securing any LS Facility Obligations;

 

  10 Intercreditor Agreement

 

 

(iv) any Lien with respect to all or any portion of the A/R Facility Receivables Collateral securing any LS Facility Obligations now or hereafter held by or on behalf of, or created for the benefit of, any LS Facility Claimholder or any agent or trustee therefor, regardless of how acquired, whether by grant, possession, statute, operation of law, subrogation or otherwise, shall be junior and subordinate in all respects to all Liens with respect to all or any portion of the A/R Facility Receivables Collateral securing any A/R Facility Obligations;

 

(v) the Lien priority provisions set forth in this Agreement shall be effective at all times and for all purposes (including during an Insolvency Proceeding).

 

Section 2.2     Disposition of Collateral; Release of Liens.

 

(a)            Exclusive Rights.

 

(i) Prior to the Discharge of the LS Facility Obligations, the LS Facility Creditors, on behalf of the LS Facility Claimholders, shall have the exclusive right to make determinations regarding the release of the Lien on any Collateral pursuant to the terms of the applicable LS Facility Documents or in accordance with the provisions of this Agreement, in each case without any consultation with, consent of or notice to the A/R Facility Lender or any other A/R Facility Claimholder. Except as set forth in clause (b) of this Section 2.2, no such release shall effect a release of the Lien of the A/R Facility Lender.

 

(ii) Prior to the Discharge of the A/R Facility Obligations, the A/R Facility Lender, on behalf of the A/R Facility Claimholders, shall have the exclusive right to make determinations regarding the release of the Lien on any A/R Facility Receivables Collateral pursuant to the terms of the applicable A/R Facility Documents or in accordance with the provisions of this Agreement, in each case without any consultation with, consent of or notice to the LS Facility Creditors or any other LS Facility Claimholder. Except as set forth in clause (b) of this Section 2.2, no such release shall effect a release of the Lien of the LS Facility Creditors.

 

(b)            Lien Release Upon Disposition of Collateral. Upon any release or Disposition of any Collateral (i) resulting from (x) the Exercise of Secured Creditor Remedies by the LS Facility Agent on behalf of the LS Facility Creditors and the A/R Facility Lender, or (y) any Combined Facility Disposition, (ii) pursuant to any sale, transfer or other Disposition of all or any portion of the Collateral (other than A/R Facility Receivables Collateral) permitted by the LS Facility Documents, or (iii) pursuant to any sale, transfer or Disposition of all or any portion of the Collateral by an Obligor with the consent of LS Facility Agent during the continuance of an Event of Default under the LS Facility Documents (so long as the Proceeds of such Disposition are applied in accordance with Section 8.4 hereof): (A) any Liens securing the A/R Facility Obligations on such Collateral (without limiting the rights of the A/R Facility Claimholders to any portion of the proceeds of such Collateral in respect of the A/R Facility Receivables Collateral or remaining after the Discharge of the LS Facility Obligations occurs) (and in the case of any release, sale or disposition of all or substantially all of the equity interests or assets of any Obligor that has guaranteed any A/R Facility Obligations, such Obligor's liability in respect of the A/R Facility Obligations) shall be automatically, unconditionally and simultaneously released with no further consent or action of any Person and (B) the A/R Facility Claimholders shall be deemed to have consented under the A/R Facility Documents to such release, sale or disposition of such Collateral (without limiting the rights of the A/R Facility Claimholders to any portion of the proceeds of such Collateral in respect of the A/R Facility Receivables Collateral or remaining after the Discharge of the LS Facility Obligations occurs) (and in the case of any release, sale or disposition of all or substantially all of the equity interests or assets of any Obligor that has guaranteed any A/R Facility Obligations, the release of such Obligor's liability in respect of the A/R Facility Obligations) and to have waived the provisions of the A/R Facility Documents to the extent necessary to permit such release, sale or disposition (and in the case of any release, sale or disposition of all or substantially all of the equity interests or assets of any Obligor that has guaranteed any A/R Facility Obligations, the release of such Obligor's liability in respect of the A/R Facility Obligations).

 

  11 Intercreditor Agreement

 

 

(c)            Power of Attorney. Until the Discharge of the LS Facility Obligations occurs, each A/R Facility Claimholder hereby irrevocably constitutes and appoints the LS Facility Agent and any officer or agent of the LS Facility Agent, with full power of substitution, as its true and lawful attorney in fact with full irrevocable power and authority in the place and stead of such A/R Facility Claimholder or in the LS Facility Agent's own name, from time to time in the LS Facility Agent's discretion, for the purpose of carrying out the terms of this Section 2.2 and Section 3.3, to take any and all appropriate action in connection therewith and to execute any and all documents and instruments that may be necessary or desirable to accomplish the purposes of this Section 2.2 and Section 3.3, including any endorsements or other instruments of transfer or release.

 

Section 2.3     Waiver of Right to Contest Obligations and Liens.

 

(a)            Waiver by A/R Facility Claimholders. Each A/R Facility Claimholder, for itself and on behalf of its affiliates, agrees that it will not (and hereby waives any right to), directly or indirectly, contest or support any other Person in contesting, in any proceeding (including any Insolvency Proceeding), (i) the validity, enforceability or allowance of any claims of any of the LS Facility Claimholders; (ii) the priority (subject to the terms of this Agreement), validity or enforceability of a Lien held by or on behalf of any of the LS Facility Claimholders in any assets of any of the Obligors or (iii) the validity or enforceability of the provisions of this Agreement; provided, however, that nothing in this Agreement shall be construed to prevent or impair the rights of the A/R Facility Lender or any other A/R Facility Claimholder to enforce the terms of this Agreement.

 

(b)            Waiver by LS Facility Claimholders. Each LS Facility Claimholder, for itself and on behalf of its affiliates, agrees that it will not (and hereby waives any right to), directly or indirectly, contest or support any other Person in contesting, in any proceeding (including any Insolvency Proceeding), (i) the validity, enforceability or allowance of any claims of any of the A/R Facility Claimholders; (ii) the priority (subject to the terms of this Agreement), validity or enforceability of a Lien held by or on behalf of any of the A/R Facility Claimholders in any assets of any of the Obligors or (iii) the validity or enforceability of the provisions of this Agreement; provided, however, that nothing in this Agreement shall be construed to prevent or impair the rights of the LS Facility Creditors or any other LS Facility Claimholder to enforce the terms of this Agreement.

 

  12 Intercreditor Agreement

 

 

Section 2.4     New Liens.

 

(a)            New Liens for the Benefit of A/R Facility Claimholders. So long as the Discharge of the LS Facility Obligations has not occurred, the Parties agree that no Obligor shall grant or permit any additional Liens on any asset to secure any A/R Facility Obligations unless such Obligor grants a Lien on such asset to secure the LS Facility Obligations prior to or concurrently with the grant of a Lien thereon in favor of the A/R Facility Lender, which Liens shall be subject to the provisions of this Agreement. To the extent that the foregoing provision is not complied with for any reason (and without limiting any other rights and remedies available to any LS Facility Claimholders), each A/R Facility Claimholder agrees that any amounts received by or distributed to any of them pursuant to or as a result of Liens granted in contravention of this Section 2.4 shall be subject to Section 8.2 (Turnover).

 

(b)     New Liens for the Benefit of LS Facility Claimholders(c)     . So long as the Discharge of the A/R Facility Obligations has not occurred, the Parties agree that no Obligor shall grant or permit any additional Liens on any asset to secure any LS Facility Obligations unless such Obligor grants a Lien on such asset to secure the A/R Facility Obligations prior to or concurrently with the grant of a Lien thereon in favor of any LS Facility Creditor, which Liens shall be subject to the provisions of this Agreement. To the extent that the foregoing provision is not complied with for any reason (and without limiting any other rights and remedies available to any A/R Facility Claimholders), each LS Facility Claimholder agrees that any amounts received by or distributed to any of them pursuant to or as a result of Liens granted in contravention of this Section 2.4 shall be subject to Section 8.2 (Turnover) below.

 

Section 2.5     Agent for Perfection. The LS Facility Creditors and the A/R Facility Lender each agree to hold (or cause to be held) all Control Collateral in their respective possession, custody or control, including "control" within the meaning of Section 9-104 of the UCC (or in the possession, custody or control of agents, bailees or other similar third parties) as a non-fiduciary agent for the other solely for the purpose of perfecting the security interest granted to each in such Control Collateral subject to the terms and conditions of this Agreement (such bailment and agency being intended, among other things, to satisfy the requirements of Section 8-301(a)(2), 9-313(c), 9-104, 9-105, 9-106 and 9-107 of the UCC). None of the LS Facility Claimholders nor the A/R Facility Claimholders, as applicable, shall have any obligation whatsoever to the others to assure that the Control Collateral is genuine or owned by any Obligor or any other Person or to preserve their respective rights or benefits or those of any other Person. The duties or responsibilities of the LS Facility Creditors and the A/R Facility Lender under this Section 2.5 are and shall be limited solely to holding or maintaining control of the Control Collateral as a non-fiduciary agent for the other for purposes of perfecting the Lien held by the LS Facility Creditors or the A/R Facility Lender, as applicable. The LS Facility Creditors are not, and the LS Facility Creditors shall not be deemed to be, fiduciaries of any kind for the A/R Facility Lender or any other Person. The A/R Facility Lender is not, and the A/R Facility Lender shall not be deemed to be, a fiduciary of any kind for the LS Facility Creditors or any other Person. Upon the Discharge of the LS Facility Obligations, the LS Facility Creditors shall, at the expense of Obligors, deliver the remaining Control Collateral (if any) held by them together with any necessary endorsements or assignments, first, to EWB to the extent A/R Facility Obligations remain outstanding as confirmed in writing by the A/R Facility Lender and, second, to the extent that the A/R Facility Lender confirms no A/R Facility Obligations are outstanding, to DDH (in each case, so as to allow such Person to obtain possession or control of such Control Collateral). Upon the Discharge of the A/R Facility Obligations, the A/R Facility Lender shall, at the expense of Obligors, but subject to the terms of any A/R Lender Account Control Agreement, deliver the remaining Control Collateral (if any) held by it together with any necessary endorsements or assignments, first, to the LS Facility Agent to the extent LS Facility Obligations remain outstanding as confirmed in writing by the LS Facility Agent and, second, to the extent that the LS Facility Agent confirms no LS Facility Obligations are outstanding, to DDH (in each case, so as to allow such Person to obtain possession or control of such Control Collateral).

 

  13 Intercreditor Agreement

 

 

Section 2.6     Insurance. Until the Discharge of the LS Facility Obligations occurs, (a) the LS Facility Creditors and the other LS Facility Claimholders shall have the sole and exclusive right, subject to the rights of the Obligors under the LS Facility Documents, to adjust and settle any claim under any insurance policy of any Obligor (including without limitation, any policy covering the Collateral and busines interruption insurance) in the event of any loss thereunder and to approve any award granted in any condemnation or similar proceeding (or any deed in lieu of condemnation) affecting the Collateral and (b) all Proceeds of any such insurance policy and any such award (or any payments with respect to a deed in lieu of condemnation) shall be paid, subject to the rights of the Obligors under the LS Facility Documents, first in accordance with the priorities set forth in Section 8.3 (Application of Proceeds) below, until paid in full in cash, and second, to the owner of the subject property, as such other Person as may be entitled thereto or as a court of competent jurisdiction may otherwise direct. If any A/R Facility Claimholder shall, at any time, receive any Proceeds of any such insurance policy or any such award or payment in contravention of this Section 2.6, it shall pay such Proceeds over to the LS Facility Creditors in accordance with the terms of Section 8.3 (Application of Proceeds) below.

 

Article 3
Exercise of Remedies

 

Section 3.1     Claim Standstill.

 

(a)            At no time prior to the Discharge of the LS Facility Obligations shall any A/R Facility Claimholder take any Collection Action with respect to any of the A/R Facility Obligations, other than declaration of an Event of Default thereunder, (ii) acceleration of the A/R Facility Loans in accordance with the terms of the A/R Facility Documents, (iii) subject to Section 7.5 hereof, Collection Action consisting of a foreclosure upon, or Disposition of, A/R Facility Receivables Collateral, or (iv) any suit or action taken solely to prevent the running of the statute of limitations; provided that any judgment or judgment lien obtained in connection with such suit or action is subject to Section 3.6 hereof.

 

(b)            At no time prior to the Discharge of the A/R Facility Obligations shall any LS Facility Claimholder Exercise any Secured Creditor Remedies consisting of a foreclosure upon, or Disposition of, A/R Facility Receivables Collateral, other than pursuant to Section 3.3 (Exclusive Enforcement Rights).

 

Section 3.2     Collateral Standstill.

 

(a)            For the period from and after the date hereof and continuing until the Discharge of the LS Obligations, whether or not any Insolvency Proceeding has been commenced by or against any Obligor or any of its Subsidiaries, no A/R Facility Claimholder shall:

 
(i) exercise or seek to exercise any right or remedies with respect to any Collateral (including any Exercise of Secured Creditor Remedies and any Collection Action) except as set forth in Section 3.1(a) above;

 

  14 Intercreditor Agreement

 

 

(ii) contest, protest or object to any Exercise of Secured Creditor Remedies by any LS Facility Claimholder, and no A/R Facility Claimholder shall have any right to direct any Exercise of Secured Creditor Remedies or other action by any LS Facility Claimholder or

 

(iii) object to (and waive any and all claims with respect to) the forbearance by any LS Facility Claimholder from the Exercise of Secured Creditor Remedies.

 

(b)            Notwithstanding the foregoing, it is understood that this Section 3.2 shall not prevent the following:

 

(i) in any Insolvency Proceeding commenced by or against any Obligor, the A/R Facility Claimholders may file a proof of claim or statement of interest with respect to the Collateral;

 

(ii) the A/R Facility Claimholders may take any action (solely to the extent not adverse to the prior Liens securing the LS Facility Obligations or the rights of the LS Facility Agent or the LS Facility Creditors to exercise remedies in respect thereof) in order to preserve, perfect or protect (but not enforce) the first priority Lien in the A/R Facility Receivables Collateral or the second priority Lien in the remaining Collateral;

 

(iii) the A/R Facility Claimholders shall be entitled to file any necessary responsive or defensive pleadings in opposition to any motion, claim, adversary proceeding or other pleading made by any Person objecting to or otherwise seeking the disallowance of the claims of the A/R Facility Lender, if any, in each case in accordance with the terms of this Agreement;

 

(iv) the A/R Facility Claimholders shall be entitled to file any pleadings, objections, motions or agreements which assert rights or interests available to unsecured creditors of the Obligors arising under either any bankruptcy, insolvency or similar law or applicable non-bankruptcy law, in each case in accordance with, and not in contravention of, the terms of this Agreement;

 

(v) the A/R Facility Claimholders shall be entitled to exercise any of its rights or remedies with respect to any of the A/R Facility Receivables Collateral to the extent permitted in Section 3.1(a)(iii); and

 

(vi) the A/R Facility Lender and the other A/R Facility Claimholders may make a bid on all, or any portion of, the Collateral in any bankruptcy or non-bankruptcy auction or foreclosure proceeding or action; provided that, the cash portion of any such bid is sufficient for the LS Facility Obligations to be Paid in Full upon consummation of the closing of the applicable sale.

 

  15 Intercreditor Agreement

 

 

Section 3.3     Exclusive Enforcement Rights. Subject to the rights of A/R Facility Claimholder with respect to A/R Facility Receivables Collateral provided in Section 3.1(a) above (subject to Section 7.5 hereof), until the Discharge of the LS Facility Obligations, whether or not any Insolvency Proceeding has been commenced by or against any Obligor or any of its Subsidiaries, the LS Facility Claimholders shall have the exclusive right to enforce rights as a secured creditor, Exercise any Secured Creditor Remedies and make determinations regarding the disposition of, or restrictions with respect to, the Collateral without any consultation with or the consent of any A/R Facility Claimholder; provided, that the A/R Facility Lender shall be entitled to application of funds in accordance with Article 8 hereof. The LS Facility Claimholders shall have the right to enforce the provisions of the LS Facility Documents and exercise remedies thereunder, all in such order and in such manner as they may determine in the exercise of their sole discretion and subject to the terms hereof. Such exercise and enforcement shall include the rights of an agent appointed by them to sell or otherwise Dispose of Collateral, to incur expenses in connection with such Disposition and to exercise all the rights and remedies of a secured creditor under the laws of any applicable jurisdiction, including the right to Exercise any Secured Creditor Remedies. The LS Facility Claimholders shall be entitled to file any necessary responsive or defensive pleadings in opposition to any motion, claim, adversary proceeding or other pleading made by any Person objecting to or otherwise seeking the disallowance of the claims of the LS Facility Creditors, if any, in each case in accordance with the terms of this Agreement. The LS Facility Claimholders shall be entitled to file any pleadings, objections, motions or agreements which assert rights or interests available to unsecured creditors of the Obligors arising under either any bankruptcy, insolvency or similar law or applicable non-bankruptcy law, in each case in accordance with the terms of this Agreement. In addition, notwithstanding anything in this Agreement to the contrary, until the Discharge of the LS Facility Obligations, the LS Facility Claimholders shall have the exclusive right to enforce rights as a secured creditor or Exercise any Secured Creditor Remedies with respect to any Collateral consisting of Equity Interests of any of the Obligors.

 

Section 3.4     Collateral or Proceeds Received from the Exercise of Secured Creditor Remedies. Each LS Facility Claimholder and each A/R Facility Claimholder agrees that until the Discharge of the LS Facility Obligations has occurred or Discharge of the A/R Facility Obligations has occurred, any Collateral or Proceeds thereof received by the LS Facility Claimholders and the A/R Facility Claimholders will be subject to Article 8 (Payments Held In Trust; Turnover; Application of Proceeds) below.

 

Section 3.5     No Hindrance.

 

(a)            Until the Discharge of the LS Facility Obligations, each A/R Facility Claimholder hereby:

 

(i) agrees that the A/R Facility Lender and the other A/R Facility Claimholders will not take any action that would restrain, hinder, limit, delay or otherwise interfere with the Exercise of Secured Creditor Remedies or any exercise of remedies pursuant to the LS Facility Documents by the LS Facility Creditors or any other LS Facility Claimholder, or any action that is otherwise prohibited hereunder;

 

(ii) waives any and all rights the A/R Facility Lender or any other A/R Facility Claimholder may have as a junior Lien creditor or otherwise to object to the manner in which the LS Facility Creditors or any of the other LS Facility Claimholders seek to enforce or collect the LS Facility Obligations or the Liens securing the LS Facility Obligations granted in any of the Collateral undertaken in good faith in accordance with this Agreement, regardless of whether any action or failure to act by or on behalf of the LS Facility Creditors or any other LS Facility Claimholder is adverse to the interest of the A/R Facility Lender or any other A/R Facility Claimholder and

 

  16 Intercreditor Agreement

 

 

(iii) acknowledges and agrees that no covenant, agreement or restriction contained in the A/R Facility Documents (other than this Agreement) shall be deemed to restrict in any way the rights and remedies of the LS Facility Creditors or the other LS Facility Claimholders, with respect to the Collateral as set forth in this Agreement and the LS Facility Documents; provided, however, that the foregoing part of this Section 3.5 shall not be construed to prohibit any action that, on or after the Discharge of the LS Facility Obligations, is expressly authorized by any other provision of this Agreement.

 

(b)            Until the Discharge of the A/R Facility Obligations, and subject to Section 7.5 hereof, each LS Facility Claimholder hereby:

 

(i) agrees that the LS Facility Agent and the other LS Facility Claimholders will not take any action that would restrain, hinder, limit, delay or otherwise interfere with the Exercise of Secured Creditor Remedies or any exercise of remedies with respect to the A/R Facility Receivables Collateral pursuant to the A/R Facility Documents by the A/R Facility Lender or any other A/R Facility Claimholder, or take any action that is otherwise prohibited hereunder;

 

(ii) waives any and all rights the LS Facility Agent or any other LS Facility Claimholder may have as a junior Lien creditor to object to the manner in which the A/R Facility Lender or any of the other A/R Facility Claimholders seek to enforce or collect the A/R Facility Obligations or the Liens on A/R Facility Receivables Collateral securing the A/R Facility Obligations undertaken in good faith in accordance with this Agreement, regardless of whether any action or failure to act by or on behalf of the A/R Facility Lender or any other A/R Facility Claimholder is adverse to the interest of the LS Facility Agent or any other LS Facility Claimholder; and

 

(iii) acknowledges and agrees that no covenant, agreement or restriction contained in the LS Facility Documents (other than this Agreement or as set forth in this Agreement) shall be deemed to restrict in any way the rights and remedies of the A/R Facility Lender or the other A/R Facility Claimholders, with respect to the Collateral as set forth in this Agreement and the A/R Facility Documents; provided, however, that the foregoing part of this Section 3.5 shall not be construed to prohibit any action that, on or after the Discharge of the A/R Facility Obligations, is expressly authorized by any other provision of this Agreement.

 

Section 3.6     Judgment Liens. In the event that, prior to the Discharge of the LS Facility Obligations, any A/R Facility Claimholder becomes a judgment Lien creditor in respect of Collateral as a result of its enforcement of its rights as an unsecured creditor to the extent permitted herein, with respect to the A/R Facility Obligations, such judgment Lien shall be subject to the terms of this Agreement for all purposes (including in relation to the LS Facility Obligations) as the other Liens securing the A/R Facility Obligations are subject to this Agreement. In the event that, prior to the Discharge of the A/R Facility Obligations, any LS Facility Claimholder becomes a judgment Lien creditor in respect of Collateral as a result of its enforcement of its rights as an unsecured creditor to the extent permitted herein, with respect to the LS Facility Obligations, such judgment Lien shall be subject to the terms of this Agreement for all purposes (including in relation to the A/R Facility Obligations) as the other Liens securing the LS Facility Obligations are subject to this Agreement.

 

  17 Intercreditor Agreement

 

 

Article 4
Insolvency Proceedings

 

Section 4.1     Enforceability and Continuing Priority. This Agreement shall be applicable both before and after the commencement of any Insolvency Proceeding and all converted or succeeding cases in respect thereof. The relative rights of the LS Facility Claimholders and the A/R Facility Claimholders in or to any Distributions shall continue after the commencement of any Insolvency Proceeding. Accordingly, the provisions of this Agreement are intended to be and shall be enforceable as a subordination agreement within the meaning of Section 510 of the Bankruptcy Code.

 

Section 4.2     Financing.

 

(a)            Until the Discharge of the LS Facility Obligations occurs, if any Obligor shall be subject to any Insolvency Proceeding and the LS Facility Creditors consent to the use of cash collateral (as such term is defined in Section 363(a) of the Bankruptcy Code; herein, "Cash Collateral") related to the proceeds, products, or profits of the Collateral (except the A/R Facility Receivables Collateral), each A/R Facility Claimholder hereby agrees that it will (a) consent, and will be deemed to have consented, to the use of such Cash Collateral, (b) raise no objection to, nor support any other Person objecting to, the use of such Cash Collateral, (c) not request or accept adequate protection or any other relief in connection with the use of such Cash Collateral, except as set forth in Section 4.5 (Adequate Protection) below; (d) be deemed to have subordinated hereunder the Liens securing A/R Facility Obligations to (i)  any adequate protection provided to the LS Facility Claimholders and (ii) any "carve-out" agreed to by the LS Facility Creditors or the other LS Facility Claimholders and (e) agree, and will be deemed to have agreed, that notice received one calendar day prior to the entry of an order approving such usage of the Cash Collateral shall be adequate notice.

 

(b)            Until the Discharge of the A/R Facility Obligations occurs, if any Obligor shall be subject to any Insolvency Proceeding and the A/R Facility Lender consents to the use of Cash Collateral related to the proceeds, products, or profits of the A/R Facility Receivables Collateral, each LS Facility Claimholder agrees that it will (a) consent, and will be deemed to have consented, to the use of such Cash Collateral, (b) raise no objection to, nor support any other Person objecting to, the use of such Cash Collateral, (c) not request or accept adequate protection or any other relief in connection with the use of such Cash Collateral, except as set forth in Section 4.5 (Adequate Protection) below; (d) be deemed to have subordinated hereunder the Liens on the A/R Facility Receivables Collateral securing LS Facility Obligations to (i)  any adequate protection provided to the A/R Facility Claimholders and (ii) any "carve-out" agreed to by the A/R Facility Lender or the other A/R Facility Claimholders and (e) agree, and will be deemed to have agreed, that notice received one calendar day prior to the entry of an order approving such usage of the Cash Collateral shall be adequate notice.

 

  18 Intercreditor Agreement

 

 

(c)            Until the Discharge of the LS Facility Obligations occurs, if any Obligor shall be subject to any Insolvency Proceeding and the LS Facility Creditors consent to any financing provided by any one or more LS Facility Claimholders or any other Person under Section 364 of the Bankruptcy Code or any similar Insolvency Law that is secured by a Lien against the Collateral (such financing, a "DIP Financing"), each A/R Facility Claimholder agrees that it will (a) consent, and will be deemed to have consented, to such DIP Financing; (b) raise no objection to, nor support any other Person objecting to, such DIP Financing; (c) not request or accept adequate protection or any other relief in connection with such DIP Financing, except as set forth in Section 4.5 (Adequate Protection) below; (d) be deemed to have subordinated hereunder the Liens securing the A/R Facility Obligations on Collateral other than the A/R Facility Receivables Collateral to (i) such DIP Financing, (ii) any adequate protection provided to the LS Facility Claimholders and (iii) any "carve-out" agreed to by the LS Facility Creditors or the other LS Facility Claimholders, in the case of each of clauses (i), (ii) and (iii) above so long as the A/R Facility Claimholders retain their Lien on the A/R Facility Receivables to secure the A/R Facility Obligations with the same priority as existed prior to the occurrence of the Insolvency Proceeding, and (e) agree, and will be deemed to have agreed, that notice received one calendar day prior to the entry of an order approving such DIP Financing shall be adequate notice.

 

Section 4.3     Sales. Until the Discharge of the LS Facility Obligations has occurred, each A/R Facility Claimholder agrees that it will consent to the Disposition of, and will not object to or oppose a motion or plan to Dispose of, any Collateral (other than A/R Facility Receivables Collateral) free and clear of the Liens or other claims in favor of the A/R Facility Lender or any other A/R Facility Claimholder under Section 363 or 1129 of the Bankruptcy Code, if the requisite LS Facility Claimholders or LS Facility Creditors, on behalf of the requisite LS Facility Claimholders, have consented to such Disposition; provided that all Proceeds of such Disposition are applied in accordance with Section 8.4 hereof. Subject to Section 7.5, until the Discharge of the A/R Facility Obligations has occurred, each LS Facility Creditor agrees that it will consent to the Disposition of, and will not object to or oppose a motion or plan to Dispose of, any A/R Facility Receivables Collateral free and clear of the Liens or other claims in favor of the LS Facility Creditors or any other LS Facility Claimholder under Section 363 or 1129 of the Bankruptcy Code, if the A/R Facility Lender on behalf of the requisite A/R Facility Claimholders has consented to such Disposition; provided that all Proceeds of such Disposition are applied in accordance with Section 8.4 hereof.

 

Section 4.4     Relief from Automatic Stay.

 

(a)            Until the Discharge of the LS Facility Obligations occurs, each A/R Facility Claimholder agrees that it shall not (i) seek (or support any other Person seeking) relief from the automatic stay or any other stay in any Insolvency Proceeding or take any action in derogation thereof, in each case, in respect of the Collateral (other than the A/R Facility Receivables Collateral subject to Section 7.5 hereof), without the prior written consent of the LS Facility Creditors on behalf of the requisite LS Facility Claimholders, or (ii) oppose or take any other action in derogation of any request by the LS Facility Creditors or any other LS Facility Claimholder for relief from the automatic stay or any other stay in any Insolvency Proceeding in respect of the Collateral.

 

  19 Intercreditor Agreement

 

 

(b)            Until the Discharge of the A/R Facility Obligations occurs, each LS Facility Claimholder agrees that it shall not (i) seek (or support any other Person seeking) relief from the automatic stay or any other stay in any Insolvency Proceeding or take any action in derogation thereof, in each case, in respect of the A/R Facility Receivables Collateral, without the prior written consent of the A/R Facility Lender on behalf of the requisite A/R Facility Claimholders, or (ii) oppose or take any other action in derogation of any request by the A/R Facility Lender or any other A/R Facility Claimholder for relief from the automatic stay or any other stay in any Insolvency Proceeding in respect of the Collateral.

 

Section 4.5     Adequate Protection; Post-Petition Accrual.

 

(a)            Granting of Adequate Protection. In any Insolvency Proceeding involving an Obligor, each A/R Facility Claimholder and LS Facility Claimholder agree as follows:

 

(i) no A/R Facility Claimholder shall contest or object (or support any other Person contesting or objecting) to any request by the LS Facility Creditors or any of the other LS Facility Claimholders for adequate protection (whether in the form of Distributions, Liens, priority administrative expense claims or otherwise) or any adequate protection provided to the LS Facility Creditors or any of the other LS Facility Claimholders;

 

(ii) no LS Facility Claimholder shall contest or object (or support any other Person contesting or objecting) to any request by the A/R Facility Lender or any of the other A/R Facility Claimholders for adequate protection (whether in the form of Distributions, Liens, priority administrative expense claims or otherwise) or any adequate protection provided to the A/R Facility Lender or any of the other A/R Facility Claimholders;

 

(iii) no A/R Facility Claimholder shall contest or object to (or support any other Person contesting or objecting) any objection by the LS Facility Creditors or any of the other LS Facility Claimholders to any motion, relief, action or proceeding based on a claim of lack of adequate protection (whether in the form of payments, Liens, a priority administrative expense claim or otherwise);

 

(iv) no LS Facility Claimholder shall contest or object (or support any other Person contesting or objecting) to any objection (except to the extent such objection is in contravention of Section 4.2(c) hereof), by the A/R Facility Lender or any of the other A/R Facility Claimholders to any motion, relief, action or proceeding based on a claim of lack of adequate protection (whether in the form of payments, Liens, a priority administrative expense claim or otherwise); and

 

(v) none of the A/R Facility Lender, any other A/R Facility Claimholder, the LS Facility Creditors, or any other LS Facility Claimholders shall object to the payment of interest, fees, expenses or other amounts to the A/R Facility Lender, any other A/R Facility Claimholder, the LS Facility Creditors, or any other LS Facility Claimholders under Section 506(b) of the Bankruptcy Code or otherwise.

 

  20 Intercreditor Agreement

 

 

(b)            Allowance of Post-Petition Accrual. Neither the A/R Facility Lender nor any other A/R Facility Claimholder shall object to, oppose or challenge any claim by any LS Facility Claimholder for allowance in any Insolvency Proceeding of LS Facility Obligations consisting of post-petition interest, premiums, fees or expenses. Neither the LS Facility Creditors nor any other LS Facility Claimholder shall object to, oppose or challenge any claim by any A/R Facility Claimholder for allowance in any Insolvency Proceeding of A/R Facility Obligations consisting of post-petition interest, premiums, fees or expenses.

 

Section 4.6     Section 1111(b) of the Bankruptcy Code. None of the A/R Facility Claimholders shall object to, oppose, support any objection or take any other action to impede the right of any LS Facility Claimholder to make an election under Section 1111(b)(2) of the Bankruptcy Code. Each A/R Facility Claimholder waives any claim it may hereafter have against any LS Facility Claimholder arising out of the election by any LS Facility Claimholder of the application of Section 1111(b)(2) of the Bankruptcy Code. Until the Discharge of the LS Facility Obligations has occurred, each A/R Facility Claimholder waives any right it may have to make an election under Section 1111(b)(2) of the Bankruptcy Code.

 

Section 4.7     No Waiver. Nothing contained herein shall prohibit or in any way limit any LS Facility Claimholder from objecting in any Insolvency Proceeding involving an Obligor to any action taken by the A/R Facility Lender or any of the other A/R Facility Claimholders which is inconsistent with the terms of this Agreement, including, if it is inconsistent with the terms of this Agreement, the seeking by any A/R Facility Claimholder of adequate protection or the assertion by any A/R Facility Claimholder of any of its rights and remedies under the A/R Facility Documents. Nothing contained herein shall prohibit or in any way limit any A/R Facility Claimholder from objecting in any Insolvency Proceeding involving an Obligor to any action taken by the LS Facility Agent or any of the other LS Facility Claimholders which is inconsistent with the terms of this Agreement, including, if it is inconsistent with the terms of this Agreement, the seeking by any LS Facility Claimholder of adequate protection or the assertion by any LS Facility Claimholder of any of its rights and remedies under the LS Facility Documents.

 

Section 4.8     Avoidance Issues. If any LS Facility Claimholder is required in any Insolvency Proceeding or otherwise to turn over, disgorge or otherwise pay to the estate of any Obligor any amount paid in respect of the LS Facility Obligations (a "LS Recovery"), then such LS Facility Claimholder shall be entitled to a reinstatement of LS Facility Obligations with respect to all such recovered amounts, and all rights, interests, priorities and privileges recognized in this Agreement shall apply with respect to any such LS Recovery. If this Agreement shall have been terminated prior to such LS Recovery, this Agreement shall be reinstated in full force and effect, and such prior termination shall not diminish, release, discharge, impair or otherwise affect the obligations of the Parties from such date of reinstatement. If any A/R Facility Claimholder is required in any Insolvency Proceeding or otherwise to turn over, disgorge or otherwise pay to the estate of any Obligor any amount paid in respect of the A/R Facility Obligations (an "A/R Facility Recovery"), then such A/R Facility Claimholder shall be entitled to a reinstatement of A/R Facility Obligations with respect to all such recovered amounts, and all rights, interests, priorities and privileges recognized in this Agreement shall apply with respect to any such A/R Facility Recovery. If this Agreement shall have been terminated prior to such A/R Facility Recovery, this Agreement shall be reinstated in full force and effect, and such prior termination shall not diminish, release, discharge, impair or otherwise affect the obligations of the Parties from such date of reinstatement.

 

  21 Intercreditor Agreement

 

 

Section 4.9     Prohibition of Payments of A/R Facility Obligations on Acceleration or in Insolvency Proceeding.

 

(a)            Upon (i) the acceleration of the A/R Facility Obligations, or any portion thereof, which has not been rescinded or revoked, or (ii) any payment or distribution of assets of any Obligor, of any kind or character, whether in cash, property or securities, following the commencement of an Insolvency Proceeding or an Exercise of Remedies by any A/R Facility Claimholder or LS Facility Claimholder, neither the A/R Facility Lender nor any other A/R Facility Claimholder shall be entitled to any Distribution (other than any payment pursuant to Section 4.5 hereof or any A/R Facility Permitted Payment pursuant to Article 8 hereof) on account of any of the A/R Facility Obligations prior to the Discharge of the LS Facility Obligations, and following the commencement of an Insolvency Proceeding or an Exercise of Remedies by any LS Claimholder or A/R Facility Claimholder, any Distribution (other than any payment pursuant to Section 4.5 hereof or any A/R Facility Permitted Payment pursuant to Article 8 hereof) in respect of the A/R Facility Obligations to which a A/R Facility Claimholder would be entitled, except for the provisions hereof, shall be paid by any Obligor or any other Person making such Distribution, or by a A/R Facility Claimholder if received by it, directly to the LS Facility Creditors, to the extent necessary to result in the Discharge of the LS Facility Obligations, before any Distribution on account of any A/R Facility Obligation is made to the A/R Facility Lender or any other A/R Facility Claimholder. For the avoidance of doubt, each A/R Facility Claimholder may receive and retain any A/R Facility Permitted Payment made pursuant to Article 8 hereof in payment of any A/R Facility Obligations.

 

(b)            Except as otherwise expressly provided elsewhere in this Agreement, in any Insolvency Proceeding by or against any Obligor:

 

(i) the LS Facility Creditors may, and are hereby irrevocably authorized and empowered (in their own name or in the name of the A/R Facility Claimholders or otherwise), but shall have no obligation to (A) demand, sue for, collect and receive every payment or distribution referred to in this Article 4 and give acquittance therefor and (B) file claims and proofs of claim in respect of the A/R Facility Obligations; provided that the LS Facility Creditors may only file claims and proofs of claims in respect of the A/R Facility Obligations if (1) the A/R Facility Claimholders have failed to file such claims and proofs of claim and (2) there shall remain not more than 10 days before such action is barred, prohibited or otherwise cannot be taken and

 

(ii) the A/R Facility Lender and each other A/R Facility Claimholder will duly and promptly take such action, at the expense of DDH, as the LS Facility Creditors may request (A) to collect the A/R Facility Obligations for the account of the LS Facility Claimholders and to file appropriate claims or proofs of claim with respect thereto; (B) to execute and deliver to the LS Facility Creditors such powers of attorney, assignments or other instruments as the LS Facility Creditors may request in order to enable it to enforce any and all claims with respect to, and any security interests and other Liens securing payment of, the A/R Facility Obligations and (C) to collect and receive for the account of the LS Facility Claimholders any and all Distributions which may be payable or deliverable upon or with respect to the A/R Facility Obligations, until there has been a Discharge of the LS Facility Obligations.

 

  22 Intercreditor Agreement

 

 

Article 5
Waivers by Claimholders

 

Section 5.1     LS Facility Obligations; A/R Facility Obligations.

 

(a)            The A/R Facility Lender and each other A/R Facility Claimholder consent to the terms and conditions of the LS Facility Documents and waive any breach arising in connection with the entry into the LS Facility Documents and release each of the LS Facility Creditors and LS Facility Claimholders from any and all claims arising in connection with the entry into the LS Facility Documents and any actions or inaction of the LS Facility Creditors or the LS Facility Claimholders thereunder.

 

(b)            Each LS Facility Creditor and LS Facility Claimholder acknowledges the terms and conditions of the A/R Facility Documents and waives any breach arising in connection with the entry into, or existence of, the A/R Facility Documents and releases each of the A/R Facility Lender and any other A/R Facility Claimholders from any and all claims arising in connection with the entry into, or the existence of, the A/R Facility Documents and any actions or inaction of the A/R Facility Lender or the A/R Facility Claimholders thereunder.

 

(c)            All LS Facility Obligations at any time incurred by any Obligor shall be deemed to have been incurred, and all LS Facility Obligations held by any LS Facility Claimholder shall be deemed to have been extended, acquired or obtained, as applicable, in reliance upon this Agreement, and each A/R Facility Claimholder hereby waives (i) notice of acceptance, or proof of reliance, by any of the LS Facility Claimholders of this Agreement and (ii) notice of the existence, renewal, extension, accrual, creation or non-payment of all or any part of the LS Facility Obligations. All A/R Facility Obligations at any time incurred by any Obligor shall be deemed to have been incurred, and all A/R Facility Obligations held by any A/R Facility Claimholder shall be deemed to have been extended, acquired or obtained, as applicable, in reliance upon this Agreement, and each LS Facility Claimholder hereby waives (i) notice of acceptance, or proof of reliance, by any of the A/R Facility Claimholders of this Agreement and (ii) notice of the existence, renewal, extension, accrual, creation or non-payment of all or any part of the A/R Facility Obligations. Nothing contained in this Agreement shall preclude any of the LS Facility Claimholders or the A/R Facility Claimholders from discontinuing the extension of credit to any Obligor (whether under the LS Facility Documents, the A/R Facility Documents or otherwise) or from taking (without notice to any A/R Facility Claimholder, LS Facility Claimholder, any Obligor or any other Person) any other action in respect of the LS Facility Obligations, the A/R Facility Obligations or the Collateral which is not prohibited hereunder or in contravention of the terms hereof and which the LS Facility Claimholders or A/R Facility Claimholders, respectively, would otherwise be entitled to take with respect to such Obligations or the Collateral.

 

  23 Intercreditor Agreement

 

 

(d)            None of the LS Facility Claimholders, the A/R Facility Claimholders, or any of their respective affiliates, directors, officers, employees or agents shall be liable for failure to demand, collect or realize upon any of the Collateral or any Proceeds or for any delay in doing so or shall be under any obligation to sell or otherwise Dispose of any Collateral or Proceeds thereof or to take any other action whatsoever with regard to the Collateral or any part or Proceeds thereof. If any LS Facility Claimholder or A/R facility Claimholder honors (or fails to honor) a request by a Obligor for an extension of credit pursuant to any of the applicable Facility Documents, whether any such Claimholder has knowledge that the honoring of (or failure to honor) any such request would constitute a default under the terms of the its respective Facility Documents or an act, condition or event that, with the giving of notice or the passage of time, or both, would constitute such a default, or if such Claimholder otherwise should exercise any of its contractual rights or remedies under its respective Facility Documents (subject to the express terms and conditions hereof), no LS Facility Claimholder shall have any liability whatsoever to any A/R Facility Claimholder and no A/R Facility Claimholder shall have any liability whatsoever to any LS Facility Claimholder, as a result of such action, omission or exercise. Each Claimholder will be entitled to manage and supervise its loans and extensions of credit under the applicable Facility Documents as such Claimholder may, in its sole discretion, deem appropriate, and each Claimholder may manage such loans and extensions of credit without regard to any rights or interests that any other Claimholder may have in the Collateral or otherwise except as otherwise expressly set forth in this Agreement. Each Claimholder agrees that no other Claimholder shall incur any liability as a result of a sale, lease, license, application or other Disposition of all or any portion of the Collateral or any part or Proceeds thereof, except to the extent that such Disposition is in direct violation of the provisions of this Agreement. Any Claimholder may, from time to time, enter into agreements and settlements with Obligors as it may determine in its sole discretion without impairing any of the subordinations, priorities, rights or obligations of the parties under this Agreement, including substituting Collateral, releasing any Lien and releasing any Obligor. Each Claimholder waives any and all rights it may have to require any other Claimholder to marshal assets, to exercise rights or remedies in a particular manner or to forbear from exercising such rights and remedies in any particular manner or order.

 

Section 5.2     Notice of Acceptance and Other Waivers. To the fullest extent permitted by applicable law, each Claimholder hereby waives (a) notice of acceptance hereof; (b) notice of any loans or other financial accommodations made or extended under any of the LS Facility Documents or A/R Facility Documents, or the creation or existence of any LS Facility Obligations or A/R Facility Obligations; (c) notice of the amount of the A/R Facility Obligations and the LS Facility Obligations; (d) notice of any adverse change in the financial condition of any Obligor or of any other fact that might increase the A/R Facility Lender's, the LS Facility Agent’s or any other Claimholder's risk hereunder; (e) notice of presentment for payment, demand, protest and notice thereof as to any instrument among the LS Facility Documents or the A/R Facility Documents; (f) notice of any Default or Event of Default under the A/R Facility Documents or the LS Facility Documents or otherwise relating to the Obligations created thereunder (other than any notice that may be required by the express terms of this Agreement) and (g) all other notices (except if such notice is specifically required to be given to the A/R Facility Lender or the LS Facility Agent under this Agreement) and demands to which the A/R Facility Lender, the LS Facility Agent or any other Claimholder might otherwise be entitled.

 

Section 5.3     Lawsuits; Defenses; Setoff. To the fullest extent permitted by applicable law, each Claimholder, (a) waives the right by statute or otherwise to require any other Claimholder to institute suit against any Obligor or to exhaust any rights and remedies which any such Claimholder has or may have against any Obligor; (b) waives any defense arising by reason of any disability or other defense (other than the defense that the Discharge of the LS Facility Obligations or Discharge of the A/R Facility Obligations has occurred (subject to the provisions of Section 4.8 (Avoidance Issues) above)) of any Obligor or by reason of the cessation from any cause whatsoever of the liability of such Obligor in respect thereof; (c) waives any right to assert against any other Claimholder any defense (legal or equitable), set-off, counterclaim or claim which the A/R Facility Lender, the LS Facility Agent or any Claimholder may now or at any time hereafter have against any Obligor or any other party liable to LS Facility Creditors, any other LS Facility Claimholder, the A/R Facility Lender or any other A/R Facility Claimholder; (d) waives any defense, set-off, counterclaim or claim, of any kind or nature, arising directly or indirectly from the present or future lack of perfection, sufficiency, validity or enforceability of any LS Facility Obligations, any A/R Facility Obligations or any security for either and (e) waives any defense arising by reason of any claim or defense based upon an election of remedies by any Claimholder.

 

  24 Intercreditor Agreement

 

 

Section 5.4     Subrogation. Solely after the Discharge of the LS Facility Obligations shall have occurred, the A/R Facility Lender and the other A/R Facility Claimholders shall be subrogated to the rights of the LS Facility Claimholders to the extent that Distributions otherwise payable to the A/R Facility Claimholders have been applied to the payment of the LS Facility Obligations in accordance with the provisions of this Agreement. Solely after the Discharge of the A/R Facility Obligations shall have occurred, the LS Facility Agent and the other LS Facility Claimholders shall be subrogated to the rights of the A/R Facility Claimholders to the extent that Distributions otherwise payable to the LS Facility Claimholders have been applied to the payment of the A/R Facility Obligations in accordance with the provisions of this Agreement. No Claimholder has, and no Claimholder shall have, any obligation or duty to protect any other Claimholder's rights of subrogation arising pursuant to this Agreement or under any applicable law, and no Claimholder is, and no Claimholder shall be, liable for any loss to, or impairment of, any subrogation rights held by any other Claimholder.

 

Article 6
Amendments; Refinancing

 

Section 6.1     Amendments. Each A/R Facility Claimholder agrees that, none of the A/R Facility Documents or any other document, instrument or agreement evidencing all or any part of the A/R Facility Obligations shall be amended, restated, supplemented, Refinanced or otherwise modified in any material respect (including, in particular and without limitation, the advance rate thereunder, the interest rate payable thereunder, the total facility amount or the committed portion thereof), and no new document, instrument or agreement may be entered into, in each case without the prior written consent of the LS Facility Agent.

 

Section 6.2     When Discharge of the LS Facility Obligations Deemed to Not Have Occurred. If any Obligor enters into any Refinancing of any LS Facility Obligations permitted under this Agreement, then (i) a Discharge of the LS Facility Obligations shall automatically be deemed not to have occurred for all purposes of this Agreement, (ii) the obligations under such Refinancing of such LS Facility Obligations shall automatically be treated as LS Facility Obligations for all purposes of this Agreement, including for purposes of the Lien priorities and rights in respect of Collateral set forth herein, (iii) the agent under the loan documents in respect of such Refinancing of such LS Facility Obligations shall be the LS Facility Creditors for all purposes of this Agreement and (iv) such new LS Facility Creditors shall agree in writing to be bound by the terms of this Agreement; provided, however, that the failure of such new LS Facility Creditors to agree in writing to be bound by this Agreement shall not constitute a material breach of this Agreement or impact the subordination effected hereby, and the terms of this Agreement shall continue to be binding upon each A/R Facility Claimholder.

 

  25 Intercreditor Agreement

 

 

Article 7
Purchase Option

 

Section 7.1     Option to Purchase A/R Facility Obligations. Without prejudice to the enforcement of remedies by the A/R Facility Claimholders to the extent permitted under this Agreement, any LS Claimholder (an "Eligible Purchaser") shall have the right to purchase by way of assignment and assumption (and shall thereby also assume all then existing lending commitments of the A/R Facility Claimholders under the A/R Facility Documents with respect to the A/R Facility Obligations), at any time during the exercise period described in Section 7.4 (Exercise Period) below, all, but not less than all, of the A/R Facility Priority Obligations, including all principal of and accrued and unpaid interest and fees (excluding any prepayment or acceleration penalties and premiums) in respect of all A/R Facility Priority Obligations outstanding at the time of purchase. Any purchase pursuant to this Article 7 shall be made on the terms set forth in Section 7.2 (Purchase Terms) below. For purposes hereof, “A/R Facility Priority Obligations” shall mean, as of any date of determination, with respect to the principal amount of A/R Facility Obligations (including all Letter of Credit Obligations in respect of Letters of Credit), an amount equal to the sum of (without duplication): (a) 110% of the Commitments (as defined in the A/R Facility Agreement) in effect on the date hereof less any permanent reductions of the Commitments (as defined in the A/R Facility Agreement) after the date hereof and prior to such date of calculation (excluding, to the extent not accompanied by a cash repayment of the principal amount of the A/R Facility Obligations, any permanent Commitment (as defined in the A/R Facility Agreement) reductions occurring (x) upon the commencement of an Insolvency Proceeding, (y) upon the occurrence of an Event of Default under the A/R Facility Documents and termination of the Commitments (as defined in the A/R Facility Agreement) as a result thereof, or (z) upon the final maturity of the A/R Facility Documents), plus (b) any obligations owing to A/R Facility Lender on account of Hedge Obligations (as defined in the A/R Facility Agreement) in an amount not to exceed $500,000, plus (c) any obligations owing to A/R Facility Lender on account of any cash management or treasury services agreements.

 

Section 7.2     Purchase Terms.

 

(a)            Purchase Price. For a purchase price (the "Purchase Price") equal to the sum of (i) in the case of all loans, advances or other similar extensions of credit that constitute A/R Facility Priority Obligations, 100.00% of the principal amount thereof (or with respect to outstanding Letters of Credit, Hedge Obligations and/or cash management or treasury services, cash collateral in an amount thereof which cash collateral shall be promptly returned to the Eligible Purchasers as such Letters of Credit are terminated, cancelled or returned to A/R Facility Lender or as such Hedge Obligations and cash management or treasury services are terminated, as applicable) and all accrued and unpaid interest (including default interest) thereon through the date of purchase (excluding any acceleration prepayment penalties or premiums) plus (ii) all other accrued and unpaid fees, expenses, indemnities (to the extent a claim has been made with respect thereto in writing by the applicable A/R Facility Claimholder) and other amounts owed to the A/R Facility Lender pursuant to the A/R Facility Documents through the date of purchase. To the extent that within thirty (30) days of payment of the Purchase Price by the applicable LS Facility Claimholders, the A/R Facility Obligations and LS Obligations are Paid in Full, the LS Claimholder shall pay any applicable prepayment penalty or premium that would have been owed to the selling A/R Facility Claimholders with respect to the A/R Facility Obligations sold to the LS Claimholders pursuant to this Article 7.

 

  26 Intercreditor Agreement

 

 

(b)            Payment, Etc. The Purchase Price described in Section 7.2(a) (Purchase Price) above shall be payable in cash (or cash collateral as applicable) on the date of purchase against transfer to the respective Eligible Purchaser or Eligible Purchasers (without recourse and without any representation or warranty whatsoever, except the representations and warranties: (i) that the transferor owns free and clear of all Liens and encumbrances and has the right to convey of the A/R Facility Obligations being sold and assigned by it and the assignment has been duly authorized and delivered, and (ii) with respect to the principal amount of the A/R Facility Obligations being purchased).

 

(c)            Documentation. Such purchase shall be made pursuant to customary assignment and assumption documentation in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to each of the parties thereto.

 

Section 7.3     Notice of Exercise.

 

(a)            The right to exercise the purchase option described in this Article 7 shall be exercisable and legally enforceable upon an Eligible Purchaser or Eligible Purchasers delivering written notice (a "Purchase Notice") to the A/R Facility Lender during the Exercise Period (as defined in Section 7.4 below).

 

(b)            The delivery of a Purchase Notice shall constitute an irrevocable and binding commitment of the applicable Eligible Purchaser, to and for the benefit of the A/R Facility Claimholders, to (i) purchase the A/R Facility Obligations and (ii) assume all of the obligations of the A/R Facility Claimholders under the A/R Facility Documents or otherwise relating to the A/R Facility Obligations and (iii) pay the Purchase Price, in each case on the date specified in the Purchase Notice.

 

Section 7.4     Exercise Period. The right to purchase the A/R Facility Obligations as described in this Article 7 may be exercised during the Exercise Period by delivery of a Purchase Notice. For purposes hereof, the “Exercise Period” shall mean each of the periods that (a) begins on the date occurring (i) fourteen (14) days after the occurrence of an Event of Default under Section 10.01(a) of the A/R Facility Agreement or under Section 10.1 of the LS Facility Agreement (if such Event of Default remains continuing at the end of such 14-day period), (ii) three Business Days after the first to occur of (A) the date of the acceleration by the A/R Facility Lender of the final maturity of the loans under the A/R Facility Agreement or the date of acceleration by the LS Facility Agent of the final maturity of the loans under the LS Facility Agreement, or (iii) five (5) Business Days after A/R Facility Lender ceases making loans and advances under the A/R Facility Agreement or terminates the commitments thereunder, or (iv) the occurrence of an Insolvency Proceeding with respect to any Obligor and (b) ends on the 60th day after the start of the applicable period described in the foregoing clause (a)‍(i), (a)‍(ii), (a)(iii) or (a)(iv) (such period, the “Exercise Period”).

 

Section 7.5     Standstill During Exercise Period . The A/R Facility Claimholders shall not Exercise any Secured Creditor Remedies pursuant to Sections 3.1(a)(iii), 3.5 or 4.3 or take any actions contemplated pursuant to Section 4.2 prior to the end of the Exercise Period or after the delivery of a Purchase Notice pursuant to Section 7.3.

 

  27 Intercreditor Agreement

 

 

Article 8
Payments Held In Trust; Turnover; Application of Proceeds

 

Section 8.1     Payments Held in Trust; Turnover. In the event that any A/R Facility Claimholder receives any Distribution (other than an A/R Facility Permitted Payment) prohibited at such time by this Agreement, such Distribution shall be held in trust for the benefit of and shall be paid over to or delivered to, as applicable, the LS Facility Creditors for the benefit of the LS Facility Claimholders no later than two Business Days after receipt. In the event that any LS Facility Claimholder receives any Distribution prohibited at such time by this Agreement, including any payment made from A/R Facility Receivables Collateral, such Distribution shall be held in trust for the benefit of and shall be paid over to or delivered to, as applicable, the A/R Facility Lender for the benefit of the A/R Facility Claimholders no later than two Business Days after receipt.

 

Section 8.2     Turnover.

 

(a)            Whether or not any Insolvency Proceeding has been commenced by or against any Obligor, any Collateral or Proceeds thereof (including assets or Proceeds subject to Liens referred to in Section 2.4 (New Liens) above), in each case, other than any A/R Facility Permitted Payment applied pursuant to Section 8.4 (Application of Proceeds) hereof, received by the A/R Facility Lender or any other A/R Facility Claimholder in violation hereof shall be segregated and held in trust and forthwith paid over to the LS Facility Agent for application pursuant to Section 8.4 (Application of Proceeds) for the benefit of the LS Facility Claimholders and A/R Facility Claimholders no later than two Business Days after receipt in the same form as received, with any necessary endorsements or as a court of competent jurisdiction may otherwise direct. The LS Facility Agent is hereby authorized to make any such endorsements as agent for any A/R Facility Claimholder. The authorization in this Section 8.2(b) is coupled with an interest and is irrevocable until the Discharge of the LS Facility Obligations.

 

(b)            Whether or not any Insolvency Proceeding has been commenced by or against any Obligor, any Collateral or Proceeds thereof (including assets or Proceeds subject to Liens referred to in Section 2.4 (New Liens) above), in each case, any payment made from A/R Facility Receivables Collateral received by the LS Facility Agent or any other LS Facility Claimholder in violation hereof shall be segregated and held in trust and forthwith paid over to the A/R Facility Lender for application pursuant to Section 8.4 (Application of Proceeds) for the benefit of the A/R Facility Claimholders no later than two Business Days after receipt in the same form as received, with any necessary endorsements or as a court of competent jurisdiction may otherwise direct. The A/R Facility Lender is hereby authorized to make any such endorsements as agent for any LS Facility Claimholder. The authorization in this Section 8.2(b) is coupled with an interest and is irrevocable until the Discharge of the A/R Facility Obligations.

 

  28 Intercreditor Agreement

 

 

Section 8.3     Account Control Agreements; Identification of Proceeds.

 

(a)            Any deposit account control agreement or securities account control agreement entered into by the A/R Facility Lender in respect of any deposit account or securities account constituting part of the Collateral (including without limitation any A/R Lender Account Control Agreement) shall be satisfactory in form and substance to the LS Facility Agent and shall (except with respect to the Term Loan Priority Accounts) provide exclusive control thereof to the A/R Facility Lender (or, following Discharge of the A/R Facility Obligations, the LS Facility Agent) upon a notice of exclusive control delivered following the occurrence of an Event of Default. Any deposit account control agreement or securities account control agreement entered into by the LS Facility Agent in respect of any deposit account or securities account constituting part of the Collateral shall be satisfactory in form and substance to the A/R Facility Lender and shall provide exclusive control thereof to the LS Facility Agent (or, following Discharge of the LS Facility Obligations, the A/R Facility Lender) upon a notice of exclusive control delivered following the occurrence of an Event of Default. EWB shall, contemporaneously with the opening of any deposit account or securities account with EWB for the account of any Obligor, enter into the A/R Lender Account Control Agreement in form and substance satisfactory to the LS Facility Agent and the A/R Facility Lender, or amend such agreement (if necessary) to cover any additional such deposit account or securities account at the time such account is opened. The LS Facility Agent or the A/R Facility Lender entering into any such account control agreement shall be treated as entering into such account control agreement on behalf of both LS Facility Claimholders and  A/R Facility Claimholders, with funds or other assets in any such deposit account or securities account to be applied in accordance with the terms of this Agreement.  Upon Discharge of the LS Facility Obligations the LS Facility Agent shall deliver any required notice, or take such other action as may reasonably be required, to transfer or assign its rights under any such account control agreement entered into by it to the A/R Facility Lender.  Upon Discharge of the A/R Facility Obligations the LS Facility Agent shall deliver any required notice, or take such other action as may reasonably be required, to transfer or assign its rights under any such account control agreement entered into by it to the LS Facility Agent.

 

(b)            Upon (i) delivery of a written notice to the LS Facility Agent from the A/R Facility Lender that an event of default has occurred under the A/R Facility Agreement and the maturity of the A/R Facility Loans has been accelerated in accordance with the terms of the A/R Facility Documents, (ii) the occurrence of Proceeds of Collateral being applied pursuant to Section 8.4 hereof, or (iii) delivery of a written notice to the A/R Facility Lender from the LS Facility Agent that an event of default has occurred under the LS Facility Agreement and the notice is being given pursuant to this Section 8.3(b), then in each case, the LS Facility Agent and the A/R Facility Lender shall (x) act in good faith, until Discharge of the A/R Facility Obligations or Discharge of the LS Facility Obligations, to identify and segregate Proceeds of the A/R Facility Receivables that constitute part of the A/R Facility Receivables Collateral and Proceeds of all other Collateral, and (y) all Proceeds of Collateral (other than A/R Facility Receivables Collateral) shall, at the direction of LS Facility Agent be deposited into the Term Loan Priority Account(s).

 

Section 8.4     Application of Proceeds.

 

(a)            Whether or not any Insolvency Proceeding has been commenced by or against any Obligor, any Collateral or Proceeds thereof received in connection with any Exercise of Secured Creditor Remedies and Proceeds of Collateral received pursuant to Section 2.2 (Disposition of Collateral; Release of Liens) or 2.6 (Insurance) above, including any distribution pursuant to any such Insolvency Proceeding, shall (at such time as such Collateral or Proceeds have been monetized) be applied:

 

(i) first, to the extent constituting Proceeds of, or included in, A/R Facility Receivables Collateral, to the payment of costs and expenses of A/R Facility Lender in connection with any Exercise of Secured Creditor Remedies, and next to the payment of costs and expenses of LS Facility Agent in connection with any Exercise of Secured Creditor Remedies;

 

  29 Intercreditor Agreement

 

 

(ii) Second, to the extent constituting Proceeds of, or included in, Collateral (other than A/R Facility Receivables Collateral) to the payment of costs and expenses of LS Facility Agent in connection with any Exercise of Secured Creditor Remedies, and next to the payment of cost and expenses of A/R Facility Lender in connection with any Exercise of Secured Creditor Remedies;

 

(iii) Third, solely to the extent constituting Proceeds of, or included in, A/R Facility Receivables Collateral, to the payment in full in cash of the A/R Facility Obligations in accordance with the A/R Facility Documents until the Discharge of the A/R Facility Obligations;

 

(iv) Fourth, to the payment in full in cash of the LS Facility Obligations in accordance with the terms of the LS Facility Documents until the Discharge of the LS Facility Obligations;

 

(v) Fifth, to the payment in full in cash of the A/R Facility Obligations in accordance with the A/R Facility Documents until the Discharge of the A/R Facility Obligations and

 

(vi) fourth, to DDH or such other Person entitled thereto under applicable law.

 

(b)            If any Exercise of Secured Creditor Remedies with respect to the Collateral produces non-cash Proceeds, or if non-cash Proceeds are received pursuant to Section 2.2 (Disposition of Collateral; Release of Liens) or 3.4 (Collateral or Proceeds Received from the Exercise of Secured Creditor Remedies) above, then the LS Facility Creditors shall have the right, but not the obligation, to hold such non-cash Proceeds as additional Collateral and, at such time as such non-cash Proceeds are monetized, shall be applied as set forth above.

 

Article 9
Other Provisions

 

Section 9.1     Representations and Warranties.

 

(a)            Representations and Warranties of A/R Facility Claimholders. Each A/R Facility Claimholder represents and warrants to each LS Facility Claimholder that:

 

(i) each A/R Facility Claimholder has the requisite power and authority to enter into, execute, deliver and carry out the terms of this Agreement;

 

(ii) this Agreement, when executed and delivered, will constitute the valid and legally-binding obligation of each A/R Facility Claimholder, enforceable against each A/R Facility Claimholder in accordance with its terms, except as such enforceability may be limited by applicable bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization, moratorium or similar laws affecting the enforcement of creditors' rights generally and by equitable principles and

 
(iii) no A/R Facility Claimholder has previously assigned any interest in the A/R Facility Documents or any of the A/R Facility Obligations.

 

  30 Intercreditor Agreement

 

 

(b)            Representations and Warranties of LS Facility Claimholders. Each LS Facility Claimholder represents and warrants to each A/R Facility Claimholder that:

 

(i) each LS Facility Claimholder has the requisite power and authority to enter into, execute, deliver and carry out the terms of this Agreement;

 

(ii) this Agreement, when executed and delivered, will constitute the valid and legally binding obligation of each LS Facility Claimholder, enforceable against each LS Facility Claimholder in accordance with its terms, except as such enforceability may be limited by applicable bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization, moratorium or similar laws affecting the enforcement of creditors' rights generally and by equitable principles and

 

(iii) no LS Facility Claimholder has previously assigned any interest in the LS Facility Documents or any of the LS Facility Obligations.

 

Section 9.2     Amendments. No amendment or waiver of any provision of this Agreement nor any consent to any departure by any party hereto shall be effective unless it is in a written agreement executed by the LS Facility Creditors (for themselves and on behalf of other LS Facility Claimholders) and the A/R Facility Lender, and then such waiver or consent shall be effective only in the specific instance and for the specific purpose for which given.

 

Section 9.3     Instrument Legends.

 

(a)            Any promissory note or other instrument or agreement evidencing any of the A/R Facility Obligations shall, at the reasonable request of LS Facility Agent, at all times include the following language:

 

"Anything herein to the contrary notwithstanding, the Liens and security interests securing the obligations evidenced by this [promissory note]/[instrument]/[agreement], the exercise of any right or remedy with respect hereto and certain of the rights of the holder hereof are subject to the provisions of the Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of October [·], 2021 (as amended, restated, supplemented, substituted, replaced or otherwise modified from time to time, the "Intercreditor Agreement"), by and between Lafayette Square Loan Servicing, LLC (in its capacity as agent for the LS Facility Lenders and together with its successors and assigns, the "LS Facility Agent"), for and on behalf of the LS Facility Creditors and each other LS Facility Claimholder (each as defined in the Intercreditor Agreement) from time to time, and East West Bank (“EWB”), acting on behalf of each A/R Facility Claimholder (as defined in the Intercreditor Agreement). In the event of any conflict between the terms of the Intercreditor Agreement and this [promissory note]/[instrument]/[agreement], the terms of the Intercreditor Agreement shall govern and control."

 

  31 Intercreditor Agreement

 

 

(b)            Any promissory note or other instrument or agreement evidencing any of the LS Facility Obligations shall, at the reasonable request of A/R Facility Lender, at all times include the following language:

 

"Anything herein to the contrary notwithstanding, the Liens and security interests securing the obligations evidenced by this [promissory note]/[instrument]/[agreement], the exercise of any right or remedy with respect hereto and certain of the rights of the holder hereof are subject to the provisions of the Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of October [·], 2021 (as amended, restated, supplemented, substituted, replaced or otherwise modified from time to time, the "Intercreditor Agreement"), by and between Lafayette Square Loan Servicing, LLC (in its capacity as agent for the LS Facility Lenders and together with its successors and assigns, the "LS Facility Agent"), for and on behalf of the LS Facility Creditors and each other LS Facility Claimholder (each as defined in the Intercreditor Agreement) from time to time, and East West Bank (“EWB”), acting on behalf of each A/R Facility Claimholder (as defined in the Intercreditor Agreement). In the event of any conflict between the terms of the Intercreditor Agreement and this [promissory note]/[instrument]/[agreement], the terms of the Intercreditor Agreement shall govern and control."

 

Section 9.4     Additional Remedies. If the A/R Facility Lender or any A/R Facility Claimholder, on one hand, or the LS Facility Creditors or any LS Facility Claimholder, on the other hand, violates any of the terms of this Agreement, in addition to any remedies in law, equity or otherwise, the LS Facility Creditors or A/R Facility Lender, as applicable, may restrain such violation in any court of law and may, in its own or in any Obligor's name, interpose this Agreement as a defense in any action by the A/R Facility Lender, such A/R Facility Claimholder, such LS Facility Creditor or such LS Facility Claimholder. Upon the LS Facility Creditors' or A/R Facility Lender's request, the A/R Facility Lender and each other A/R Facility Claimholder or the LS Facility Creditors and each other LS Facility Claimholder, as applicable, will promptly take all actions which the LS Facility Creditors may request to carry out the purposes and provisions of this Agreement.

 

Section 9.5     Third-Party Beneficiaries. This Agreement is solely for the benefit of LS Facility Creditors, the other LS Facility Claimholders, the A/R Facility Lender, and the other A/R Facility Claimholders, and no other Person (including any Obligor) is intended to be a third-party beneficiary hereunder. The LS Facility Creditors and the A/R Facility Lender shall have the right to modify or terminate this Agreement at any time without notice to or approval of any Obligor or any other Person (other than, in the case of LS Facility Creditors, the requisite LS Facility Claimholders under the LS Facility Agreement, and in the case of the A/R Facility Lender, the requisite A/R Facility Claimholders under the applicable A/R Facility Document).

 

  32 Intercreditor Agreement

 

 

Section 9.6     Notices. Except as otherwise provided herein, any notice, demand, request, consent, approval, declaration, service of process or other communication that is required, contemplated or permitted under this Agreement, or with respect to the subject matter hereof, shall be in writing and shall be deemed to have been validly served, given, delivered and received upon the earlier of (i) the day of transmission by electronic mail or hand delivery or delivery by an overnight express service or overnight mail delivery service and (ii) the third calendar day after deposit in the United States mails, with proper first class postage prepaid, in each case addressed to the party to be notified as follows:

 

If to the LS Facility Creditors: If to the A/R Facility Lender:
   
  Lafayette Square Loan Servicing, LLC East West Bank
  PO Box 25250 5001 Spring Valley Road, Suite 825W
  PMB 13941 Dallas, Texas 75244
  Miami, Florida 33102-5250 Attention: Hamilton LaRoe
  Attention: Susan Golden Email: Hamilton.LaRoe@EastWestBank.com
  Telephone:   (786) 598-2089 Telephone: +1 469 547 0992

  Email: legal@lafayettesquare.com;  
  lsloanops@lafayettesquare.com  

 

or to such other address as each Party may designate for itself by like notice.

 

Section 9.7     Reseved.

 

Section 9.8     Governing Law. THIS AGREEMENT AND THE OTHER Loan Documents (OTHER THAN AS EXPRESSLY SET FORTH IN OTHER LOAN DOCUMENTS) SHALL BE CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH AND GOVERNED BY THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK, EXCLUDING CONFLICTS OF LAWS PRINCIPLES THAT WOULD CAUSE APPLICATION OF LAWS OF ANY OTHER JURISDICTION.

 

Section 9.9     Consent to Jurisdiction and Venue.

 

(a)            Each Party hereby irrevocably and unconditionally submits, for itself and its property, to the exclusive jurisdiction of any New York State court or Federal court of the United States sitting in New York City, and any appellate court from any thereof, in any action or proceeding arising out of or relating to this Agreement, or for recognition or enforcement of any judgment, and each Party hereby irrevocably and unconditionally agrees that all claims in respect of any such action or proceeding may be heard and determined in such New York State or, to the extent permitted by law, in such Federal court. Each Party agrees that a final judgment in any such action or proceeding shall be conclusive and may be enforced in other jurisdictions by suit on the judgment or in any other manner provided by law. Nothing in this Agreement shall affect any right that the LS Facility Creditors may otherwise have to bring any action or proceeding relating to this Agreement or any LS Facility Document against the A/R Facility Lender, any Obligor or their respective properties in the courts of any jurisdiction. Notwithstanding the foregoing, in connection with any Insolvency Proceeding each Party submits to the jurisdiction of the court for such proceeding.

 

(b)            Each Party hereby irrevocably and unconditionally waives, to the fullest extent it may legally and effectively do so, any objection which it may now or hereafter have to the laying of venue of any suit, action or proceeding arising out of or relating to this Agreement in any New York State or Federal court. Each Party irrevocably waives, to the fullest extent permitted by law, the defense of an inconvenient forum to the maintenance of such action or proceeding in any such court.

 

  33 Intercreditor Agreement

 

 

(c)            Each Party irrevocably consents to service of process in the manner provided for notices in Section 9.6 (Notices) above. Nothing in this Agreement shall affect the right of any Party to serve process in any other manner permitted by law.

 

Section 9.10     Waiver of Jury Trial.

 

(a)            Because disputes arising in connection with complex financial transactions are most quickly and economically resolved by an experienced and expert person and the Parties wish applicable state and federal laws to apply (rather than arbitration rules), the Parties desire that their disputes be resolved by a judge applying such applicable laws. Each Party hereby waives, to the fullest extent permitted by applicable law, any right it may have to a trial by jury in respect of any litigation, including, without limitation, any cause of action, claim, cross-claim, counterclaim, third-party claim or any other claim, directly or indirectly arising out of, under or in connection with this Agreement (collectively, "Claims"). Each Party (a) certifies that no representative, agent or attorney of any other party has represented, expressly or otherwise, that such other party would not, in the event of litigation, seek to enforce the foregoing waiver and (b) acknowledges that it and the other parties hereto have been induced to enter into this agreement and the other loan documents, as applicable, by, among other things, the mutual waivers and certifications in this Section 9.10.

 

(b)            This waiver extends to all such Claims, including (i) Claims that involve Persons other than the Parties, (ii) Claims that arise out of or are in any way connected to the relationship among the Parties, or among the Parties and the Obligors and (iii) any Claims for damages, breach of contract, tort, specific performance or any equitable or legal relief of any kind arising out of this Agreement.

 

Section 9.11     Successors and Assigns.

 

(a)            This Agreement shall be binding upon, inure to the benefit of, and be enforceable by, each of the Parties, each of the LS Facility Claimholders, each of the A/R Facility Claimholders and the respective successors, transferees and assigns of each of the foregoing. Nothing herein is intended, or shall be construed to give, any other Person (including, for the avoidance of doubt, any Obligor or Subsidiary thereof) any right, remedy or claim under, to or in respect of this Agreement or any Collateral.

 

(b)            In addition, any assignee or transferee of any LS Facility Claimholder or A/R Facility Claimholder shall be required to enter into a joinder to this Agreement (to be in a form reasonably acceptable to the LS Facility Creditors or the A/R Facility Lender, as applicable); provided that (i) any purported assignment or transfer in violation of the foregoing provisions shall be null and void ab initio and of no force and effect and (ii) the subordination effected hereby shall survive any sale, assignment, disposition or other transfer of all or any portion of the LS Facility Obligations or A/R Facility Obligations.

 

Section 9.12     Integrated Agreement. This Agreement reflects the entire understanding of the parties with respect to the transactions contemplated hereby and shall not be contradicted or qualified by any other agreement, oral or written, before the date hereof.

 

  34 Intercreditor Agreement

 

 

Section 9.13     Counterparts. This Agreement may be executed in any number of counterparts and by different parties on separate counterparts, each of which, when executed and delivered, shall be deemed to be an original, and all of which, when taken together, shall constitute but one and the same Agreement. Delivery of an executed counterpart of this Agreement by telefacsimile or other electronic method of transmission shall be equally as effective as delivery of an original executed counterpart of this Agreement. Any party delivering an executed counterpart of this Agreement by telefacsimile or other electronic method of transmission also shall deliver an original executed counterpart of this Agreement, but the failure to deliver an original executed counterpart shall not affect the validity, enforceability or binding effect of this Agreement.

 

Section 9.14     Effectiveness; Continuing Nature of this Agreement; Severability. This Agreement shall become effective when executed and delivered by the Parties. This is a continuing agreement of Lien subordination, and the LS Facility Claimholders may continue, at any time and without notice to the A/R Facility Lender or any other A/R Facility Claimholder, to extend credit and other financial accommodations to or for the benefit of any Obligor constituting LS Facility Obligations in reliance hereof. The A/R Facility Lender and each other A/R Facility Claimholder hereby waives any right it may have under applicable law to revoke this Agreement or any of the provisions of this Agreement. The terms of this Agreement shall survive, and shall continue in full force and effect, in any Insolvency Proceeding. Any provision of this Agreement that is prohibited or unenforceable shall not invalidate the remaining provisions hereof, and any such prohibition or unenforceability in any jurisdiction shall not invalidate or render unenforceable such provision in any other jurisdiction. All references to any Obligor shall include such Obligor as debtor and debtor in possession and any receiver or trustee for such Obligor in any Insolvency Proceeding.

 

Section 9.15     Conflicts. To the extent that there is a conflict or inconsistency between any provision hereof, on the one hand, and any provision of any LS Facility Document or A/R Facility Document, on the other hand, this Agreement shall control and prevail.

 

Section 9.16     Termination. This Agreement shall continue in full force and effect until the Discharge of the LS Facility Obligations or the Discharge of the A/R Facility Obligations (or purchase thereof by an Eligible Purchaser pursuant to Article 7 hereof) shall have occurred and shall thereafter be revived to the extent provided for in Section 4.8 (Avoidance Issues) above.

 

[Signature pages follow]

 

  35 Intercreditor Agreement

 

 

In witness whereof, the undersigned have executed this Intercreditor Agreement as of the date first above written.

 

  LAFAYETTE SQUARE LOAN SERVICING, LLC, 
  as the LS Facility Creditor

 

By: /s/ Damien Dwin
    Name: Damien Dwin
    Title: Chief Executive Officer

 

 

 

 

  East West Bank
  as the A/R Facility Lender

 

By: /s/ Hamilton LaRoe
    Name: Hamilton LaRoe
    Title: First Vice President

 

 

 

 

Exhibit 10.19

 

Execution Version

 

PREFERRED EQUITY SUBORDINATION AGREEMENT

 

THIS PREFERRED EQUITY SUBORDINATION AGREEMENT (this “Subordination Agreement”) is entered into as of December 3, 2021, among Lafayette Square Loan Servicing, LLC, as agent for the Senior Lenders (as defined herein) (“Senior Agent”), USDM HOLDINGS, INC., a Texas corporation (“Class B Preferred Unit Holder”), and DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC, a Texas limited liability company (the “Company”). Capitalized terms used herein and not herein defined shall have the same meanings assigned to such terms in the Credit Agreement (as defined herein).

 

R E C I T A L S

 

A.            The Company desires that the Senior Lenders extend credit to the Company and certain of its affiliates, as set forth in the Credit Agreement. The Company and Class B Preferred Unit Holder have entered into that certain Amended and Restated Limited Liability Company Agreement dated as of September 30, 2020 (the “Company Agreement”).

 

B.            It is the agreement of the parties that the payment obligations owed by the Company to Class B Preferred Unit Holder shall be subordinate to the indebtedness owed by the Credit Parties (as defined below) to Senior Agent and the Senior Lenders, all as hereafter provided.

 

NOW, THEREFORE, for good and valuable consideration, the receipt, sufficiency and adequacy which are hereby acknowledged, the parties hereto agree as follows:

 

1.            Definitions. The following terms shall have the respective meanings specified below or in the Section or Recital referred to below:

 

Bankruptcy Proceeding means any proceeding by or against any party for relief under any bankruptcy, reorganization or insolvency law or laws relating to the relief of debtors, or any receivership, insolvency or assignment for the benefit of creditors, or any proceeding for any liquidation, liquidating distribution, dissolution or other winding up of such party, voluntary or involuntary, whether or not involving insolvency or bankruptcy proceedings.

 

Credit Agreement means that certain Term Loan and Security Agreement by and among the Company (together with any party joined thereto as a “Borrower” in accordance with Section 6.12 thereof, and all of their respective permitted successors and assigns, the “Borrowers”), Colossus Media, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company (“Colossus”), Huddled Masses LLC, a Delaware limited liability company (“HM’), Orange142 LLC, a Delaware limited liability company (“Orange”), and Universal Standard for Digital Marketing, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company (“USDM” and together with Colossus, HM, and Orange, Guarantors and each individually a Guarantorand together with the Borrowers, the “Credit Parties” and each a “Credit Party), the Senior Lenders, and Senior Agent dated of even date herewith, as amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time.

 

Enforcement Action means any judicial, arbitral or other proceeding, or any collection or enforcement action of any kind, to enforce or attempt to enforce any right or remedy available to Class B Preferred Unit Holder to collect the Junior Obligations, including any judicial, arbitral or proceeding or any collection action against the Company or the Company’s assets seeking, directly or indirectly, to enforce any rights or remedies, or to enforce any of the obligations incurred by the Company, under or in connection with the Junior Obligations (but excluding demand notices and other similar notices); provided, however, that (1) the imposition of surcharges as contemplated by Sections 3.1, 8.8, 8.9, or 8.10 of the Company Agreement, (2) the submission to mediation or arbitration as contemplated by Sections 8.8, 8.9, 8.10 or Section 12.16 of the Company Agreement and/or (3) specific performance, injunctive or other equitable relief as contemplated by Sections 8.11 or 12.16 of the Company Agreement (but still subject to Section 3 hereof) shall not be an “Enforcement Action” hereunder.

 

 

 

Junior Obligations means the obligation of Company to pay distributions of available cash, to allocate profits, to redeem Class B Preferred Units (as defined in the Company Agreement) or Common Units (as defined in the Company Agreement), or make any other payments to Class B Preferred Unit Holder in relation to Class B Preferred Unit Holder’s Class B Preferred Units and Common Units in accordance with Sections 3.1, 4.1, 8.8, 8.9 or 8.10 of the Company Agreement.

 

Permitted Payments has the meaning given such term in Section 3 herein.

 

Senior Debt has the meaning given such term in Section 2 herein.

 

Senior Lenders” means the “Lenders” under and as defined in the Credit Agreement.

 

2.            Subordination. The Junior Obligations shall be subordinate and junior in right of payment and collection to the payment and collection in full of all present and future indebtedness, obligations and liabilities of the Credit Parties to Senior Agent and the Senior Lenders under the Credit Agreement and Other Documents (the Senior Debt”).

 

3.            Limitations on Distributions, Payments and Redemption. Except as is hereinafter set forth in this Section 3, no payment shall be made by or on behalf of the Company on account of or for application against the Junior Obligations, whether as a result of setoff, realization upon collateral or otherwise, and no distribution (other than payment of Tax Distributions permitted under the Credit Agreement) of any kind shall be received by Class B Preferred Unit Holder from the Company, and no redemption shall be made by Class B Preferred Unit Holder any of the Class B Preferred Units (as defined in the Company Agreement) until the Senior Debt shall have been fully paid in cash and satisfied (other than contingent indemnification obligations as to which no claim has been asserted). The provisions of the first sentence of this Section 3 notwithstanding, so long as, at the time of and after giving Pro Forma Effect to such payment(s) or distribution(s): (i) the Consolidated Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio would not be less than 1.5 to 1.00 and (ii) no Default or Event of Default is continuing on the date of such payment or distribution (notwithstanding that any prior Events of Default may have occurred but have been waived or cured) or would reasonably occur as a result of such payment or distribution, the Company may make payments or distributions to the Class B Preferred Unit Holder permitted by the Company Agreement and the Company may pay the Class B Preferred Unit Holder and the Class B Preferred Unit Holder may receive the distributions and redemption price set forth in the Company Agreement with respect to such Class B Preferred Units or Common Units (as defined in the Company Agreement (the “Permitted Payments”). Notwithstanding anything in the foregoing to the contrary, nothing contained in this Subordination Agreement shall prevent the accrual of payments and distributions that would, but for the provisions of this Subordination Agreement, be payable or made; provided, that no such accrued payments or distributions shall actually be paid or made until otherwise permitted hereunder.

 

2

 

 

4.            Certain Distributions. Class B Preferred Unit Holder agrees that in the event of any distribution, division or any application, partial or complete, voluntary or involuntary, by operation of law or otherwise, of all or any part of the assets of the Company or the proceeds thereof to creditors of the Company, in any case for reason of the liquidation, dissolution or winding up of the Company or the Company's business, or in the event of any sale, receivership, insolvency or Bankruptcy Proceeding or assignment for the benefit of creditors, or any proceeding by or against the Company for any relief under any bankruptcy or insolvency law or laws relating to the relief of debtors, the adjustment of indebtedness, reorganizations, compositions or extensions, then and in any such event any payment or distribution of any kind or character, either in cash, property, securities or otherwise, which shall thereafter be paid or delivered by the Company upon or with respect to the Junior Obligations shall be turned over by Class B Preferred Unit Holder to Senior Agent (without liability for interest thereon) for application on the Senior Debt, until the Senior Debt shall have been fully paid in cash and satisfied (other than contingent indemnification obligations as to which no claim has been asserted).

 

5.            Remedies Standstill. Unless Senior Agent otherwise consents in writing, Class B Preferred Unit Holder will not commence any Enforcement Action prior to the date all Senior Debt is fully paid in cash and satisfied (other than contingent indemnification obligations as to which no claim has been asserted); provided however that if the Borrower fails to make any Permitted Payment that is due and owing to Class B Preferred Unit Holder, Class B Preferred Unit Holder may commence an Enforcement Action to collect such Permitted Payment.

 

For the avoidance of doubt, nothing contain herein shall be deemed to limit Class B Preferred Unit Holder's ability to enforce or attempt to enforce any right or remedy available to Class B Preferred Unit Holder under that certain Membership Interest Purchase and Contribution Agreement, dated on or about the date hereof, by and among Class B Preferred Unit Holder, the Company, and Orange, or under that certain Redemption Agreement dated as of November 14, 2021 by and between the Company and Class B Preferred Unit Holder (the “Redemption Agreement”).

 

6.            Additional Agreements. Class B Preferred Unit Holder agrees (a) that it will not commence or pursue in any action of any kind (including any Enforcement Action or Bankruptcy Proceeding) to prohibit, limit or impair the commencement or pursuit by Senior Agent of any of its rights or remedies under or in connection with the Senior Debt, the Credit Agreement, the Other Documents, or otherwise available to Senior Agent under applicable law; (b) that Class B Preferred Unit Holder will not assign or otherwise transfer the Junior Obligations unless such assignment is made expressly subject to this Subordination Agreement; and not to amend in any material respects the terms of the payment of the Junior Obligations, or to increase the distribution or other payments constituting Junior Obligations without the consent of Senior Agent (other than the imposition of surcharges as contemplated by Sections 3.1, 8.8, 8.9, or 8.10 of the Company Agreement).

 

7.            Treatment of Payments. In the event that notwithstanding the provisions of this Subordination Agreement, any cash or distribution of assets of the Company, whether in cash, property, securities or otherwise, which, under the provisions of this Subordination Agreement should not have been paid to Class B Preferred Unit Holder, is received by Class B Preferred Unit Holder or any person on its behalf, or provision is made for such payment or distribution, such payment or distribution shall be held for the benefit of and shall immediately be paid or delivered directly to Senior Agent, with any necessary endorsement, for application to the payment of the Senior Debt; until the Senior Debt shall have been fully paid cash and satisfied (other than contingent indemnification obligations as to which no claim has been asserted); provided, however, the Senior Agent must provide written notice to the Class B Preferred Unit Holder within 60 days of Senior Agent’s actual knowledge that a cash payment or distribution was made in violation of the terms hereof that such payment or distribution must be returned.

 

3

 

 

8.            Modification to Senior Debt. Senior Agent may, at any time and from time to time, without the consent of or notice to Class B Preferred Unit Holder, without incurring any responsibility to Class B Preferred Unit Holder, and without impairing or releasing the obligations of Class B Preferred Unit Holder to Senior Agent (a) change the manner, place or terms of payment of, or change or extend the time of payment of, or renew, alter or increase the Senior Debt; (b) extend, modify or amend any agreement or any other document related to the Senior Debt or the Senior Liens; (c) sell, exchange, release or otherwise deal with any property by whomsoever at any time pledged or mortgaged to secure or howsoever securing, any of the Senior Debt; (d) release anyone liable in any manner for the payment or collection of any of the Senior Debt, (e) exercise or refrain from exercising any rights against any Credit Party or any other person; or (f) take or refrain from taking any other action whatsoever.

 

9.            No Impairment. The provisions of this Subordination Agreement are intended solely for the purpose of defining the relative rights of Class B Preferred Unit Holder or any holder of the Junior Obligations, on one hand, and Senior Agent or any holder of the Senior Debt, on the other hand, and nothing contained in this Subordination Agreement is intended to or shall impair, as between the Company, other creditors, and Class B Preferred Unit Holder or any holder of the Junior Obligations, all amounts due and payable in accordance with the Junior Obligations, or to affect the relative rights of Class B Preferred Unit Holder or any holder of the Junior Obligations and creditors of the Company other than Senior Agent or holders of the Senior Debt, nor shall anything herein or therein prevent Class B Preferred Unit Holder or any holders of the Junior Obligations from exercising all remedies against the Company otherwise permitted by applicable law, subject to the rights of Senior Agent under the provisions of this Subordination Agreement and subject to the restrictions set forth in Section 5 hereof.

 

10.            Obligations Hereunder Not Affected. No action or inaction of Senior Agent or any other person, and no change of law or circumstances, shall release or diminish the obligations, liabilities, agreements or duties hereunder of Class B Preferred Unit Holder or the Company, or affect this Subordination Agreement in any way or provide any party any recourse against Senior Agent.

 

11.            Specific Performance. Senior Agent is hereby authorized to demand specific performance of this Subordination Agreement at any time when any other party shall have failed to comply with any of the provisions of this Subordination Agreement applicable to it. The Company and Class B Preferred Unit Holder hereby irrevocable waive any defense based upon the adequacy of a remedy at law which might be asserted as a bar to such remedy of specific performance and waive any requirement of the posting of any bond which might otherwise be required before such remedy of specific performance granted.

 

4

 

 

12.            Subrogation. No payment or distribution to Senior Agent pursuant to the provisions of this Subordination Agreement shall entitle Class B Preferred Unit Holder to exercise any rights of subrogation in respect thereof until the Senior Debt shall have been paid in cash and satisfied in full (other than contingent indemnification obligations as to which no claim has been asserted) or the Senior Agent shall have consented in writing to the exercise of such rights. After the payment of the Senior Debt in cash in full (other than contingent indemnification obligations as to which no claim has been asserted) and provided no payments are voidable, Class B Preferred Unit Holder shall be subrogated to the rights of Senior Agent to receive payments or distributions applicable to the Senior Debt to the extent the distributions otherwise payable to Class B Preferred Unit Holder have been applied to the payment of the Senior Debt.

 

13.            Choice of Law. THIS SUBORDINATION AGREEMENT SHALL BE GOVERNED BY AND CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK APPLICABLE TO AGREEMENTS MADE AND TO BE PERFORMED ENTIRELY WITHIN SUCH STATE.

 

14.            Representations. Class B Preferred Unit Holder represents and warrants that it has full power and authority to execute this Subordination Agreement and that this Subordination Agreement constitutes the valid and binding obligation of Class B Preferred Unit Holder enforceable in accordance with its terms, subject to applicable bankruptcy, insolvency and similar laws affecting creditors’ rights generally, concepts of reasonableness and general principles of equity, regardless of whether considered in a proceeding in equity or at law.

 

15.            Waivers and Amendments. Until the Senior Debt shall have been fully paid or satisfied, this Subordination Agreement may not be amended, waived, terminated or otherwise modified except with the consent of Senior Agent and Class B Preferred Unit Holder; provided however that this Subordination Agreement shall automatically terminate upon consummation of an IPO (as defined in the Redemption Agreement).

 

16.            No Implied Waiver. Any delay in the exercise of or any failure to exercise any right or remedy of Senior Agent shall not be deemed a waiver of any such right or remedy.

 

17.            Binding Effect. This Subordination Agreement shall be binding upon the parties and their respective successors, transferees and assigns. Each reference in this Subordination Agreement to Class B Preferred Unit Holder shall include any assignee or transferee of the Junior Obligations, and each reference in this Subordination Agreement to Senior Agent shall include any assignee or transferee of the Senior Debt and the Senior Liens.

 

18.            Invalid Provisions. If any term or provision of this Subordination Agreement shall be determined to be illegal or unenforceable, all other terms and provisions hereof shall nevertheless remain effective and shall be enforced to the fullest extent permitted by law.

 

19.            Further Assurances. Class B Preferred Unit Holder and the Company further agree to execute such subordinations and other documents that may be reasonably requested by Senior Agent to more fully give effect to the provisions of this Subordination Agreement.

 

5

 

 

20.            Notices. All notices, requests, consents, demands and other communications required or permitted under this Subordination Agreement shall be in writing and, unless otherwise specifically provided in this Subordination Agreement, (i) shall be deemed sufficiently given or furnished (a) if delivered by a commercial messenger service regularly retaining receipts for such delivery, effective on the date of delivery by the commercial messenger service; (b) if sent by electronic mail, effective on the date of delivery if sent return receipt acknowledged; (c) if sent by registered or certified mail, return receipt requested, effective forty-eight (48) hours after deposit; (d) if sent by telephonic facsimile transmission with a copy sent by regular mail, effective on the date imprinted on the facsimile transmission form; or if delivered by the air courier services known as FedEx, Express Mail, Airborne or Emory Air, effective upon delivery thereof to the courier, and (ii) shall be addressed to the parties as listed as follows:

 

Senior Agent’s address:

 

Lafayette Square Loan Servicing, LLC
PO Box 25250 

PMB 13941 

Miami, Florida 33102-5250 

  Attention: Susan Golden
  Email: legal@lafayettesquare.com;
    lsloanops@lafayettesquare.com

  

Company's address:

 

Direct Digital Holdings, LLC 

1233 West Loop South, Suite 1170 

Houston, Texas 77027 

Attention: Keith W. Smith 

Email: ksmith@directdigitalholdings.com 

Phone: (713) 540-4545

 

Class B Preferred Unit Holder's address:

 

USDM Holdings, Inc. 

5729 Krause Lane, Unit #13 

Austin, Texas 78738 

Attention: Leah Woolford and Jeff Woolford 

Email: leah@usdmholdings.com

    jeff@usdmholdings.com

 

with a copy (not constituting notice) to:

 

Fredrikson & Byron, P.A. 

200 South Sixth Street, Suite 4000 

Attention: Jessica D. Manivasager 

Email: jmanivasager@fredlaw.com

 

21.            Costs and Expenses. The Company agrees to pay, upon demand to Senior Agent, all reasonable and documented out-of-pocket costs and expenses (including court costs and reasonable attorneys’ fees for one primary counsel) incurred by Senior Agent in the enforcement of this Subordination Agreement.

  

22.            Counterparts. This Subordination Agreement may be executed in any number of identical counterparts, each of which when so executed constitutes an original and all of which constitute, collectively, one agreement.

 

[Remainder of Page Intentionally Blank; Signatures Begin on Next Page]

 

6

 

 

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, this Subordination Agreement is executed as of the date first above written.

 

  CLASS B PREFERRED UNIT HOLDER:
   
  USDM HOLDINGS, INC.
   
  By: /s/ Leah Woolford
    Name: Leah Woolford
    Title: Chairman and CEO

  

Signature Page to Preferred Equity Subordination Agreement

 

 

 

  COMPANY:
   
  DIRECT DIGITAL HOLDINGS, LLC
   
  By: /s/ Keith Smith
    Name: Keith Smith
    Title: President

 

Signature Page to Preferred Equity Subordination Agreement

 

 

  

  SENIOR AGENT:
   
  Lafayette Square Loan Servicing, LLC
   
  By: /s/ Damien Dwin
    Name: Damien Dwin
    Title: Chief Executive Officer

 

Signature Page to Preferred Equity Subordination Agreement

 

 

 

Exhibit 21.1

 

Subsidiaries of Direct Digital Holdings, Inc.

 

Legal Name   Jurisdiction of Formation
Direct Digital Holdings, LLC   Delaware
Orange 142, LLC   Delaware
Huddled Masses, LLC   Delaware
Colossus Media, LLC   Delaware

 

 

 

Exhibit 23.1

 

 

Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm’s Consent

 

We consent to the inclusion in this Registration Statement of Direct Digital Holdings, Inc. on Form S-1, of our report dated September 9, 2021 with respect to our audit of the financial statements of Direct Digital Holdings, Inc., as of August 26, 2021 and our report dated September 9, 2021 with respect to our audits of the consolidated financial statements of Direct Digital Holdings, LLC as of December 31, 2020 and 2019, and for the years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019, which reports appear in the Prospectus, which is part of this Registration Statement. We also consent to the reference to our Firm under the heading “Experts” in such Prospectus.

 

/s/ Marcum LLP

 

Marcum LLP

Houston, Texas

January 18, 2022

 

 

 

 

 

Exhibit 23.3

 

 

CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

 

Direct Digital Holdings, Inc.
Houston, Texas

 

We hereby consent to the incorporation by reference in this Amendment No. 1 to Registration Statement on Form S-1 of Direct Digital Holdings, Inc. of our report dated April 1, 2020, relating to our audit of the financial statements of Orange142, LLC as of December 31, 2019 and 2018, and for the years then ended, which appears in this Registration Statement. We also consent to the reference to our Firm under the heading “Experts” in this Registration Statement.

 

/s/ Baker Tilly US, LLP

 

Baker Tilly US, LLP
Plano, TX

 

January 17, 2022